Cambridge
UNIVERSITY PRESS
Physics
for Cambridge IGCSE™
c* r~ o
xx ix
vUUi\JlDvJUlx
David Sang, Mike Follows & Sheila Tarpey
Cambridge
UNIVERSITY PRESS
Physics
for Cambridge IGCSE™
COURSEBOOK
David Sang, Mike Follows & Sheila Tarpey
Cambridge
*
UNIVERSITY PRESS
University Printing House, Cambridge CB2 8BS, United Kingdom
One Liberty Plaza, 20th Floor, New York, NY 10006, USA
477 Williamstown Road, Port Melbourne, VIC 3207, Australia
314-321, 3rd Floor, Plot 3, Splendor Forum, Jasola District Centre, New Delhi - 110025, India
79 Anson Road, #06-04/06, Singapore 079906
Cambridge University Press is part of the University of Cambridge.
It furthers the University’s mission by disseminating knowledge in the pursuit of
education, learning and research at the highest international levels of excellence.
www.cambridge.org
Information on this title: www.cambridge.org/978-l-108-88807-3
© Cambridge University Press 2021
This publication is in copyright. Subject to statutory exception
and to the provisions of relevant collective licensing agreements,
no reproduction of any part may take place without the written
permission of Cambridge University Press.
First edition 2009
Second edition 2014
Third edition 2021
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
Printed in Dubai by Oriental Press
A catalogue record for this publication is available from the British Library
ISBN 978-1-108-88807-3 Coursebook with digital access (2 years)
ISBN 978-1-108-97042-6 Digital coursebook (2 years)
ISBN 978-1-108-74449-2 Coursebook eBook
Additional resources for this publication at www.cambridge.org/delange
Cambridge International copyright material in this publication is reproduced
under license and remains the intellectual property of Cambridge Assessment
International Education
NOTICE TO TEACHERS
The photocopy masters in this publication may be photocopied
or distributed [electronically] free of charge for classroom use
within the school or institution that purchased the publication.
Worksheets and copies of them remain in the copyright of
Cambridge University Press, and such copies may not be
distributed or used in any way outside the purchasing institution.
Exam-style questions [and sample answers] have been written by
the authors. In examinations, the way marks are awarded may be
different. References to assessment and/or assessment preparation
are the publisher’s interpretation of the syllabus requirements
and may not fully reflect the approach of Cambridge Assessment
International Education.
NOTICE TO TEACHERS IN THE UK
It is illegal to reproduce any part of this work in material form
(including photocopying and electronic storage) except under the
following circumstances:
(i) where you are abiding by a licence granted to your school or
institution by the Copyright Licensing Agency;
(ii) where no such licence exists, or where you wish to exceed the
terms of a licence, and you have gained the written permission
of Cambridge University Press;
(iii) where you are allowed to reproduce without permission under
the provisions of Chapter 3 of the Copyright, Designs and
Patents Act 1988, which covers, for example, the reproduction
of short passages within certain types of educational anthology
and reproduction for the purposes of setting examination
questions.
L
DEDICATED
TEACHER
> AWARDS
Teachers play an important part in shaping futures.
Our Dedicated Teacher Awards recognise the hard
work that teachers put in every day.
Thank you to everyone who nominated this year; we have been inspired and moved
by all of your stories. Well done to all of our nominees for your dedication to learning
and for inspiring the next generation of thinkers, leaders and innovators.
Congratulations to our incredible winner and finalists!
For more information about our dedicated teachers and their stories, go to
dedicatedteacher.cambridge.org
Hi Cambridge
UNIVERSITY PRESS
Brighter Thinking
Better Learning
Building Brighter Futures Together
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
•
Contents
*
How to use this series
vi
How to use this book
viii
Introduction
X
1 Making measurements
1.1
1.2
1.3
Measuring length and volume
Density
Measuring time
3
5
9
2 Describing motion
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
Understanding speed
Distance-time graphs
Understanding acceleration
Calculating speed and acceleration
20
24
25
31
6 Energy stores and transfers
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
Energy stores
Energy transfers
Conservation of energy
Energy calculations
104
107
110
114
7 Energy resources
7.1
7.2
The energy we use
Energy from the Sun
125
133
8 Work and power
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
Doing work
Calculating work done
Power
Calculating power
141
142
145
146
3 Forces and motion
3.1
3.2
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
We have lift-off
Mass, weight and gravity
Falling and turning
Force, mass and acceleration
Momentum
More about scalars and vectors
44
47
49
52
54
59
4 Turning effects
4.1
4.2
4.3
The moment of a force
Calculating moments
Stability and centre of gravity
5.4
5.5
Forces acting on solids
Stretching springs
The limit of proportionality and the
spring constant
Pressure
Calculating pressure
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
9.5
States of matter
The kinetic particle model of matter
Gases and the kinetic model
Temperature and the Celsius scale
The gas laws
155
156
160
162
164
10 Thermal properties of matter
68
69
74
5 Forces and matter
5.1
5.2
5.3
9 The kinetic particle model of matter
86
86
88
93
94
10.1
10.2
10.3
Thermal expansion
Specific heat capacity
Changing state
172
175
179
11 Thermal energy transfers
11.1
11 .2
11.3
11.4
Conduction
Convection
Radiation
Consequences of thermal
energy transfer
191
196
200
204
Contents
12 Sound
1 2.1
1 2.2
1 2.3
1 2.4
19 Electrical circuits
Making sounds
How does sound travel?
The speed of sound
Seeing and hearing sounds
216
217
219
221
13 Light
13.1
1 3.2
13.3
13.4
13.5
Reflection of light
Refraction of light
Total internal reflection
Lenses
Dispersion of light
231
236
241
246
253
Describing waves
Speed, frequency and wavelength
Explaining wave phenomena
Circuit components
Combinations of resistors
Electrical safety
349
353
365
20 Electromagnetic forces
20.1
20.2
20.3
20.4
The magnetic effect of a current
Force on a current-carrying
conductor
Electric motors
Beams of charged particles and
magnetic fields
378
382
384
386
21 Electromagnetic induction
14 Properties of waves
14.1
1 4.2
1 4.3
1 9.1
19.2
19.3
260
266
267
21.1
21.2
21 .3
Generating electricity
Power lines and transformers
How transformers work
395
401
405
22 The nuclear atom
15 The electromagnetic spectrum
15.1
15.2
15.3
Electromagnetic waves
Electromagnetic hazards
Communicating using
electromagnetic waves
279
284
285
16 Magnetism
1 6.1
16.2
Permanent magnets
Magnetic fields
295
297
17 Static electricity
17.1
17.2
17.3
Charging and discharging
Explaining static electricity
Electric fields
310
312
314
18 Electrical quantities
18.1
18.2
18.3
18.4
18.5
Current in electric circuits
Voltage in electric circuits
Electrical resistance
More about electrical resistance
Electrical energy, work and power
323
327
330
335
337
22.1
22.2
Atomic structure
Protons, neutrons and electrons
415
418
23 Radioactivity
23.1
23.2
23.3
23.4
Radioactivity all around us
Radioactive decay
Activity and half-life
Using radioisotopes
429
431
436
442
24 Earth and the Solar System
24.1
24.2
Earth, Sun and Moon
The Solar System
453
456
25 Stars and the Universe
25.1
25.2
25.3
The Sun
Stars and galaxies
The Universe
468
469
474
Appendix
Glossary
485
Key equations
496
Index
498
Acknowledgements
511
488
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
> How to use this series
We offer a comprehensive, flexible array of resources for the Cambridge IGCSE™
Physics syllabus. We provide targeted support and practice for the specific challenges
we've heard that students face: learning science with English as a second language;
learners who find the mathematical content within science difficult; and developing
practical skills.
Cambridge
UNIVERSITY PRESS
Physics
for Cambridge IGCSE’“
"
The coursebook provides coverage of the full Cambridge
IGCSE Physics syllabus. Each chapter explains facts
and concepts, and uses relevant real-world examples of
scientific principles to bring the subject to life. Together
with a focus on practical work and plenty of active learning
opportunities, the coursebook prepares learners for all
aspects of their scientific study. At the end of each chapter,
examination-style questions offer practice opportunities for
learners to apply their learning.
The digital teacher s resource contains detailed guidance for all topics of the
syllabus, including common misconceptions identifying areas where learners
might need extra support, as well as an engaging bank of lesson ideas for each
syllabus topic. Differentiation is emphasised with advice for
identification of different learner needs and
suggestions of appropriate interventions to
support and stretch learners. The teacher’s
resource also contains support for preparing
and carrying out all the investigations in the
practical workbook, including a set of sample
results for when practicals aren’t possible.
The teacher’s resource also contains scaffolded
worksheets and unit tests for each chapter.
Answers for all components are accessible to
teachers for free on the Cambridge GO platform.
How to use this series
The skills-focused workbook has been carefully constructed to help
learners develop the skills that they need as they progress through
their Cambridge IGCSE Physics course, providing further practice
of all the topics in the coursebook. A three-tier, scaffolded approach
to skills development enables learners to gradually progress through
‘focus’, ‘practice’ and ‘challenge’ exercises, ensuring that every learner
is supported. The workbook enables independent learning and is
ideal for use in class or as homework.
Cambridge
The Cambridge IGCSE practical workbook provides learners
with additional opportunities for hands-on practical work,
giving them full guidance and support that will help them to
develop their investigative skills. These skills include planning
investigations, selecting and handling apparatus, creating
hypotheses, recording and displaying results, and analysing
and evaluating data.
Physics
for Cambridge IGCSE'
COMING
IN 2022
Physics
for Cambridge IGCSE'
Mathematics is an integral part of scientific study, and one that
learners often find a barrier to progression in science. The Maths
Skills for Cambridge IGCSE Physics write-in workbook has been
written in collaboration with the Association of Science Education
with each chapter focusing on several maths skills that learners
need to succeed in their Physics course.
COMING
IN 2022
Our research shows that English language skills are the single
biggest barrier to learners accessing international science.
This write-in workbook contains exercises set within the
context of Cambridge IGCSE Physics topics to consolidate
understanding and embed practice in aspects of language
central to the subject. Activities range from practising using
comparative adjectives in the context of measuring density,
to writing a set of instructions using the imperative for an
experiment investigating frequency and pitch.
Physics
for Cambridge IGCSE'
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
> How to use this book
Throughout this book, you will notice lots of different features that will help your learning. These are explained below.
LEARNING INTENTIONS
These set the scene for each chapter, help with navigation through the coursebook and indicate the
important concepts in each topic. These begin with 'In this chapter you will:'.
In the learning intentions table, Supplement content is indicated with a large arrow and a darker
background, as in the example here.
GETTING STARTED
This contains questions and activities on subject knowledge you will need before starting the chapter.
SCIENCE IN CONTEXT
This feature presents real-world examples
and applications of the content in a chapter,
encouraging you to look further into topics that
may go beyond the syllabus. There are discussion
questions at the end which look at some of the
benefits and problems of these applications.
Supplement content: Where content is intended for
learners who are studying the Supplement content of the
syllabus as well as the Core, this is indicated in the main
text using the arrow and the bar, as on the right here, and
the text is in blue. You may also see the blue text with
just an arrow (and no bar), in boxed features such as the
Key Words or the Getting Started. Symbols in blue are
also supplementary content.
Questions
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS
This feature focuses on developing your practical
skills. They include lists of equipment required and
any safety issues, step-by-step instructions so you
can carry out the experiment, and questions to
help you think about what you have learned.
Appearing throughout the text, questions give you a
chance to check that you have understood the topic you
have just read about. The answers to these questions are
accessible to teachers for free on the Cambridge GO site.
ACTIVITY
Key vocabulary is highlighted in the text when it
is first introduced, and definitions are given in
Activities give you an opportunity to check
your understanding throughout the text in a more
active way, for example by creating presentations,
posters or taking part in role plays. When activities
have answers, teachers can find these for free on
the Cambridge GO site.
boxes near the vocabulary. You will also find
definitions of these words in the Glossary at the
back of this book.
KEY EQUATIONS
KEY WORDS
Important equations which you will need to learn
and remember are given in these boxes.
vlll
How to use this book
COMMAND WORDS
SELF/PEER ASSESSMENT
Command words that appear in the syllabus and
might be used in exams are highlighted in the
exam-style questions. In the margin, you will find
the Cambridge International definition. You will
also find these definitions in the Glossary.
At the end of some activities and experimental
skills boxes, you will find opportunities to help
you assess your own work, or that of your
classmates, and consider how you can improve
the way you learn.
WORKED EXAMPLE
REFLECTION
Wherever you need to know how to use an equation
to carry out a calculation, there are worked example
boxes to show you how to do this.
These activities ask you to think about the
approach that you take to your work, and how
you might improve this in the future.
PROJECT
Projects allow you to apply your learning from the whole chapter to group activities such as making posters or
presentations, or performing in debates. They may give you the opportunity to extend your learning beyond
the syllabus if you want to.
SUMMARY
There is a summary of key points at the end of each chapter.
Supplement content is indicated with a large arrow in the margin and a darker background, as here.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
Questions at the end of each chapter provide more demanding exam-style questions, some of which may require
use of knowledge from previous chapters. The answers to these questions are accessible to teachers for free on the
Cambridge GO site.
Supplement content is indicated with a large arrow in the margin and a darker background, as here.
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
The summary checklists are followed by ‘I can’ statements which match the Learning intentions at the beginning
of the chapter. You might find it helpful to rate how confident you are for each of these statements when you are
revising. You should revisit any topics that you rated ‘Needs more work’ or ‘Almost there’.
See
Topic...
Needs
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
Core
Supplement
ix
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
> Introduction
Studying physics
Thinking physics
Why study physics? Some people study physics for the
simple reason that they find it interesting. Physicists
study matter, energy and their interactions. They might
be interested in observing the tiniest sub-atomic particles,
or understanding the vastness of the Universe itself.
How do physicists think? One of the characteristics of
physicists is that they try to simplify problems - reduce
them to their basics - and then solve them by applying
some very fundamental ideas. For example, you will
be familiar with the idea that matter is made of tiny
particles that attract and repel each other and move
about. This is a very useful model, which has helped
us to understand the behaviour of matter, how sound
travels, how electricity flows, and much more.
On a more human scale, physicists study materials to
try to predict and control their properties. They study
the interactions of radiation with matter, including the
biological materials we are made of.
Other people are more interested in the applications of
physics. They want to know how it can be used, perhaps
in an engineering project, or for medical purposes.
Depending on how our knowledge is applied, it can
make the world a better place.
Some people study physics as part of their course
because they want to become some other type of scientist
- perhaps a chemist, biologist or geologist. These
branches of science draw a great deal on ideas from
physics, and physics may draw on them.
Once a fundamental idea is established, physicists look
around for other areas where it might help to solve
problems. One of the surprises of 20th century physics
was that, once physicists had begun to understand the
fundamental particles of which atoms are made, they
realised that this helped to explain the earliest moments
in the history of the Universe, at the time of the
Big Bang.
Medicine is often seen as a biological career but this doctor will use many applications of physics, from X-rays to robotic
limbs, in her work.
X
Introduction
Physics relies on mathematics. Physicists measure
quantities and analyse data. They invent mathematical
models - equations and so on - to explain their
findings. In fact, a great deal of mathematics has been
developed by physicists to help them to understand their
experimental results. An example of this is the work of
Edward Witten, who designed new mathematical tools to
unify different versions of superstring theory - a theory
which tries to unite all the forces and particles you are
learning about.
The more you study physics, the more you will come to
realise how the ideas join up. Indeed, the ultimate goal
for many physicists is to link all ideas into one unifying
‘theory of everything’.
Computers have made a big difference in physics,
allowing physicists to process vast amounts of data
rapidly. Computers can process data from telescopes,
control distant spacecraft and predict the behaviour of
billions of atoms in a solid material.
Stephen Hawking was a brilliant young student when he was
diagnosed with motor neurone disease. He was expected to
live only a few years, but at the time of his death at 76 he was
still working as a professor at Cambridge University. One of
his main aims was to unite relativity (which explains the very
large) and quantum physics (which explains the very small).
Hawking came to believe this would not happen, but
was glad about this: ‘I’m now glad that our search for
understanding will never come to an end, and that we
will always have the challenge of new discovery. Without
it, we would stagnate.’
Using physics
The practical applications of physics are far reaching.
Many physicists work in economics and finance, using
ideas from physics to predict how markets will change.
Others use their understanding of particles in motion to
predict how traffic will flow, or how people will move in
crowded spaces. This type of modelling can be used to
help us understand the spread of pathogens, such as the
virus which caused the 2020 Covid-19 pandemic.
In April 2019 the first pictures were released of a black hole.
The central area is so dense that light cannot escape it.
This image was the result of hundreds of scientists using a
network of radio telescopes around the world, processing
many petabytes of data - 1 petabyte is equal to 1 million
gigabytes or 1 x 1015 bytes.
Physics is being used to find solutions for the world’s
major problems. New methods of generating electricity
without adding to greenhouse gas emissions are helping
to reduce our dependence on fossil fuels. Developments
in battery technology allow us to store electrical energy,
making electric vehicles a reality.
xi
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
If this child drives it will probably be in an electric vehicle like this one. Many countries aim to phase out polluting, fossil fuel
powered vehicles by the middle of the 21st century. Physicists are improving car design and battery life to make this feasible.
Joining in
So, when you study physics, you are doing two things.
i
You are joining in with a big human project learning more about the world around us and
applying that knowledge.
ii At the same time, you are learning to think like
a physicist - how to apply some basic ideas, how
to look critically at data, and how to recognise
underlying patterns. Whatever path you take, these
skills will remain with you and help you make sense
of the rapidly changing world in which we live.
> Chapter 1
Makino
measurements
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
In pairs, either take the measurements or write down how you would do the following:
•
•
•
measure the length, width and thickness of this book and work out its volume
measure the thickness of a sheet of paper that makes up this book
measure the length of a journey (for example, on a map) that is not straight.
Now discuss how you would work out the density of:
•
•
an irregular-shaped solid
•
a liquid.
a regular-shaped solid
ARE WE CLEVERER THAN OUR ANCESTORS WERE?
People tend to dismiss people who lived in the
past as less intelligent than we are. After all, they
used parts of their bodies for measuring distances.
A cubit was the length of the forearm from the tip
of the middle finger to the elbow. However, the
ancient Egyptians knew this varied between people.
Therefore, in around 3000 BCE, they invented the
royal cubit (Figure 1.1), marked out on a piece of
granite and used this as a standard to produce
cubit rods of equal length.
Figure 1.2: Eratosthenes used shadows and geometry to
work out the circumference of the Earth.
Discussion questions
Figure 1.1: Cubit rod.
1
The Ancient Egyptians were experts at using very
simple tools like the cubit rod. This enabled them
to build their pyramids accurately. Eratosthenes,
a brilliant scientist who lived in Egypt in about
300 BCE, showed the same care and attention to
detail. This allowed him to work out that the Earth
has a circumference of 40000 km (Figure 1.2).
In contrast, there are many recent examples where
incorrect measurements have led to problems.
Although the Hubble Space Telescope had the most
precisely shaped mirror ever made, the original
images it produced were not as clear as expected.
Tiny mistakes in measuring meant that it had the
wrong shape and it took a lot of effort to account
for these errors.
2
You cannot always depend on your eyes to
judge lengths. Look at Figure 1.3 and decide
which line is longer? Check by using a ruler.
Figure 1.3: Which line is longer?
2
Eratosthenes may have hired a man to pace
the distance between Alexandria and Syene
(present-day Aswan) to calculate the Earth's
circumference. People have different stride
lengths so some people take longer steps than
others. Discuss the possible ways that anyone
with any stride length could have measured
the distance between these towns accurately.
1
1.1 Measuring length
and volume
In physics, we make measurements of many different
lengths, for example, the length of a piece of wire, the
height of liquid in a tube, the distance moved by an
object, the diameter of a planet or the radius of its orbit.
In the laboratory, lengths are often measured using a
ruler (such as a metre ruler).
Measuring lengths with a ruler is a familiar task. But when
you use a ruler, it is worth thinking about the task and
just how reliable your measurements may be. Consider
measuring the length of a piece of wire (Figure 1 .4).
• The wire must be straight, and laid closely alongside
the ruler. (This may be tricky with a bent piece
of wire.)
• Look at the ends of the wire. Are they cut neatly,
or are they ragged? Is it difficult to judge where the
wire begins and ends?
• Look at the markings on the ruler. They are
probably 1 mm apart, but they may be quite wide.
Line one end of the wire up against the zero on the
scale. Because of the width of the mark, this may be
awkward to judge.
• Look at the other end of the wire and read the scale.
Again, this may be tricky to judge.
Now you have a measurement, with an idea of how precise
it is. You can probably determine the length of the wire to
within a millimetre. But there is something else to think
about - the ruler itself. How sure can you be that it is
correctly calibrated? Are the marks at the ends of a metre
ruler separated by exactly one metre? Any error in this will
lead to an inaccuracy (probably small) in your result.
Figure 1.5: Making multiple measurements.
Making measurements
The point here is to recognise that it is always important
to think critically about the measurements you make,
however straightforward they may seem. You have to
consider the method you use, as well as the instrument
(in this case, the ruler).
Figure 1.4: Simple measurements still require careful
technique, for example, finding the length of a wire.
KEY WORDS
standard: is an absolute or primary reference or
measurement
precise: when several readings are close together
when measuring the same value •
calibrated: should agree closely with a standard
or agrees when a correction has been applied
More measurement techniques
If you have to measure a small length, such as the
thickness of a wire, it may be better to measure several
thicknesses and then calculate the average. You can use
the same approach when measuring something very thin,
such as a sheet of paper. Take a stack of 500 sheets and
measure its thickness with a ruler (Figure 1.5). Then
divide by 500 to find the thickness of one sheet.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
For some measurements of length, such as curved lines,
it can help to lay a thread along the line. Mark the thread
at either end of the line and then lay it along a ruler
to find the length. This technique can also be used for
measuring the circumference of a cylindrical object such
as a wooden rod or a measuring cylinder.
Measuring volumes
There are two approaches to measuring volumes,
depending on whether or not the shape is regular.
For a cube or cuboid, such as a rectangular block,
measure the length, width and height of the object and
multiply the measurements together. For objects of other
regular shapes, such as spheres or cylinders, you may
have to make one or two measurements and then look up
the equation for the volume.
For liquids, measuring cylinders can be used as shown
in Figure 1.6. (Recall that these are designed so that
you look at the scale horizontally, not at an oblique
angle, and read the level of the bottom of the meniscus.)
The meniscus is the curved upper surface of a liquid,
caused by surface tension. It can curve up or down but
the surface of water in a measuring cylinder curves
downwards. Think carefully about the choice of cylinder.
A 1 litre (or a 1 dm3) cylinder is unlikely to be suitable
for measuring a small volume such as 5 cm3. You will get
a more accurate answer using a 10 cm3 cylinder.
Measuring volume by
displacement
Most objects do not have a regular shape, so we cannot
find their volumes simply by measuring the lengths
of their sides. Here is how to find the volume of an
irregularly shaped object. This technique is known as
measuring volume by displacement.
•
Select a measuring cylinder that is about three or
four times larger than the object. Partially fill it with
water (Figure 1.7), enough to cover the object. Note
the volume of the water.
•
Immerse the object in the water. The level of water
in the cylinder will increase, because the object
pushes the water out of the way and the only way it
can move is upwards. The increase in its volume is
equal to the volume of the object.
Units of length and volume
In physics, we generally use SI units (this is short for
Le Systeme International d’Unites or The International
System of Units). The SI unit of length is the metre (m).
Table 1.1 shows some alternative units of length,
together with some units of volume. Note that the litre
and millilitre are not official SI units of volume, and so
are not used in this book. One litre (11) is the same as
1 dm3, and one millilitre (1 ml) is the same as 1 cm3.
KEY WORDS
volume: the space occupied by an object
meniscus: curved upper surface of a liquid
displace: moving something to another place so
water is moved out of the way (upwards) when an
object is lowered into it
immerse: to cover something in a fluid (usually
water) so that the object is submerged
Figure 1.6: A student measuring the volume of a liquid.
Her eyes are level with the scale so that she can accurately
measure where the meniscus meets the scale.
1
2
Making measurements
A stack of paper contains 500 sheets of paper.
The stack has dimensions of 0.297 m x 21.0 cm x
50.0 mm.
a What is the thickness of one sheet of paper?
b What is the volume of the stack of paper in cm3?
1.2 Density
Figure 1.7: Measuring volume by displacement.
Quantity
Units
length
metre (m)
0.1m
1 decimetre (dm) =
(cm)
=
0.01 m
1 centimetre
0.001 m
1 millimetre (mm) =
0.000001 m
1 micrometre (pm) =
(km)
= 1000 m
1 kilometre
volume
cubic metre (m3)
1 cubic centimetre (cm3) = 0.000001 m3
1 cubic decimetre (dm3) = 0.001 m3
Our eyes can deceive us. When we look at an object,
we can judge its volume. However, we can only guess its
mass. We may guess incorrectly, because we misjudge
the density. You may offer to carry someone’s bag, only
to discover that it contains heavy books. A large box of
chocolates may have a mass of only 200 g.
The mass of an object is the quantity (amount) of matter
it is made of. Mass is measured in kilograms. But density
is a property of a material. It tells us how concentrated
its mass is. You will learn more about the meaning of
mass and how it differs from weight in Chapter 3.
In everyday speech, we might say that lead is heavier than
wood. We mean that, given equal volumes of lead and
wood, the lead is heavier. In scientific terms, the density
of lead is greater than the density of wood. So we define
density as shown, in words and as an equation.
Density is the mass per unit volume for a substance.
Table 1.1: Some units of length and volume in the SI system.
Questions
1
The volume of a piece of wood which floats in water
can be measured as shown in Figure 1.8.
a Write a paragraph to describe the procedure.
b State the volume of the wood.
KEY WORDS
mass: the quantity of matter a body is composed
of; mass causes the object to resist changes in
its motion and causes it to have a gravitational
attraction for other objects
density: the ratio of mass to volume for a
substance
weight: the downward force of gravity that acts
on an object because of its mass
Figure 1.8: Measuring the volume of an object that floats.
The symbol for density is p, the Greek letter rho. The SI
unit of density is kg/m3 (kilograms per cubic metre).
You may come across other units, as shown in Table 1.2.
5
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Unit of mass
Unit of volume
Unit of density
Density of water
kilogram, kg
cubic metre, m3
kilograms per cubic metre
1000 kg/m3
kilogram, kg
cubic decimetre, dm3
kilograms per cubic decimetre
1.0 kg/dm3
gram, g
cubic centimetre, cm3
grams per cubic centimetre
1.0 g/cm3
Table 1.2: Units of density.
Values of density
Some values of density are shown in Table 1.3. Gases
have much lower densities than solids or liquids.
An object that is less dense than water will float. Ice is
less dense than water which explains why icebergs float
in the sea, rather than sinking to the bottom. Only about
one tenth of an iceberg is above the water surface. If any
part of an object is above the water surface, then it is less
dense than water.
Gases
Liquids
Solids
Many materials have a range of densities. Some types
of wood, for example, are less dense than water and will
float. Other types of wood (such as mahogany) are more
dense and will sink. The density depends on the nature
of the wood (its composition).
Gold is denser than silver. Pure gold is a soft metal, so
jewellers add silver to make it harder. The amount of
silver added can be judged by measuring the density.
It is useful to remember that the density of water is
1000 kg/m3, 1.0kg/dm3 or 1.0g/cm3.
Material
Density /kg/m3
air
1.29
hydrogen
0.09
helium
0.18
carbon dioxide
1.98
WORKED EXAMPLE 1.1
water
1000
alcohol (ethanol)
790
A sample of ethanol has a volume of 240 cm3.
Its mass is found to be 190.0 g. What is the density
mercury
13 600
ice
920
wood
400-1200
polyethene
glass
910-970
steel
7500-8100
lead
11340
silver
10 500
gold
19 300
2500-4200
Table 1.3: Densities of some substances. For gases, these are
given at a temperature of 0°C and a pressure of 1.0 x 105 Pa.
Calculating density
To calculate the density of a material, we need to know
the mass and volume of a sample of the material.
of ethanol?
Step 1: Write down what you know and what you
want to know.
mass m 190.0 g
volume V 240 cm3
density p ?
=
=
=
Step 2: Write down the equation for density,
substitute values and calculate p.
m
_
P~V
190 g
240 cm3
= 0.79 g/cm3
Answer
Density of ethanol = 0.79 g/cm3
1
Measuring density
The easiest way to determine the density of a substance
is to find the mass and volume of a sample of the
substance.
5
6
For a solid with a regular shape, find its volume by
measurement (see Section 1.1). Find its mass using a
balance. Then calculate the density.
Making measurements
The Earth has a mass of 6 x 1024kg and a radius
of about 6400 km. What is the density of the Earth
(in kg/m3)? The volume of a sphere is given by the
equation V = |w3, where r is the radius.
40 drawing pins (thumb tacks) like those shown
in Figure 1.10 have a mass of 17.55g. What is the
volume (in mm3) of one pin when they are made of
metal with a density of 8.7 g/cm3?
Questions
3
A brick is shown in Figure 1.9. It has a mass of
2.8 kg.
Figure 1.1 0: A pair of drawing pins (thumb tacks).
7
A young girl from the Kayan people in northern
Thailand wears a neck ring made of brass (Figure
1.11). It looks as if there are 21 individual rings but
the ring is actually one continuous length of brass
fashioned (bent) into a coil. The height of the brass
coil is 12 cm and its average circumference is 40 cm.
Neck rings are usually only removed to be replaced
with a bigger one as the girl grows. However, we
can estimate the mass of this neck ring without
removing it.
Figure 1.9: A brick labelled with its dimensions.
Give the dimensions of the brick in metres.
Calculate the volume of the brick.
Calculate the density of the brick.
c
A box full of 35 matches has a mass of 6.77 g.
The box itself has a mass of 3.37 g.
a
What is the mass of one match in grams?
b What is the volume (in cm3) of each match.
A match has dimensions of 42 mm x 2.3 mm x
2.3 mm?
What is the density of the matches?
c
d How do you know if these matches will float?
a
b
4
Figure 1.11: A Kayan girl wearing a neck ring.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
a
b
c
What looks like 21 individual rings around
the girl’s neck is actually 21 turns of a coil of
brass. Each turn has a circumference of 40 cm.
Calculate (in cm) the total length of brass used
to make the girl’s neck ring.
The coil has a height of 12 cm and the coil has
21 turns. Calculate the radius of the brass in cm.
If the brass coil is unwound from the girl’s neck
and straightened out, it would be a long, thin,
cylinder. Calculate the volume of this cylinder
in cm3. The volume of a cylinder is given by the
equation V nr2 h, where
r = radius and h = height.
Calculate the mass of brass used to make
the neck ring and express your answer in kg.
The density of brass 8.73 g/cm3.
When liquids mix, it is usually because dhe liquid dissolves
in the other. For example, orange squash is a concentrated
syrup that is diluted by dissolving it in water.
=
d
=
Finding the density of a liquid
Figure 1.13: Liquid density towers.
Figure 1.12 shows one way to find the density of a
liquid. Place a measuring cylinder on a balance. Set the
balance to zero. Now pour liquid into the cylinder. Read
the volume from the scale on the cylinder. The balance
shows the mass.
Apart from making colourful liquid density towers,
do variations in the density of liquids have practical
consequence? In Chapter 11, you will learn about
convection currents in fluids (liquids and gases), which
are driven by differences in density. These convection
currents include the thermohaline circulation in the
oceans. Colder and saltier water sinks, displacing
(pushing up) warmer and less salty water.
ACTIVITY 1.1
Finding the density of a regularly shaped solid
Figure 1.12: Measuring the mass of a liquid.
When liquids with different densities are poured into
the same container, they will arrange themselves so that
the liquid with the lowest density will be at the top and
the ones with the highest density will be at the bottom.
This is because the denser liquids displace the less dense
liquids. This is easier to see when each liquid is given a
different colour. In Figure 1.13, the green liquid is less
dense than the red liquid and so on.
When a distinct layer forms in a mixed solution, the
liquids are said to be immiscible, which means they do
not mix. This is why oil floats on water. However, not all
liquids stay separated so you would be disappointed if
you tried this at home with squash and water, for example.
In pairs, create a worksheet on the computer for
finding the density of a regularly shaped solid object
(for example, a rectangular block) using a ruler and a
mass balance. Your worksheet should include:
• a method for measuring the mass and working
out the volume
• the equation for calculating density
• a table to record the data.
You could include an optional task to work out the
density of a liquid.
After your allotted time, another pair is going to
test a copy of your worksheet (perhaps by doing
the experiment). They are going to add any steps
that are missing or make suggestions to make your
worksheet clearer. When you get your worksheet
returned, edit and save a new version of it.
1
Making measurements
CONTINUED
REFLECTION
Finding the density of an irregularly shaped solid
Before you start, make a copy of your previous
worksheet and save it under a new name. Some of
what you included in the previous worksheet can
be kept and some will need to be edited.
Write down one thing that you did really well in
this activity.
In pairs, create a worksheet for finding the density
of an irregularly shaped solid object using a mass
balance, a measuring cylinder, some thread, a pair
of scissors and a eureka can (if you have access to
one). Your method explaining how to measure the
mass and how to calculate the density should be
the same. However, you should:
• explain how to measure volume by displacement
• say something about choosing a suitably sized
measuring cylinder
• change your previous table
Write down one thing that you will try to do better
next time. How will you do this?
1.3 Measuring time
The athletics coach in Figure 1 .14 is using his stopwatch
to time a sprinter. For a sprinter, a fraction of a
second (perhaps just 0.01 s) can make all the difference
between winning and coming second or third. It is
different in a marathon, where the race lasts for more than
two hours and the runners are timed to the nearest second.
You could include an optional task to work out
the density of an irregularly shaped solid object
that is less dense than water. Finding its mass
and calculating the density is straightforward. The
challenging part is explaining how to work out the
volume of an object that floats.
Design a flowchart or decision-tree (optional)
Design a flowchart or decision-tree for use by
anyone who wants to work out the density of
any liquid or any solid object. Ensure that your
flowchart includes enough information so that
someone could take the measurements. Ask your
partner or someone else who has completed the
first two parts to check and correct your flowchart.
Figure 1.14: An athletics coach uses a stopwatch to time a
hurdler, who can then learn whether she has improved.
ACTIVITY 1.2
How dense can you be?
In groups of three, write a method showing how you could work out your own density, or that of a friend or of
a younger sibling. Alternatively, plan out your strategy and be prepared to share it with the class. There are at
least two methods: a dry method and a wet method. Discuss one or both of them.
You will need to include:
• a method that is detailed enough for someone to follow (this should include advice about how a
measurement should be taken)
• any calculations
• possible sources of uncertainty in the measurements
• what you expect your answer to be.
If you actually carried out the experiment, comment on how close your measurement was to what you expected.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
In the laboratory, you might need to record the
temperature of a container of water every minute, or
find out how long an electric current is flowing. For
measurements like these, stopclocks and stopwatches can
be used. You may come across two types of timing device.
An analogue clock (Figure 1.15) is like a traditional
clock whose hands move round the clock’s face. You find
the time by looking at where the hands are pointing on
the scale. It can be used to measure time intervals to no
better than the nearest second.
KEY WORDS
analogue: display has hands (or a needle) and is
often not very precise
digital: display shows numbers and is often precise
When studying motion, you may need to measure the
time taken for a rapidly moving object to move between
two points. In this case, you might use a device called a
light gate connected to an electronic timer. This is similar
to the way in which runners are timed in major athletics
events. An electronic timer starts when the marshal’s gun
is fired, and stops as the runner crosses the finishing line.
You will learn more about how to use electronic timing
instruments in Chapter 2.
Measuring short intervals
of time
Figure 1.15: An analogue clock.
A digital clock (Figure 1.16) or stopwatch is one that
gives a direct reading of the time in numerals. For
example, a digital clock might show a time of 9.58 s. A
digital clock records time to a precision of at least one
hundredth of a second. You would never see an analogue
watch recording times in the Olympic Games.
Figure 1.17 shows a typical lab pendulum. A mass, called
a plumb bob, hangs on the end of a string. The string
is clamped tightly at the top between two wooden jaws.
If you pull the bob gently to one side and release it, the
pendulum will swing from side to side.
The time for one oscillation of a pendulum (when it
swings from left to right and back again) is called its
period. A single period is usually too short a time to
measure accurately. However, because a pendulum
swings at a steady rate, you can use a stopwatch to
measure the time for a large number of oscillations
(perhaps 20 or 50), and calculate the average time per
oscillation. Any inaccuracy in the time at which the
stopwatch is started and stopped will be much less
significant if you measure the total time for a large
number of oscillations.
KEY WORDS
plumb bob: a mass (usually lead) hanging from a
string to define a vertical line
oscillation: a repetitive motion or vibration
Figure 1.16: A digital clock started when the gun fired and
stopped 9.58 s later when Usain Bolt crossed the finishing
line to win the 100 m at the 2009 World Championships in
world record time.
period: the time for one complete oscillation or
wave; the time it takes an object to return to its
original position
1
9
Making measurements
A student was investigating how the period of a
pendulum varied with the length of the string and
obtained the results in Table 1.4.
string / m
Length of
Time for 20
oscillations / s
0.00
0.0
0.20
18.1
0.40
25.1
0.60
28.3
0.80
39.4
1.00
40.5
1.20
44.4
1.40
47.9
Time for 1
oscillation / s
Table 1.4
a
Figure 1.17: A simple pendulum.
b
Questions
8
High-speed video can record sporting events at a
frame rate of 60 frames per second (frame/s).
a What is the time interval between one frame
and the next?
b If we can see 24 frame/s as continuous motion,
by what factor can the action recorded at
60 frame/s be slowed down and still look
continuous?
c
d
Why did the student record the time for 20
swings?
Make a copy of Table 1.4 and, for each length
of the pendulum, calculate the time for one
oscillation and record the value in the third
column of the table.
Plot a graph of the period of the pendulum
against its length (that is, plot the length of the
pendulum on the x-axis).
Use the graph to work out the length of the
pendulum when the period is 2 seconds. This is
the length of pendulum used in a grandfather
clock.
ACTIVITY 1.3
Using a pendulum as a clock
In 1656 the Dutch scientist Christiaan Huygens invented a clock
based on a swinging pendulum. Clocks like these were the
most precise in the world until the 1 930s. One oscillation of a
pendulum is defined as the time it takes for a plumb bob at the
bottom of the string to return to its original position (Figure 1.18).
You need to develop a worksheet so that students can plot a
graph of how the period of oscillation of a pendulum varies with
the length of the string. They then need to use the graph to find
the length the pendulum needs to be to give a period of one
second (useful for a clock). Your worksheet needs to:
Figure 1.1 8: One oscillation is when the
plumb bob swings one way and then the
other and returns back to its original position.
11
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
• define what an oscillation means (so that a student knows when to start and stop the stopwatch)
• explain why we take the time for 10 or 20 oscillations when we only need the time for one oscillation
• provide a labelled diagram of the assembled apparatus (not just a list of equipment) so that students
know how to put the equipment together
•
a method (step-by-step instructions).
Swap copies of your worksheet with a classmate. Write down suggestions for any improvements on the worksheet
you receive before returning it to its owner. Note down any improvements if you have a class discussion.
PROJECT
In groups of three or four, produce a podcast (no more
than five minutes long) on one of the following options.
•
Option 1: Can we build on what we have learned
about density?
•
This is opportunity to revise what you have learned
about density and then consolidate that knowledge
and understanding by applying it to one of the two
examples below.
• You must explain how density is calculated,
including the equation.
• You should describe how to measure the mass
and volume of both regular and irregular
shaped objects.
• You could describe how to work out the density
of an object that can float.
1 RSS Titanic
It was claimed that the RSS Titanic was unsinkable.
However the ship sank in 1912 on its first voyage.
• You must explain why a ship can float despite
being made of material that is denser than water.
• You should explain why a ship can sink, in terms
of changes in density.
• Do some research to find out about bulkheads
in ships: what are they and what are they for?
Why did the RSS Titanic sink despite being
fitted with bulkheads?
2 Submarines and scuba divers
You could describe one phenomenon that depends
on changes or differences in density. You could think
of your own or select one of these:
Explain how a submarine or scuba diver moves up
and down in the water column (or perhaps explain
how a Cartesian diver demonstration works).
Explain how differences in fluid density can
lead to convection (something you will meet in
Chapter 11). You might want to go on to discuss
how this relates to ocean currents or wind.
Option 2: What was the solution to the
longitude problem?
A clock based on a pendulum is impractical on the
moving deck of a (sailing) ship but knowing the time
is important for navigation as this provides your
longitude on a spinning Earth. Lines of longitude
are the vertical lines on a map. When you move east
or west you are changing your longitude; move far
enough and you change time zone.
• You must start with a short description of the
longitude problem.
• You could describe the various suggested
solutions to the longitude problem.
• You could describe the final solution to the
longitude problem. For this, you would need to
look up John Harrison and his marine chronometer.
Option 3: How did the Ancient Egyptians build
their pyramids so accurately?
The pyramids are an incredible feat of engineering,
even by today's standards. Using very basic tools, the
Egyptians' pyramids are perfectly symmetrical.
• You could start by introducing the dimensions
of the Giza pyramid and the number of blocks
required to build it.
1 Making measurements
CONTINUED
•
You could explain how the Egyptians managed
to get the sides of their pyramids lined up with
true north (without a compass) and how they got
the base of them absolutely level (flat) without a
(spirit) level.
Option 4: How did Eratosthenes work out the
circumference of the Earth?
Eratosthenes was a brilliant scientist. He was told
that, at the same time every year (1 2 noon on
21 June), vertical columns in Syene (present day
Aswan) cast no shadows while columns where he
lived in Alexandria cast shadows. He used this
to work out that the Earth is round. Eratosthenes
may have hired a man to measure out the distance
between Alexandria and Syene.
• You could start with a short biography of
Eratosthenes.
should explain why the observation with the
You
•
shadows shows that the Earth is a sphere. You
might want to include a diagram like Figure 1.2.
• You should try and show how the man hired
by Eratosthenes could have worked out his
stride-length (the distance of each step) and
kept count of his strides (steps). Think about his
possible journey: did he follow a straight line;
were there any hills in the way? Could this have
introduced errors in measuring the distance
between Alexandria and Syene?
• Finally, you could show how Eratosthenes did
the calculation.
Option 5: How did Archimedes really work out
that the goldsmith had replaced some of the
gold in Hiero's crown with silver?
Archimedes was probably the most brilliant scientist
of his era. He is supposed to have solved the
problem of how to work out the density of the crown
while having a bath. Legend has it that he then ran
into the streets shouting 'eureka' (I've solved it).
• You could start with a short biography of
Archimedes.
• You could then describe the usual explanation
of how he worked out that some gold had
been stolen. Silver is less dense than gold so
the same mass of silver has a bigger volume
and will displace a bigger volume of water.
However, it would be difficult to measure the
difference in volume, especially since bubbles
of air could cling to the submerged crown and
there could be other sources of error. '
• You could describe a better method, which
uses a mass balance. You would need to
explain why, when the masses are equal, the
balance tips towards the denser mass when
lowered into water.
• Gold needs some silver impurity or it would
be too soft and would be easy to bend out
of shape. Perhaps the goldsmith was falsely
accused? Perhaps this idea could form part of a
piece of creative writing (some prose or a play)
but be sure to include the physics.
REFLECTION
For your project, write down some thoughts
about what you feel went well and areas where
you could improve.
Give yourself a score out often for how much
you know and understand the physics you
included. If you scored ten, write down how
you could have produced a more ambitious
project. If you scored less, do you need to
thoroughly review the material or are you
making careless errors? Write down what
concrete steps you need to take to improve for
next time.
Give yourself a score out of ten for the
quality of your presentation. Write down
what you thought was good about the other
presentations or any effective presentation
ideas that you might use next time you present.
13
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SUMMARY
Length can be measured using a ruler.
The period of one oscillation can be measured by measuring the time for 20 oscillations and then dividing the
time by 20.
The volume of a cube or cuboid can be found by measuring the length of the three sides and multiplying the
measurements together.
The volume of a liquid can be measured using a measuring cylinder where the bottom of the meniscus appears
on the scale when looked at horizontally.
All objects that sink in water displace their own volume of water.
The volume of an irregularly shaped object can be found from the change in the height of liquid in a measuring
cylinder when it is immersed in the liquid.
Density is the ratio of mass to volume for a substance: p
=
The density of water is 1000kg/m3 or 1.0g/cm3.
Anything less dense than water will float in water and anything denser than water will sink in water.
Ice floats because it is less dense than water.
One liquid will float on top of another liquid if it is less dense.
Time can be measured using a clock or watch.
An analogue clock has hands and can only measure time to the nearest second.
A digital clock displays numbers and records time to a precision of at least one hundredth of a second.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
Use this table to answer questions 1 and 2.
Metal
Density / g/cm3
gold
19.30
silver
10.49
lead
11.34
1 Three metal cubes have the same volume but are made of different metals.
Each one is lowered into a beaker of water. Use the data in the table to
decide which one will cause the biggest rise in water level.
A gold
B silver
C lead
D all will cause the same rise in water level
14
>
[1]
1
Making measurements
CONTINUED
2 Three metal cubes have the same mass but are made of different metals.
Each one is lowered into a beaker of water. Use the data in the table to
decide which one will cause the biggest rise in water level.
A gold
B silver
C lead
D all will cause the same rise in water level
[1]
3 Astronauts land on another planet and measure the density of the atmosphere
on the planet surface. They measure the mass of a 500 cm3 conical flask
plus stopper as 457.23 g. After removing the air, the mass is 456.43 g (1 m3 =
[1]
1000 litres). What is the best estimate of the density of the air?
A 0.000001 6 kg/m3
B 0.0016 kg/m3
C 0.16kg/m3
D 1.6 kg/m3
4 The graph shows the mass and volume of several different objects.
Volume
[1]
Which two objects have the same density?
A 2 and 3
Bl and 4
C 2 and 4
D 3 and 4
5 A student measures the circumference of a circular copper pipe.
He wraps a length of string four times around the pipe and marks it with
ink, as shown in the photograph.
15
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
%
CONTINUED
a The student unwraps the string and holds it against a ruler with a centimetre
scale.
The photograph shows the first two ink marks on the string.
i Use the photograph to estimate the circumference of the pipe.
[1 ]
ii The student finds that the total length of string for 4 turns is 354 mm.
Calculate the average (mean) circumference of the pipe using this value. [1 ]
[Total: 2]
6 Suggest how you would work out the thickness of a single sheet of paper
if the only measuring device available was a ruler and its smallest division
was 1 mm.
[1 ]
7 What is the mass of a microscope slide that has dimensions of
75 mm x 26 mm x 1 mm and has a density of 2.24 g/cm3?
[2]
8 Four different liquids are poured into a 100 cm3 measuring cylinder that is
10 cm tall. Each liquid has a different density and each has a different colour.
a Calculate the missing values in the table.
[4]
Liquid
Mass / g
Volume /
cm3
Density /
g/cm3
clear
ethanol
i
20.00
0.79
red
glycerin
20.00
ii
1.26
green
olive oil
25.90
28.80
iii
blue
turpentine
30.00
35.30
iv
calculate; work out
from given facts,
figures or information
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations
b Copy the diagram below. Using the data from the table above, write down
the colour of the liquid you would expect to find in each layer and how
thick the layer would be.
[2]
Colour of layer
Thickness of layer / cm
9 Metals are denser than water. Explain why a metal ship can float.
[1 ]
1 0 Suggest how you could work out the density of a drawing pin.
[3]
16
COMMAND WORDS
where there are
a range of valid
responses in order
to make proposals/
put forward
considerations
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
1
Making measurements
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
\fter studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
iny gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
Measure length, volume and time.
See
Topic...
Needs
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
1.1, 1.3
Calculate the volume of a cube or cuboid from
measurements using a ruler.
1.1
Determine the volume of an irregularly shaped object.
1.1
Measure the size of tiny objects (for example, the thickness
of a sheet of paper, the volume of a drawing pin).
1.1
Calculate density.
1.2
Predict whether an object will float or sink in water
based on its density.
1.2
Describe an experiment to find the density of a liquid.
1.2
Predict whether a liquid will float on top of another liquid
if their densities are known and they cannot mix.
1.2
Describe an experiment to find the density of a cube
or cuboid.
1.2
Describe an experiment to find the density of an
irregularly shaped object.
1.2
Describe the differences between analogue and digital
watches or clocks.
1.3
•
17
> Chapter 2
Describing
motion
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
define speed and calculate average speed
plot and interpret distance-time and speed-time graphs
work out the distance travelled from the area under a speed-time graph
understand that acceleration is a change in speed and the gradient of a speed-time graph
distinguish between speed and velocity
define and calculate acceleration; understand deceleration as a negative acceleration
use the gradient of a distance-time graph to calculate speed and the gradient of a speed-time graph to
calculate acceleration.
2
Describing motion
.1 ITING STARTED
Work in pairs.
)n your own, quickly sketch a distance-time graph, perhaps based on your journey to school. Then ask your
I - irtner to write a description of it on a separate sheet of paper. Discuss each other's answers.
1
ik < Itch a speed-time graph for a sprinter running the 100 m in a time of 9.58 s. Label it with as much
information as you know. Show how your graph could be used to work out the sprinter's acceleration at
tin start of the race and the distance he travelled. Compare your sketch with your partner's and add to or
orrect your own work. Be prepared to share your thoughts with the class.
AROUND THE WORLD IN 80 DAYS
II" first known circumnavigation (trip around
tin world) was completed by a Spanish ship on 8
1
>i ptember 1 522. It took more than three years.
IL French writer Jules Verne wrote the book
I tour du monde en quatre-vingts j'ours (which
n tans Around the World in Eighty Days) in 1873.
In honour of the writer, the Jules Verne Trophy
r
prize for the fastest circumnavigation by a
h
ht,
now held by the yacht IDEC Sport, which
.
lid it in just under 41 days in 2017. In 2002, the
-American Steve Fossett was the first to make a solo
ir :umnavigation in a balloon, without stopping,
i if ing just over 13 days. In 2006, he flew the
ir< iin Atlantic GlobalFlyer (Figure 2.1), the first
f i - »d-wing aircraft to go around the world without
>pping or refuelling. It took him just under
lime days. Hypersonic jets are being developed
th-it could fly at 1.7 km per second so they could
iriumnavigate the globe in an incredible six and a
half hours.
Sometimes these epic adventures inspire those who
do them to campaign for a better world. The British
sailor Ellen MacArthur (Figure 2.2) is just such a
person. She held the world record for the fastest
solo circumnavigation, achieved on 7 February
2005. However, she retired from competitive
sailing to set up the Ellen MacArthur Foundation,
a charity that works with business and education
to accelerate the transition to a circular economy.
A circular economy would create less waste as
things should be designed to last a long time and
be easy to maintain, repair, reuse or recycle.
1
Figure 2.2: Ellen MacArthur celebrates after completing
her record solo round the world journey on 7 February
2005 in Falmouth, England.
Discussion questions
I Igure 2.1: The Virgin Atlantic GlobalFlyer passes over
th Atlas Mountains.
1
What were the speeds of the six journeys
mentioned in the first paragraph? Assume that
the Earth's circumference is 40000 km.
2
How could the fastest boat not win a roundthe-world yacht race?
19
}
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
2.1 Understanding speed
Measuring speed
If you travel on a major highway or through a large city,
the chances are that someone is watching you. Cameras
by the side of the road and on overhead road signs keep
an eye on traffic as it moves along. Some cameras are
there to monitor the flow, so that traffic managers can
take action when blockages develop, or when accidents
occur. Other cameras are equipped with sensors to spot
speeding motorists, or those who break the law at traffic
lights. In some busy places, traffic police may observe the
roads from helicopters.
In this chapter, we will look at ideas of motion and
speed. In Chapter 3, we will look at how physicists came
to understand the forces involved in motion, and how to
control them to make our everyday travel possible.
We cannot say whether it was travelling at a steady speed,
or if its speed was changing. For example, you could use
a stopwatch to time a friend cycling over a fixed distance,
for example, 100 metres (see Figure 2.3). Dividing
distance by time would tell you their average speed, but
they might have been speeding up or slowing down along
the way.
Table 2.1 shows the different units that may be used in
calculations of speed. SI units are the standard units
used in physics. The units m/s (metres per second) should
remind you that you divide a distance (in metres, m) by a
time (in seconds, s) to find speed. In practice, many other
units are used. In US space programmes, heights above the
Earth are often given in feet, while the spacecraft’s speed
is given in knots (nautical miles per hour). These awkward
units did not prevent them from reaching the Moon!
Distance, time and speed
There is more than one way to determine the speed of a
moving object. Several methods to determine speed rely
on making two measurements:
•
the total distance travelled between two points
•
the total time taken to travel between these two points.
We can then work out the average speed between the
two points.
KEY EQUATION
„„
average
speed
_
travelled
= total distance
total time taken
KEY WORDS
speed: the distance travelled by an object per
unit of time
average speed: the speed calculated from total
distance travelled divided by total time taken
We can use the equation for speed in the definition
when an object is travelling at a constant speed. If it
travels 10 metres in 1 second, it will travel 20 metres in
2 seconds. Its speed is lOm/s.
20
>
Figure 2.3: Timing a cyclist over a fixed distance. Using
a stopwatch involves making judgements as to when the
cyclist passes the starting and finishing lines. This can
introduce an error into the measurements. An automatic
timing system might be better.
Quantity
SI unit
Other units
distance
metre, m
kilometre, km
time
second, s
hour, h
metres per second,
kilometres per
hour, km/h
speed
m/s
Table 2.1: Quantities, symbols and units in measurements
of speed.
2 Describing motion
)RKED EXAMPLE 2.1
A • \ i list completed a 1500 metre stage of a race in
i
> s What was her average speed?
up I : Start by writing down what you know, and
what you want to know.
distance = 1500 m
time 37.5 s
speed ?
=
=
'
Determining speed in
the laboratory
There are many experiments you can do in the laboratory
if you can measure the speed of a moving trolley or
toy car. Figure 2.4 shows how to do this using one or
two light gates connected to an electronic timer (or to
a computer). The light gate has a beam of (invisible)
infrared radiation.
<tcp 2: Now write down the equation.
speed = distance
time
3: Substitute the values of the quantities on the
right-hand side.
1500 m
' itcp
._
infrared
beam
Step 4: Calculate the answer.
speed 40 m/s
=
kiMwer
I he cyclist’s average speed was 40 m/s.
Questions
1
J
I
What was Usain Bolt’s average speed when he
achieved his 100 m world record of 9.58 s in
2009?
b How do you know that his top speed must have
been higher than this?
A cheetah runs 100 m in 3.11 s. What is its speed?
Information about three trains travelling between
stations is shown in Table 2.2.
a
travelled / km
Time taken /
minutes
train A
250
120
train B
72
50
train C
400
150
Vehicle
Distance
Table 2.2
a
b
Which train has the highest average speed?
Which train has the lowest average speed?
Figure 2.4: Using light gates to measure the speed of a
moving trolley in the laboratory.
In the first part of Figure 2.4, the peg attached to the
trolley breaks the beam of one light gate to start the
timer. It breaks the second beam to stop the timer. The
timer then shows the time taken to travel the distance
between the two light gates.
21
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
In the second part of Figure 2.4, a piece of card, called
an interrupt card, is mounted on the trolley. As the
trolley passes through the gate, the leading edge of
the interrupt card breaks the beam to start the timer.
When the trailing edge passes the gate, the beam is no
longer broken and the timer stops. The faster the trolley
is moving, the shorter the time for which the beam
is broken. Given the length of the interrupt card, the
trolley’s speed can be calculated.
KEY WORDS
Similarly, the crew of an aircraft might want to know
how long it will take for their aircraft to travel between
two points on its flight path:
time
or ; = £v
= distance^
speed
WORKED EXAMPLE 2.2
A spacecraft is orbiting the Earth at a steady speed
of 8.0 km/s (see Figure 2.5). How long will it take to
complete a single orbit, a distance of 44 000 km?
light gates: allow the speed of an object passing
between them to be calculated electronically
interrupt card: allows the speed of an object
passing through a light gate to be calculated; a
timer starts when the card breaks the beam and
stops when the beam is no longer broken
Rearranging the equation
It is better to remember one version of an equation
and how to rearrange it than to try to remember three
different versions. The equation
speed
= dis-tance
time
allows us to calculate speed from measurements of distance
and time. This equation can also be written in symbols:
Figure 2.5
Step 1: Start by writing down what you know, and
what you want to know.
speed (v) = 8.0 km/s
distance (5) 40 000 km
time (t) ?
=
=
Step 2: Choose the appropriate equation, with the
unknown quantity, time, as the subject (on
the left-hand side).
Step 3:
This is sometimes known as the instantaneous speed,
which is the speed at a particular instant or moment in
time, whereas average speed is worked out over a longer
time interval. Beware, s in this equation means distance
(or displacement) and not speed. We can rearrange the
equation to allow us to calculate distance or time.
For example, a railway signaller might know how fast a
train is moving, and needs to be able to predict where it
will have reached after a certain length of time:
distance
22
= speed x time or s = vt
Substitute values - it can help to include units.
40000 km
t
8.0 km/s
_
Step 4: Perform the calculation.
t 5000 s
=
Answer
The time to complete a single orbit (44 000 km) is 5500 s.
This is about 92 minutes (5500 -r 60 9 1 .667). So, the
spacecraft takes 92 minutes to orbit the Earth once.
=
2
i 1 ed Example 2.2 illustrates the importance of
"I ling
at the units. Because speed is in km/s and
•Il । .nice is in km, we do not need to convert to m/s and
mil r We would get the same answer if we did the
i um ersion:
(i
me
_
7
8
40 000 000 m
8000 m/s
= 5000s
An aircraft travels 900 metres in 3.0 seconds.
What is its speed?
A car travels 400 km in 3.5 hours. What is the speed
of the car in km/h and m/s?
The Voyager spacecraft is moving at 17 000 m/s.
I low far will it travel in one year? Give your answer
in km.
h
6
Calculate how many minutes it takes sunlight to reach
us from the Sun. Light travels at 3 x 108m/s and the
Sun is about 144 million km away.
A cheetah can maintain its top speed of 31 m/s
over a distance of 100 metres while some breeds of
gazelle, such as Thomson’s gazelle, have a top speed
of 25 m/s. This question considers how close the
cheetah needs to be to catch the gazelle if they have
both just reached top speed.
a
How long does it take a cheetah to cover 100 m?
b What is the closing speed of the cheetah, that
is, what is the difference in speed between the
cheetah and the gazelle?
c
How far ahead of the cheetah would the gazelle
need to be to escape? (Hint: you need the time
you calculated in a and the closing speed you
calculated in b.)
d How long would it take the cheetah to catch the
gazelle with the closing speed you calculated in
b and the distance apart you calculated in c?
Questions
4
Describing motion
ACTIVITY 2.1
Running with the wind behind you
Plot your time for the 400 m (y-axis) against wind
speed (x-axis). When you are running against the
wind on the straight section opposite the finish
line, subtract the wind speed from your normal
running speed. When you are running with the
wind on the final straight section before the
finish line, add the wind speed to your normal
running speed.
For example, if there is a wind speed of 1 m/s,
your speed along the straight opposite the finish
line will be 9 m/s while it will be 1 1 m/s along the
straight section before the finish line. Then you
need to add the times for each straight section
to the 20 s for the bends. Repeat this, increasing
the wind speed by 1 m/s each time, until you
reach 10 m/s.
In 2011, Justin Gatlin ran 100 metres in 9.45 seconds
(faster than Usain Bolt's world record by 0.13 seconds).
However, he was pushed along by a 20 m/s tailwind
< pmerated by giant fans as part of a Japanese game
how. A 100 m or 200 m sprint record can stand only if
.i tailwind does not exceed 2 m/s. Why does this rule
not apply to longer events?
I irst, think about how you might approach
this problem.
The day Roger Bannister ran a mile in four minutes
(6 May 1 954) he almost decided not to race because
it was too windy. Imagine there is a tailwind along
the final straight section of a 400 m track which
•ipeeds you up, and a headwind on the opposite
section which slows you down. Why do the
effects of the tailwind and headwind not cancel out?
(Hint: you need to think about the time it would take
you to run the straight sections.)
1
Imagine that you are a 400 m runner who can run
the distance in 40 s (a new world record) at the
same average speed of 1 0 m/s. Assume that the
400 m track is equally divided so that the straight
sections and bends are each 100 m long.
2
Could you have reached the answer without
plotting a graph?
3
Discuss whether it is realistic to add or subtract
the wind speed to your normal running speed.
4
Design an experiment to test how wind speed
affects running speed. You might need to
include equipment that you do not have access
to (such as the giant fans used on the Japanese
game show).
23
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
REFLECTION
Discuss your answers to the activity with the person
sitting next to you. Have they thought of anything
you haven't included in your answer? Would you
add anything to your answers after your discussion?
2.2 Distance-time graphs
You can describe how something moves in words,
‘The coach drove away from the bus stop. It travelled at
a steady speed along the main road, leaving town. After
five minutes, it reached the highway, where it was able to
speed up. After ten minutes, it was forced to stop because
of traffic.’
We can show the same information in the form of a
distance-time graph, as shown in Figure 2.6a. This graph
is in three sections, corresponding to the three sections of
the coach’s journey.
In section C, the graph is flat (horizontal). The distance
of the coach from its starting point is not changing. It is
stationary.
The slope of the distance- time graph tells us how fast the
coach is moving. The steeper the graph, the faster it is
moving (the greater its speed). When the graph becomes
horizontal, its slope is zero. This tells us that the coach’s
speed is zero in section C. It is not moving.
Figure 2.6a shows abrupt (instant) changes in speed
between A, B and C. It would not be a very comfortable
ride for the passengers! Instead of abrupt changes in
speed, the speed would change more slowly in the real
world and there would be smooth curves joining the
sections (Figure 2.6b). The increasing gradient of the
upward-sloping curve between A and B would show
that the coach was speeding up (accelerating) and the
decreasing gradient of the curve between B and C would
show that the coach was slowing down (decelerating).
However, we will only look at graphs with angled edges
as in Figure 2.6a.
Questions
A car pulled away from the lights and travelled at a
steady speed along an empty road. After 8 minutes
it joined a main road, where it travelled at about
twice the original speed for 12 minutes. The car then
met a traffic jam and had to quickly slow down and
stop. The traffic cleared after 5 minutes but then the
car travelled slowly, at about half the original speed.
Sketch a distance-time graph to show the car’s
journey.
1 0 Figure 2.7 shows the distance-time graph for a
woman running a mountain marathon.
9
Figure 2.6 a and b: A graph to represent the motion of a
coach, as described in the text. The slope of the graph tells
us about the coach's speed.
In section A, the graph slopes up gently, showing that the
coach was travelling at a slow speed.
In section B, the graph becomes steeper. The distance
of the coach from its starting point is increasing more
rapidly. It is moving faster.
24
>
Time of day
Figure 2.7: Distance-time graph
2
a
b
c
d
e
f
g
How far did she travel?
What was her average speed in km/h?
How many stops did she make?
The rules said she had to stop for half an hour
for food. When did she take her break?
Later she stopped to help an injured runner.
When did this happen?
What would her average speed have been if she
had not stopped at all?
What was her highest speed and over what
section did this happen?
Express trains, slow buses
Describing motion
Figure 2.9: It can be uncomfortable on a packed bus as it
accelerates and decelerates along its journey.
2.3 Understanding
An express train is capable of reaching high speeds,
acceleration
perhaps more than 300 km/h. However, when it sets off
on its journey, it may take several minutes to reach this
top speed. Then it takes a long time to slow down when
it approaches its destination. The French TGV trains
( Figure 2.8) run on lines that are reserved solely for their
operation, so that their high-speed journeys are not
disrupted by slower, local trains.
Some cars, particularly high-performance ones, are
advertised according to how rapidly they can accelerate.
An advert may claim that a car goes ‘from 0 to 100 km/h in
5 s’. This means that, if the car accelerates at a steady rate,
it reaches 20 km/h after 1 s, 40 km/h after 2 s, and so on.
We could say that it speeds up by 20 km/h every second.
In other words, its acceleration is 20 km/h per second.
A bus journey is full of accelerations and decelerations.
I ‘he bus accelerates away from the stop. Ideally, the driver
So, we say that an object accelerates if its speed increases.
Its acceleration tells us the rate at which its speed is
changing, that is, the change in speed per unit time.
hopes to travel at a steady speed until the next stop. A
speed means that you can sit comfortably in your
Then there is a rapid deceleration as the bus slows to
halt. A lot of accelerating and decelerating means that
you are likely to be thrown about as the bus changes speed.
1'he gentle acceleration of an express train will barely
disturb the drink in your cup. The bus’s rapid accelerations
and decelerations would make it impossible to avoid
tpilling the drink (Figure 2.9).
When an object slows down, its speed is also changing.
We say that it is decelerating. Instead of an acceleration,
it has a deceleration.
Speed and velocity, vectors
and scalars
In physics, the words ‘speed’ and ‘velocity’ have different
meanings, although they are closely related: velocity is
an object’s speed in a particular stated direction. So, we
could say that an aircraft has a speed of 200 m/s but a
velocity of 200 m/s due north. We must give the direction
of the velocity or the information is incomplete.
Velocity is an example of a vector quantity. Vectors have
both magnitude (size) and direction. Another example
of a vector is weight - your weight is a force that acts
downwards, towards the centre of the Earth.
Figure 2.8: France's high-speed trains, the TGVs (Trains a
C <rande Vitesse), run on dedicated tracks. Their speed has
made it possible to travel 600 km from Marseille in the south
l<> Paris in the north, attend a meeting, and return home
again within a single day.
Speed is an example of a scalar quantity. Scalars only
have magnitude. Temperature is an example of another
scalar quantity.
You will learn more about vectors and scalars in Chapter 3.
25
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
KEY WORDS
acceleration: the rate of change of an object's
velocity
velocity: the speed of an object in a stated direction
vector quantity: has both magnitude (size) and
direction
scalar quantity: is something that has magnitude
but no direction
Speed-time graphs
Just as we can represent the motion of a moving object
by a distance-time graph, we can also represent it by a
speed-time graph. A speed-time graph shows how the
object’s speed changes as it moves. Always check any
graph by looking at the axes to see the labels.
A speed-time graph has speed on the vertical axis and
time on the horizontal axis.
Figure 2.10 shows a speed-time graph for a bus. The
graph frequently drops to zero because the bus stops to
let people on and off. Then the line slopes up, as the bus
accelerates away from the stop. Towards the end of its
journey, the bus is moving at a steady speed (horizontal
graph), as it does not have to stop. Finally, the graph
slopes downwards to zero again as the bus pulls into the
terminus and stops.
The slope of the speed-time graph tells us about the
bus’s acceleration:
• the steeper the slope, the greater the acceleration
• a negative slope means a deceleration (slowing
down)
• a horizontal graph (slope = 0) means a constant
speed.
Graphs of different shapes
Speed-time graphs can show us a lot about an object’s
movement. Was it moving at a steady speed, or speeding
up, or slowing down? Was it moving at all?
Figure 2.11 represents a train journey. The graph is in
four sections. Each section illustrates a different point:
• A: sloping upwards, so the speed increases and the
train is accelerating
• B: horizontal, so the speed is constant and the train
is travelling at a steady speed
• C: sloping downwards, so the speed decreases and
the train is decelerating
• D: horizontal, so the speed has decreased to zero
and the train is stationary.
Figure 2.11: An example of a speed-time graph for a train
during part of its journey.
The fact that the graph lines are curved in sections A
and C tells us that the train’s acceleratioh was changing.
If its speed had changed at a steady rate, these lines
would have been straight.
Questions
11 Two students live in the same apartment block
in Hometown and attend the same school in
Schooltown, as shown in Figure 2.12. For this
question, work in km and hours.
Figure 2.10: A speed-time graph for a bus on a busy route.
At first, it has to halt frequently at bus stops. Towards the
end of its journey, it maintains a steady speed.
Figure 2.12
26
2 Describing motion
Arun gets a lift to school in his mother’s car.
The traffic is heavy so the average speed for the
journey is 40 km/h. How many minutes does it
take Arun to get to school?
Sofia leaves home at the same time as Arun
but she walks the 0.3 km to Hometown station,
waits 3 minutes (0.05 hour) for the train, travels
on the train to Schooltown station (journey
distance 22 km) and walks the 0.7 km from
Schooltown station to the school. The train
averages 88 km/h and Sofia walks at 5 km/h.
How many minutes does it take Sofia to get to
school?
How many minutes shorter is Sofia’s journey
time than Arun’s?
Draw a speed-time graph for their journeys
on the same axes but assume that any
change in speed is instant (do not show the
acceleration).
i
b
c
d
1 ' Look at the speed-time graph in Figure 2.13.
14 a
Copy Table 2.3 and sketch the motion graphs
for each motion described.
Motion of
Distance-time Speed-time
body
graph
graph
at rest
moving at
constant speed
constant
acceleration
(speeding up)
constant
deceleration
(slowing down)
Table 2.3
b
Copy Table 2.4 and sketch the speed-time
graphs for each acceleration described.
60
50
|40
'
Motion of
constant
body
acceleration
®
<D
30
accelerating
on
20
decelerating
10
Table 2.4
CL
decreasing
increasing
acceleration acderation
0
Figure 2.13
Name the sections that represent:
a steady speed
b speeding up (accelerating)
c being stationary
d slowing down (decelerating).
13 A car is travelling at 20 m/s. The driver sees a
hazard. After a reaction time of 0.7 s, she performs
an emergency stop by applying the brakes. The car
takes a further 3.3 s to come to a stop. Sketch a
speed-time graph for her journey from the moment
she sees the hazard to the moment she brings her car
to a stop. Label the graph with as many details as
you can.
Finding distance travelled
A speed-time graph represents an object’s movement.
It tells us about how its speed changes. We can also use
the graph to deduce (work out) how far the object travels.
To do this, we have to make use of the equation:
distance = area under speed-time graph
The area under any straight-line graph can be broken
down into rectangles and triangles. Then you can
calculate the area using:
area of rectangle = width x height
area of a triangle =
x base x height
To understand this equation, consider Worked Examples
2.3, 2.4 and 2.5.
27
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
*
WORKED EXAMPLE 2.3
Calculate the distance you travel when you cycle for
20 s at a constant speed of lOm/s (see Figure 2.14).
Step 1: Distance travelled is the same as the shaded
area under the graph. This rectangle is 20 s
wide and lOm/s high, so its area is lOm/s x
20 s = 200 m.
Step 2: Check using the equation:
distance travelled = speed x time
= lOm/s x 20s - 200m
Answer
You would travel 200 metres.
Figure 2.1 4: Speed-time graph for Worked Example 2.3.
WORKED EXAMPLE 2.4
area of a triangle =1x base x height
You set off down a steep ski slope. Your initial speed is
Om/s. After 10 s you are travelling at 30m/s (see Figure
2.15). Calculate the distance you travel in this time.
—2 x 10 s x 30m/s
= 150m
Step 2: Check using the equation:
,
average speed
=
initial velocity + final velocity
_ 0 m/s + 30 m/s 2
= 15 m/s
Figure 2.15: Speed-time graph for Worked Example 2.4.
Step 1:
28
>
Distance travelled is the same as the shaded
area under the graph. The shape is a triangle
with a height of 30 m/s and base of 10 s.
.
distance travelled = average speed x time
= 15m/s x 10s
= 150 m
Answer
You travel 150 metres.
—
2
Describing motion
>RKED EXAMPLE 2.5
X 1 1 .mi’s motion is represented by the graph in Figure
I (> ( 'alculate the distance the train travels in 60 s.
Step 3: Find the area of the orange triangle. It has a
base of 40 s and height of 14.0 m/s - 6.0 m/s
8.0 m/s
=
area of a triangle =
± x base x height
m/s
= 4x40sx8.0
2
= 160 m
(Note: this tells us the extra distance travelled
by the train because it was accelerating.)
Add these two areas to find the total area
and, therefore, the total distance travelled:
•
total distance travelled
i<iur« 2.16: Speed-time graph for Worked Example 2.5.
।
p I: Distance travelled is the same as the shaded
areas under the graph. This graph has two
shaded areas: the pink rectangle and the
orange triangle.
>•
p 2:
Find the area of the pink rectangle.
It is 60 s wide and 6.0 m/s high, so its area =
60s x 6.0 m/s 360m
(Note: this tells us how far the train would
have travelled if it had maintained a constant
speed of 6.0 m/s.)
=
= 360 m + 160 m
= 520m
Step 5:
Check using the equation
distance travelled average speed x time
The train travelled for 20 s at a steady speed
of 6.0 m/s, and then for 40 s at an average
speed of 10.0 m/s. So:
distance travelled (6.0 m/s x 20 s ) +
(10.0m/s x 40s)
= 120m x 400m
=
=
= 520m
Answer
In 60 s, the train travelled 520 metres.
Question
1
i
I>
i
Draw a speed-time graph to show a car that accelerates uniformly from 6 m/s for 5 s then travels at a steady
speed of 12 m/s for 5 s.
On your graph, shade the area that shows the distance travelled by the car in 10 s.
Calculate the distance travelled in this time.
ACTIVITY 2.2
I he 4 x 1 00 metre relay
II" purpose of this activity is to apply what you have learned about motion (and particularly sketching
।hh id-time graphs) to a real problem. If you get the chance to take this activity out onto a running track, you
ill need to take time and distance measurements (something you learned about in Chapter 1).
ir
ess in a 4 x 100m relay race depends both on the speed of the runners and effective baton exchange
I " tween the runners. The baton must pass between runners within a 30 m changeover (or passing) zone,
v /hich includes a 10 m acceleration (or fly) zone. Figure 2.17 shows the first of these three passing zones.
29
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
ideal exchange
point for baton
1
In what hand will runners receive and carry the
baton on subsequent legs?
2
What are the advantages of passing the baton
to the opposite hand?
Ideally, during the baton exchange the speeds
of the runners should be the same. To achieve
this the outgoing runner starts his run when the
incoming runner reaches a check mark.
3
4
Figure 2.17: The first bend of a 400m athletics track.
5
Each athlete actually sprints for more than 100 m,
as shown in Table 2.5. By planning for the baton to
exchange between runners at the beginning or end
of the changeover box, you can adjust the distance
each runner runs. You might have a slightly shorter
distance for a 60 m sprinter and a lengthened
distance for a 100 m runner who also runs 200 m,
which also makes them used to running bends.
Usually, each runner keeps the baton in the same
hand and passes it to the opposite hand of the
next runner to exchange the baton. Usually, the first
runner carries the baton in their right hand.
100 m
200 m
Right-handed, left-handed,
personal
best / s
personal
best / s
or ambidextrous (happy
Sajjan Sidhu
12.1
25.8
right
prefers bends
Gar Psi Ho
11.8
24.3
right, ambidextrous
Andrew Kerr-Chin
11.1
24.4
ambidextrous
prefers bends
prefers straights but
Tom Schofield
11.7
25.1
right, ambidextrous
better at straights
Oliver Hudson
12.6
26.3
ambidextrous
happy to run bends
Athlete name
Table 2.5
30
How would you work out where to place the
check mark? (Hint: it might help if you sketch
speed-time graphs on the same axes for both
runners, starting when the runner receiving the
baton starts running.) What other information
would you need to make this accurate?
Even at Olympic finals teams can be disqualified
(stopped from taking part) if they drop the baton
or pass it outside of the changeover zone. Why
does this happen so often?
Imagine you are the school's athletics coach.
Table 2.5 lists the times for runners who often
compete in the senior 4 * 100 m relay.
Use this information to select your team and
decide which leg each runner should run and
enter their names on the team sheet. Do you
have a strategy for deciding which athlete
runs which leg? What other information might
you want to gather before making a decision?
For example, Sajjan suggests that he is the best
starter. Some athletes are better at running
bends. Some are better at passing or receiving
the baton.
)
Good bend runner
using either hand)
good at both
2 Describing motion
CONTINUED
Collect data from your own group. Use this to select a 4 x 100 m team and decide who should run each leg.
Copy and complete this team sheet.
6
Team sheet
Leg
Typical distance actually run / m
1
105
2
125
3
125
4
120
100 m personal best
Athlete name
Table 2.6
SELF-ASSESSMENT
WORKED EXAMPLE 2.6
In icience it is often helpful to visualise tasks.
I or question 3, did you have a clear idea of how to
Use the gradient of the graph in Figure 2.18 to
calculate the car’s speed on the open road. '
work out where to place the check marks? Did the
ide.i of sketching the speed-time graphs for the
runners help? (The difference in the area under the
Iwo graphs up to the moment of baton exchange
should tell you how far in front of the acceleration
ne to place the check mark).
Wh.it other information did you need before
I, iding which runner should run each leg?
Distance travelled / km
Time taken / h
0
0.0
10
0.4
20
0.8
100
1.8
110
2.3
Table 2.7: Data for a car journey.
2.4 Calculating speed
and acceleration
I i • mi a distance-time graph, we can find how fast
micihing is moving. Figure 2.18 shows information
al 'lit a car journey between two cities. The car travelled
1 1 1< ii i slowly at some times than at others. It is easier to
this if we present the information as a graph.
I i mi the graph, you can see that the car travelled slowly
I the start of its journey, and also at the end, when it
Will ravelling through the city. The graph is steeper in
il middle section, when it was travelling on the open
ii I between the cities.
Figure 2.1 8: Distance-time graph for a car journey.
1 1'
;i iph also shows how to use the gradient to
ih ulute the car’s speed on the open road:
= gradient of distance-time graph
*
l
i '
detail is given in Worked Example 2.6.
31
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Calculating acceleration
CONTINUED
speed = gradient of distance-time graph
Step 1: Identify the relevant straight section of the
graph. Here, we are looking at the straight
section in the middle of the graph, where the
car’s speed was constant.
Step 2: Draw horizontal and vertical lines to
complete a right-angled triangle.
Step 3:
Step 4:
Calculate the lengths of the sides of the
triangle.
Divide the vertical height by the horizontal
width of the triangle (‘up divided by along’).
vertical height = 80 km
horizontal width = 1.0 h
. 80km
srad,mt
= Toit
= 80 km/h
Answer
The car’s speed was 80 km/h for this section of its
journey.
Note: It helps to include units in the calculation
because then the answer will automatically have the
correct units, in this case, km/h.
Picture an express train setting off from a station on a
long, straight track. It may take 300 s to reach a velocity
of 300 km/h along the track. Its velocity has increased by
1 km/h each second, and so we say that its acceleration is
1 km/h per second.
These are not very convenient units, although they may
help to make it clear what is happening when we talk
about acceleration. To calculate an object’s acceleration,
we need to know two things:
•
•
its change in velocity (how much it speeds up)
the time taken (how long it takes to speed up).
The acceleration of the object is defined as the change of
an object’s velocity per unit time.
,
acceleration
=
change in velocity
time taken
We can write the equation for acceleration in symbols
with Av for change in velocity and At for time taken.
So we can write the equation for acceleration like this:
Question
1 6 Table 2.8 shows information about a train journey.
Station
Distance
travelled/ km
Time taken /
minutes
Hornby
0
0
Kirby Lonsdale
10
30
Ingleton
20
45
Dolphinholme
46
60
Galgate
56
80
Table 2.8
Use the data in Table 2.8 to plot a distance-time
graph for the train. Find the train’s average speed
between Kirby Lonsdale and Dolphinholme. Give
your answer in km/h.
32
Alternatively, because there are two velocities, we
could use two symbols: u initial velocity and v = final
velocity. Now we can write the equation for acceleration
like this:
=
The advantage of this equation is that if the final velocity
is less than the initial velocity, the answer is negative.
This tells you that the acceleration is negative (i.e. that
the object is decelerating).
In the example of the express train, we have initial
velocity u = 0 km/h, final velocity v = 300 km/h and time
taken t = 300 s.
.
..
c
So,
acceleration a
-
= 300 km/h3000s km/h = 1, .km/h„ Fper
second. Worked Example 2.7 uses the more standard
velocity units of m/s.
2
Units of acceleration
bi
>rked Example 2.7, the units of acceleration are
i'i> cn as m/s2 (metres per second squared). These are
llu il.mdard units of acceleration. The calculation
du / . that the aircraft’s velocity increased by 2 m/s
• " i v second, or by 2 metres per second per second. It
i • implest to write this as 2 m/s2, but you may prefer to
dunk of it as 2m/s per second, as this emphasises the
uh tiling of acceleration.
\n aircraft accelerates from 100 m/s to 300 m/s in
I < H ) What is its acceleration?
’•lep 2:
_ v - m _ lOOm/s - 300m/s _ ~2- m/s2
:/— =
—s = ,,
100
This is because acceleration is a vector quantity:
it has a direction. It can be forwards (positive) or
backwards (negative). So it is important always to think
about velocity rather than speed when working out
accelerations, because velocity is also a vector quantity.
Questions
>RKED EXAMPLE 2.7
Su p I :
a
Describing motion
Start by writing down what you know, and
what you want to know.
initial velocity u = 100 m/s
final velocity v = 300 m/s
time t = 100 s
acceleration a = ?
1 7 Which of the following could not be a unit of
acceleration?
mph/s
km/s2
m/s2
km/s
18 A car sets off from traffic lights. It reaches a speed
of 21 m/s in 10 s. What is its acceleration?
19 A train, initially moving at 1 5 m/s, speeds up to
39 m/s in 120 s. What is its acceleration?
20 The speed of a car increases from 12 m/s to 20 m/s in
4 seconds.
a Sketch the speed-time graph.
b Calculate the acceleration.
c
Use the graph to work out the distance covered
in those 4 seconds.
d Calculate the distance travelled.
e If your answers to parts c and d are not the
same, then work out where you have made a
mistake.
Now calculate the change in velocity.
change in velocity = 300 m/s - 100 m/s
200 m/s
=
su p 3: Substitute into the equation.
change in velocity
,
acceleration =
time taken
_ 200 m/s
100 s
2.0
= m/s2
Alternatively, you could substitute the values
of u, v and t directly into the equation.
_ 300 - 100
100
Acceleration from
speed-time graphs
A speed-time graph with a steep slope shows that the
speed is changing rapidly - the acceleration is greater.
It follows that we can find the acceleration of an object
by calculating the gradient of its speed-time graph:
= 2 m/s2
acceleration
= gradient of speed-time graph
\nswer
Three points should be noted:
I In aircraft’s acceleration is 2.0 m/s2
•
The object must be travelling in a straight line; its
velocity is changing but its direction is not.
•
If the speed-time graph is curved (rather than a
straight line), the acceleration is changing.
•
If the graph is sloping downwards, the object is
decelerating. The gradient of the graph is negative.
So a deceleration is a negative acceleration.
II on are working out the acceleration of an object that
। "lowing down, then this alternative method shown in
w ' h ked Example 2.7 will give a negative answer. If the
Hi' i aft was slowing down from 300 m/s to 100 m/s then
ii .i< celeration would be:
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
*
WORKED EXAMPLE 2.8
The sloping section shows that the train was
then accelerating.
A train travels slowly as it climbs up a long hill. Then
it speeds up as it travels down the other side. Table 2.9
shows how its speed changes. Draw a speed-time graph
to show this data. Use the graph to calculate the train’s
acceleration during the second half of its journey.
Time / s
Speed / m/s
0
6.0
10
6.0
20
6.0
30
8.0
40
10.0
50
12.0
60
14.0
Table 2.9: Speed of a train.
Before starting to draw the graph, it is worth looking
at the data in the table. The values of speed are given
at equal intervals of time (every 10 s). The speed is
constant at first (6.0 m/s). Then it increases in equal
steps (8.0, 10.0, and so on). In fact, we can see that the
speed increases by 2.0 m/s every 10 s. This is enough to
tell us that the train’s acceleration is 0.2 m/s2. However,
we will follow through the detailed calculation to
illustrate how to work out acceleration from a graph.
Step 1:
Draw the speed-time graph using the data in
Table 2.9; this is shown in Figure 2.19.
The initial horizontal section shows that the
train’s speed was constant (zero acceleration).
Figure 2.19: Speed-time graph for Worked Example 2.8.
Step 2: Draw in a triangle to calculate the slope of
the graph, as shown on Figure 2.19. This
gives us the acceleration.
_ 14.0 m/s - 6.0m/s
_
60 s
- 20 s
8.0m/s
40 s
= 0.20 m/s2
Answer
The train’s acceleration down the hill is 0.20 m/s2.
Although Worked Example 2.8 uses the equation for
acceleration, you are finding the gradient of the slope in
Figure 2.19.
Figure 2.20 shows the speed-time graph for a skydiver
from the moment she leaves an aircraft. She jumps
from 5000 m and opens her parachute when she reaches
1500 m, 60 s after she jumps. You have already learned
that you can find the acceleration from the gradient of a
speed-time graph. However, there are places where the
gradient of the graph is changing (when the graph is not
a straight line). To find the acceleration at any moment in
time, a tangent to the graph is drawn. This works for any
graph: straight or curved.
34
Time / s
Figure 2.20: The speed-time graph for a skydiver, showing
the first 105 s of the jump.
2 Describing motion
WORKED EXAMPLE 2.9
I ook at Figure 2.20. What is the skydiver’s
.icceleration at:
Part b
Step 1: Draw a tangent to the graph at t = 5.5 s
(shown below by the blue line).
m 0s
b 5.5 s?
Step 2: Draw in a triangle to calculate the slope of
the graph (shown below by the dashed lines).
I'Hrt a
Step 1:
Draw a tangent to the graph at t = 0 s (shown
below by the blue line).
Step 2:
Draw in a triangle (shown below by the
dashed lines).
70
60
50
40
“O
o
o
30
LO
20
CL
10
0
10
me / s
0
Step 3:
5
10
Time / s
15
20
Calculate the slope of the graph. This gives
us the acceleration.
I'ri haps you can already explain why her acceleration
h. mges as she falls but it will be explained in
• i ipter 3. Can you see when she opens her parachute
i l igure 2.20? Recalling how to work out distance on
peed time graph, can you work out how far she has
I. illen when she opens her parachute? Can you work out
ih.it she lands 160 s after she starts her jump?
i
Question
JI A car driver has to do an emergency stop. This is
when the driver needs to stop the car in the shortest
possible stopping distance. There is a delay between
•teeing a hazard and applying the brakes. This is due
to the reaction time of the driver, sometimes called
the thinking time. The distance the car moves in this
time (when the car has not changed speed) is the
thinking distance. The distance the car moves once
Step 3: Calculate the slope of the graph. This gives us
the acceleration.
Answer
The parachutist has the acceleration of free-fall
(9.8 m/s2) the moment she jumps out of the aircraft
(at t 0 s) and her acceleration decreases with time
until she reaches a constant speed. After 5.5 s her
acceleration is 3.8 m/s2.
=
the brakes are applied and until the car comes to a
stop is the braking distance. The stopping distance
thinking distance + braking distance.
A car is travelling at 20 m/s when the driver sees a
hazard. She has a reaction time of 0.7 s and brings
her car to a stop 4.0 s after seeing the danger.
a Draw a speed-time graph to represent the car’s
motion during the 4.0 s described. Assume
that the deceleration (negative acceleration) is
constant.
b Use the graph to deduce (work out) the car’s
deceleration as it slows down.
c Use the graph to deduce how far the car travels
during the 4.0 s described.
=
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 2.3
Using ticker tape to find the acceleration of a
trolley down a ramp
You are going to investigate the motion of a trolley
down a ramp. Some ticker tape is attached to the
trolley - and a ticker timer marks the paper 50 times
a second (Figure 2.21). As the trolley accelerates, the
distance between the dots increases.
1
The ticker timer marks the paper 50 times a
second. What interval of time does each gap
represent?
To find the speed at a particular dot, you need
to measure the distance covered over a short
interval of time centred on the dot. Measure the
distance between the preceding (previous) dot
and succeeding dot (the one that follows). For
example, to find the speed at dot 1 5, we need
to find the distance covered between dot 14
and dot 1 6 (1 3 mm) and then divide by the time
taken to cover this distance (2 x 0.02 s = 0.04 s),
using the equation:
speed =
2
= 13mm
0 325 m/s
^ce
time
0.04 s
=
3
Plot a speed-time graph.
4
Use the gradient from the graph to calculate the
acceleration.
Alternative approach
Every fifth dot has been numbered. This corresponds
to the distance travelled every 0.1 s.
1
Cut a copy of the the ticker tape into lengths
corresponding to every fifth dot (0.1 s time
interval).
2
Stick the lengths side by side (like a histogram)
onto graph paper, with the bottom of each strip
on the horizontal axis.
3
Draw a line through the dot at the top of each
strip (or the middle of the top of each strip, if the
dot is missing).
4
Work out the scale for each axis. The width of
each strip is equal to a time interval of 0.1 s.
5
Work out the gradient of the speed-time graph
you have constructed.
Copy and complete Table 2.10, using the ticker
tape to help you.
Dot number
Time since tape started / s
0
0.0
5
0.1
10
0.2
15
20
25
30
Table 2.10
Figure 2.21: Ticker tape.
Distance covered / mm
Speed / m/s
13
0.325
2
Describing motion
PROJECT
>ur teacher will decide whether you will work on
i
y >ur own, in pairs or as part of a small group. Your
rik is to plan a three-part revision lesson on the
material in this chapter for the rest of your class,
। .it t icularly the link between motion graphs and the
ju.itions of motion. Write down a plan to show
/h it you would do and what resources you would
u
If you have time, you can produce and teach
ilr lesson to small groups of your classmates or the
h He of your class. The following points will help
i as you plan the revision lesson.
।
• You need to be able to answer questions on
motion graphs and equations of motion so that
you can then use them as a basis to write your
own own questions.
•
You need to produce model answers for your
questions or come up with a better way of
getting the ideas across.
•
Insist that your classmates show their working.
•
You need to label what parts of your questions
ire
।
supplementary.
k i are some suggested questions which you can
Uw In your plan for the lesson:
Part 1: Howto interpret motion graphs
u .tion for your classmates to answer: 'Copy and
nplete the table by stating what feature of the
nr lion graph can be used to obtain the variable
I I in the left-hand column. The first cell has
I'
n done for you.'
Distance-time
di.tance
graph
read off the
vertical axis
Speed-time
graph
t»| >ead
deration
might want to suggest that your classmates
I nir code the table in some way.
।
l
think of a better way of getting information
m motion graphs?
i you
Part 2: Linking motion graphs to equations
of motion
Question for your classmates to answer: 'A body
moving at 2 m/s accelerates for 2 seconds until
it reaches a speed of 4 m/s. Show that the body
travels a distance of 6 m and accelerates at 1 m/s2.'
You need your classmates to get the same answer
for the question you produce using two different
methods.
Method 1: Use the relevant equations (for
acceleration and distance)
Some of your classmates will get the distance wrong
because they do not use the average speed in the
equation for distance.
Method 2: Sketch the motion graph
Your classmates should use the gradient of the
graph to find the acceleration and the area under
the curve to find the distance. However, some of
your classmates will sketch the motion from the
origin (instead of from 2 m/s) and will work out
the area of a triangle (instead of a triangle plus a
square) so will get a distance travelled of 2 metres.
Others will measure the horizontal and vertical
distances with a ruler to work out the gradient
instead of using the scale on the axes to work out
the changes in the speed and time to work out
the gradient.
You need to come up with similar questions
(different numbers) and their model answers.
Perhaps try your question on a few of your friends
to check that it is clear and to pick up common
mistakes. You could provide your question and a
wrong solution and ask other members of your class
to spot and correct the mistakes.
Part 3: Putting learning into practice
Questions for your classmates to answer:
Bloodhound LSR is being developed to achieve a
new land speed record of 1000mph. The vehicle
will be timed over a 'measured mile' half-way down
a 12 mile long salt pan in South Africa.
•
If Bloodhound achieves WOOmph, how long
would it take to complete the 'measured mile'?
37
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
•
•
What is the total time for the 12 mile journey?
What is the acceleration or deceleration of
the vehicle and how does this compare to the
acceleration of freefall (9.81 m/s2)?'
First, you need to answer the question yourself.
When you set your question, decide whether
to convert the data in the question to SI units
or get your classmates to do it themselves
(1 mph = 0.447 m/s; 1 mile = 1610 m).
Figure 2.22: Bloodhound LSR during a practice run on
the Hekskeenpan in South Africa.
Sketch a speed-time graph for its journey.
Label it with significant speeds and times.
Assume that Bloodhound accelerates uniformly
until it reaches the 'measured mile' and then
decelerates uniformly so that it comes to rest
12 miles from the start (and before the end of
the salt pan).
You could introduce the question with a short video
clip about the vehicle. Adapt the questions above
and produce a model answer so that your peers
can check and correct their solutions. For example,
you could flip the question by telling your peers
the maximum acceleration and deceleration of the
vehicle and get them to work out the minimum
distance the 'track' needs to be, or you could
change the data while keeping it realistic^
SUMMARY
Speed is distance divided by time.
Average speed is total distance divided by total time.
Light gates and interrupt cards can be used to measure speed in the laboratory.
The equation that relates speed, distance and time can be re-arranged to find any one of the variables, given the
values of the other two.
The gradient (slope) of a distance-time graph represents speed.
Acceleration is a change in speed.
The greater the gradient (slope) of a speed-time graph, the bigger the acceleration.
Distance travelled can be calculated (worked out) from the area under a speed-time graph.
Speed can be calculated from the gradient of a distance-time graph and acceleration can be calculated from the
gradient of a speed-time graph.
Speed is a scalar and velocity is a vector.
Acceleration can be calculated from the change of speed divided by time and a negative acceleration is the same
as a deceleration.
38
>
2
Describing motion
AM-STYLE QUESTIONS
this graph for questions 1 and 2.
1
।
I low is a constant velocity shown on the graph?
A the sloping line at the start
I
[1 ]
the horizontal part of the line
C the area under the line
( ) the sloping line at the end
I low is the distance travelled shown on the graph?
the sloping line at the start
I ’• the horizontal part of the line
C the area under the line
D the sloping line at the end
[1 ]
A
<
\ snail takes part in a snail race. The snail completes the 180 cm course in
0 minutes. What is the approximate average speed of the snail?
A 0.43 m/s
1
B 26m/s
C 0.26 m/s
[1]
D 0.0043 m/s
I he velocity-time graph shows the performance of a Formula 1® racing car as
it accelerates from rest for 7.33 seconds and then brakes, coming to a stop in
.69 seconds. It covers a distance of 520 metres.
[1 ]
What is the approximate maximum velocity of the car?
A 50 m/s
B 75 m/s
C 105 m/s
D 175 m/s
39
>
>
CAMBRIDGE 1GCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
5 The table shows Usain Bolt’s split times from his world record 100 m run in
Berlin in 2009. Each split time is for a 10 m section of the 100 m distance.
The time for the first 10 m includes his reaction time of 0.146 s before he left
his blocks.
Section / m
Time / s
0-10 10-20 20-30 30-40 40-50
50-60 60-70 70-80
£
o
co
90-1 0
1.89 0.99 0.90 0.86 0.83 0.82 0.81 0.82 0.83 0.83
a Calculate the time that Usain Bolt takes to run the first 10 metres from
the moment he starts moving.
[1 ]
b Calculate Usain Bolt’s average speed over the first 10 metres from the
moment he starts moving.
[2]
c Calculate Usain Bolt’s maximum speed over the first 10 metres.
Ignore his reaction time and assume his acceleration is constant.
[2]
d Calculate Usain Bolt’s acceleration over the first 10 metres.
Ignore his reaction time and assume his acceleration is constant.
[2]
e Calculate Usain Bolt’s top speed in the race. Show your working.
[2]
[Total: 8]
6 An aircraft happened to be flying near a volcano when it erupted. The co-pilot
took some video footage. He handed the footage over to scientists for analysis.
The scientists spotted a huge boulder that was moving at a constant speed
horizontally (sideways) in the first frame and falling in subsequent frames of the
video. They wanted to work out how far the ash and rock would spread.
a Plot a graph of the position of the boulder at intervals of 5 seconds.
Plot the vertical height of the boulder (vertical axis) against the
horizontal distance travelled (horizontal axis).
[3]
Time / s
Horizontal distance
travelled / m
0
0
4420
5
525
4292
10
1050
3924
15
1580
3311
20
2100
2453
25
2630
1349
30
3150
0
b Explain the shape of the graph.
40
Vertical height / m
[11
COMMAND WORDS
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
2
CONTINUED
Describing motion
COMMAND WORD
c The scientists thought the aircraft had been at an altitude (height) of
4420 metres when the video was taken but it was at 3600 metres. Use your
graph to estimate the (horizontal) distance the boulder will have travelled
from the point that it was recorded on video to where it hit the ground. [2]
d Use your graph to estimate how long it took the boulder to hit the
ground from where it was filmed.
[1 ]
e Calculate the horizontal speed of the boulder.
[2]
f Suggest why there is ash and rocks over a wide area and not just a circle
of debris that your answer to c might suggest.
[1 ]
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations
where there are
a range of valid
responses in order
to make proposals/
put forward
considerations
[Total: 10]
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
fter studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
>y gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
Work out speed from distance travelled and time taken.
See
Topic...
2.1
Work out average speed from total distance travelled
and total time taken.
2.1
Describe experiments to measure speed in the
laboratory.
2.1
Work out distance travelled from a speed-time graph.
2.3
Find speed on a speed-time graph.
2.3
Calculate acceleration from the change in velocity and
lime taken.
2.4
Work out acceleration from a speed-time graph.
2.4
Explain the difference between speed and velocity.
2.4
Needs
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
*
> Chapter 3
Forces
and motion
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
discover the differences between mass and weight
describe the ways in which a resultant force may change the motion of a body
find the resultant of two or more forces acting along the same line
find out about the effect of friction (or air resistance or drag) on a moving object
learn about circular motion
learn how force, mass and acceleration are related
define what a force is, understand the concepts of momentum and impulse and apply the principle of
the conservation of momentum
understand the difference between scalars and vectors and learn how to determine the resultant of two
vectors acting at right angles to each other.
3
Forces and motion
.1 ITING STARTED
I "ok at the following questions. Your teacher will give
you some time to think about them on your own. You
m.jy also take some time to discuss them with the
।'>irson sitting next to you. Be prepared to share your
irriwers with the class.
While sitting on your seat, describe any forces
acting on you.
2
Imagine a ball thrown in the air. Sketch the ball.
Draw an arrow or arrows to show any forces acting
on the ball and, if possible, label the arrows.
3
Describe daily life without friction. What do you
think would change the most?
4
Look at Figure 3.1 and decide which path the Earth
would follow if gravity stopped acting.
Figure 3.1: The Earth orbiting the Sun. Which of the paths
would Earth follow if the Sun suddenly stopped'existing?
HYPERLOOP ONE: SUPERSONIC TRAVEL INSIDE VACUUM TUBES
Ir.insport systems would be much more efficient if
energy was wasted working against friction or
.»ir resistance. Hyperloop One promises to get rid
• I both. Elon Musk proposed it on 12 August 2013
i । faster alternative to air travel. It combines two
• -isting technologies - maglev (magnetic levitation)
»nd vactrain (vacuum tube train). Maglev trains use
magnetic repulsion (like poles repel) to make the train
ll< ».it, which eliminates friction. A linear motor then
.!■ < elerates the train: magnetic attraction (unlike poles
h
1
.f
attract) pulls the train from the front while magnetic
repulsion pushes it from behind. The trains will travel
through tubes with most of the air removed using
pumps. This will allow them to travel at Mach 7 (that
is, seven times the speed of sound at sea level). This is
about 2000m/s, much faster than supersonic aircraft.
In 2016, Hyperloop One launched its Hyperloop One
Global Challenge and selected five countries for the
development of the hyperloop networks: US, UK,
Canada, Mexico, and India.
r
I Iflure 3.2a: The idea of passengers travelling through a tube is not new. Passengers taking a ride in the first pneumatic
I ।isenger railway in the US, erected at the Exhibition of the American Institute at the Amory, New York City, in 1867.
bl A Hyperloop tube on display during the first test of the propulsion system at the Hyperloop One Test and Safety site
nil May 2016 in Las Vegas, Nevada.
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Discussion questions
1
Describe the ways in which friction will be reduced in Hyperloop One.
2
Describe any potential dangers of travelling in Hyperloop One.
3.1 We have lift-off
It takes an enormous force to lift a giant space shuttle off
its launch pad, and to propel it into space (Figure 3.3).
The booster rockets that supply the initial thrust provide
a force of several million newtons. As the spacecraft
accelerates upwards, the crew experience the sensation
of being pressed firmly back into their seats. That is how
they know that their craft is accelerating.
Unbalanced forces
change motion
One moment, the shuttle is sitting on the ground,
stationary. The next moment, it is accelerating upwards,
pushed by the force provided by the rockets.
In this chapter, we will look at how forces - pushes and
pulls - affect objects as they move. You will be familiar
with the idea that the unit used for measuring forces is the
newton (N). To give an idea of the sizes of various forces,
here are some examples:
•
•
•
•
You lift an apple. The force needed to lift an apple is
roughly one newton (1 N).
You jump up in the air. Your leg muscles provide the
force needed to do this, about 1000N.
You reach the motorway in your high-performance
car, and press the accelerator pedal. The car
accelerates forwards. The engine provides a force of
about 5000 N.
You are crossing the Atlantic in a Boeing 747 jumbo
jet. The four engines together provide a thrust
of about 500 000 N. In total, that is about half
the thrust provided by each of the space shuttle’s
booster rockets.
Some important forces
Forces appear when two objects interact with each other.
Figure 3.4 shows some important forces. Each force is
represented by an arrow to show its direction. Usually,
the longer the arrow, the bigger the force is. Notice the
convention that the arrow usually points away from the
object of interest.
Figure 3.3: A space shuttle accelerating away from its
launch pad. The force needed is provided by several rockets.
Once each rocket has used all its fuel, it will be jettisoned
(dropped), to reduce the mass that is being carried up
into space.
44
3 Forces and motion
lb weight of an object is the
I ill of gravity on it. Weight
i . acts vertically
Inwnwards. When two objects
n u< h, there is a contact force. It
I lb contact force that stops
I filling through the floor.
i1
Friction opposes motion. Think
about the direction in which an
object is moving (or trying to
move). Friction acts in the
opposite direction.
Air resistance or drag is the
force of friction when an object
moves through air or water.
Upthrust is the upward push of a
liquid or gas on an object. The
upthrust of water makes you float
in the swimming pool.
i ii jinu 3.4: Some common forces.
I In ’ ur shown in Figure 3.5 is moving rapidly. The
in inc is providing a force to accelerate it forwards, but
•I' i is another force acting, which tends to slow down
Uli < n. This is air resistance, a form of friction caused
I n in object moves through the air. (Friction is also
lit d drag, especially for motion through liquids.) The
hi Ii .igs on the object, producing a force that acts in the
•
।
tile direction to the object’s motion.
is no motion of one surface against another, there is no
increase in thermal energy. If you are running quickly on
concrete and fall over you may notice that the graze on
your knee feels hot. This is because your kinetic energy
transfers into thermal energy due to the solid friction
between your skin and concrete. A ‘shooting star’ is a
meteor (lump of rock that bums up in our atmosphere).
It shows that air resistance and drag lead to the transfer
of kinetic energy to thermal energy.
air resistance
KEY WORDS
force: the action of one body on a second body;
unbalanced forces cause changes in speed, shape
or direction
I l#ut« 3.5: A car moves through the air. Air resistance acts
1
opposite direction to its motion.
1
\ Ii I ver who needs to stop quickly will apply the brakes
I i.iki advantage of solid friction, when two surfaces
' 1 1 1 contact (the brake pads and brake discs, in this
।.i n ) I'he kinetic energy of the car transfers into thermal
ii i y, raising the temperature of the brakes. You can
I monstrate this for yourself by rubbing your hands
I her. Energy transformations like these are discussed
I
in more detail in Chapter 6. Solid friction exists even
* In n the surfaces are not moving against each other,
mik . one or both surfaces are like ice and offer almost
ii
1 listance to motion (then they are said to have a
o i v low coefficient of friction). Compare standing on
• m n ie with standing on ice. There is much more solid
1 1 1 lion on concrete and you do not have to think about
i 1 ping your balance. The solid friction between the
• ol your shoes and concrete impedes motion (so
I diui the possibility of slipping) and, because there
।
1
।
1
-
newton (N): the force required to give a mass of
1 kg an acceleration of 1 m/sI2
air resistance: friction acting on an object moving
through air
friction: the force that acts when two surfaces rub
over one another
drag: friction that acts on an object as it moves
through a fluid (a liquid or a gas)
solid friction: the resistance to motion caused
when two surfaces are in contact
Unbalanced forces
produce acceleration
The car driver in Figure 3.6a is waiting for the traffic
lights to change. When they go green, he moves forwards.
The force provided by the engine causes the car to
accelerate. In a few seconds, the car is moving quickly
45
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
along the road. The arrow in the diagram shows the force
pushing the car forwards. If the driver wants to get away
from the lights more quickly, he can press harder on the
accelerator. The forward force is then bigger, and the
car’s acceleration will be greater.
To summarise, we have seen several things about forces:
•
They can be represented by arrows. A force has a
direction, shown by the direction of the arrow.
• A force can make an object change speed. A
forward force makes it speed up (accelerate), while a
backward force makes it slow down (decelerate).
•
A force can change the direction in which an object
is moving.
This can be summarised by saying that a body will
remain at rest or will move at a constant speed in a
straight line unless acted upon by a resultant force.
There are alternative ways of saying the same thing.
For example, a resultant force will change the speed
or direction of a body. However, the problem with this
statement is that some people forget to include starting
and stopping as changes in speed. Another alternative
is to say that a resultant force will change the velocity
of a body, but as velocity is a vector, a resultant force
can change the direction as well as the speed of a body.
A resultant force can change both speed and direction at
the same time.
Question
1
Figure 3.6: A force can be represented by an arrow.
a: The forward force provided by the engine causes the car
to accelerate forwards, b: The backward force provided by
the brakes causes the car to decelerate, c: A sideways force
causes the car to change direction.
The driver reaches another junction, where he must stop.
He applies the brakes. This provides another force to
slow down the car (see Figure 3.6b). The car is moving
forwards, but the force needed to make it decelerate
is directed backwards. If the driver wants to stop in a
hurry, a bigger force is needed. He must press hard on
the brake pedal, and the car’s deceleration will be greater.
Finally, the driver wants to turn a corner. He turns the
steering wheel. This produces a sideways force on the car
(Figure 3.6c), so that the car changes direction.
46
Figure 3.7 shows three objects that are moving.
A force acts on each object. For each, say how its
movement will change.
Figure 3.7: Three moving objects.
Two or more forces along the
same straight line
The two forces acting on the car in Figure 3.8a are:
•
•
push of engine = 600 N to the right
drag of air resistance = 400 N to the left.
3 Forces and motion
Question
2
The forces acting on three objects are shown in
Figure 3.9.
Figure 3.9: Forces acting on three objects.
I luure 3.8: A car moves through the air. Air resistance acts
hi ll
opposite direction to its motion.
i nn work out the combined effect of these two forces
mbtracting one from the other to give the resultant
Im acting on the car. The resultant force is the single
I in that has the same effect as two or more forces. So,
hi I igure 3.8a:
I
nltant force = 600 N- 400 N
i
= 200 N to the right
I In resultant force will make the car accelerate to the
i ii'lil but not as much as if there was no air resistance.
In I igure 3.8b, the car is moving even faster, and air
n ritance is greater. Now the two forces cancel each
llici out. So, in Figure 3.8b:
I
ult.int force = 600 N- 600 N = ON
Wi ny that the forces on the car are balanced. There is
H i .ultant force and so the car no longer accelerates.
Il ।mt inues at a constant speed in a straight line.
•
11 no resultant force acts on an object, it will not
iccelerate; it will remain at rest or it will continue to
move at a constant speed in a straight line.
•
1 1 an object is at rest or is moving at a constant
ipced in a straight line, we can say that there is no
1 “sultant force acting on it.
For each of a, b and c:
i
state whether the forces are balanced or
unbalanced
ii if the forces are unbalanced, calculate the
resultant force on the object and give its direction
iii state how the object’s motion will change.
3.2 Mass, weight
and gravity
If you drop an object, it falls to the ground. It is difficult
to see how a falling object moves. However, a multi-flash
photograph can show the pattern of movement when an
object falls.
Figure 3.10 shows a ball falling. There are seven images
of the ball, taken at equal intervals of time. The ball falls
further in each successive time interval. This shows that
its speed is increasing - it is accelerating.
1
।
WORDS
Itant force the single force that has the same
If t on a body as two or more forces
'• ’
H
Figure 3.10: The increasing speed of a falling ball is
captured in this multi-flash image.
47
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
When an object accelerates, there must be a force that is
causing it to do so. In this case, the force of gravity is pulling
the ball downwards. The name given to the gravitational
force acting on an object that has mass is its weight. Because
weight is a force, it is measured in newtons (N).
Every object on or near the Earth’s surface has weight.
This is caused by the attraction of the Earth’s gravity.
The Earth pulls with a force of ION (approximately) on
each kilogram of matter, so an object of mass 1 kg has
a weight of about ION. Actually, the Earth pulls with
a force of 9.8 N on each kilogram so an object of mass
1 kg has a weight of 9.8 N.
Because the Earth pulls with the same force on every
kilogram of matter, every object falls with the same
acceleration close to the Earth’s surface. If you drop a
5 kg ball and a 1 kg ball at the same time, they will reach
the ground at the same time.
The acceleration caused by the pull of the Earth’s gravity
is called the acceleration of free fall or the acceleration
due to gravity. This quantity is given the symbol g and its
value is approximately constant close to the surface of
the Earth. It is approximately 9.8 m/s2.
Calculating weight and
gravitational field strength
We have seen that an object of mass 1 kg has a weight of
9.8 N; an object of mass 2 kg has a weight of 19.6 N; and so
on. To calculate an object’s weight W from its mass m, we
multiply by 9.8, the value of the acceleration of free fall g.
We can write this as an equation in words and in symbols:
weight = mass x acceleration of free fall
W = mg
The gravitational field strength at a point is the gravitational
force exerted per unit mass placed at that point. From the
equation, W = mg, the gravitational field strength, g, is:
On the Earth’s surface, the gravitational field strength is
9.8 N/kg. It has the same value as the acceleration of free
fall or acceleration due to gravity that we met earlier and
is often rounded up to 10 N/kg.
48
>
Distinguishing mass
and weight
It is important to understand the difference between the
two quantities, mass and weight.
• The mass of an object, measured in kilograms, tells
you how much matter an object is composed of.
• The weight of an object, measured in newtons, is the
gravitational force that acts on the object.
KEY WORDS
gravity: the force that exists between any two
objects with mass
acceleration of free fall: the acceleration of an
object falling freely under gravity
acceleration due to gravity: the acceleration of
an object falling freely under gravity
gravitational field strength: the gravitational
force exerted per unit mass placed at that point
If you take an object to the Moon, it will weigh less than
it does on Earth, because the Moon’s gravity is weaker
than the Earth’s. Flowever, its mass will be unchanged,
because the object is made of just as much matter as
when it was on Earth.
When we weigh an object using a balance, we are
comparing its weight with that of standard weights
on the other side of the balance (Figure 3.11). We are
making use of the fact that, if two objects weigh the
same, their masses will be the same. We always talk about
weighing an object. However, if the balance we use has
a scale in kilograms or grams, we will find its mass, not
its weight.
Figure 3.11: When the balance is balanced, we know that
the weights on opposite sides are equal, and so the masses
must also be equal.
3
Forces and motion
Questions
I 1st the differences between mass and weight.
\ bag of sugar has a mass of 1 kg so its weight on Earth is 10 N. What can you say about the bag’s mass and its
w eight if you take it:
a
to the Moon, where gravity is weaker than on Earth?
b to Jupiter, where gravity is stronger?
<i
Look at Table 3.1. Calculate the missing values i-v. Show your method.
>
4
I
Object on planet or
asteroid
Mass of
object / kg
Acceleration due to
gravity / m/s2
Weight of
object / N
Earth
astronaut
70
9.8
i
Moon
astronaut
ii
1.60
112.0
Jupiter
tin of beans
0.44
23.0
iii
bus
iv
0.00153
7.650
astronaut
70
V
0.538
Planet or asteroid
Geographus (asteroid 1620)
Toro (asteroid 1685)
Table 3.1
l>
<
What do you notice about the mass of the astronaut?
Explain why a tin of beans weighs more on Jupiter than a bus weighs on the asteroid Geographus.
3.3 Falling and turning
fall to the ground because they have weight,
•llIl |i Isweight
is caused by the gravitational field of the
n
I u ih pulling downwards on their mass. The Moon’s
national field is much weaker, which is why objects
i i'll less when they are on the Moon.
In this section, we will look at two situations in which
his weight does not change (so the length of the
downward-pointing arrow does not change). At first, air
resistance has little effect. However, air resistance increases
with the speed of motion. As the parachutist falls faster,
eventually air resistance balances his weight. Then the
parachutist stops accelerating: he falls at a steady rate
known as the terminal velocity. The resultant force on the
free-fall parachutist is the result of two forces acting along
the same line and acting in opposite directions.
'• have to take careful account of the directions of the
Inn cm acting on an object.
KEY WORDS
Falling through the air
terminal velocity: the greatest speed reached by
an object when moving through a fluid
1 1 1 • Earth's gravity is equally strong at all points close
hi Earth’s surface. If you climb to the top of a tall
hiiilding, your weight will stay the same. We say that
I In1 1 < is a uniform gravitational field close to the Earth’s
Ian , This means that all objects fall with the same
hi * rioration as the ball shown in Figure 3.10, provided
I In 1 is no other force acting to reduce their acceleration.
I hi many objects, the force of air resistance can affect
lln li acceleration.
i" l
1
I'm achutists make use of air resistance. A free-fall
put u hutist (Figure 3.12a) jumps out of an aircraft and
hi * (crates downwards. Figure 3.12b shows the forces on
h i' n achutist at different points in his fall. Notice that
।
Opening the parachute greatly increases its area and
hence the air resistance. Now there is a much bigger
force upwards. The forces on the parachutist are again
unbalanced, and he slows down. The idea is to reach a
new, slower, terminal velocity of about 10m/s,'at which
speed he can safely land. At this point, weight = drag,
and so the forces on the parachutist are balanced.
Figure 3.12c shows how the parachutist’s speed changes
during a fall.
When the graph is horizontal, speed is constant and
forces are balanced. When the graph is sloping, speed is
49
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
changing. The parachutist is accelerating or decelerating,
and forces are unbalanced.
In Figure 3.13b, an aircraft ‘banks’ (tilts) to change
direction. The lift force on its wings provides the
necessary force.
In Figure 3.13c, the Moon is held in its orbit around the
Earth by the pull of the Earth’s gravity.
Figure 3.12a: Free-fall parachutists, before they open their
parachutes. They can reach a terminal velocity of more than
50m/s. b: The forces on a falling parachutist. Notice that
his weight is constant. When air resistance equals weight,
the forces are balanced and the parachutist reaches a steady
speed. The parachutist is always falling (velocity downwards),
although his acceleration is upwards when he opens his
parachute, c: A speed-time graph for a falling parachutist.
Question
6
Look at the speed-time graph in Figure 3.12c. Find
a point at which the graph is sloping upwards.
Is the parachutist accelerating or decelerating?
a
b Which of the two forces acting on the parachutist
is greater when the graph is sloping upwards?
Explain the shape of the graph after the
c
parachute is opened.
Going round in circles
When a car turns a comer, it changes direction. Any
object moving along a circular path is changing direction
as it goes. A force is needed to do this. Figure 3.13 shows
three objects following curved paths, together with the
forces that act to keep them on track.
In Figure 3.13a, the boy is spinning an apple around on
the end of a piece of string. The tension in the string
pulls on the apple, keeping it moving in a circle.
so
y
Figure 3.13: Examples of motion along a curved path.
In each case, there is a sideways force holding the object in
its circular path.
For an object following a circular path, the object is
acted on by a force perpendicular (at right angles) to its
motion. The force that keeps an object moving in a circle
always acts towards the centre of the circle. If the force
3 Forces and motion
h appears, the object will move off at a tangent to the
in Ie; it will not fly outwards, away from the centre.
1 1 \ moving in a circle, an object will be changing direction
i mitinuously (all the time). Therefore, even if the object
i moving at a constant speed, its velocity is changing.
I '< member that velocity is a vector and so has direction
Il i well as magnitude (size). If the velocity of an object
l • i hanging, it must be accelerating. This means that an
unbalanced force is acting on the object and this force
i'ti towards the centre of the circle. The resultant force
that acts towards the centre of a circle is the result of a
l it e acting perpendicular to the motion of the object.
I he size of the resultant force needed to make an object
nvel in a circle depends on the object’s mass, its speed
mil the radius of the circle in which it is moving. A
I nr per force is needed if:
11
•
the object’s mass is bigger (and speed and radius
stay the same)
•
the object’s speed is bigger (and mass and radius
slay the same)
the radius of the circle is smaller (and mass and
• speed
stay the same).
\ ii object moving in a circle is changing direction. It
• 1ii I res less force to change the direction of an object
1
th ii has less mass. An insect is easier to deflect than a
i
limoceros, even if the rhino is moving slowly. When you
h avelling in a car, you will feel a bigger force when
uh
u I ravel faster round a bend in the road or when the
Ih nd is sharper.
Hi wall of death’ is a stunt where motorcycles or cars
ippcut to defy gravity as they are driven around the
in ulur wall inside a giant cylinder (Figure 3.14a). The
• hk les do not slide down the wall because their weight
। Imlnticed by friction. As they move faster, the force of
1 1 1< I ion increases because the force pushing the vehicle
Inwards the centre of the cylinder increases. If they were
in < I op, the vehicles would slide down the wall.
5 ipm dryer works by spinning about its axis of
»i mmiitry. The walls push the clothes towards the centre
il 1 1 k' drum. Water droplets pass out through the holes
win ic they do not experience this force.
of you will have ridden a carousel or merryW < i' >uild (Figure 3.14b). Passengers sit on a circular
I «1 Him in that is made to spin. It feels like you are being
|ui
Ii I outwards, away from the centre, but this is an
Illusion. If you were lucky your merry-go-round had
.
with a railing along the circumference where you
mill 'ill facing the centre; it would feel like the railing
Wal
।
Figure 3.14a: The 'wall of death' in Rajkot, India,
b: A mother and her sons playing on a merry-go-round.
was pushing you towards the centre. Imagine the railings
disappeared and there was nothing to hold onto. Where
would you go? You would move at a tangent to the
circular motion (along path A in Figure 3.1).
If you roll a ball along a flat surface it will move in a
straight line until friction brings it to a stop. If someone
pushes it at right angles to its motion, it will change
direction. You may have seen a footballer gently tap a
ball to divert it into the goal.
You might want to try the following challenge with a
smaller ball. Gather some classmates around a square
table. One of you rolls a marble or other small ball close
to and parallel to an edge of the table. As the ball passes
each person, they push it once with a flat edge like a
ruler or book but only towards the centre of the table.
See if you can get the ball to travel in a circle before it
is slowed down by friction. As the ball slows down, you
will notice that you need to apply a smaller force to keep
it moving in a circle. If someone misses their turn, notice
which way the ball moves. It should move in a straight
51
I
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
line at a tangent to the circle, so long as the table is
perfectly horizontal and there is no spin on the ball. If
the Sun suddenly stopped existing the Earth would travel
in a straight line in the direction that it was moving the
instant the Sun disappeared.
Questions
7
8
9
Draw a diagram (seen from above) to show the
forces acting on a car as it turns a comer.
What provides the force keeping the planets in orbit
round the Earth?
Throwing the hammer is an Olympic sport (Figure
3.15), where the thrower spins around inside a circle
while swinging a ‘hammer’. Throwers spin as fast
as they can before releasing the hammer. Looking
down from above, sketch the path of the hammer
moving in a circle followed by its path after it is
released.
There is another factor that affects the car’s acceleration.
Suppose the driver fills the boot with a lot of heavy boxes
and then collects several children from college. He will
notice the difference when he moves away from the traffic
lights. The car will not accelerate so readily, because its
mass has increased. Similarly, when he applies the brakes,
it will not decelerate as readily as before. The mass of
the car affects how easily it can accelerate or decelerate.
Drivers learn to take account of this.
The greater the mass of an object, the smaller the
acceleration it is given by a particular force.
So, big (more massive) objects are harder to accelerate
than small (less massive) ones. If we double the mass
of the object, its acceleration for a given force will be
halved. We need to double the force to give it the same
acceleration.
This tells us what we mean by mass. It is the property of
an object that resists changes in its motion.
Force calculations
These relationships between force, mass and acceleration
can be combined into a single, very useful, equation:
KEY EQUATION
force = mass x acceleration
F —ma
Figure 3.15: Zheng Wang of China competes in the
Women's hammer throw in the 2019 World Championships.
Describe how the force needed by the athlete would
change if:
the speed of the hammer increased
a
b the length of the hammer was reduced
c
the mass of the hammer increased.
3.4 Force, mass and
acceleration
A car driver uses the accelerator pedal to control the
car’s acceleration. This alters the force provided by the
engine. The bigger the force acting on the car, the bigger
the acceleration it gives to the car. Doubling the force
produces twice the acceleration; three times the force
produces three times the acceleration, and so on.
52
The force vector and the acceleration vector are in the
same direction. This seems obvious when we are talking
about increasing the engine force to make a car accelerate
along a straight road, but recall from the previous
section that the Earth must be accelerating towards the
Sun because of the pull of the Sun’s gravity.
The quantities involved in this equation, and their units,
are summarised in Table 3.2. The unit of force is the
newton. Worked Examples 3.1 and 3.2 show how to use
the equation.
Symbol
SI Unit
force
F
netwon, N
mass
m
acceleration
a
kilogram, kg
metres per second
squared m/s2
Quantity
Table 3.2: The three quantities related by the equation
force = mass x acceleration.
3 Forces and motion
)RKED EXAMPLE 3.1
When you strike a tennis ball that another player has
lilt towards you, you provide a large force to reverse
Ils direction of travel and send it back towards your
opponent. You give the ball a large acceleration.
What force is needed to give a ball of mass 0.10 kg an
in deration of 500 m/s2?
Nlep 1: Write down what you know and what you want
to find out:
mass = 0.10 kg
acceleration = 500 m/s2
force = ?
Step 2: Substitute in the equation to find the force:
force
= mass x acceleration
= 0.10 kg x 500 m/s2
= 50N
Answer
You need to give the ball a force of 50 N.
Note that mass must be in kg (the base SI unit), not g,
if the force is to work out in N.
FORKED EXAMPLE 3.2
An Airbus A380 aircraft (Figure 3.16) has four jet
ngines, each capable of providing 320 000 N of thrust.
I he mass of the aircraft is 560 000 kg when loaded.
What is the greatest acceleration that the aircraft can
<
achieve?
Step 1: Write down what you know and what you
want to find out:
force = 4 x 320 000 N = 1 280 000 N '
(the greatest force provided by all four
engines working together)
mass = 560 000 kg
acceleration
=?
Step 2: Substitute in the equation to find the
acceleration:
acceleration = mass
_ 1280 000N
560000kg
= 2.29 N/kg
Answer
I i<|ure 3.16: An Airbus A380.
2.29 N/kg is the greatest acceleration the aircraft can
achieve.
Questions
1 0 I ,ook at Table 3.3. Calculate the missing values a-d.
Show your working.
I 4>lc 3.3
11 a
Calculate the weight of a brick that has a mass
of 2.4 kg.
b The same brick falls with an acceleration of
9.8 m/s2. Calculate the force on the brick.
c
What can you say about your answers to parts a
and b?
12 An accelerometer is a device that can detect and
calculate acceleration. Calculate the acceleration of
a 0.15 kg mass that experiences a force of 10 N.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 3.1
REFLECTION
Can mosquitoes fly in the rain?
Did you need to use the questions to help you
during the activity? Using these questions gives
you some insight into how scientists might go
about answering a question: they break a question
or problem down into smaller steps or questions.
Work in pairs. Using your physics knowledge and
the information and data below, try to answer the
question: can mosquitoes fly in the rain?
Once you have arrived at an answer, discuss it
with another pair and be prepared to share your
reasoning with the class.
If you are not sure where to start, work through the
following questions:
1
What is the acceleration of the mosquito when
hit by a raindrop in mid-air?
2
Calculate how many times bigger this is than
the acceleration of free fall.
Do you think a human could survive this
acceleration?
State the equation that relates force, mass and
acceleration.
Calculate the force that the mosquito
experiences.
Will a mosquito survive a mid-air collision with
3
4
5
6
a raindrop?
7
Will a mosquito survive if it is sitting on a
hard surface when struck with a raindrop?
Calculate the force a raindrop would exert
on a mosquito if the insect was sitting on a
hard surface (such as a tree branch) and the
raindrop came to a stop in 2 x 10-3s.
In heavy rain, a mosquito might collide with
a raindrop twice a minute.
If a raindrop hits a mosquito in mid-air,
the mosquito falls with the raindrop for a
few centimetres and the mosquito's speed
increases from zero to 2.1 m/s in 1.5 x 10~3s.
If a raindrop hits a mosquito when it is on
a solid surface, such as a tree branch, the
raindrop stops moving in 2 x 10-3s.
speed of raindrops = 10 m/s
mass of raindrops = up to 1 00 mg
mass of mosquito = 2 mg
force that mosquito exoskeleton can survive
= 0.03 N
54
Were the questions helpful? If not, can you think of
questions that would be more helpful? Could you
suggest other questions to your teacher or classmates?
3.5 Momentum
A force will change an object’s motion. It will make the
object accelerate; it may make it change direction. The
effect of a force F depends on two things:
• how big the force is
• the time interval At it acts for.
The bigger the force and the longer it acts for, the more
the object’s motion will change. The impulse equation
sums this up:
FNt -mv - mu
The quantity on the left, F^t, is called the impulse of the
force. On the right we have mv (mass x final velocity) and
mu (mass x initial velocity).
The quantity mass x velocity is known as the momentum
(p) of the object (p mv), so the right-hand side of the
equation mv - mu is the change in the object’s momentum,
which can be written as:
=
\p = mv
—
mu = A(mv)
We can write the impulse equation like this:
impulse of force = change of momentum
Impulse and momentum are both defined by equations:
= force x time for which it acts = FAr
change in momentum = Ap = A(mv) so
impulse = Fkt = A(wv)
impulse
KEY WORDS
impulse: the change in an object's momentum, Ap,
or the force acting on an object multiplied by the
time for which the force acts (F x At)
momentum: the quantity mass x velocity, p = mv
3
Expanding out the brackets gives:
„ mv - mu
I QUATIONS
tin nu ilium
f=~nT~
= mass x velocity
Knowing that Np = mv - mu, we can write the equation as:
p = mv
Ihi| ml
iiu|'iil <
Forces and motion
force x time for which the force acts
FNt = N(mv)
Nt
•RKED EXAMPLE 3.3
A < ill of mass 600kg is moving at 15 m/s.
< 'alculate its momentum.
i»
I li'' driver accelerates gently so that a force of 30 N
u h on the car for 10 seconds.
< alculate the impulse of the force.
( 'alculate the momentum of the car after the
h
r
accelerating force has acted on it.
AlMwer
m momentum = mass x velocity
= 600 kg x 15m/s = 9000 kg m/s
It
impulse = force x time = 30 N x 10 s = 300 N s
r
I'he impulse of the force tells us how much the
car’s momentum changes. The car is speeding
up, so its momentum increases by 300 N s.
final momentum = initial momentum + impulse
of force
9000 + 300
= 9300 kg m/s
=
lob that the unit of momentum is kgm/s; this is the
line as N s, the unit of impulse.
So, the resultant force is the change in momentum per
unit time.
This defines the force as the rate of change of
momentum but it is really just a different way of writing
the more familiar equation F ma in a way that makes
it easier to explain some physics. For example, ‘it explains
why cars are fitted with seatbelts, airbags and crumple
zones. It also explains why we automatically bend our
knees when we jump down from a tall object.
=
When a car crashes at a given speed say, (10 m/s), the
passengers experience the same impulse or change in
momentum whether or not they are wearing seatbelts.
However, the time taken to come to a stop increases for
those wearing seatbelts. This makes the right-hand side
of the equation
smaller. This reduces the force
Nt
experienced by the passengers, which reduces the risk
of injury. The same reasoning can be applied to other
safety measures, including the use of air bags in Worked
Example 3.4.
1
WORKED EXAMPLE 3.4
Questions
11
'alculate the momentum of a bullet of mass 10.5 g
moving at 553 m/s.
14 A force of 500 N acts on a rocket for 600 s, causing
the rocket’s velocity to increase.
Calculate the impulse of the force.
b By low much does the rocket’s momentum
increase?
u
Remember that F = ma. We know that a
Nt
Nt
In we can substitute for a to give:
(
•
I
Crash tests allow scientists to investigate the forces
on passengers during collisions. In the first test, a car
travelling at 15 m/s crashes into a wall (Figure 3.17).
The crash test dummy, which has a mass of 70 kg,
comes to a stop in 0.03 s. In the second test, the car
is fitted with an airbag so the dummy takes five times
longer to come to a stop. What forces are acting on
the dummy in both tests?
=^-=-
55
1
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
1 6 Superman is a fictional aharacter who was made for
life on the planet Krypton but arrived on Earth as
a child. While he could have grown up to become
average on Krypton, this question explores why he
appears to have superpowers on Earth.
CONTINUED
a
b
Figure 3.17: A crash test.
c
d
Step 1: Start by writing down what you know and
what you want to know.
First test
Second test
= 70 kg
v = 15 m/s
AZ 0.03 s
F ?
m
m
=
=
F=?
Step 2: Now write down the equation.
M
Step 3: Substitute the values of the quantities on the
right-hand side and calculate the answer.
_ 70 kg x 15 m/s
0.03 s
= 3.5 x 104N
ACTIVITY 3.2
Public awareness campaign
F=—
First test
e
= 70 kg
v = 15 m/s
AZ = 0.15 s
Write down an equation for force in terms of
momentum and time.
Assume that Superman has a mass of 100 kg
and launches himself upwards with a speed of
60 m/s. What force would he apply if he spent
0.25 s pushing off from the ground?
What is Superman’s weight?
How many times bigger is the force he exerted
(your answer to part b) compared to his weight
(your answer to part c)?
Calculate the gravitational field strength of
Krypton. (Hint: You need to know the value of
the gravitational field strength for the Earth’s
surface and that, when most people jump, they
apply a force approximately equal to their weight.)
Second test
70 kg x 15 m/s
0.15s
= 7.0 x 103N
Answer
In the first test, the force on the crash test dummy was
3.5 x KFN. In the second test, the force was 7.0 x 103N.
The airbag increased the time that it took for the dummy
to come to a stop and reduced the force by a factor of
five. An airbag reduces the risk of , injury.
Work in pairs to develop your ideas and then join
with another pair to complete the activity. Develop
a public awareness campaign (posters, video clips)
to highlight road traffic accidents (RTAs). The aim
of your campaign is to reduce serious injury.
In your campaign make sure you include why the
following are important in reducing serious injury
in RTAs:
•
•
•
•
•
•
keeping to speed limits
wearing seatbelts
installing airbags
crumple zones on cars
not driving after taking drugs
not driving when tired.
Remember that the audience are not scientists,
so you will need to explain, by using physics, why
these precautions reduce serious injury in RTAs.
Question
15 In a car crash the driver and his passenger both
experience the same impulse. However, the driver
is wearing a seatbelt so it takes him longer to stop
moving. Explain why his injuries are less serious
than those of his passenger.
56
Momentum in a collision
Figure 3.18 shows a game of swing ball, in which a ball
hangs from a length of string. The player hits the ball
horizontally with a racket.
3 Forces and motion
WORKED EXAMPLE 3.5
• |l 1l*! Hitting a ball with a tennis racket, a: Before the
•lim th* hit.
I* i hi’ c use the idea of momentum to describe what
We need to think about momentum before the
pb < ollidcs with the ball, and then after the collision.
I
H 8a, before the collision, the racket is moving
i iphl; it has momentum. The ball is stationary, so
।
IM*
momentum.
i nidi 1 18b, after the collision, the racket is moving
•I" 1 1 ph I . but more slowly than before. It has lost
mu mum The ball is moving rapidly to the right. It
li giilni d momentum.
u' in see that, when the racket exerts a force on
ill momentum is transferred from the racket to the
ill ** he never a force acts on an object, its momentum
\t the same time, the momentum of the object
in mi the force also changes. If one object gains
nix ntiim, then the other loses an equal amount
ii' nu iitum. This is known as the principle of the
ion of momentum.
During a game of swing ball, a player hits the ball
horizontally with a racket.
• mass of tennis racket = 3.0 kg
• velocity of tennis racket before it strikes the
ball = 20 m/s
• velocity of tennis racket after it strikes the
ball = 18 m/s
• mass of tennis ball = 0.25 kg
• velocity of tennis ball before the racket strikes
it = Om/s
Find:
a the momentum of the racket
i before the collision
ii after the collision
b the momentum of the ball after the collision
c
Answer
momentum
a
K
' )RDS
ii After the collision:
momentum = 3.0 kg x 18 m/s = 54 kg m/s
Note: After the collision, the racket is moving
more slowly and so its momentum is less.
b
The momentum gained by the ball is equal to
the momentum lost by the racket.
So, momentum of ball = 60 kg m/s - 54 kg m/s
= 6.0 kg m/s
c
We can calculate the velocity of the ball by
rearranging the equation for momentum:
velocityJ
Wv
t ate the principle in a different way. Whenever
l»n "b|ri ts interact, the total amount of momentum
Il 1 >h I hoy interact is the same as the total amount of
Hlimi' ilium afterwards:
Ini.i I momentum before = total momentum after
in
= mass x velocity
i Before the collision:
momentum = 3.0 kg x 20 m/s = 60 kg m/s
With in the meeting of particles or of bodies in
h ach exerts a force upon the other
Inclpl* of the conservation of momentum: the
il in jmentum is constant and does not change
। -nr
" of an interaction between bodies (such
1
illi'llons)
1
the velocity of the ball.
_ 6.0 mass
kg m/s
0.25 kg
24
= m/s
The ball will move off with a velocity of 24 m/s
to the right.
3.5 shows how we can use this to work
"• hi• <1 Example
last the ball in Figure 3.18 will be moving after
1
i
'i
II Im Im en hit by the racket.
57
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 3.3
Finding the velocity of a tennis ball using conservation of momentum
You want to carry out an investigation to find the speed of a tennis ball, but most of the instructions are
missing. You need to finish the plan.
This is the only guidance you have.
E^uipmenf.: tennis ball (or similar), carJboarX box,
newspaper Or bubble wrap, stopwatch, measuring
tape or metre rulers, mass balances.
Method: Fill a Cardboard box with loosely Crumpled
newspaper Or bubble wrap. Put the box On a
smooth flat floor and throw the ball horizontally
into the box (Figure 3.1^5. The box will slide
before coming to a stop.
Figure 3.19
On your own, spend three minutes thinking carefully about the following activity and answer the questions.
Then spend three minutes sharing ideas about the activity with the person sitting next to you. Be prepared
to share your answers with the class.
Follow these steps to finish the plan:
1
Explain how the speed of the ball can be calculated using the principle of conservation of momentum.
(Hint: this is a collision between the ball and the box.)
2
Explain how the speed of the ball can be calculated using only the equipment available. It might help to
sketch a speed-time graph for the box, as this will suggest what measurements you can take.
3
Write down the steps (method) required to complete the investigation, including calculations needed and
any safety precautions.
Optional
4
Compare your explanation and method with another group and improve your own.
5
If you have access to the equipment, carry out the experiment.
6
Using an alternative technique (such as video analysis) check whether you measured the correct speed
and account for any difference.
PEER ASSESSMENT
Did the other group correctly and clearly:
• describe and explain what measurements to take?
• describe and explain what calculations to do?
Would you have been able to follow their method to produce reliable results?
Did the group include sensible safety precautions?
Provide constructive written and verbal feedback. As well as pointing out improvements, praise good
aspects of their work.
When you get your work returned to you, make improvements based on the feedback.
58
>
3 Forces and motion
3.6 More about scalars
and vectors
"in will recall that scalars have magnitude (size)
ill md no direction. We can represent forces using
tows because a force has a direction as well as a
in i g mt ude. This means that force is a vector quantity
( hapter 2). Table 3.4 lists some scalar and vector
*
ju unities. Every vector quantity has a direction.
1 1 iivovcr, it is not always necessary to state the direction
il I Ins is obvious - for example, we might say, ‘The
• i t h! of the block is ION,’ without saying that this
iii acts downwards.
i
quantities
• 1
Vector quantities
llutonce
velocity
limn
force
| >rod
weight
Innis
acceleration
unurgy
momentum
b mperature
electric field strength
gravitational field
strength
I il l' 3.4: Some scalar and vector quantities.
Adding forces
A hut happens if an object is acted on by two or more
i in i
Figure 3.20a shows someone pushing a car.
I i iction opposes their pushing force. Because the forces
<r acting in a straight line, it is simple to calculate
i
la resultant force, provided we take into account the
In etions of the forces:
h
ultant force = 500N-350N
= 1 50 N to the right
’ hili that we must give the direction of the resultant
Inn c, as well as its magnitude. The car will accelerate
I .irds the right.
-
I r lire 3.20b shows a more difficult situation. A firework
i ' h ket is acted on by two forces.
•
I'he thrust of its burning fuel pushes it towards
the right.
•
1 ts weight acts vertically downwards.
Figure 3.20a: Adding two forces in a straight line.
b: Adding two forces at right angles.
Worked Example 3.6 shows how to find the resultant
force by drawing a vector triangle (a graphical
representation of vectors) or using Pythagoras’ theorem.
KEY WORDS
vector triangle: a graphical representation of
vectors in two dimensions so that the resultant
vector can be calculated
Rules for vector addition
You can add two or more forces using the following
method. Simply keep adding arrows end-to-end.
• Draw arrows end-to-end. so that the end of one is
the start of the next.
• Choose a scale that gives a large triangle.
• Join the start of the first arrow to the end of the last
arrow to find the resultant.
Other vector quantities (for example, two velocities)
can be added in this way. Imagine that you set out to
swim across a fast-flowing river. You swim towards
the opposite bank, but the river’s velocity carries you
downstream. Your resultant velocity will be at an angle
to the bank.
Airline pilots must understand vector addition. Aircraft
fly at high speed, but the air they are moving through
is also moving fast. If they are to fly in a straight line
towards their destination, the pilot must take account of
the wind velocity (both its speed and direction).
Once you have mastered drawing a vector triangle, you
could use Pythagoras’ theorem to find the length of the
resultant vector and trigonometry to find the angle.
59
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
*
WORKED EXAMPLE 3.6
Find the resultant force acting on the rocket shown in
Figure 3.20b. What effect will the resultant force have
on the rocket?
Method 1: Draw a scale diagram
Step 1: Look at Figure 3.20b. The two forces are 4.0 N
horizontally and 3.0 N vertically.
You now need to draw a scale diagram
(a vector triangle) to represent these forces.
Figure 3.21: Vector triangle.
Use a scale of 1.0 cm to represent 1.0N.
Step 2: Draw a horizontal arrow, 4.0 cm long, to
represent the 4.0 N force. Mark it with an
arrow to show its direction.
Step 3: Using the end of this arrow as the start of the
next arrow, draw a vertical arrow, 3.0 cm long,
to represent the 3.0 N force.
Step 4: Complete the triangle by drawing an arrow
from the start of the first arrow to the end of
the second arrow. This arrow represents the
resultant force.
Method 2: Using Pythagoras’ Theorem
Step 1: Look at Figure 3.20b. The two forces are at
right angles so Pythagoras’ theorem can be
used. The square of the hypotenuse (the side
opposite the right angle) is equal to the sum
of the squares of the other two sides.
Step 2: Find the resultant force using Pythagoras’
theorem.
c2 = b2 + a2
so c
Step 5: Measure this arrow, and use the scale to
determine the size of the force it represents.
length of line
= 5.0 cm
so c = A2 + 32 = ^16 + 9 = /25 = 5N
Step 3: Find the angle below the horizontal using
trigonometry.
resultant force = 5.0 N
adjacent
Step 6: Use a protractor to measure the angle of the
force. (You could also calculate this angle using
trigonometry.)
angle of force = 37° below horizontal
Figure 3.21 shows what your vector triangle should
look like.
= /u2 + b2
6 = tan'1
4N
= 37°
Answer
The resultant force acting on the rocket is 5.0 N
acting at 37° below the horizontal. The rocket will be
given an acceleration in this direction.
Notice that both methods give the same answer.
Question
17 You are rowing across the Lembeh Strait at 1.5 m/s.
a Calculate your velocity if you row against a
current of 0.2 m/s?
60
>
b
Use a vector triangle or calculate your resultant
velocity if you travel at 4 m/s in a speedboat
due south and a current pushes you towards
the east at 3 m/s. Give both your speed and
direction.
3 Forces and motion
• HQJECT
Hyr il op One was described at the beginning of
B h ipter. If Hyperloop One is successful, trains
at high speed along tubes. It will use
*MaIni ivol
-tic repulsion between two unlike magnetic
I’"1' > lift trains off the floor of the tubes to
Bl inmate solid friction. By removing airfrom the
llllu , ie trains will push against less air resistance.
The judgement
we often want to reduce friction there are
«i" i tuations where friction is helpful or even
ti.il. Later you will discover other examples
if ph .ics where something can be both helpful
1 h। irdous (for example, ionising radiation
transport system
Wl
h.ipter23).
I" 1
In" nne that there is a character called Friction who
L • I on charged with the crime of impeding the
Bim dh running of the natural world. Evidence is
i »11« < tod for and against him before his case goes
i Io ln.ll.
evidence for the prosecution
(•gainst fiction)
m h at least one example that you have not
•' iy met in this chapter where it is helpful to
I- I
solid friction or drag.
N*
i k
evidence for the defence (of Friction)
h at least one example of solid friction and
ample of air resistance that is necessary
» I ” l| ful. For example, we need solid friction
’ <1 car tyres and the road. Without this friction
i
would not be able to change speed (or start
•
l
it
ip) or change direction in order to follow the
li i ind turns in the road. However, this friction
M
In
in
'
•
|i
’li' es heat and this leads to wasted energy.
Write the transcript from the trial (what was said and
who said it). This might include statements by the
prosecutor, defence lawyer, expert witnesses, and
the trial judge.
Optional task: promoting an efficient mass
By reducing friction, Hyperloop One promises
more efficient use of energy. However, it requires
the building of tubes for the trains to run inside,
which requires building materials and energy
for construction.
Use the Internet to find out about efficient mass
transport systems (such as tram or subway systems
for cities) that have a low carbon footprint. It could
be an existing system or one that is proposed for
the future (such as Hyperloop One). To learn about
the maglev technology in Hyperloop One, you
could read Chapter 16 to discover why magnets
attract and repel.
Once you have found the most promising system,
imagine that you are an environmental journalist
with a physics background. Write an article
(maximum 500 words) in support of it, which urges
readers to pressure the government to adopt
the transport system you are proposing. As well
as writing something that grabs the attention of
readers, you need to:
•
justify why you support the system you have
chosen, based on physics
•
explain the relevant physics so that it can be
understood by the public
•
include relevant images.
61
>
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SUMMARY
The unit of force is the newton (N).
Forces appear when two objects interact with each other.
A force can be represented by an arrow to show its direction, while length is proportional to the size of
the force.
Solid friction, air resistance, and drag act in the opposite direction to the object’s motion and can
produce heating.
The resultant force is the single force that has the same effect as two or more forces.
A resultant force can change the speed and/or direction of an object.
The force of gravity pulls objects downwards and is normally called the weight of the object.
I
terationcaused by the pull of the Earth’s gravity is called the acceleration of free fall or the
ation due to gravity. It is given the symbol g and its value is 9.8 m/s2 close to the surface of the Earth.
iss of an object, measured in kilograms, tells you how much matter that object is composed of.
ight of an object, measured in newtons, is the gravitational force that acts on that object.
al velocity is the name for the maximum constant speed reached when the resultant force acting on an
becomes zero. It is often applied to parachutists when the upwards force of air resistance becomes equal
posite to weight.
bject moves in a circle, a force must be acting towards the centre of the path, perpendicular (at right
to the speed of the object.
ition in a circular path, a bigger force is required if the body is more massive, moving faster or moving in
:r circle.
- mass x acceleration, F
= ma.
itum is the quantity mass x velocity, p
= mv.
inciple of the conservation of momentum means that the total momentum after an interaction between
(for example, a collision) is the same as it was before the interaction.
pulse (of a force) can be defined as the change in an object’s momentum (mv - mu) or the force acting on
:ct multiplied by the time for which the force acts (Ft), so impulse = Fht.
of momentum, F:an be defined as the rate of change
°
—.
;ultant of two vectors that do not act along the same line can be found by drawing a vector triangle or
ulation.
—
62
3 Forces and motion
'M STYLE QUESTIONS
in ’014, Alan Eustace set the world record for the highest freefall parachute
I iimp (from a height of more than 41 km). As he fell towards the Earth, he
.u hed a terminal velocity of almost 370 m/s. The air was very thin where he
।
I. ii ted his jump and became thicker the closer he got to the ground. What
li । p pened to his terminal velocity, before he opened his parachute?
A it increased
11
[1]
C it reduced but not to zero
D it reduced to zero
it stayed the same
\ n object with a mass of 35 kg accelerates at 0.7 m/s2 to the right, as shown in
tin diagram.
X
acceleration = 0.7 m/s2
70 N
mass = 35 kg
320 N
I here are four forces acting on the object. What are the values of the forces
Libelled T and T?
A
H
[1]
C X= 320 N; y= 94.5 N
D 2f=320N; Y= 119.0N
\ =70N; Y= 119.0 N
\ 70N; T=94.5N
=
I hr diagram shows the forces during a tug of war competition. Team A has
total mass of 800 kg and pulls with a force of 1000 N to the left. Team B
h i ,i total mass of 700 kg and pulls with a force of 700 N to the right.
A . t rong rope joins them.
1000N
team A
— team B
800 kg
700 kg
700 N
W hat is the acceleration of team A?
A 0.20 m/s2 to the left
[1]
C 1.25 m/s2 to the left
D 0.38 m/s2 to the left
B 1 .25 m/s2 to the right
I hese four diagrams show the forces on raindrops that are falling towards
i h<
ground.
W hich raindrop is slowing down?
2.6 N
2.6 N
[1]
3.1 N
1.4N
1.8N
1.8N
2.6 N
1
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
^O^TINUED
5 An aircraft of mass 4000 kg produces a thrust of 10 kN. The aircraft needs
to travel at 35 m/s to take off.
a State the equation that links force, mass and acceleration.
b Calculate the acceleration of the aircraft.
c The aircraft starts from rest. Calculate the time it takes to become
airborne.
d Sketch a speed-time graph for the aircraft from the moment it starts
until it takes off. Assume that its acceleration is constant.
e Calculate the minimum length of the runway required for this aircraft
to take off.
f When it lands at the end of the flight, it travels on the ground (taxis) at
a constant speed. Explain how this aircraft can accelerate even when it
is travelling at a constant speed.
[1 ]
[1 ]
[2]
[2]
[1 1
[1 ]
6 Scientists test the safety features of a car by crashing it into a large block
of concrete.
A crash test dummy sits in the driver's seat. A video camera records the
crash. In one test, the car is travelling at 13 m/s and the dummy has a mass
of 83 kg.
a State the equation that links momentum, mass and velocity.
[1 ]
in a time of 0.17 s. Calculate the average force acting on the dummy
during this time.
[1 ]
[2]
d These tests help to make our roads safer. Use ideas about momentum
to explain how seat belts and the crumple zones of a car help to reduce
injuries during a crash.
[3]
[Total: 7]
64
state: express in
clear terms
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
sketch: make a
simple freehand
[Total: 8]
b Calculate the momentum of the dummy.
c In another test, the momentum of the dummy changes by 1250 kg m/s
COMMAND WORDS
drawing showing the
key features, taking
care over proportions
explain: set out
purposes o.r
reasons / make
the relationships
between things
evident / provide
why and / or how and
support with relevant
evidence
3
Forces and motion
'.ELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
un gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
Recall the two ways that a force can change the motion
of a body.
Recall the significance of both the length and direction
of arrows used to represent a force.
Recall that friction acts between two solid surfaces;
friction acts in the opposite direction to motion and can
produce thermal energy.
Recall that air resistance and drag are like friction.
Calculate the resultant force when two or more forces
act along the same line.
Define mass and weight and recall the differences
between them, including the units used.
Recall that weight is the name given to the force of
gravity on a body and that it always acts downwards.
Recall and use the equation W = mg and recall that
g = 9.8 m/s2.
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
3.1
3.1
3.1
3.1
3.1
3.2
3.2
3.2
Define terminal velocity.
3.3
Recall the direction of the force that acts on a body to
make it move in a circle.
3.3
Recall how the size of the force that acts on a body to
make it move in a circle depends on the mass and speed
of the body and the radius of the circle.
3.3
Recall and use the equations for force and momentum.
3.4, 3.5
Define impulse and perform calculations by recalling
and using the associated equations.
3.4
Apply the principle of the conservation of momentum.
3.5
Define what a force is and recall and use the associated
equation.
3.4
Calculate, or draw a vector triangle to work out, the
resultant force when the forces do not act along the
same line.
3.6
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
> Chapter 4
Turning effects
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
describe and calculate the turning force
investigate and apply the principle of moments
describe the conditions needed for an object to be in equilibrium
describe how the centre of gravity of an object affects its stability
apply the principle of moments when there is more than one moment on each side of a pivot.
4
Turning effects of forces
HUG STARTED
l| "lid 60 seconds thinking on your own, have 30 seconds of discussion with a partner and then be prepared
|| lim your answers to the following questions with the class. You might find it helpful to draw sketches.
। ilnin how the street performer
n|i Inn d in Figure 4.1 a appears
1
it h it.ite (float in space above
pound) and the performer
tin wn in Figure 4.1b appears to
H I v lb' force of gravity.
I i im how lifeboats (see Figure
I I ) ' an be self-righting (turn
•In i Kjht way up after capsizing).
I
Figure 4.1a: A street performer appears to levitate, b: A street performer
appears to defy the force of gravity, c: An engraving of a self-righting lifeboat
from the 19th century.
I T THE WOLF OF WAR
Il i
i
lad fact that war creates opportunities
counterweight swapped positions. Hint: Think
about the relative speeds of the two ends of
the beam. Draw a sketch if it helps.
It n advances in technology. China invented the
•'•■I >im het in the 5th century and it was an effective
|l»i i' weapon until the invention of gunpowder.
A n auchet is a catapult that has a swinging arm to
2
A trebuchet uses energy transfers as well as
turning forces. Can you think of other ideas
in physics that need more than one topic to
explain it?
3
What do you think would have done more
damage to the walls of Stirling Castle - a
projectile that is twice as massive or twice as
fast? (If you have already met the equation for
kinetic energy, see if you can work it out.)
• projectile (a thrown object).
i '
I lu> tn buchet is made from a long beam that pivots
in in axle. The attacking soldiers attach a sling
•i nh lining the projectile to the end of the longer
M lion. They attach a counterweight to the shorter
I Io fire the trebuchet, the soldiers allow the
mnterweight to fall which applies a turning force
ii moment on the beam. Because the projectile
I* luri her from the axle (or pivot), the projectile
Hu iv< much faster than the counterweight and
tl" ding at the end extends the effective length
il the beam, making the projectile move even
I • ilor. The trebuchet uses energy transfers as well
i lurning forces. The largest trebuchets had a
I metre beam, a 9000 kg counterweight and could
Inui a 140 kg stone block to a range of almost
I00 metres. Loup de Guerre (or Wolf of War) was
'hi biggest trebuchet ever built, by Edward I, who
i king of England in the late 13th century. He
i Tried the surrender of Scottish defenders so that
Ii" i ould use it against Stirling Castle.
।
.
beam
counter-
I 'l’■cussion questions
1
Try explaining how a trebuchet works.
Describe how the performance of the
trebuchet would change if the projectile and
Figure 4.2: Trebuchets are not a part of modern warfare.
Here, an enthusiast uses his trebuchet to throw a pumpkin
during a recent North American Pumpkin Launch.
r
y
CAMBRIDGE 1GCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
4.1 The moment of a force Making use of turning effects
Figure 4.3 shows a boy who is trying to open a heavy
door by pushing on it. He must make the turning effect
of his force as big as possible. How should he push?
Figure 4.4 shows how understanding moments can
be useful.
When using a crowbar to lift a heavy rock, pull near the
end of the bar, and at 90°, to have the biggest possible
turning effect.
When lifting a load in a wheelbarrow, the long handles
help to increase the moment of the lifting force.
Figure 4.3: Opening a door - how can the boy have a big
turning effect?
First of all, look for the pivot the fixed point about
which the door will turn. This is the hinge of the door.
To open the door, the person must push with as big a
force as possible, and as far as possible from the pivot
- at the other edge of the door. (That is why the door
handle is fitted there.) To have a big turning effect,
the person must push hard at right angles to the door.
Pushing at a different angle gives a smaller turning effect.
-
The quantity that tells us the turning effect of a force
about a pivot is its moment.
• The moment of a force is bigger if the force is bigger.
•
The moment of a force is bigger if it acts further
from the pivot.
The moment of a force is greatest if it acts at 90° to
the object it acts on.
•
KEY WORDS
turning effect: when a force causes an object to
rotate or would make the object rotate if there
were no resistive forces
pivot: the fixed point about which a lever turns;
also known as the fulcrum
moment: the turning effect of a force about a
pivot, given by force x perpendicular distance
from the pivot
68
>
Figure 4.4: Understanding moments can help in some
difficult tasks.
Balancing a beam
Figure 4.5 shows a small child sitting on the left-hand end
of a see-saw. Her weight causes the see-saw to tip down on
the left. Her father presses down on the other end. If he
can press with a force greater than her weight, the see-saw
will tip to the right and she will come up in the air.
Now, suppose the father presses down closer to the pivot.
He will have to press with a greater force if the turning
effect of his force is to overcome the turning effect of his
daughter’s weight. If he presses at half the distance from
the pivot, he will need to press with twice the force to
balance her weight.
4
c
2
whh )ht of girl
।pii •>
ii
The moment of a force is greatest if it acts at
{0°/ 45°/ 90°} to the object it acts on.
Three different forces are pulling on a heavy
trapdoor (Figure 4.6). Which force will have the
biggest turning effect? Explain your answer.
father's push
4.5: Two forces are causing this see-saw to tip.
hinge
ir 1' - weight causes it to tip to the left, while her father
1'
Turning effects of forces
. a force to tip it to the right. He can increase the
ffect of his force by increasing the force, or by
। Illi") down at a greater distance from the pivot.
trapdoor
Figure 4.6
in ;
\ m ' .aw is an example of a beam, a long, rigid object
'i'll pivoted at a point. The girl’s weight is making the
I mi lip one way. The father’s push is making it tip the
><ili i Way. If the beam is to be balanced, the moments of
lli. I wo forces must cancel each other out.
Equilibrium
In
lence and in other subjects, you will often hear
♦«i ml Ihings that are in equilibrium. This always means
it i wo or more things are balanced. When a beam is
I meed, we say that it is in equilibrium. When an object
1' in equilibrium:
• I he forces on it must be balanced (no resultant force)
• I he turning effects of the forces on it must also be
balanced (no resultant turning effect).
1 b
" In n a resultant force acts on an object, it will start to
inm<’ off in the direction of the resultant force. If there is
I '■
' illant turning effect, it will start to rotate.
I Y WORD
I equilibrium: when no net force and no net
moment act on a body
3
4
Explain why somebody would use a spanner with a
longer handle if they needed to undo a tight bolt.
Explain why a tree is more likely to be blown
a
over in a stronger wind.
b Explain why a taller tree is more likely to be
blown over than a shorter tree.
4.2 Calculating moments
We have seen that, the greater a force and the further it acts
from the pivot, the greater is its moment. We can write an
equation for calculating the moment of a force like this:
KEY EQUATION
moment of a force = force x perpendicular distance
from the pivot
Now let us consider the unit of moment. Since moment is
a force (N) multiplied by a distance (m), its unit is simply
the newton metre (Nm). There is no special name for this
unit in the SI system. Take care: if distances are given in
cm, the unit of moment will be Ncm. Take care not to mix
these different units (Nm and Ncm) in a single calculation.
Figure 4.7 shows an example. The 40 N force is
2.0 metres from the pivot, so:
moment of force = 40 N x 2.0 m - 80 Nm
Questions
I
hoose the correct option in the following
statements.
a The moment of a force is bigger if the force is
{smaller /bigger}.
1 ' The moment of a force is bigger if it acts
{closer / further} from the pivot.
(
m
2.0 m
Ta
beam
pivot
J
I
|4QN
Figure 4.7: Calculating the moment of a force.
69
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Balancing moments
6
A bolt is tightened by Applying a turning force of
30 N to the end of the spanner (Figure 4.8).
Look back at Figure 4.5, where a father and his daughter
are playing on a see-saw. On her own, she would make
the see-saw turn anticlockwise; her weight has an
anticlockwise moment. To make the see-saw balance, her
father needs to push down on the right-hand end of the
see-saw, applying a clockwise moment.
The idea that an object is balanced when clockwise
and anticlockwise moments are equal is known as the
principle of moments. We can use this principle to find
the value of an unknown force or distance, as shown in
Worked Example 4. 1.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4.1
The daughter in Figure 4.5 has a weight of 500 N and
is sitting 2.0 metres to the left of the pivot. Her father
has a weight of 800 N. How far to the right of the
pivot should he sit so that the see-saw is balanced?
Step 1:
Write down what you know and what you
want to find out.
anti-clockwise force = 500 N
distance - 2.0 m
clockwise force = 800 N; distance = ?
Which of the three distance measurements
should you use?
b Use this distance to calculate the moment.
A uniform metre ruler is balanced at its midpoint
(Figure 4.9).
a
7
Step 2: Since the see-saw has to be in equilibrium,
we can write:
total anticlockwise total clockwise
moment
moment
=
Step 3: Substitute in the values from Step 1, and solve.
500 N x 2.0 m = 800 N x perpendicular
distance
1000 Nm 800 N x perpendicular distance
=
.. .
perpendicular distance
_
~
1-25 m
= l000Nm_1oc
gpg
Answer
The father needs to sit 1.25 m to the right of the pivot
so that the see-saw is balanced.
Questions
5
70
Write down, in words, the equation for finding the
moment of a force about a point, stating carefully
the units for each quantity.
>
Figure 4.9
8
Calculate the unknown force F.
A boy of mass 60 kg, and his sister of mass 49 kg,
play on a see-saw pivoted at its centre. If the boy sits
2.7 metres from the pivot of the see-saw, calculate
the distance from the other side of the pivot the girl
must sit to make the see-saw balanced.
KEY WORDS
anticlockwise: turning in the opposite direction
from the hands on a clock
clockwise: turning in the same direction as the
hands on a clock
principle of moments: when an object is in
equilibrium, the sum of anticlockwise moments
about any point equals the sum of clockwise
moments about the same point
4 Turning effects of forces
2.0 m
fIVITY 4.1
f '■
1.0 m
1.0 m
vlng fingers along a metre ruler
>d with a partner. Take it in turns to balance
pair of round pencils) across
, "ii index fingers with your hands wide apart but
Hl liIf erent distances from the ends of the ruler.
Iili wly bring your hands together. Discuss what
"i observe with your partner. As part of your
li tissions, you both need to describe and explain
L il you observe.
i metre ruler(ora
।
.
ii
I Mw work independently to write a description
iiI .»n
ii
explanation. Your description should
H p lude a diagram of what was happening. You
|an Libel the diagram as part of your explanation,
whic h needs to include the following words:
liniments, centre of gravity, and friction.
/lien you have both finished writing, swap your
w 4 and decide who has written the better
n।'Lination and why it is better. For example, is it
Ie. nor or more scientifically accurate? Update your
wn work with any improvements.
।
low try the same thing with a 100 g mass taped
to the ruler (or use a pool cue if
ill lble). What do you observe this time? Can
ymi oxplain what is happening?
1
hi need to describe and
Figure 4.10: A balanced see-saw. On her own, the child
on the left would make the see-saw turn anticlockwise; her
weight has an anticlockwise moment. The weight of each
child on the right has a clockwise moment. Since the see¬
saw is balanced, the sum of the clockwise moments must
equal the anticlockwise moment.
WORKED EXAMPLE 4.2
The beam shown in Figure 4.1 1 is 2.0 metres long
and has a weight of 20 N. It is pivoted as shown. A
force of 10N acts downwards at one end. What force,
F must be applied downwards at the other end to
balance the beam?
explain as you did before.
More balancing moments
t In ihice children in Figure 4.10 have balanced their
mw it is in equilibrium. The weight of the child on
F Uh li'lt is tending to turn the see-saw anticlockwise. So
Hn weight of the child on the left has an anticlockwise
The weights of the two children on the right
I
I linvi dockwise moments. From the data in Figure 4.10,
-
i mi
calculate these moments:
b |llll< lockwise moment = 500 Nx 2.0 m = 1000 Nm
lock wise moments = (300 N x 2.0 m) + (400 N x 1.0 m)
= 600 Nm + 400 Nm
= 1000 Nm
i
I In hi tickets are included as a reminder to perform the
••mil (plications before the addition.
mi see that, in this situation:
" total
clockwise moment total anticlockwise moment
'
<
=
|n tin see-saw in Figure 4.10 is balanced.
Figure 4.11: Balancing a beam.
Step 1: Identify the clockwise and anticlockwise
forces. Two forces act clockwise: 20 N at a
distance of 0.5 m, and 10N at 1.5 m. One
force acts anticlockwise: the force Fat 0.5 m.
Step 2: Since the beam is in equilibrium, we can
write total clockwise moment = total
anticlockwise moment
Step 3: Substitute in the values from Step 1, and solve.
(20N x 0.5m) + (10N x 1.5m) Fx 0.5m
lONm + 15Nm = Fx 0.5m
25Nm = Fx 0.5m
Nm
F 25
0.5m
= 50N
=
=
71
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Answer
A force of 50 N must be applied downwards at the
other end to balance the beam.
You might have been able to work this out in your
head, by looking at the diagram. The 20 N weight
requires 20 N to balance it, and the ION at 1.5 m
needs 30 N at 0.5 m to balance it. So the total force
needed is 50 N.
In equilibrium
In Figure 4.10, three forces are shown acting downwards.
There is also the weight of the see-saw itself, 200 N,
to consider, which also acts downwards, through its
midpoint. If these were the only forces acting, they
would make the see-saw accelerate downwards. Another
force acts to prevent this from happening. There is an
upward contact force where the see-saw sits on the pivot.
Figure 4.12 shows all five forces.
Now we have satisfied the two conditions that must be
met if an object is to be in equilibrium:
• there must be no resultant force acting on it
• total clockwise moment total anticlockwise
moment.
You can use these two rules to solve problems concerning
the forces acting on objects in equilibrium.
=
Sometimes we know that the forces and moments acting
on an object are balanced. Then we can say that it is in
equilibrium. Sometimes we know the reverse, namely, that
an object is in equilibrium. Then we can say that there is
no resultant force on it, and no resultant moment.
Questions
9
A uniform metre ruler is balanced at its centre
(Figure 4.13).
0.44 m
76 N
Figure 4.13: Balanced uniform metre ruler.
a
b
Figure 4.12: A force diagram for the see-saw shown in
Figure 4.10. The upward contact force of the pivot on the
see-saw balances the downward forces of the children's
weights and the weight of the see-saw itself. The contact
force has no moment about the pivot because it acts
through the pivot. The weight of the see-saw is another
force that acts through the pivot, so it also has no moment
about the pivot.
Because the see-saw is in equilibrium, we can calculate
this contact force. It must balance the four downward
forces, so its value is (500 + 200 + 400 + 300) N = 1 400 N,
upwards. This force has no turning effect because it acts
through the pivot. Its distance from the pivot is zero, so
its moment is zero.
Calculate the distance to the right of the pivot
that the 125 N load needs to be placed for the
ruler to be balanced.
Calculate the contact force acting at the pivot.
10 A beam is balanced on a pivot 0.33 metres from its
left-hand side (Figure 4.14).
The beam balances when a weight of 0.47 N is
suspended 0.13 metres from the same end.
Figure 4.14: Balanced beam.
a
b
c
Calculate the anticlockwise moment of the
0.47 N force.
What is the moment due to the weight of the rod?
The weight of the rod is 0.79 N. Calculate the
position of its centre of gravity to the right of
the pivot.
4 Turning effects of forces
l.'IMENTAL SKILLS 4.1
I A >v ition of balance
Method
fall
that do
• us need design
I Awwn when the forces them change location
।
structures
to
1 1
not
on
1
or
IhmiHltude (size). For example, a building needs
Bitty t .inding when wind blows against it with
I dlllt". '(it strengths or from different directions.
HKlduni should not bend or collapse when vehicles
ll m. You will test whether there is a resultant
Winn u nt on an object that is in equilibrium. You
Willi I the moment of a force and the principle of
1 1""
Set up the apparatus as shown in Figure 4.16
with the loops for the spring balances about
5 cm from each end of the ruler. You are going
to move the load to different positions along
the ruler. Make sure that the ruler is horizontal
before you take each measurement by moving
the clamps holding one of the spring balances
up or down its clamp-stand.
it', in this experiment.
S
will need:
LI
i metre ruler
spring
balance A
supported from
clamp stand
H distance A
two 10 N spring balances
spring
balance B ,.Q
supported from E
clamp stand
J
distance B
n
"1 of 100 g masses
two clamp-stands with clamps and
I h >sses
loop A
at the 5 cm
mark
three cotton loops
moveable
load of 9.8 N
loop B
at the 95 cm
mark
Figure 4.16: Apparatus for investigation.
Utoty Take care not to drop the masses on
Bur iMt.
1
" i ilnq started
•
2
Hang the 9.8 N from the ruler so that distance
A = 10 cm and distance B = 80 cm.
3
Note down the readings on both of the spring
balances, FA and FB, and calculate (FA + FB).
Record all the values in a copy of the table below:
A/l it is meant by equilibrium?
• Mi. is the
it
moment of a force?
• Wl it is the principle of moments?
would you expect the
of gravity
• Whore
I " for a
ruler?
5 shows a lorry about to be driven
• I ross a4.1bridge
supported by columns A and B.
।
centre
Distance
from A / m
fb/n
fa + fb/n
0.1
metre
t
fa/n
Igure
"
tribe the force at column A as the lorry travels
I " tween A and B and then beyond column B.
I
।
4
Move the load about 10 cm along the ruler
towards B. Make sure the ruler is horizontal and
then record all the measurements required to
complete the next row of the table.
5
Repeat this process until the load is at a
distance of 0.8 m from A.
6
On the same axes, plot line graphs of FA, FB
and Fa + Fb on the vertical axis against the
distance from A on the horizontal axis.
min A
it" 4.15: Lorry on a bridge.
r
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Questions
1
2
Why did you have to make sure that the ruler
was horizontal before each measurement was
made?
3
Measure the mass of the ruler and work out its
weight. Does this account for the difference in
the last question?
4
Instead of doing the experiment, it can be
solved mathematically by taking moments about
either spring balance. For example, the force at
spring balance A, FA, can be solved by taking
moments about B (and taking into account of
the ruler to get a more accurate result).
Calculate the mean of your (FA + FB) values.
This should be more than the load of 9.81 N
hanging from the ruler. Can you explain why?
ACTIVITY 4.2
Understanding the shadoof
The Ancient Egyptians used the shadoof to lift
water and irrigate the land. It is still in use today
(see Figure 4.17).
The shadoof has a counterweight at the short end
and a bucket at the long end of a beam. It takes as
much effort to move the bucket down as it does to
pull it up.
Unless your teacher gives you a time, spend
one minute thinking on your own, one minute of
discussion with your neighbour and then be prepared
to share your answers to question 1 with the class.
1
2
Figure 4.17: A Sudanese man irrigates his land using a
shadoof.
REFLECTION
Did you understand the physics in Activities 4.1
and 4.2? A good test of your understanding is
whether you can explain it clearly. Are you able to
support your explanations with clear and correct
force diagrams? If you are still unsure, ask a
classmate to explain it.
74
a
What is the advantage of making it take as
much effort to push the bucket down as it
does to pull it up?
b
Explain how the shadoof does this.
Draw a diagram of the shadoof and include the
pivot, the counterweight and the forces acting
on it. You could estimate the lengths of the
beam and assume that the counterweight has a
weight of 1 50 N.
If you are given time and the equipment, make a
working model.
4.3 Stability and centre
of gravity
People are tall and thin, like a pencil standing on end.
Unlike a pencil, we do not topple over when touched by
the slightest push. We are able to remain upright, and
to walk, because we make continual adjustments to the
positions of our limbs and body. We need considerable
brain power to control our muscles for this. The advantage
is that, with our eyes about a metre higher than if we were
on all-fours, we can see much more of the world.
4
.
« »«. ii ll t isles such as tightrope walkers and high-wire
MliU'll n'ure 4.18) have developed the skill of remaining
upi i>< hl Io a high degree. They use items such as poles or
.
.ibi to help them maintain their balance. The idea of
Hwiiih nt < an help us to understand why some objects are
(MW* hi Ie others are more likely to topple over.
|mi
Turning effects of forces
table. The line of the glass’s weight is to the left of this
pivot, so it has an anticlockwise moment, which tends to
tip the glass back to its upright position.
In Figure 4.19c, the glass is tipped further. Its weight acts
to the right of the pivot, and has a clockwise moment,
which makes the glass tip right over.
Centre of gravity
9l«W» 4 18: This high-wire artiste is using a long pole to
M*'1 an hor stability on the wire. If she senses that her
|l< r 1 I illghtly too far to the left, she can redress the
Ml* " by moving the pole to the right. Frequent, small
i its allow her to walk smoothly along the wire.
’ Im11 hiss can be knocked over easily - it is unstable.
1 1 1 "h I 19 shows what happens if the glass is tilted.
In Figure 4.19, the weight of the glass is represented by
an arrow starting at a point inside the liquid. Why is this?
The reason is that the glass behaves as if all of its mass
were concentrated at this point, known as the centre of
gravity. The force of gravity acts on the mass of the glass
- each bit of the glass is pulled by the Earth’s gravity.
However, rather than drawing lots of weight arrows, one
for each bit of the glass, it is simpler to draw a single
arrow acting through the centre of gravity. (Because we
can think of the weight of the glass acting at this point,
it is sometimes known as the centre of gravity.)
KEY WORDS
stable an object that is unlikely to topple over,
often because it has a low centre of gravity and a
wide base
unstable: an object that is likely to topple over,
often because it has a high centre of gravity and a
narrow base
centre of gravity: all the mass of an object could
be located here and the object would behave the
same (when ignoring any spin)
fiiiui" 4.19: A tall glass is easily toppled. Once the line of
0 ’its weight is beyond the edge of the base the glass
Mm n |hl over.
I
I nine 4.19a, the glass is upright. Its weight acts
4 N ii" i rds and the contact force of the table acts
mi'“ uds
The two forces are in line, and the glass is in
miiiilihnum.
||i I limit 4. 19b, the glass is tilted slightly to the right,
• n 1 1 he forces are no longer in line. There is a pivot at the
i" nl where the base of the glass is in contact with the
Figure 4.20 shows the position of the centre of gravity
for several objects. A person is fairly symmetrical, so
their centre of gravity must lie somewhere on the axis
of symmetry. (This is because half of their mass is on
one side of the axis, and half on the other.) The centre
of gravity is in the middle of the body, roughly level
with the navel. A ball is much more symmetrical, and its
centre of gravity is at its centre.
For an object to be stable, it should have a low centre of
gravity and a wide base. The pyramid in Figure 4.20 is an
example of this. The high-wire artiste shown in Figure
4. 1 8 has to adjust her position so that her centre of
gravity remains above her base, which is the point where
her feet make contact with the wire.
75
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Figure 4.20: The weight of an object acts through its centre of gravity. Symmetry can help to judge where the centre of
gravity lies. An object's weight can be considered to act through this point. Note that, for the table, its centre of gravity is in
the air below the table top.
Finding the centre of gravity
KEY WORD
Balancing is the clue to finding an object’s centre of
gravity. A metre ruler balances at its midpoint, so that is
where its centre of gravity must lie.
lamina: flat two-dimensional shape
The procedure for finding the centre of gravity of a more
irregularly shaped object is shown in Figure 4.21. In this
case, the object is a piece of card, described as a plane
lamina. The card is suspended from a pin. If it is free to
move, it hangs with its centre of gravity below the point
of suspension. This is because its weight pulls it round
until the weight and the contact force at the pin are lined
up. Then there is no moment about the pin. A plumb-line
is used to mark a vertical line below the pin. The centre
of gravity must lie on this line.
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 4.2
The process is repeated for two more pinholes. Now
there are three lines on the card, and the centre of
gravity must lie on all of them, that is, at the point where
they intersect. Two lines might have been enough, but
it is advisable to use at least three points to reveal any
inaccuracies.
Centre of gravity of a plane lamina
You will investigate a technique for finding the
centre of gravity of a piece of rectangular card.
Once you gain confidence that the technique works,
you will apply it to an irregular shape, perhaps the
map of your country. Locating the centre of gravity
of a body is important when considering its stability.
You will need:
•
•
•
•
at least two pieces of card
•
•
a ruler
•
•
Figure 4.21: Finding the centre of gravity of an irregularly
shaped piece of card. The card hangs freely from the pin.
The centre of gravity must lie on the line indicated by the
plumb-line hanging from the pin. Three lines are enough to
find the centre of gravity.
76
a hole punch
a pencil
a pair of scissors
a clamp stand and boss
a pin (or short thin metal rod)
a length of string with a weight (plumb
bob) attached.
Safety: The pin and the scissors should be
handled with care to avoid cutting someone. Wear
eye protection if using a pin (as opposed to a thin
metal rod). Ensure that the pin is not at eye height
and is pointing away from the edge of the bench.
4
Turning effects of forces
PEER ASSESSMENT
l UHIng started
»
I n .diet where the centre of gravity is located
on the rectangular lamina.
diet where the centre of gravity is located
• I the
shape you propose.
।
in
•
( .in
you suggest shapes where the centre of
• pivity would not be on the card?
Method: Part 1
I H 1. 1 th< centre of gravity of a rectangular sheet of
I I his is your lamina.
the hole punch to make three holes far
>| >nrt around the edge of the lamina.
/ I l the pin horizontally in the clamp.
1 Using one hole, hang the lamina from the
pin.
M<ike sure that it can swing freely.
4 I Ling the string from the pin so that the weight
m.lkes it hang vertically. Mark two points on the
l imina along the length of the string.
K< ipeat steps 3 and 4 using the other two holes.
A I uy the lamina on the bench and, using a
ruler, draw lines joining each pair of points.
Where the lines cross is the centre of gravity
4 the lamina. It should be where the lines of
symmetry coincide but, if the three lines cross
• <actly at a point, you have done well!
i <i
I If.,
Method: Part 2
i pt .it part 1 after you have cut a shape out of the
Lunin,i. See if you can get a map of your country
I HIntod on the card so that you can find its centre
til gravity.
< nmitions
I I )id the three lines you drew intersect at the
point?
If the three lines did not intersect at the same
point, how did you decide where the centre of
pavity is located?
t If the three lines did not intersect at the same
point, how much confidence do you have in
the location you have chosen?
'4 ' .uggest a way of checking that you have
located (found) the centre of gravity?
'. I xplain why the centre of gravity of the lamina
Iles on a vertical line below the pin (pivot).
Swap your work with a partner for Experimental
skills 4.2.
Give them a smiley face for the following:
•
three neatly drawn and closely intersecting
lines on their rectangular lamina (as this
shows careful experimental technique)
• three closely intersecting lines on their
irregular shape
• correct answer to the Getting Started
questions
• a clear and correct explanation of why the
centre of gravity is vertically below the pivot.
Finally, discuss anything that you can learn from
each other.
Questions
11 On a copy of the shapes below, mark the centre of
gravity for each with an X. Where possible, show lines
that helped you locate the centre of gravity.
Figure 4.22: Laminar shapes.
1 2 Buses and other vehicles have to be tilt-tested to an
angle of at least 28 degrees from the vertical before
they can carry passengers.
bus A
bus B
.'
Figure 4.23: Both of these double-decker buses would
topple over if tilted any further.
rr
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
a
b
c
Use the ideas of stability and centre of gravity
to explain why either bus in Figure 4.23 would
topple over if tilted any further. You can draw
on copies of the diagrams to help with your
explanation.
Explain how the stability of the bus would
be affected by having more passengers on the
upper deck.
Explain why bags of sand are only put on the
top deck of bus B and not the lower deck.
1 3 Figure 4.24 shows the forces acting on a cyclist.
a
Explain how you can tell that the cyclist shown
in Figure 4.24a is in equilibrium.
b Are the forces on the cyclist in Figure 4.24b
balanced now? How can you tell?
c Would you describe the cyclist as stable or
unstable? Explain your answer.
Figure 4.24: Forces acting on a cyclist.
PROJECT
The Italian Job
The Italian Job was a film made in 1969. In this
film a gang steals gold worth $4 million in Turin,
northern Italy. As the gang escapes through
Switzerland on a bus, the driver loses control. The
bus ends up with its rear half hanging over the
edge of a vertical drop. Any attempt to reach the
gold at the back of the coach risks sending the
bus, the men and the gold crashing into the valley
below. The film finishes with Croker saying: 'Hang
on a minute lads, I've got a great idea'. The film is
available online but only the last five minutes are
important from a physics viewpoint.
You need to suggest what Croker's 'great idea'
might have been to save the gold and get off the
coach safely. You should work in groups of three.
Start by describing the problem using
correct scientific terms like 'pivot',
'centre of gravity', 'equilibrium',
'moment' and 'the principle of moments'.
Make a storyboard of your solution and
include it as part of a two-minute pitch
for a sequel to the film.
Select the best pitch (with correct or
corrected physics) from three or four
groups of three to present to the rest of
the class.
4 Turning effects of forces
IARY
moment of a force is a measure of its turning effect.
force or distance from the pivot increases the moment of a force.
mm ill of a force = force x perpendicular distance from the pivot.
I n I |<i t is in equilibrium when the forces on it are balanced (no resultant force) and the turning effects of the
Uh** on it are balanced (no resultant turning effect).
In
nl i
of gravity is the point at which the weight of an object appears to be concentrated.
In* lot it ion of the centre of gravity affects stability.
79
>
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
80
>
4 Turning effects of forces
ONTINUED
two ways that the turning force can be increased.
[2]
State two pieces of evidence that would tell you that a body is not in
equilibrium.
[2]
I he diagram shows an angle-poise lamp. The light is at the end of an arm.
I he arm can be moved about the pivot. The cord passes vertically down to a
st retched spring.
I he weight of the lamp and arm is 3.75 N and acts at a distance of 25 cm
1 1 om the pivot.
pivot
25 cm
3.75 N
pivot
3.75 N
pivot
«— pivot
COMMAND WORDS
spring
•i
I
<
Write down the equation used to calculate the moment of a force.
[1 ]
alculate the moment of the 3.75 N force about the pivot when the
arm is horizontal.
[2]
The arm is raised as shown in the diagram.
i Explain what has happened to the moment of the 3.75 N force
about the pivot.
ii Explain what has happened to the clockwise moment produced by
the spring.
[1 ]
[1 ]
[Total: 5]
state: command
term not supplied
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
8 The diagrams show a windsurfer pulling up the sail of a sailboard. The sail
pivots where it joins with the board at point P.
a As the sail is pulled up from A to C, how does the force needed
The windsurfer and the sailboard shown in the diagram below are in
equilibrium.
The windsurfer weighs 900 N. The wind is blowing with a force of 300 N.
The windsurfer maintains equilibrium.
c Calculate how far to the right of the pivot the windsurfer has to move
his centre of gravity.
d What would the windsurfer need to do if the force of the
wind decreased? Explain your answer.
[2]
[2]
[Total: 7]
82
>
4
Turning effects of forces
I F-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
tudying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
i
ips in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
iive everyday examples of a turning force.
4.1
1 hiderstand that increasing force or distance from the
pivot increases the moment of a force.
4.1
(
< .ilculate the moment using the product force x
pi tpendicular distance from the pivot.
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
4.2
Apply the principle of moments to balancing a beam.
4.2
Apply the principle of moments to different
filiations, including when there is more than one
moment on either side of the pivot.
4.2
1' '1 form an experiment to find the centre of gravity
o| a piece of card.
4.3
1 scribe how the location of the centre gravity
''
ilkicts stability.
4.3
•
> Chapter 5
Forces and
matter
*
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
recognise that a force may change the size and shape of a body
plot and interpret load-extension graphs and describe the associated experimental procedure
p
relate pressure to force and area and recall the associated equation p = —
71
relate the pressure beneath a liquid surface to depth and to density
>
\
p
recall and use the expression k = —, where k is the spring constant and F is force per unit extension
recognise the significance of the 'limit of proportionality' for an load-extension graph
recall and use the equation ^p = pgkh.
5 Forces and matter
I FING STARTED
I njure 5.1 shows a pop-up popper toy. Figure 5.1a
hows the popper in its natural state and Figure 5.1b
hows it when it is turned inside out. Once turned
inside out, a popper can jump several metres into
the air. Using your knowledge of physics, explain
how this can happen.
I ujure 5.1 a: Rubber pop-up popper in its normal state, b: When it has been turned inside out, just before springing back
•• » It normal shape.
OW THE MANTIS SHRIMP PUNCHES ABOVE ITS WEIGHT
I ii jure 5.2 shows a mantis shrimp. This marine
• n iture can punch its prey (usually crabs) with a
I in of more than 700 N, over a thousand times its
' iwn bodyweight. It has hinged clubs at the front
'I its body called dactyls. They can reach speeds
il ’3m/s in less than three milliseconds, more than
Zhi) times the acceleration due to gravity. It achieves
ilil' by storing elastic potential energy in a part of its
•xoukeleton that is shaped like a saddle. This piece
'1 oxoskeleton behaves like a compressed spring or
flu rubber popper shown in Figure 5.1. Turning the
।" i| >per inside out changes its shape. The shrimp
IM", its muscles to change the shape of part of
H oxoskeleton by transferring chemical potential
norgy into elastic potential energy. Humans achieve
lh« same thing with a crossbow. Once enough
i">rgy has been stored, a latch can release it.
I <l4cussion questions
1
What weapons have humans developed that acts in the same way as the shrimp's dactyl?
Can you think of other applications?
i
Could a 50g mantis shrimp injure you? A punch from a mantis shrimp exerts the same force as the
weight of a typical adult.
85
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
5.1 Forces acting
on solids
Forces can change the size and shape of an object. They
can stretch, squash, bend or twist it. Figure 5.3 shows
the forces needed for these different ways of deforming
an object. You could imagine holding a cylinder of foam
rubber, which is easy to deform, and changing its shape
in each of these ways.
undeformed
(tensile forces)
(bending forces)
(compressive forces)
(torsional forces)
Figure 5.4a: This X-ray image shows how a football is
compressed when it is kicked. It returns to its original shape
as it leaves the player's boot. (This is an example of an elastic
deformation.) The boot is also compressed slightly but, because
it is stiffer than the ball, the effect is less noticeable, b: When
the bungee cord reaches its maximum extension, it will return tc
its original length, pulling the bungee jumper upwards.
Some materials are less springy. They become
permanently deformed when forces act on them.
•
When two cars collide, the metal panels of their
bodywork are bent.
•
Gold and silver are metals that can be deformed
by hammering them (see Figure 5.5). People have
known for thousands of years how to shape rings
and other ornaments from these precious metals.
Figure 5.3: Forces can change the size and shape of a
solid object. These diagrams show four different ways of
deforming a solid object.
Foam rubber is good for investigating how things
deform, because, when the forces are removed, it springs
back to its original shape. Here are two more examples
of materials that deform in this way:
Firstly, when a football is kicked, it is compressed for a
short while (see Figure 5.4a). Then it springs back to its
original shape as it pushes itself off the foot of the player
who has kicked it. The same is true for a tennis ball when
struck by a racket.
Secondly, bungee jumpers rely on the springiness of the
rubber rope, which breaks their fall when they jump
from a height (see Figure 5.4b). If the rope became
permanently stretched, they would stop suddenly at the
bottom of their fall, rather than bouncing up and down
and gradually coming to a halt.
86
y
Figure 5.5: A Tibetan silversmith making a wrist band. Silver
is a relatively soft metal at room temperature, so it can be
hammered into shape without the need for heating.
5.2 Stretching springs
To investigate how objects deform, it is simplest to start
with a spring. Springs are designed to stretch a long way
when a small force is applied, so it is easy to measure
how their length changes.
5 Forces and matter
n 5.6 shows how to carry out an investigation on
lung a spring. The spring is hung from a rigid clamp,
ih H its top end is fixed. Weights are hung on the end of
pi mg - these are referred to as the load. As the load is
n i ;d, the spring stretches and its length increases.
Extension of a spring
As the force stretching the spring increases, the spring gets
longer. It is important to consider the increase in length of
the spring. This quantity is known as the extension.
length of stretched spring = original length + extension
This means that, if you double the load that is stretching
a spring, the spring will not become twice as long. It is
the extension that is doubled.
KEY WORD
extension: the increased length of an object (for
example, a spring) when a load (for example,
weight) is attached to it
Table 5. 1 shows how to use a table with three columns to
record the results of an experiment to stretch a spring.
The third column is used to record the value of the
extension, which is calculated by subtracting the original
length from the value in the second column.
ii
• 5.6: Investigating the stretching of a spring.
WORD
Itad; the force (usually weight) stretches an object
i.i spring)
I u uh ''.7 shows the pattern observed as the load is
lined in regular steps. The length of the spring
i i es (also in regular steps). At this stage the spring
I il ium to its original length if the load is removed.
McIver, if the load is increased too far, the spring
i mu permanently stretched and will not return to its
length. It has been inelastically deformed.
Ci
।
M^iiim 5.7: Stretching a spring. At first, the spring deforms
•h’b. ,|||y. It will return to its original length when the load is
.
Bn,, n J Eventually, however, the load is so great that the
•i
p
. damaged.
To see how the extension depends on the load, we draw
a load-extension graph (Figure 5.8). You can see that the
graph is in two parts.
•
At first, the graph slopes up steadily. This shows that the
extension increases in equal steps as the load increases.
•
Then the graph curves. This happens when the load
is so great that the spring has become permanently
damaged. It will not return to its original length.
You can see the same features in Table 5.1. Look at the
third column. At first, the numbers go up in equal steps.
The last two steps are bigger.
Load/N
Length /cm
Extension /cm
0.0
24.0
0.0
1.0
24.6
0.6
2.0
25.2
1.2
3.0
25.8
1.8
4.0
26.4
2.4
5.0
27.0
3.0
6.0
27.6
3.6
7.0
28.6
4.6
8.0
29.5
5.6
Table 5.1: Results from an experiment to find out how a
spring stretches as the load on it is increased.
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
5.3 The limit of
proportionality and the
spring constant
The mathematical pattern of the stretching spring was
first described by the British scientist Robert Hooke. He
realised that, when the load on the spring was doubled,
the extension also doubled. Three times the load gave
three times the extension, and so on. This is shown in tl
graph in Figure 5.9. The graph shows how the extensior
depends on the load. At first, the graph is a straight line
leading up from the origin. This shows that the extensio
is proportional to the load.
Figure 5.8: A load-extension graph for a spring, based on
the data in Table 5.1.
Questions
1
2
A piece of elastic cord is 75 cm long. When it is
stretched, its length increases to 97 cm. What is
its extension?
Table 5.2 shows the results of an experiment to
stretch an elastic cord. Copy and complete the table,
and draw a graph to represent this data (with load
on the vertical axis).
Load / N
0
Length /cm
75
2
81
4
87
6
93
8
99
10
105
12
14
16
118
Table 5.2
88
y
135
156
At a certain point, the graph curves and the line
slopes up less steeply. This point is called the limit of
proportionality. If the spring is stretched beyond this
point, it will be permanently damaged. If the load is
removed, the spring will not return all the way to its
original, undeformed length.
KEY WORDS
limit of proportionality: up to this limit, the
extension on a spring is proportional to load
Extension /cm
0
Figure 5.9a: A load-extension graph for a spring. Beyond
the limit of proportionality, the graph is no longer a straight
line, and the spring is permanently deformed, b: This
graph shows what happens when the load is removed. The
extension does not return to zero, showing that the spring
now longer than at the start of the experiment.
5 Forces and matter
•PE RIMENTAL SKILLS 5.1
In Mitigating springs
Method
itning how different materials behave when a
Is applied to them is very important if they
in med to make something. The hull of the RMS
III ink was composed of mild steel plates held
।
" r ther by 3 million rivets. When the ship struck an
4 " irg in 1912 the force broke some of these rivets
' I this contributed to the ship sinking.
I
i
p i
1
"I will investigate how the extension of the spring
1 mges as the load is increased and whether the
•h'Dsion on the spring is proportional to the load.
1
Y< 'U will need:
• • eye protection
I• clamp stand, boss and clamp
I• spring
f • hanger with slotted masses
• G-clamp
• ruler
I• plumb line (a piece of thread with a lump of
metal on the end).
Figure 5.10: Apparatus for investigation.
You need to wear eye protection because
a
danger that the spring will fly into
is
Ihrn
i.
tone's
eye if it breaks under tension. Place a
K
on the floor beneath the masses so that, if the
•pi Ing snaps, the masses will not damage the floor.
Avijld standing on the mat because the masses may
fond on your feet if the spring snaps.
2
Arrange the ruler with zero at the top. This
means that, as the steel spring stretches, the
readings on the ruler increase.
3
Use the headings below to draw a results table.
Remember to add more rows.
",
i
lotting started
1
I xplain the purpose of:
a
the G-clamp
b
the plumb line.
Does the spring
Load on Ruler
Spring
return to original
hanger/ reading/ extension/
length when
cm
N
cm
unloaded? Y/N
'
I ach slotted weight is 100 g. Calculate what
load this represents.
4
Attach your hanger to the bottom of the spring
so that the spring hangs vertically.
1
Identify the independent (input) and dependent
(output) variables.
5
Record the load as zero and record the reading
on the ruler where it lines up with the bottom of
the hanger.
89
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
6
7
8
9
Add a slotted 100 g mass (equal to a load of
1.0 N) and record the new ruler reading where it
lines up with the bottom of the hanger.
Remove the mass and record whether the steel
spring returns to its original length.
Repeat steps 6 and 7, adding another 100 g
mass each time until you have filled the table or
the spring breaks.
Remember, the extension is the difference
between the length of the spring with the load
attached and the original length when just the
hanger was attached. To calculate the spring
extension, subtract your ruler reading for a
load of 0 N from all of your ruler readings. This
means that the spring extension should be zero
(0 cm) when the load is zero (0 N).
10 Plot a graph of load against extension (that is,
extension on the horizontal axis). Include a title,
axis labels and a line of best fit.
Questions
1
2
3
4
Did your graph pass through the origin? If not,
did you remember to correct for the original
length of the spring?
How can you identify where on the graph the
force on the steel spring is proportional to the
load? What is the name of the point where this
no longer happens to the spring and can you
locate it on your graph?
What are the values for the load and extension
corresponding to the limit of proportionality for
your spring?
Did the spring continue returning to its original
length beyond the limit of proportionality?
ACTIVITY 5.1
front cover
Elastic glass
Glass is brittle. It shatters once it reaches its limit of
proportionality.
So, why can glass fibres (used in optic fibres and
loft insulation) bend so easily without shattering? In
this activity you will explain why you can bend glass
fibres into a circle but a glass block will shatter if you
try to bend it.
First, think about how you would approach this
problem without the guidance that follows; make
some notes of your ideas.
When you bend an object (such as a pencil eraser),
one surface stretches and the opposite surface
compresses (gets shorter). Take your textbook and
measure the width of the bottom edge. It should
be about 21 cm. Now bend it into the shape of an
arch with the spine on the left-hand side as shown in
Figure 5.11.
back cover
book
spine
This would be the
difference in length
between the front
and back covers if
the book was a solid
block of paper.
Figure 5.1 1: A textbook bent out of shape.
You will see the book spine on the left-hand side is at
right angles to both the front and back covers. The
pages slide past each other so that the length of all
the pages and the book covers have not changed.
A solid block of paper (such as a stack of paper in its
wrapper) is difficult to bend but, if you could bend it,
the top surface would stretch and the bottom surface
would compress and the right-hand edge would
be at right-angles to the top and bottom surface as
shown by the dotted red line to the right of the book.
The little triangle of paper to the right of the dotted
line would not be present. In this example, it would
90
y
5
Forces and matter
»NTINUED
b lit in an approximate difference of about 2 cm in
Iwiqth between the top and bottom surfaces. Half
1 1his difference would be because the top surface
iii' iched and the other half would be because the
j^ltom surface compressed.
I
Either take measurements from Figure 5.11
or try the experiment yourself (in pairs). One
person can hold and bend the book while the
Other person uses a set square to find where the
dashed red line should be (no need to mark the
book though). Use a ruler to measure the length
indicated by the red double-headed arrow.
The extension (or compression) is half the length
of the double-headed arrow.
1 1 |ineers calculate strain, which is the extension
li ided by the original length. For the book in the
I" lure this will be roughly 1 cm divided by 21 cm
| ( 1 05 or 5%). Engineers have also worked out that
ll«rent materials have different breaking strains.
A • il.iss fibre has a breaking strain of about 2%.
lit hcliaviour of the spring is represented by the graph
} 1 Igurc 5.10a and can be described as:
In intension of a spring is proportional to the load
i rli 'd to it, provided the limit of proportionality is
v needed.
liii in nlso known as Hooke's law. We can write the
MWiour of a spring as an equation:
!•A
The breaking strain of ordinary glass is much lower
than this, probably because it has microscopic (tiny)
imperfections where stress tends to concentrate.
3 Would glass as thick as your book shatter if bent
through the angle shown in Figure 5.11?
4 Calculate the extension (or compression) for an
individual page. You learned how to work out
the thickness of a single page in Chapter 1. How
does extension vary with the thickness of the
object that is being bent out of shape?
5 Would glass as thick as a page in your book shatter
if bent through the angle shown in Figure 5.11?
Other things to think about
1
2
What is the relationship between the length of
the double-headed arrow and the thickness of
the book?
What is the relationship between the length of
the double-headed arrow and how much the
book is bent?
load is plotted against extension (i.e. with extension on
the horizontal axis).
KEY WORDS
spring constant: the constant of proportionality,
the measure of the stiffness of a spring
WORKED EXAMPLE 5.1
।
'lit।equation, Fis the load (force) stretching the
Mg, k is the spring constant of the spring, and x is the
l« inion of the spring. The spring constant is defined
i ihr force per unit of extension, which is obvious when
law is expressed in terms of k:
।
A spring has a spring constant k = 20 N/cm. What
load is needed to produce an extension of 2.5 cm?
Step 1: Write down what you know and what you
want to find out.
=
spring constant k 20 N/cm,
extension = 2.5 cm
load F = ?
i
Step 2: Write down the equation linking these
quantities, substitute values and calculate
the result.
F=kx
F= 20 N/cm x 2.5 cm = 50 N
I’" spring constant is a measure of the ‘stiffness’ of the
Bumr
(he stiffer the spring, the bigger the load required
Bl IniDgc its length and the steeper the gradient when
Answer
A load of 50 N will stretch the spring by 2.5 cm.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
How rubber behaves
A rubber band can be stretched in a similar way to
a spring. As with a spring, the bigger the load, the
bigger the extension. However, if the weights are added
with great care, and then removed one by one without
releasing the tension in the rubber, the following can
be observed.
•
The graph obtained is not a straight line. Rather, it
has a slightly S-shaped curve. This shows that the
extension is not exactly proportional to the load.
•
Eventually, increasing the load no longer produces
any extension. The rubber feels very stiff. When
the load is removed, the graph does not come back
exactly to zero.
Hooke and springs
Why was Robert Hooke so interested in springs? Hooke
was a scientist, but he was also a great inventor. He was
interested in springs for two reasons.
• Springs are useful for making weighing machines,
and Hooke wanted to make a weighing machine
that was both very sensitive (to weigh very light
objects) and very accurate (to measure very precise
quantities).
• He also realised that a spiral spring could be used to
control a clock or even a wristwatch.
Figure 5.12 shows a set of diagrams drawn by Hooke,
including a long spring and a spiral spring, complete
with pans for carrying weights. You can also see some of
his graphs.
For scientists, it is important to publish results so that
other scientists can make use of them. Hooke was very
secretive about some of his findings, because he did not
want other people to use them in their own inventions.
For this reason, he published some of his findings in
code. For example, instead of writing his law of springs
as given above, he wrote: ceiiinosssttuv. Later, when he
felt that it was safe to publish his ideas, he revealed that
this was an anagram of a sentence in Latin. Decoded,
it said: Ut tensio, sic vis. In English, this is: As the
extension increases, so does the force.’ In other words,
the extension is proportional to the force producing it.
You can see Hooke’s straight-line graph in Figure 5.12.
Questions
3
4
5
A spring requires a load of 7.5 N to increase its
length by 5.0cm. What load will give it an extension
of 12 cm?
A spring has an unstretched length of 13.0 cm. Its
spring constant, k is 7.0 N/cm. What load is needed
to stretch the spring to a length of 18.0 cm?
The results of an experiment to stretch a spring are
shown in Table 5.3. Use the results to plot a
load extension graph. On your graph, mark the
limit of proportionality and state the value of the
load at that point.
Load / N
Length /m
0.0
1.396
2.6
1.422
5.3
1.448
7.9
1.475
10.6
1.501
13.2
1.536
15.9
1.579
Table 5.3
REFLECTION
Think back to Activity 5.1. This was an example of
a thought experiment. Great scientists like Albert
Einstein have used this approach to make huge
progress in science.
Figure 5.12: Robert Hooke's diagrams of springs.
92
5 Forces and matter
ONTINUED
I ' I you need the guidance? If so, was it helpful?
When bending an object, you compress it on the
III Ie that gets shorter and stretch (or extend) it on
flu' other side.
ould you imagine what was happening? When
ytuj roll one sheet of paper into a cylinder, the
'i 'de circumference and outside circumference
Hi' nearly the same length: there has been very
Illi stretching (extension) or compression. This
I* the same as the glass fibre. Can you see that,
. making the paper very much thicker, the
iillorence in length between the inner and outer
। i»i umferences would get bigger and so would the
••!<msion and compression? Glass is quite brittle
" ' i retching it too much will make it shatter.
1 in you think of ways of developing this thinking
ill .ind practising it in the next two activities in
flu ( hapter and beyond?
1
1
.
•
This pressure comes about because any object under
water is being pressed down on by the weight of water
above it. The deeper you go, the greater the amount
of water pressing down on you (see Figure 5.14a).
In a similar way, the atmosphere exerts pressure
on us, although we are not normally conscious of
this. The Earth’s gravity pulls it downwards, so that
the atmosphere presses downwards on our heads.
Mountaineers climbing to the top of Mount Everest rise
through two-thirds of the atmosphere, so the pressure is
only about one-third of the pressure down at sea level.
There is much less air above them, pressing down.
The pressure caused by water is much greater than that
caused by air because water is much denser than air.
Figure 5.14b shows how a dam is designed to withstand
the pressure of the water behind it. Because the pressure
is greatest at the greatest depth, the dam must be made
thickest at its base.
In a fluid such as water or air, pressure does not simply act
downwards - it acts equally in all directions. This is because
the molecules of the fluid move around in all directions,
causing pressure on every surface they collide with.
5.4 Pressure
N >mi dive into a swimming pool, you will experience the
I* me of the water on you. It provides the upthrust,
•In li pushes you back to the surface. The deeper you go,
Ik it .iter the pressure acting on you. Submarines and
।
iiir exploring vehicles (Figure 5.13) must be designed to
'I' Lind very great pressures. They have curved surfaces,
•tin li Mre much stronger under pressure, and they are made
I Im k inetal.
in
।
hi-
5,13: This underwater exploring vehicle is used to
♦•iii
it Pits to depths of 600 metres, where the pressure is 61
1 1 it .it the surface. The design makes use of the fact that
m "i >il nd cylindrical surfaces stand up well to pressure. The
' I window is made of acrylic plastic and is 9.5 cm thick.
Figure 5.14a: Pressure is caused by the weight of water (or
other fluid) above an object, b: This dam is thickest near its
base, because that is where the pressure is greatest.
93
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 5.2
Drinking through straws and breathing
through snorkels
1 When you drink through a straw, are
you pulling the liquid up the straw or is
atmospheric pressure pushing the liquid up
the straw? Try to explain what is going on.
2 Try this with family or friends. Drink through
two straws, with the end of one straw below
the surface of the liquid and the end of the
other straw above the liquid surface. Explain
why you or your friends fail to draw up any
liquid through either straw.
3 We can modify (bend) a straw and use it to
breathe underwater. Figure 5.15a shows
someone using a snorkel. Normally, snorkelers
hold their breath and dive to explore deeper
under water. But could someone just breathe
from a longer snorkel? Is there a practical
limit to the length that a snorkel can be or the
depth you can breathe from one? If so, try to
explain why.
4 An elephant can swim under water and use
its trunk as a snorkel (Figure 5.15b). Use the
Internet to research how an elephant can
breathe when deeper in the water than we can
and present your work on an A4 or A3 poster.
Now let us consider the unit of pressure. If force, F, is
measured in newtons (N) and area, A, is in square metre;
(m2), then pressure, p, is in newtons per square metre
(N/m2). In the SI system of units, this is given the name
pascal (Pa). It is equivalent to one newton per square
metre (1 N/m2).
KEY WORDS
pressure: the force acting per unit area at right
angles to a surface
pascal: the SI unit of pressure, equivalent to one
newton per square metre; 1 Pa = 1 N/m2 = 1 Pa
WORKED EXAMPLE 5.2
Stiletto heels have a very small surface area. (‘Stiletto’
is an Italian word meaning a small and murderous
dagger.) Such narrow heels can damage floors, and
dance halls often have notices requiring shoes with
such heels to be removed.
Calculate the pressure exerted by a dancer weighing
600 N standing on a single heel of area 1 cm2. The
surface of the dance floor is broken by pressures over
5 million pascals (5.0 MPa). Will it be damaged by
the dancer?
Step 1: To calculate the pressure, we need to know the
force, and the area on which the force acts, in m2.
force F = 600 N
area A = 1 cm2 = 0.0001 m2 = 10-4m2
Figure 5.1 5a: A snorkeler. b: Elephants can use their
trunks as snorkels to help them breathe and can swim
deeper than humans.
_ 600 N
5.5 Calculating pressure
A large force pressing on a small area gives a high
pressure. We can think of pressure as the force per unit
area acting on a surface, and we can write an equation
for pressure, as shown:
force
F
=
94
>
Step 2: Now we can calculate the pressure p.
P-~.
0.0001 m2
= 6 000 000 Pa
= 6.0 MPa
Answer
The pressure is 6.0 x 106Pa, or 6.0 MPa. This is more
than the minimum pressure needed to break the
surface of the floor, so it will be damaged.
5
Questions
Write down an equation that defines pressure.
What is the SI unit of pressure?
Which exerts a greater pressure, a force of 200 N
acting on 1.0 m2, or the same force acting on 2.0 m2?
What pressure is exerted by a force of 50 000 N
acting on 2.5 m2?
ID A swimming pool has a level, horizontal, bottom.
Its dimensions are 25.0m by 5.0m. The pressure
of the water on the bottom is 15 000 Pa. What total
force does the water exert on the bottom of the
pool? What is the weight of water?
1 1 An elephant has a mass of 5000 kg. The area of an
elephant’s foot is 0.13 m3.
A woman has a mass of 60 kg. The area of her
si iletto heel is 25mm2.
State the equation linking weight, mass and g.
Use the equation to calculate the weights of the
elephant and the woman.
b State the equation that links (solid) pressure,
force and area.
c Calculate the pressures exerted by the elephant
and woman. (Hint: Remember that weight is a
force and that you need to convert the area of
the stiletto heel into m2.)
d Use the pressure values you calculated to
suggest why the women might cause more
damage to a floor than an elephant.
Forces and matter
ACTIVITY 5.3
Atmospheric stopper
Fill a container, such as a bottle or beaker, with
water to the brim (top).
Place a piece of stiff card on top of the bottle or
beaker so that it more than covers the opening
(in other words, it is wider than the opening). You
could use a table tennis ball instead of card, if the
bottle has a very narrow neck.
Ensure that you do the next step over a sink. While
holding the card firmly to the top of the container,
turn the container upside down and slowly remove
your hand from the card. The water should stay in
the container.
Explain why this happens. Think about what forces
are acting on the card. What is the tallest column
of water you could use before the 'trick' no longer
works?
REFLECTION
The activities in this chapter asked you to imagine
what is happening. It can be helpful for scientists
to visualise (imagine something in their mind).
Can you think of ways that you can develop your
scientific imagination?
Pressure, depth and density
Wr have seen that the deeper one dives into water, the
the pressure. Pressure p is proportional to depth
I we use the letter h, for height). Twice the depth means
bee the pressure. Pressure also depends on the density
i' nl the material (where p is the Greek letter rho). If you
Ike into mercury, which is more than ten times as dense
•» water, the pressure will be more than ten times as great.
Hi i in write an equation for the change in pressure at a
drplh A in a fluid of density p:
I aige in pressure = density x acceleration due to
gravity x depth
Np = pg^h
Fuller
I Y EQUATION
hange in pressure = density x acceleration due to
gravity x depth
Ap = pg^h
WORKED EXAMPLE 5.3
Calculate the pressure on the bottom of a swimming
pool that is 2.5 metres deep. How does the pressure
compare with atmospheric pressure, 105Pa
(100 000 Pa)? The density of water = 1000 kg/m3.
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what you
want to know.
hh = 2.5 m
p 1000 kg/m3
g 10 N/kg
^p
=
=
=^
Step 2: Write down the equation for pressure,
substitute values and calculate the answer.
Ap pg^h 1000 kg/m3 x lON/kg x 2.5 m
=
=
= 2.5 x 104Pa
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
a
CONTINUED
b
Answer
This is one-quarter of atmospheric pressure. We live
at the bottom of the atmosphere. There is about
10 km of air above us, pressing downwards on us that is the origin of atmospheric pressure.
c
d
Questions
12 The density of water is 1000 kg/m3. Calculate the
pressure due to the water on a diver when he is
25 metres under the surface.
13 Figure 5.16 shows a tank that is filled with oil.
The density of the oil is 920 kg/m3.
Calculate the volume of the tank.
Calculate the weight of the oil in the tank.
The pressure on the bottom of the tank is
caused by the weight of the oil. Calculate the
pressure using:
Now calculate the pressure using:
hp = pg^h
Do you find the same answer as in part c?
14 Atmospheric pressure is 100 000 Pa. The roof of
a building has an area of 50 m2.
a What force does the atmosphere exert down
on the roof?
b Explain why the roof does not collapse.
c What would happen to the roof if it were
possible to remove all of the air from inside
the building? Explain your answer.
1 5 Calculate the depth of the pool in question 1 0.
Assume the density of water = 1000 kg/m3 and
g = lON/kg.
Figure 5.16: A tank filled with oil.
PROJECT
Under pressure
2
Describe a situation in which pressure is
deliberately increased (by increasing the force or
reducing the area).
3
Describe a situation in which pressure is
deliberately reduced (by increasing the area).
4
Choose one of the following:
• Explain why the collapsing can experiment
works using the first pressure equation you
met in this chapter. Unless this has been
demonstrated in class, you might need to
search for it on the Internet.
• Explain why pressure increases with
increasing depth in a fluid and therefore
why a dam must be made thicker (or wider)
in cross-section with increasing depth.
how a hydraulic braking system in
Explain
•
a car works. It is important to emphasise
that pressure in a fluid does not simply
push down from above. It pushes from all
directions.
Develop a resource about pressure for a future
IGCSE class.
How to present your work
Choose the medium you think is most suitable
for your work (such as a PowerPoint presentation
or podcast).
As far as possible, produce your own informative
drawings, photographs or video clips (which should
last for less than one minute).
List all the sources of your information (websites,
books, television documentaries, and so on) with
enough details for other people to find the sources.
What you need to include
1
96
Introduce each of the two equations you have
met in this chapter at the appropriate point in
your resource and, for each equation, include an
example question with its solution.
>
5 Forces and matter
I
uu i can change the size and shape of an object.
I \ n object (for example, a spring) will stretch when a load is attached to it.
u Iculate the extension of a spring for a given load, its original length must be subtracted from its new length.
H l
I -Ik ti hing a spring beyond its limit of proportionality permanently deforms it and it will not return to its
I 'i binal size and shape.
I 11« extension on a spring is proportional to the load applied to the spring until the spring reaches the limit of
1' 'itionality.
id -extension graph, the extension on a spring is proportional to the load applied to the spring where the
iraight.
> i l<
ii i
curve at the limit of proportionality; beyond this point, the extension on a spring is not
lional to the load applied to the spring.
i i ph starts to
i>
i
l
I i mg constant is defined as the force per unit extension, k
1 1.
1» .1
—
= F.
I i ; er the spring constant, the more difficult it is to stretch the spring. We say that the object is stiffer.
. returns to its original size and shape unless the load is increased after it has stopped stretching.
i
I'lV1 Hi' is the force (for example, weight) per unit area (perpendicular to the surface).
I'lr
ii
i
hi !■
in a fluid (liquid or gas) is caused by the weight of fluid above it.
iiu c the pressure is greatest at the greatest depth, a dam is thickest at its base.
dire in a fluid, it is more usual to use the equation change in pressure
i
depth, hp = pghh.
= density x gravitational field
M STYLE QUESTIONS
I
t the graph . Which material is the stiffest?
[1 ]
Extension / cm
97
>
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
COMMAND WORDS
state: express in
clear terms
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations
where there are
a range of valid
responses in order
to make proposals /
put forward
considerations
98
5 Forces and matter
1 1 INUED
unwater that lands on the roof of a building can be collected (harvested)
In ecling the rain from the gutters into water butts (sometimes called rain
1 1 els or rainwater tanks).
diagram shows two containers that store rainwater. The containers have
A pipe joins the taps. The taps are closed. Both containers have a base of
i t).O7
m2.
density of water is 1000 kg/m3.
i s plain why the pressure at the bottom of each water butt is different.
।
[1]
ilculate the volume of the water in water butt A.
[1]
State the equation linking density, mass and volume.
[1]
< 'alculate the mass of water in water butt A.
[1]
State the equation linking weight, mass and g.
[1]
alculate the weight of water in water butt A.
[1]
a
(
a
State the equation that links (solid) pressure, force and area.
I sing this equation, calculate the pressure at the base of water
butt A.
State the equation linking (hydrostatic) pressure difference, height,
density and g.
I sing this equation, calculate the pressure at the base of water
butt A and compare it to the answer you found in e ii.
I he taps between the water butts are now opened.
< >n a copy of the diagram, show the final depth of
w ater in water butt A and water butt B.
I \plain in terms of pressure and forces why the water starts
to How and then stops.
[1]
[1]
[1]
[1]
[1]
[3]
[Total: 14]
COMMAND WORD
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons I make
the relationships
between things
evident I provide
why and I or how and
support with relevant
evidence
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
7 Car braking systems multiply forces. In the diagram below, there are three
pistons: one effort piston and two load pistons.
a The effort piston has an area of 2.0 cm2. The driver exerts a force of
[2]
50 N on the effort piston. What is the pressure of the brake fluid?
b This pressure is the same everywhere in the brake fluid, including at the
load pistons. The load pistons have a total area of 40 cm2.
[2]
Calculate the force at the brake disc.
[Total: 4]
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
Recall that forces can change the size and shape of an
object.
Plot and interpret load-extension graphs and describe
the associated experimental procedure.
Recall how to calculate the extension of a spring for a
given load.
Recall what happens to a spring if it is stretched beyond
its limit of proportionality.
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
5.1
5.2
5.2
5.2
Recall the equation for determining the spring constant.
5.3
Identify the limit of proportionality on a load-extension
graph and where on the graph the extension is proportional
to the load.
5.3
Understand the significance of the spring constant and
recognise how an object with a different spring constant
would appear on a load-extension graph.
5.3
100
>
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
5
Forces and matter
r ( )NTINUED
I ran
I*' call the equation that relates pressure, force and area.
1'
all what causes the pressure to increase with
tin leasing depth into water.
1'
ill and use the equation for pressure in a fluid.
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
5.5
5.5
5.5
101
>
> Chapter 6
Energy stores
and transfers
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
identify changes in different energy stores
recognise different energy transfers and interpret energy flow diagrams
understand the meaning of energy efficiency
apply the principle of conservation of energy
calculate potential energy and kinetic energy.
6
Energy stores and transfers
I TTING STARTED
Work with a classmate to describe the energy
ti.msfers that are taking place in each diagram.
What do you already know about energy?
With a classmate, draw an energy mind map to
include everything you know about this topic,
including the principle of conservation of energy.
I H|ure 6.1a: Flashlight switched on. b: Wound up toy. c: Moving radio-controlled car. d: Bunsen burner, e: Loudspeaker
hi U" . f: Ringing bicycle bell, g: Solar-powered battery, h: Hair dryer.
OMETS - FRIEND OR FOE?
Ci ople have different opinions about comets, both
I and bad. Some people think comets are 'dirty
i
u iwballs' that brought water to our planet which
•illows us to live. However, along with asteroids,
i • nn0ts also threaten life on Earth. For example,
II" impact of an asteroid or comet wiped out the
•lim "iaurs 66 million years ago. It is not surprising
•Ii il comets used to be seen as warnings of disaster
(I mure 6.2). However, thanks to physics, comets
an now less mysterious and we can predict their
Astronomers working for Spaceguard search
1 ill
1
II"’ ’(kies, looking for and tracking objects (including
i limits) that might collide with the Earth.
Comets can cross our path (and collide with Earth)
because their orbits are highly elliptical (shaped like
squashed circles). The speed of Earth in its orbit
around the Sun is nearly constant because its orbit
is nearly circular. The speed of a comet changes.
As it moves closer to the Sun, more of the comet's
gravitational potential energy is transferred into
kinetic energy, so it speeds up. As it gets further
away from the Sun, some of its kinetic energy
transfers into gravitational potential energy, and it
slows down.
Discussion questions
When was the Earth's last major collision with
an asteroid or comet and what happened?
2
•
hjim- 6.2: The engraving that shows Halley's Comet
ii I()06. The Monk of Malmesbury sees it as a warning
I il Norman Conquest, when the Normans invaded
"
I in il.ind.
Describe a system on Earth where energy
transfers from gravitational potential energy to
kinetic energy and back again.
Describe the energy transfers when you throw
a ball into the air and relate this to the energy
transfers for a comet orbiting the Sun.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
6.1 Energy stores
Energy can be divided into energy stores and energy
transfers. Energy, and energy transfers, are involved in all
sorts of activities. We will look at two examples and see
how we can describe them in terms of energy. We need to
have the idea of stores of energy.
The energy changes involved are shown in Figure 6.4.
Electricity is useful because it brings energy, available a
the flick of a switch. We can think of the energy being
transferred electrically. In the light bulb, this energy
is transferred by light. Every light bulb also produces
thermal energy.
KEY WORD
energy: quantity that must be changed or
transferred to make something happen
Example 1: running
At the start of a race, you are stationary, waiting for
the starter’s pistol. Energy is stored in your toned-up
muscles, ready to be released. As you set off, the energy
from your muscles gets you moving. If you are running a
marathon, you will need to make use of the energy in the
longer-term stores of the fatty tissues of your body.
The energy transfers involved are shown in Figure 6.3.
Your muscles store chemical energy. The energy is stored
by chemicals in your muscles, ready to be released at
a moment’s notice. Your muscles start you moving,
and you then have kinetic energy. Running makes you
hot. This tells us that some of the energy released in
your muscles is wasted as thermal energy, rather than
becoming useful kinetic energy. Fitness training helps
people to reduce this waste.
Figure 6.3a: At the start of a race, the runner's muscles are stores
of chemical energy, b: As the runner starts to move, chemical
energy is transferred to kinetic energy and thermal energy.
Example 2: switching on a light
It is evening, and the daylight is fading. You switch on
the light. Your electricity meter starts to turn a little
faster, recording the fact that you are drawing more
energy from the distant power station.
104
Figure 6.4: Switching on the light requires a supply of
electricity. In the light bulb, electrical energy is transferred
light and heating.
Naming energy
Example 1 and Example 2 highlight some of the variot
energy stores and transfers. We will now take a brief lo
at examples of these.
A moving object has kinetic energy. The faster an object
moves, the greater its kinetic energy. We know this becau
we need to transfer energy to an object to get it moving.
If you lift an object upwards, you give it gravitational
potential energy (g.p.e.). The higher an object is above
the ground, the greater its g.p.e. If you let the object fal
you can get the energy back again. This is exploited in
many situations. The water stored behind a hydroelectr
dam has g.p.e. As the water falls, it can be used to drive
a turbine to generate electricity. A grandfather clock ha
weights that must be pulled upwards once a week. The:
as they gradually fall, they drive the pendulum to open
the clock’s mechanism.
KEY WORDS
kinetic energy: the energy store of a moving object
gravitational potential energy (g.p.e): the
energy store of an object raised up against the
force of gravity; more generally, it is the distance
between particles or bodies
6 Energy stores and transfers
•
I ujch as coal or petrol (gasoline) are stores of
il energy. We know that a fuel is a store of
(ui \ because, when the fuel burns, the stored energy is
Mil* i cd, usually as heat and light. There are many other
, of chemical energy (see Figure 6.5). As Figure 6.3
•ho" energy is stored by chemicals in our bodies.
Null riles are also stores of energy. When a battery is part
"( .i i omplete circuit, the chemicals start to react with
Hu mother and an electric current flows. The current
.Hi energy to the other components in the circuit.
.
.
•
jure 6.5: Some stores of chemical energy
- bread and
!<■ mut butter, petrol, batteries. Our bodies have long-term
it nr
. of energy in the form of fatty tissues.
releasing elastic energy as the car travels along, so that
the occupants have a smoother ride. A wind-up clock
stores energy in a spring, which is the energy source
needed to keep its mechanism operating.
If you heat an object so that it gets hotter, you are giving
energy to its atoms. The energy stored in a hot object is
called internal energy. We can picture the atoms of a hot
object jiggling rapidly about - they have a lot of energy.
This picture is developed further in Chapter 9.
If you get close to a hot object, you may feel thermal
energy coming from it. This is energy travelling from a
hotter object to a colder one. The different ways in which
this can happen are described in Chapter 11.
It is important not to confuse internal energy and thermal
energy. The internal energy of an object is the total
kinetic and potential energies of the particles it is made
of. The internal energy of an object will be higher if these
particles are moving faster (higher kinetic energy) or they
are further apart (bigger potential energy). Heating an
object (giving it more thermal energy) raises its internal
energy and this can raise its temperature or change its
state (from water to steam, for example). Steam has more
internal energy than boiling water even though they are
at the same temperature. The particles (water molecules)
in steam have more potential energy than water molecules
in boiling water because they are further apart. Thermal
energy spreads out from a hot object.
Very hot objects glow brightly. They are transferring energy
by light. Light radiates outwards all around the hot object.
Another way in which energy can be transferred to an
object’s surroundings is by sound. An electric current
transfers energy electrically to a loudspeaker. Energy is
transferred to the surroundings as sound and thermal
energy (see Figure 6.6).
in illectric current is a good way of transferring energy
1 1 1 mi one place to another. When the current flows through
i•
omponent such as a heater, it gives up some of its energy.
i inium is an example of a nuclear fuel, which is a
'•liiii
of nuclear energy. All radioactive materials are also
ilnn
. of nuclear energy. In these substances, the energy
lured in the nucleus of the atoms - the tiny positively
h uged core of the atom. A nuclear power station is
li><igned to release the nuclear energy stored in uranium.
II you stretch a rubber band, it becomes a store of strain
The band can give its energy to a paper pellet and
"
wild it flying across the room. Strain energy is the energy
by an object that has been stretched or squashed
hi in elastic way (so that it will spring back to its original
dimensions when the stretching or squashing forces are
n moved). For this reason, it is also known as elastic energy.
I he metal springs of a car are constantly storing and
KEY WORDS
chemical energy: energy stored in bonds
between atoms that can be released when
chemical reactions take place
nuclear energy: energy stored in the nucleus of
an atom
strain energy/elastic energy: energy stored in
the changed shape of an object
internal energy: the energy of an object; the
total kinetic and potential energies of its particles
thermal energy: energy transferred from a
hotter place to a colder place because of the
temperature difference between them
105
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Energy stores, energy transfers
Imagine that energy is like money. The amount of money
you have determines what you can buy. The amount of
energy you have determines what you can do.
the back of my sofa. I can*transfer (move) money betwet
these stores but the total money I have does not change.
Energy stores are potential energy. Energy can also transff
between stores, but the total amount of energy never
changes. So, energy can be stored or it can be transferred.
Let us imagine that the amount of money I have is fixed
(I cannot earn any or spend it). Some of my money is stored
in my bank account, some in my wallet and some down
Table 6.1 lists energy under two headings: energy stores
and energy transfers.
Energy stores
Energy transfers
kinetic energy (k.e.)
electrical
gravitational potential energy (g.p.e.)
thermal (heat)
chemical energy
radiation (such as light)
elastic (strain) energy
mechanical (such as sound, which is a way of
transferring vibrational kinetic energy)
nuclear energy
internal energy
electrostatic energy
Table 6.1: Energy can be classified as stores or transfers.
Figure 6.6: At a major rock concert, giant loudspeakers
transfer sound to the audience. Extra generators may have
to be brought on to the site to act as a source of energy to
power the speaker systems. Much of the energy supplied
is wasted as thermal energy, because only a fraction of the
energy is transferred by sound.
106
>
Figure 6.7: When a catapult fires a ball, energy is
transferred from the elastic store of the catapult to the
kinetic store of the ball. If the ball is fired vertically upward:
energy from the kinetic energy store is transferred to the
g.p.e. store, until there is nothing left in the kinetic energy
store. The ball stops moving upwards and starts falling, wit
energy transferring from the gravitational store back to th<
kinetic store.
6
I Jii my can be transferred from one store to another,
fwn within the same object.
4
ample, when you climb a hill, you are transferring
from your chemical store to your gravity (or
) store. Here are four different ways in which energy
1'
1
Un be transferred:
By a force (mechanical working). If you lift
something, you give it gravitational potential energy
you provide the force that lifts it. Alternatively,
y ou can provide the force needed to start something
moving - you give it kinetic energy. Firing a catapult
( Figure 6.7) is another example of a mechanical
I riinsfer. When energy is transferred from one object
Io another by means of a force, we say that the force
is doing work. This is discussed in detail in Chapter 8.
• Uy heating (thermal working). We have already
teen how thermal energy spreads out from hot
objects. No matter how good the insulation,
energy is transferred from a hot object to its cooler
mrroundings. This is discussed in detail in Chapter 11.
• Uy radiation (light). Light reaches us from the Sun.
That is how energy is transferred from the Sun to
I he Earth. Some of the energy is also transferred as
infrared and ultraviolet radiation. These are examples
of electromagnetic radiation (see Chapter 1 5).
• Uy electrical currents (electrical working). An
electric current is a convenient way of transferring
energy from place to place. The electricity may be
generated in a power station many kilometres away
from where the energy is required. Alternatively, an
electrical current transfers energy from the chemical
energy store of a flashlight battery to the internal
energy of a bulb. This increased internal energy
store of the bulb is transferred to the surroundings
via light radiation. This is covered in Chapter 18.
5
>
i ry
>
I Y WORDS
doing work: transferring energy by means of a
lorce
electromagnetic radiation: energy that is
Imnsferred using electromagnetic waves
6
Energy stores and transfers
Explain why steam is likely to lead to a more serious
skin burn than boiling water.
Look at the list of energy stores shown in Table 6. 1 .
For each, give an example of an object or material
that stores this energy.
Look at the physical clues in the left column of
Table 6.2 and write down which energy store is
changing.
Physical clue
Which energy store is
changing?
material changing
shape
object changes speed
chemical reaction
change of temperature
nuclear fission or fusion
distance between
objects changes
•
Table 6.2
6.2 Energy transfers
We have already mentioned several examples of energy
transfers. Now we will look at a few more and think a
little about how energy is transferred between stores
during events and processes, and how these transfers can
be represented by energy flow diagrams.
Striking a match is an example of an event while burning
is a process. An event is something that happens or
takes place, often at a specific time and place. A process
is a series of actions or steps, often taking place over a
long period of time. Climbing a mountain would be an
example of a process, while falling over would be an event.
Sometimes, it is difficult to tell the difference between an
event and a process. The important thing to remember is
that energy is only transferred or changed during events
and processes; in other words, when something happens.
KEY WORDS
Questions
What name is given to the energy of a moving
object?
! What do the letters g.p.e. stand for? How can an
object be given g.p.e.?
I
What energy is stored in a stretched spring?
1
event: something that happens or takes place,
often at a specific time and place
process: a series of actions or steps, often taking
place over a long period of time
107
>
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Figure 6.8 shows scuba divers using flashlights during a
dive at night. The transfer of energy to the lightbulbs is
a process. The chemical energy stored in the battery is
transferred electrically through the wires to the light bulbs,
which increases its store of internal energy. The lamp
transfers (useful) energy by light to the surroundings as
well as by heating, which is wasted. The divers would be in
serious danger if their flashlight ran out of charge. They
cannot replace or recharge their batteries under water.
They need their flashlights to be efficient so that most of
the chemical energy is transferred usefully by light and
very little is wasted as thermal energy. A more efficient
flashlight will produce light for a longer time.
The energy stores and transfers in a flashlight can be
represented by the flow diagram in Figure 6.9. The blue
boxes show the energy stores (and where those stores
are) and the green boxes with arrows show the energy
transfers.
Figure 6.8: Divers using flashlights.
battery
Figure 6.10: Mars Curiosity rover.
A device called a radioisotope thermoelectric generator
(RTG) is a source of energy used in space probes. The
Apollo missions and the Mars Curiosity rover used then
(Figure 6.10). They are ideal for remote places where
batteries, generators or solar cells are not practical. Also
because the devices have no moving parts, they are more
reliable than alternatives and require very little maintenant
The energy transfers in an RTG are another example
of a process. In an RTG, a container seals a radioactive
source (usually plutonium-238). The radioactive source
produces thermal energy, raising the internal energy of
the fuel. Thermocouples pass through the walls of the
container, with the inner end of each thermocouple kep
hot by the fuel while the outer end is connected to a het
sink so that it stays cold.
lightbulb
surroundings
surroundings
Figure 6.9: The energy stores and transfers associated with a battery-powered lamp. The stores are indicated by blue boxes
and the transfers by the green boxes with arrows.
108
6
Energy stores and transfers
|fell oi thermal energy moves along the thermocouple
hum the hot end to the cold end (down a temperature
|i idu nt). The temperature difference at the junction of
Hit l o metals produces a voltage.
1
1 1" nuclear energy in the fuel changes store several times.
Il H im lers from the nuclear store to the internal energy
H 'ir nt the fuel. It then transfers as thermal energy as it
ilong the thermocouples. At the junction of the
nietals,
it transfers as electrical energy.
'
ihk tear energy (store) > internal energy (store)
Ihei mal energy (transfer) electrical energy (transfer)
energy changes can be represented in the energy
v
mgram
1
1
in Figure 6.11.
fl
' Ml mg an arrow is an event, but a rocket launch is a
|mn r , The rocket in Figure 6.12 is lifting off from the
|i mild as it carries a new spacecraft up into space. Its
•m i K comes from its store of chemical energy (tanks
। In |iud hydrogen) and oxygen. When the hydrogen fuel
in n m oxygen, its store of chemical energy is released.
1 Im iix ket is accelerating, so we can say that its kinetic
|*gV Is increasing. It is also rising upwards, so its
gins Hiilional potential energy is increasing. In Figure 6.12,
in see light coming from the burning fuel. You can
•I । imagine that large amounts of thermal energy and
tumid energy are transferred into the atmosphere.
I
ii energy changes could be represented as an energy
। "> diagram as before or as an equation:
'
i hemical energy
k.e. + g.p.e. + thermal energy +
light energy + sound energy
hi
i
——
—
.
|
।
—
Figure 6.12: This rocket uses rocket motors to lift it up into
space. Each rocket motor burns about one tonne of fuel and
oxygen every minute to provide the energy needed to move
the rocket upwards.
radioactive
source in
radioactive
the RTG
source
along
thermocouple
surroundings
• luui« 6.11: The energy flow diagram for the RTG. The blue boxes represent
stores and the green boxes are the transfers.
109
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Question
7
What energy transfers are going on in the following?
In each case, write an equation to represent the
energy transfer.
a Coal is burned to heat a room and to provide a
supply of hot water.
b A student uses an electric lamp while she is
doing her homework.
c A hair dryer is connected to the mains
electricity supply. It blows hot air at the user’s
wet hair. It whirrs as it does so.
ACTIVITY 6.1
Energy changes
Examine some devices that transfer energy. Some
ideas are shown in Figure 6.1 in the 'Getting
Started' box.
•
In pairs, examine each of the devices you are
•
With your partner, decide how to record
and present the energy transfers you have
described for each device.
•
Compare your answers with the answers of
other members of the class and correct or
add to your own answers.
provided with. For each of them, describe what
energy transfers are going on in the device.
6.3 Conservation
of energy
When energy is transferred from one store to another, it is
often the case that some of the energy ends up as unwanted
energy. The energy transfers in a light bulb were shown in
Figure 6.9. The bulb transfers light (which we want) and
heat (which is not wanted).
This is an example of a very important idea, the principle
of conservation of energy:
In any energy transfer, the total amount of energy
before and after the transfer is constant.
This tells us something very important about energy:
it cannot be created or destroyed. The total amount
of energy is constant. If we measure or calculate
the amount of energy before a transfer, and again
afterwards, we will always get the same result. If we fin
any difference, we must look for places where energy m
be entering or escaping unnoticed.
KEY WORDS
principle of conservation of energy: energy
cannot be created or destroyed; it can only be
stored or transferred
WORKED EXAMPLE 6.1
A car bums 3 x 105 J of fuel (chemical energy) per
second. It has 1.3 x 105 J of kinetic energy and gains
0.7 x 105 J of gravitational potential energy as it goes
up a slope. How much energy transfers away from
the car through thermal energy transfer? Assume tha1
acceleration due to gravity g = 10m/s2.
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what you
want to know.
input energy:
chemical energy 3 x IO5 J
output energy:
kinetic energy = 1.3 x 105 J
gravitational potential energy 0.7 x 105 J
thermal energy transferred ?
=
=
=
Step 2: Write down any equations or useful
principles.
According to the principle of conservation
of energy, the total input energy should equal
the total output energy.
Step 3: Apply the principle to this problem and
substitute known values to solve the problem
chemical energy = k.e. + g.p.e. + thermal
energy
3 x 105 J 1.3 x 105 J + 0.7 x 105J + thermal
energy
x
1.0 105 J transfers away from
the car through thermal energy
transfer
Answer
=
=
1.0 x 105 J transfers away from the car as thermal
energy.
6 Energy stores and transfers
uestion
A light bulb is supplied with 60 J of energy each
wcond.
How many joules of energy are transferred
from the bulb each second?
4 J of energy are transferred from the lamp
each second as light. How many joules of
energy are transferred each second by heating?
ankey diagrams
diagram for this. By doing mechanical work, they
transferred energy from the chemical energy store in
their bodies to the (useful) gravitational potential energy
gained by the blocks. At the same time, some of their
store of chemical energy is transferred, by heating, to the
(useless) internal energy of the surroundings. This heat
came from their bodies and because of friction between
the blocks and the ramp.
increased g.p.e.
store of the blocks
chemical energy
store of the
Egyptian workers
li rlfective way to represent the principle of
<irvation of energy is by using a Sankey diagram,
rocket motor we saw earlier (Figure 6.12) does
lianical work to transfer chemical energy into k.e.
not p.e. (energy stores that we do want), while heat,
i
increased internal energy
of the surroundings
hplil and sound transfer energy to the internal energy
Figure 6.14: A Sankey diagram for blocks being dragged up
•bur of the surroundings (an energy store that we do not
a ramp.
*unt to increase). This is shown in Figure 6.13.
Inimical
energy
kinetic
energy
billed in
IijoI and
'kygen)
gravitational
potential
energy
internal energy of the
surroundings
1 '(jure 6.13: The energy changes going on as a rocket like
In Figure 6.12 accelerates upwards. Chemical energy in
fuel is released when it burns in oxygen and is transferred
I three other energy stores.
I Y WORDS
S.tnkey diagram: a flow diagram that represents
Ihe principle of conservation of energy; the width
of the arrows is proportional to energy
I the beginning of Chapter 1 you were introduced
I he Ancient Egyptians and their pyramids. The
yvptians built their pyramids by dragging limestone
docks up ramps and Figure 6.14 shows the Sankey
Energy efficiency
Most wasted energy is transferred away as heat. There
are two main reasons for this.
When fuels are burned (perhaps to generate electricity,
or to drive a car), heat is produced. Any kind of engine
needs a difference in temperature to create movement.
Thermal energy transfers from the hot part to the cold
part of the engine and kinetic energy is produced. But no
matter how well insulated the hot part is, it will transfer
thermal energy to the surroundings. Or, the cold part
has to be cooled to maintain (keep) the temperature
difference. So, power stations produce warm cooling
water and cars produce hot exhaust gases.
Friction is often a problem when things are moving.
Lubrication can help to reduce friction and no doubt the
Egyptians lubricated the ramps to make it easier for the
blocks to be dragged up them. A streamlined car design
can reduce air resistance. But it is impossible to eliminate
(remove) friction entirely from machines with moving
parts. Friction generates heat.
Another common wasted energy transfer is sound.
Noisy machinery, loud car engines and so on, all
transfer sound to the atmosphere. However, even loud
noises contain very little energy, so there is little to be
gained (in terms of energy) by reducing noise.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
It is important to make good use of the energy resources
available to us. This is because energy is expensive,
supplies are often limited, and our use of energy can
damage the environment. So we must use resources
efficiently. Here is what we mean by efficiency:
Efficiency is the fraction (or percentage) of energy
supplied that is usefully transferred.
Making better use of energy
Figure 6.15 shows a Sankey diagram that represents
energy flows in the whole of the UK in a typical year.
Most of the energy flowing in to the UK comes from
fuels, particularly coal, oil and gas. Energy is wasted ii
two general ways: when it is changed into electricity, a
while it is being used (for example, in light bulbs).
Be careful, the word, ‘efficiency’ is often used in everyday
life, but often it is used to mean quickly, which is not the
same as the scientific meaning.
KEY WORDS
lubrication: usually a liquid, it allows two surfaces
to slide past each other more easily
efficiency: the fraction (or percentage) of energy
supplied that is usefully transferred
Table 6.3 shows the typical efficiencies for some important
devices. You can see that even the most modern gas-fired
power station is only 50% efficient. Half of the energy it is
supplied with is wasted.
Device
Typical efficiency
electric heater
100%
large electric motor
90%
washing machine motor
70%
gas-fired power station
50%
diesel engine
40%
car petrol engine
30%
steam locomotive
10%
Table 6.3: Energy efficiencies. Most devices are less than
100% efficient because they produce waste heat. An electric
heater is 100% efficient because all of the electrical energy
supplied is transferred to thermal energy. There is no
problem with waste here.
Figure 6.1 5: Energy flows in the UK in the year 2000.
All numbers are x10,8J. A large propdrtian of the energy
supplied by fuels is wasted in energy transfer processes
and during its final use. Some of this waste is inevitable, t
better insulation and more efficient machines could reduc
the waste and environmental damage, and save money.
Figure 6.16 shows one way to make more efficient use
of electricity. We use light bulbs to provide us with lig]
The lower light bulb is a filamtnt lamp; the other one
is an energy-efficient lamp. The Sankey diagrams show
the energy each light bulb transfers each second. The
diagram shows that each of the two bulbs produces th
same amount of light. However, because it wastes mu<
less energy as heat, the energy-efficient lamp requires e
much smaller input of energy and is more efficient.
electrical
energy
25 J
waste heat 10 J
electrical
energy
100 J
Questions
In what way is energy usually wasted?
b Name another way in which energy is often wasted.
10 Give three reasons why it is important not to waste
energy.
9
a
Figure 6.16: Each of these two light bulbs provides the
same amount of light. The energy-efficient lamp wastes
much less energy as heat.
6
not to mix stores and transfers on the same Sankey
i nn. Figures 6.13 and 6.14 shows energy stores while
>> h 6.16 shows transfers. Figure 6.16 shows the energy
I by the light bulbs per second. Energy transferred
a cond is known as power and is something you
meet in Chapter 8. This highlights an important
i tnce between stores and transfers. Transfers are a
of energy.
ergy becoming dissipated
Efficiency is expressed as a number (no units) up to a
value of 1. This number can be multiplied by 100 to get
percentage efficiency. Percentage efficiency greater than
100% is impossible.
When the filament lamp from Figure 6.16 is supplied
with 100 J of energy, it produces 15 J of useful light. Its
efficiency is thus:
_
.
efficiency
.
i mod (and gain some internal energy). It is very
useful energy output
= total energy input
0.15
= JlL
100 J =
luive seen that energy changes are usually less than
efficient. Energy escapes and is wasted as heat.
i« means that objects and their surroundings are
„
.
percentage efficiency =
ult to get that energy back. We say that energy tends
WORD
useful energy output
x 100%
total energy input
= 100 J x 100% = 15%
^0 dissipated (spread out) during an energy transfer.
I Imik about, for example, a battery in a flashlight.
N |» <i convenient, compact store of energy. Once it has
I ii Used, some of its energy has been changed to light
h is then absorbed by the surfaces it falls on, causing
n to warm slightly (raising their internal energy). The
of the energy is dissipated as thermal energy in the
ponents of the electric circuit in the flashlight.
Energy stores and transfers
Similar equations can be used to calculate the efficiency
and percentage efficiency in terms of power as follows:
efficiency
useful power output
= total power input
percentage efficiency =
useful power output
total power input
Questions
tlpated: energy that is spread out is not
noful (wasted)
11 Describe the energy transfers taking place when
charging a mobile phone, including the energy that
is wasted.
12 Calculate the efficiency of the energy-efficient lamp
from the data shown in Figure 6.16.
< .in see from Table 6.3 that efficiency is often
ti us a percentage. We can calculate the efficiency
1 1 percentage
। Y
useful energy output
= total energy input
;
.
ii entage efficiency
useful energy output
, „„„ ,
= total energy ;input x 100%
efficiency =
|)ercentage efficiency
useful energy output
total energy input
useful energy output
=
14 A tungsten-filament lamp is 4% efficient. How much
electrical energy must be supplied to the lamp each
second when it produces 6 J of light per second?
EQUATIONS
Uh icncy
।
efficiency of an energy change as follows:
13 A tidal-power station is expected to produce 32 TJ
of energy (1 TJ 1012 J) when the tides provide it
with 100 TJ of gravitational potential energy. What
is the efficiency of the power station?
= total energy input x
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 6.2
Energy changes during the pole vault
Energy is transferred between different energy stores
during the pole vault. Snapshots (labelled 1-5) of
an athlete at different stages of the pole vault are as
shown in Figure 6.17. Between each snapshot, the
energy is transferred between stores.
1
try to resolve any differences. Be prepared to
discuss your thinking with the class.
Copy and complete this table:
Main
Snapshot energy
store
Additional
Wasted
energy
energy
stores
1
2
3
4
5
2
How is the energy transferred between each store?
3
Using Figure 6.9 as a guide, draw an energy flow
diagram that shows the main energy stores and
the energy transfers between them.
4
Decide whether you think the pole vault is an
event or a process and justify your answer.
5
If your teacher gives you the time to do so,
compare your answers with your neighbour and
SELF-ASSESSMENT
Think about Activity 6.2. Did you find this activity easy? If you found it difficult, you could think about energy
transfers that you come across every day (for example, the transport you use to get to and from school) and
ask a friend to check your answer.
6.4 Energy calculations
Energy is not simply an idea, it is also a quantity that
we can calculate.
Gravitational potential energy
(g.p.e.)
Mountaineering on the Moon should be easy (see
Figure 6. 1 8). The Moon’s gravity is much weaker than
the Earth’s, because the Moon’s mass is only one¬
eightieth of the Earth’s. This means that the weight
astronaut on the Moon is a fraction of his or her we
on the Earth. In principle, it is possible to jump higt
on the Moon than on the Earth.
Earlier, we saw that an object’s g.p.e. depends on its
height above the ground. The higher it is, the greatei
g.p.e. If you lift an object upwards, you provide the 1
needed to increase its g.p.e. The heavier the object, t
greater the force needed to lift it, and hence the grea
its g.p.e.
6
Energy stores and transfers
WORKED EXAMPLE 6.2
An athlete of mass 50 kg runs up a hill. The foot of
the hill is 400 metres above sea-level. The summit is
1200 metres above sea-level. By how much does the
athlete’s g.p.e. increase? Assume that acceleration due
to gravity g = 10 m/s2.
Step 1: Assume that g.p.e. is zero at the foot of the
hill. Calculate the increase in height.
A/z 1200m - 400m 800m
=
6.18: Astronauts on the Moon. The gravitational field
|th
on the surface of the Moon is one-sixth of what it is
M"
I I .I ih. Experiments on the Moon have shown that a golf
Mil ' an be hit much further than on Earth. This is because
III bIh a much greater distance horizontally before gravity
j**!1 II back to the ground.
Ml ilggests that an object’s gravitational potential
Hkipv (g.p.e.) depends on two factors:
I he object’s weight, mg - the greater its weight, the
=
Step 2: Write down the equation for g.p.e., substitute
values and solve.
A£p weight x change in height
mgkh
50 kg x 10 m/s2 x 800 m
= 400 000 J
400 kJ
Answer
The athlete’s g.p.e. increases by 400 kJ.
=
=
=
=
rteater its g.p.e.
I
I he object’s height, h, above ground level - the
greater its height, the greater its g.p.e.
Hu i it illustrated in Figure 6.19. From the numbers in
Hi iliigram, you can see that a change in g.p.e. is simply
|ah 1 1 luted by multiplying weight by height. (Here, we
«i ,i iwming that an object’s g.p.e. is zero when it is at
Bbin ml level.) We can write this as an equation for g.p.e.:
EQUATION
in
in g.p.e. = weight x change in height
&Ep = mgEh
g.p.e. = 40 N x 2.5 m
= 100 J
g.p.e. = 40 N x 1
40 N
Q
2.5 m
<1 pe.
iri .
1m
ION
Hgiu * 6.19: The gravitational potential energy of an object
Hl' >i" as it is lifted higher. The greater its weight, the
-i
I
i.I its g.p.e.
A note on height
We have to be careful when measuring or calculating the
change in an object’s height.
First, we have to consider the vertical height through which
it moves. A train may travel 1 km up a long and gentle
slope, but its vertical height may only increase by 10 metres.
A satellite may travel around the Earth in a circular orbit.
It stays at a constant distance from the centre of the Earth,
and so its height does not change. Its g.p.e. is constant.
Second, it is the change in height of the object’s centre of
gravity that we must consider. This is illustrated by the
pole-vaulter shown in Figure 6.20. As he jumps, he must
try to increase his g.p.e. enough to get over the bar. In
fact, by curving his body, he passes over the bar but his
centre of gravity may pass under it.
Figure 6.20: This pole¬
vaulter adopts a curved
posture to get over the bar.
He cannot increase his g.p.e.
enough to get his whole
body above the level of the
bar. His centre of gravity may
even pass under the bar, so
that at no time is his body
entirely above the bar.
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 6.3
Moon flight high jump
High jump record / m Athlete
Height of athlete / m
Year
men
2.45
Javier Sotomayor (Cuba)
1.95
1993
women
2.09
Stefka Kostadinova (Bulgaria)
1.80
1987
Table 6.4
Table 6.4 lists the current world records for the
high jump.
3
The athletes are doing physical work to raise
their centres of mass over the bar. Now that
you know the jumpers are raising their centres
of gravity, work out a revised prediction for the
records, but take care, as there is still a potenti
trap for the unwary.
4
Most high jumpers now use a technique that
allows their centre of gravity to pass below the
bar, by as much as 20 cm. Explain or sketch ho'
this is possible.
5
Can you explain why the height gained by the
athlete when they jump is not the distance
between the bar and the ground?
6
Use physics to explain why successful high
jumpers tend to be tall and slim.
7
Make a case for medals\being awarded to
athletes who can raise their centres of gravity
through the biggest height.
•
the object’s speed v - the greater the speed, the
greater its kinetic energy.
Predict what the high jump record would be on the
lunar surface.
Now follow these steps to see if your prediction
was correct.
1
Let us assume that the Moon has the same
atmosphere as Earth, and that the athletes can
reach the same run-up speed. Imagine that
the gravitational field strength on the Moon is
reduced to one sixth of the value it has on the
Earth's surface (1 0 N/kg) only after the jumpers
have lifted off the ground. Predict what you think
the high jump records would be on the Moon.
Write down your working and your answers.
2
Now assume that the centre of gravity of a person
is located half-way up their body. Through what
height have these athletes moved their centre of
gravity in order to achieve their world records?
Kinetic energy
It takes energy to make things move. You transfer energy
to a ball when you throw it or hit it. A car uses energy
from its fuel to get it moving. Elastic energy stored in a
stretched piece of rubber is needed to fire a pellet from
a catapult. So a moving object is a store of energy. This
energy is known as kinetic energy (k.e.).
We often make use of an object’s kinetic energy. To do
this, we must slow it down. For example, moving air
turns a wind turbine. This slows down the air, reducing
its k.e. The energy extracted can be used to turn a
generator to produce electricity.
This suggests that the kinetic energy of an object
depends on two factors:
• the object’s mass m - the greater the mass, the
greater its kinetic energy
These are combined in an equation for kinetic energy
KEY EQUATION
kinetic energy =
x mass x speed2
£k = ~mv2
2
Worked Example 6.3 shows how to use the equation
calculate the kinetic energy of a moving object. Note
also that kinetic energy is a scalar quantity, despite tl
fact that it involves v. It is best to think of v here as s
rather than velocity.
6
)RKED EXAMPLE 6.3
\ van of mass 2000 kg is travelling at 10 m/s.
Calculate its kinetic energy.
h Its speed increases to 20 m/s. By how much does its
kinetic energy increase?
Energy stores and transfers
When the van’s speed doubles from lOm/s to 20 m/s, its
kinetic energy increases from 100 kJ to 400 kJ. In other
words, when its speed increases by a factor of two, its
kinetic energy increases by a factor of four. This is because
kinetic energy depends on speed squared. If the speed
trebled (increased by a factor of three), the kinetic energy
would increase by a factor of nine (see Figure 6.21).
•<lop 1: Calculate the van’s kinetic energy at 10 m/s.
£k
=lwv2
2
= |x 2000kg x (10m/s)2
= 100 000 J
= 100 kJ
••I op 2: Calculate the van’s kinetic energy at 20 m/s.
-I
Ev = -mv*2
k
2
= x 2000 kg x (20 m/s)2
|
= 400 000 J
= 400 kJ
Slop 3: Calculate the change in the van’s kinetic
energy.
change in kinetic energy = 400 kJ - 100 kJ
= 300 kJ
tiHwer
• The van’s k.e. when travelling at 10 m/s is 100 kJ.
h The van’s k.e. increases by 300 kJ when it speeds
up from 10 m/s to 20 m/s.
When the van starts moving from rest and speeds up
In 1 0 m/s, its kinetic energy increases from 0 to 100 kJ.
When its speed increases by the same amount again,
h nin 10 m/s to 20 m/s, its kinetic energy increases by
’HO kJ, three times as much. It takes a lot more energy
In increase your speed when you are already moving
I ulckly. That is why a car’s fuel consumption starts to
mi itase rapidly when the driver tries to accelerate in
I n‘ fast lane of a motorway.
H i i Worth looking at Worked Example 6.3 in detail,
»im। it illustrates several important points.
I i'ii calculating kinetic energy using E^-^mv2, take
•pul Only the speed is squared. Using a calculator, start
iquaring the speed. Then multiply by the mass, and
Im. illy divide by two.
Figure 6.21: The faster the van travels, the greater its kinetic
energy. The graph shows that kinetic energy increases more
and more rapidly as the van's speed increases.
Questions
15 In the following examples, is the object’s g.p.e.
increasing, decreasing or remaining constant?
a
A balloon rises in the air.
b A bird flies at a constant height on its migration
route.
c
A raindrop falls from the sky.
16 It is claimed that Superman can jump 200 metres
vertically upwards. If he has a mass of 100 kg, by
how much does his g.p.e. increase?
17 A raindrop weighs 1 x 10"3N. Its g.p.e. decreases
by 0.8 J when it falls from a cloud. How high was
the cloud?
18 What does v represent in the equation Ek =
^mv 2?
19 How much kinetic energy is stored by a bullet with a
mass of 10.5 g travelling at 553 m/s?
20 Usain Bolt has a mass of 86 kg. When he runs at
12 m/s, what is his kinetic energy?
21 Which has more kinetic energy, a 2.0g bee flying at
1.0 m/s, or a 1.0 g wasp flying at 2.0 m/s?
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
REFLECTION
How easy did you find this topic?
How will you learn the different energy stores and transfers and remember the difference between them?
If you do not know the difference between an event and a process, how are you going to find out?
PROJECT
Choose one of the options below and either
produce a short report (less than 500 words)
along with relevant illustrations or produce a short
presentation (two or three minutes), with suitable
visual aids.
Option 1: Inventions for remote places
Research an invention that provides useful energy
in a location without an obvious or reliable energy
supply. If you cannot track down another invention,
focus on one of the following examples.
•
You should already have met the radioisotope
thermoelectric generator (RTG) earlier in
the book.
•
Trevor Baylis invented the wind-up radio,
which worked without batteries or access to an
electrical power source.
Option 2: Efficiency
It is important to increase efficiency to reduce
waste, reduce environmental damage, and save
money. Investigate efforts to improve the efficiency
of one device (for example, a light bulb, or a car) or
create better insulation for homes.
SUMMARY
Transfers between different stores of energy can occur because of an event or process.
A collision is an event that will change the kinetic energy of a body.
Heating a body will increase its internal energy.
Changing the shape of a body will change its elastic (strain) energy.
Lifting a body will increase its g.p.e.
6
Energy stores and transfers
Burning a substance will reduce its chemical energy.
I ,nergy can be transferred between energy stores, which can be illustrated using an energy flow diagram.
Mechanical work can transfer g.p.e. to an object, by lifting it.
I Electric currents transfer energy electrically.
Thermal energy can transfer internal energy from a hot object to a cold object.
Il is important to increase efficiency to reduce waste, reduce environmental damage, and save money.
When a process is not 100% efficient, the wasted energy spread outs and is not useful (usually thermal energy).
I nergy is conserved. It cannot be created or destroyed; it can only transfer from one store to another.
\ Sankey diagram illustrates the principle of conservation of energy.
I lliciency is the fraction of the total energy that is useful.
hange in gravitational potential energy = weight x change in height or change in gravitational potential energy
mass x gravitational field strength x change in height or AEp = mg^h.
I metic energy is Ek = jmv2.
When working out kinetic energy, only the speed is squared.
KAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
I
This diagram shows an amusement park roller coaster ride (not drawn to scale).
[1]
On what part of the ride is the car moving slowest?
[1]
b On what part of the ride is the car moving fastest?
<
The car becomes stuck at point P, which is 50 metres above the ground.
To the relief of the passengers, the car eventually moves again and passes
point R at 20 m/s. Approximately how high is point R? The car and its
passengers have a combined mass of 700 kg (though the question can be
[1]
answered without this information).
.1
A 35 m/s
B 30 m/s
C 25 m/s
D 20 m/s
[Total: 3]
119
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
2 Copy and complete the table. For each description, write down the name
of the associated energy and
te whether it is a store or transfer.
Description
energy of a moving object
Name of energy
COMMAND WOR
[2]
Store or transfer
energy in a hot object
energy in a fuel
energy that we can see
energy in a squashed spring
energy carried by an electric
current
energy in the nucleus of an
atom
energy escaping from a hot
object
3 Which of the following statements is closest to the meaning of the principle
of conservation of energy?
A Energy can only be stored or transferred
B Energy is created by energy stores
C Energy can be destroyed by transfers
D Energy can only be transferred
[1 ]
4 This diagram represents an energy transfer.
energy input
useful energy
output
waste energy
Copy and complete the following two word equations for this energy change:
a wasted energy
b efficiency =
120
>
=
[1 ]
[1 ]
[Total: 2]
state: express in
clear terms
6 Energy stores and transfers
ONTINUED
Scientists use a ballistic pendulum to work out the speed of a projectile that
hits it. The block has a mass of 4.7 kg and moves with an initial speed of
I 24 m/s when it is hit.
after
before
V.
State the equation linking kinetic energy, mass and velocity.
b alculate the kinetic energy of the block.
As the block swings, it gains g.p.e. What is the maximum g.p.e.
that can be gained by the block.
d Calculate the maximum height the block gains.
It might not be easy to measure the height increase. Suggest another
variable a researcher could measure more easily and then use to get
the height.
f Researchers find the kinetic energy of the projectile is much higher than
the kinetic energy of the block. What happened to the kinetic energy
that was not transferred from the projectile to the block?
Hl
[2]
[1]
[2]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 8]
This is the Sankey diagram for a 100 W light bulb.
not to scale
power
station
transmission
lines
7J
208 J
lamp
4J
93 J
a Calculate the input energy to the power station.
b Calculate the efficiency of the power station.
c Calculate the efficiency of the light bulb.
d State the energy dissipated (wasted) in the lamp.
[1]
Hl
[11
[1]
[Total: 4]
COMMAND WORDS
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations where
there are a range
of valid responses
in order to make
proposals/put forward
considerations
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
See
I can
Topic...
Recall the different names of energy stores (k.e., g.p.e.,
chemical, elastic, nuclear, internal, electrostatic, magnetic)
and transfers (electrical, thermal, radiation, mechanical).
Recognise how energy is transferred during events and
processes.
6.1, 6.2
6.2
Interpret energy flow diagrams.
6.2
Understand the meaning of efficiency.
6.3
Understand and apply the principle of conservation of
6.3
energy.
Calculate using the equations for percentage efficiency.
6.3
Explain that, in any event or process, the energy tends
to become more spread out among the objects and
surroundings.
6.3
Recall and use the equation for kinetic energy, Ek =
6.4
Recall and use the equation for a change in g.p.e.,
Ep mgAA.
=
122
>
^mv2.
6.4
Needs
more work
Almost
Confident
there
to move on
Chapter 7
nergy
esources
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
y
understand that the Sun is the source of energy for all our energy resources except geothermal,
nuclear and tidal
understand that energy is released by nuclear fusion in the Sun.
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
List all the energy resources that you know.
Examples of energy resources include wood for
heating and cooking.
Which of these energy resources are renewable?
Can any of these resources be traced back to
sunlight?
IS THORIUM THE PERFECT FUEL?
Kirk Sorensen worked for NASA to come up with
a reliable source of energy for a Moon base. None
of the energy resources that are used on Earth
were suitable. But then he found a book about
liquid fluoride thorium reactors (or 'lifters'), an
environmentally friendly and safe version of nuclear
power. They were being developed by the USA
so that aircraft carrying nuclear bombs would only
have to land to change crews and take on supplies.
But the experiment was abandoned in 1956
because missiles could more easily send nuclear
bombs over great distances.
Nuclear power stations need water but a lifter
would not, making it suitable for the Moon.
Figure 7.1: Pellets of thorium.
124
)
But Sorenson thought, 'why not have them here
on Earth?' There are huge reserves of thorium
fuel available, they produce tiny amounts of
radioactive waste, an accidental meltdown would
be impossible, and it would be extremely difficult
to make a nuclear bomb using a lifter.
Discussion questions
1
Explain why energy resources used on Earth
would not be suitable for the Moon.
2
Would you be in favour of nbclear power
based on a lifter? Explain your answer.
7 Energy resources
other
renewables (4%)
7.1 The energy we use
I lore on Earth, we rely on the Sun for most of the energy
? c use. The Sun is a fairly average star, 1 50 million
1 ilometres away. The heat and light we receive from it
l ike about eight minutes to travel through empty space
Io get here. Plants absorb this energy in the process of
photosynthesis, and animals are kept warm by it.
I he Earth is at a convenient distance from the Sun for
living organisms. The Sun’s rays are strong enough, but
not too strong. The Earth’s average temperature is about
1 5 °C, which is suitable for life. If the Earth were closer
Io (he Sun, it might be intolerably hot like Venus, where
I he average surface temperature is over 400 °C. Further
out, things are colder. Saturn is roughly ten times as
In from the Sun, so the Sun in the sky looks one-tenth
• il the diameter that we see it, and its radiation has
only one-hundredth of the intensity. Saturn’s surface
temperature is about - 1 80 °C.
nuc|ear (4%)
hydro (7%)
oil (34%)
natural
gas (24%)
coal (27%)
Figure 7.2: World energy use, by fuel. This chart shows
people's energy consumption of different fuels across the
world in 2018. Around 85% of all energy comes from fossil fuels.
of the energy we use comes from the Sun, but only
i
imall amount is used directly from the Sun. On a cold
hut sunny morning, you might sit in the sunshine to
"ii rm your body. Your house might be designed to collect
" urmth from the Sun’s rays, perhaps by having larger
' Indows on the sunny side. However, most of the energy
use comes only indirectly from the Sun. It must be
Hunsferred in a more useful form, such as electricity.
I Igure 7.2 shows the different fuels that contribute to the
>0rld’s energy supplies. This chart reflects patterns of
< uergy consumption in 2018. Many people today live in
industrialised countries and consume large amounts of
riiergy, particularly from fossil fuels (coal, oil and gas).
People living in less-developed countries consume far
Iris energy mostly they use biomass fuels, particularly
A thousand years ago, the chart would have
looked very different. Fossil fuel consumption was much
h is important then. Most people relied on burning wood
Io supply their energy requirements. We will now look at
these groups of fuels in turn, in addition to other energy
nsources. Energy resources are not the same as the stores
md transfers of energy you studied in Chapter 6.
I lowever, we first need to categorise (group together)
।uergy resources to make it easier to compare them. So,
We will look at how most of them can be used to generate
electricity and whether or not they are renewable.
Renewables and non-renewables
Figure 7.2 shows that most of the energy supplies we
use are fossil fuels - coal, oil and gas. Oil and natural
gas are expected to run out this century but reserves of
coal should last another 200 years. They are described as
non-renewables. Once used, they are gone forever.
Other sources of energy, such as wind, solar and biofuel,
are described as renewables. This is because, when we
use them, they will soon be replaced. The wind will blow
again, the Sun will shine again. After harvesting a biofuel
crop, we can grow another crop.
Ideally, our energy supply should be based on
renewables. Then we would not have to worry about
supplies running out. As we will see, non-renewable
resources also cause significant environmental problems.
Burning fossil fuels causes global warming while nuclear
power produces dangerous radioactive waste.
KEY WORDS
non-renewables: an energy resource that is gone
forever once it has been used
renewables: an energy resource that will be
replenished (replaced) naturally when used
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 7.1
Create a presentation on an energy resource
Research a particular energy resource and present
your work to the class. Work in groups of two
or three.
Your two to three minute presentation should
answer these questions:
•
•
However, as this technology becomes cheaper, it is find
more and more uses. It is useful in remote locations.
For example, for running a refrigerator that stores
medicines in central Africa, or for powering roadside
emergency phones in desert regions such as the Austral
outback. Solar cells have also been used extensively for
powering spacecraft. Ideally, a solar cell is connected to
rechargeable battery, which stores the energy collected,
that it can be available during the hours of darkness.
What is the origin of the energy resource?
KEY WORDS
Is the energy resource renewable or
non-renewable?
solar panel, used to collect energy that is
transferred by light from the Sun
•
If the resource is used to generate electricity,
what energy transfers happen and how it
is done?
•
What are the advantages and disadvantages
of using this energy resource compared
with others?
solar cell/photocell/photovoltaic cell: an
electrical device that transfers the energy of
sunlight directly to electricity, by producing a
voltage when light falls on it
The presentation should make use of audio-visual
technology (such as presentation software), or you
could produce a documentary.
The presentation will be graded by the rest of the
class on its scientific content and the quality of its
delivery (in other words, how well it is presented).
You should also prepare a handout consisting of
one side of A4 that summarises the points made in
your presentation.
Energy direct from the Sun
In hot, sunny countries, solar panels are used to collect
energy transferred by light from the Sun. The Sun’s rays
fall on a large solar panel, on the roof of a house, for
example. This absorbs the energy of the rays, and water
inside the panel heats up. This provides hot water for
washing. It can also be pumped round the house, through
radiators, to provide a cheap form of central heating.
We can also generate electricity directly from sunlight
(Figure 7.3). The Sun’s rays shine on a large array of
solar cells (also known as a photocells or photovoltaic
cells). The solar cells absorb the energy of the rays, and
electricity is produced.
While solar power (from solar panels and photocells) is
renewable and does not contribute to global warming, it
is unreliable because the intensity of sunlight varies (and
drops to zero at night) and a large area of solar panels is
required to capture the energy.
Figure 7.3: An array of solar cells inside the Vansad Natic
Park, India.
Wind power
Wind and waves are also caused by the effects of the Su
The Sun heats some parts of the atmosphere more than
others. Heated air expands and starts to move around this is a convection current (see Chapter 11). This is the
origin of winds. There are many technologies for extraci
energy from the wind. Windmills have been used for a k
time for grinding and pumping, and modem wind turbi
can generate electricity (see Figure 7.4).
Wind is renewable and does not contribute to global
warming. However, it is unreliable because the speed
of the wind can vary and on calm days no power is
produced. Wind turbines need a minimum wind speed
of about 5 m/s and are switched off when wind speeds
exceed 25 m/s to prevent them being damaged.
7 Energy resources
Wind is a dilute energy resource. It would take a ‘wind
liirm’ of several hundred wind turbines (spread over
>«|veral square kilometres) to produce the same energy as
i typical fossil fuel power station. Wind turbines are also
liqisy and many people think they spoil the appearance
' >1 places where they are located.
I igure 7.4: These giant turbines are part of a wind farm
«1 Xinjiang in China. They produce as much electricity as a
modium-sized coal-fired power station.
Wave power
Most of the energy of winds is transferred to the sea
1 i waves are formed by friction between wind and
"liter. Like wind, wave power is renewable and does not
oiltribute to global warming. However, it is unreliable
liecause the height of waves can vary and, when there
nt no waves, no power is produced. It is also difficult
in convert the up-and-down motion of waves into the
pinning motion required for a turbine in the wave
nergy converters, which float on the water. The cost is
high because these machines corrode in the saltwater and
in be damaged in storms.
।
Hydroelectric power
One of the smallest contributions to the chart in Figure 7.2
is hydroelectric power. For centuries, people have used the
kinetic energy of moving water to turn water wheels, which
then drive machinery. For example, they are used to grind
com and other crops, pump water and weave textiles. Today
we have hydroelectric power stations (see Figure 7.5).
Water stored behind a dam is released to turn turbines,
which make generators spin. This is a very safe, clean and
reliable way of producing electricity, but it is not without its
problems. A new reservoir floods land that might otherwise
have been used for hunting or farming. People may be
made homeless, and wildlife habitats destroyed.
Hydroelectric power stations have a very short start up
time (the time between switching on a power station and
energy being delivered). This makes them very useful for
storing energy until there is a sudden surge (increase) in
demand. The demand for electricity varies during the
day: it is highest during the daytime (when most people
are awake) and lowest during the night. Power stations
that use fossil fuels and nuclear fuels take a long time
to start up and stop so, once started, they are allowed
to continue running. It would take too long to stop
them when demand is low and then start them again
for the next rise in demand. This means that sometimes
(usually at night) too much electricity is supplied and
battery technology is not currently good enough to store
large amounts of energy. In some hydroelectric power
stations (called pumped storage systems), the turbines
can be reversed so that water can be pumped back up a
mountain to the reservoir so that energy can be stored as
gravitational potential energy. This water can be allowed
to fall back down the mountain to produce electricity
when demand rises.
Questions
।
Explain why wind power can be traced back
to sunlight.
What is the difference between a solar panel and
a solar cell?
Describe the advantages and disadvantages of
solar power.
Figure 7.5: The giant Itaipu dam on the Parana River in
South America generates electricity for Brazil and Paraguay.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Biomass fuels
For many people in the world, wood is the most important
fuel. It warms their homes and provides the heat necessary
for cooking their food. Wood is made by trees and shrubs.
It stores energy that the plant has captured from sunlight
in the process of photosynthesis. When we bum wood, we
are releasing energy that came from the Sun in the recent
past, perhaps ten or a hundred years ago.
Wood is just one example of a biofuel. Others include
animal dung (Figure 7.6) and biogas, generated by rotting
vegetable matter.
oxygen from the air. In thi^ process, the carbon becomes
carbon dioxide. The hydrogen becomes dihydrogen
monoxide, which we usually call water. Energy is releasee
We can write this as an equation:
hydrocarbon + oxygen
dioxide + water
— carbon
+ energy
Hence, we can think of a fossil fuel as a store of chemic:
energy. Where has this energy come from?
Fossil fuels (Figure 7.7) are the remains of organisms
(plants and animals) that lived in the past. Many of the
Earth’s coal reserves, for example, formed from trees
that lived in the Carboniferous era, between 286 and
360 million years ago. (Carboniferous means coal¬
producing.) These trees captured energy from the Sun
by photosynthesis. They grew and eventually they died.
Their trunks fell into swampy ground, but they did not
rot completely, because there was insufficient oxygen.
KEY WORDS
biofuel: material, recently living, qsed as a fuel
fossil fuels: material, formed from long-dead
material, used as a fuel
Figure 7,6: A Maasai blowing into elephant dung to make
fire in a village in West Kilimanjaro, Tanzania.
Biomass fuels account for roughly 10% of global energy
consumption but, because no-one keeps track of all
the wood consumed as fuel, it is a rough estimate. This
means that it is rarely included in global figures and does
not appear in Figure 7.2. About two-thirds of biomass
fuel is used in developing countries for cooking and
heating. The 25% of people in the developed (industrial)
nations consume about six times as much energy as the
other 75% of people living in the developing world.
Biomass has the advantage that it is renewable and does
not contribute to global warming. It is reliable because it
can be burned when needed. However, burning biofuels,
particularly indoors, can lead to respiratory and other
health problems.
Fossil fuels
Oil, coal and gas are all examples of fossil fuels. These
are usually hydrocarbons (compounds of hydrogen and
carbon). When they are burned, they combine with
128
Figure 7.7: Coal is a fossil fuel. A fossil is any living material
that has been preserved for a long time. Usually, its chemica
composition changes during the process. Coal sometimes
shows evidence of the plant material from which it formed.
Sometimes you can see fossilised creatures that lived in
the swamps of the Carboniferous era. These creatures died
along with the trees that eventually became coal.
7 Energy resources
A« material built up on top of these ancient trees, the
Hire on them increased. Eventually, millions of years
i •
II i oinpression turned them into underground reserves
I 1 i onl (Figure 7.7). Today, when we burn coal, the light
hm we see and the warmth that we feel have their origins
l lie energy from the Sun trapped by trees hundreds of
billions of years ago.
I Hl ii nd gas are usually found together. They are formed
|l i
mnilar way to coal, but from the remains of tiny
•'i i linp-like creatures called microplankton that lived
II l he oceans. The oilfields of the Arabian Gulf, North
Ii lea and the Gulf of Mexico, which contain half
। 1 I hi world’s known oil reserves, all formed in the
I l Inccous era, 75 to 120 million years ago.
Figure 7.8: Belleville nuclear power station in France.
hai ning fossil fuels releases carbon dioxide into the
♦inn sphere. This enhances (increases) the greenhouse
'I i ( and is the cause of recent global warming. Coal
I induces more carbon dioxide than oil and natural
1 1 1 Burning coal and oil usually also produces sulfur
III it ide, which leads to acid rain and damage to
• ' ystems and buildings.
( Juestions
I What form of energy is stored in fossil fuels
ii nd biofuels?
What is the difference between biofuels and fossil fuels?
| I Jescribe how fossil fuels are formed.
Nuclear fuels
Niu Icar power was developed in the second half of the
1 II
Ii century. It is a very demanding technology, which
•|litres very strict controls, because of the serious
• i uniige that can be caused by an accident.
i In fuel for a nuclear power station (Figure 7.8) is
u ihilly uranium, sometimes plutonium. These are
• idloactive materials. Inside a nuclear reactor, the
• ' I inactive decay of these materials is speeded up so that
|li* • 'iiergy they store is released much more quickly. This
1« i hi process of nuclear fission.
1 1 n ium is a nuclear fuel. It is a very concentrated store
Mi tiergy in the form of nuclear energy. A typical nuclear
[■ iwur station will receive about one truckload of new
nml iiach week. Coal is a less concentrated energy store.
A unilar coal-fired power station is likely to need a
link' trainload of coal every hour. A wind farm capable
mnerating electricity at the same rate would cover a
Ihiit area of ground - perhaps 20 square kilometres.
1
1
KEY WORDS
nuclear fission: the process by which energy is
released from nuclear fuels by the splitting of a
large heavy nucleus into two or more smaller nuclei
In some countries that have few other resources for
generating electricity, nuclear power provides a lot of
energy. In France, for example, nuclear power stations
generate three-quarters of the country’s electricity.
Excess production is exported to neighbouring countries,
including Spain, Switzerland and the UK.
Nuclear fuel is a relatively cheap, concentrated energy
resource. However, nuclear power has proved to be
expensive because of the initial cost of building the
power stations, and the costs of disposing of the
radioactive spent fuel and decommissioning the stations
at the end of their working lives. Also, accidents like
those at Chernobyl in 1986 and Fukushima in 2011 can
cause radioactive material to be spread over a wide area.
Geothermal energy
The interior of the Earth is hot. This would be a useful
source of energy, if we could get at it. People do make use
of this geothermal energy where hot rocks are found at a
shallow depth below the Earth’s surface. These rocks are hot
because of the presence of radioactive substances inside the
Earth. To make use of this energy, water is pumped down
into the rocks, where it boils. High-pressure stearh returns to
the surface, where it can be used to generate electricity.
KEY WORDS
geothermal energy: energy stored in hot rocks
underground
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Suitable hot underground rocks are usually found in places
where there are active volcanoes. Iceland, for example, has
several geothermal power stations. These also supply hot
water to heat nearby homes and buildings. While energy
from geothermal resources has no obvious disadvantages,
there are few places on Earth where it is available.
Tidal energy
A tidal power station is similar to a hydroelectric power
station: electrical power is generated by moving water.
A barrage (dam) is built across a river estuary (where a
river meets the sea) creating a reservoir. As the tide goes
in and out, water passes through turbines in the dam.
Tidal power has the advantage of being renewable. Also,
tides are predictable making it a fairly reliable energy
resource. However, by flooding estuaries, a tidal power
station can destroy wetlands, an important habitat for
wildlife, particularly migrating birds that use it to feed
and rest before the next leg of their journey. The barrage
can also block shipping routes.
Questions
7
8
9
List the advantages and disadvantages of
nuclear power.
What energy is available from moving water?
In what way is a hydroelectric power station like
a cell (or battery) and how can it be adapted to
act like a rechargeable cell?
Using energy resources to
generate electricity
Many of the energy resources in this chapter produce
electricity so that it can be transferred to where it is
needed. The thermal energy produced when fossil fuel
are burned (Figure 7.9) or when nuclear fission takes
place is used to heat water in a boiler to form steam.
The steam turns the blades of a turbine, transferring
thermal energy into kinetic energy. The turbine is linki
by an axle to a generator where a voltage is induced in
conducting wires when they move in a magnetic field.
You will learn more about generators in Chapter 21.
The details of how thermal energy is produced in powe:
stations that use fuel will vary, but they will all have a
boiler, turbine and generator. Those energy resources tl
do not use a fuel will not need a boiler, but they will stil
use a turbine linked to a generator to produce electricity
Moving air (wind) and moving water (hydroelectricity,
wave and tidal) can turn a turbine directly.
KEY WORDS
boiler: device where thermal energy is transferrei
to water to turn it into steam
turbine: a device that is made to turn by moving aii
steam or water; often used (o generate electricity
generator: a device which generates electricity
using electromagnetic induction
Figure 7.9: A schematic of coal-fired power station. The details of how thermal energy is produced in power stations that i.
fuel will vary but they will all have a boiler, turbine and generator.
130
>
7
ornparing energy resources
(
k. ii h fossil fuels a lot because they represent
|UHri nt rated sources of energy. A modern gas-fired
F
1 nation might occupy the space of a football
•uni and supply a town of 100000 people. To replace
di a wind farm might require 50 or more wind
• ml uir ipread over an area of several square kilometres.
I la । ind is a much more dilute source of energy.
|
1
I Im illustrates some of the ideas that we use when comparing
ill energy resources. Each has its advantages and
I ullages. We need to think about the following factors.
M«n«wability
have seen, there are limited reserves of fossil fuels.
In
I mine applies to uranium nuclear fuel. However,
nr plentiful reserves of alternative nuclear fuels
I hoi ium. All other energy resources are renewable,
i> liuling all those that can be traced back to radiation
h • 1 1 he Sun. The most important advantage of
able resources is that, once installed, they do not
miilbute to global warming.
i
CH
Energy resources
Environmental impact
The use of fossil fuels leads to climate change.
A hydroelectric dam may flood useful farmland.
Every energy source has some effect on the environment.
Questions
10 Which of the following energy resources is renewable?
A
B
oil
nuclear
C
D
biofuels
coal
11 Which of the following energy resources is not
renewable?
A hydroelectric power
B wind
C
D
tidal
nuclear
ACTIVITY 7.2
Sanghera Island
N
I o*t
*■
to in
lumld separate initial costs from running costs. A
i II is expensive to buy but there are no costs for
-unlight is free! While nuclear fuel is cheap, the
liol decommissioning nuclear power plants are high.
Avnil.ibility
ft r uses nuclear power to produce about 75% of its
I ' i u i(y because it has few alternative energy resources.
uh
has plenty of rainfall and mountains so generates
* ml 5% of its electricity from hydroelectric power.
h 1 mil uses geothermal energy, which is quite localised.
i
Hnllnbility
f ' ' nergy supply constantly available? The wind is
*«i i thlc, so wind power is unreliable. Wars and trade
..Tm es can interrupt fuel supplies.
il fuel power station can be compact and still supply
Kilt" population. It would take several square metres
। I n cells to supply a small household. Alternatively,
H i ili lometimes talk about how concentrated or dilute
P i।» i py resource is. When talking about fuels, they are
i"l' 1 1 mg how much energy is stored in a certain mass of
Ite i it I Particularly when comparing wind turbines with
|Hi i nergy resources, people will talk about the land
M» • ii <|uired to generate the same amount of energy.
*i
।
Key
forest
stream
O hot springs
• spot heights
1 km
tracks
Figure 7.10: Map of Sanghera Island.
Part 1
Sanghera Island (Figure 7.10) is a remote fictitious
island. It has no fossil fuels. It is hot with jungle
vegetation, though it can sometimes be cold
at night. High rainfall and mountainousterrain
leads to fast-flowing streams. You are one of 25
members of a scientific expedition planning to
study the island for three years. At the same time
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
ACTIVITY 7.3
as minimising your impact (ecological footprint)
on the island, you are the expert given the job of
Planning meeting
providing all the energy the team will need.
Answer the following questions to develop a plan
that you will present to the team.
1
Describe two ways of providing hot water and
heat for the buildings (living accommodation
and laboratory).
2
Describe two possible ways of supplying heat
for cooking food.
3
How would you supply the electricity needed
for lighting, PCs and machinery?
4
There will be a refrigerator for life-saving
medicines, as well as chemicals, that need to be
stored at a constant temperature. How would
you ensure a constant supply of electricity?
5
Which natural resource on the island should
be conserved?
6
On a copy of the map, mark where you plan
to locate buildings and the energy harvesters
(devices that collect energy from the
environment), showing how you would get the
energy from the harvesters to the buildings, if
necessary. Explain your reasons for choosing
these particular sites.
7
Would your answers be different if the team
had a limited budget? Explain your answer.
8
Describe what other information you
might need before you can make a
recommendation to the team.
Part 2
In a group of four, design your own island and
a brief or set of questions for another group to
decide how they will provide the required energy.
Be prepared to answer questions and have your
own solution in mind.
REFLECTION
Work in a group of three. Each group will be random
allocated a 'power station' that uses a different enerc
resource (such as a wind farm). You will be given the
role of either advocating (supporting) or opposing
planning permission for your allocated power station
to be built close to your community.
You will need to identify the general advantages
or disadvantages of your power station before
identifying the specific advantages or disadvantage
of locating it close to your community.
Each group will present their case as a spoken
presentation, with a whiteboard and pens the
only resources permitted.
• You will be given a short time to agree, as a
class, the criteria forjudging each case. For
example, you might decide to dismiss a cast
if the science is incorrect.
• You will then be allocated your power statioi
Unless it is given as a homework task (when
you could spend time doing more detailed
research), spend about five minutes in your
groups preparing your case.
• Those advocating and opposing each power
station will be called to the front of the class
and each given a maximum of one minute to
put their case to the rest of the class. The class
will have a maximum of 30 seconds to questio
each case. While listening to each case, note
down the advantages and disadvantages of
each power station in a table so that you hav
a summary. Questions from the class and
answers from your teacher should identify
any errors.
•
While you are in the audience, you will score
each presentation out of 10 according to the
criteria agreed. Subtract your vote for the
opposition from your vote for the advocates to
get an overall score. Two examples are given ir
Table 7.1. A negative score suggests oppositio
but, if all proposals are negative, you might be
forced to choose the least-worst option.
Type of power
For
Against
station
Overall
score
Is there an effective method for memorising the
different energy resources? For example, could
you putthem into categories? How will you learn
wind farm
2
4
-2
nuclear
7
3
4
their advantages and disadvantages?
Table 7.1: Example score sheet.
132
>
7 Energy resources
REFLECTION
KEY WORDS
Did you find Activity 7.3 helpful in summarising
the advantages and disadvantages of the
different energy resources? Is there a better
method for learning this material?
water cycle: water evaporates from the surface
of the Earth, rises into the atmosphere, cools,
condenses, and falls as rain
nuclear fusion: the process by which energy is
released when two small light nuclei join together
to form a new heavier nucleus
.2 Energy from the Sun
list of the energy we use can be traced back to
li.ition from the Sun. To summarise:
Fossil fuels are stores of energy that came from the
Sun millions of years ago.
Radiation (light and heat) from the Sun can be
absorbed by solar panels to provide hot water.
Sunlight can also be absorbed by arrays of solar
cells (photocells) to generate electricity. In some
countries, you may see these on the roofs of houses.
Ilie wind is caused when air is heated by the Sun.
Warm air rises; cool air flows in to replace it. This
moving air can be used to generate electricity using
wind turbines.
Most hydroelectric power comes ultimately from
the Sun. The Sun’s rays cause water to evaporate
from the oceans and land surface. This water
vapour in the atmosphere eventually forms clouds
nt high altitudes. Rain falls on high ground, and
van then be trapped behind a dam. This is part of
the water cycle. Without energy from the Sun, there
would be no water cycle and no hydroelectric power.
jwuver, we make use of a small amount of energy
nt does not come from the Sun as radiation. Here are
Kt examples:
I he Moon and the Sun both contribute to the
oceans’ tides. Their gravitational pull causes the
level of the ocean’s surface to rise and fall every
iwclve-and-a-bit hours. At high tide, water can be
1 1 apped behind a dam. Later, at lower tides, it can be
i leased to drive turbines and generators. Because
I his depends on gravity, and not the Sun’s heat and
light, we can rely on tidal power even at night and
when the Sun is hidden by the clouds.
N itclear power makes use of nuclear fuels - mostly
in .inium - mined from underground. Uranium is a
radioactive element, which has been in the
ever
since the Earth formed, together with
round
It
I hr rest of the Solar System, 4.5 billion years ago.
•
Geothermal energy also depends on the presence of
radioactive substances inside the Earth. These have
been there since the Earth formed; they have been
continuously releasing their store of energy ever
since.
The source of the Sun's energy
The Sun releases vast amounts of energy, but it is not
burning fuel in the same way as we have seen for fossil
fuels. It is not a chemical reaction. The Sun consists
largely of hydrogen, but there is no oxygen to burn this
gas. Instead, energy is released in the Sun by the process
of nuclear fusion. In nuclear fusion, four energetic
hydrogen atoms collide and fuse (join together) to form
an atom of helium.
Nuclear fusion requires very high temperatures and
pressures. The temperature inside the Sun is close to 15
million degrees. The pressure is also very high, so that
hydrogen atoms are forced very close together, allowing
them to fuse. At this temperature all the atoms are
ionised. All the electrons have been removed from all the
atoms, creating plasma of positive nuclei and negative
electrons. Atomic nuclei all have a positive charge and
like charges repel so a temperature of about 1 00 million
degrees (and high pressure) is required to overcome this
electrostatic repulsion and get the nuclei close enough
to fuse. The mass of the final nucleus is slightly less than
the combined mass of the initial nuclei and the difference
in mass is turned into energy according to Einstein’s
famous equation: E = me1. The energy, E, released is big
because the mass, m, is multiplied by the speed of light, c,
squared (which is a big number).
Nuclear fusion reactors artificial Suns on Earth?
Scientists have been trying to recreate the same process
artificially here on Earth since the 1950s as it offers
a clean source of almost unlimited energy. It will not
produce greenhouse gases or nuclear waste.
133
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
It is essential to hold the hot plasma in place for long
enough for fusion to take place. In the Sun, the star’s
enormous gravitational field prevents the plasma
escaping. In the 1950s, Soviet physicists came up with the
idea of a tokamak (Figure 7.11) to contain the plasma.
So far, no fusion reactor Was produced more energy thai
needs to be put in to keep the plasma hot. In 1997 Joint
European Torus claimed the world record for getting
out 67% of the input energy. It is hoped that reactors
will get out ten times more energy than is put in. The
International Thermonuclear Experimental Reactor
(ITER) project (Figure 7.12) is being built at Cadaracht
in France. This is an international collaboration that
involves scientists from countries that represent half the
world’s population.
Figure 7.11: China's new tokamak under construction
in Chengdu.
This is a container shaped like a torus (or doughnut)
with a complicated arrangement of magnets to stop the
plasma touching the walls. If the plasma were to touch
the container walls, it would cool (and fusion would
stop) and the container walls would be damaged. This is
why fusion is a very challenging engineering problem.
Fusion reactors on Earth will fuse deuterium and
tritium (two isotopes of hydrogen) to produce helium
and a neutron. Only charged particles (that are moving)
can experience a magnetic force and be confined by a
magnetic field. Neutrons are neutral (have zero charge)
so cannot be confined by the magnetic field and so they
hit the walls of the tokamak. These collisions produce
thermal energy. Heat exchangers in the walls conduct the
thermal energy to heat up water to make steam to turn a
turbine and produce electricity.
134
>
Figure 7.12: Employees in late 2018 building the tokamak
inside the ITER (International Thermonuclear Experimental
Reactor) construction site in France.
\
Questions
1 2 What is plasma?
13 Compare how plasma is confined in a star with hoi
we will achieve the same effect here on Earth.
1 4 Discuss the advantages and disadvantages of
nuclear fusion.
15 What is the difference between nuclear fusion and
nuclear fission?
7 Energy resources
PROJECT
The future of energy resources
There is a huge variety of potential projects in this
Important area of physics. We need energy but
getting it by burning fossil fuels contributes to global
warming. Whatever topic you choose, you need
to pose a question like the one describing thorium
reactors at the start of the chapter. Your answer
ihould be clear, concise and coherent. Write it in
your own words and limit yourself to 1000 words.
Use informative diagrams where you can. Whatever
medium you choose to convey your answer, try to
reach an audience beyond your own classroom.
Or, you could promote (for example, to your friends
.Ind family on social media) good work that you have
discovered during your research. You could:
•
Investigate ways to reduce demand for energy.
In cold countries this might include efforts
to improve building insulation while, in hot
countries, it might be worth thinking about the
development of wind towers to reduce demand
for air conditioning. Or you could focus on the
development of more efficient transport (such
as electric vehicles).
Investigate ways to increase the supply of
energy. This could focus on one of the energy
resources you have already met in this chapter,
or you might investigate one that is under
development (for example, one based on algae).
Investigate the challenges facing development
of the lifters you met at the start of the chapter.
You should look at the process and make a
comparison with nuclear power based on the
uranium cycle.
Investigate fracking. You should explain the
process itself and offer a balanced assessment
of the advantages and disadvantages.
Investigate developments in energy storage,
including improved battery technology, which
might include the environmental impact of
lithium mining.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SUMMARY
Solar panels are used to collect energy from the Sun.
Solar cells (also known as photocells) generate electricity using energy from the Sun.
Oil, coal and natural gas are all examples of fossil fuels.
Coal forms from trees, and oil and natural gas form from microplankton.
Non-renewable energy resources will run out. This includes fossil fuels and nuclear fuel but not biofuel.
Renewable energy resources are replenished (replaced) after they have been used.
Biofuels are renewable, reliable, cheap to set up and use, but are diffuse.
Geothermal energy is harvested (collected) where hot rock is close to the Earth’s surface.
Wind power, wave power and solar power are renewable but unreliable and dilute energy resources. Running
costs are low but they are expensive to set up.
Hydroelectric power, tidal power and geothermal power are renewable, reliable and concentrated energy
resources but suitable locations are limited, and they are expensive to set up.
Nuclear power stations use nuclear fuel, which produces thermal energy by nuclear fission when heavy nuclei
break apart.
The Sun is the origin of all our energy resources except geothermal, nuclear and tidal.
The source of the Sun’s energy is nuclear fusion, when hydrogen fuses (joins) together to form helium.
We are trying to develop nuclear fusion reactors.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which of the following energy resources does not depend on sunlight?
A hydroelectric power
B tidal
C coal
D wind
2 Which of the following energy resources produces greenhouse gases?
A hydroelectric power
B nuclear
136
y
[1 ]
C wind power
D nuclear power station
4 Which of these power stations generates electricity from thermal energy?
A hydroelectric power station
B windfarm
[1]
C biofuels
D natural gas
3 Which of these power stations generates electricity from gravitational
potential energy?
A tidal power station
B geothermal power station
[1 ]
C coal-fired power station
D solar farm
[1 ]
7 Energy resources
NTINUED
1 1 < 1 1 is a list of energy resources available to the world. Some of these are
n newable and some are non-renewable.
| Energy resource
Non-renewable
Renewable
wave power
| hydroelectricity
quothermal
| i oal
nuclear energy
oil
| '.olar energy
natural gas
lidal energy
I
[wind energy
I the table. In the first blank column, put a tick by any three resources
Hi ii ire non-renewable.
।
Ini hi second blank column, put a tick by any three resources that are
i ii
[4]
wable.
Hu ।uestion is about hydroelectric power stations. Water is stored behind
1 1 in. Water released from the dam flows downhill and spins a turbine.
Ih spinning turbine causes a generator to turn, which produces electricity.
4 Write down the two energy transfers that occur in a hydroelectric power
[1]
i.ition.
>lain how electricity from a hydroelectric power station relies on
[2]
nergy from the Sun.
I
electricity
Explain
hydroelectric
for
is
not
constant.
he
demand
how
a
I
[2]
I >wer station can help match supply to demand.
।
1
।
[Total: 5]
1-fired power station and a wind turbine both produce electrical
. The power station produces 2500 MW and the wind turbine
miuces 2.0 MW.
one advantage of using wind turbines instead of a coal-fired
1<
[1 ]
>wer
station to produce electricity.
1
>al-fired power stations still account for one third of the world’s energy
i nsumption. Explain why wind turbines have not replaced them.
[2]
1
i
[Total: 3]
a new power station but has to decide
en a solar power station and a geothermal power station.
upl nn how the location and the climate might affect the decision.
>ti 1 nergy company is proposing
11
t
[4]
COMMAND WORDS
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
state: express in
clear terms
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
9 Imagine that you are writing a science fiction story in which fossil fuels have
run out and the Sun stops shining. Only power stations based on three different
energy resources will continue producing power.
a You want to make your story believable, so what power stations should
[1]
people use if they want to survive?
b As the temperature falls, explain why one of these power stations
might stop working.
[1]
[Total: 2]
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to se<
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Appreciate that electricity is a convenient way of moving
energy to where it is used.
7.1
Recall all the energy resources: fossil fuels, biofuels,
nuclear, geothermal, solar, hydroelectric, tidal, wind
and wave.
7.1
Describe how each energy resource can produce
electricity or other useful forms of energy.
7.1
Give advantages and disadvantages of each energy
resource in terms of renewability, cost, reliability,
availability, scale and environmental impact.
7.1
Understand that the Sun is the origin of all our energy
resources except geothermal, nuclear and tidal.
7.2
Understand that nuclear fusion is the source of the
Sun’s energy.
7.2
Understand that there has been a lot of research into
developing a nuclear fusion reactor.
7.2
138
>
Almost
there
Confiden
to move
Chapter 8
A/ork
and power
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
What is the everyday meaning of 'work'? Do you know what the word 'work' means in physics?
What is the everyday meaning of 'power'? Do you know what the word 'power' means in physics?
THE MACHINE AGE
Scottish engineer, James Watt (Figure 8.1),
developed the steam engine just over two centuries
ago. It delivered the power for Britain to enter
the industrial age. According to legend, Watt's
first customer wanted a steam engine only if it
could pump at least as much water from a well
to his brewery as one of his horses. The brewer
picked his strongest horse and worked him hard
for eight hours. The horse pumped 33 000 lb
(1 lb = 0.453592 kg) of water to a height of one foot
(0.3048 metres) per minute; this is the origin of the
unit of horsepower. As you will see, this is equivalent
to about 750 watts. The watt, W, is the SI unit for
power, named after James Watt. Long before steam
power, humans developed mechanical machines to
perform tasks that might otherwise be impossible
(such as the ramp to build the pyramids). Electric
motors have been developed since.
Discussion questions
1
What are the advantages and disadvantages
of using steam power?
2
Can we produce power without any of the
disadvantages of steam power?
3
The steam engine is a machine that changes
thermal energy (from a difference in
temperature) into mechanical work. What
other machines are mentioned in this section,
and what energy transfers take place?
Figure 8.1: The Golden Boys statue in the UK, which shows Matthew Boulton, James Watt (centre) and William Murdoch
who all played a part in improving the steam engine.
140
>
8
8.1 Doing work
1
Ipure 8.2 shows one way of lifting a heavy object.
I tilling on the rope raises the heavy box. As you pull, the
।
r c moves the box upwards.
I।lift an object, you need a store of energy (as chemical
ncrgy, in your muscles). You give the object more
» invitational potential energy (g.p.e.). The force is your means
i il transferring energy from you to the object. The name given
li ' this type of energy transfer by a force is doing work.
I In more work that a force does, the more energy it
minsfers. The amount of work done is simply the amount
ill e nergy transferred:
work done = energy transferred
IIIUBiHI
I Igure 8.2: Lifting an object requires an upward force, pulling
Work and power
KEY WORDS
work done: the amount of energy transferred
when one body exerts a force on another; the
energy transferred by a force when it moves;
work done = energy transferred
Three further examples of forces doing work are shown
in Figure 8.3.
Mechanical or electrical work is equal to energy transferred.
In this chapter, we are focussing on mechanical work.
Electrical work is discussed in Chapter 18.
How much work?
Think about lifting a heavy object, as shown in Figure 8.2.
A heavy object needs a big force to lift it. The heavier
the object is, and the higher it is lifted, the more its
g.p.e. increases. This suggests that the amount of energy
transferred by a force depends on two things:
the size of the force - the greater the force, the more
work it does
the distance moved in the direction of the force - the
further it moves, the more work it does.
So a big force moving through a big distance does more
work than a small force moving through a small distance.
ilnst gravity. As the box rises upwards, the force also moves
i|>Wards. Energy is being transferred by the force to the box.
.1' i
I flure 8.3: Three examples offerees doing work. In each case, the force moves as it transfers energy, a: Pushing a shopping
Holley to start it moving. The pushing force does work. It transfers energy to the trolley, and the trolley's kinetic energy
(I • increases, b: An apple falling from a tree. Gravity pulls the apple downwards. Gravity does work, and the apple's k.e.
increases, c: Braking to stop a bicycle. The brakes produce a force of friction, which slows down the bicycle. The friction does
work, and the bicycle's k.e. is transferred to the internal energy of the brakes, which get hot.
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Words in physics
KEY EQUATION
You will by now understand that ‘work’ is a word that
has a specialised meaning in physics, different from its
meaning in everyday life. When physicists think about the
idea of work, they think about forces causing movement.
work done by a force = force x distance moved by
the force in the direction of
the force
If you are sitting thinking about your homework, no
forces are causing movement and you are doing no work.
It is only when you start to write that you are doing work
in the physics sense. To make the ink flow from your pen,
you must push against the force of friction, and then you
really are working. Similarly, you are doing work (in the
sense of physics) when you lift up this heavy book.
The phrase ‘in the direction of the force’ will be explainec
shortly. As amount of work done is the same as the
amount of energy transferred, it is measured in joules (J)
the unit of energy.
Many words have specialised meanings in science. In
earlier chapters, we used these words: ‘force’, ‘mass’,
‘weight’, ‘velocity’, ‘moment’ and ‘energy’. Each has a
carefully defined meaning in physics. This is important
because physicists have to agree on the terms they
are using. However, if you look these words up in
a dictionary, you will find that they have a range of
everyday meanings, as well as their specialised scientific
meaning. This is not a problem, provided you know
whether you are using a particular word in its scientific
sense or in a more everyday sense. (Some physicists get
very upset if they hear shopkeepers talking about weights
in kilograms, for example, but no-one will understand
you if you ask for 10 newtons of oranges!)
8.2 Calculating work done
When a force does work, it transfers energy to the object
it is acting on. The amount of energy transferred is equal
to the amount of work done. We can write this as a
simple equation:
W=Fd = ^E
Joules and newtons
=
The equation for the work done by a force (W F x d)
shows us the relationship between joules and newtons.
If we replace each quantity in the equation by its SI
unit, we get 1 J = 1 N x 1 m 1 N m. So, a joule is a
newton metre.
=
KEY WORD
joule (J): the SI unit of transferred energy (or work
done); work done is the force of one newton (1 N)
when applied through a distance of one metre
(1 m); 1 J = 1 N m
WORKED EXAMPLE 8.1
A crane lifts a crate upwards through a height of
20 metres. The lifting force provided by the crane is
5.0 kN, as shown in Figure 8.4.
a How much work is done by the force?
b How much energy is transferred to the crate?
W- ^E
In this equation, we use the symbol A (Greek capital
letter delta) to mean ‘amount of’ or ‘change in’. So,
hE = change in energy
How can we calculate the work done by a force? The work
done depends on two things:
• the size of the force, F
• the distance, d, moved by the force.
We can then write an equation for this:
work done by a force = force x distance moved by
the force in the direction of the force.
In symbols:
W= Fd=^E
142
Figure 8.4
8 Work and power
Forces doing no work
ONTINUED
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what you
want to know.
F= 5.0 kN 5000 N
d = 20 m
W=?
=
Step 2: Write down the equation for work done,
substitute values and solve.
^=Fx</= 5000N x20m
= 100000 Nm = 100000J
Answer
I'he work done by the force is 100 000 J, or 100 kJ.
I > Since work done = energy transferred, 100 kJ of
energy is transferred to the crate.
If you sit still on a chair (Figure 8.6), there are two forces
acting on you. These are your weight, mg, acting downwards,
and the upward contact force, C, of the chair, which stops
you from falling through the bottom of the chair.
Neither of these forces is doing any work on you. The
reason is that neither of the forces is causing movement,
so you do not move through any distance, d. From W = F
x d, the amount of work done by each force is zero. When
you sit still on a chair, your energy does not increase or
decrease as a result of the forces acting on you.
n
weight,
contact
force of
chair, C
Work done and mgh
linked Example 8.1 illustrates an important idea.
I lit force provided by the crane to lift the crate must
i|iliil the crate’s weight, mg. It lifts the crate through a
hi Ight , h. Then the work it does is force x distance, or mg
• h I'he gain in g.p.e. of the crate is mgh. This explains
* here the equation for g.p.e. comes from.
In I igure 8.5, the child slides down the ramp. Gravity
nil*, her downwards, and makes her speed up. To
* ik ulate the work done by gravity, we need to know the
Wltical distance, h, because this is the distance moved in
(In direction of the force. If we calculated the work done
n weight x distance moved down the ramp, we would get
hi nnswer that was too large. Now you should understand
* hy we write the definition of work done like this:
I Y EQUATION
>ork done = force x distance moved in the direction
of the force
Figure 8.6: When you sit still in a chair, there are two forces
acting on you. Neither transfers energy to you.
Figure 8.7 shows another example of a force that is doing
no work. A spacecraft is travelling around the Earth in a
circular orbit. The Earth’s gravity pulls on the spacecraft
to keep it in its orbit. The force is directed towards the
centre of the Earth. However, since the spacecraft’s orbit
is circular, it does not get any closer to the centre of the
Earth. There is no movement in the direction of the force,
and so gravity does no work. The spacecraft continues
at a steady speed (its k.e. is constant) and at a constant
height above the Earth’s surface (its g.p.e. is constant).
Of course, although the force is doing no work, this does
not mean that it is not having an effect. Without the force,
the spacecraft would escape from the Earth and disappear
into the depths of space.
gravity
l(|ure 8.5: It is important to use the correct distance when
* -lie ulating work done by a force. Gravity makes the child
llh Ie down the slope. However, to calculate the energy
|i '"f erred by gravity, we must use the vertical height moved.
1
Figure 8.7: The spacecraft stays at a constant distance from
the Earth. Gravity keeps it in its orbit without transferring any
energy to it.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
WORKED EXAMPLE 8.2
ACTIVITY 8.1
A girl can provide a maximum pushing force of 200 N.
To move a box weighing 400 N onto a platform, she
uses a plank as a ramp, as shown in Figure 8.8.
a How much work does she do in raising the box?
b How much g.p.e. does the box gain?
The efficiency of a ramp
The Ancient Egyptians did not have cranes. It
is believed they used ramps to drag the blocks
into place. The ramp is an example of a simple
machine. It reduces the required force (sometir
called the effort) but this force has to be applie
over a bigger distance than if it were moved
vertically. If there was no friction, the ramp wou
be 100% efficient. However, additional work ne
to be done against friction.
400 N
Figure 8.8
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what you
want to know.
pushing force along the ramp F = 200 N
distance moved along ramp d 2.5 m
weight of box downwards mg 400 N
vertical distance moved h 0.75 m
work done along the ramp W = ?
work done against gravity W ?
=
The Ancient Egyptians are famous for their
pyramids. The pyramids are made from stone
blocks with a mass of at least one tonne. The
useful work done in lifting a block is the weight
of the block multiplied by the vertical distance
is moved. Whether the block is dragged or lifte
work has to be done against the force of gravit
Your task is to design an experiment to work oi
how the efficiency of a ramp depends on the ai
of the slope.
=
=
You need to recall what efficiency is and how tc
calculate it.
You need to decide on:
=
• the equipment you will need (sketch
Step 2: Calculate the work done, W, by the pushing
force along the ramp.
W = pushing force along ramp x distance
moved along ramp
-F^d
a labelled diagram of your assembled
apparatus)
•
= 200Nx2.5m
same)
= 500 J
Step 3: Calculate the gain in g.p.e. of the box. This is
the same as the work done against gravity, W
W' weight of box x vertical distance moved
mg x h
= 400 Nx 0.75 m
= 300 J
=
=
Answer
a The girl does 500 J of work in raising the box.
b The box gains 300 J in g.p.e.
Note: only 300 J is transferred to the box. The
remaining 200 J is the work done against friction as
the box is pushed along the slope.
144
y
your independent, dependent and centre
variables (that is, what you will change, wl
you will measure and what you will keep t
.
•
the measurements that you will take (desi
a table to record them)
• what you need to calculate (what equatio
you will need)
• the graph that you will plot and predict w
your graph should look like.
Then join together to form design teams of thn
First, peer assess each other's work. Then deve
a combined plan, putting together the best of
individual plans.
Discuss your plan with a neighbouring group ai
be prepared to share your ideas with the class.
8 Work and power
PEER ASSESSMENT
When you check the plan in Activity 8.1, go through
this list.
• Does the plan include the correct
equipment? Is anything missing?
• Does the plan include a clear sketch of the
experimental setup?
•
Are the independent, dependent and control
variables identified correctly?
• The experiment requires that one end of
the ramp is raised. Is there a sensible range
of heights? Does the plan explain how the
angle of the slope is calculated?
• Does it suggest repeating measurements
so that an average value of the dependent
variable can be calculated for each value of
the independent variable?
• Does the plan explain how to do any calculations?
• Does the plan explain what to plot on each
axis of the graph?
• Does the plan predict what the graph should
look like?
• Can you carry out the experiment successfully
based on what your classmates have written?
Improve your own work using the feedback on it
born another group.
0.80 m
Figure 8.9: Moving a washing machine.
a
b
c
d
Calculate the work the man does when he
pushes the washing machine up the ramp into
the back of the van against a frictional force
of 440 N.
Superman happens to be passing and he lifts
the washing machine vertically into the van
(without using the plank). Calculate the work
Superman does.
Explain why a and b give different answers,
Calculate the efficiency of the ramp.
8.3 Power
Exercising in the gym (Figure 8.10) can put great
demands on your muscles. Speeding up a treadmill
means that you have to work harder to keep up.
Equally, your trainer might ask you to find out how
many times you can lift a set of weights in one minute.
These exercises are a test of how powerful you are.
The faster you work, the greater your power.
Questions
I
Explain why no work is being done by the Sun’s
gravity on the Earth.
•'
A boy pulls a sled (at a constant speed) with a force
of 50 N for a distance of 250 metres.
How much work does the boy do?
1
A 100 g apple falls from a tree and lands on the
ground 6 metres below.
a What is the force that is pulling the apple, and
how large is the force?
b Calculate how much work gravity does on the
apple as it falls.
c What energy transfer is taking place?
4
A man is trying to move his washing machine into
the back of a removal van. The washing machine has
a weight of 650 N and the floor of the removal van is
0.80 metres above the ground (Figure 8.9).
Figure 8.10: At the gym, it is easier to lift small loads, and to
lift them slowly. The greater the load you lift and the faster
you lift it, the greater the power required. It is the same
with running on a treadmill. The faster you have to run, the
greater the rate at which you do work.
}
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
In physics, the word power is used with a special
meaning. It means the rate at which you do work (that
is, how fast you work). The more work you do, and the
shorter the time in which you do it, the greater your
power. Power is the rate at which energy is transferred, or
the rate at which work is done.
KEY WORD
power: the rate at which work is done, or the rate
at which energy is transferred
•
A locomotive pulling a train of coaches or wagons
does work. The greater the force with which it
pulls and the greater the speed at which it pulls, the
greater the power of the locomotive.
Question
5
Your neighbour is lifting bricks and placing them
on top of a wall. He lifts them slowly, one at a time.
State two ways in which he could increase his power
(the rate at which he is transferring energy to the
bricks).
Fast working
Power tells you about the rate at which a force does work,
that is the rate at which it transfers energy. When you lift
an object up, you are transferring energy to it. Its potential
energy increases. You can increase your power by:
• lifting a heavier object in the same time
• lifting the object more quickly.
It is not just people who do work. Machines also do
work, and we can talk about their power in the same way.
• A crane does work when it lifts a load. The bigger
the load and the faster it lifts the load, the greater
the power of the crane.
8.4 Calculating power
We know from Section 8.3, that power is the rate at
which work is done. Since work done is equal to energy
transferred, we can write these ideas about power as
equations, as shown.
KEY EQUATIONS
power
_ work done
_ W taken
time
power =
energy transferred
time taken
P-^
ACTIVITY 8.2
The meaning of work and power
Work and power have very specific meanings in
physics. You will create a resource that helps people
understand their correct meanings in physics. You could
start by collecting definitions that are wrong in physics.
For example, collect images of powerful people or
cars, or an image of a gymnast performing the 'iron
cross' (Figure 8.11). If you are feeling creative, you
could write a poem or create a song or podcast.
• Work for a few minutes in small groups to
discuss ideas and choose one idea to develop.
• Develop your idea within the timeframe given
by your teacher.
If
• the class is divided into two or three large
groups, you will perform or present your idea to
the other pairs or threes in your group.
• Vote on the other presentations. A pair or three
cannot represent their group unless the physics
is correct so help correct any physics mistakes.
146
>
The pair or three chosen by each group will
present to the rest of the class.
Figure 8.11: This gymnast is performing the 'iron cross'
on rings. It is a move that requires tremendous strength in
the core, arms and wrists. But is he doing any work from a
physics point of view?
Work and power
8
Units of power
CONTINUED
I'ower is measured in watts (W). One watt (1 W) is the
power when one joule (1 J) of work is done per unit time.
Mo one watt is one joule per second.
•
•
•
k.e.
= ±mv2
2
= 4 x 800 kg x (25 m/s)2
= 250 000 J
=
I W 1 J/s
1 000 W = 1 kW (kilowatt)
1 000 000 W = 1 MW (megawatt)
Step 2: Calculate the power.
done
power work
;
time taken
_
I ike care not to confuse IV for work done (or energy
If ansferred) with W for watts. In books, the first of these is
ihown in italic type (as here), but you cannot usually tell
the difference when they are handwritten. SI units are
alien related to each other. It is useful to remember some
ol the connections, such as 1 J = 1 Nm and 1 W = 1 J/s.
_
Answer
KEY WORD
—
250 000 J
10s
25000W
=
= 25kW
The energy is being transferred to the car (from its
engine) at a rate of 25 kW, or 25 kJ per second.
watt (W): the unit of power when 1 J of work is
Car engines are not very efficient. In this example,
the car’s engine may transfer energy at the rate of
100 kW or so, although most of this is wasted as
done per unit time; 1 W = 1 J/s
Power in general
thermal energy.
We can apply the idea of power to any transfer of
energy. For example, electric light bulbs transfer energy
REFLECTION
supplied to them by electricity. They transfer energy
by light and heating. Most light bulbs are labelled
w ith their power rating - for example, 40 W, 60 W,
100 W - to tell the user about the rate at which the bulb
Do you find the problem-solving strategy in the
worked examples useful?
Do you use it all the time?
tuinsfers energy.
Do you have a better approach?
We can express the efficiency of a light bulb or any other
energy-changing device in terms of the power it supplies:
„
.
percentage efficiency =
useful power output , „
x 100%
power input
Questions
6
Hemember, from Chapter 6, how this compares with the
< quation for energy efficiency in terms of energy:
_.
percentage efficiency =
useful energy output ,
x 100%
energy input
7
How many watts are there in a kilowatt?
b How many watts are there in a megawatt?
One horsepower is the power output of one horse
when it lifts a mass of 33 000 lb of water through
a height of one foot in one minute as shown in
Figure 8.12.
a
I’hcre is more about electrical power in Chapter 18.
WORKED EXAMPLE 8.3
A car of mass 800 kg accelerates from rest to a speed
of 25 m/s in 10 s. What is its power?
Step 1: Calculate the work done. This is the increase
in the car’s kinetic energy.
Ah = 1 foot
t
33 000 lb
Figure 8.12: A graphical representation of horse power.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
=
You need to know that 1 lb 0.453592 kg and one
foot = 0.3048 metres.
Calculate the mass of water the horse lifts in
a
one minute.
b Calculate the weight of water the horse lifts in
one minute. (Assume that g = 10 N/kg)
Calculate the work the horse does in one minute.
c
d Calculate the power output of the horse.
An average man needs to eat food containing about
2500 kcal of chemical potential energy per day
(1 kcal 4.18 kJ).
8
=
What is 2500 kcal expressed in joules?
b Calculate the power output of the average man,
even when he is doing no work.
9 It is estimated that the human brain has a power
requirement of 40 W. How much energy does it use
in an hour?
10 A light bulb transfers 1000 J of energy in 10 s.
What is its power?
a
11 An electric motor transfers 100 J in 8.0 s. It then
transfers the same amount of energy in 6.0 s.
Has its power increased or decreased?
ACTIVITY 8.3
ACTIVITY 8.4
What is the power of a world-class sprinter?
Revision boomerang
Work on this problem on your own for three
minutes. Share your ideas with a partner for a
further two minutes. Be prepared to share your
results and thinking with the rest of the class.
The 100 metre sprint world record of 9.58 seconds
was set in the final of the World Athletics
Championships in Berlin in 2009.
• Work out the average speed for a sprinter
You will be in a group of three. Your teacher will
let you know how much time you have to draw a
mind map on a sheet of A3. It should include all
the key terms, concepts and equations related to
energy (from Chapters 6, 7 and 8). Use pictures to
illustrate the ideas where possible, but your mind
map should include:
• the principle of consen/ation of energy and
the various energy stores and energy transfers
• the various energy resources (which ones depend
on sunlight, which are renewable, and so on)
• any equations (both word and symbol) you
need to know (include units in pencil or a
different colour)
•
•
running 100 m in 9.58 s.
Using the average speed, work out the
sprinter's kinetic energy for the race. Assume
that he had a mass of 86 kg.
Work out his power output.
This power output is much smaller than the figure
worked out by a team of Mexican scientists. They
worked out that he had a maximum power output
of about 2600 W and his total mechanical work
was 80 kJ.
• What is missing from your calculation?
• Apart from the fact that he did not run
at a constant speed, are there any other
assumptions you made in your calculation?
• To reach a more realistic value, think about the
forces involved when he is accelerating and
even when he is running at a constant speed.
When your teacher tells you to, pass your mind
map to the person on your left. You receive a mind
map from the person on your right. Your job is to
correct any mistakes and add missing information.
When your teacher tells you, the mind maps will
change hands a second time. Correct and add
as before.
The next time your teacher asks you to pass on the
mind maps, your own mind map should arrive back
with you.
SELF ASSESSMENT
Did you know most of the information for Activity 8.4,
or did your classmates need to add a lot of missing
information?
148
>
If you could not remember as much as you thought
you would, you need to develop a strategy to help
you learn the material (for example, by developing a
set of flash cards).
8 Work and power
PROJECT
How does the stopping distance of a vehicle vary
With its speed?
When a car comes to an emergency stop all its
kinetic energy is transformed into thermal energy
because of the work done by the brakes, W, which
apply a braking (frictional) force, F, throughout
the braking distance. So, W = Fd, where F is the
frictional force and d is the stopping distance.
We can write: |mv2 = Fd.
1
Assume that the mass of the car is 1500 kg
and the braking force is 10000 N. Show that
you get nearly the same braking distance as in
Table 8.1.
2
Find the guidelines published in your country.
Though the physics is the same, different
assumptions might have been made to arrive at
different numbers. If you know how to, develop
a spreadsheet so that calculations for the
different speeds can be done at the same. time.
3
What could reduce the braking force?
4
Work out the braking distance when the
braking force is halved.
5
Work out the reaction time for the thinking
distances in Table 8.1.
6
Work out the thinking distance when the
thinking time is doubled.
7
List the ways in which reaction time for a driver
could increase.
8
Design one of two safety campaign posters.
Use physics (and graphs) to back up your
claims.
Figure 8.13: A collision between a car and a crash test
dummy in order to raise awareness of road safety.
You are going to apply some of the physics you
have learned to keep you and other motorists safer.
Table 8.1 shows how the stopping distance for an
emergency stop is affected by the speed of the car.
An emergency stop is when a driver attempts to
Stop in the shortest possible distance in order to
avoid an accident.
Note that stopping distance = thinking distance +
braking distance. The driver cannot apply the brakes
instantly. Thinking distance is the speed of the car
multiplied by the driver's reaction time. This is the
distance travelled between the driver becoming
aware of a hazard and applying the brakes.
Thinking
distance
/m
Braking
distance
/m
Stopping
distance
8.9
6
6
12
13.4
9
14
23
17.9
12
24
36
22.3
15
38
53
26.8
18
55
73
31.3
21
75
96
Speed /
m/s
/m
Table 8.1: Stopping distances for different speeds.
•
Design a poster urging people to drive
more slowly. A longer stopping distance
reduces the chance that an accident can
be avoided and increases the impact
speed. Emphasise that damage (and
injuries) depends on the kinetic energy of
the car, not its speed.
•
Design a safety campaign poster
urging people not to use their phone
when driving as it could increase their
reaction time.
149
)
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SUMMARY
Energy transferred by a force is called work done.
The amount of work done is the amount of energy transferred.
The amount of work done depends on the size of the force - the greater the force, the more work is done.
The amount of work done depends the distance moved in the direction of the force - the further it moves,
the more work is done.
To calculate the energy transferred by the force of gravity, we must use the vertical height moved.
Work done = force x distance in the direction of the force.
The work done to move a weight vertically upwards is equal to g.p.e.
Power is the rate at which energy is transferred, or the rate at which work is done.
Power can be increased by increasing the work done in a given time.
Power can be increased by reducing the time over which the same work is done.
A r
Recall and use the equation P = —p in simple systems.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
[1]
1 Work done is measured in which of the following units?
A newton
B watt
C kilogram
D joule
[1]
2 Power is measured in which of the following units?
A newton
B watt
C kilogram
D joule
3 A man pushes a 25 kg pram up a slope as shown in the diagram.
He pushes with a force of 150 N along the 20 m slope. How much energy is
dissipated as thermal energy?
A 250J
150
>
B 500J
C 2000J
D 2500J
[2]
8 Work and power
CONTINUED
For each sentence, select the correct word from the list,
work energy more less
_ work than a
a When it moves an object, a smaller force does
bigger force.
b The greater the distance an object is moved by the force, the
work it does.
Power is the rate at which
is transferred.
d Power is the rate at which
is done.
[1]
[1]
[1]
[1]
[Total: 4]
The Empire State Building in New York is the venue for an annual running
competition. Competitors race up 86 floors (1576 stairs) or 320 metres to
finish close to the top. The record fastest time is 9 minutes 33 seconds by
Paul Crake in 2003. His mass was 62.5 kg.
a Calculate Paul Crake’s weight.
[1]
b State the relationship between work done, force and distance.
[1]
Calculate the work done by Paul Crake. Express your answer in kJ
(1 kJ 1000 J).
[2]
d State the relationship between power, work done, and time.
Hl
Calculate Paul Crake’s average power output during his
record-breaking run.
[2]
[Total: 7]
=
The diagram shows a section through a subway station. The track at the
station platform is designed to be higher up than the track in the tunnels.
The driver uses brakes to stop the train at the platform and a motor to
make the train set off. What is the advantage of having the platform higher
up than the track in the tunnels? Explain your answer in terms of the
work done by the brakes and the motor.
[2]
b A subway train has a mass of 270 000 kg (including passengers) and a
maximum kinetic energy of 81.7 MJ.
i State the relationship between kinetic energy (k.e.), mass and velocity. [1]
ii Calculate the maximum velocity of the train.
[3]
[Total: 6]
COMMAND WORDS
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
state: express in
clear terms
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Understand that work done equals energy transferred.
8.1
Relate work done to the force multiplied by the distance
moved in the direction of the force.
8.2
Recall and use W = Fd. = hE.
8.2
Understand the relationship between power, work done
and time.
8.3
Recall and use the equation P =
152
AU
for simple problems.
8.4
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
Chapter 9
The kinetic
particle mode
of matter
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
Work with a partner. Take a large sheet of paper
and write the words 'solid', 'liquid' and 'gas' on
the paper.
melting
liquid
Around each word, write as much as you can about
that state of matter. You can include drawings.
Using a different coloured pen, make as many
links as you can between the three words.
gas
Figure 9.1: Making links between words.
MELTING ICE LEADS TO MAGMA FLOW
magma to flow. The melting of the glaciers is linked
to global warming, which is caused bj^the changes
to gases in the atmosphere. Changes of state, such
as the melting of glaciers, can have dramatic effects.
We are familiar with the changes th<t happen
when ice melts. A glass-like solid changes into a
transparent, colourless, runny liquid. Heat the liquid
and it 'vanishes' into thin air. Although this sounds
like a magic trick, it is so familiar that it does not
surprise us. It is more surprising when we see solid
rock heat up and become magma.
In this chapter, we will look at materials and their
different states - solid, liquid and gas. We will
consider how the particles in matter behave and
how this can help us explain some of the things we
Figure 9.2: Scientists in Arizona and Oxford have shown
a correlation between the melting of glaciers and an
increase in volcanic eruptions such as this one in Iceland
which erupted in 2010.
The volcano in Figure 9.2 is erupting. High
temperatures inside the earth have melted the rock
creating magma. Scientists believe the eruption
may have been triggered by the melting of the
glacier situated above the volcano. The glacier
melting meant there was less ice pressing down on
the rocks. This reduced the pressure on the magma
underneath the rocks. This made it easier for
154
>
observe when materials change from one state to
another.
Discussion questions
1
List ten solids, ten liquids and ten gases.
Are there any substances which are hard to
categorise?
2
The Earth is distinctive among the planets of
the Solar System in being the only planet on
which water is found to exist naturally in all
three of its physical states. Discuss how life on
Earth would be affected if one of the states of
matter did not exist.
9
The kinetic particle model of matter
A.
9.1 States of matter
n
Figure 9.3: Ice cubes have a fixed
Figure 9.4: This coloured water
Figure 9.5: The steam leaving the
pot quickly condenses to form
shape.
takes the shape of the flasks.
water droplets.
State
solid
liquid
gas
Size
rigid, fixed shape, fixed
volume; cannot be squashed
not rigid, no fixed shape,
fixed volume; cannot be
not rigid, no fixed shape,
no fixed volume; can be
squashed
squashed
takes the shape of its
takes the shape of its
expands to fill its container
container
container
Shape
Table 9.1: The distinguishing properties of the three states of matter.
Matter exists in three states: solid, liquid and gas.
An example of this is water which can exist as solid ice,
liquid water or steam which is an invisible gas. Steam
quickly condenses in air to form tiny water droplets,
which are what we see. We can describe these states by
describing their shape and volume (size). Table 9.1 shows
how these help us to distinguish between solids, liquids
and gases.
Changes of state
Heat a solid and it melts to become a liquid. Heat the liquid
and it boils to become a gas. Cool the gas and it becomes
first a liquid and then a solid. These are changes of state.
The names for these changes are shown in Figure 9.7.
GAS
evaporation
or boiling
Figure 9.6: The volume of a liquid stays the same.
Figure 9.6 shows a famous psychology experiment. A
young child will usually think the taller glass holds more
water even when they see it being poured from the wider
glass. The child does not realise yet that a liquid has a
fixed volume. Although the drink changes its shape when
you pour it from one glass to the other, its volume stays
the same.
condensing
LIQUID
melting
solidifying
SOLID
Figure 9.7: Naming changes of state.
155
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Another word for a liquid changing to a gas is
evaporation. We will see the difference between
evaporation and boiling later.
9.2 The kinetic particle
model of matter
KEY WORDS
In this section, we will use a model to help us explain t
behaviour of materials. Scientists often use models to
explain things which we cannot see directly. Using this
model will help us answer questions such as:
• why does an ice cube change shape as it melts?
• how can we smell perfume from across a room?
• why does it take time to melt a solid?
states of matter: solid, liquid or gas
changes of state: changing from one state of
matter to another
evaporation: changing from a liquid to a gas at
any temperature
The model is called the kinetic particle model of matter.
The word ‘kinetic’ means related to movement. All mat
is made up of tiny particles - atoms, molecules or ions.
When a substance is heated, its particles gain energy an
move faster. The higher the temperature, the faster the
particles move.
boiling: changing from liquid to gas at a fixed
temperature called the boiling point
melting: changing from solid to liquid
condensing: changing from gas to liquid
solidifying/freezing: changing from liquid
to solid
KEY WORDS
model: a way of representing a system which we
cannot experience directly
kinetic particle model of matter: a model in
which matter consists of moving particles
atom: the smallest part of an element that can exis
molecule: two or more atoms joined together by
Questions
1
Copy and complete these sentences:
The three states of matter are
,
A solid has a definite shape and
and
chemical bonds.
. A liquid
has a definite
but takes the shape of its
container. A gas will expand to fill all the
available.
When a solid is heated it
to make a
The temperature this happens at is called the
.
The boiling point is the temperature at which a
turns to a
.
2
a
b
c
3
156
What name is given to the temperature at which
a gas condenses to form a liquid?
What name is given to the process during which
a liquid changes into a solid?
What name is given to the temperature at which
this happens?
To measure the volume of a liquid, you can pour
it into a measuring cylinder. Measuring cylinders
come in different shapes and sizes - tall, short, wide,
narrow. Explain why the shape of the cylinder does
not affect the measurement of volume.
>
There are many different types of particles with diffen
chemical properties. In this chapter we will look at hoi
these particles move rather than how they react. We w
draw all the atoms and molecules as spheres and refer
them all as particles.
carbon dioxide molecule
W
-
&
nitrogen molecule
oxygen molecule
water molecule
argon atom
**
X.
ww
<A»
*
w
*
Mw
<
W
Mu
•
*•
**
***
**
Figure 9.8a: Air is a mixture of elements and compounds
9 The kinetic particle model of matter
substance cools down its particles lose kinetic energy and
slow down. This suggests that there is a theoretical lower
limit to how cold anything can be. If the particles lose all
their kinetic energy and stop moving, it is not possible for
the substance to cool any further.
The lowest possible temperature anything can reach is
-273 °C. This is also known as absolute zero.
KEY WORDS
*
9.8b: For this model we will assume all atoms and
>lm ules are identical spherical particles.
absolute zero: the temperature at which particles
have no kinetic energy
i li" Idea that matter is made up of identical, spherical
mi'Ii c ules is a great simplification, but using this model
w ill help to explain the behaviour of materials.
Describing the particle structure
of solid, liquids and gases
I me 9.9 shows how we picture the particles in a solid, a
"
liquid and a gas. Each state of matter can be described by
iI*m ribing the arrangement, separation and motion
il IT particles.
Particle movement and
temperature
1 metic theory uses the idea that as particles heat up
ihcv gain more kinetic energy and so move faster. As a
Arrangement and separation of particles
Figure 9.9: Representations of a: gas, b: liquid, c: solid. The
arrangement, separation and motion of the particles change
as the gas cools to become a liquid and then a solid.
Motion of particles
Solid
The particles are packed closely together, in Because the particles are so tightly packed, they
a regular pattern. Notice that each particle is cannot move around. However, they do move a bit.
in close contact with all its neighbours.
They can vibrate about a fixed position. The hotter
the solid, the more they vibrate.
I Iquid
The particles are packed slightly less
closely together than in a solid. The particles
are arranged randomly rather
than in a fixed pattern.
Gas
Because the particles are slightly less tightly
packed than in a solid, they can move around. So
the particles are both vibrating and moving from
place to place. The hotter the liquid is, the faster its
molecules move.
The particles are widely separated from
The particles move freely about, bouncing off one
one another. They are no longer in contact,
another and off the walls of the container. In air at
unless they collide with each other. In air, the room temperature, the average speed of the particles
average separation between the particles is is about 500 m/s and this increases with temperature.
about ten times their diameter.
Table 9.2: The arrangement and motion of particles in the three different states of matter. Compare these statements with
the diagrams shown in Figure 9.9.
157
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Evidence for the kinetic model
Atoms and molecules are far too small to see, even with a
microscope, but experiments show the effects of moving
atoms and molecules. These experiments do not prove
there are moving particles, but they do provide support
for the idea.
In 1827, a scientist called Robert Brown was using a
microscope to study pollen grains when he noticed tiny
particles jiggling about. At first he thought that they
might be alive, but when he repeated his experiment with
tiny grains of dust suspended in water, he saw that the
dust also moved around. This motion is now known as
Brownian motion, and it happens because the moving
particles are constantly knocked about by the fast¬
moving particles of the air.
KEY WORDS
Brownian motion: the motion of small particles
suspended in a liquid or gas, caused by molecular
bombardment
We can use a smoke cel) (Figure 9.10a). This is a sma
glass box which contains air with a small amount of
smoke. The cell is lit from the side, and the microscoj
used to view the smoke particles.
The smoke particles show up as tiny specks of light,
but they are too small to see any detail of their shape
What is noticeable is the way they move. If you watcl
a single particle, you will see that it follows random
path, frequently changing direction. This is because e
molecules repeatedly hit the smoke particle.
Explanations using the
kinetic model
The kinetic model of matter can be used to explain n
observations. Here are some of them:
•
Liquids take up the shape of their container
because their particles are free to move about wi
the liquid.
•
Gases fill their container beca use their particles।
move about with complete freedom.
•
Solids keep their shape because the particles are
packed tightly together.
•
Gases diffuse (spread out) from place to place, si
that, for example, we can smell perfume across t]
room. The perfume particles spread about becat
they are free to move.
observations what you see happening in an
experiment
We can do a similar experiment using smoke particles.
The oxygen and nitrogen molecules that make up the air
are far too small to see, so we have to look at something
bigger, and look for the effect of the air molecules.
cover slip
smoke cell
smoke
Figure 9.10a: An experimental arrangement for observing Brownian motion. The smoke particles are just large enough t<
show up under the microscope. The air molecules that collide with them are much too small to see. b: The invisibly small
molecules repeatedly hit the smoke particle making it change direction. The dotted line shows the path of the smoke pari
.
158
>
9
Dissolved substances diffuse throughout a liquid.
Sugar crystals in a drink dissolve and molecules
spread throughout the liquid, carried by the mobile
particles. In a hotter drink, the particles are moving
faster and the sugar diffuses more quickly.
Most solids expand when they melt. The particles
are slightly further apart in a liquid than in a solid.
Liquids expand a lot when they boil. The particles
of a gas are much further apart than in a liquid. We
can think about this the other way round. Gases
contract a lot when they condense. If all of the air
in the room you are now in was cooled enough, it
would condense to form a thin layer of liquid, two
or three millimetres deep, on the floor.
The kinetic particle model of matter
KEY WORDS
attractive forces: forces between particles which
hold the particles in fixed positions in a solid
bonds: another name for the forces between
particles
ACTIVITY 9.1
Demonstrating the kinetic model
The kinetic theory can be modelled using small
balls or marbles in a tray.
More on Brownian motion
The molecules in air have an average diameter of about
4 x 1O“10 metres. This makes them impossible to see with
i laboratory microscope. The smoke particles consist of
inany molecules and so are many times larger than the
Air molecules. A smoke particle has a diameter of about
I x 10"7 metres, which is about 250 times the diameter
i>f the air molecules. The air molecules are light but fast
moving and so have enough kinetic energy to cause the
tfnoke particles to change direction on impact.
Forces and the kinetic model
We have seen that the kinetic model of matter can explain
I Ihe differences between solids, liquids and gases. We
Figure 9.11: Modelling kinetic theory using marbles in
a tray.
<'nn explain some other observations if we add another
1
scientific idea to the kinetic theory: we need to consider
Ihe forces between the particles that make up matter.
i Why do the particles that make up a solid or a liquid stick
Place some identical small balls or marbles on
a shallow tray. They should cover about onequarter of the area of the tray.
2
Tip the tray slightly so that the balls all roll to
the lower end. The pattern they form is like
the arrangement of particles in a solid.
3
Keep the tray slightly tipped and shake it
gently so that the balls can move about. This
is like a liquid.
4
Keep shaking the tray and tip it so that it,,
becomes horizontal. The balls move around
freely, colliding with each other and the sides
of the tray. This is like the particles in a gas.
j together? There must be attractive forces (forces pulling
them together) between them. Without attractive forces
Io hold together the particles, there would be no solids or
liquids, only gases. No matter how much we cooled matter
<|own, it would remain as a gas.
Another way to refer to these forces is to say that there
.tre bonds between the particles. Each particle of a solid
I In strongly bonded to its neighbours. This is because the
i
forces between particles are strongest when the particles are
dose together. In a liquid, the particles are slightly further
apart and so the forces between them are slightly weaker.
In a gas, the particles are far apart, so that the particles do
not attract each other and can move freely about.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Your task is to make a video, or a presentation to
explain the kinetic model, using the tray of balls.
You could:
•
•
•
show the arrangement and movement of
particles in each of the three states
demonstrate absolute zero
demonstrate and explain changes of state melting, boiling, condensing and freezing
•
model Brownian motion (hint: use a larger,
different-coloured ball for the smoke particle)
•
add some different-coloured balls to one
corner of the tray to represent perfume; show
how the perfume diffuses (spreads out).
Questions
4
5
6
7
Sketch three diagrams to show the arrangement of
molecules in a solid, a liquid and a gas.
a In which state of matter are the particles most
closely packed?
b In which state of matter are they most widely
separated?
c In which state do the particles move fastest?
a Describe what is meant by Brownian motion.
b How can the kinetic model be used to explain
Brownian motion?
c A student did an experiment to observe
Brownian motion. She then repeated the
experiment in a much colder room.
Describe and explain how her observations
would change.
Use the kinetic model of matter to explain why we
can walk through air and swim through water but
we cannot walk through a solid wall.
9.3 Gases and the
kinetic model
The kinetic model can help us understand how gases
behave. Thinking about the particles in a gas helps us
answer questions about the gas.
160
Why does a gas cause pressure on the walls of its
container? Figure 9.12 shows the particles that mak<
up a gas. The particles of a gas move around inside
its container, bumping into the sides. The gas causes
pressure on the walls of the container because the g;
particles are constantly colliding with the walls.
>
Figure 9.12: Moving gas particles in a container.
What happens to a gas when it is heated? Figure 9.1
shows the same gas at a higher temperature. The hig
the temperature of a gas, the faster its particles are
moving. The particles will hit the walls more often a
with more force. This increases the pressure.
Figure 9.13: Heating the gas in a container.
What happens when a gas is compressed (squashed
Figure 9.14 shows the same gas again. This time th
volume of the container has been decreased. The g
has been compressed into a smaller space. The par
don’t move as far between collisions, so they collid
the walls more often. Decreasing the volume of a j
increases its pressure.
9 The kinetic particle model of matter
To produce a loud sound the girl in Figure 9.16 needs to
blow out with as much pressure as she can. Musicians
learn to breathe from their diaphragm. Figure 9.17 shows
how the girl’s diaphragm moves down so a large volume
of air can enter her lungs. Her diaphragm then moves up,
reducing the volume and so increasing the pressure of
the air she blows out and the loudness of her music.
gas molecule
container
l ujure 9.1 4: Decreasing the volume of a gas in a container.
Figure 9.17: The diaphragm moves down as you breathe in
and up as you breathe out.
I ijure 9.15: Pumping up tyres means squashing a lot more
particles into a fixed space. This increases the pressure.
Questions
8
I In cyclist in Figure 9.15 needs to understand gas
pressure. He pumps air into his tyres to make them hard.
Il Ilie temperature rises, the pressure in his tyres will
'
tease even more. This could burst his tyres.
9
1
n|ure 9.16: You need air pressure to play the trumpet.
Copy and complete the paragraph.
are constantly moving
The molecules in a
freely and rapidly and so hit the walls of the
container. This creates
on the walls. When
the gas is heated, the molecules move
and
When the gas is compressed,
the pressure
the molecules hit the walls more often and the
pressure
.
A balloon is inflated by blowing air into it. Explain
what would happen if an inflated balloon was put in
a freezer.
10 A tin can containing air is tightly sealed so no air
can escape. The can is then heated. Describe what
happens to:
the speed of the air molecules inside the can
a
b how often the air molecules hit the walls of
the can
the force with which the air molecules hit
c
the walls
d the pressure on the walls of the can.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
9.4 Temperature and the
Celsius scale
Temperature is a measure of how hot or cold something
is. Temperature is measured using a thermometer.
Most thermometers take a minute or so to measure
temperature. This is because thermal energy has to be
transferred to or from the thermometer until it is at the
same temperature as the thing it is measuring.
A bath of water at 50 °G can have the same temperati
as a cup of tea, but it has more internal energy than t
cup of tea because it has far more molecules.
KEY WORDS
temperature: a measure of how hot or cold
something is; a measure of the average energy c
the particles in a substance
The temperature of a firework may reach 1500 °C, wl
means its particles have very high kinetic energy, but
has less total energy than the bath because it has very
few particles.
Figure 9.18a: Thermal energy transfers from the girl to
the thermometer until they are at the same temperature,
b: Thermal energy transfers from the thermometer to the
ice until they are at the same temperature.
Temperature and internal energy
A thermometer tells us about the average energy of
the particles in the object whose temperature we are
measuring. It does this by sharing the energy of the
particles. If they are moving rapidly, the thermometer
will indicate a higher temperature. Placing a
thermometer into an object to measure its temperature
is rather like putting your finger into some bath water
to detect how hot it is. Your finger does not have a scale
from 0 to 100, but it can tell you how hot or cold the
water is, from uncomfortably cold to comfortably warm
to painfully hot.
The temperature of an object is a measure of the average
kinetic energy of its particles. Because it is the average
kinetic energy of a particle, it does not depend on the
size of the object.
• Internal energy is the total energy of all of the
particles.
Temperature
is a measure of the average kinetic
•
energy of the individual particles.
162
y
Figure 9.1 9: The firework has the fastest particles and si
the highest temperature. The bath water has many more
particles and much more internal energy than the tea.
9 The kinetic particle model of matter
The Celsius temperature scale
The melting and boiling points of water are used to
define the Celsius temperature scale.
The Kelvin temperature scale starts from absolute zero,
or -273 °C. Temperatures measured on this scale are
called absolute temperatures. Scientists often measure
temperatures using the Kelvin scale. A change in
temperature of one degree is the same for both scales.
The Kelvin temperature (T) can be calculated from the
Celsius temperature (0) using the equation:
T(K) = 0(°C) + 273
KEY EQUATION
conversion between Kelvin temperature and degrees
Celsius:
T(K)
Figure 9.20: A modem liquid-in-glass thermometer.
Thermometers like the one shown in Figure 9.20 are used
in school laboratories. The bulb contains a liquid which
expands when it gets hot. The liquid moves into the tube
and we can read the temperature on the scale.
The liquid used is usually alcohol. This expands a lot
when heated and it is safe.
Some thermometers use mercury. Mercury thermometers
can be used at very low temperatures. Mercury is
poisonous so mercury thermometers are not used in
ichools.
The scale was devised by the Swedish scientist Anders
Celsius.
1 1is scale is known as the Celsius scale. It has two fixed points:
•
0 °C: the melting point of pure ice at atmospheric
pressure
•
100 °C: the boiling point of pure water at
atmospheric pressure.
= 0(°C) + 273
WORKED EXAMPLE 9.1
Calculate the absolute temperature of the human
body. Assume that the temperature of the human
body is 37 °C.
T(K)
= 0 (°C) + 273
T= 37 + 273 = 310K
KEY WORDS
fixed points: known values used to calibrate a
measuring instrument
calibrate: to mark a standard scale on to a
measuring instrument
Kelvin temperature scale: (or the absolute
temperature scale) the temperature measured
from absolute zero. A difference in temperature of
1 kelvin is the same as a difference of 1 °C. 0 K is
approximately -273 °C
Bach time he made a new thermometer, Celsius would
Calibrate it. He put the thermometer in melting ice and
marked 0 °C on the thermometer. He then put it in
boiling water and marked 100 °C. He then divided the
ipace between these points into 100 parts. Each part
represents one degree Celsius.
Questions
The Kelvin temperature scale
11 Copy and complete these sentences.
A thermometer is used to measure
a measure of how hot something is.
It is measured in
or
Temperature depends on how fast the
1 inetic theory suggests there is a limit to how low
temperatures can go. The lowest possible temperature
( ihc point at which molecules have no kinetic energy) is
273 °C. This is called absolute zero.
moving.
12 A laboratory thermometer has no temperature
markings. Describe how you could use ice and
boiling water to calibrate the thermometer.
,.which is
are
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
13 Calculate the temperature in kelvin of:
a a classroom at 20 °C
b lava at 800 °C
c the surface temperature of minor planet Pluto
at -233 °C.
9.5 The gas laws
The temperature, pressure and volume of a gas all affect
each other. The gas laws explain mathematically how the
three affect each other. There are laws describing how each
of these quantities affects the others, but we will look just
at the law connecting the pressure of a gas and its volume.
It is important to be clear about what the terms
‘temperature’, ‘pressure’ and ‘volume’ mean. The gas
laws all refer to a fixed mass of gas. Imagine the gas in a
sealed container which can be squashed or heated. The
number of molecules does not change.
The effect of increasing the pressure on a gas can I
investigated using the simple apparatus shown in F
9.21. Adding weights increases the pressure and ca
the volume of the gas to decrease.
Figure 9.22 shows a more accurate method. In this
apparatus, some air is trapped inside the vertical gl
tube. The oil in the bottom of the apparatus can be
compressed with a pump, so that it pushes up insid
tube, compressing the air. The volume of the air ca
read from the scale. The pressure exerted on it by tl
can be read from the dial gauge.
Increasing the pressure on the gas decreases its voh
Table 9.3 shows some typical results. Boyle found a
mathematical relationship between the pressure, p,
the volume, V, of the gas.
The temperature of a gas is a measure of the average
kinetic energy of the molecules. In a hot gas, the
molecules move faster than in a cold gas.
The pressure of a gas is caused by atoms or molecules
hitting the walls, changing momentum and so causing a
force. The pressure is the force per unit area on the walls
of the container.
Pressure and volume
In 1 662, Robert Boyle, a physicist and chemist,
investigated the relationship between the pressure on a
gas, p, and its volume, V.
Figure 9.21: Increasing the pressure on a gas decreases its
volume.
164
y
Figure 9.22: Apparatus for increasing the pressure on
gas. A fixed mass of air is trapped inside the tube, and
pressure on it is increased.
Pressure,
Volume,
Pressure x volunr
p/Pa
V/cm3
pV/Pacm3
WO
60
6000
125
48
6000
150
40
6000
200
30
6000
250
24
6000
300
20
6000
Table 9.3: Typical results for an experiment into pressu
and volume of gas. The temperature of the gas does m
change.
9 The kinetic particle model of matter
Hoyle’s experiments showed that increasing the pressure
ure
es
decreased the volume. This is shown in Figure 9.23a.
Figure 9.23b shows that plotting p against -p gives a
straight-line graph passing through the origin.
Finally, we can write the relationship in words: the
volume of a fixed mass of gas is inversely proportional to
its pressure, provided its temperature remains constant.
KEY WORDS
he
ne
oil
Volume, V
e.
d
Figure 9.23: Two graphs to represent the results of a Boyle's
Idw experiment, a: The graph of pressure against volume
ihows that increasing the pressure causes a decrease in the
Volume, b: The mathematical relationship between p and —
in be seen from this graph. It is a straight line through the
ijrigin, which means that pressure is inversely proportional to
Volume.
Hoyle also found that when he multiplied pressure by
Volume, he always got the same result. You can see this in
the last column of Table 9.3.
inversely proportional: two quantities are
inversely proportional when increasing one
quantity decreases the other by the same factor;
doubling one quantity halves the other
WORKED EXAMPLE 9.2
A scuba diver releases a bubble of air. The bubble has
a volume of 2 cm3. He watches it rise to the surface,
expanding as it rises. The diver is at a depth where the
pressure is 5 atmospheres. What will the volume of
the bubble be when it reaches the surface, where the
volume is 1 atmosphere? Assume that the temperature
does not change.
KEY EQUATION
Step 1: Write down the initial and final values of the
quantities that we know.
Pi = 5 atmospheres
K] 2 cm3
p2 1 atmosphere
/2 = ?
relationship between pressure and volume for gas at
a constant temperature:
Step 2: Write down the Boyle’s law equation and
substitute values.
Ibis can be written mathematically as:
pV = constant
=
=
P\V\ =P2V2
pV = constant
This relationship can be expressed in different ways. We
can write the same idea in a way that is useful for doing
5 atmospheres x 2 cm3 = 1 atmosphere x U,
Step 3: There is only one unknown quantity in this
equation (V2). Rearrange it and solve.
Calculations:
P2
_ 5 atmospheres x 2 cm3 _
initial pressure x initial volume = final pressure x
final volume
Or: PiVi-p2V2
Where px and Vx are one pair of readings of pressure and
Volume, and p2 and V2 are another pair.
Doubling the pressure halves the volume. This means
that pressure is inversely proportional to volume. Using
the symbol * (‘is proportional to’), we can write:
or
3
1 atmosphere
Answer
The volume of the air increases to 10 cm3.
Worked Example 9.2 shows how to use the equation
Pi “ Pi ^2 to And how the volume of a gas changes
when the pressure on it is changed. You can use the same
equation to work out how the pressure changes when the
volume is changed.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Units
In the equation Pi^- P2^2> it does not matter what
units we use for p and V, as long as we use the same units
for both values of p and the same units for both values
of V.
The standard unit of pressure is the Pascal (Pa).
1 Pa = 1 N/m2. Pressure can also be measured in kPa,
N/cm2 or atmospheres. One atmosphere is approximately
100 kPa.
Volume is usually measured in m3, dm3, cm3 or litres.
Questions
14 What do each of the terms in the equation
Pi ^i = Pi ^2 represent?
15 The pressure on 6 dm3 of nitrogen gas is doubled at a
fixed temperature. What will its volume become?
16 A flask holds 6 litres of air at a pressure of
2 atmospheres. Calculate the volume when the
gas is compressed by increasing the pressure to
6 atmospheres. Assume that the temperature
remains constant.
REFLECTION
Physics involves a lot of calculations. Presenting
your calculations clearly helps you check your
work. It also helps you identify any errors.
Look back over your calculations. Which steps are
you using?
•
Identify which values are given in the question.
•
Check that the units are consistent and
change them if necessary.
•
Write down the equation.
•
Substitute values into the equation.
•
Rearrange the equation if needed.
•
Calculate the answer.
•
Give units for the answer.
Can you make your calculation answers more
clear? Make a note of what you could improve and
refer to this next time you are doing calculations.
PROJECT
Making a game
Put all the cards face down on a table, making sure
they are mixed up.
Players take turns to turn over two cards. If they
match, the player keeps them and takes another go.
If they don't match, the player turns them face down
again and the next player takes a turn.
The winner is the player with most cards at the end.
Banned words
In this game a player takes a card which has a key
word on it and a list of banned words.
Your task is to make a game to check how well you
have understood this topic. You can invent your own
game or use one of the ideas below.
Pairs
Make pairs of cards, one with a key word and the other
with its definition. Do this for as many key words or ideas
as you can find. Be creative - for example, you could
draw Brownian motion rather than write a definition.
166
>
An example is shown here.
The player has to describe
the word 'condensation' to their
team without using any of the
banned words. They could say,
'it is the change of state that
happens when water vapour
turns to water'.
Condensation
• liquid
• gas
• cool
• particle
9
The kinetic particle model of matter
CONTINUED
You can make your game harder or easier by the
words you choose for your banned list.
Make a set of cards for the following words
and phrases: solid, liquid, gas, vapour, melting,
evaporation, condensation, freezing, melting point,
boiling point, kinetic model of matter, Brownian
motion, temperature, diffuse, expand, change of
state, Boyle's law, Pascal.
When you have made your cards, swap with another
group and play the game. Players take turns
choosing a card and describing the word to their
team. The aim is to get through all the cards as
quickly as possible.
SUMMARY
Matter can exist in three states - solid, liquid and gas.
Solids have a fixed shape and volume. Liquids have a fixed volume but take the shape of their container. Gases
expand to fill their container.
The kinetic model explains the behaviour of materials by describing what is happening to the particles of which
they are made.
According to the kinetic model, matter is made of moving particles that are close together in solids and liquids,
and far apart in gases.
There are attractive forces between particles that act strongly when the particles are close together.
In Brownian motion, the movement of water or air particles is revealed by their effect on visible grains of pollen
or smoke particles.
As the temperature of a substance increases, the kinetic energy of its particles increases.
The particles of a gas bombard the walls of its container. This causes pressure. Increasing temperature increases
pressure. Decreasing the volume increases the pressure.
Temperature can be measured using the Kelvin temperature scale which has its zero at -273 °C.
Pressure and volume are related by the equation p V = constant.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which one of these statements is describing a gas?
It expands to fill the volume of its container.
B It has a fixed size and shape.
C It has a fixed volume but takes up the shape of its container.
D It has strong forces between the particles.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
2 Brownian motion can be observed by looking at smoke particles under a
microscope. What causes the movement of the smoke particles?
A The smoke particles are moved by air currents.
B The smoke particles hit the walls of the container.
C Air molecules bit the smoke particles.
D There are strong forces between the smoke particles.
3 Describe the differences between solids, liquids and gases in terms of the
arrangement and movement of their particles.
[1]
COMMAND WORD
[6]
4 A student observes smoke particles under a microscope. The smoke is lit
up so she sees the smoke particles as dots of light.
[1 ]
a Describe the movement of the smoke particles.
[1 ]
causing
b Name the particles which are
this movement.
c Explain why observation of this movement provides evidence for the
[2]
kinetic model of matter.
[Total: 4]
5 The diagram shows a syringe containing a small amount of air.
The end of the syringe is sealed so no air can enter or leave.
describe: state the
points of a topic; givi
characteristics and
main features
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
determine: establish
an answer using the
information available
K state: express in
clear terms
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
[1 ]
a Determine the amount of air in the syringe from the diagram.
b A student pushes in the end of the syringe, compressing the gas.
State and explain what happens to the pressure of the air.
c The syringe is placed on a radiator. After a while, the student notices
that the volume of the air has increased. Explain in terms of the air
molecules why this has happened.
[2]
[2]
[Total: 5]
6 a Before going for a bike ride, a cyclist pumps his tyres up so they have a
pressure of 2.5 atmospheres. Straight after his ride, the cyclist checks his
[2]
tyre pressure. It is now 4 atmospheres. Explain why it has increased.
b After a few minutes, the pressure returns to 2.5 atmospheres. He releases
the air so the pressure drops to 1 atmosphere. The tyre has a volume of
1200cm3. Calculate the volume of air that will be released from the tyre. [4]
[Total: 6]
168
>
9
The kinetic particle model of matter
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
i’ter studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
ly gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
See
1 can
Topic...
Describe the shape and volume of solids, liquids
and gases.
Draw and explain particle diagrams showing the
separation and arrangement of particles in solids, liquids
and gases.
Describe the movement of particles in all three states
of matter.
9.2
Describe and explain Brownian motion.
9.2
Use the kinetic model to explain gas pressure.
9.3
Describe and use the Celsius temperature scale.
9.4
Describe and use the Kelvin temperature scale.
9.4
Convert temperatures from Celsius to Kelvin and from
Kelvin to Celsius.
P elate gas pressure to the change in force created per
unit area of particles hitting the wall of a container.
1 : ecall and use the equation pV
= constant.
9.1
9.2
9.4
9.5
9.5
Needs
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
> Chapter 10
Thermal
properties
of matter
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
describe how and why solids, liquids and gases expand when their temperatures rise
explain some everyday uses and consequences of thermal expansion
relate energy supplied to increase in temperature when an object is heated
>
measure the specific heat capacity of some materials
explain changes of state using the kinetic model of matter.
10 Thermal properties of matter
GETTING STARTED
THE STRANGE BEHAVIOUR OF WATER
the top of the pond more dense, so it sinks to the
bottom. The coldest water will be at the bottom of
the pond. If this continued, ice would form at the
bottom of the pond.
Figure 10.2: The water below the ice is cold, but not
old enough to freeze.
i
Most substances expand when they get hot and
i Ontract when
they get cold. Water does not always
1' lllow this rule. Think about how a pond cools down
in cold weather. As the air temperature drops, the
water at the top of the pond is cooled by the cold
nr above it and contracts. This makes the water at
Fortunately for the fish, water does not keep
contracting. As it cools from 4 °C to 0 °C, the water
expands. This means that the colder water is less
dense than the water below it and so it remains at
the top. This water continues to cool and eventually
freezes. The ice forms at the top of the pond, not
the bottom. This means fish can survive in the water
beneath the ice. This property of water is called the
anomalous expansion of water.
Unlike most substances, water is less dense as a
solid (ice) than it is as a liquid. This means that ice
floats in water. Most substances are more dense
when they are solid and so do not float. This strange
behaviour is caused by the hydrogen bonds in water
which cause it to form a crystal structure with the
particles in ice more spaced out than in water.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Discussion questions
1
Sketch a graph to show how the density of
water changes from 0 to 1 0 °C.
10.1 Thermal expansion
Most substances - solids, liquids and gases - expand when
their temperature rises. This is called thermal expansion.
Thermal expansion happens because the particles gain
energy and move faster, pushing each other further apart.
The expansion of solids
Figure 10.3 shows an experiment that demonstrates that
a metal ball expands when it is heated.
•
•
2
Discuss what would happen to life on Earth
if water froze like other liquids so that ponds
froze from the bottom up.
in two metal plates and then hammered until the end
rounded (Figure 10.4). As the rivet cools, it contracts
pulls the two plates together tightly.
A metal lid or cap may stick on a glass jar or bottle, £
be hard to unscrew. Heating the lid (for example, by
running hot water over it) causes it to expand. The gl
expands much less than the metal lid, meaning that tl
lid loosens and can be removed.
hot rivet
cold rive
When the ball is cold, it just fits through the ring.
The ball, but not the ring, is heated strongly. It now
will not pass through the ring. It has expanded.
Figure 10.4: Joining two metal plates using a rivet.
When the ball cools down, it contracts and returns
to its original size and will once again pass through
the ring.
Figure 10.5: Steel tyres are heated so they expand and <
be fitted to train wheels. They contract and fit very tighth
Figure 1 0.3a: The metal ball is cold and has passed through
the ring, b: The metal ball is hot. It has expanded and will no
longer fit through the ring.
A steel ‘tyre’ can be fitted on to the wheel of a train w
the tyre is very hot. It then cools and contracts, so th:
fits tightly on to the wheel.
KEY WORDS
thermal expansion: the increase in volume of a
material when its temperature rises
Uses of expansion
Rivets are used in shipbuilding and other industries to
join metal plates. A red-hot rivet is passed through holes
172
>
heat
Figure 1 0.6: A bimetallic strip. Invar is a metal alloy whic
expands very little when heated. Copper expands more,
difference in expansion causes the strip to bend.
A bimetallic strip (Figure 10.6) is designed to bend as i
gets hot. The strip is made of two metals joined firmly
together. One metal expands much more than the othe
10 Thermal properties of matter
\ I he strip is heated, this metal expands, causing the strip
bend. The metal that expands more is on the outside of
llu curve, because the outer curve is longer than the inner
Ml These strips are used in devices such as fire alarms
"id thermostats. Thermostats are used to control the
ii ni|)erature of devices such as ovens and irons.
i i
The expansion of liquids
Many thermometers use the expansion of a liquid to
measure temperature. As the temperature of the liquid
rises, it expands and the level of liquid in the tube rises.
ACTIVITY 10.1
id
Dies of a bimetallic strip
A bimetallic strip can be used in an electric circuit
b। complete or break a circuit depending on the
Inmperature.
i
•
Design a fire alarm circuit which will sound
a buzzer when it gets hot. Design a poster
to promote your invention. Include a circuit
diagram and an explanation of how the
device works.
Consider how you could change your circuit
to make an alarm to warn gardeners when
temperatures are dropping and allow them
to protect delicate plants from frost. Design a
poster for a frost alarm.
Consequences of expansion
I he expansion of materials can cause problems. For
ample, metal bridges and railway lines expand on hot
Tn and there is a danger that they might bend. To avoid
llll'. bridges are made in sections, with expansion joints
I 'tween the sections (Figure 10.7). On a hot day, the bridge
pands and the gaps between sections decrease. Railway
lines are now usually made from a metal alloy that expands
i'iy little. On a concrete roadway, you may notice that the
mad surface is in short sections. The gaps between are filled
Hh soft tar, which becomes squashed as the road expands.
p*
lei
t
Figure 10.8: As the temperature drops, so does the
volume of the liquid in the thermometer. The alcohol in this
thermometer remains liquid at very low temperatures.
Glass containers may crack when hot liquid is placed
in them. This is because the inner surface of the glass
expands rapidly, before the thermal energy has passed
through to the outer surface. The force of expansion
cracks the glass. To avoid this, glass such as Pyrex has
been developed that expands very little on heating. An
alternative is toughened glass, which has been treated
with chemicals to reduce the chance of cracking.
The expansion of gases
Gases expand when they are heated, just like solids and
liquids. We can explain this using the kinetic model of
matter (see Chapter 9). Figure 10.9 shows some gas in a
cylinder fitted with a piston. At first, the gas is cold and
its particles press weakly on the piston. When the gas
is heated, its particles move faster. Now they push with
greater force on the piston and push it upwards. The gas
has expanded.
cylinder
piston
piston
rises
gas
ii
molecules
I Igure 10.7: This lorry is about to cross an expansion joint
..ii ,> road bridge. On a hot day, the bridge expands and the
mhirlocking teeth of the joint move closer together.
Figure 10.9: A gas expands when it is heated at constant
pressure.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
The expansion of gases as they heat up means that the
density of a hot gas is lower than the density of the same
gas when it is cold. This is why hot air rises (you will
learn more about this in Chapter 1 1).
Questions *
1
Copy and complete these sentences:
. When it c
When an object is heated it
Liquids expand more than
but less tha
whic
A bimetallic strip is made of two
expand by different amounts when heated.
This causes the strip to
.
2
Look at the bridge in Figure 10.11. One end o:
bridge is on rollers rather than being fixed. Ex]
how this helps it cope with extreme temperatui
3
Alcohol has a freezing point of -115 °C. Explai
why coloured water could not be used in the
thermometer in Figure 10.8.
4
Figure 10.12 shows an experiment to compare t
expansion of liquids. Equal volumes of ethanol
water and mercury were heated in a water bath.
Figure 10.10: The expansion of air as it heats up creates
thermal currents, which this hang glider is using.
Comparing solids, liquids
and gases
Which expands most, a solid, a liquid or a gas, for a
given rise in temperature?
•
Solids expand least when they are heated. Some,
such as Pyrex glass and invar metal alloy, have been
designed to expand as little as possible.
•
•
Liquids generally expand more than solids.
Gases expand even more than liquids.
There are some exceptions to this. For example, liquid
paraffin expands very rapidly on heating. Petrol
(gasoline) is stored in cool underground tanks. If a
motorist fills their tank on a hot day, the petrol will heat
up and expand. This can cause the fuel to overflow when
it expands.
When a material expands, its particles (atoms or
molecules) do not get any bigger. However, they have
more energy, so they can move around more and take up
more space. It is difficult for the particles of a solid to
push their neighbours aside, so a solid does not expand
much. When a gas is heated, its particles move about
more rapidly, and it is easy for them to push the walls
of their container further apart, so that the gas takes up
more space.
liquids.
a
b
Which liquid expands the most?
Explain why this liquid is used in most sch
laboratory thermometers.
10 Thermal properties of matter
10.2 Specific heat capacity
Is it
Energy and temperature
Ml objects store energy, called internal energy. Internal
uergy is a measure of the total energy of all the particles
in the object. This includes both the kinetic energy of
the particles and chemical potential energy of the bonds
between them. Supplying thermal energy to an object
Will raise its temperature. The particles will move faster
ri they gain kinetic energy.
i
tie
tin
I lowever, energy and temperature are not the same thing.
I he internal energy of an object is the total energy of all
Ils particles. A cup of tea may have a higher temperature
than a bath of warm water, but the energy stored in
the bath water is much greater as there are many more
Water particles.
So, the amount of energy you need to supply to boil the
water will depend on two facts:
• the mass of the water
• the increase in temperature.
In order to calculate how much energy must be supplied
to boil a certain mass of water, we need to know a third
fact:
• it takes 4200 J to raise the temperature of 1 kg of
water by 1 °C.
Let us assume that the cold water from your tap is at
20 °C. You have to provide enough energy to heat it to
100 °C, so its temperature must increase by 80 °C. Let us
also assume that you need 2 kg of water for all the drinks.
The amount of energy required to heat 2 kg of water by
80 °C is, therefore:
energy required
= 2 kg x 4200 J/(kg °C) x 80 °C
= 672 000 J = 672 kJ
Another way to express the third fact above is to say that
the specific heat capacity of water is 4200 J per kg per °C
or 4200 J/(kg °C). In general, the specific heat capacity
of a substance is defined as the energy needed to raise
the temperature of 1 kg of the substance by 1 °C. It is
defined by the equation:
c=
^
mA#
KEY EQUATION
,
.c ,
.t
specific
heat capacity
energy required
= mass x temperature increase
mA#
Figure 10.13: The tea is hotter than the bath so its particles
move faster. However, the bath has far more particles and
tores more energy.
I leating water causes the water particles to gain kinetic
energy and speed up. It takes more energy to raise the
temperature of a large amount of water because more
particles need to have their speed changed. This section
deals with increasing the kinetic energy of particles. We
will look at the potential energy in Section 10.3.
Suppose that you want to make a hot drink for yourself
and some friends. You need to boil some water. You
will be wasting energy if you put too much water in the
kettle or pan. It is sensible to boil just the right amount.
Also, if the water from your tap is really cold, it will take
longer, and require more energy, to reach boiling point.
I
where c = specific heat capacity, AE = energy required,
m = mass and A# = increase in temperature. A is the
Greek letter delta; it means ‘change in’.
The energy needed can be calculated by rearranging the
equation:
energy required = mass x specific heat capacity
x increase in temperature .■
AE mcAO
=
KEY WORDS
specific heat capacity: the energy required per
unit mass per unit temperature increase
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Worked Example 10.1 shows how to use this equation in
more detail.
WORKED EXAMPLE 10.1
A kettle heats 1.5 kg of water. How much energy is
needed to raise the temperature of the water from
20 °C to 100 °C? Assume that specific heat capacity of
water = 4200 J/(kg °C).
Table 10.1 shows that there is quite a wide range of
values. The specific heat capacity of steel, for exampli
is one-tenth that of water. This means that, when you
supply equal amounts of energy to 1 kg of steel and t
1 kg of water, the temperature of the steel rises ten tir
as much as the temperature of the water.
Type of
material
Material
Specific heat
capacity/J/(kg °i
metals
steel
420
aluminium
910
copper
gold
385
300
lead
130
glass
670
specific heat capacity of water
4200 J/(kg °C)
nylon
1700
polythene
2300
Write down the equation for energy
required, substitute values, and calculate the
result.
ice
2100
water
4200
sea water
3900
ethanol
2500
olive oil
1970
air
1000
water vapour
2020 (at 100 °C)
methane
2200
Step 1: Calculate the required increase in
temperature.
increase in temperature = 100 °C - 20 °C
= 80 °C
Step 2:
Write down the other quantities needed to
calculate the energy.
mass of water = 1 .5 kg
non-metals
=
Step 3:
energy required
liquids
= mass x specific heat
capacity x increase in
temperature
= 1.5 kg x 4200J/(kg°C) x 80°C
= 504 000 J
= 504 kJ
Answer
gases
Table 10.1: Specific heat capacities of a variety of materi
504 kJ of energy is required to boil the water.
The meaning of specific
heat capacity
Energy is needed to raise the temperature of any material.
The energy is needed to increase the kinetic energy of the
particles of the material. In solids, they vibrate more. In
gases, they move about faster. In liquids, it is a bit of both.
We can compare different materials by considering
standard amounts (1 kg), and a standard increase in
temperature (1 °C). Different materials require different
amounts of energy to raise the temperature of 1 kg by
1 °C. In other words, they have different specific heat
capacities. Table 10.1 shows the values of specific heat
capacity for a variety of materials.
The specific heat capacity
of water
Water is an unusual substance. As you can see from
Table 10.1, it has a high value of specific heat capacity
(s.h.c.) compared with other materials. This has
important consequences:
•
it takes a lot of energy to heat up water
•
hot water takes a long time to cool down.
The consequences of this can be seen in our climates.
In the hot months of summer, the land warms up quit
(low specific heat capacity) while the sea warms up on
slowly. In the winter, the sea cools gradually while the
land cools rapidly. People who live a long way from th
sea (in the continental interior of North America or
10 Thermal properties of matter
I ufasia, for example) experience freezing winters and
« 0ry hot summers. People who live on islands and in
t < las tai areas (such as western Europe) are protected
of heat in the winter, and stays relatively cool in the
summer.
11 nin climatic extremes because the sea acts as a store
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 10.1
-
Measuring the specific heat capacity of a metal
Method
In this experiment you will heat a metal block. You
will measure the energy you supply, the mass of the
metal and the change in temperature. You will then
be able to calculate the s.h.c. of the metal.
power pack
-
joulemeter
You will need:
•
-
•
•
•
-
•
-
-
•
•
a block of metal with holes for the
thermometer and heater
insulation for the block
electric heater
power pack
joulemeter (your teacher may show you an
alternative way to find the energy used)
thermometer
access to balance.
heater
metal block
thermometer
insulation
Figure 10.14
1
Measure and record the mass, m, of the block
in kg.
Safety: The electric heater can become extremely
hot. Leave it to cool inside the block when you have
finished your experiment.
3
Set up the experiment as shown in Figure 10.14.
Measure and record the initial temperature (0J
of the block.
Getting started
2
4
Turn on the power supply.
1
Should you insulate the metal block? Explain
your answer.
5
2
Why should you measure the mass of the
block at the start of the experiment rather
than the end?
When there has been a temperature rise of
10 °C, turn off the power supply and record the
Joulemeter reading.
6
Watch the thermometer for a few minutes and
record the highest temperature (02) it reaches.
Calculate the change in temperature using
= 02 ~
8
Calculate the specific heat capacity of the
the equation:
metal using
'
c=
y
^1-
^
mA0
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 10.2
Measuring the specific heat capacity of water
1
Put 0.25 kg of water into the beaker.
In this experiment you will heat a mass of water and
find its specific heat capacity
2
Set up the experiment as shown in Figure 10.15.
3
Measure and record the initial temperature (0,)
of the block.
4
Turn on the power supply and leave until the
temperature changes by about 50 °C.
5
Turn off the power supply. Record the final
temperature (02).
6
Calculate the change in temperature using
= 02 - Oy.
7
Record the joulemeter reading.
8
Calculate the specific heat capacity of the
metal using the equation:
You will need:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
a beaker of water with a lid with holes for
the thermometer and heater
insulation for the beaker
electric heater
power pack
joulemeter (your teacher may show you an
alternative way to find the energy used)
thermometer
access to balance.
Safety: The heater and water will get hot. Allow
them to cool before clearing away your apparatus.
Questions
Getting started
1
Compare your answers with the values of
specific heat capacity given in Table 10.1.
Are they higher or lower?
2
The thermal energy supplied by the heater
heats the heater itself, the\thermometer
and the surrounding air as well as the block.
Explain what effect this will have on the
accuracy of your answer.
1
Why is it important to have a lid on the beaker?
2
How will you measure the mass of the water?
Method
power pack
Figure 10.15
178
10 Thermal properties of matter
a
Questions
Fable 10.2 gives the specific heat capacities of some
* materials.
Material
Specific heat capacity
water
4200
gold
300
glass
840
air
1000
Table 10.2
Name the substance that requires the least
amount of energy to raise its temperature.
b The table does not give units. What is the unit
for specific heat capacity?
c State the amount of energy needed to heat 1 kg
of glass by 1 °C.
d Calculate the energy needed to heat 1 kg of
glass by 10 °C.
The specific heat capacity of copper is 385 J/kg °C.
Calculate the energy needed to heat 3 kg of copper:
a
A
by 1 °C
b from 20 °C to 50 °C.
A cook heats 500 g of olive oil in a steel pan which
has a mass of 300 g. The oil needs to be heated
from 20 °C to 190 °C. Using data from Table 10. 1 ,
calculate the thermal energy needed:
to heat the pan
a
b to heat the oil
in total.
c
The electric kettle in Figure 10.16 has a power rating
of 2000 W. It takes 90 seconds to heat 500 g water
from 20 °C to boiling.
b
Use this information to calculate an
approximate value for the specific heat capacity
of water.
Compare your answer to the specific heat
capacity of water given in Table 10.1. Comment
on why it is different.
10.3 Changing state
Figure 10.17 shows what happens to the temperature
when you take some ice from the freezer and heat it at
a steady rate. In a freezer, ice is at a temperature well
below its freezing point, maybe as low as -20 °C. From
the graph, you can see that the ice warms up to 0 °C,
then stays at this temperature while it melts. As lumps
of ice float in water, both are at 0 °C. When all of the ice
has melted, the water’s temperature starts to rise again.
At 100 °C, the boiling point of water, the temperature
again remains steady. The water is boiling to form steam.
Eventually, all of the water has turned to steam. If you
continue to heat the steam, the temperature of the steam
will rise again.
a
/
<D
100
Time / min
Figure 10.17: A temperature against time graph to show
the changes that occur when ice is heated until it eventually
becomes steam. A: ice is heating up. B: ice is melting.
C: water is heating up. D: water is boiling. E: steam is
heating up.
It takes energy to change a solid into a liquid. The
temperature stays the same as the ice melts. Similarly,
when a liquid becomes a gas, its temperature stays the
same even though energy is being supplied to it. This is
due to changes in the chemical potential energy in the
bonds between the molecules or atoms. Energy-must
be provided to break bonds and change a substance
from solid to liquid. Energy is also needed to overcome
the attraction between the particles when a substance
changes from liquid to gas. When these changes are
reversed, energy is given out.
Figure 10.16: An electric kettle.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Condensation is when a gas changes to a liquid. The
particles slow down and the particles are drawn together.
Solidification, or freezing, is when a liquid changes to
a solid. As a liquid loses energy, its particles slow down
and the bonds holding the particles together re-form.
The boiling and melting points of a substance change
if the air pressure changes. Water has a melting point
of 0 °C and a boiling point of 100 °C at standard
atmospheric pressure. This is the pressure at sea level
which is about 101.32 kPa or 1 atmosphere. At altitude,
water boils at a lower temperature.
Figure 10.1 8: On top of Mount Everest water boils at 71 °C
Investigating a change of state
Time / min
Figure 1 0.1 9a: The thermometer measures the temperature of the wax as it cools, b: The graph shows how the
temperature changes.
Figure 10.19a shows one way to investigate the behaviour
of a liquid material as it solidifies. The test tube contains
a waxy substance called stearic acid. This is warmed up,
and it becomes a clear, colourless liquid. It is then left
to cool down, and its temperature is monitored using a
thermometer (or an electronic temperature probe) and
recorded.
Figure 10.19b shows the results.
At first, the liquid wax cools down. Its temperature drops
gradually. The wax is hotter than its surroundings, so
thermal energy is transferred to the surroundings. The
graph is slightly curved. As the temperature drops, there
is less difference between the temperature of the wax and
its surroundings, so it cools more slowly.
180
)
Now the temperature of the wax stays the same for
a few minutes. The tube contains a mixture of clear
liquid and white solid. The wax is solidifying. The wax
is still transferring thermal energy to the surroundings,
because it is still warmer than its surroundings, but its
temperature does not decrease.
The wax’s temperature starts to drop again. All the wax
is now solid. It continues cooling until it reaches the
temperature of its surroundings.
The dashed line on the graph has been drawn to find th
temperature at which the stearic acid changes from a
liquid to a solid.
10 Thermal properties of matter
KEY WORDS
ACTIVITY 9.2
melting point: the temperature at which a solid
melts to become a liquid
Breaking free
boiling point: the temperature at which a liquid
changes to a gas (at constant pressure)
I am so bored in this solid.
It's so squashed and I never
get to see anyone except these
particles on each side of me.
If only I had the energy to change...
I he stearic acid experiment (Figure 10.19) shows that
i pure substance changes from solid to liquid at a fixed
lumperature, known as the melting point. Similarly, a
liquid changes to a gas at a fixed temperature, known as
Hi boiling point. Table 10.3 shows the melting and boiling
points of some pure substances.
«l
«
«l
l»
ID
Figure 10.20
Create a comic strip to tell the story of what
happens to the particle when it gets what it wants
(energy) and changes from a solid to a liquid and
bible 10.3: The melting and boiling points of some pure
•instances. Mercury is interesting because it is the only
then to a gas.
nittal that is not solid at room temperature. Tungsten is a
unital, and it has the highest boiling point of any substance.
I lolium has the lowest melting and boiling points of any
nlument. In fact, helium will only solidify if it is compressed
Your comic strip should be:
quashed) as well as cooled.
•
engaging (use pictures, colour and humour)
•
scientifically correct (check back through the
chapter so far; use the correct scientific words
and explain what is happening).
\ pure substance has a clear melting point and a clear
i nd boiling point. A mixture of substances may melt
Ui boil over a range of temperatures. Candle wax is an
xn mple. It is not a single, pure substance, and some
nl the substances in it melt at lower temperatures than
PEER ASSESSMENT
।
Swap comic strips with another group. Study their
work and give them feedback. Include:
others.
1 Hssolving things in water changes the boiling point and
Iniczing point of the water. For example, salty water
boils at a higher temperature than pure water and freezes
ill u lower temperature.
Not all substances melt or boil when they are heated,
burn, and others decompose (break down) into
nnpler substances before they have a chance to
। hnnge state.
•
three ways it works well
•
one suggestion for how it could be even
better; this could be something they need to
make clearer, or something they could add.
Questions
9
Look at Figure 10.17. Sketch the graph and add notes
explaining what is happening during each section.
> CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
10 Use Figure 10.19b to determine the melting point of
stearic acid.
11 Use the information in Table 9.2 to explain why
air doesn’t have a fixed melting or boiling point.
(Hint: air is roughly 80% nitrogen and 20% oxygen).
Evaporation
How can we use the kinetic molecular model of m.
to explain evaporation? Imagine a beaker of water,
water will gradually evaporate. Figure 10.22 shows
particles that make up the water. The particles of t
water are moving around, and some are moving fa:
than others. Some may be moving fast enough to e.
from the surface of the water. They become particL
of water vapour in the air. In this way, all of the wa
particles may eventually escape from the beaker, an
water will have evaporated.
If the temperature of the liquid is higher, more of i'
particles will have enough energy to escape. This mt
the liquid will evaporate more quickly. The hottest
particles are most likely to escape as they have most
energy. When they escape, the average energy of the
remaining particles is less, so the liquid cools down.
Cooling by evaporation
If you get wet, perhaps in the rain or after swimmin;
you will notice that you can quickly get cold. The wt
on your body is evaporating, and this cools you dow
Why does evaporation make things cooler?
Figure 10.21: In warm weather puddles evaporate quickly.
A liquid can change state without boiling. After it
rains, the puddles dry up even though the temperature
is much lower than 100 °C. The water from the puddles
has evaporated. The liquid water has become a gas
called water vapour in the air. This is the process of
evaporation. We can think of a vapour as a gas at a
temperature below its boiling point.
A liquid evaporates more quickly as its temperature
approaches its boiling point. That is why puddles
disappear faster on a hot day than a cold day.
gas particle
particle with
higher kinetic
energy leaves
the liquid surface
liquid particle
Figure 10.22: Fast-moving particles leave the surface of a
liquid. This is how the liquid evaporates.
182
y
Look again at Figure 10.22. The particles that are
escaping from the water are the fastest-moving ones.
They are the particles with the most kinetic energy.
This means that the particles that remain are those v
less energy. Now the particles of the liquid have less
energy (on average) and so the temperature of the wi
decreases. The water cools down.
Comparing evaporation
and boiling
Evaporation and boiling both involve a liquid turnin
into a gas. Evaporation is different from boiling.
•
Boiling only happens at the boiling point of the
substance. Evaporation occurs at all temperatur
•
For a liquid to boil, it has to be heated - the
kinetic energy of its particles must be increased.
Evaporation happens when the most energetic
particles escape, so evaporation takes energy fro
the substance.
•
Boiling happens throughout the liquid. Evapora
only happens at the surface.
•
A boiling liquid bubbles. A liquid can evaporate
without bubbles.
10 Thermal properties of matter
it
Ipweding up evaporation
ha
11 mi use the kinetic model to explain some ways of
*M*<ln>i| up evaporation.
r
er
:a
As a liquid evaporates, the remaining liquid cools. This
means that thermal energy will flow to the liquid from
any objects in contact with it. When we get hot we sweat.
The sweat evaporates, causing thermal energy to flow
from the skin. This helps us cool down.
Hvvasing the temperature
Mumn 10.23: Increasing the temperature increases the rate
.1 >. q n nation.
I
Im ii .rung the temperature of the liquid means the
les on average have more kinetic energy. More of
du।m i tides will have enough energy to escape. This
fWuu the liquid will evaporate more quickly.
Figure 10.26: Sweating helps us regulate our body
temperature in hot conditions.
Increasing the surface area
o°i
o
o o o
I
Ilir"
•J
- 10.24: Increasing the surface area increases the rate
•• iporation.
In I igure 10.24, the liquid has a greater surface area
Fridges use the cooling effect of evaporation (see Figure
10.27). A liquid is compressed then squirted through a
narrow hole so its pressure is reduced and it evaporates.
This draws thermal energy from inside the fridge into
the liquid. The liquid is then pumped out of the fridge
to the pipes on the back of the fridge where it is
compressed and condenses, releasing the thermal energy
to the surroundings.
of the particles are close to the surface, and so they
mu। tcape more easily. This means the liquid evaporates
mi H quickly.
insulator
narrow
hole
Blowing air across the surface
cooling
fins
COLD
door
U WARM
pump
I iqure 10.25: A draught blowing across the surface
uh mases the rate
of evaporation.
A draught is moving air. When particles escape from the
water, they are blown away so that they cannot fall back
in to the water. This helps the liquid evaporate quickly.
low-pressure
high-pressure
pipe
pipe
Figure 10.27: The refrigerant liquid absorbs thermal energy
from the fridge as it evaporates.
183
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
1 2 Copy and complete the following sentences.
is the change from a liquid to a gas at a
a
temperature below the boiling point.
b Evaporation causes a liquid to cool because the
moving, hotter particles are the most
likely to escape. This means the particles left
ones.
behind are the slower moving,
13 Explain in terms of movement and position of
particles what happens to an ice cube as it is heated
and melts.
14 Tungsten melts a| a much higher temperature t
iron. What can you say about the forces betwec
tungsten atoms, compared to the forces betwee
iron atoms?
15 A solid material is heated but its temperature c
not rise.
What is happening to the solid?
a
b What happens to the energy that is being
supplied to the material?
16 Use the kinetic theory to explain why a wet tov
will dry much faster if hung outside on a warm
windy day than if left folded up in a bag.
17 Explain how covering a bottle of milk with a d
cloth will help to cool the milk.
PROJECT
Hot stuff
drawings to represent the particles. You must inclu
the following key words:
•
•
•
boiling
•
•
internal energy
condensing
*
temperature.
melting
solidifying
Write three multiple choice questions for the stude
to test their understanding to go with your video.
Option 2: Specific heat capacity questions
Specific heat capacity is important in engineering
and in the choice of material for different products
Investigate the applications of specific heat capaci
in answering questions such as:
Figure 10.28: Heating gold causes it to melt. Liquid gold
can be poured into moulds, where it will cool and solidify.
Option 1: Changing state
Create a video or article for a revision guide to
explain changes of state. Show objects changing
state, such as an ice cube melting or a puddle
of water evaporating (you could use time lapse
photography). You should show what is happening
to the particles. You may want to use marbles or
184
•
•
Which is the best metal for a pan?
•
Why do the different specific heat capacities
sand and water create sea breezes?
•
Which types of food store most thermal ener
and so stay hot the longest?
What makes a good coolant for the cooling
system for an engine?
Research one or more of these questions. Present
your results as a website entry for a site which answ
scientific questions posed by science students. Wri
a question to test the students' understanding.
Include a calculation and answer.
10 Thermal properties of matter
n
tha
ha
PEER ASSESSMENT
Present your work to another group. Ask them to answer your questions and comment on what they
have learnt.
SUMMARY
Solids, liquids and gases expand when their temperatures rise.
Solids, liquids and gases contract when their temperatures drop.
Solids expand least because their particles are held together by strong attractive forces.
Gases expand most as their particles are free to move.
Expansion can cause problems such as the bending of train tracks, but can also be useful, for example in
thermometers.
Melting is the change from a solid to a liquid without any change in temperature.
Boiling is the change from a liquid to a gas without a change in temperature.
Supplying heat energy increases the internal energy of a substance and its temperature rise.
The amount of energy needed to raise the temperature of 1 Kg of a substance by 1°C is called the specific heat
capacity of the substance.
The energy needed to heat a mass m of a substance by A0 degrees can be calculated using the equation
mM '
During a change of state, energy is supplied or given out but the temperature does not change.
When a liquid evaporates the most energetic particles escape from the surface, so the liquid cools.
Evaporation occurs at temperatures below the boiling point of the liquid. It happens faster at higher
temperatures, with a larger surface area or if there is a draught across the surface.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
Which one of the following statements is true?
Hl
A The firework has the highest temperature and it contains the most internal
energy.
B The bath has the highest temperature and contains the most internal energy.
C The firework has the highest temperature but contains the least internal energy.
D The bath has the lowest temperature and contains the least internal energy.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
2 Which statement about the difference between evaporation and boiling
is true?
A Evaporation happens at any temperature.
B Evaporation happens throughout a liquid.
B Evaporation happens at a specific temperature.
C Evaporation and boiling are not different.
[1]
3 What is thermal expansion?
A An increase in density due to an increase in temperature.
B A decrease in density due to a decrease in temperature.
C A decrease in density due to an increase in temperature.
D A decrease in volume due to an increase in temperature.
[1 ]
4 A jeweller is making a silver ring. She heats the silver until it melts, and then
continues to heat it for another minute after it has melted. She then pours the
molten (melted) silver into a mould and leaves it to cool down.
COMMAND WORDS
a Describe what happens to the arrangement and movement of the
silver atoms as the silver is heated from room temperature and poured
into the mould.
[3]
b The graph shows how the temperature of the silver varies as it is heated.
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
state: express in
clear terms
Use the graph to find the melting point of silver.
c State how long it takes for the silver to melt.
[1]
[1 ]
[Total: 5]
5 The diagram shows the circuit for a fire alarm using a bimetallic strip.
a Brass expands more than iron. Which metal should be at the top of
the strip?
b Describe what happens as the temperature rises in case of a fire.
186
>
[1 ]
[3]
[Total: 4]
10 Thermal properties of matter
'NTINUED
\ c ook spills water. Some falls on the floor, some on the hot stove top.
I lie temperature of the stove top is about 80 °C. He goes to get a cloth to
wipe up. When he returns, he sees the stove is dry but the floor is still wet.
Name the process by which water becomes a gas at a temperature
[11
below its boiling point.
b Explain why energy must be supplied to a liquid to turn it into a gas.
In your answer, refer to the particles of the liquid and the forces
[1]
between them.
on
turns
cook
an
dry
quickly
if
more
will
the
Explain why the floor
[1]
electric fan.
[Total: 3]
1 1 uda follows the cooking instructions for a tin of baked beans.
420g
© Microwave
Empty contents into a non-metallic bowl and cover.
Stir well before serving.
650 watt
750 watt
850 watt
Category B
Category D
Category E
1 min
2 mins
2 mins
Heat on full power
Remove cover and stir. Re-cover, then:
1 min
2 mins
2 mins
Heat on full power
3 mins
4 mins
2 mins
Total time
Adjust times according to your particular oven.
1 1 uda’s microwave oven has a power of 650 W. She heats the beans for the
recommended time and checks the temperature. The beans have heated from
10 °C to 90 °C.
a Use the equation energy = power x time to calculate the energy supplied. [i]
b Calculate the specific heat capacity of the beans. Give your answer to
[3]
two significant figures.
She notices that the dish she heated the beans in has also become hot
and realises this will affect her calculation. Explain whether her result
[2]
will be too high or too low.
Huda also measures the specific heat capacity of tinned spaghetti.
She calculates it as 3100 J/kg°C. If she heats both the beans and
spaghetti to the same temperature, which will cool down quicker?
[2]
Explain your answer.
[Total: 81
COMMAND WORDS
explain: produce an
answer from a given
source or recall I
memory
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Describe everyday examples of thermal expansion.
10.1
State which expands most, solid, liquid or gas, and
explain this in terms of the particles.
10.1
State the effect of raising an objects, temperature on its
internal energy.
10.2
Recall and use the equation c
77
=A .
10.2
Describe experiments to measure the specific heat
capacity of solids and liquids.
10.2
Describe changes of state as a change in internal energy
without a change in temperature.
10.3
Know why evaporation causes cooling.
10.3
Explain the factors that increase the rate of evaporation.
10.3
Explain how an evaporating liquid causes objects in
contact with it to cool.
10.3
188
y
Almost
there
Confident 1
to move
orl
Chapter 11
"hermal energy
transfers
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
carry out experiments to demonstrate conduction, convection and radiation
explain why some materials conduct and others do not
describe and explain convection currents
explain thermal energy radiation
investigate the differences between good and bad emitters of radiation
research applications and consequences of thermal energy transfer.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
Figure 11.1 shows items that are used to transfer
thermal energy or prevent thermal energy transfer.
Work in a group to decide what each item is for and
how it works. Your teacher will stop you and pick a
conduction
convection
radiation
member of the group to report back on one of the
photos. If they can do this they score a point for the
team. If they use any of the following terms correctly,
your teacher will award bonus points.
conductor
insulator
convection
current
infrared
radiation
Rules:
All members of the group need to be able to answer.
You cannot write down your ideas.
You can write a maximum of three words for each picture as a prompt.
Figure 11.1: A selection of items that transfer thermal energy, or prevent thermal energy transfer.
WHAT CAN WE LEARN FROM A REINDEER'S NOSE?
Reindeer live in some of the most difficult conditions
on the planet. They need to cope with temperatures
dropping to -50 °C and below.
Reindeer are adapted so they lose very little thermal
energy from their bodies. They have two layers of
Figure 11.2: Reindeer are superbly adapted to prevent
thermal energy losses.
190
y
fur: soft fur near the body, then a layer of guard
hairs which are hollow tubes containing air. Air is an
excellent insulator. The hairs are densely packed,
insulating the body so well reindeer can sleep on
snow without melting it.
11
Thermal energy transfers
CONTINUED
I he reindeer's nasal passages serve as a complex
thermal energy exchange system. They have a
। omplex system of tubes which allow warm air
I feing breathed out to pass over cold air being
I reathed in. Thermal energy is transferred to the
incoming air so that the air leaving a reindeer's
body is cold, and the reindeer keeps the thermal
nergy. The warm air is cooled by about 21 °C
before leaving the reindeer's nose.
I he reindeer are so well insulated that they are in
lunger of overheating when running from predators
as wolves.
Ihey lose thermal energy from their large tongues.
Also they circulate more blood to their legs, which are
less insulated so can give out the thermal energy.
It is important that a reindeer does not lose feeling in
its nose while finding food in the snow. To keep the
nose warm and sensitive, it has extra blood vessels.
This means that when a reindeer is photographed
With a temperature-sensitive camera, the nose seems
to glow.
Reindeer have other adaptations that make them
suited to life in the Arctic. They need to stick
together in blizzards, because they cannot see each
other. Their feet make a clicking sound as tendons
move across bones. This means they can hear each
other. They also have a gland in the leg that leaves a
scent on the ground, which helps them locate each
other.
Reindeer's eyes change in winter. In summer, they
have a golden reflective layer at the back of the eye,
like a cat's eye. In winter, this layer turns dark blue,
which means less light escapes and the eyes are
more sensitive.
In this chapter you will study the ways in which
thermal energy is transferred and how we can use
this to our advantage.
Discussion questions
1
Human nasal passages also transfer thermal
energy from exhaled air. Try breathing onto
your hand, first from your mouth, then from
your nose. You will notice the air from your
nose is cooler. Discuss how we use this to help
us cool down or to keep warm.
2
Figure 11.3: A reindeer's nose has a complex thermal
exchange system. Reindeer lose thermal energy through
their large tongues.
The reindeer's nasal passages can be referred
to as a heat energy exchange system. They
exchange the thermal energy from the warm
hair breathed out to the cold air breathed in.
Thermal energy exchangers can reduce the
amount of fossil fuels we use, helping reduce
the amount of energy we use and cutting
costs. Discuss any other uses of thermal energy
exchangers. These may be examples you have
seen, or situations where you think they could
be useful.
11.1 Conduction
in which thermal energy is transferred. We start with
As we discussed in Chapter 6, thermal energy transfers
from a hotter place to a colder place, that is, from a
higher temperature to a lower temperature. Thermal
energy requires a temperature difference if it is to be
transferred. In this chapter, we look at the various ways
Lying on the table are two spoons: one is metal, the other
is wooden (Figure 11 .4). You pick up the metal spoon
- it feels cold. You pick up the wooden spoon - it feels
warm. In fact, both are at the same temperature (room
temperature) as a thermometer would prove to you.
thermal conduction.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
How can this be? What you are detecting is the fact that
metal is a good conductor of thermal energy, and wood
is a poor conductor of thermal energy.
When your finger touches a metal object, thermal energy
is conducted out of your finger and into the metal.
Because metal is a good thermal conductor, thermal
energy spreads rapidly through the metal. Thermal
energy continues to escape from your finger, leaving it
colder than before. The temperature-sensitive nerves in
your finger tip tell your brain that your finger is cold. So,
you think you are touching something cold.
When you touch a wooden object, thermal energy
conducts into the area that your finger is in direct contact
with. However, because wood is a good thermal insulator,
the thermal energy travels no further. Your finger loses
no more thermal energy and remains warm. The message
from the nerves in your finger tip is that your finger is
warm. So, you think you are touching something warm.
Note that the nerves in your finger tell you how hot your
finger is, not how hot the object that you are touching is!
This is similar to our discussion of thermometers in
Chapter 10. A thermometer in water indicates its own
temperature, and we have to assume that the temperature
of the water is the same as this.
Figure 11 .4a: Touching a metal spoon, b: Touching a
wooden spoon.
KEY WORDS
thermal conduction: the transfer of thermal
energy by the vibration of molecules
thermal conductor: a substance that conducts
thermal energy
thermal insulator: a substance that conducts very
little thermal energy
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 11.1
Demonstrating conduction
In this series of experiments, you will investigate
how materials conduct, and which are the best
conductors. This information is vital for engineers
and designers whose work involves planning how to
keep temperatures safe and comfortable.
Safety: These experiments will involve heating
materials to high temperatures. Plan carefully so
that you can leave hot materials to cool safely. Wear
safety goggles while using the Bunsen burner.
Carry out a risk assessment and make sure your
teacher has checked it before beginning any
practical work.
192
>
Getting started
Look at the apparatus in Figure 11.5. Explain how
attaching paper clips using petroleum jelly will allow
you to observe conduction.
Part 1: How is thermal energy conducted along a
metal bar?
You will need:
• Bunsen burner
•
•
heatproof mat
clamp and stand
•
•
•
copper rod
paper clips
petroleum jelly.
11 Thermal energy transfers
ONTINUED
Method
Method
clamp stand
paperclips
rod
Bunsen burner
hi’ 4 resistant mat
I Iflure 11.5: Experimental set-up for part 1.
1
2
Figure 11.6: Experimental set-up for part 2.
Use small blobs of petroleum jelly to attach
paper clips along the copper rod, as shown
in Figure 11.5.
Secure the rod in the clamp and heat the
other end.
1
Use small blobs of petroleum jelly to attach a
paper clip to the end of each metal rod.
2
Place the rods on the tripod, as shown in
Figure 11.6, and heat the ends.
Watch carefully what happens to the paper clips.
3
Use a table like this to record the time taken
for each paper clip to fall.
Questions
1
Metal
Describe what happened to the paper clips.
Time taken for clip to fall /
seconds
What does this tell you about how thermal
energy is conducted along the rod?
I'urt 2: Which metal is the best conductor?
You will need:
• Bunsen burner
• heatproof mat
• tripod
• rods made from different metals
• paper clips
• timer
• petroleum jelly.
Questions
1
Write the metals in order from the best
conductor to the worst conductor.
2
Do you think this was a fair test? Explain why
or why not. Describe any possible sources of
experimental error.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Part 3: Is water a good conductor of thermal
energy?
Questions
Describe your observations.
Explain why this experiment shows that wate
a poor conductor of thermal energy.
1
You will need:
• Bunsen burner
2
• heatproof mat
• boiling tube
• small piece of wire gauze
Part 4: What materials make good insulators?
•
•
•
test tube holder
cold water
ice cube.
Method
You will need:
• 4 equal sized beakers with cardboard lids
• 4 thermometers, pushed through the
cardboard lids
timer
•
• a range of insulating materials
•
electric kettle.
Method
Figure 11.7: Experimental set-up for part 3.
1
2
Fill three-quarters of the boiling tube with
water. Add a small ice cube and then a small
piece of wire gauze to hold the ice in place, as
shown in Figure 11.7.
Look at the boiling tube. Touch it to check the
temperature.
3
4
194
Hold the tube with the test tube holder and
gently heat the water at the top of the tube.
Watch carefully to see what happens to the
water at the top of the tube and to the ice.
y
Figure 11 .8: Experimental set-up for part 4.
11
Thermal energy transfers
JUNUED
Wi.ip three of the beakers in different insulating
in.lterials. Leave the fourth beaker without
insulation.
I >< "jign a table to record your results.
Boil the kettle and carefully pour equal
•
Questions
1
2
I amounts of water into each of the beakers.
osure the temperature of the water in each
’ IM<K'.iker
every minute for ten minutes.
CTION
II -i iljoutthe experiments you have done
•i I yule a short sentence to sum up what you
.irnt in each. What was the most powerful
niilng moment for you in these experiments?
Ilunl ibout why this was and how it helped your
ynilm standing.
3
4
Why was the beaker with no insulation included
in the experiment?
Draw a graph of your results. Plot temperature
on the y-axis against time on the x-axis. Plot all
four sets of results on the same axis.
Which insulator kept the water the hottest?
List the insulators in order from best to worst.
Explaining conduction in
metals and non-metals
Both metals and non-metals conduct thermal energy.
Metals are generally much better conductors than nonmetals. We need different explanations of conduction for
these two types of material.
energy flow
III I compares conductors and insulators. In
1 1 metals are good conductors of thermal energy
•ihI nun metals are poor conductors. Air and water are
•
hot
cold
। >m conductors of thermal energy.
i
tnductor
diamond
worst insulator
glass rod
silver, copper
aluminum,
steel
Bunsen burner
lead
ice, marble,
glass
Figure 11.9: Conduction of thermal energy in non-metals.
A glass rod is heated at one end. Thermal energy travels
from the hot end to the cold end.
polyethene,
nylon
rubber, wood
polystyrene
•> .I < onductor
glass wool
best insulator
We will start with non-metals. Imagine a long glass rod
(Figure 11.9). One end is being heated, the other end is
cold. This makes a temperature difference between the
two ends, and so thermal energy flows along the rod.
What is going on inside the rod?
111: Comparing conductors of thermal energy, from
IlK'.l ' onductors to the worst. A bad conductor is a good
||
Almost all good conductors are metals; polymers
in i) .ire at the bottom of the list. Glass wool is an
h4 Hunt insulator because it is mostly air.
195
)
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Look at the particles inside the rod in Figure 11.9. At the
hot end of the rod, the atoms are vibrating much more
than they are at the cold end. As the atoms vibrate, they
collide with their neighbours. This process results in each
atom sharing its energy with its neighbouring atoms.
Atoms with a lot of energy end up with less, and those
with a little end up with more. The collisions gradually
transfer energy from the atoms at the hot end to those at
the cold end. Energy is steadily transferred down the rod,
from the hot end to the cold end.
This is how poor conductors (such as glass, ice and
plastic) conduct thermal energy. It is not a very efficient
method of thermal energy transfer.
Metals are good conductors for another reason. Many of
the electrons in metallic conductors are free to move (they
are delocalised). These are the particles which carry electric
current. They also carry thermal energy as they get hot and
move through the metal. Figure 11.10 shows a copper rod,
heated in the same way as the glass rod. Notice the free
electrons, which carry thermal energy through the metal.
Questions
1
2
3
4
5
*
Copy these sentences. Choose the correct word froffl
each set of brackets.
Conduction happens mostly in {solids / liquids /
gases}. Thermal energy flows from the {hotter I
cooler} parts of an object to the {hotter / cooler} part
A material which does not conduct thermal energy
well is called {a conductor I an insulator I a resistor}.
An example is {copper / polystyrene / gold}.
Explain why a wooden spoon is better than a metal
one to stir a saucepan of hot soup.
Use the information in Table 11.1 to explain why
walking on a marble floor in bare feet would feel
colder than walking on a wooden floor.
Explain why two thin layers of clothing are often
warmer than one thick layer.
Explain why:
a copper is a better conductor than wood
b wood is a better conductor than air.
KEY WORD
electron: a negatively charged particle, smaller
than an atom
11.2 Convection
As we have seen, liquids and gases are not usually good
conductors of thermal energy. Thermal energy transfer
in liquids and gases is mainly by another method known
as convection.
Figure 11.10: Conduction of thermal energy in metals.
Metals have free electrons which carry thermal energy,
making metals good conductors.
Liquids can also conduct thermal energy, because the
particles of which they are made are in close contact
with one another. However, as the particles are free to
move, vibrations are not passed on as easily as in a solid.
The particles in gases are very spread out, making gases
very poor conductors of thermal energy.
196
y
Figure 11.11: The heater is heating the air going into the
balloon. This makes the air expand so it becomes less deni!
and makes the balloon float up.
1 1 Thermal energy transfers
Ml tin i l ies’ is a popular saying - one of the things
H "lulls remember from their science lessons. Figure
|| i hows this science being put to use. When air is
' I II e xpands and so its density decreases. The
Mllv m is less dense than its surroundings, so it floats
"I <nl For the balloon to rise, the density of the hot
N Un I '.illoon itself, plus the basket and its occupants,
Mu ' i II ogether have a density less than that of the
IMi* "Hiding cold air.
1
the
pposite effect can be seen in Figure 1 1.12. Cold air
Ek
• I his photo is taken with a technique which shows
If ns of air. You can see cold air sinking down below
liii i n pizza.
In convection, energy is transferred through a
material from a warmer place to a cooler place by
the movement of the material itself.
In conduction, energy is transferred through a
material from a warmer place to a cooler place
without the material itself moving.
KEY WORDS
convection: the transfer of thermal energy
through a material by the movement of the
material itself
fluid: a substance which can flow; liquids and
gases are fluids
density: the ratio of mass to volume for a
substance
convection current: the transfer of thermal
energy by the motion of a fluid
tiii'ii” 11.12: Cold air sinks below any object which is
Mi<' i than its surroundings.
I In i rung of hot air is just one example of convection.
ILd iiu can rise because air is a fluid, and convection can
i nil <)rved in any fluid any (liquid or gas). Convection
il n't happen in solids as the particles are in fixed
l*"illons so they cannot flow.
I Till i' 11.13 shows how a convection current can be
vcd in water. Above the flame, water is heated
*ml expands. Now its density is less than that of the
|m muilding water, and it floats upwards. The purple dye
•Ie . how it moves. Colder water, which is more dense,
> in to replace it.
11 u i
BI advection current is a movement of a fluid that
i li
energy from a warmer place to a cooler one. This
h lights an important difference between convection
mid conduction.
Figure 11.13: Because water is clear and colourless, it can
be difficult to see how the water moves to form a convection
current. Crystals of potassium manganate(VII) act as a purple
dye to show the movement of the water.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 11.2
Method part 2: Convection in air
Demonstrating convection
Convection in air and water is difficult to see
as air and water are transparent and colourless.
These experiments will let you observe convection
currents in water and air.
You will need:
• Bunsen burner
• heatproof mat
•
•
tripod
•
tweezers
beaker
•
•
•
•
thin card
scissors
thin thread
potassium
manganate(VII)
crystals.
Safety: Wear eye protection when using a Bunsen
burner. Wear protective gloves when handling
potassium manganate(VII). Do not hold the card
spiral near a flame.
Figure 11.15: Cutting a spiral and using it to demonstrati
convection.
1
Cut a spiral from thin card.
2
Attach a thin thread to the ceptre of the spiral.
Hold the thread above a heat source (such as a
radiator) and observe how it moves.
3
Getting started
What is the purpose of the potassium
manganate(VII) crystal in this experiment?
Method part 1: Convection in a liquid
Figure 11.14: Set-up for experiment.
1
2
Fill three-quarters of a beaker with water.
When the water is settled, use tweezers to
place two or three small crystals of potassium
manganate(VII) on the bottom of the beaker, at
one side. (See Figure 11 .14.)
3
Use a Bunsen burner to heat the water gently,
just below the crystals.
4
Observe what happens to the colour of the
potassium manganate(VII) as it moves. This
shows how the water is flowing.
198
>
Questions
1
Draw the beaker of water and arrows to show
the movement of the purple colour when you
heated it.
2
The experiment shown in Figure 11.16 uses
smoke from burning paper to show convection
currents in air. Explain why the smoke moves
down one chimney and up the other.
11
IConvection currents at work
c lion currents help to share energy between warm
•ml old places. If you are sitting in a room with an
li K heater, thermal energy will be moving around
•»<। mom
from the heater as a result of convection
III*
I >n. ji| , which rise from the heater. You are likely to
1» l Ik source of convection currents yourself, since
pin i body is usually warmer than your surroundings
I igure 1 1 .21). Many biting insects make use of this
pin I For example, bed bugs crawl across the bedroom
1 1 1 r They can detect a sleeping person below by
ding the warmest spot on the ceiling. Then they drop
*li >ii«' hl down on to the sleeper. This is a lot easier than
> 1 m ling about on top of the bedding.
RI
ceiling
24°C
Thermal energy transfers
Explaining convection
We have already seen that convection results from the
expansion of a fluid when it is heated. Expansion means
an increase in volume while mass stays constant. This
means that density decreases. A less dense material is
lighter and so is pushed upwards by the surrounding
denser material.
The particles in the hotter fluid have more kinetic energy
so they move around faster. As they flow from place to
place, they take this energy with them.
Convection is the main method of thermal energy
transfer in fluids. Thermal energy can be conducted
through a liquid but this is generally a slow process
compared with convection.
Questions
6
Copy Figure 11.19. Add arrows labelled ‘cold
dense water’ and ‘hot, less dense water’ to show the
convection current in the pan.
floor
18°C
hum# 11.17: Convection currents rise above the warm
Mi’ll in a room.
I ilil objects also produce convection currents. You may
heat
•w V noticed cold water sinking below an ice cube in a
di nd Ina refrigerator, the freezing surface is usually
r I uoncd at the top and the back, so that cold air will
•ml Io the bottom. Warm air rises to replace the cold air
n il links. The warm air is then cooled, (see Figure 11.18).
Figure 1 1.1 9: A pan of water.
7
The ice cube in Figure 1 1.20 floats at the top of the
water. Draw and label a diagram to show how the
ice cube creates a convection current which cools all
of the water.
I lgut« 1 1.18: In a refrigerator, cold air sinks from the freezing
• >i| aitment. If the freezer was at the bottom, cold air would
* iin there, and the food at the top would not be cooled.
Figure 11.20: Ice in glass of water.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
8
An inventor makes an electric kettle with the heating
element at the top. Explain why it will not work.
9 a Draw diagrams to show the difference in the
arrangement of particles in a hot gas and a
cold gas.
b Use your diagrams to explain why hot gases
rise. Use the words ‘expand’ and ‘density’ in
your answer.
1 0 Explain why convection does not happen in solids.
11.3 Radiation
At night, when it is dark, you can see much further
than during the day. In the daytime, the most distant
object you are likely to be able to see is the Sun, about
150 million kilometres away. At night, you can see much
further, to the distant stars. The most distant object
visible to the naked eye is the Andromeda galaxy, about
20 million million million kilometres away.
The light that reaches us from the Sun and other stars
travels to us through space in the form of electromagnetic
radiation. This radiation travels as electromagnetic
waves. It travels over vast distances, following a
straight line through empty space. Radiation is the only
form of thermal energy transfer which does not involve
the movement of particles. Thermal radiation does not
need a medium to travel through. It can travel through a
vacuum. As well as light, the Earth receives other forms of
electromagnetic radiation from the Sun, including infrared
and ultraviolet radiation. (You will learn much more about
electromagnetic radiation in Chapter 15.)
All objects emit infrared radiation. The hotter an object,
the more infrared radiation it gives out. You can use this
idea to help you to do a bit of detective work. Imagine
you arrive at a crime scene. The suspect says he has just
arrived by car. You suspect he has been at the scene for
an hour, giving him time to commit the crime. Holding
your hand over the engine compartment will quickly tell
you if the engine is radiating thermal energy.
KEY WORDS
infrared radiation: electromagnetic radiation with
a wavelength greater than that of visible light;
sometimes known as thermal energy radiation
Our skin detects the infrared radiation produced by a
hot object. Nerve cells just below the surface respond to
thermal energy. You notice this if you are outdoors on a
sunny day.
To summarise, infrared radiation:
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
is produced by warm or hot objects
is a form of electromagnetic radiation
travels through empty space (and through air) in the
form of waves
travels in straight lines
warms the object that absorbs it
is invisible to the naked eye
can be detected by nerve cells in the skin.
Figure 11.21: Using an infrared-sensitive camera. Slight
variations in temperature show up as different colours. The
scale shows how the colour relates to temperature.
Figure 1 1.21 shows another way of detecting infrared
radiation: by using a temperature-sensitive camera. The
photograph of a woman sitting at a desk is taken with a
camera which detects infrared radiation instead of light.
It is very sensitive to slight differences in temperature.
Questions
1 1 Which statement about infrared radiation is true?
A
Infrared radiation travels slower than light.
B
Infrared radiation cannot be reflected.
C
Infrared radiation can travel through a vacuum.
D
Infrared radiation is transferred by the
movement of particles.
11
I x plain why thermal energy from the Sun can only
icach us by radiation, not conduction or convection.
What evidence is there in this infrared photograph
( I igure 1 1 .22) to suggest that the car has only just
broken down?
Thermal energy transfers
CONTINUED
The board should be interesting to the general
public and also detailed enough to be relevant to
high school physics students.
Uses of infrared technology include:
• medicine
• military
• detection of drug farms
•
•
•
•
astronomy
wildlife photography
forensic science
studying thermal energy loss from buildings.
PEER ASSESSMENT
Figure 11.22: Infrared photograph of a car.
ACTIVITY 9.1
Display each group's work from Activity 9.1 around
the classroom. Take a class vote on which board
best meets the brief. Discuss what makes it a good
piece of work. Adapt your board to add some of
the features you identified.
Good absorbers, good emitters
Figure 11.23: Thermal image of a fingerprint.
A science museum is preparing a display about
infrared photography. You are a researcher and
I i.ive been given the following brief.
Investigate one of the uses of this technology and
। mpare an information board about it. Your board
•should be one side of A4 paper. It must include
it least one eye-catching picture taken with an
Infrared camera, and a maximum of 150 words
• Inscribing the science and how it is used.
Figure 11.24: A sunshield reflects unwanted radiation, which
would otherwise make the car very hot.
On a hot, sunny day, car drivers may park their cars with
a sunshield behind the windscreen (Figure 11.24). Such a
sunshield is usually shiny, because this reflects light and
infrared radation from the Sun. This stops the car getting
uncomfortably hot. The black plastic parts of the car
(such as the steering wheel and dashboard) are very good
absorbers of infrared radaition, and they can become too
hot to touch.
201
)
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
It is the surface that determines whether an object
absorbs or reflects infrared radiation. A surface that is a
good reflector is a poor absorber. On a hot day, you may
have noticed how the black surface of a tarred (metalled)
road emits thermal energy. Black surfaces readily absorb
infrared radiation. They are also good emitters.
You may also have noticed that you stay cooler on a hot
day if you wear light coloured clothes. Light surfaces do
not absorb much thermal radiation. Instead, they reflect
the radiation. The house in Figure 11.25 is painted white
to reflect infrared radiation.
• Shiny or white surfaces are the best reflectors (the
worst absorbers).
• Matte black surfaces are the best absorbers (the
worst reflectors).
• Matte black surfaces are the best emitters.
Factors affectihg infrared
radiation
All objects emit radiation and absorb radiation from
their surroundings. The hotter an object is, the more
radiation it emits each second, or the more power it
radiates. Any object which is hotter than its surrounding
radiates more energy per second than it absorbs and
so will cool down. An object which is cooler than
its surroundings absorbs more energy per second
than it radiates until it reaches the temperature of its
surroundings. An object with a temperature that remain
constant absorbs thermal energy at the same rate as it
emits thermal energy. An object with a large surface are:
emits thermal energy at faster rate.
Figure 11.27 shows three beakers of water. The
room temperature is 20 °C. All three bedkers radiate
and absorb energy, but the amount or radiation and
absorption depends on the temperature.
0°C
Figure 11.25: This house is built from bottles filled with sand.
It is painted white to reduce absorption of infrared radiation.
Questions
14 Explain why the worker in Figure 11.26 is wearing a
shiny suit.
Figure 11.26: A worker supervising the flow of hot
molten metal.
1 5 Which will stay hot longer: tea in a shiny silver teapot
or tea in dark brown one? Explain your answer.
202
>
Figure 11.27: Beaker A will warm up, beaker B will cool
down and beaker C will remain at a constant temperature.
11
Thermal energy transfers
I KPERIMENTAL SKILLS 11.3
Investigating the emission and absorption of
Infrared radiation
Experiment A: Which surface radiates better, black
or shiny?
In this investigation you will use cans of water with
Jlfforent surfaces to investigate which emits most
mf r ared radiation and which absorbs most infrared
Method
1
Set up the experiment as shown in Figure 1 1.28.
idlation.
2
Fill the two cans with equal volumes of hot water.
the amount of infrared radiation emitted also
li 'pends on the surface area and temperature of
tin objects so these must be controlled in your
experiment.
3
Use thermometers or electronic temperature
probes to measure the temperature of the
water in each can every minute for ten minutes.
i.
You will need:
1
•
1 shiny silver can and 1 dull black can
•
2 lids with holes for thermometers
•
2
2 thermometers or electronic temperature
probes
3
•
timer
•
•
kettle
board to isolate the cans from each other
Bunsen burner or electrical heater.
•
Questions
Safety: Take care when using hot water. Do not
touch or move the cans while they are full of very
What features of the experimental design
ensure that this is a fair test?
Plot a graph of temperature on the y-axis
against time on the x-axis. Plot both sets of
results on the same graph.
What can you conclude from your results?
Experiment B: Which surface absorbs thermal
energy better, black or shiny?
thermometer Bunsen burner
matte black
surface
— shiny silver
surface
hot water. Wear eye protection when using a
llunsen burner.
Getting started
look at Figure 11 .28. Use what you know about
thermal energy transfers to explain why the cans
must be fitted with lids, and why they should stand
on a wooden or plastic surface.
thermometer
board to isolate cans
wooden bench
Figure 11.29: Set-up for the experiment.
Method
1
Set up the experiment as shown in Figure 11.29;
use the same cans as in experiment A.
2
Fill the cans with equal volumes of cold water.
3
Place the cans at equal distances from the
Bunsen flame or electric heater.
Use thermometers or electronic temperature
probes to measure the temperature of the
water in each can every minute for ten minutes.
J — shiny silver
matte black
surface
lurface
4
wooden bench
Figure 11.28: Set-up for the experiment.
Questions
1
Plot a similar graph to experiment A.
2
What can you conclude from your results?
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
11.4 Consequences of
thermal energy transfer
In this section, we will see how we can use ideas about
thermal energy transfers to understand a lot of different
situations. Remember that:
•
•
•
•
Thermal energy travels from a hotter place to a
colder place. It is the temperature difference that
makes it flow.
Conduction is the main way in which energy can
pass through a solid. Energy travels through the
solid but the solid itself cannot move.
Convection is the main way in which energy is
transferred in a fluid. Warm fluid moves around,
carrying energy with it.
Radiation is the only way in which thermal energy
can travel through empty space. Infrared radiation
can also pass through some transparent materials
such as air.
Hot objects have a lot of internal energy. As we have
seen, energy tends to escape from a hot object, spreading
to its cooler surroundings by conduction, convection
and radiation. This can be a great problem. We may use
a lot of energy (and money) to heat our homes during
cold weather, and the energy simply escapes. We eat food
to supply the energy we need to keep our bodies warm,
but energy escapes from us at a rate of about 100 watts
(100 W = 100 J/s).
To keep energy in something that is hotter than its
surroundings, we need to insulate it. Knowing about
conduction, convection and radiation can help us to
design effective insulation.
*
26% roof:
install loft insulation
3% doors
33% walls:
fit cavity wall
install a
curtain or
insulation
fit draugh
excluders
A well-insulated house can avoid a lot of energy wastage
during cold weather. Insulation can also help to prevent
the house from becoming uncomfortably hot during
warm weather. Figure 11.30 shows where thermal energy
is lost from a house, and some ways to reduce thermal
energy losses. More details are listed in Table 11.2.
1 8% windows:
fit draught
excluders
fit double glazing
Figure 11 .30: Insulating a house reduces thermal energy
loss and heating costs.
_
..
Why it works
Method
| thick curtains, stops
draught
convection
I 11
excluders
|
underfloor
insulating
materials
\
double and
of windows
1
r
cavity walls
ki
prevents
conduction of
thermal energ
through floors
and ceilings
vacuum
triple glazing between glass
ji
mi
currents, and
so prevents
thermal energ
transfer
MKMa loft and
Remember that all three mechanisms of energy transfer
(conduction, convection and radiation) may be involved
when an object warms up or cools down.
Home insulation
1 2% draughts:
8% floors:
fit carpets or
underfloor
insulation
panes cuts ou
losses or gain:
by conduction
and convectio
reduces
thermal energ
loss or gain bj
conduction
MM
foam or
rockwool in
wall cavity
further reduce
thermal energ
transfer by
convection
Table 11.2: Methods of retaining energy in a house in a cc
climate, and of keeping a house cool in a hot climate.
204
y
1 1 Thermal energy transfers
I hmble-glazed windows usually have a vacuum between
Uh two panes of glass. This means that energy can only
«•1 ipe by radiation, since conduction and convection
Uh require a material. Modern houses are often built
HU It cavity walls, with an air gap between the two
Ims <srs of bricks. It is impossible to have a vacuum in
du cavity, and convection currents can transfer energy
Hi toss the gap (see Figure 11.31a). Filling the cavity with
hinin means that a small amount of energy is lost by
induction, although the foam is a very poor conductor.
I lowever, this does stop convection currents from flowing
i
vacuum
between walls
stopper
metal or
plastic case
double-walled —flglass flask
insulating
supports -
figure 11.31a: A cavity wall reduces thermal energy loss
, onduction because air is a good insulator. However, a
Bnvection current can transfer energy from the inner wall
।। the outer wall, b: Filling the cavity with foam or mineral
fl jfiss or rock) wool prevents convection currents from
<>rming.
।
silvered inner
surfaces
Figure 11.32: A vacuum flask is cleverly designed to keep
hot things hot by reducing thermal energy losses. It also
keeps cold things cold. Although we might say 'it stops the
cold getting out', it is more correct to say that it prevents
thermal energy from getting in. The first such flask was
designed by James Dewar, a Scottish physicist, in the 1870s.
He needed flasks to store liquefied air and other gases at
temperatures as low as -200 °C. Soon after, people realised
that a flask like this was also useful for taking hot or cold
drinks on a picnic.
Keeping cool
\lcuum flasks are used to keep hot drinks hot. They
in also be used to keep cold drinks cold. Giant vacuum
links are used to store liquid nitrogen and helium at very
low temperatures, ready for use in such applications as
body scanners in hospitals. They also have medical uses,
1Uch as for storing frozen embryos for IVF treatment.
I Igure 1 1.32 shows the construction of a vacuum
flunk. Glass is generally used, because glass is a good
uliulator. However, some flasks are made of steel for
ndded strength. Air is removed from the gap between the
double walls, creating a vacuum. This reduces losses by
• onduction and convection because both of them need a
material to travel through. The silver coating on the glass
induces losses by radiation by reflecting any infrared
inflation. The stopper is made of plastic and it prevents
losses by convection and evaporation.
Figure 11.33: This couple are hoping to have a baby by IVF
The flask they are holding contains their frozen embryos.
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 11.2
Marketing a vacuum flask
Imagine you have just invented the vacuum flask.
You want to go into business producing and selling
flasks but need finance. Prepare a presentation for
potential investors. You will need to explain the
technical details of how it works. You must use the
words 'conduction', 'convection' and 'radiation'.
The investors want to know you are an expert and
understand the science. You should also explain
why your product will be popular with customers.
Your presentation can include an information
leaflet, a video or an advertising poster.
A car engine bums fuel and so gets very hot. The cooling
system (Figure 11 .34a) transfers some of this thermal
energy to the surroundings so the engine does not
overheat. This system uses many of the things you have
learnt:
• Specific heat capacity: water flows around the block
to absorb thermal energy. Water is a good choice as
it has a very high specific heat capacity.
• Convection: as the water is heated, a convection
current flows in the direction shown by the arrows.
The pump is used to speed up this flow.
• Conduction: the radiator has metal fins (Figure
11.34b) so the thermal energy is conducted to all
parts of the radiator.
• Radiation: the fins have a large surface area and are
black to increase the rate of thermal energy radiation.
Wood burns on a bonfire to ’produce thermal energy.
The heating effect you experience when sitting by a fire is
almost entirely due to radiation. Air is a bad conductor
and thermal energy transfer due to convection will heat
the air above the fire.
Figure 11.35: The older child will feel hotter than the
younger child as his black T-shirt absorbs infrared radiation
whereas the white T-shirt reflects the infrared radiation.
f
1
Thermal energy transfer,
climate and weather
Radiation from the Sun is essential for life on Earth.
The Sun’s radiation warms the Earth. The warm Earth
emits some infrared radiation. Gases in the Earth’s
atmosphere, such as carbon dioxide, absorb some of this
thermal energy and this warms our atmosphere. This is
the greenhouse effect (Figure 11.36) and without it life
on Earth would be impossible. However, the amount
of greenhouse gases in the atmosphere is increasing,
trapping more thermal energy. This means that Earth
and its atmosphere are absorbing more infrared radiation
than they emit. This is the cause of global warming.
water
Figure 11.34a: Transfer of thermal energy in a car cooling
system, b: The black metal radiator cooler fins in a car.
206
Figure 11.36: For the Earth to maintain a constant
temperature, infrared radiation must be emitted at the same
rate as it is absorbed. Upsetting this balance is causing
global warming.
11
Thermal energy transfers
I flure. 11.37: Convection currents in the oceans flow in predictable directions. The red lines show warm surface water and
lh< blue lines show the flow of the deeper, colder water. The warm currents affect the climate. For example, the British Isles
in warmed by the Gulf steam (a flow of warm water from the Gulf of Mexico).
currents explain the origins of winds and
• onvection
currents, which are two of the major factors that
oisan
i
1 7 The coat in Figure 11.38 is designed for a cold
climate.
ontrol climate patterns around the world. For example,
warm air rises above the Equator, and colder air sinks in
Mibtropical areas. This creates the pattern of trade winds
that are experienced in the tropics.
<)cean currents (Figure 11.37) help to spread thermal
nergy from equatorial regions to cooler parts of the
I arth’s surface. Warm water at the surface of the sea
flows towards the poles. In polar regions, colder water
Minks and flows back towards the Equator. Provided this
I uttern remains constant, this helps to make temperate
legions of the world more habitable. However, there is
that the pattern of ocean currents is changing,
perhaps as a consequence of global warming.
Questions
16 In a rolling mill, iron is heated to make it malleable
and it is then passed through rollers to produce
thin sheets of the metal. Explain how the following
become hot in this process:
the rollers which press the metal
a
b the face of a worker
c the air in the building.
Figure 11.38
Describe the features of the coat which prevent
thermal energy loss by:
a conduction
b convection
radiation.
c
207
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
18 Figure 11.39 shows a solar water heater. Cold water
flows through the pipes and is heated by the Sun.
Suggest reasons why:
the inside of the panel is painted black
a
b the back of the panel is insulated
the cold water enters at the bottom of the
c
panel, and leaves at the top.
Figure 11 .39: A solar water heater.
PROJECT
Be the teacher
Homework questions
A student has submitted their answers to a homework
question. As you will see, they have not understood
the topic. Your task is to:
1
•
Mark their work and identify any mistakes. Is there
anything that shows they have been listening in
class? Write brief encouraging feedback notes
so the student will be willing to try again. Discuss
with your group where the student is going
wrong and what you might do to help them avoid
making this mistake again.
•
Write a model answer. Each member of the
group should do this individually, then as a
group, share your ideas and make sure you
have the best possible answer.
•
Plan a five minute revision session in which you
explain the main points the student has missed.
You can do this using presentation software,
a short video, an illustrated talk or you could
demonstrate some experiments (check with
your teacher). Include study hints on how to
remember key points as well as the factual
information. Make your presentation as lively
and relevant as you can.
•
Deliver this revision session to another group of
students.
•
Prepare a follow up worksheet, with answers, to
check that the students have understood your
presentation.
The photograph shows a reusable insulated
coffee cup.
Explain how the cup reduces thermal energy
loss by conduction, convection and radiation.
2
A student heats some ice. She records the
temperature and plots a graph.
Describe what is happening at each stage of the
graph and identify any important temperatures.
208
)
11 Thermal energy transfers
PEER ASSESSMENT
< )nce your peers have completed your worksheet, read their answers and give them feedback. Comment on
how well they use scientific terms, and how clear their explanations are.
REFLECTION
What problems did you encounter while working on this project?
Did playing the part of the teacher tell you anything about the way you learn?
SUMMARY
1 Metals are good thermal conductors. Most non-metals are good insulators.
1 Metals are good thermal conductors because they have free electrons.
1 Hot fluids are less dense than cold fluids. This causes convection currents.
Infrared radiation transfers thermal energy using electromagnetic waves.
1 Infrared radiation does not require a medium (it can travel through a vacuum).
1 Shiny, white surfaces reflect infrared radiation. They are poor emitters and absorbers of infrared radiation.
1 Dull, black surfaces are good absorbers and emitters of infrared radiation, but poor reflectors.
1‘he amount of infrared radiation emitted also depends on the surface area and temperature of the object.
209
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which word describes a material that does not let thermal energy pass
through it?
A conductor
B vacuum
C resistor
D insulator
[1 ]
2 Which states of matter can convention happen in?
A solids and liquids
B liquids and gases
C gases and solids
D solids, liquids and gases
[1 ]
3 Hot fluids rise. This can be explained because, as the fluid gets hotter,
there is a decrease in the fluid’s:
A mass
[1 ]
B temperature
C density
D volume
4 This diagram shows an electric water heater.
COMMAND WORDS
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
a The copper wall is hot to touch. Name the process by which thermal
energy from the water passes through the wall.
[1 ]
b Describe how a heater at the bottom of the tank heats all the water in
the tank.
[3]
c The hot walls transfer thermal energy to the surroundings. Suggest a
way this thermal energy loss could be reduced.
[1 ]
[Total: 5]
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations where
there are a range
of valid responses
in order to make
proposals/put forward
considerations
11
Thermal energy transfers
CONTINUED
Suggest a question which can be answered using the apparatus in
the diagram.
[1]
COMMAND WORD
b Explain which rod you would expect the drawing pin to fall from first.
[2]
c Describe two features of the experiment which make it a fair test.
[2]
[Total: 5]
The diagram shows a Leslie cube. It is a metal box and each side has a
different surface.
Leslie cube
shiny black
shiny 'silver'
heatproof mat
matte black
matte white
Saraya uses a Leslie cube to investigate infrared radiation. She fills the cube
with boiling water so all sides are at the same temperature. She uses the
infrared detector to investigate the radiation from each surface.
a Why is it important to keep the detector the same distance from
each side?
b Match the surfaces to the temperatures. The first one has been done
for you.
64.5 °C
shiny black
71.2 °C
matte black
60.4 °C
shiny silver
65.3 °C
matte white
[1]
[2]
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons / make
the relationships
between things
evident I provide
why and / or how and
support with relevant
evidence
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
*
CONTINUED
c Saraya’s infrared detector gave the temperature to the nearest 0.1 °C.
Zain repeats the experiment using a different infrared detector which
gives the temperature to the nearest degree.
[2]
Suggest how Zain’s conclusion will differ from Saraya’s.
[Total: 5]
7 Some double glazed windows have a plastic frame and two panes of glass
with a vacuum between them.
a Explain why plastic is used for the frame.
[1 ]
b Name the types of thermal energy transfer which are stopped by
the vacuum.
[2]
c Double glazing reduces thermal energy losses from a house. Describe
two other ways to reduce thermal energy losses and state the type of
[4]
thermal energy transfer which each reduces.
[Total: 7]
8 Two beakers are filled with water at 20 °C. Beaker A is placed outside in the
snow at -5 °C. Beaker B is placed in a room at 25 °C. The temperature of
each beaker is taken half an hour later.
a State what you would expect to happen to the temperatures of the two
[2]
beakers.
b Explain your answer in terms of the energy radiated or absorbed by
the water in each beaker.
[2]
c A third beaker, also filled with water at 20 °C remains at this temperature.
State and explain what you can deduce from this about where the third
[2]
beaker has been placed..
[Total: 6]
212
>
COMMAND WORD
state: express in
clear terms
11 Thermal energy transfers
'.ELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
X I r studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
iin
I can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Describe experiments to show the properties of
conductors and insulators.
11.1
I ixplain thermal conduction in metallic conductors in
terms of free electrons.
11.1
State that thermal energy is transferred by convection in
lluids.
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
11.2
Explain how changes in density cause convection
currents.
11.2
Describe experiments to demonstrate convection.
11.2
Describe experiments to demonstrate convection.
11.2
State that infrared radiation is a part of the
electromagnetic spectrum and can pass through a
vacuum.
11.3
Describe how the surface of an object affects how it
emits, reflects or absorbs infrared radiation.
11.3
Describe experiments to show which surfaces absorb
and emit most infrared radiation.
11.3
Describe and explain some practical applications of
thermal energy transfer.
11.4
213
)
> Chapter 12
Sound
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
describe how sounds are produced and how they travel
measure the speed of sound
III
describe how the amplitude and frequency of a sound wave are linked to its loudness and pitch
state the range of human hearing
define the term 'ultrasound' and describe some of its applications.
12 Sound
.ETTING STARTED
•
Draw a table like this. Your table should fill a piece of A4 paper.
How are sounds made?
How does sound travel?
How fast is sound?
How do we detect sound?
How do sounds differ from each other?
Are there sounds we cannot hear?
Write or draw something in each cell of the table. Make it as detailed as you can.
Pair up with another student and compare your tables. Make any additions or changes you want to based on
your discussion.
Join with another pair and share your ideas. Again, make any changes.
THE SOUND OF SILENCE
In this chapter we will look at how sounds are
created, how they travel and how we hear sounds.
We will also look at why sounds can be so varied.
Why are some sounds high or low pitched? Why are
some sounds loud and others quiet?
Figure 12.1: Outer space is a
vacuum. This means sounds
cannot travel through it.
Astronauts communicate by
using radio waves.
Discussion questions
1
Evelyn Glennie (Figure 12.2) is one of the
world's top percussionists despite being
profoundly deaf. Can you work out how she
experiences sound? (Hint: she plays barefoot.)
We are surrounded by sounds. Natural sounds
include birds, animals and the wind. Other sounds
include cars, computers and musical instruments.
'Jounds wake us, sounds alert us that our food is
ooked, our plane is ready to board or that a car is
approaching. It is hard for most of us to imagine a
World without sound. How would we communicate
।
our emotions? How would a baby attract attention
When it is hungry? How different would our forms of
ontertainment be?
Our world is increasingly noisy as we add more
machines and technology. Silence is not something
city dwellers hear often. Psychologists believe noise
r. a major cause of stress. Acoustic engineers study
^ays to make a better sound environment. Mobile
phone noise is alleviated by using vibration rather
than sound to inform us of a call.
It is important for our wellbeing to reduce unnecessary
rloise, but sound reduction is not always entirely
positive. Silent electric cars raise fears of more
accidents as people are unaware of their approach.
Figure 12.2: Some people are born or become deaf,
or they are only able to hear a limited range of sound.
They learn how to navigate the world using other
senses.
2
Discuss with a partner all the ways in which
you have used sound today. What adaptations
could you make to get through your daily
activities if you could not hear sounds?
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
12.1 Making sounds
All sounds are caused by something vibrating. The
vibrations are not always visible because they may be too
small or too fast. Vibrating sources cause the air around
them to vibrate. These vibrations are passed through the
air to our ears where they cause the eardrum to vibrate
and we hear sound.
Figure 1 2.5: Hitting the gong with a harrimer causes it to
vibrate.
Figure 1 2.3: The water particles on this speaker are
vibrating as the speaker makes a sound. The vibrations
of the speaker and the water will change if the pitch or
loudness of the sound is changed.
AiMnltIv
Figures 12.4-12.7 link sounds to the vibrating sources
which cause them.
Figure 1 2.6: The cicada has ribbed membranes at the bas
of its abdomen which vibrate causing a particularly loud
sound.
Figure 12.4: Hitting the tuning fork causes the prongs to
vibrate.
216
>
Figure 12.7: Vocal folds in the human throat vibrate to
create speech.
12 Sound
Musical sounds
Musical instruments are engineered to vibrate in ways
thill make a range of interesting and beautiful sounds.
Wind instruments are blown to cause the column of
air inside to vibrate. Players cover and uncover holes to
change the length of the air column. This changes the
pitch of the note.
Figure 12.10: The system of holes on a flute allows a range
of notes to be played.
figure 12.8: Djembe drums are made in a range of sizes
i । produce different notes. The skin vibrates when hit and
produces sound waves.
Siring instruments are plucked or bowed to cause them to
> ibrate. The length of the string can be changed (usually
by holding the string down with a finger) and this changes
I he note produced. The body of the instrument and the
ur inside it also vibrate and this gives the instrument its
ililtinctive sound. This is why an oud and a violin can
play the same note but sound very different.
An orchestra produces vibrations by a complex
combination of hitting, plucking, bowing and blowing.
These vibrations pass through the air to the audience,
causing their eardrums to vibrate, so they hear the sound.
If the sound is very loud, such as at a rock concert, the
audience may feel vibrations throughout their bodies and
through the floor.
Questions
1
2
3
What are all sounds caused by?
A drum, a flute and a violin all play a note. For each
instrument state what vibrates to create the sound.
Describe how a drummer hitting a drum leads to a
listener hearing sound.
12.2 How does
sound travel?
I Igure 1 2.9: The musician's left hand varies the length of the
it rings whilst his right plucks the strings to cause vibrations.
Sound is a series of vibrations passing through air or
another material. The source of the sound vibrates and
this makes the air particles around it vibrate back and
forward in the direction the sound is travelling. These
vibrations make a sound wave. This type of wave is called
a longitudinal wave.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
You will learn more about waves in Chapter 14.
The movement of the air particles can be demonstrated
using a slinky spring, as shown in Figure 12.11.
The vibrations of the prohgs are not easy to see, but th
effect on water can be dramatic, as seen in Figure 12.13
Figure 1 2.1 3: The number on the tuning fork tells us that
the fork vibrates 440 times a second.
;
Figure 12.11: Moving the end of the spring back and forwards
causes the coils of the spring to be squashed together and
then stretched out. The squashed up area moves along the
spring but the spring remains in its original place.
z
More about sound waves
When a tuning fork is hit, it the prongs start to vibrate.
Figure 12.12 shows how this creates a sound wave. As
the right-hand prong moves forward, it squashes the air
particles together. This makes a dense region in the air
called a compression. As it moves back, the air particles
are more spread out, making a less dense region called
a rarefaction. Air does not move from the tuning fork to
the listener - the vibrations pass through the air by the
patterns of compressions and rarefactions caused by the
air molecules being pushed back and forth.
KEY WORDS
compression: a region of a sound wave where
the particles are pushed together
rarefaction: a region of a sbund wave where the
particles are further apart
What can sound travel through
Sound waves are vibrations caused by particles moving
back and forth. In a vacuum there are no particles, so i
is impossible for sound to travel.
Sound needs a medium (material) to travel through. T1
can be shown using a bell in a glass jar. Figure 12.14
shows an experiment to demonstrate this.
Figure 12.12: The tuning fork's prongs move back and forth creating compressions and rarefactions in the air.
218
>
I
12 Sound
The Sun is very active and yet we hear no sound from it.
This is because there are no particles to carry the huge
disturbances caused by explosions and solar flares. We
can see the Sun because, unlike sound waves, light waves
can travel through a vacuum.
Another major difference between sound and light waves
is their speed. Light travels at 300 000 000 m/s, about a
million times faster than sound. This means we see the
lightning almost as it happens but hear the sound later.
To calculate how many kilometres away the storm is,
measure the time between the lightning and the thunder
and divide by three. This works because sound travels
1 km in about 3 seconds.
figure 12.14: When the battery is connected, the bell can
I seen and heard. Vibrations from the bell pass through the
in the jar, through the glass and then through the air to
your ear. When the pump removes the air from the jar, the
bell can still be seen vibrating, but cannot be heard.
"■
Sound can travel through solids. You may be able to
hear sounds from outside the classroom as you read this.
Sound vibrations can travel through the walls.
Bounds can also pass through liquids. Many sea animals
luch as dolphins and whales use sound to communicate
With each other and to navigate.
bC
*V
e •<
•
Questions
4
5
6
Explain why sound cannot be heard in a vacuum.
Describe and explain what is heard when the
vacuum pump in figure 12.14 is switched on.
A boy sees lightning and hears the thunderclap 9
seconds later. Calculate how far away is the storm is.
12.3 The speed of sound
Sound travels at between 330 m/s and 350 m/s in air. The
speed changes slightly depending on the temperature and
humidity of the air. This is much slower than light, but
still so fast that we are usually not aware of the time it
takes for sounds to reach us, unless the distance it travels
is large.
An echo is a reflected sound wave. If you bang two
wooden blocks together in the classroom you will hear
only one bang. The sound will reflect from the walls, but
the echo will be so close to the original bang that you
will not hear it as a separate sound. Banging the blocks
outside will mean the sound has further to travel so you
may hear an echo. This can be used to measure the speed
of sound.
approximate size of earth
Figure 12.15: This is a solar flare, where a huge amount of
matter is emitted by the Sun. An explosion like this on Earth
would create a deafening sound.
219
)
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 12.1
Measuring the speed of sound in air
1
Stand a measured distance (ideally at least
50 metres) from a large flat wall. Bang the
blocks together and listen for the echo.
2
Now try to bang the blocks in an even rhythm
so that each clap coincides with the echo of the
previous bang. This will mean you don't hear
You can calculate the speed of sound in air by
measuring the time taken for an echo to be heard.
You will need:
• 2 wooden blocks
the echo separately from the next bang. This
may take some practice.
•
stopwatch
•
long tape measure or trundle wheel.
3
Your partner should then measure the time for
20 of your bangs.
Safety: You will be creating very loud sounds. Avoid
doing this near anyone's ears as loud sounds can
damage the ear.
4
Record the time taken for 20 bangs and the
distance from the wall.
Getting started
5
Calculate the total distance travelled by the
sound. Each bang involves the sound travelling
to the wall and back, so the total distance is
20 x 2 x distance from wall.
Why is it necessary to stand a long distance from
the wall?
Why will it be difficult to measure the time from
hitting the blocks together to hearing the echo?
6
, distance travelled
:
Method
speed =
large flat wall
at least 50 m
Figure 12.1 6: Measuring the speed of sound in air.
A more precise value of the speed of sound can be
obtained using an electronic timer and microphones.
Figure 12.17 shows this method. The wooden blocks and
the two microphones are arranged in a straight line.
When the students bangs the two blocks of wood
together, it creates a sudden, loud sound. The sound
reaches microphone 1 and a pulse of electric current
is sent to the timer. The timer starts timing. A fraction
of a second later the sound reaches microphone 2.
220
y
Calculate the speed of sound in air.
Use the equation:
;
time taken
Questions
1
What is the actual speed of sound in air?
How does the value you calculated compare
to this?
2
Which measurement (distance or time) do you
think was least accurate? Explain your answer.
REFLECTION
Discuss the experiment with a partner. Suggest
ways to improve your experiment to increase the
accuracy of this measurement.
A second pulse of current is sent to the timer and stops
it. The timer now indicates the time it took for the sour
to travel from microphone 1 to microphone 2. If the
distance between the two microphones is measured, the
speed of sound can be calculated using the equation:
distance
speed
j
_
time
12 Sound
microphone 2
5000
timer
42 4000
3000
microphone 1
<D
2000
1000
0
air
brick
Material
water
iron
Figure 12.18: The speed of sound in different materials.
Questions
figure 12.17: Another method for measuring the speed
"I sound.
7
WORKED EXAMPLE 12.1
8
A man blows a whistle and hears the echo from a rock
face after 3.6 seconds. How far away from the rock is
9
he? Assume speed of sound in air = 340 m/s.
Step 1: Calculate the distance travelled by the sound,
speed distance
= time
so, distance
= speed x time
= 340 m/s x 3.6 s
= 1244m
Step 2: Halve this distance. (The distance you have
already calculated is the total distance
travelled by the sound, to the rock face and
back. The distance to the rock face is half of
this.)
1224
612m
2
Answer
=
A spectator at a cricket match sees the batsman hit
the ball, then 1.2 seconds later he hears the strike.
How far away is the spectator? The speed of sound
in air is 330 m/s.
Sound travels at 1 500 m/s in fresh water and at
1530 m/s in salt water. Explain the difference in
speeds.
Explain why the method shown in Figure 12.17
is more accurate than the echo method when
measuring the speed of sound.
12.4 Seeing and hearing
sounds
Seeing sounds
A cathode ray oscilloscope and microphone can be used
to represent sounds on a display screen (Figure 12.19).
The microphone picks up the sound and converts it to an
electrical signal. The oscilloscope converts this to a line
which represents the vibrations that make up the sound
wave.
Sound travels at different speeds in different materials.
The vibration from a musical instrument is complicated
because it is produced by vibrations of the air and the
instrument itself. A signal generator can be used to
produce a pure sound wave. Pure notes are easier to
measure, but not so musical.
Figure 12.18 shows the speed in different materials.
This can be explained by considering the spacing of
particles. Particles are closer together in solids than in
liquids, so the vibrations can be passed on more easily
in solids. This means that the sound wave travels faster in
u solid.
The oscilloscope trace that represents a pure note
is a simple curve as shown in Figure 12.20a. When
representing a musical note from a particular musical
instrument, the pattern is more complicated. Figures
12.20b and c show this.
The rock face is 612 metres away from the man.
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
The oscilloscope can be used to observe two important
things about the wave (Figure 12.21).
• The amplitude is the furthest distance the particles
move from their undisturbed position. This is show
by the height or depth of the oscilloscope trace.
• The frequency is the number of vibrations each
second. The more waves on the screen, the higher
the frequency. Frequency is measured in hertz.
One hertz means one wave per second.
KEY WORDS
amplitude: the greatest height or depth of a
wave from its undisturbed position
frequency: the number of complete vibrations or
waves per unit time
hertz: the unit of frequency; 1 Hz =1 wave per
second
Figure 12.1 9: As the student blows, he creates vibrations in
the air. The vibrations are detected by the microphone and
converted to electrical signals, which are displayed on the
oscilloscope.
Signal generator
Figure 12.21: The frequency of the note can be calculated
from the oscilloscope trace. This oscilloscope is set at
20 ms/div. This means each division on the grid represents
20 ms (0.02 s). The time for one wave (marked as T) is two
divisions or 0.04 seconds. One wave takes 0.04 seconds, so
the number of waves each second is 1 + 0.04 = 25 Hz.
Piano
Figure 1 2.20: The three representations of sound waves
shown here are all the same note. Each wave has a repeating
pattern. The design of the instrument adds extra vibrations
called overtones which give each instrument its distinctive
sound. All three waves have four repeats, meaning that they
all are the same note.
222
y
Connecting a signal generator and a speaker to an
oscilloscope allows you to both see a representation of
the sound wave and hear the sound.
Increasing the loudness of the sound produces taller
waves - they have a bigger amplitude. Increasing the
frequency means more waves will be seen on the screen they have a higher frequency, and the sound heard will t
higher pitched. Remember:
• high frequency means high pitch
• large amplitude means loud sound.
12
Sound
Hearing sounds
Young humans can hear sounds from 20 Hz up to 20 000 Hz.
A* we grow older, the sensory cells in the ear which detect
ibrations deteriorate. This means that the range of sounds
hich can be heard decreases with age. These cells can also
I " damaged by repeated exposure to very loud noise.
Sounds which have a higher frequency than 20 000 Hz
u re too high pitched to be heard by the human ear.
I hese sounds are known as ultrasound.
KEY WORD
ultrasound: any sound with a frequency higher
than 20 000 Hz
Many animals can hear high pitched sounds that we
cannot. Many animals such as dolphins communicate
Using ultrasound. Whistles creating ultrasound can be
used to train animals (Figure 12.22).
Figure 12.22: This whistle was invented by a scientist called
Francis Galton in around 1900 to help him investigate human
hearing. Similar whistles are used in animal training.
ACTIVITY 12.1
An annoying noise
The mosquito sound alarm is a device intended to
stop young people congregating in areas where they
are not wanted. The device emits a high pitched
pulsing sound which young people can hear but
older people cannot. It is not harmful but is annoying
to those who can hear it.
Prepare a leaflet to inform young people about the
device and the science behind it. Use the words
'frequency' and 'ultrasound' in your explanation.
PEER ASSESSMENT
Swap leaflets with another student. Complete a grid like this to give them feedback:
Question
©@® Comments
Does the leaflet explain what the
frequency of a sound is?
Does it explain the difference in
hearing range between teenagers
and adults?
Does it explain why the mosquito
device will stop young people
hanging around where they are
not wanted?
*
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Applications of ultrasound
Sonar
trace A. Oscilloscope trace B has an extra peak. This
indicates to the engineers that some ultrasound is being
reflected from a crack or flaw inside the metal.
Sonar is a method used to measure the depth of water or
to locate an underwater object. Figure 12.23 shows how
this works.
Figure 1 2.23: Using sonar to measure depth. What effect
might the fish have?
A pulse of ultrasound is sent down from a boat and reflects
from the seabed. The time taken for the reflected pulse to
be received is measured. This is used, with the speed of
sound in water to calculate the depth of the water.
WORKED EXAMPLE 12.2
Figure 12.24: The exact location of the flaw can be
calculated from the speed of sound in t(ie metal and the
time for the reflected pulse to be detected.
.
:
Ultrasound is also used in medicine (Figure 12.25).
Ultrasonic waves are partially reflected from boundaries
between different materials, such as the chambers of
a patient’s heart, or a fetus. Computer analysis of the
reflected waves produces an image.
A ship sends out an ultrasound pulse and receives the
echo after 3 seconds. The speed of sound in water is
1500 m/s. Calculate the depth of the water.
Step 1: Calculate the distance travelled by the pulse:
distance = speed x time 1500 m/s x 3 s
= 4500 m
=
Step 2: Halve this to get the depth. Remember the
pulse goes down and back up again.
m
-4500
A
depth
- 2250 m
-
——
Answer
The depth of the water is 2250 m.
Figure 1 2.25: The ultrasound image shows the doctor and
the mother how this fetus is developing.
Material testing
Ultrasound can be used to detect flaws inside materials.
A small crack in a metal girder could cause a building
to collapse. Figure 12.24 shows ultrasound being passed
through uncracked (A) and cracked (B) metal. The
original and reflected pulses are shown on oscilloscope
224
y
Questions
1 0 State the range of sound a young person can
typically hear.
11 Describe what happens to this range as the person
gets older. What else can have this effect on hearing?
12 Sound
12 Figure 12.26 shows the traces produced on an
oscilloscope by three different sounds.
Figure 12.26: Three sounds produced on an oscilloscope.
a
b
Which sound is quietest? Explain your answer.
Which two sounds have the same pitch?
Explain your answer.
Figure 12.27: Using ultrasound to find depth.
13 A ship positioned above a shoal of fish (Figure
12.27) sends out an ultrasound pulse and receives
two reflected pulses, one after 0.2 seconds and the
other after 0.5 seconds. The speed of sound in water
is 1500 m/s.
a
b
Calculate the depth of the sea.
Calculate the depth of the shoal of fish.
Explain why the first reflected pulse lasts for
longer than the second.
PROJECT
How do musical instruments produce a range
of notes?
•
Is the note produced by a string affected by
other factors such as the material it is made
from, its thickness or the tension (how tightly it
is stretched)?
•
How is the frequency of a note from a string
related to length? You can measure the
frequency of the sound directly or by using a
microphone and oscilloscope. You can draw a
graph of frequency against length.
Your task is to investigate how different instruments
create a range of sounds.
Wind instruments
Wind instruments produce sounds by making
columns of air vibrate. Putting different amounts of
air into test tubes creates columns of air above the
water. The air can be made to vibrate by tapping the
glass or by blowing over the top of the tube.
Investigate the effect ofchanging the length of the
air column. How does it affect the pitch of the note
produced?
Present your results to the class. This could be
as a poster, a talk, a presentation, or playing a
recognisable tune on an improvised instrument.
You should include evidence such as diagrams,
tables or graphs.
Plucked instruments
Plucking a stretched string creates a sound. Use a
stringed instrument or a homemade elastic band
guitar to investigate the relationship between the
length of the string and the pitch of the sound.
Optional
Extend your investigation to answer one of the
following:
•
What other methods are used to produce
different notes in musical instruments?
Figure 12.28: A musical instrument that is plucked.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SUMMARY
All sounds are caused by vibrating sources.
Sound waves are longitudinal waves.
Sound waves consist of a series of compressions and rarefactions.
Sound waves need a medium to travel through.
Sound travels at between 330 m/s and 350 m/s in air.
Sound travels fastest in solids and slowest in gases.
An echo is a reflected sound.
The greater the amplitude of a sound, the louder the sound.
The greater the frequency of a sound, the higher its pitch.
Humans can hear sounds between 20 Hz and 20 000 Hz.
Ultrasound can be used in medical scans, testing materials and depth calculation.
226
>
12 Sound
CONTINUED
4 a What is meant by the term ‘frequency of a sound’?
[1]
[1 ]
b What units is frequency measured in?
c What name is given to sounds with a frequency of more than
20000 Hz?
d
[1]
COMMAND WORD
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
5 A irummer is playing a solo.
a Describe how the sound produced travels through the air.
b What type of wave is a sound wave?
Describe an experiment to show that sound needs a medium to
travel through.
[1]
[1 ]
[2]
[Total: 4]
6 A ship uses echo sounding to find the depth of the water. It sends out an
ultrasound pulse and detects the echo after 3 seconds.
a Calculate the depth of the water. Assume that the speed of sound in
water is 1500 m/s.
b The ship’s siren is heard by a boy windsurfing nearby. He is 400 metres
away from the boat. How long will the sound take to reach him.
Assume that the speed of sound in air is 340 m/s.
c The sound of the siren also travels through the metal body of the ship.
Which of these could be the speed of sound in the steel?
200 m/s
1200 m/s
5800 m/s
[2]
[2]
[1]
[Total: 5]
227
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to se<
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
See
Needs
Amost
Topic...
more work
there
Describe how sounds are produced.
12.1
Describe sound waves.
12.1
Use the terms ‘compression’ and ‘rarefaction’.
12.2
State that sound needs a medium.
12.2
State the speed of sound in air.
12.3
Describe a method to measure the speed of sound in air.
12.3
Compare the speed of sound in solids, liquids and gases.
12.3
Describe how the amplitude of a sound affects
its loudness.
12.4
Describe how the frequency of a sound affects its pitch.
12.4
Explain how an echo is made.
12.3
Define the term ‘ultrasound’.
12.4
State the range of sounds which humans can hear.
12.4
Describe medical and engineering applications
of ultrasound.
12.4
228
>
Confident
cl
to move
Light
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
use the law of reflection of light to explain how an image is formed in a plane mirror
construct ray diagrams for reflection
investigate the refraction of light
draw ray diagrams to show how lenses form images
describe the difference between real and virtual images
describe total internal reflection and how it is used
describe how the visible spectrum is formed.
I
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
The statements opposite are all true, but there
are some exceptions to each statement. Discuss
each statement and identify when light behaves
differently. Rewrite each statement to include
these exceptions.
•
.
*
Light travels in straight lines.
, ,
. , ,
L,9ht Passes stra,9ht throu9h 9^.
,. ,
Ljght always travels at the same speed.
THE WORLD IN A DROP OF RAIN
The image in Figure 13.1 has been captured using
a camera which also contains a lens to produce
an image.
Light travels at 300 million metres per second, so it
takes eight minutes and 20 seconds to travel from
the Sun to the Earth. This means that if the Sun
stopped producing light, we would not know for
eight minutes and 20 seconds.
In this chapter you will learn more about the
processes of reflection and refraction, which can help
us explain how light behaves.
Figure 13.1: The light is bent by the raindrop, forming an
upside down image of the scene.
This raindrop on a blade of glass shows an image
of its surroundings. The light rays causing this have
travelled about 150 million kilometres from the
Sun to the Earth. Some rays striking the grass are
absorbed and supply energy for photosynthesis,
while others are reflected, allowing you to see the
grass. Those rays passing through the water drop are
refracted (bent) to form the image that you see.
Notice that the Sun is at the bottom and the trees
appear to grow downwards. The image is upside
down. Your eyes contain lenses which produce
images in a very similar way to the water drop.
Light from the Sun reflects from different objects and
enters your eyes. The lens forms an upside-down
image, like the water drop. Your brain knows the
image is upside down so automatically turns it
upright. It has had years of practice, so you are not
aware of this process.
230
When Apollo astronauts visited the Modn, they left
behind reflectors on its surface. These are used to
measure the distance from the Earth to the Moon.
A laser beam is directed from an observatory on
Earth so that it reflects back from these reflectors
left on the lunar surface. The time taken by the light
to travel there and back is measured and, because
the speed of light is known, the distance can be
calculated.
A similar method can be used with sound waves
to measure the depth of water. Sound is reflected
from the sea bed and the time taken is measured.
Knowing the speed of sound in water allows the
depth to be calculated.
Discussion questions
1
How are these two methods similar?
2
What are the differences?
3
Why is light suitable for one and sound for
the other?
13 Light
13.1 Reflection of light
I jght usually travels in straight lines. It changes direction
if it hits a shiny surface. This change in direction at a
shiny surface such as a mirror is called reflection. We will
look at reflection in this section.
You can see that light travels in a straight line using a ray
box, as shown in Figure 1 3.2. A light bulb produces light,
which spreads out in all directions. A ray box produces a
broad beam. By placing a narrow slit in the path of the
beam, you can see a single narrow beam or ray of light.
The ray shines across a piece of paper. You can record its
position by making dots along its length. Laying a ruler
along the dots shows that they lie in a straight line.
You may see demonstrations using a different source
of light, a laser. A laser (Figure 13.3a) has the great
advantage that all of the light it produces comes out in
a narrow beam. All of the energy is concentrated in this
beam, rather than spreading out in all directions (as with
a light bulb). The total amount of energy coming from
the laser is probably much less than that from a bulb, but
it is much more concentrated. That is why it is dangerous
if a laser beam gets into your eye.
KEY WORDS
reflection the change of direction of a ray when
it strikes a surface without passing through it
ray box: apparatus used to produce a ray of light
ray: a narrow beam of light
laser: a device for producing a narrow beam
of light of a single colour (monochromatic) or
wavelength
Figure 13.2a: A ray box produces a broad beam of light,
which can be narrowed down using a metal plate with a slit
in it. b: Marking the line of the ray with crosses allows you to
record its position.
Figure 13.3a: Laser beams are very intense. It is important to
protect your eyes when using a laser, b: Scarring (just left of
centre) to the retina of a child after looking at a laser pointer.
231
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Looking in the mirror
Most of us look in a mirror, at least once a day, to check
on our appearance (Figure 13.4). It is important to us to
know how people see us.
Archaeologists have found bronze mirrors more than
2000 years old, so the desire to see ourselves clearly has
been around for a long time.
The angle of incidence, i, and tfte angle of reflection, r, are
found to be equal to each other. This is the law of reflection:
angle of incidence angle of reflection
i r
Angles of incidence and reflection are always measured
between the ray and the normal to the surface. The angles
between the rays and the mirror are also equal, but it
would be hard to measure them if the mirror was curved.
The law of reflection also works for curved mirrors.
=
=
KEY WORDS
incident ray: a ray of light arriving at a surface
reflected ray: a ray of light which has been
reflected from a surface
ray diagram: a diagram showing the path of rays
of light
angle of incidence: the angle between the
incident ray and the normal drawn at the point
where the ray hits the surface
angle of reflection: the angle between the
reflected ray and the normal drawn at the point
where the ray hits the surface
normal: the line drawn at right angles to a surface
at the point where a ray hits the surface
Figure 13.4: Psychologists use mirrors to test the
intelligence of animals. Do they recognise that they are
looking at themselves? Chimpanzees' reactions show they
clearly do recognise their images. Other animals, such as
cats and dogs, do not - they may even try to attack their
own reflection.
Modern mirrors give a very clear image. When you look
in a mirror, rays of light from your face reflect off the
shiny surface and back to your eyes. You seem to see an
image of yourself behind the mirror. To understand why
this is, we need to use the law of reflection of light.
ACTIVITY 13.1
Investigating the law of reflection
When a ray of light reflects off a mirror or other reflecting
surface, it follows a path as shown in Figure 13.5. The ray
bounces off, rather like a ball bouncing off a wall. The two
rays are known as the incident ray and the reflected ray.
ray
Figure 1 3.6: Investigating the law of reflection.
The student in Figure 13.6 is investigating the law
of reflection.
Figure 13.5: This ray diagram shows the reflection of light.
The normal is drawn at 90° to the mirror. Then the angles are
measured between the rays and the normal. The angle of
incidence and the angle of reflection are equal: i = r.
232
y
Write step-by-step instructions for his investigation.
Include a list of the apparatus needed, and the
measurements that he should take.
13 Light
The image in a plane mirror
Why do we see such a clear image when we look in a
plane mirror? And why does it appear to be behind the
mirror?
travelled in straight lines from a point behind the mirror,
shown by the dashed lines. (Our brains assume that light
travels in straight lines, even though we know that light
is reflected by mirrors.) In reality, no light is coming from
behind the mirror. The dashed lines appear to be coming
from a point behind the mirror, at the same distance
behind the mirror as the candle is in front of it. You can
see this from the symmetry of the diagram.
The image looks as though it is the same size as the
candle. Also, it is (of course) a mirror image - it is
left-right reversed, or laterally inverted. You will know
this if you have seen writing reflected in a mirror. If you
could place the object and its image side-by-side, you
would see that they are mirror images of each other, in
the same way that your left and right hands are mirror
images of each other.
The image of the candle in the mirror is not a real image.
A real image is an image that can be formed on a screen.
If you place a piece of paper at the position of the image,
you will not see a picture of the candle on it, because no
rays of light from the candle reach that spot. That is why
we drew dashed lines, to show where the rays appear to
be coming from. We say that it is a virtual image.
KEY WORDS
image: what we see when we view an object by
means of reflected rays
plane mirror: (or a flat mirror) a mirror with a flat,
reflective surface
laterally inverted: an image in which left and
right have been reversed
real image: an image that can be formed on a
screen
Figure 13.7a: Looking in the mirror, the observer sees an
Image of the candle. The image appears to be behind the
mirror, b: The ray diagram shows how the image is formed
Rays from the candle flame are reflected according to the
law of reflection.
Figure 13.7a shows how an observer sees an image of
u candle in a plane mirror. Light rays from the flame
are reflected by the mirror . Some of them enter the
observer’s eye. The observer has to look forward and
slightly to the left to see the image of the candle.
Figure 13.7b shows how the image is formed. The solid
lines show the light from the candle reflecting from
the mirror. The girl’s brain assumes that the rays have
virtual image: an image that cannot be formed
on a screen
To summarise, when an object is reflected in a plane
mirror, its image is:
•
the same size as the object
•
the same distance behind the mirror as the object is
in front of it
• laterally inverted
• virtual.
233
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
1
a
2
A student investigated the^law of reflection. She
increased her angle of incidence by 20° each time.
Why is the word ambulance written in reverse
on the front of this vehicle?
a
b
Angle of incidence
Angle of reflection
20°
20°
40°
39°
60°
30°
Which angle of reflection did she measure
incorrectly?
Suggest what she may have done wrong.
3
Draw a diagram to show a ray hitting a mirror with
an angle of incidence of 40°. Draw the reflected
ray. Label both rays, the normal and the angles of
incidence and reflection.
4
What angle must ray hit a mirror at for the direction
of the ray to be turned through 90°? Draw a
diagram to illustrate your answer.
i
Ray diagrams
Figure 13.8: An ambulance.
b
Write the word POLICE in the same way.
WORKED EXAMPLE 13.1
A small lamp is placed 5 cm in front of a plane mirror.
Draw an accurate scale diagram, and use it to show that
the image of the lamp is 5 cm behind the mirror.
Step 1: Draw a line to represent the mirror. Indicate its
reflecting surface by drawing short lines on the
back of the line. Mark the position of the object
(the lamp) with a cross and label it O.
The steps needed to draw the ray diagram are listed
below and shown in Figures 13.9a-d. (It helps to work
on squared paper or graph paper.)
234
Light rays follow strict rules. By following the same rules
we can construct detailed ray diagrams. These show where
an image is formed and what type of image it is. Worked
Example 13.1 shows the steps in constructing a ray diagram
plane mirror.
to show the formation of an image
in^a
1 3 Light
CONTINUED
Step 2: Draw two rays from the object to the mirror.
Draw in the normal lines where they strike
the mirror.
Figure 13.9b
Step 3: Using a protractor, measure the angle of
incidence for each ray. Mark the equal angle of
reflection. Draw in the reflected rays.
Step 4: Extend the reflected rays back behind the
mirror. Draw this using dotted lines. The point
where they cross is where the image is formed.
Label this point I.
Answer
From the diagram for Step 4, it is clear that the image is
5 cm from the mirror, directly opposite the object. The
line joining O to I is perpendicular to the mirror.
235
>
}
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
a
5
b
Figure 13.10 shows an object placed 6 cm from a
plane mirror.
Copy and complete the diagram in Figure 13.11
to show how the light reaches the observer.
The image the observer sees is not laterally
inverted. Explain why.
13.2 Refraction of light
Figure 1 3.1 2: The ripples seen on the bottom of the pool
are caused by water bending the light.
Figure 13.10: Object and mirror.
Copy Figure 13.10 and use the law of reflection
to find the path of the rays after they hit
the mirror.
b Trace these rays back to find the position of
the image.
c
Measure the perpendicular distance from the
image to the mirror.
Figure 13.1 1 shows how a periscope uses mirrors to
allow the user to see beyond obstacles.
a
6
mirror
Figure 13.11: Periscope.
236
>
If you look down at the bottom of a swimming pool, you
may see patterns of shadowy ripples as in Figure 13.12
The surface of the water is not flat. There are often small
ripples on the water, and these cause the rays of sunlight
to change direction. Where the pattern is darker, rays of
light have been bent away, producing a sort of shadow.
This bending of rays of light when they travel from one
medium to another is called refraction.
There are many effects caused by the refraction of light.
Some examples are the sparkling of diamonds, the way
the lens in your eye produces an image of the world
around you, and the twinkling of the stars in the night
sky. The image of a bent straw in liquid (Figure 13.13) is
another consequence of refraction.
Figure 13.13: The straw is partly immersed in the drink.
Because of the refraction of the light coming from the part
of the straw that is underwater, the straw appears bent.
Light
13
Refraction occurs when a ray of light travels from one
medium into another. The ray of light may change
direction. Refraction happens at the boundary between
the two materials. The ray approaching the boundary is
called the incident ray and the ray leaving the boundary
is called the refracted ray. The angle of incidence, i,
and angle of refraction, r, are measured to the normal
drawn at the point where the ray hits the boundary
(see Figure 13.14).
angle of
incidence
incident
ray
air
glass
refracted
ray
angle of
reflection
KEY WORDS
refraction: the bending of light when it passes
from one medium to another
angle of refraction: the angle between a
refracted ray and the normal to the surface at the
point where it passes from one medium to another
normal
Figure 13.14: Refraction of a light ray entering glass.
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 13.1
Investigating refraction
Method
You can investigate refraction by shining a ray of light
into a glass or Perspex® block and tracing the path of
the ray.
1
Place the block on paper and draw round it.
2
Shine a ray into the block as shown in Figure
13.15. Look carefully at the ray inside the glass.
You will see it travels in a straight line. It only
bends at the surface.
You will need:
•
•
•
rectangular glass or Perspex® block
•
glass or Perspex® of different shapes
•
•
plain paper
ray box
power pack
air
glass
optical pins.
Safety: You will be working in a darkened area, so
keep your work area tidy to avoid trip hazards.
Figure 13.15: Ray hitting the glass block.
Getting started
How will you mark the path of the rays going in and
3
out of the block?
How will you determine the path of the ray inside the
glass block?
Mark the ray going into the block and the"
ray coming out of the block with crosses or
optical pins.
4
Remove the block and draw the ray going in to
the block and the ray coming out.
237
)
> CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
5
Join these two rays to show the path of the
light through the glass.
6
Draw the normal at the points where the ray
12 Record your observations in sketches. Note any
unexpected effects you observe - these will be
explained later in this chaoter.
enters and leaves the block.
7
Measure angles i and r for the ray entering the
block and record them in a table.
Angle of incidence in
air, i
a
Angle of refraction in
glass, r
/
/
\
\
\
Figure 1 3.16: Light rays incident on glass blocks.
Questions
1
Copy and complete these sentences:
8
Repeat this for rays entering the block at
different angles.
When a ray goes from air to glass it bends
the normal.
9
If you have blocks of different materials, repeat
the experiment to find out which material
bends light the most.
For a ray going from air to glass, the angle of
is smaller than the anqle of
10 Investigate what happens if a ray of light hits
the glass block at 90°.
1 1 Investigate the refraction of light as it passes
through different shaped blocks, such as those
in Figure 13.16.
When a ray goes from glass to air it bends
the normal.
2
Describe what happens when a ray hits the
block at 90°.
\
Changing direction
Figure 13.17 shows light passing through a rectangular
block. Notice that the light only bends at the point
where it enters or leaves the block, so it is the change of
material that causes the bending.
From Figure 13.17, you can see that the direction in
which the ray bends depends on whether it is entering or
leaving the glass.
•
The ray bends towards the normal when entering
the glass.
•
The ray bends away from the normal when leaving
the glass.
One consequence of this is that, when a ray passes
through a parallel-sided block of glass or Perspex®, it
returns to its original direction of travel, although it is
shifted to one side.
238
>
Figure 13.17: Demonstrating the refraction of a ray of
light when it passes through a rectangular block of glass or
Perspex®. The ray bends as it enters the block. As it leaves,
it bends back to its original direction.
13 Light
When we look at the world through a window, we are
looking through a parallel-sided sheet of glass. Although
the rays of light are shifted slightly as they pass through
the glass, we do not see a distorted image because they
all reach us travelling in their original direction.
This matches what we have seen with light. Light slows
down when it goes from air to glass, and it bends towards
the normal (Figure 13.14).
Figure 13.19: To explain why a change in speed explains
the bending caused by refraction, picture a truck's wheels
slipping off the road into the sand. The truck turns to the
side because it cannot move so quickly through the sand.
Figure 1 3.1 8: When a ray hits a boundary at 90° it is not
refracted.
A ray of light may strike a surface at an angle of
incidence of 0°, as shown in Figure 13.18. In this case,
it does not bend - it simply passes straight through and
carries on in the same direction. Usually we say that
refraction is the bending of light when it passes from one
medium to another. However, we should bear in mind
that, when the light is perpendicular to the boundary
between the two materials, there is no bending.
Explaining refraction
Light is refracted because it travels at different speeds
in different materials. Light travels fastest in a vacuum
(empty space) and almost as fast in air. It travels more
slowly in glass, water and other transparent substances.
Figure 13.19 shows how a change of speed can cause a
change of direction. Imagine a truck is driving along a
road across the desert. The driver is careless and allows
the wheels on the left to drift off the road onto the sand.
Here, they spin around, so that the left-hand side of the
truck moves more slowly. The right-hand side is still on
the road, and keeps moving quickly, so that the truck
starts to turn to the left.
The boundary between the two materials is the edge of
the road. The normal is at right angles to the road. The
truck has turned to the left, so its direction has moved
towards the normal.
Questions
7
Describe what happens to a ray of light that passes
from:
a
air to glass
b glass to air.
8
Why are the angle of incidence and the angle of
refraction always measured between the ray and
the normal?
9
Draw a diagram to show a light ray passing from
glass to air. Mark the incident and refracted
rays, the normal and the angles of incidence
and refraction.
10 A swimming pool is lit from the bottom.
Use Figure 13.20 to explain why the swimming pool
appears to be shallower than it is.
Figure 13.20: Light in a swimming pool.
239
>
I
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Refractive index
Light travels very fast. As far as we know, nothing can
travel any faster than light. The speed of light as it travels
though empty space is exactly 299 792 458 m/s. This is
usually rounded to 300 000 000 m/s or 3 x 108 m/s.
When a ray of light passes from air into glass, it slows
down and bends towards the normal. This happens when
light passes from one transparent medium to another, or
when light passes between different regions, such as from
hot water to cold water.
The refractive index of a material is a measure of how
much the light slows, or how much it is bent. If the speed
of light is halved when it enters a material, the refractive
index is 2, and so on. The refractive index is the ratio of the
speeds of light in two different media or different regions.
KEY WORDS
speed of light: the speed at which light travels
(usually in a vacuum: 3.0 x 108m/s)
The value of
refractive index: the ratio of the speeds of a light
wave in two different media
material. This value is the refractive index ®f the material.
The refractive index of glass is about 1 .5 and the refractive
index of water is about 1.33.
— - is always the same for a, particular
sinr
Refractive index (ri) can be calculated u^ing the equation:
speed in vacuum
speed in material
Material
Speed of light /m/s
vacuum
2.998 x 108
1 exactly
air
2.997 x 108
1.0003
water
2.308 x 108
1.33
Perspex®
2.000 x 108
1.5
glass
(1.800-2.000) x 108
1.5-1.7
diamond
1.250 x 108
2.4
Table 13.1: The speed of light in some transparent
materials. Note that the values are only approximate.
Calculating refractive index
ACTIVITY 13.2
Interpreting data
You can use the measurements you took in
Experimental skills 13.1 to investigate the relationship
between the angles of incidence and refraction.
240
)
WORKED EXAMPLE 13.2
A ray of light hits the surface of water at an angle
of incidence of 30°. It is refracted at an angle of 22°.
Find the refractive index, n, of water.
Step 1: Write down what you know and what you
want to find out.
i 30°
r 22°
n=?
=
=
Step 2: Write down the equation and substitute
these values.
n llUi = sin 30
sinr sin22
=
13 Light
Step 3: Use a calculator or tables to find the sines and
calculate n.
0.5
n
0.375
1.33
_
=
Answer
n= 1.33
Questions
11 A ray of light enters a block of glass at an angle of
incidence of 40°. The angle of refraction in the glass
is 25°. Calculate the refractive index of the glass.
12 a
b
13 a
b
c
Refraction can happen when light passes from
one transparent solid to another. Use the
information in Table 13.1 to deduce what will
happen to a ray of light passing from diamond
to glass. Sketch a diagram to show what will
happen.
16 A ray of light enters glass with a refractive index of
1.52 at an angle of incidence of 60°.
a Calculate the angle of refraction.
b Calculate the speed of light in the glass.
15 a
CONTINUED
Define ‘refractive index’.
Explain why refractive index does not have
a unit.
Describe what happens to the speed of light as
it passes from air to glass.
Use your answer to part a to explain why light
entering glass at an angle is refracted.
Explain in terms of the speed of light why a
ray entering the glass along the normal is not
refracted.
14 Figure 13.21 shows a ray of light passing from air
into an unknown material (X). The ray is deflected
by 19°.
13.3 Total internal
reflection
When you investigated refraction you may have noticed
that not all the light is refracted. Some is reflected back
from the surface, as shown in Figure 13.17. You can also
see that as the light emerges from the glass, some light
is reflected back inside the glass. This is called internal
reflection.
Like all reflected light, these reflected rays obey the law
of reflection:
angle of incidence = angle of reflection
Rays reflected back inside materials such as glass can
be very useful. Figure 13.22 shows internal reflection.
A ray of light is incident on a semicircular glass block.
The ray enters the curved side of the block at right angles
and so passes straight through to the midpoint of the
straight side.
material X
19°
Figure 13.21: Ray of light passing into air.
a
b
Determine the angles of incidence and
refraction.
Calculate the refractive index of material X.
Give your answer to two significant figures.
Figure 13.22: Using a ray box to investigate reflection when
a ray of light strikes a glass block. The ray enters the block
without bending, because it is directed along the radius of
the block.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
What happens next depends on the angle of incidence
of the ray at the midpoint. Figure 13.23 shows the
possibilities.
In Figure 13.23a, the angle of incidence is small, so most
of the light emerges from the block. There is a faint
reflected ray inside the glass block. The refracted ray
bends away from the normal.
In Figure 13.23b, the angle of incidence has increased, so
more light is reflected inside the block. The refracted ray
bends even further away from the normal.
In Figure 13.23c, the refracted ray emerges along and
parallel to the surface of the block for a particular angle
of incidence. This angle is called the critical angle. Most
of the light is reflected inside the block.
In Figure 13.23d, the angle of incidence is even greater
and all of the light is reflected inside the block. No
refracted ray emerges from the block.
For total internal reflection to happen, the angle of
incidence of the ray must be greater than the critical
angle. The critical angle depends on the material being
used. For glass, it is about 42°, depending on the type of
glass. For water, the critical angle is greater, about 49°.
For diamond, the critical angle is small, about 25°.
Rays of light that enter a diamond are very likely to be
totally internally reflected, so they bounce around inside,
eventually emerging from one of the diamond’s cut faces.
That explains why diamonds are such sparkly jewels.
KEY WORDS
internal reflection: when a ray of light strikes the
inner surface of a material and some of it reflects
back inside it
critical angle: the minimum angle of incidence at
which total internal reflection occurs
total internal reflection (TIR): when a ray of light
strikes the inner surface of a material and 100% of
the light reflects back inside it
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 13.2
Total internal reflection and the critical angle
You will shine a ray of light into a block and
investigate when and how it is reflected.
You will need:
• ray box with a slit
Figure 13.23: How a ray of light is reflected or refracted
inside a glass block depends on the angle of incidence.
We have been looking at how light is reflected inside a
glass block. We have seen that, if the angle of incidence
is greater than the critical angle, the light is entirely
reflected inside the glass. This is known as total internal
reflection (TIK):
•
•
•
242
total, because 100% of the light is reflected
internal, because it happens inside the glass
reflection, because the ray is entirely reflected.
y
•
power pack
•
•
•
glass or Perspex® semi-circular block
plain paper
ruler and protractor.
Safety: As you will be working in a darkened area,
you should keep your work area tidy to avoid trip
hazards.
13 Light
CONTINUED
Getting started
refracted
ray
How will you record the path of the rays of light that
you observe as they pass through the block?
Method
1 Place the semi-circular block on the paper and
draw around it. Mark the exact centre of the
internally
reflected
ray
straight side with a normal line.
2 Shine a ray of light into the block along the
curved side so that it hits the midpoint of the
straight side. Notice that the ray enters the block
at right angles.
Figure 13.25: Critical angle.
6 Measure the critical angle, c.
7 Draw round the block again, and shine a ray into
the block at an angle greater than the critical
angle. The ray will be totally internally reflected.
raybox
Figure 1 3.24: Shining the ray of light onto the
Figure 13.26: Total internal reflection.
glass block.
3 Observe the path of the ray. You should see
two rays. One is refracted as it emerges from
the block and the other is reflected back into
the block.
4 Move the ray box to increase the angle of
incidence until the refracted ray emerges along
the side of the block. The angle of incidence at
which this happens is called the critical angle (c).
5 Mark the rays with crosses. Remove the block and
draw the ray as it passes through the block.
8 Mark the rays, remove the block and measure
angles / and r.
Questions
1 Why is the ray not bent when it enters the block?
2 What was the critical angle for your block?
3 What conclusion can you draw from your
measurements of angles i and rfor the totally
internally reflected ray?
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
17 Explain the meaning of the words ‘total’ and
‘internal’ in the expression ‘total internal reflection’.
18 The critical angle for water is 49°. If a ray of light
strikes the upper surface of a pond at an angle
of incidence of 45°, will it be totally internally
reflected? Explain your answer.
19 Look at Figure 13.27.
Figure 13.28: Reversing the rays.
You can see from Figure 13.28 that the angle of
incidence is 90°, and the angle of refraction as the ray
goes into glass is the critical angle. Substituting in the
equation gives:
n = sinz sin90°
:
sin r
sin c
_— _
Since sin 90° = 1
n
_ 1
sine
Figure 13.27
a
b
c
KEY EQUATION
Name angles x, y and z.
Write down any relationships you know
between the angles.
Describe what will happen when angle x is
increased.
critical angle:
1
n
sin c
_
=
Note that you need to know this equation, but you do
not need to remember how it is drived.
Critical angle and
refractive index
Note also that the letter c is used both for critical angle
and the speed of light. Read questions carefully and
make sure you know which meaning is being used.
As we have seen, the critical angle depends on the
material through which a ray is travelling. The greater the
refractive index of the material, the smaller the critical
angle (see the example of diamond in Worked Example
WORKED EXAMPLE 13.3
13.3). We can use the equation n
= sin r to see how
Find the critical angle, c, for diamond. Assume that
refractive index n 2.40.
=
Step 1: Substitute the value of n in the equation:
critical angle c and refractive index n are related. To do
this we need to be aware than the refractive index for glass
relates to light passing from air to glass, not from glass
to air. During your reflection and refraction experiments
you always marked the rays with arrows. This is because
all light rays are reversible. When you shine light from the
opposite direction, you will get the same lines, only the
arrows tell you which way the ray was travelling.
Step 3: Use a calculator (remember to check your
calculator is set to degrees not radians) to find
sin-1 0.417.
Figure 13.28 shows what happens when we reverse
Answer
the rays.
c = 24.6°
244
>
Step 2: Rearrange to make c the subject:
c = sin-1 0.417
13
Optical fibres
A revolution in telecommunications has been made
possible by the invention of fibre optics. Telephone
messages and other electronic signals such as internet
computer messages or cable television signals are passed
along fine glass fibres in the form of flashing laser light,
which is a digital signal. Figure 13.29a shows how fine
these fibres can be. Each of these fibres is capable of
carrying thousands of telephone calls simultaneously.
Light
its angle of incidence is greater than the critical angle.
This means no light is lost as it is reflected. The fibre can
follow a curved path and the light bounces along inside
it, following the curve. For signals to travel over long
distances, the glass used must be of a very high purity, so
that it does not absorb the light.
Optical fibres are also used in medicine. An endoscope
is a device that can be used by doctors to see inside a
patient’s body, for example, to see inside the stomach
(Figure 13.30). One bundle of fibres carries light down
into the body, while another bundle carries an image
back up to the user. The endoscope may also have a small
probe or cutting tool built in, so that minor operations
can be performed without the need for major surgery.
Figure 13.30: Passing a fibre optic cable down the
oesophagus to the stomach allows the doctor to see inside
the patient without the need for major surgery.
Light can be used in sensory play to sooth or stimulate
children with sensory processing issues. Using optical
fibres means children can play freely with lights with no
risk of electrocution or burning.
Figure 1 3.29: The use of fibre optics has greatly increased
the capacity and speed of the world's telecommunications
networks. Without this technology, cable television and
the Internet would not be possible, a: Each of these very
fine fibres of high-purity glass can carry many telephone
messages simultaneously, b: Light travels along a fibre by
total internal reflection.
Inside a fibre, light travels along by total internal
reflection (see Figure 13.29b). It bounces along inside the
fibre because, each time it strikes the inside of the fibre,
Questions
20 List three uses of total internal reflection.
21 a The critical angle for a material is 38°.
Calculate its refractive index.
Calculate the critical angle for diamond.
Use data from Table 13.1.
22 Sketch a diagram to show how a ray of light can
travel along a curved glass fibre. Indicate the points
where total internal reflection occurs.
b
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
23 Figure 13.31 shows a bicycle reflector. It reflects
light by total internal reflection.
13.4 Lenses
Lenses are all around us, for example in spectacles and
cameras. Lenses are particularly important to scientists
in instruments including microscopes and telescopes.
Figure 13.32 shows two uses of lenses which helped to
revolutionise science.
red plastic
reflector
light rays from car
Converging and
diverging lenses
Lenses can be divided into two types, according to their
effect on light (Figure 13.33):
• converging lenses are fatter in the middle than at
Figure 13.31: How light is reflected in a bicycle
reflector.
a
Why is light not refracted when it enters
the plastic?
b
What is the angle of incidence at the
diagonal surface?
c
Copy and complete the diagram in Figure 13.31
to show the path of the rays from the car.
d
What can you deduce about the critical angle of
the plastic?
the edges
•
diverging lenses are thinner in the middle than at
the edges.
KEY WORDS
converging lens: a lens that causes rays of
light parallel to the axis to converge at the
principal focus
diverging lens: a lens that causes rays of
light parallel to the axis to diverge from the
principal focus
Figure 13.32a: More than 400 years ago, Galileo ground his own glass lenses to make telescopes like this. What he saw
through them suggested the Earth was not the centre of the universe, b: A few years later, Van Leeuwenhoek used a simple
single lens microscope to observe bacteria from his teeth, providing a clue as to how infectious diseases are spread.
246
)
13
Light
parallel beam (Figure 13.34b). This diagram is the same
as Figure 13.34a, but in reverse.
Converging lenses
A converging lens is so-called because it makes parallel
rays of light converge. The principal focus is the point
where the rays are concentrated together, and where a
piece of paper needs to be placed if it is to be burned.
The distance from the centre of the lens to the principal
focus is called the focal length of the lens. The fatter the
lens, the closer the principal focus is to the lens. A fat
lens has a shorter focal length than a thin lens. Figure
13.35 shows this.
Diverging lenses
KEY WORDS
Figure 13.33: Converging lenses are fattest in the middle.
Diverging lenses are thinnest in the middle. They are given
these names because of their effect on parallel rays of light.
Usually, we simply draw the cross-section of the lens.
You have probably used a magnifying glass to look at
small objects. This is a converging lens. ‘Converging’
means bringing together. You may even have used a
magnifying glass to focus the rays of the Sun onto a
piece of paper, to set fire to it. (More than a thousand
years ago, an Arab scientist described how people used
lenses for starting fires.)
Figure 13.34a shows how a converging lens focuses the
parallel rays of the Sun. On one side of the lens, the
rays are parallel to the principal axis of the lens. After
they pass through the lens, they converge on a single
point: the principal focus (or focal point). After they
have passed through the principal focus, they spread
out again. A converging lens can be used to produce a
beam of parallel rays. A source of light, such as a small
light bulb, is placed at the principal focus. As they pass
through the lens, the rays are bent so that they become a
focus length
parallel rays
principal axis: the line passing through the centre
of a lens perpendicular to its surface
principal focus/focal point: the point at which
rays of light parallel to the principal axis converge
after passing through a converging lens
focal length: the distance from the centre of the
lens to its principal focus
Figure 13.35a: A fatter lens is more powerful so bends the
light more. This gives a shorter focal length, b: A thinner lens
is not as powerful and does not bend the light as much.
b
principal focus
v principal focus
parallel rays
V
focus length
Figure 1 3.34: The effect of a converging lens on rays of light, a: A converging lens makes parallel rays converge at the
principal focus, b: Rays from the principal focus of a converging lens are turned into a parallel beam of light.
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Lenses work by refracting light. When a ray strikes the
surface of the lens, it is refracted towards the normal.
When it leaves the glass of the lens, it bends away from
the normal. The clever thing about the shape of a
converging lens is that it bends all rays just enough for
them to meet at the principal focus.
Images can be described in terms of their size (enlarged,
the same size, or diminished), which way up they are
(inverted or upright), and where they are formed.
KEY WORDS
enlarged: used to describe an innage which is
bigger than the object
Forming a real image
diminished: used to describe an image which is
smaller than the object
When the Sun’s rays are focused onto a piece of paper,
a tiny image of the Sun is created. It is easier to see how
a converging lens makes an image if you focus an image
of a light bulb or a distant window onto a piece of white
paper. The paper acts as a screen to catch the image.
(Be careful if you try this yourself - you could set fire to
the paper or burn yourself. And remember: never look
directly at the Sun.)
Figure 13.36 shows an experiment in which an image of
a light bulb (the object) is formed by a converging lens.
The image in the raindrop in Figure 13.1 was formed in
the same way.
inverted: used to describe an image which is
upside down compared to the object
upright: used to describe an image which is the
same way up as the object
The image of the lightbulb in Figure 13.36 is:
•
•
•
•
inverted
diminished
nearer to the lens than the object
real.
We say that the image is real, because light really does
fall on the screen to make the image. If light only
appeared to be coming from the image, we would say
that the image was virtual. The size the image depends
on how fat or thin the lens is.
^f
Drawing ray diagrams
for lenses
Figure 13.36: Forming a real image of a light bulb using a
converging lens. The image is upside down on the screen at
the back right.
248
y
We can explain how this real image is formed using a
ray diagram. These ray diagrams are drawn to scale
and show the path of two particular rays. The steps
needed to draw an accurate ray diagram are shown in
Worked Example 13.4. Remember that it helps to work
on squared paper or graph paper when drawing a ray
diagram.
13 Light
WORKED EXAMPLE 13.4
Draw a ray diagram to find the image formed of a 3 cm tall object placed 12 cm from a converging lens which has a
focal length of 5 cm.
Step 1: Draw the lens (a simple outline shape will do)
with a horizontal axis through the middle of it.
cX
s
1
Figure 1 3.37a
Step 2: Mark the positions of the principal focus (F) on
either side, at 5 cm from the centre of the lens.
Mark the position of the object, O, along with
a 3 cm arrow standing on the axis, . Place the
arrow 12 cm from the lens.
A
I
c
SX rs
-
?
Figure 13.37b
Step 3: Draw ray 1, a straight line from the top of the
object arrow which passes undeflected through
the middle of the lens.
Figure 13.37c
Step 4: Draw ray 2 from the top of the object arrow
parallel to the principal axis. As it passes
through the lens, it is refracted through the
principal focus. To make things easier when we
draw ray diagrams, we only show rays bending
once, at the centre of the lens.
Figure 13.37d
Look for the point where the two rays cross. This is the
position of the top of the image (I).
With an accurately drawn ray diagram, you can see that
the image is inverted, diminished and real.
So, to construct a ray diagram like this, draw two rays
starting from the top of the object:
• ray 1 : unrefracted through the centre of the lens
• ray 2: parallel to the axis and then refracted through
the principal focus.
249
y
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 13.3
Ray diagrams
Imagine you work for a company which makes
cameras and projectors. You have been asked to
produce short, technical guides explaining the use
of lenses in these products.
Drawing ray diagrams lets us predict what an
image will look like. A lens can make different
images depending on its position. Draw the
following ray diagrams:
•
A lens with a focal length of 3 cm with the
object 8 cm from the lens.
•
The same lens but with the object 5 cm from
the lens.
Questions
24 Copy and complete these sentences:
A converging lens refracts parallel rays of light to a
.
point called the
The distance from this point to the lens is called the
The fatter the lens the
25 Copy and complete the ray diagrams in Figure 13.38
to show what happens when the rays hit the lenses.
Describe the image formed in each case. Which is
for a camera, and which for a film projector?
Draw diagrams to investigate the difference the
thickness of a lens makes to the image. Remember,
a fat lens has a short focal length, a thin lens has a
longer focal length.
PEER ASSESSMENT
this distance will be.
Figure 13.38: Ray diagrams.
Magnifying glasses
A magnifying glass is a converging lens. You hold it close
to a small object and peer through it to see a magnified
image. Figure 13.39 shows how a magnifying glass can
help to magnify print for someone with poor eyesight.
Swap ray diagrams with a partner and check if they
are correctly drawn.
Give them a smiley face, straight face or sad face
for each of the following features:
•
axis drawn horizontally through the middle of
the lens
•
focal point, F, marked on each side of the lens
•
ray from the top of the object passing though
the centre of the lens without being deflected
•
ray from the top of the object parallel to the
axis striking the lens then passing through
the principal focus
•
•
•
rays drawn as straight lines using a ruler
correct arrows on both rays
image clearly marked, including which way
up it is.
Discuss what, if anything, was missing and how you
can both improve your diagrams.
250
y
Figure 13.39: A converging lens produces a magnified
image making small print easier to read.
The object viewed by a magnifying glass is closer to the
lens than the principal focus. We can draw a ray diagram
using the same two rays as in Figure 1 3.40.
•
Ray 1 is unrefracted as it passes through the centre
of the lens.
13
•
Ray 2 starts off parallel to the axis and is refracted
by the lens so that it passes through the principal
focus.
Rays 1 and 2 do not cross over each other. They are
diverging (spreading apart) after they have passed
through the lens. However, by extending the rays
backwards, as shown by the dashed lines, we can see that
they both appear to be coming from a point behind the
object. This is the position of the image (I). We draw
dashed lines because light does not actually travel along
these parts of the rays. We cannot catch the image on a
screen, because there is no light there.
Light
an image of a distant object. Figure 13.41b shows the
eye focusing on a much closer object. The light from the
closer object is diverging so the lens needs to be thicker
and stronger to form an image on the retina.
Figure 1 3.40: A ray diagram to show how a magnifying
glass works. The object is between the lens and the focus.
The image produced is virtual. To find its position, the rays
have to be extrapolated back (dashed lines) to the point
where they cross.
From the ray diagram (Figure 13.40), we can see that the
image produced by a magnifying glass is:
•
upright
•
enlarged
•
further from the lens than the object
•
virtual.
So, if you read a page of a book using a magnifying
glass, the image you are looking at is behind the page
that you are reading. This image is a virtual image.
Using lenses to correct
eyesight problems
Our eyes contain converging lenses which form an image
on the retina at the back of the eye. The lenses in our
eyes are flexible and muscles can change the shape and
strength of the lens. This allows us to focus on objects at
different distances. Figure 13.41a shows an eye forming
Figure 13.41a: Parallel light from a distant object is focused
by a weak lens, b: Diverging light from a close object needs
a stronger lens.
Some eyes are unable to change their strength enough
to focus on either close or distant objects. An extra lens,
worn as spectacles or contact lenses, can work with the
eye lens to let it focus as needed.
Short sight
A person with short sight can see close up objects clearly,
but cannot form a clear image of distant objects. The
image is formed in front of the retina. This is usually
because the eyeball is slightly too long so that the rays
meet in front of the retina. To correct this, a diverging
lens is used to make the rays from the distant object
diverge. The eye lens is then able to form a focused
image. Figure 13.42 shows the problem and how it is
corrected.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Long sight
A long-sighted person has the opposite problem. A long¬
sighted eye can focus on distant objects but not close
objects. This can be because the eyeball is too short, or
the lens cannot become strong enough so the rays from
a close object cannot be converged enough to a form an
image on the retina. A converging lens causes the rays to
converge, allowing the eye lens to form a focused image
of close objects, as shown in Figure 13.44.
Figure 13.42a: With short sight, the image is formed before
the retina, b: Using a diverging lens to help the lens in the
eye to form an image on the retina.
Figure 13.44a: With long sight, the image is formed behind
the retina, b: A converging lens works with the lens in the
eye to form an image on the retina.
Questions
Figure 13.43: Without glasses, distant objects appear
blurred to a short-sighted person. The diverging lens in the
glasses lets the person focus on distant objects.
252
y
26 Look at Figure 13.40. How can you tell from the
diagram that the image formed by the magnifying
glass is a virtual image?
27 a A converging lens has focal length 3 cm. An
object, 2 cm tall, is placed 5 cm from the centre
of the lens, on the principal axis. Draw an
accurate ray diagram to represent this.
b Use your diagram to determine the distance of
the virtual image formed from the lens, and the
height of the image.
13
28 Figure 13.45 shows an eye looking at a distant
object. The person sees a blurred image.
Figure 13.45: Eye looking at a distant object.
a
b
c
Light
This splitting up of white light into a spectrum is known
as dispersion. Isaac Newton set out to explain how it
happens. It had been suggested that light is coloured
by passing it through a prism. Newton showed that
this was the wrong idea by arranging for the spectrum
to be passed back through another prism. The colours
recombined to form white light again. He concluded that
white light is a mixture of all the different colours of the
spectrum. Newton described the visible light spectrum
as being made up of seven colours - red, orange, yellow,
green, blue, indigo and violet. You may wonder why
indigo and violet are separate rather than just being
purple. This is because, in the 17th century, seven
was considered to be a mystical number. So, Newton
wanted seven colours not just six. The colours can be
remembered as a name, Roy G Biv.
Name the eyesight problem this person has.
Describe how the shape of the eye causes this
problem.
Draw a diagram to show how a lens can be used
to help this person to see a focused image of the
distant object.
13.5 Dispersion of light
When white light passes through glass, it refracts as
it enters and leaves the glass, and can be split into a
spectrum of colours. Figure 13.46a shows light being
refracted as it passes through a glass prism. You can see
that the colours merge into one another, and they are
not all of equal widths in the spectrum. A rainbow is a
naturally occurring spectrum. White light from the Sun is
split up into a spectrum of colours as it enters and leaves
droplets of water in the air. It is also reflected back to the
viewer by total internal reflection, which is why you must
have the Sun behind you to observe a rainbow.
Figure 1 3.47: The first prism refracts the light causing it to
disperse. The second prism refracts the light back, causing
the colours to recombine.
So, what happens in a prism to produce a spectrum?
As the white light enters the prism, it slows down. We
say that it is refracted and, as we have seen, its direction
changes. Dispersion occurs because each colour is
refracted by a different amount (Figure 13.47). Violet
light slows down the most, and so it is refracted the
most. Red light is least affected.
KEY WORDS
spectrum: (plural: spectra) waves, or colours, of
light, separated out in order according to their
wavelengths
dispersion: the separation of different
wavelengths of light because they are refracted
through different angles
Figure 13.46a: White light is dispersed by a prism.
b: Raindropstake the place of the prism to form a rainbow.
Light of a single colour is not dispersed by a prism. It is
refracted so that it changes direction, but it is not split up
into a spectrum. You can see this in Figure 13.48. This is
because it is light of a single colour. This light is described
as monochromatic (mono one, chromatic coloured).
Monochromatic light is light of a single frequency.
=
=
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
29 Copy and complete these sentences.
When light enters glass it slows down( causing it to
change direction. This is called
.
Red light changes direction
than violet light.
The light is split into different colours. This is called
30 Draw a diagram to show how white light can be
dispersed into a spectrum using a glass prism. Label
the red and violet light.
31 List the colours of the visible spectrum in order
starting with the colour which is refracted the least.
Figure 13.48: Monochromatic light from a laser is not
dispersed by a prism as the light is all one frequency.
KEY WORD
monochromatic: describes a ray of light (or other
electromagnetic radiation) of a single wavelength
REFLECTION
When we study light, we use very similar words and
diagrams for reflection and refraction. Have you
found this difficult? How have you learnt the rules
for ray diagrams? How successful have you been?
PROJECT
Light fantastic
In this chapter you have seen lots of optical effects
caused by the reflection and refraction of light.
Some are useful, some are a nuisance. Your task is to
investigate, illustrate and explain one of these effects.
Your results should be presented as a poster and
should include:
• a photo - preferably one you have taken - of
the effect
a ray diagram to show what is happening
a description of the scientific laws and principles
which explain the effect.
You can use an effect you have seen in class, such as
the formation of an image in a plane mirror, or you
can apply what you have learnt to a new situation.
For example:
• How does the turtle in Figure 13.49 see itself?
(With a waterproof camera you could take a
similar photo of yourself in a swimming pool.)
• Why do diamonds sparkle so much?
• Why do lenses create upside down images?
How can interior designers use mirrors to make
a space seem bigger?
How does the eye form an image (and how can
glasses help solve vision problems)?
How does a periscope work?
•
•
254
>
Figure 13.49: Reflection at the surface of the water allows
this turtle to see itself.
Light
13
SUMMARY
The law of reflection: angle of incidence = angle of reflection.
The image in a plane mirror is upright, as far behind the mirror as the object is in front and swapped round left
to right.
The image in a plane mirror is virtual.
Refraction is the bending of light as it goes from one substance to another.
Refraction is caused by light travelling at different speeds in different materials.
When light passes from air to glass it bends towards the normal. When it passes from glass to air it bends away
from the normal.
When light travelling through glass hits a boundary with air, some light passes from glass to air, some light is
internally reflected back into the glass.
When the angle of incidence in glass is equal to, or greater than, the critical angle, all the light is reflected back
into the glass. This is total internal reflection.
The refractive index is a measure of how much light is slowed, or bent, by a material.
Refractive index can be calculated using the equation n = S1-
sinr
Refractive index
— —
=—
—- angle.
critical
Optical fibres can transmit information rapidly and efficiently using total internal reflection. This is useful in
telecommunications and medicine.
Converging lenses bend parallel rays together so they meet at a point called the principal focus.
Drawing a ray parallel to the axis, and a ray which strikes the centre of a lens allows us to draw a ray diagram
and find the type of image formed.
A magnifying glass produces a virtual image.
Our eyes use a flexible convex lens to form images.
A short-sighted eye has a lens which is too powerful. This can be corrected using a diverging lens.
A long-sighted eye has a lens which is too weak. This can be corrected using a converging lens.
White light can be dispersed by passing it through a glass prism. This creates the visible spectrum.
255
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 The diagram shows a ray of light striking a plane mirror.
[1]
Which row gives the correct labels for the diagram?
X
Y
Z
normal
incident ray
angle of refraction
angle of incidence
incident ray
normal
reflected ray
normal
angle of reflection
normal
incident ray
reflected ray
2 Which one of the following statements about the image formed in a plane
mirror is true?
A The image can be formed on a screen.
B The image is diminished.
C The image is upright.
D The image is on the surface of the mirror.
3 A ray of light passes from air to glass at an angle of 30°. Which statement
correctly describes what happens?
A The ray bends towards the normal.
B The ray passes through the glass without bending.
C The ray is totally internally reflected.
D The ray bends away from the normal.
[1 ]
[1]
4 This diagram shows light being refracted by a converging lens.
a What name is given to the distance marked X?
256
>
[1 ]
13 Light
CONTINUED
This diagram shows one ray of light passing through the lens. The lens can
be used to form an image of an object.
object
Copy the diagram and draw another ray to complete it. Draw an arrow
to represent the image.
[3]
Choose two of these words to describe the image in b.
[2]
upright
inverted
diminished
enlarged
[Total: 6]
This diagram shows a ray of light entering
a glass prism. The refractive index of the
glass is 42°.
a Explain why the ray is not refracted as it enters the glass.
[1]
b Copy and complete the diagram to show what happens to the ray.
[1]
c What name is given to the effect you have drawn?
[1]
d If the prism was removed, what other piece of apparatus could produce
[1 ]
the same effect on the light ray?
[Total: 6]
The diagram shows a ray of
light striking the inner surface
of a glass block. The critical
angle for the glass is 42°.
40°'1
not to scale
COMMAND WORDS
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
a Copy the diagram. Without calculating, continue the ray from the point
where it strikes the surface until it leaves the block.
[2]
b What can you say about the speed of light in the glass block?
[1]
of
refractive
glass.
index
the
the
Calculate
Write down the equation you use.
[2]
Calculate the angle of incidence at which the ray enters the glass block. [2]
[Total: 7]
7 a Construct a ray diagram to show how a magnifying glass with a focal
length of 6 cm produces an image of an object placed 4 cm from the lens. [5]
b The image formed is virtual. Explain what this means.
[1]
[Total: 6]
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
Describe how an image is formed in a plane mirror.
Recall and use the equation: angle of incidence =
angle of reflection.
Draw a ray diagram to show the formation of a
virtual image in a plane mirror.
Describe an experiment to investigate how light is
refracted when it passes through a glass block.
Draw a labelled diagram of light passing through a
glass block, labelling the normal and the angles of
incidence and refraction.
Describe internal reflection and recall that if the
angle of incidence is greater than the critical angle,
total internal reflection occurs.
Recall and use the equations:
n sinz
smr
1
~ :
n
critical angle
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Describe and explain how total internal reflection is
used in telecommunications and medicine.
Draw a fully labelled ray diagram to show the
formation of a real image by a converging lens.
Describe the nature of the image formed.
Draw a fully labelled ray diagram to show the
formation of a virtual image by a converging lens
and explain how this is used in a magnifying glass.
Draw diagrams to show the correction of long and
short-sightedness using lenses.
Name the seven colours of the visible spectrum in
the correct order.
258
>
Confident
to move on
13.1
13.1
13.1
13.2
13.2
13.3
_
—
Almost
there
13.2, 13.3
13.3
13.4
13.4
13.4
13.4
13.5
1
> Chapter 14
Properties
of waves
describe a wave in terms of speed, amplitude, frequency and wavelength
identify differences between transverse waves and longitudinal waves
calculate wave speed
describe reflection and refraction of waves
describe diffraction of waves.
F
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
In a group, discuss all the different types of wave you can think of.
What do these waves have in common? What do waves do?
MAKING WAVES
The discovery of gravitational waves is important for
two reasons:
Figure 14.1: Einstein's last prediction was confirmed after
100 years.
Einstein hypothesized that the universe is made of a
fabric that he called the space-time continuum. He
predicted that interactions between massive objects
would create ripples in space-time in much the
same way that throwing a stone into a pond causes
ripples in the water.
The ripples are very hard to detect as they are tiny.
The space-time continuum is very stiff and only
really huge events cause any measurable ripples.
Lasers are used to pick up tiny variations in space¬
time that could be caused by a passing gravitational
wave. In 2016, scientists working at the Laser
Interferometer Gravitational-Wave observatory
(LIGO) detected a ripple in space-time caused by
two black holes spiralling towards each other and
merging into one.
14.1 Describing waves
Physicists use waves as a model to explain the behaviour
of light, sound and electromagnetic radiation. Water
waves can help us understand the behaviour of waves as
260
y
•
It provides further evidence to support
Einstein's theory of relativity.
•
Gravitational waves travel huge distances
without the signal being affected. This could
allow astronomers to investigate qreas of the
universe which we cannot access using light.
This could provide information about the Big
Bang, and the existence of dark matter.
The idea of a wave is a very useful model in physics.
Physicists talk about light waves, soiJnd waves,
electromagnetic waves, and so on. It is easy to see
how waves behave in water and springs. It is not
obvious that light, gravity and sound are waves in
the way we think of waves in the sea. In this chapter,
we will investigate waves in water and springs, and
see how these waves can act a^a good model for
both light and sound.
Discussion questions
1
Does the discovery of gravitational waves prove
that Einstein was right?
2
A member of the LIGO team commented that
the discovery of gravitational waves means we
are at the start of the era of gravitational wave
astronomy. Gravitational waves will provide us
with information that will help us to understand
the universe. Discuss other ways in which
humans have used waves to gather information
about the earth and beyond.
they are easy to observe. Waves are what we see on the
sea or a lake, but physicists have a more specialised idea
of waves. We can begin to understand this model in the
laboratory using a ripple tank (Figure 14.2).
14 Properties of waves
A ripple tank is a shallow glass-bottomed tank containing
a small amount of water. A light shining downwards
through the water casts a shadow of the ripples on the
floor below, showing the pattern that they make.
In each case, the ripples are produced by something
vibrating up and down vertically, but the ripples move
out horizontally. The vibrating bar or dipper pushes
water molecules up and down. Each molecule drags
its neighbours up and down. These then start their
neighbours moving, and so on. Each molecule simply
moves up and down. Energy is transferred by the wave,
but the water molecules remain in the same place after the
wave has passed. A wave transfers energy but not matter.
How can these patterns of ripples be a model for the
behaviour of light? The straight ripples are like a beam
of light, perhaps coming from the Sun. The ripples move
straight across the surface of the water, just as light from the
Sun travels in straight lines. The circular ripples spreading
out from a vibrating dipper are like light spreading out from
a lamp. (The dipper is the lamp.) In this chapter we will use
waves in the ripple tank as a model to help us understand
the behavior of light and sound waves.
Figure 14.2: The ripples on the surface of the water in this
ripple tank are produced by the bar, which vibrates up and
down. The pattern of the ripples is seen by shining a light
downwards through the water. This casts a shadow of the
ripples on the screen beneath the tank.
I KEYWORDS
model, a way of representing a system in order to
understand how it functions
Figure 1 4.3 shows two patterns of ripples, straight and
ripple tank: a shallow water tank used to
demonstrate how waves behave
circular, which are produced in different ways.
ripple: a small uniform wave on the surface of water
Wavelength and amplitude
Waves are often represented by a wavy line, as shown in
Figure 14.4. We have already used this idea for sound
waves (in Chapter 12) and we will do so again for
electromagnetic waves (in Chapter 15). This wavy line
is like a downward slice though the ripples in the ripple
tank. It shows the succession of crests (also called peaks)
and troughs of which the ripples are made.
Figure 14.3: Two patterns of ripples on water, a: Straight
ripples are a model for a broad beam of light, b: Circular
ripples are a model for light spreading out from a lamp.
One way of making ripples on the surface of the water in
a ripple tank is to have a wooden bar that just touches the
surface of the water (as in Figure 14.2). The bar vibrates
up and down at a steady rate. This sends equally spaced
straight ripples across the surface of the water.
A spherical dipper can produce a different pattern of
ripples. The dipper just touches the surface of the water.
As it vibrates up and down, equally spaced circular ripples
spread out across the surface of the water.
261
)
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
KEY WORDS
crest/peak: the highest point of a wave
trough: the lowest point of a wave
wavelength: the distance between two adjacent
crests (or troughs) of a wave
Frequency and period
Figure 14.4b: The same wave as a represented as a
smoothly varying wavy line on a graph. This shape is known
as a sine wave. If you have a graphics calculator, you can
use it to display a graph of y = sinx, which will look like this
graph.
As the bar in the ripple tank vibrates, it sends out
ripples. Each up-and-down movement sends out a single
ripple. The more times the bar vibrates each second, the
more ripples it sends out. This is shown in the graph
in Figure 14.5. Take care! This looks very similar to
the previous wave graph in Figure 14.4, but here the
horizontal axis shows time, t, not distance, x. This graph
shows how the surface of the water at a particular point
moves up and down as time passes.
The graph in Figure 14.4b shows a wave travelling
from left to right. The horizontal axis (x-axis) shows
the distance, x, travelled horizontally by the wave. The
vertical axis (y-axis) shows how far (distance y) the
surface of the water has been displaced from its normal
level. We can think of the x-axis as the level of the
surface of the water when it is undisturbed. The blue line
on the graph shows how far the surface of the water has
been displaced from its undisturbed level.
From the representation of the wave in Figure 14.5, we
can define two quantities for waves in general:
•
The frequency,/, of a wave is the number of waves
sent out each second. Frequency is measured in
hertz, Hz. One hertz (1 Hz) is one complete wave or
ripple per second.
Two measurements are marked on the graph. These
define quantities used to describe waves.
•
The period, T, of a wave is the time taken for
one complete wave to pass a point. The period is
measured in seconds, s.
•
The wavelength A of a wave is the distance from
one crest of the wave to the next or between any
two points on the wave which are in step. Since the
wavelength is a distance, it is measured in metres, m.
Its symbol is 2, the Greek letter lambda.
•
The amplitude, A, of a wave is the maximum
distance that the surface of the water is displaced
from its undisturbed level, that is, the height of
a crest (or the depth of a trough). For ripples on
the surface of water, the amplitude is a distance,
measured in metres, m. Its symbol is A.
For ripples in a ripple tank, the wavelength might be a
few millimetres and the amplitude a millimetre or two.
Waves on the open sea are much bigger, with wavelengths
of tens of metres, and amplitudes varying from a few
centimetres up to several metres.
262
>
Figure 1 4.5: A graph to show the period of a wave. Notice
that this graph has time, t, on its horizontal axis.
We have already discussed the frequency and period of
a sound wave in Chapter 12. It is always important to
check whether a wave graph has time, t, or distance, x,
on its horizontal axis.
14 Properties of waves
The frequency of a wave is the number of waves made
each second, or the number of waves passing a point per
second. The period is the number of seconds it takes for
each wave to pass a point. Frequency,/, and period, T,
are obviously related to each other. Waves with a short
period have a high frequency.
frequency (Hz) =
-
period (s)
/=1T
J
period (s)
= frequency (Hz)
Waves on the sea might have a period of 10 seconds.
Their frequency is therefore about 0.1 Hz. A sound wave
might have a frequency of 1000 Hz. Its period is
eardrums vibrate. Energy has been transferred by the
sound waves to our ears.
The bigger the amplitude, the more energy the wave
transfers. A large amplitude means a bright light or a
loud sound.
If you have ever been knocked over by a wave in the sea,
you will know that water waves also carry energy. It is
important to remember that, when a wave travels from
one place to another, it is not matter that is moving.
The wave is moving, and it is carrying energy. It may
move through matter or even through a vacuum, but the
matter itself is not transferred from place to place. A
wave transfers energy without transferring matter.
Earthquakes show the huge amounts of energy which
waves can transfer. Vibrations passing through the Earth
can cause buildings to collapse. A seismometer records
the vibrations caused by an earthquake.
——
- , which means that a wave arrives every7
1000s
1 ms (one millisecond).
therefore
Wave speed
The wave speed is the rate at which the crest of a wave
travels. For example, it could be the speed of the crest of
a ripple travelling over the surface of the water. Speed is
measured in metres per second (m/s).
Waves can have very different speeds. Ripples in a ripple
tank travel a few centimetres per second. Sound waves
travel at 330 m/s through air. Light waves travel at about
300 000 000 m/s through air.
KEY WORDS
wave speed: the speed at which a wave travels
Waves and energy
We can also think of the speed of a wave as the speed at
which it transfers energy from place to place.
Think of the Sun. It is a source of energy. Its energy
reaches us in the form of radiation - light waves and
infrared waves - which travels through the vacuum of
space and which is absorbed by the Earth.
Think of a loudspeaker. It vibrates and causes the air
nearby to vibrate. These vibrations spread out in the
air as a sound wave. When they reach our ears, our
Figure 14.6a: Vibrations caused by shifts in the Earth's
tectonic plates can cause devastation, b: The seismometer
records the amplitude and frequency of the vibrations.
263
>
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Transverse and
*
undisturb
secondary or S-wave
undisturbe
primary or P-wave
longitudinal waves
Ripples in a ripple tank are one way of looking at the
behaviour of waves. You can model waves in other ways.
As shown in Figure 14.7, a stretched slinky spring can be
used to model waves. Fix one end of the spring and move
the other end from side to side (Figure 14.7a). You will
see that a wave travels along the spring. (You may also
notice it reflecting from the fixed end of the spring.) You
can demonstrate the same sort of wave using a stretched
rope or piece of elastic. You can see the link between
frequency and wavelength by changing the rate at which
you move the end of the spring up and down. Increasing
the frequency decreases the wavelength.
A second type of wave can also be modelled with a
stretched slinky spring. Instead of moving the free end
from side to side, move it backwards and forwards
(Figure 14.7b). A series of compressions travels along
the spring. These are regions in which the segments
of the spring are compressed together. In between
are rarefactions, regions in which the segments of the
spring are further apart. This type of wave cannot be
demonstrated on a stretched rope.
The direction of propagation of a wave is the direction
in which it travels. You can observe this by watching the
movement of crests and troughs, or compressions and
Figure 14.8: Primary and secondary seismic waves.
A ripple on the surface of water is an example of £
transverse wave. The particles of the water move u
down as the wave travels horizontally.
In an earthquake there are two types of seismic wa
primary or P-waves and secondary or S-waves. P-w
are longitudinal. These waves are called primary w;
they travel faster than slower secondary waves and
felt first. Secondary waves are transverse.
A sound wave is an example of a longitudinal wave,
a sound travels through air, the air molecules move
and forth as the wave travels. Table 14.1 lists examp
transverse and longitudinal waves.
------
»
rarefactions.
Transverse waves
Longitudinal waves
The demonstrations in Figure 14.7 show the two different
types of wave:
ripples on water
sound
• Transverse waves: the particles carrying the wave
light and all other
electromagnetic waves
(P-waves)
move from side to side, at right angles to the
direction of propagation of the wave.
•
Longitudinal waves: the particles carrying the
wave move back and forth, along the direction of
propagation of the wave.
primary seismic wavt
secondary seismic waves
(S-waves)
Table 14.1: Transverse and longitudinal waves.
direction of propagation
Figure 14.7: Modelling waves using a spring, a: A transverse wave on a stretched spring. It is made by moving the free
from side to side, b: A longitudinal wave on a stretched spring. It is made by pushing the free end back and forth, along
length of the spring.
264
>
1 4 Properties of waves
Copy these sentences, selecting the correct answers
from the brackets.
a The two waves have {the same / different}
wavelengths.
b The two waves have {the same I different}
KEYWORDS
transverse wave: a wave in which the vibration is
.it right angles to the direction of propagation of
the wave
longitudinal wave: a wave in which the vibration
Is forward and back, parallel to the direction of
propagation of the wave
waves: waves caused by earthquakes
P-waves: fast moving, longitudinal seismic waves
S-waves: slow moving, transverse seismic waves
ind
1
es
I
!S as
||
are fl
ck
of
4
Give one example of a transverse wave and one
example of a longitudinal wave.
5
Deduce the wavelength of the waves in Figure 14.10.
| Questions
i:
lS
3
amplitudes.
Light X will be {brighter I dimmer} than
c
light Y.
Draw a wave and label the amplitude and the
wavelength.
I
2
Copy and complete the following sentences.
a
A wave transfers
from place to place
without transferring
.
b In a
wave the vibrations are at right
angles to the direction in which the wave travels.
wave the vibrations are back and
In a
forth along the direction of the wave,
Figure 14.10: Waves.
6
The bar of a ripple tank vibrates five times per
second.
a
State the frequency of the waves it makes.
b Find the period of the waves it makes.
7
A student sees a flash of lightning and, three
seconds later, she hears the thunder.
a
Why does she see the lightning before she hears
the thunder?
b Light and sound are both types of waves.
Copy and complete the following sentences,
choosing the correct words from the brackets.
i
Light is a {transverse / longitudinal} wave.
The vibrations are {parallel to / at right
angles to} the direction of travel of the
wave. These waves {can / cannot} travel
through a vacuum.
ii Sound is a (transverse I longitudinal} wave.
The vibrations are {parallel to / at right
angles to} the direction of travel of the
wave. These waves {can / cannot} travel
through a vacuum.
c The speed of sound in air is 330 m/s. Calculate
how far away the storm is from the student.
The two waves in Figure 14.9 represent two light
waves, X and Y.
light Y
Figure 14.9: Two light waves.
265
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
14.2 Speed, frequency
and wavelength
How fast do waves travel across the surface of the sea?
If you stand on the end of a pier, you may be able to
answer this question.
Another way to think of this i§ to say that the speed is
the number of waves passing per second multiplied by
the length of each wave. If 100 waves pass each second
(/■=100 Hz), and each is 4.0 m long (2 = 4.0 m), then
400m of waves pass each second. The speed of the waves
is 400 m/s.
WORKED EXAMPLE 14.1
An FM radio station broadcasts signals of wavelength
1.5 metres and frequency 200 MHz. What is their speed?
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what you
want to know.
/= 200 MHz = 200 000 000 Hz
= 2 x 108Hz
2=1.5m
v
Figure 14.11: By timing waves and measuring their
wavelength, you can find the speed of waves.
Suppose that the pier is 60 metres long, and that
you notice that exactly five waves fit into this length
(Figure 14.1 1). Using this information, you can deduce
that the wavelength is:
wavelength
=
=?
Step 2: Write down the equation for wavp speed.
Substitute values and calculate the answer.
v
= /2
v = 2x 108Hzxl.5m
= 3xl08m/s
Answer
The radio waves travel through the air at 3.0 x 108m/s.
(You might recognise this number as^he speed of light.)
= 12m
Now you time the waves arriving. The interval between
crests as they pass the end of the pier is 4.0 seconds. How
fast are the waves moving? One wavelength (12 metres)
passes in 4.0 seconds. So the speed of the waves is:
= 3.0m/s
The speed, v, frequency,/, and wavelength, 2, of a wave
are connected. We can write the connection in the form
of an equation:
speed (m/s)
= frequency (Hz) x wavelength (m)
KEY EQUATION
wave speed = frequency x wavelength
v=/2
266
>
WORKED EXAMPLE 14.2
The highest note on a piano has a frequency of
4186 Hz. What is the wavelength of the sound waves
produced when this note is played? Assume that the
speed of sound in air = 330 m/s. Give your answer to
two significant figures.
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what you
want to know.
/= 4186 Hz
= 330 m/s
2=?
v
Step 2: Write down the equation for wave speed.
Rearrange it to make wavelength 2 the
subject.
v =/2
14
CONTINUED
Step 3: Substitute values and calculate the answer.
A_
330
4186
Properties of waves
1 1 Blowing across pan pipes (Figure 14.13) creates a
sound wave in the pipe.
Explain why the longer pipes produce lower
pitched notes.
= 0.07166m
To 2 s.f. this is 0.072 m
Answer
The wavelength of the note in air is 0.072 metres.
Changing material, changing
speed
When waves travel from one material into another,
they usually change speed. Light travels more slowly
in glass than in air. Sound travels faster in steel than
in air. When this happens, the frequency of the waves
remains unchanged. This means that their wavelength
must change. This is illustrated in Figure 14.12, which
shows light waves travelling quickly through air. They
reach some glass and slow down, and their wavelength
decreases. When they leave the glass, they speed up, and
their wavelength increases again.
Figure 14.13: Pan pipes.
1 2 Which have the longer wavelength, radio waves of
frequency 90 000 kHz or 100 MHz?
Figure 14.12: Waves change their wavelength when their
speed changes. Their frequency remains constant. Here,
light waves slow down when they enter glass and speed up
when they return to the air.
Questions
1 3 Sound waves get faster when they go from air into
water. What happens to their:
a speed?
b wavelength?
c frequency?
d period?
8
For the equation v =/2, write down what each
symbol represents and give their SI units.
14.3 Explaining wave
9
Calculate the speed of water waves which have a
wavelength of 3 m and a frequency of 0.5 Hz.
phenomena
10 A wave in air has a frequency of 1100 Hz, an
amplitude of 4 cm and a wavelength of 30 cm.
a Calculate the speed of the wave.
b Suggest what type of wave it is likely to be.
c Calculate the period of the wave.
When we look at ripples on the surface of water in a
ripple tank, we can begin to see why physicists say that
light behaves as a wave. The ripples are much more
regular and uniform than waves on the sea, so this is a
good model system to look at.
267
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Figure 14.14c shows a drawing of the same pattern.
This is an overhead view of the ripples. The blue lines
represent the tops of the ripples. These lines are known
as wavefronts. The separation of the wavefronts is equal
to the wavelength of the ripples. Figure 14.14c also
shows lines (the red arrows) to indicate how the direction
of travel of the ripples changes. This diagram may
remind you of the ray diagram for the law of reflection
of light (see Figure 14.5).
Reflection of ripples
Looking at the red arrows, you can see that the waves
obey the same law of reflection as light:
angle of incidence
= angle of reflection
KEY WORD
wavefront: a line joining adjacent points on a
wave that are all in step with each other
Refraction of ripples
Refraction of light occurs when the speed of light
changes. We can see the same effect for ripples in a ripple
tank (Figure 14. 15). A glass plate is immersed in the
water, to make the water shallower in that part of the
tank. There, the ripples move more slowly because they
drag on the bottom of the tank (which is now actually
the upper surface of the submerged glass plate).
•normal
Figure 14.14: The reflection of plane waves by a flat metal
barrier in a ripple tank, a: This criss-cross pattern is observed
as the reflected ripples pass through the incoming ripples,
b: How the ripples are produced, c: The arrows show how
the direction of the ripples changes when they are reflected.
The angle of incidence is equal to the angle of reflection,
just as in the law of reflection of light.
Figure 14.14 shows what happens when a flat barrier
is placed in the ripple tank. Figure 14.14a shows the
pattern of the ripples observed, and Figure 14.14b shows
how the ripples are produced. Straight ripples (plane
waves) are reflected when they strike the flat surface of
the barrier. The barrier acts like a mirror, and the ripples
bounce off it. This shows an important feature of how
waves behave. They pass through each other when they
overlap.
268
>
Figure 14.15a: The refraction of plane waves by a flat glass
plate in a ripple tank. A submerged glass plate makes the
water shallower in the grey region. In this region, the ripples
move more slowly, so that they lag behind the ripples in the
deeper water.
14 Properties of waves
An interesting thing happens to waves when they go
through a gap in a barrier. Figure 14.16 shows what
happens. Waves passing through the gap in the rocks
spread out to fill the bay. This is an example of a
phenomenon called diffraction. Figure 14.17 shows
water waves in a ripple tank being diffracted as they pass
through a gap.
KEY WORD
Figure 14.15b: This wavefront diagram shows the same
pattern of ripples as a. The rays show that the refracted ray
is closer to the normal, just as when light slows down on
entering glass.
In the photograph in Figure 14.15a, you can see that these
ripples lag behind the faster-moving ripples in the deeper
water. Their direction of travel has changed. Figure 14.15b
shows the same effect, but as a wavefront diagram. On the
left, the ripples are in deeper water and they move faster.
They advance steadily forwards. On the right, the ripples
are moving more slowly. The right-hand end of a ripple is
the first part to enter the shallower water, so it has spent
longest time moving at a slow speed. This means that the
right-hand end of each ripple lags behind.
The rays (the red arrows) marked on Figure 14.15b show
the direction in which the ripples are moving. They are
always at right angles to the ripples. They emphasise how
the ripples turn so their direction is closer to the normal as
they slow down, just as we saw with the refraction of light
in Chapter 13.
Diffraction
Figure 14.16: The waves on the sea are straight. As they
pass through the gap in the rocks, they start to spread out.
diffraction: when a wave spreads out as it travels
through a gap or past the edge of an object
Figure 14.17: Ripples are diffracted as they pass through a gap
in a barrier -they spread into the space behind the barrier.
Sound waves are diffracted as they pass through
doorways and open windows. This is why we can hear
a person around the comer, even though we cannot see
them. This supports the idea that sound travels as a wave.
Light waves are also diffracted when they pass through
very tiny gaps. You might notice that, on a foggy night,
street lamps and car headlights appear to be surrounded
by a halo of light. This is because their light is diffracted
by the tiny droplets of water in the air. The same effect
can also sometimes be seen around the Sun during the
day (see Figure 14.18).
Figure 14.18: Light from the Sun is diffracted as it passes
through foggy air (which is full of tiny droplets of water),
producing a halo of light.
269
y
1
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 14.1
Studying waves in a ripple tank
3
In this experiment you will observe reflection and
refraction of ripples in a ripple tank and describe
the reflection, refraction and diffraction of water
Look carefully at the reflected waves. Investigate
what happens when you change the angle of the
barrier.
4
Place the glass sheet in the tank so that the
waves hit it straight on. Adjust the water level so
that the water above the glass is very shallow.
5
Observe the waves as they enter and leave the
shallower water.
6
Investigate the effect of turning the glass sheet
so that the waves enter the shallow water at an
waves.
You will need:
•
ripple tank and dipper with an eccentric
motor
•
•
•
•
power supply
light
metal or plastic barriers
glass sheet to adjust the depth of water.
angle.
7
Use two barriers to create a wide gap for the
waves to pass through. Observe the effect.
8
Narrow the gap until it is about the same size
as the wavelength of the waves. Observe how
this affects the waves.
Safety: It is easiest to observe the shadow of
the waves in a darkened room. Keep the work
area tidy to avoid trip hazards. Clear up any spilt
water immediately.
1
Getting started
What effect does changing the speed of the motor
have on the wavefronts produced?
Draw a diagram to show what happens to plane
waves when they strike a flat reflector placed at
45° to their direction of travel.
2
Draw a diagram to show what happens to
Questions
plane waves when:
If you put a small piece of cork in the water, how
does it move?
Method
1 Adjust the motor so that you can clearly see the
shadows of the waves moving across the tank.
2
Place a barrier in the tank at an angle so that it
reflects the waves.
a
they enter the shallower water straight on
b they enter shallower water at an angle.
3
Draw diagrams to show diffraction at a wide
gap and at a narrow gap.
4
How can the speed of ripples in a ripple tank
be changed?
SELF-ASSESSMENT
Compare your ripple tank diagrams to another student's. Think about what makes a good diagram. Are your
diagrams clear, simple and correctly labelled? Add notes to your diagrams saying what you have done well
and what could be improved.
270
y
14 Properties of waves
ACTIVITY 14.1
Learning the definitions of key words
You will have noticed that this topic contains a lot
of key words. To explain waves you need to be
familiar with these words, which describe wave
characteristics and how waves behave.
Design and make a revision activity to help you
remember the key definitions. You could use one of
the ideas below or create your own.
• Flash cards: have a key word on one side and
its definition on the other. This way, anything
you get wrong, you will see the correct answer
straight away which will help for the next time.
REFLECTION
Learning key words is important in physics as
words have very precise meanings which may be
different from the everyday use of the word. Think
about how you learn these words. What activities
are most helpful for you? Are you regularly
checking back over key words from other
chapters? Have you learnt revision techniques in
other subjects which you can apply here?
Questions: write a set of short questions such
as, 'What is the unit of frequency?' on a large
sheet of paper. Give each question a mark (1
for easy, 2 for difficult). With a friend, take turns
answering questions. Remove any which have
been answered correctly as you go. The winner
is the person with most points.
Create self-test questions on a quiz app. This
way you can test yourself regularly and quickly.
1 5 Figure 14.20 shows four ripples, a-d, in a ripple
tank. Copy and complete each diagram to show
what happens to the ripples. Label each diagram
with the wave phenomenon it is showing.
Questions
1 4 The red lines in Figure 14.19 show sound waves
created by person A.
person B
shallow water
Figure 14.20
Diffraction, more or less
Figure 14.19
a
b
Waves are diffracted when they pass through a gap or
around the edge of an obstacle. The size of the gup
affects diffraction. The effect is greatest when the width
of the gap is equal to the wavelength of the ripples
(Figure 14.21).
Copy and complete Figure 14.19 to show how
the sound waves reach person B.
What type of waves are sound waves?
271
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Sound waves have wavelengths'between about 10 mm
and 10 metres. This is why they are diffracted as they
pass through doorways and windows. Light waves have
a much shorter wavelength - less than a millionth of a
metre. This is why very small gaps are needed to see light
being diffracted.
Diffraction also happens as waves pass an edge. The
greater the wavelength of the waves, the greater the angle
Figure 14.21: Diffraction is greatest when the width of
the gap is equal to the wavelength of the waves being
diffracted. When the gap is much smaller than the
wavelength, the waves do not pass through at all.
Compare Figure 14.22 with Figure 14.17. In Figure
14.22, the gap is wider, so it is now much bigger than
the wavelength of the waves. The diffraction effect is not
so pronounced. The central part of the ripple remains
straight after it has passed through the gap. At the edges,
the ripples are curved.
Figure 14.22: The wavelength of the waves is much smaller
than the gap, so the waves are diffracted less.
272
)
Figure 14.23: Increasing the wavelength of waves increases
the angle of diffraction.
,
Questions
1 6 Explain why person B in question 14.14 can hear
person A, but not see them.
17 A man who lives behind a mountain finds he can
receive waves with a wavelength of 1500 metres, but
not shorter waves with a wavelength of 2 metres.
Explain why.
1 8 Draw a diagram to show how a series of parallel,
straight wavefronts are altered as they pass through
a gap with a width that is equal to the wavelength of
the waves.
14 Properties of waves
PROJECT
So, what is a wave?
You should also explain some of the differences,
for example, that sound waves need a medium.
Your section will introduce the programme so it
needs to get the audience's interest so they don't
reach for the remote control. (You could point out
that the remote control is operated by infrared or
radio waves!) The producer suggests you might
show a crowd doing a Mexican wave as a way of
showing energy being transferred by a wave. You
could also include pictures or video clips of water
waves, including seismic waves and tsunamis.
You work for a television company that is making a
programme about the discovery of gravitational waves.
The producer has asked your team to work on a five
minute introduction to the general idea of waves. You
need to answer the question: 'What is a wave?'.
The director thinks viewers may think of waves as
being just water waves. She wants viewers to have a
clear idea of what a wave is and how waves behave.
Viewers should understand why physicists describe
light and sound as waves.
You will need to show that water, light and sound
waves behave in the same ways, particularly that
they can be reflected, refracted and diffracted.
Once you have the audience interested, you will
need to introduce the idea that waves transmit
energy but not matter. Illustrate this by referring to
waves in springs, boats bobbing on the waves at
sea, or any other examples you can think of. You
should then cover wave behaviour, giving as many
examples as possible to show the audience how
many everyday things depend on waves.
You may present your ideas as a video, or as a
storyboard.
When the programme is broadcast all your names
will be in the credits, along with your job title.
Decide early on what each person will do. Jobs
could include: researcher, picture researcher, editor,
producer, sound technician, cameraperson and any
other roles you think are needed.
SUMMARY
Waves transfer energy without transferring matter.
Waves can be clearly seen in water and springs.
Waves can be transverse or longitudinal.
Wave speed, frequency and wavelength are related by the equation v
Waves can be reflected and refracted.
Waves can be diffracted when they pass through a gap or round an obstacle.
The wave model can be used to explain reflection, refraction and diffraction.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
COMMAND WORD
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
274
y
14 Properties of waves
CONTINUED
5 This diagram shows a wave in the sea.
x/cm
20
10-10-
6 d/m
-20-
a What is the wavelength of the wave?
[1]
b A student says the amplitude is 40 cm. Explain what mistake they have
made and write down the correct amplitude.
[1]
c Later in the day the sea is calmer. The amplitude is reduced to 10 cm.
On graph paper, draw the new wave.
[1]
d A bird is floating on the sea. Describe the movement of the bird as
the waves pass it.
[2]
e The student observes the waves closer to the beach. The wavelength
here is 0.5 metres. What can you deduce from this?
[1]
[Total: 6]
6 Radio station A broadcasts radio waves with a wavelength of 1 500 metres
and a frequency of 200 kHz. Station B has a frequency of 100 MHz.
a Calculate the speed at which the waves travel.
[1]
b Use your answer to part a to calculate the wavelength of the waves
from station B.
[1]
c Explain why a man living in a hilly area can receive the waves from
station B but not the waves from station A.
[2]
[Total: 4]
7 A vibration generator is used to make a wave on a string.
a What is the name of the distance labelled a?
[1]
b The distance from the pulley to the vibration generator is 90 cm.
What is the wavelength of the wave?
[1]
COMMAND WORDS
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
deduce: conclude
from available
information
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
Calculate the speed of the waves in the string.
[2]
d The vibration of the string causes a sound wave to pass through the air.
What type of wave is:
[1]
i the wave in the string?
ii the sound wave in the air?
[1]
[Total: 6]
8 A student investigates waves in a ripple tank. All the water is the same depth.
She measures the wavelength of each wave as 22 cm. The period of each
wave is 0.58 s.
Calculate the speed of the wave.
[4]
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will hglp you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
State what is transferred by a wave.
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Almost
there
14.1
Recall that waves (including electromagnetic and
seismic waves), vibrations in springs and ropes,
light, and sound are all examples of wave motion.
Illustrate wave motion using ropes, springs and
water waves.
14.1
14.1
Define and use the terms: wavefront, wavelength,
frequency, amplitude, wave speed, crest, trough,
compression, rarefaction.
14.1
Recall and use the equation linking wave speed,
frequency and wavelength.
14.2
Recall the direction of vibrations in transverse and
longitudinal waves.
14.1
Give examples of transverse and longitudinal waves.
14.1
Draw diagrams to show reflection, refraction and
diffraction of waves.
14.3
Describe how the wavelength of a wave affects
diffraction.
14.3
276
A
Confident
to move on
spectrum
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL
describe the main features of the electromagnetic spectrum
describe some uses of different electromagnetic waves
consider how electromagnetic waves can be used safely.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
Think about what you have learnt so far about waves.
Write down five bullet points which sum up what you know about waves - including light and sound.
Pair up and agree five points from your combined lists. You can change or combine them.
Join with another pair and write out five points that the group agrees on. Display these points to the class.
RADIATION - FRIEND OR FOE?
risk vitamin D deficiency. Our bodies create vitamin
D when exposed to sunlight. Lack of it can cause a
range of health problems, including rickets.
Gamma radiation released in nuclear disasters has
been shown to cause cancers, and yet when used
correctly, the same radiation can be directed on to
cancer cells to kill them.
Decisions about the use of potentially harmful
Figure 15.1a: This artist's impression shows how high
energy gamma radiation can be finely targeted to kill
tumour cells, b: Jocelyn Joyce Burnell was one of the
first astrophysicists to observe light from pulsars. Pulsars
emit pulses of light at very regular intervals, making
them enormously accurate clocks. Pulsars can be used to
measure astronomical distances very accurately.
The light waves we see are part of a bigger family
of waves called the electromagnetic spectrum.
These range from gamma rays (seen killing a cancer
cell in Figure 15.1a) to the radio waves used in radio
astronomy by astronomers such as Jocelyn Joyce
Burnell (Figure 15.1b). In this chapter you will learn
about these waves: what they have in common and
the differences that make them useful in a huge
variety of ways.
All these forms of radiation have useful applications,
but many can also cause harm.
Ultraviolet radiation from the Sun can cause skin
cancer. However, in trying to avoid skin cancer by
staying indoors and covering skin whilst outside, we
278
>
radiation have to balance risk with benefit. Consider
a pregnant woman involved in a car crash who
appears to have sustained a serious spinal injury.
X-rays could damage the developing fetus, but
without X-ray images to inform treatment, the
woman could be paralysed.
Decisions like this have no easy answers. Whichever
decision is made, the doctors wifi aim to minimise
risk; for example, if they decide to use X-rays, they
will shield the fetus with lead shields which block
X-rays as much as they can.
As you will see in this chapter, electromagnetic
radiation is all around us. Decisions about how to
use these waves have to be taken by everybody, not
just the scientists.
Discussion questions
A large sports arena concerned about security
is considering installing X-ray scanners to check
supporters and their bags for dangerous items.
1
Discuss the risks and benefits of installing this
system.
2
Consider who should make the final decision:
the arena managers, supporters or scientists?
15
15.1 Electromagnetic
waves
William Herschel was an astronomer. In 1799 he was
investigating the spectrum of light from the Sun. He used
prism to create a spectrum then placed a thermometer at
different parts of the spectrum. The thermometer reading
increased when the light fell on it. The light energy was
absorbed, creating a heating effect. Herschel noticed this
effect was greatest for red light and smallest for violet.
I Icrschel then placed his thermometer past the red end
of the spectrum. The temperature rise was even greater.
I ic concluded that there must be some type of radiation,
invisible to the human eye, beyond the red end of the
ipectrum. He called this infrared radiation (‘infra’ means
below). Infrared radiation is the thermal radiation
described in Chapter 11. It is the heat you can feel
radiating out from any hot object.
The electromagnetic spectrum
Both infrared and ultraviolet radiation were discovered
by looking at the spectrum of light from the Sun.
However, they do not have to be produced by an object
like the Sun. Imagine a lump of iron that you heat in
a Bunsen flame. At first, it looks dull and black. Take
it from the flame and you will find that it is emitting
infrared radiation. Put it back in the flame and heat it
more. It begins to glow, first a dull red colour, then more
yellow, and eventually white hot. It is emitting visible
light. When its temperature reaches about 1000 °C, it will
also be emitting ultraviolet radiation.
This experiment suggests that there is a connection
between infrared, visible and ultraviolet radiation. A
cool object emits only radiation at the cool end of the
spectrum. The hotter the object, the more radiation it
emits from the hotter end.
The Sun is a very hot object (Figure 15.3). Its surface
temperature is about 5500 °C, so it emits a lot of
ultraviolet radiation. Most of this is absorbed in the
atmosphere, particularly by the ozone layer. A small
amount of ultraviolet radiation does get through to us.
The ozone layer is depleted (decreased) by chemicals
used in aerosols and refrigerants. Depletion lets more
ultraviolet through, increasing the risk of skin cancer.
In 1985, an international agreement called the Montreal
Protocol regulated, then banned, the use of CFCs the main chemicals involved in the depletion. In 2019,
NASA reported a 20% decrease in ozone depletion.
While there is still work to be done, this is an example of
what global cooperation on climate issues can achieve.
Figure 15.2: A modern version of Herschel's experiment.
The spectrum of light from the Sun extends beyond the
visible region, from infrared to ultraviolet. The thermometer
placed beyond the red light detects more thermal radiation
than any of the others.
Beyond the violet end of
the spectrum
The discovery of radiation beyond the red end of the
spectrum encouraged people to look beyond the violet
end. In 1801, a German scientist called Johan Ritter used
silver chloride to look for ‘invisible rays’. Silver salts are
blackened by exposure to sunlight (this is the basis of
film photography). Ritter directed a spectrum of sunlight
onto paper soaked in silver chloride solution. The paper
became blackened and, to his surprise, the effect was
strongest beyond the violet end of the visible spectrum. He
had discovered ultraviolet radiation (‘ultra’ means beyond).
Figure 15.3: The Sun is examined by several satellite
observatories. This image was produced by the SOHO
satellite using a camera that detects the ultraviolet radiation
given off by the Sun. You can see some detail of the Sun's
surface, including giant prominences looping out into space.
The different colours indicate variations in the temperature
across the Sun's surface.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Electromagnetic waves
Wavelength and frequency
We have seen that a spectrum is formed when light passes
through a prism because some colours are refracted more
than others. The violet end of the spectrum is refracted
the most. Now we can deduce that ultraviolet radiation
is refracted even more than violet light, and that infrared
radiation is refracted less than red light.
We can represent light as a transverse wave. Figure 15.4
compares red light with violet light. Red light has a greater
wavelength than violet light. This means that there is a
greater distance from one wave crest to the next. This is
because both red light and violet light travel at the same
speed, but violet light has a greater frequency, so it goes up
and down more often in the same length.
To explain the spectrum, and other features of light,
physicists developed the wave model of light.
Just as sound can be thought of as vibrations or waves
travelling through the air (or any other material), so
we can think of light as being another form of wave.
Sounds can have different pitches - the higher the
frequency, the higher the pitch. We can think of a piano
keyboard as being a ‘spectrum’ of sounds of different
frequencies. Light can have different colours, according
to its frequency. Red light has a lower frequency than
violet light. Visible light occurs as a spectrum of colours,
depending on its frequency.
A Scottish physicist, James Clerk Maxwell, described
light as small oscillations in electric and magnetic fields
which he called electromagnetic waves. His theory
allowed him to predict that they could have any value
of frequency. In other words, beyond the infrared and
ultraviolet regions of the spectrum, there must be even
more types of electromagnetic wave (or electromagnetic
radiation). By the early years of the 20th century,
physicists had discovered or artificially produced several
other types of electromagnetic wave to complete the
electromagnetic spectrum.
The electromagnetic spectrum is a family of transverse
waves. Like all waves, they can be reflected, refracted
or diffracted. They all travel at the same speed as light
in a vacuum. The waves have different frequencies, and
this means they have different effects on the materials
with which they interact. These waves have many very
important uses, and some can be hazardous.
The speed of electromagnetic
waves
All types of electromagnetic wave have one thing in
common: they travel at the same speed in a vacuum.
They travel at the speed of light, which has a value
close to 300 000 000 m/s (3 x 108 m/s) in a vacuum and
approximately the same speed in air. Like light, the
speed of electromagnetic waves depends on the material
through which they are travelling.
280
>
a
wavelength
I4—*|
lamp
wvwvw
b
wavelength
Figure 15.4: Comparing red and violet lightwaves.
Both travel at the same speed, but red light has a longer
wavelength because its frequency is lower. Th£ wavelength is
the distance from one crest to the next (or from one trough to
the next). Think of red light waves as longer, lazy waves. Violet
light is made up of shorter, more rapidly vibrating waves.
The waves that make up visible light have very high
frequencies: over one hundred million million hertz, or
1014Hz. Their wavelengths are very small, from 400 nm
(nanometres) for violet light to 700 nm for red light.
(1 nm is one-billionth or one-thousand-millionth of a
metre, so 400 nm
m.) More than one
-—
= —1000000000
’
million waves of visible light fit into a metre.
Figure 15.5 shows the complete electromagnetic
spectrum, with the wavelengths and frequencies of
each region. In fact, we cannot be very precise about
where each region starts and stops. This is similar to the
light spectrum: it is hard to say where red finishes and
orange begins. Even the ends of the visible light section
are uncertain, because different people can see slightly
different ranges of wavelengths, just as they can hear
different ranges of sound frequencies.
KEY WORDS
ultraviolet radiation: electromagnetic radiation
with a wavelength shorter than that of visible light
electromagnetic spectrum: the family of
radiations similar to light
15 The electromagnetic spectrum
increasing frequency
Figure 1 5.5: The electromagnetic spectrum. Remember all waves travel at the same speed and because v =/A.As frequency
increases, wavelength decreases.
Questions
1
Draw and label two waves to show the difference
between red light and violet light.
2
Write the names of the waves in the electromagnetic
spectrum:
a in order of increasing wavelength
3
Describe and explain what happens when
monochromatic green light of wavelength 540 nm
passes through a prism.
4
Use the equation v =/A to calculate the frequency
of the green light in question 15.3.
b in order of increasing frequency.
Uses of electromagnetic waves
The different frequencies of the waves in the
electromagnetic spectrum give them different properties
and this means that they are useful in different ways.
Here are some important examples.
Radio waves
Radio waves are used to broadcast radio and television
signals. These waves are sent out from a transmitter
a few kilometres away to be captured by an aerial on
the roof of a house. Radio astronomy can be used to
detect radio waves from objects such as stars, galaxies
and black holes. Radio frequency identification (RFID)
chips are microchips inserted underneath the skin. These
can store vital medical information and could be used
instead of a passport, or as a contactless bank card.
An RFID tag stores data. It transmits the data as radio
waves, which is read by an electronic reader.
Figure 15.6: Tiny RFID tags can store and transmit data.
A tag inserted in your body could be used to open doors
or pay for shopping to track for your movements.
281
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Microwaves
Used in satellite television broadcasting, because
microwaves pass easily through the Earth’s atmosphere.
They travel up to a broadcasting satellite, thousands
of kilometres away in space. Then they are sent back
down to subscribers on Earth. Microwaves are also used
to transmit mobile phone (cellphone) signals between
masts, which may be up to 20 km apart.
Microwaves ovens emit microwaves, which are absorbed
by molecules in food, causing heating.
Infrared radiation
Infrared radiation is used in remote controls for devices
such as televisions. A beam of radiation from the remote
control carries a coded signal to the appliance, which
changes the settings on the television; for example,
changing channel, increasing the volume. You may be
able to use a smartphone camera to observe this type of
radiation, which would otherwise be invisible to our eyes.
Point a remote control at your phone and record what
happens as you press buttons. Grills and toasters also
use infrared radiation to cook food. Security alarms send
out beams of infrared radiation and detect changes in
the reflected radiation, which may indicate the presence
of an intruder. Infrared red light is also used together
with optical fibres. In Figure 15.9b an endoscope allows
the doctor to see inside the patient. Visible light is passed
down an optical fibre to illuminate the lungs of this
COVID-19 patient. Reflected light travels back up to
the doctor’s eye. Infrared radiation can also be used in
medicine to detect heat which may indicate infection, or
to speed up healing and reduce pain.
Figure 1 5.8: Using an infrared scanner allows a doctor to
see a patient's veins. This means injections can be targetted
much more precisely.
Visible light
Visible light provides us with information about the
world, both directly through our eyes and via optical
instruments such as cameras, telescopes and microscopes.
Visible light is also vital for photosynthesis.
Figure 15.7: Microwaves allow signals to be transmitted
around the curve of the earth's surface.
282
y
Figure 1 5.9a: This leaf has used visible light to grow. It is
illuminated by the microscope lamp, and the reflected light
is focused by the microscope lenses, b: An endoscope allows
the doctors to see inside the patient. Visible light is passed
down an optical fibre to illuminate the lungs of this COVID-19
patient. Reflected light travels back up to the doctor's eye.
15 The electromagnetic spectrum
Ultraviolet (UV) light
t JV light causes some chemicals to emit visible light. This
includes body fluids such as sweat and saliva. Forensic
'lien lists use this to find evidence at crime scenes which
r. invisible to the human eye.
(
hemicals which glow in UV light can be used for
'icurity marking of valuable equipment and banknotes.
I Jltraviolet light can be used to sterilise water. Exposure
(o UV radiation destroys DNA within any bacteria and
viruses contained in the water. This makes the bacteria
mid viruses harmless and the water much safer to use.
Figure 15.11: X-ray scanners allow airport security to quickly
detect hidden items.
Gamma rays
Gamma rays can damage or kill living cells. A targeted
beam of gamma rays can be used to kill cancerous cells.
Surgical instruments can be sterilised by using gamma
rays to kill any bacteria.
Gamma rays can also be used in the detection of cancer.
You will learn more about gamma rays and how they are
used in Chapter 23.
Figure 15.10: Many banknotes have markings which are
only visible in ultraviolet light. This helps in the detection of
forged banknotes.
X-rays
X-rays can penetrate solid materials and so they are
used in security scanners at airports. They are also used
in hospitals and clinics to see inside patients without
the need for surgery. The X-rays are detected using
electronic detectors. Bone absorbs X-rays more strongly
than flesh, so bones appear as a shadow in the image.
Similarly, a metal gun will appear as a shadow because it
absorbs X-rays more strongly than the items around it in
Figure 15.11.
Figure 15.12: A nurse demonstrates a radiation helmet.
The holes in the helmet allow the gamma rays to be
targeted exactly on to a tumour.
Questions
5
6
Name two types of electromagnetic radiation that
are used to cook food.
Name three types of electromagnetic radiation that
have medical uses.
283
y
>
7
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
A girl phones her friend on her mobile phone while
watching TV by a log fire. Explain how infrared
radiation, microwaves, visible light and radio waves
are involved in this.
15.2 Electromagnetic
hazards
All types of radiation can be hazardous. Even bright
light shining into your eyes can blind you. Infrared
radiation can cause burns. UV radiation from the Sun
can damage skin cells which may lead to sunburn and
skin cancer. Sunbeds can also damage skin cells and
should be used with care. UV radiation can also damage
eye cells which is why is important to protect your eyes
in bright sunlight by wearing sunglasses or a hat. In
general, the higher the frequency of the wavelength, the
greater the harm it can cause.
Figure 1 5.13a: The radiographer operates the machine
from a separate room.
X-rays and gamma rays are the most dangerous part
of the electromagnetic spectrum. They can cause cell
mutations which may lead to cancer. People who work
with X-rays and gamma rays are in danger of being
exposed to too much radiation. They can protect
themselves by standing well away when a patient is being
examined, or by enclosing the equipment in a metal case,
which will absorb rays.
Longer waves such as microwaves are much less harmful,
but as we use them a lot more frequently in everyday
life, we are exposed to much larger amounts of these
waves. Microwaves are used to cook food in microwave
ovens. This shows that they have a heating effect when
absorbed. Telephone engineers, for example, must take
care not to expose themselves to excessive amounts of
microwaves when they are working on the masts of a
mobile phone (cellphone) network. Domestic microwave
ovens must be checked to ensure that no radiation is
leaking out.
Mobile phones use radio waves and microwaves. Many
people are concerned that these could be harmful.
Scientists have researched this and the only effect they
have found consistent evidence for is a slight heating
effect. This is not believed to be harmful. If any risks are
found, they would have more effect on children, as they
are still developing. Any harm would be increased by
using the phone for longer.
284
>
Figure 1 5.1 3b: All areas where X-rays or gamma rays are
used have hazard warning labels.
Questions
8
9
The radiographer must leave the room before
operating an X-ray machine. Why is it considered
too dangerous for the radiographer but not for the
patient?
A headline reads, ‘Scientists prove mobile phones are
safe’. Explain why this headline is misleading.
15
ACTIVITY 15.1
The electromagnetic spectrum
15.3 Communicating
using electromagnetic
waves
Satellites
Satellites are objects which orbit the Earth. Earth
has one natural satellite - the Moon. Earth also has
many artificial satellites, many of which are used in the
transmission of information carried by electromagnetic
waves. Most artificial satellite communication uses
microwaves.
Some of the satellites used for communication are in
geostationary orbits. This means that they orbit at the
same rate as the Earth turns and so they stay above one
point on the Earth’s surface. They are about 35000 km
above the Earth’s surface and are positioned above the
Equator. These satellites are powerful and can transmit
large amounts of data. This makes them suitable for
satellite television and some satellite phones. The waves
travel a long distance to the satellite, meaning there
is a slight delay, making it more difficult to have a
conversation.
Low Earth orbits are much closer. They can be as low as
2000 km above the Earth’s surface. This means there is
no delay in conversation. These satellites orbit the Earth
in as little as two hours. A lot more of these are needed
than for geostationary orbits as they only cover a small
area of the Earth’s surface (see Figure 15.15). They
cannot transmit data as fast as geostationary satellites
and so are not suitable for television transmission.
Low Earth orbit satellites
move around the Earth.
They cover a much
smaller area.
Geostationary \
satellites stay
above one point
on the Earth's
surface and cover
a large area.
Figure 15.15: Low Earth orbits require many more satellites.
285
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
The right wave for the job
Mobile phones and wireless internet use microwaves,
because they can pass through most walls and only a
small aerial is needed.
Figure 15.18: Optical fibres.
Analogue and digital signals
Figure 15.16: This laptop is connected to the internet using
microwaves.
Bluetooth - used for short range communication - uses
radio waves. The signal is weakened when it passes
through walls. This short range signal is useful for
communication between electronic devices such as in
hands-free mobile phone systems.
In telephone communication, the signal being
transmitted starts off as a sound wave. This( varies in
amplitude and frequency as the people talk. A sound
wave is an analogue signal - it can vary continuously.
In traditional telephones, the sound wave is converted
by a microphone to an electrical signal, x^hich varies
in the same way as the sound wave. The electrical
signal is transmitted via copper wires to a receiver,
where a speaker converts it back to a sound wave. The
transmission process for analogue signals causes the wave
to become distorted and unwanted vibrations are often
heard as noise. This means the signal is not always clear.
A digital system is a sequence of pulses. Digital signals are
either on or off. Digital systems usitrg optical fibres give a
much clearer signal. They are also faster and optical cables
can carry much more data than a copper cables.
Figure 1 5.1 9: An analogue signal varies continuously while
a digital signal is either on or off.
Figure 15.17: A woman wearing a bluetooth headset.
KEY WORDS
Optical fibres (for cable television and high speed
internet) use infrared radiation and visible light. Optical
fibres are made of glass which is transparent to light and
infrared radiation. These waves have a higher frequency
and can carry more data. This is vital for high speed
broadband connections.
286
y
analogue signal: a signal which varies
continuously in frequency and amplitude
digital signal, a signal that consists of a series of
pulses which are either on or off
1 5 The electromagnetic spectrum
ADC
analogue
to digital
microphone
laser
diode
pulsed beam of light
(or infrared)
converter
.
(encoder)^
regenerator
(repeater)
photo¬
diode
cleans up the
signal
perhaps
DAC
digital to
analogue
amplifier
loudspeaker
converter
(decoder)
'noisy'
pulse
in
'clean'
regenerator
out
Figure 15.20: The use of regenerators means that digital signals can be transmitted over hundreds of kilometres without
being distorted.
Making a digital phone call
The analogue sound wave from a caller is encoded by
a converter which turns the sound wave to a series of
pulses. The digital signal is carried along optical fibres
by visible pulses or infrared waves. The signal passes
through one or more regenerators which clean up the
signal, removing any distortion. The regenerators also
boost the signal if it has lost power. A second converter
switches the signal back to an analogue signal which can
be converted to a sound wave.
Digital signals can transmit data much more rapidly and
accurately than analogue signals. Digital signals can also
communicate directly with computers which only use
digital data.
ACTIVITY 15.2
Guess who?
waves, microwaves, infrared, visible light, ultra
violet, X-rays, gamma rays, red light, violet light,
sound, ultrasound, water and seismic waves).
Place the cards face down in the middle. One
player takes a card and looks at it without letting
the others see. The other players then try to, find
out what the wave is by asking questions to which
the answer can only be 'yes' or 'no'. Each player can
only ask one question.
Work in a group of about four students. Write the
names of different waves on identical cards (radio
When the wave has been identified, the next player
takes their turn.
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
REFLECTION
There are two spectra which you need to
remember in order: visible light and the
electromagnetic spectrum. How easily can you
remember them? What helps you with this?
Mnemonics can be very useful here. The colours
of the visible spectrum can be remembered using
Richard Of York Gave Battle In Vain. The first
letters of the words correspond to the first
letters of the colours. Try to make a mnemonic
to remember the order of the waves in the
electromagnetic spectrum.
10 There are two types of communication satellite:
geostationary and low earth orbit. Explain which
type:
a is best suited to transmitting TV signals
b gives the shortest delay for phone conversations
c takes least time to orbit the Earth.
11 State two benefits of converting a phone signal from
analogue to digital.
PROJECT
Rainbow balloon debate
Balloon debates usually involve discussing which
person should be thrown out of an overloaded hot
air balloon basket, so that it does not crash. Each
passenger explains why they should stay and then a
vote is taken. In this activity, the passengers are the
different waves of the electromagnetic spectrum.
Seven different wavelengths of radiation are
travelling in a hot air balloon.
•
Radio waves
•
Microwaves
•
•
Infrared radiation
Visible light
•
•
•
Ultraviolet radiation
X-rays
Gamma rays
The balloon can only manage six waves, and so one of
the waves must be thrown overboard, or the balloon
will crash. As a class you will debate which wave
should be sacrificed. Each wave will have a team who
prepare to speak in favour of their wave and look at
arguments why the other waves should go.
You will need to divide the class into se^en teams (you
could have fewer teams and leave some waves out if
necessary). Your teacher will assign each team a wave.
You will need to prepare arguments why your
given wave is so important that it must stay in the
balloon. Think about what it is used for - medical or
communication uses for example - and why losing
this would be bad. Think about the harmful aspects
of your wave - you will have to answer questions
about these, so be prepared to defend your wave.
You will also need to prepare questions for the
other waves. Your aim is to make them seem either
harmful or not particularly useful so that they are
more likely to be voted off.
Your teacher will tell you how long each team can
speak for and how long the question portion will last.
15
The electromagnetic spectrum
PEER ASSESSMENT
After every team has spoken and has been
questioned, you will all vote for which wave must go.
To help with this, record your impressions of each
group on a sheet similar to this.
Use your scoring and notes to decide how you
will vote.
Group name
Wave
Initial speech
©©©
Answering questions
© @©
Notes
SUMMARY
The electromagnetic spectrum is a group of waves which have similar properties to light.
In order of increasing frequency, the waves in the electromagnetic spectrum are: radiowaves, microwaves,
infrared, visible light, ultraviolet, X-rays and gamma rays.
All electromagnetic waves travel at the same speed - the speed of light.
The speed of light is 300 000 000 m/s.
Electromagnetic waves have different wavelengths and this gives them different properties and makes them
suitable for different uses.
High frequency electromagnetic radiation can be hazardous. It can damage cells and cause cells to mutate.
Radio waves, microwaves, visible light and infrared are used in communication systems.
Signals can be analogue or digital. Digital signals transmit data more accurately and faster.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which statement is correct when comparing gamma rays and microwaves?
[1 ]
A Microwaves have a higher speed in air and the same frequency.
B Microwaves have a higher frequency and the same wavelength.
C Microwaves have a longer wavelength and the same speed.
D Microwaves have a higher frequency and the same speed.
2 This is part of the electromagnetic spectrum:
radiowaves
visible
light
microwaves P
ultraviolet
Q
gamma
rays
Increasing R
[1]
Which row correctly describes the labels P, Q and R?
P
Q
R
X-rays
infrared radiation
wavelength
infrared radiation
X-rays
frequency
X-rays
infrared radiation
frequency
infrared radiation
X-rays
wavelength
3 Which of the following statements is true for electromagnetic waves?
[1]
A They all have the same frequency.
B They cannot be refracted.
C They all travel at the same speed.
D They are harmless.
4 This diagram shows white light being dispersed by a prism. The dispersed light
hits a screen.
290
a What will be seen at B?
[1 ]
b What will be seen at C?
[1 ]
>
\
1 5 The electromagnetic spectrum
CONTINUED
What might be detected at A?
[1 ]
What might be detected at D?
[1 ]
COMMAND WORD
State one way in which the waves at A, B, C and D are alike.
[1 ]
State one way in which the four waves differ from each other.
[1]
state: express in
clear terms
[Total: 6]
5 These are some waves on the electromagnetic spectrum:
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
State the speed of electromagnetic waves in a vacuum.
15.1
Describe the properties all electromagnetic waves
share, including speed.
15.1
List the waves in the electromagnetic spectrum in
order of increasing frequency or wavelength.
15.1
Describe how radio waves, microwaves, visible light
and infrared are used in communications.
15.3
Describe how X-rays are used in medicine and security.
15.2
Describe how gamma rays can be harmful.
15.2
Consider the safety issues which may arise when
using microwaves.
15.2
Describe the advantages of using digital signals.
15.3
292
>
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
1
> Chapter 16
Magnetism
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
describe magnetic forces between magnets, and between magnets and magnetic materials
distinguish between hard and soft magnetic materials, and non-magnetic materials
describe an experiment to identify the pattern of magnetic field lines around a bar magnet
distinguish between the design and use of permanent magnets and electromagnets
use magnetic field patterns between magnets to explain the forces between them and understand how
to work out the relative strength of a magnetic field.
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
Spend two minutes producing a mind map that
answers the following questions before comparing
notes with your neighbour for a further two minutes,
adding or correcting your own work. Be prepared to
share your thoughts with the class.
•
'
Which elements are magnetic?
,
. ., on Earth, would be like ifr
Describe
magnetism did not exist. Ths might include
inventions that depend on magnetism.
whatJlfe
FLIPPING FIELDS
A German polar researcher called Alfred Wegener
(Figure 16.1) suggested that continents like South
America and Africa used to fit together like a jigsaw
and the pieces have drifted apart. Few people
believed him but later scientists proved him right.
Changes in the Earth's magnetic field helped prove
the Earth's surface is made of plates that move in a
process called plate tectonics.
Figure 16.2: A NASA image of what the Earth's magnetic
field looks like.
Figure 16.1: Alfred Wegener, the man whose theory of
continental drift was proved right by physics.
The Earth has a magnetic field, as if a giant bar
magnet sits along its axis (Figure 1 6.2). But where
does this field come from? The Earth's core is made
of iron. Like all metals, iron contains delocalised
electrons, which are free to move. The spin of
the Earth, and convection currents in the outer
core move these electrons, which creates electric
currents. These electric currents create magnetic
fields just as in electromagnets, which you will
meet later in the chapter. While many animals use
the Earth's magnetic field for navigation, we have
mostly replaced the compass with the GPS.
294
>
Molten (liquid) rock erupting at mid-ocean ridges
pushes the tectonic plates apart at about the
same speed as our fingernails grow (Figure 16.3).
Grains of magnetite in the molten rock act like little
compasses, which are free to change direction. As
the rock cools, these little compasses line up with
the Earth's magnetic field and become fixed in
place when the rocks crystallise (freeze). They show
that the Earth's magnetic field has reversed in the
past. The magnetic pattern is symmetrical (a mirror
image on each side of the mid-ocean ridge), which
shows that the continents were once stuck together,
proving Wegener right.
16 Magnetism
CONTINUED
KEY WORDS
The Earth's magnetic field acts as a shield,
protecting our atmosphere and life on Earth by
deflecting the harmful solar wind (a stream of
charged particles from the Sun). It also protects
all the electric circuits developed over the last
century. In the process of reversing, the field
has to decrease before increasing again in the
opposite direction. Some scientists believe that
animal species can become extinct during this
reversal process, which has happened roughly
once every 300000 years in the last 20 million
years. The last reversal was 780 000 years ago.
bar magnet: a rectangular-shaped permanent
magnet with a north pole at one end and a south
pole at the other
magnetic
stripes
mid-ocean
ridge
0
1f
When two magnets are brought close together, there is a
force between them. The north pole (N pole) of one will
attract the south pole (S pole) of the other. Two north
poles will repel each other, and two south poles will repel
each other (Figure 16.5). This is summarised as:
• like poles repel
• unlike poles attract.
‘Like poles’ means poles that are the same - both north,
or both south. ‘Unlike poles’ means opposite poles - one
north and the other south. People often remember this
rule more simply as ‘opposites attract’.
2f
3
4
Figure 16.3: The magnetic stripes on the ocean floor
that show that the Earth's magnetic field has reversed
once every 300000 years on average.
Discussion questions
Figure 1 6.4: A freely suspended magnet turns so that it
points north-south.
Describe what causes the Earth's magnetism
in less than 20 words.
2
In what ways is the Earth's magnetic field
beneficial?
3
Should we be concerned about magnetic
reversals?
16.1 Permanent magnets
A compass needle is like a bar magnet. When it is free
to rotate (Figure 16.4), it turns to point north-south.
One end points north - this is the magnet’s north
pole, pointing roughly in the direction of the Earth’s
geographical North Pole. The other end is the magnet’s
south pole. Sometimes, the north and south poles of
a magnet are called the north-seeking pole and south¬
seeking pole, respectively.
Figure 16.5a: Two like magnetic poles repel one another,
b: Two unlike magnetic poles attract each other.
295
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Since the north pole of the compass needle is attracted
to the Earth’s North Pole, it follows that there must be
a magnetic south pole up there, under the Arctic ice.
It is easy to get confused about this. In fact, for a long
time, mediaeval scientists thought that compass needles
were attracted to the Pole Star. Eventually, an English
instrument-maker called Robert Norman noticed that,
if he balanced a compass needle very carefully at its
midpoint, it tilted downwards slightly, pointing into the
Earth. Now we know that the Earth itself is magnetised,
rather as if there was a giant bar magnet inside it.
Magnetic materials
Magnetic materials are attracted by a magnet and can
be magnetised. Though they can be magnetised, not all
pieces of magnetic material are magnets. They first need
to be magnetised. In contrast, non-magnetic materials
are not attracted by a magnet and cannot be magnetised.
Examples include plastic and rubber.
Magnetic materials may be classified as hard (permanent)
or soft (temporary). Table 16.1 summarises the
difference. A soft magnetic material such as soft iron can
be magnetised and demagnetised easily.
KEY WORDS
permanent magnet magnetised magnetic
material that produces its own magnetic field that
does not get weaker with time
hard (material): a material that, once magnetised,
is difficult to demagnetise
soft (material): a material that, once magnetised,
is easy to demagnetise
i
Induced magnetism
A bar magnet is an example of a permanent magnet.
It can remain magnetised. Its magnetism (floes not
disappear. Permanent magnets are made of hard
magnetic materials.
A compass needle is a permanent magnet. Like many
bar magnets, it is made of hard steel. You have probably
come across another type of magnetic material, called
ferrite. This is a ceramic material used for making
fridge magnets and the magnets sometimes used to keep
cupboard doors shut. There are also small rare-earth
magnets in the headphones used with mobile phones,
which are based on elements such as neodymium.
A permanent magnet can attract or repel another
permanent magnet. It can also attract other
unmagnetised magnetic materials. For example, a bar
magnet can attract steel pins or paper clips, and a fridge
magnet can stick to the steel door of the fridge.
Most magnetic materials (including steel and ferrite)
contain iron, the most common magnetic element.
For this reason, they are known as ferrous materials
(from the Latin word ferrum meaning ‘iron’). Other
magnetic elements include cobalt and nickel. (If a
material contains iron, this is not a guarantee that it will
be magnetic. Stainless steel contains a lot of iron, but
magnets will not always stick to it.)
What is going on here? Steel pins are made of a magnetic
material. When the north pole of a permanent magnet
is brought close to a pin, the pin is attracted (see Figure
16.6). The attraction tells us that the end of the pin
nearest the magnetic pole must be a magnetic south
pole, as shown in Figure 16.6. This is known as induced
magnetism. The two objects will have opposite polarities.
In this example the pin will have a south pole induced in
Type of magnetic
material
hard
'
""
Description
Examples
retains magnetism well, but
difficult to magnetise in the first
hard steel
Uses
permanent magnets, compass
needles, loudspeaker magnets
place
easy to magnetise, but readily
loses its magnetism
soft
cores for electromagnets (discussed
soft iron
later in the chapter), transformers
and radio aerials
Table 16.1: Hard and soft magnetic materials. Hard steel is both hard to bend and difficult to magnetise and demagnetise.
Soft iron is both easier to bend and easier to magnetise and demagnetise.
296
y
'
16
the end nearest the north pole of a bar magnet. When
the permanent magnet is removed, the pin will return to
its unmagnetised state (or it may retain a small amount
of magnetism).
KEY WORDS
magnetised: when a magnetic material has been
made magnetic
Magnetism
16.2 Magnetic fields
A magnet affects any piece of magnetic material that is
nearby. We say that there is a magnetic field around the
magnet. You have probably done experiments with iron
filings or small compasses to illustrate the magnetic field
of a magnet. Figure 16.7 shows the field of a bar magnet
as revealed by iron filings.
unmagnetised: when a magnetic material has not
been made magnetic
induced magnetism: when a magnetic material is
only magnetised when placed in a magnetic field
(for example, when brought close to the pole of a
permanent magnet)
N
Figure 16.6: A steel pin is temporarily magnetised when a
permanent magnet is brought close to it.
Figure 16.7: The magnetic field pattern of a bar magnet
is illustrated by iron filings. The iron filings cluster most
strongly around the two poles of the magnet. This is where
the field is strongest.
Questions
1
Name three magnetic elements.
2
What is the rule about whether magnetic poles repel
or attract?
3
Copy and complete Table 16.2.
Type of
magnetic
material
Description Examples Uses
Hard
Soft
Table 16.2
4
Why is a permanent magnet made of steel rather
than iron?
Figure 16.8: Field lines are used to represent the magnetic
field around a bar magnet.
Figure 16.8 shows how we represent the magnetic field of
a single bar magnet using magnetic field lines. Of course,
the field fills all the space around the magnet, but we can
only draw a selection of typical lines to represent it. The
pattern tells us two things about the field:
•
Direction: the direction of a magnetic field line at
any point is the direction of the force on the north
pole of a magnet at that point. We use a convention
297
>
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
that says that field lines come out of north poles and
go in to south poles.
Strength: lines that are close together indicate a
strong field.
KEY WORDS
magnetic field: a region of space around a
magnet or electric current in which a magnetic
pole experiences (feels) a force
magnetic field lines: represent the direction
the magnetic force would have on the north pole
of a magnet
plotting compass: very small compass with a
needle that lines up with magnetic field lines,
allowing changes in field direction to be observed
and plotted over a very short distance
Plotting field lines
Iron filings can illustrate the pattern of the magnetic field
around a magnet. Place a magnet under a stiff sheet of
plain paper or (preferably) clear plastic. Sprinkle filings
over the paper or plastic. Tap the paper or plastic to
allow the filings to move slightly so that they line up in
the field. You should obtain a pattern similar to that
shown in Figure 16.7.
An alternative method of doing this uses a small
compass called a plotting compass. When a plotting
compass is placed in a magnetic field, its needle turns
to indicate the direction of the field. Activity 16.1
describes how to use a plotting compass to show the
pattern of a magnetic field. When drawing magnetic
field patterns, the field lines should never cross and they
should include arrows, pointing from magnetic north to
magnetic south.
ACTIVITY 16.1
Plotting field lines
In pairs, design an experiment to plot a field pattern
around a bar magnet. Create a worksheet which
gives instructions on how to do the experiment.
There should be at least ten field lines (including at
least two from each side of the magnet). In addition
to the bar magnet, the only pieces of equipment
needed for the experiment are a plotting compass,
a pencil and a sheet of plain paper.
In your worksheet remember to include:
•
how a compass works and how it can reveal
magnetic field lines
•
a clear step-by-step method for plotting the
field lines (including helpful sketches).
You could provide an optional extension task such
as: plot the field lines between two bar magnets
that are attracting or repelling. (In this case, make
sure you suggest a way to prevent the magnets
from moving.)
You could also produce a very short podcast
(maximum two minutes) to demonstrate how to do
the experiment.
After you have created your worksheet, you will
have the opportunity to look at the worksheets
written by other pairs. You should note any physics
you have learned, and any ideas for making your
own worksheet or presentation clearer or more
engaging in the future.
PEER ASSESSMENT
Provide feedback on the worksheets produced by
other pairs. As you give feedback on the worksheets,
think about these questions:
• Is the physics of a how a compass works
explained clearly?
298
>
• Could you follow the steps in the method?
• Are any steps missing or unclear?
Discuss any improvements that could be made. Each
pair should note down the feedback and, if there is
time, make any improvements.
16 Magnetism
c
Questions
5
a
b
c
d
6
Sketch the field pattern around a bar
magnet.
Someone has drawn the field pattern but forgot
to label the poles. Do the arrows point towards
or away from the magnetic north pole?
When looking at a field pattern, how would you
know where the magnetic field is strongest?
Where is the field strongest on a bar
magnet?
d
Is the magnetic field stronger at the Equator
or at the geographic North Pole? Explain
your answer.
Why is a compass very difficult to use near to
the north magnetic pole?
Interacting magnetic fields
a
Figure 1 6.9 shows the Earth’s magnetic field.
geographic
b
Figure 16.10a: The attraction between two opposite
magnetic poles shows up in their field pattern, b: The field
pattern for two like poles repelling each other.
We can show the field patterns for two magnets attracting
(Figure 16.10a) and repelling (Figure 16.10b) each other.
Notice that there is a point between the two repelling
magnets where there is no magnetic field.
When two bar magnets are placed close together their
magnetic fields interact (affect each other) and produce
a new pattern of magnetic lines of force. From these
patterns, it is possible to say whether the magnets will
attract or repel.
Figure 16.9: The Earth's magnetic field.
A compass needle inside a compass is a lightweight
bar magnet suspended at its centre of gravity on top
of a tiny vertical column.
a What will the compass needle line up with when
it is suspended (held at a point) so that it can
move freely?
b What magnetic pole is at the geographical
North Pole when the north pole of the compass
needle points in that direction?
Notice that, in Figure 16.10b, the field lines from
each magnet between the south poles are in the same
direction. The field lines inside the box are all pointing
downwards and are close together, so the field there is
stronger than the field at the north poles. The magnets
will move from where the field is stronger to where it is
weaker - so like poles repel. A similar argument can be
used to explain why unlike poles attract. Activity 16.2
is an alternative model to explain magnetic attraction
and repulsion.
299
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 16.2
KEY WORDS
An imaginary model to explain magnetic
electromagnet: a coil of wire that acts as a
magnet when an electric current passes through it
attraction and repulsion
Sometimes it helps to have an imaginary model to
understand the physics which causes something to
happen, for example, to understand the physics in
magnetic attraction.
Imagine that magnetic field lines are like stretched
elastic bands that want to pull the two ends closer
together. Imagine also that there is pressure
between the field lines pushing them apart and
that, the closer the lines, the bigger this pressure is.
Sketch the field lines between and around:
•
•
a pair of like poles
a pair of unlike poles.
Use this imaginary model to explain the attraction
and repulsion.
If you can visualise what is happening it should
help you to remember how to sketch the patterns.
REFLECTION
solenoid: an electromagnet made by passing a
current through a coil of wire
You can see that the magnetic field around a solenoid
(Figure 16.11) is similar to that around a bar magnet
(Figure 16.8). One end of the coil is a north pole, and
the other end is a south pole. In Figure 16.11, the
field lines emerge from the left-hand end, so this is the
north pole.
There is no way to change the strength of a permanent
magnet, but there are three ways to increase the strength
of an electromagnet:
• Increase the current flowing through it: the greater
the current, the greater the strength of the field.
• Increase the number of turns of wir^on the
coil: this does not mean making the foil longer,
but packing more turns into the same space to
concentrate the field.
• Add a soft iron core: an iron core becomes strongly
magnetised by the field, and this makes the whole
magnetic field much stronger.
Models are an important tool in physics.
•
Did Activity 1 6.2 help you to visualise what
is going on when magnets and magnetised
objects attract and repel?
•
Did it help you to remember how to sketch
the field patterns?
•
Can you suggest a better model?
Electromagnets
Using magnetic materials is only one way of making
a magnet. An alternative method is to use an
electromagnet. A typical electromagnet is made from a
coil of copper wire. A coil like this is sometimes called a
solenoid. When a current flows through the wire, there is
a magnetic field around the coil (Figure 16.11). Copper
wire is often used, because of its low resistance, though
other metals will do. The coil does not have to be made
from a magnetic material. The point is that it is the
electric current that produces the magnetic field.
300
>
Figure 16.11: A solenoid. When a current flows through
the wire, a magnetic field is produced. The field is similar in
shape to that of a bar magnet. Note that the field lines go all
the way through the centre of the coil.
16
Electromagnets have the great advantage that they can
be switched on and off. Simply switch off the current
and the field around the coil disappears. This is the
basis of a number of applications. For example, the
electromagnetic cranes that move large pieces of metal
and piles of scrap around in a scrapyard (Figure 16.12).
The current is switched on to start the magnet and pick
up the scrap metal. When it has been moved to the
correct position, the electromagnet is switched off and
the metal is released.
Electromagnets are also used in electric doorbells,
loudspeakers, electric motors, relays and transformers.
These uses are described in detail later in Chapters 20
and 21.
Magnetism
ACTIVITY 16.3
How does the strength of an electromagnet
depend on the number of turns?
Arun investigated how the strength of an
electromagnet varies with the number of turns.
Figure 16.13 shows the equipment he put
together, and Table 16.3 shows the data he
collected.
Arun made sure that the pole at the bottom of
the electromagnet was the same as the top of the
permanent magnet so that they would repel.
with magnet on top
Figure 16.13: Apparatus for investigating the strength
of an electromagnet.
Figure 16.1 2: Using an electromagnet in a scrapyard. With
the current switched on, a steel object or pile of scrap can
be lifted and moved. Then the current is switched off to
release it.
Questions
7
a
b
c
Name three ways to increase the strength of an
electromagnet.
What are the advantages of an electromagnet
over a bar magnet.
What does an electromagnet need that a
permanent magnet does not?
Number of turns
Mass / g
6
0.21
8
0.29
10
0.34
12
0.38
14
0.43
16
0.47
18
0.54
20
0.59
Table 16.3: Experimental data
301
y
I
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 16.1
1
Plot a graph of mass against the number
of turns.
Which magnetic pole sits below the
geographical North Pole?
2
The mass of the permanent magnet is not
changing, so what is causing the apparent
change in mass?
3
What does the graph tell Arun about the
strength of the electromagnet as the number
of turns increases?
The red end of a compass needle points towards
the North Pole of the Earth. If you look on the
Internet, it is not clear whether the magnetic pole
near the geographical North Pole is magnetic
north or magnetic south. Therefore, you need to
work out whether the red end of a compass needle
is a north or south magnetic pole.
4
Why is it important that the electromagnet
and permanent magnet are repelling (and
not attracting)? How could Arun have
checked this before collecting data?
5
How else could Arun increase the strength of
the electromagnet?
The field around a solenoid
When an electric current flows through a solenoid, a
magnetic field is produced both inside and outside the
coil (see Figure 16.11). The magnetic field inside an
electromagnet is uniform. This means that the field
lines are parallel and the same distance apart. The field
around the outside of a solenoid is similar to that around
a bar magnet:
You need to ensure you know which way
conventional current is flowing (from the positive
to the negative of a battery or power pack).
You will need:
• electromagnet
• compass.
Method
1
Look along the electromagnet fnpm
either end.
If conventional current is flowing clockwise
around the end loop, you are looking at the
south pole like the arrows on ihe S (as shown
in Figure 16.14a).
•
One end of the solenoid is the north pole and the
other end is the south pole. Field lines emerge from
the north pole and go in to the south pole.
If conventional current is running
anticlockwise, like the arrows on the N (Figure
16.14b), you are looking at the north pole.
•
The field lines are closest together at the poles,
showing that this is where the magnetic field is
strongest.
•
The lines spread out from the poles, showing that
the field is weaker in these regions.
The magnetic poles in Figure 16.1 1 are drawn
correctly. Imagine standing at the left-hand
end of the electromagnet looking along it,
as if you were looking down a long tunnel.
Conventional current would be flowing
anticlockwise, telling you that you were at the
north pole.
The strength of the field can be increased by increasing
the current. The field can be reversed by reversing the
direction of the current.
a
Question
8
a
b
302
y
Sketch a diagram of the magnetic field pattern
around a solenoid.
How would the pattern change when the
current through the solenoid is reversed?
Figure 16.14
b
16
CONTINUED
2
Bring your compass towards either pole of
the electromagnet. Use your observations to
decide whether the red end of your compass
needle is north or south. Use this information
to decide which magnetic pole sits below the
geographical North Pole.
Magnetism
KEY WORDS
conventional current: the direction positive
charges would flow in a complete circuit, from
the positive to negative terminals of a cell, and
opposite to the direction that electrons flow
PROJECT
Read this newspaper extract.
I'
COMPASS CONFUSION: HIKER
ALMOST KILLED BY HIS COMPASS
is
nexperienced hiker from the USA
who became lost in the Australian
Outback was rescued by the police last
week. He complained, ‘my compass
stopped working’. A spokesman for
the Western Australia Police Force was
A
You are a science journalist whose job it is to explain
the science behind this story. You can decide
whether you write an article, write a script for a
television news item or produce a podcast.
Remember that your audience are not scientists.
Sometimes explaining a problem needs ideas from
two or more topics, as is the case here. You will need
to explain why magnetic compasses stop working
when used in the opposite hemisphere (for example,
a compass designed for the northern hemisphere
will not work in the southern hemisphere). You need
to use diagrams or video clips to help your audience
follow your explanation.
When using a compass, you should hold it flat (that
is, parallel to the ground). The compass needle
(sometimes called the card) should be parallel to
the baseplate of the compass (when viewed from
quoted as saying, ‘this gentleman
lucky to be alive. The hiker was using
a compass designed for use in the USA
and had not realised until it was too
late that he needed to buy a compass
here in Australia.’
the side) and needs to be able to swing clockwise
or anticlockwise when viewed from above. However,
you should recall that a compass needle lines up with
the magnetic field lines, which are not parallel to the
ground in Australia.
You will need to explain why the magnetic field lines
are not parallel to the ground in Australia. You need
to sketch what the compass needle looks like when
viewed from the side. It looks like a tiny see-saw
balanced on a tiny pillar at its mid-point (look back
at Chapter 4 if necessary). Use the principle of
moments and the idea of equilibrium to explain how
a compass needle is made to be parallel to the base
plate (and the ground). Then explain why this is a
particular problem when a compass designed for one
hemisphere is taken and used in the other.
303
y
> CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
1
SUMMARY
Magnets have a north pole and a south pole.
Magnetic field lines are drawn with an arrow from north to south, which is the direction of the magnetic force.
Like poles repel and unlike poles attract.
Magnetic elements include iron, cobalt and nickel. Metal alloys (for example, steel) containing these elements
are also magnetic.
Magnetic materials can be magnetised while non-magnetic materials (like rubber and glass) cannot be magnetised.
A permanent magnet can attract unmagnetised magnetic materials by inducing magnetism in them.
A hard magnetic material like steel is difficult to magnetise and demagnetise.
A soft magnetic material like soft iron is easy to magnetise and demagnetise.
A magnetic field is a region of space around a magnet or electric current in which a magnet will feel a force.
A magnetic field pattern around a (bar) magnet can be produced using a plotting compass.
A magnetic field line is the line (direction) of force on the north pole of the magnet, which is why a magnet (for
example, a compass needle) lines up with it.
An electromagnet (or solenoid) is a magnet created when a current is passed through wire, which is usually
shaped into a coil.
The strength of an electromagnet increases with the number of turns in the coil, the strength of the current and
if it has a soft iron core.
The advantages of an electromagnet over a permanent magnet are that its strength can be changed, it can be
switched on and off and it can be reversed.
The magnetic forces of attraction and repulsion between magnets are caused when their magnetic fields interact
(affect each other) and produce a new pattern of magnetic lines of force.
——
The closer together magnetic field lines are to each other, the stronger the magnetic field.
•••
'
"
l"
J
’
1
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Some metals and alloys are magnetic. Which of these is magnetic?
A aluminium
B copper
C gold
D steel
304
>
[1]
— —-— —
16 Magnetism
COMMAND WORD
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
a Which pole is at X?
b If the magnets are released, in which direction will they move?
[1]
[1]
[Total: 2]
6 Karamveer investigated how the strength of an electromagnet varied with
current. He used an arrangement like the one in the diagram. He passed a
current through an electromagnet so that it attracted a small steel plate. For
each current he passed through the coil, he suspended more masses from the
bottom of the steel plate until the steel was pulled away from the electromagnet.
Current / A
Force / N
0
0.00
2
0.60
4
1.20
6
1.90
8
2.40
10
3.00
COMMAND WORDS
a Plot a graph of force against current.
[3]
b State how the strength of the electromagnet varies with the current
passing through the coil.
[11
c State two other ways that the strength of an electromagnet can be
[2]
increased.
d An electromagnet can be switched on and off. Suggest one situation
where this would be an advantage over the constant field of a
permanent magnet.
[1]
e In terms of forces, state why the steel plate falls from the electromagnet
once the suspended masses exceed a certain value.
[1 ]
[Total: 8]
306
y
state: express in
clear terms
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations where
there are a range
of valid responses
in order to make
proposals/put forward
considerations
Magnetism
16
CONTINUED
7 a What is the difference between a magnetically soft and a magnetically
hard material?
b Give an example of a magnetically hard material and suggest where it
might be used.
c Give an example of a magnetically soft material and suggest where it
might be used.
[11
[11
HI
COMMAND WORD
give: produce an
answer from a given
source or recall/
memory
[Total: 3]
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
Recall the names of the two poles of a magnet.
Recall the direction that the arrows on a field line
should point.
Recall what happens between like poles and unlike
poles.
Identify common magnetic materials.
Recall the difference between magnetic and
non-magnetic materials.
Account for induced magnetism.
Recall examples of hard and soft magnetic materials
and the difference between them.
Draw the pattern of magnetic field lines around a
bar magnet and describe an experiment to plot them,
including the direction arrows.
Recall why a compass needle or other permanent
magnet lines up with the field lines when it is placed
in a magnetic field.
Describe electromagnets (and solenoids).
Describe the three ways in which the strength of an
electromagnet can be changed.
Describe the advantages of an electromagnet over a
permanent magnet.
Explain that magnetic forces are due to interactions
between magnetic fields.
Use the spacing of the field lines to work out the
relative strength of the magnetic field.
See
Needs
Topic...
16.1
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
16.2
16.2
16.1
16.1
16.2
16.1
16.2
16.2
16.2
16.2
16.2
16.2
16.2
V
> Chapter 17
Static
electricity
17
Static electricity
GETTING STARTED
In a small group, discuss what you know about
electricity. Organise your ideas into a mind map.
Include as many of the following words as possible,
giving definitions and examples wherever you can:
electron, charge, current, static, shock, voltage,
One member of the group should now stay with
the map to explain it to other groups. The rest of
the group should visit the maps of different groups.
Having done this, return to your own group and add
any additional information to your map.
conductor, insulator.
A SHOCKING PHENOMENON
The US scientist Benjamin Franklin was lucky to
survive his experiments into this kind of electricity.
He suspected lightning was a form of electricity due
to the similarity between a lightning flash and the
sparks he produced in his laboratory. To investigate
he flew a kite into a thundercloud. To avoid being
electrocuted, he included a metal key at the bottom
of the kite string, and attached a length of ribbon to
the key. Holding the ribbon, he was relatively safe
from electrocution (although other people were
killed when they repeated his experiment). As a bolt
of lightning struck the kite, Franklin saw the fibres of
the kite string stand on end and a spark jumped from
the key to the ground.
Franklin's method was hazardous, and by flying
a kite into the cloud, he may have brought on a
lightning flash and thereby affected the situation
he was investigating. Sunil Gupta and the team
who measured the potential difference in the Ooty
storm used a rather different method. They studied
muons - a type of subatomic particle - as they
passed through the storm cloud. The muons gained
energy from the potential difference in the cloud,
increasing the number which reached the scientists'
muon sensors. This allowed the team to calculate the
potential difference within the cloud.
Figure 17.1a: Lightning and electrical sparks are both
Discussion questions
caused by a large build-up of electric charge, b: electrical
hazard symbol
1
The similarity between lightning bolts and the sign
used for electrical hazards is not a coincidence.
A large build-up of electrical charge can cause the
air to breakdown and conduct electricity, potentially
delivering a fatal electric shock. In December 2014, a
potential difference of 1.3 billion volts was recorded
during a thunderstorm over Ooty in Southern India.
Franklin made important discoveries about
static electricity, but his experiment would be
considered too dangerous to be carried out
now. Should scientists be allowed to conduct
hazardous investigations?
2
Gupta's observations did not affect the
situation he was studying. Why this is an
important feature of scientific research?
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
17.1 Charging and
discharging
We experience static electricity in a number of ways in
everyday life, including lightning flashes. You may have
noticed tiny sparks when you take off clothes made of
synthetic fibres. You may have felt a small shock when
getting out of a car. An electrostatic charge builds up on the
car and then discharges through you when you touch the
metal door. You may have rubbed a balloon on your clothes
or hair and seen how it will stick to a wall or ceiling.
The two types of static electricity are referred to as
positive charge and negative charge. We can explain the
experiments shown in Figure 17.3 by saying that the
process of rubbing gives the rods one type of electric
charge (say, negative), while the cloth is given the
opposite type (say, positive). Figures 17.3c and 17.3d
show the two experiments with the charges marked.
KEY WORDS
static electricity: electric charge held by a
charged insulator
electrostatic charge: a property of an object
that causes it to attract or repel other objects
with charge
When you rub a plastic object (for example, a balloon)
with a cloth, both are likely to become electrically
charged. You can tell that this is so by holding the
balloon or the cloth close to your hair - they attract
the hair.
positive charge: the type of electric charge
carried in the nucleus of an atom
negative charge: the type of electric charge
carried by electrons
From these experiments, we can also say something
about the forces that electric charges ex^rt on each other:
• Two positive charges will repel each other.
•
•
Two negative charges will repel each other.
A positive charge and a negative charge attract
each other.
Figure 17.2: Objects which have electrostatic charge can
attract light objects such as hair or paper.
You have observed that static electricity is generated by
friction. You have also observed that a charged object
may attract uncharged objects.
Now we have to think systematically about how to
investigate this phenomenon. First, how do two charged
objects affect one another? Figure 17.3 shows one way
of investigating this. A plastic rod is rubbed with a cloth
so that both become charged. The rod is hung in a cradle
so that it is free to move. When the cloth is brought close
to it, the rod moves towards the cloth (Figure 17.3a).
When a second rod is rubbed in the same way and
brought close to the first one, the hanging rod moves away
(Figure 17.3b). Now we have seen both attraction and
repulsion. This suggests that there are two types of static
electricity. Both rods have been treated in the same way,
so we expect them to have the same type of electricity.
The cloth and the rod must have different types.
310
y
Figure 17.3: Two experiments to show the existence of
two, opposite, types of static electricity, a: The charged
rod and cloth attract one another, b: The two charged
rods repel one another, c: The rod and the cloth have
opposite electric charges, d: The two rods have the same
type of electric charge.
17 Static electricity
You can see that this rule is similar to the rule we saw
for magnetic poles in Chapter 16. But do not confuse
magnetism with static electricity! Magnetism arises from
magnetic poles - static electricity arises from electric
charges. When you rub a plastic rod, you are not making
it magnetic.
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 17.1
Investigating static electricity
In this experiment you will find out about static
electricity by charging materials and observing
how they behave.
Questions
Copy and complete these sentences.
There are two types of charge called
Two objects with the same charge will
two objects with opposite charges will
You will need:
polythene and acetate or glass rods
and
cloths of different materials
paper stirrups with fine thread
and
clamp and stand
watch glass
Figure 17.4 shows a child’s hair standing on end
after the child has been on a trampoline.
balloons
tiny pieces of thin paper.
Getting started
Investigate how much you need to rub the rods in
order to charge them. Test this by using the rod to
pick up little pieces of paper.
Figure 17.4
b
How does bouncing on the trampoline cause
the child’s hair to become charged?
The individual hairs are repelling each other.
What does this tell you?
Explain why, after walking on a nylon carpet, you
may get a small shock when you touch a metal
door handle.
Figure 17.5: Set-up for investigation.
Method
1
You need to be sure that you can place the
rods so that they can turn freely, either by
hanging them in the paper stirrup, or by
placing them on an upturned watch glass.
Try this out with your rods.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
2
Rub a polythene rod with a woollen cloth,
making sure that you rub the full length of
the rod. Hang the rod or place it on a watch
glass.
3
Rub another polythene rod and bring one
end close to an end of the first rod. Do they
In the discussion that follows, we will talk about
electrons. They make it much easier to understand what
is going on in all aspects of electricity.
attract or repel?
4
Rub an acetate or glass rod and repeat the
test. What do you observe?
5
Try different combinations of rods. Try a cloth
of a different fabric. Given that a polythene
rod, rubbed with a woollen cloth, gains a
negative charge, what can you say about the
charges gained by the cloth and by the other
rods?
6
Blow up a balloon and rub it. Can you
determine whether it gains positive or
negative charge? (Hint: polythene becomes
negative and acetate becomes positive.)
Questions
1
2
Some students investigate polythene and
acetate rods. They find that the two rods
attract each other. One student says this
proves that the rods have opposite charge.
Explain why the student is wrong.
Describe what the students would need
to do in order to prove that the rods have
opposite charges.
17.2 Explaining static
electricity
The Ancient Greeks knew something about static
electricity. Amber is a form of resin from trees, which
hardens and becomes fossilised. It looks like clear,
orange plastic. The Greeks knew that, when rubbed,
amber could attract small pieces of cloth or hair.
Like the Ancient Greeks, Franklin had no idea about
electrons - these particles were not discovered until 100
years later. However, that did not stop Franklin from
developing a good understanding of static electricity.
312
>
Figure 17.6: An insect trapped in resin as ’it hardened.
Resin is a good insulator and easily becomes electrostatically
charged.
J
i
Friction and charging
It is the force of friction that causes charging. When a
plastic rod is rubbed on a cloth, friction transfers tiny
particles called electrons fpom one material to the other.
When the rod is made of polythene, usually electrons are
transferred from the cloth to the rod.
Electrons are a part of every atom. They are negatively
charged, and they are found on the outside of the atom.
The nucleus in the centre of the atom has a positive
charge. The positive and negative charges in an atom are
equal so overall an atom has no electric charge - we say
that it is neutral. Since the outer electrons are relatively
weakly held in the atom, they can be pulled away by the
force of friction. When an atom has lost an electron, it
becomes positively charged.
KEY WORD
neutral: having no overall positive or negative
charge
17
Static electricity
Charging is always the result of gaining or losing
electrons. Positive charge is not transferred.
An object which gains electrons becomes negative.
An object which loses electrons becomes positive.
So why can charge move through conductors but not
through insulators? In insulators, the electrons are tightly
bound to their atoms and not easily removed. In conductors
some of the electrons are free to move between atoms (these
electrons are sometimes referred to as free electrons).
Since a polythene rod becomes negatively charged when
it is rubbed with a cloth, we can imagine electrons being
transferred from the cloth to the rod (see Figure 17.8).
It is difficult to explain why one material pulls electrons
from another. The atoms that make up polythene contain
positive charges, and these must attract electrons more
strongly than those of the cloth.
When you rub a polythene rod, it gains electrons from
the cloth and so becomes negatively charged. The
electrons cannot move through the polythene, so the end
which was rubbed remains charged.
Remember that it takes two different materials to
generate static electricity. One material becomes positive,
the other negative.
Conductors and insulators
When a copper rod is rubbed, electrons are also transferred
by friction, but these electrons are free to move, so they flow
through the rod, through your hand and into the Earth.
This means the copper rod does not become charged.
A metal object can be charged if it is held by an
insulating handle. In this case the charge will spread
evenly through the conductor.
KEY WORDS
You may have noticed that all the examples of objects
becoming charged involve non-metals. Metals are
electrical conductors, which means electrons can move
through them and the metal doesn’t stay charged. Gold
and copper are particularly good electrical conductors.
Non-metals, such as glass, plastic and amber are
electrical insulators.
electrical conductor: a substance that allows the
flow of electrons (electric current)
electrical insulator: a substance that inhibits the
flow of electrons (electric current)
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 17.2
Investigating conductors and insulators
In this experiment you will find test materials to find
out which are conductors and which are insulators.
You will need:
•
•
•
•
cell
lamp
wires with crocodile clips
Figure 17.7: Circuit for testing materials.
materials to test.
Getting started
Connect the cell and lamp in a simple circuit to make
the lamp light.
Make a gap in the circuit by removing a wire. Explain
why the lamp no longer lights and consider how
placing materials in the gap will help you decide if
they are conductors or insulators.
Method
Connect the circuit as shown in Figure 17.7.
2
Using the crocodile clips, attach a material into
the gap in the circuit.
3
Observe whether the lamp lights. If it does, it is
a conductor, if not it is an insulator.
4
Record your results in a table.
Question
The wires you used are made of copper covered
in plastic. Explain why these materials were
chosen.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
REFLECTION
Which part of Activity 17.1 did you find most
useful? Summarising, condensing or sharing?
Consider how this might help you when revising
for a test.
17.3 Electric fields
Figure 17.8: When a polythene rod is rubbed with a cloth,
electrons are transferred from the cloth to the polythene.
The rod now has an overall negative charge and the cloth
has an overall negative charge.
Questions
4
Copy and complete these sentences.
move from
When a polythene rod is rubbed,
.
to the
the
and the cloth
This means the rod becomes
.
becomes
5
a
b
Draw a diagram similar to Figure 17.8 to show
how an acetate rod becomes positively charged
by losing electrons.
Write sentences similar to those you completed
in question 1 7.4 to explain how the acetate
becomes charged.
When you hold a polythene rod and rub it with
a cloth, it becomes charged. If the rod is made
of metal, it will not become charged. Explain
this difference by describing what happens to the
electrons in each case.
6
ACTIVITY 17.1: WHAT HAVE I LEARNT?
Take two minutes to summarise what you have
learnt so far in this chapter on one sheet of paper.
Now, take two more minutes to condense your
notes. You may use ten words and four diagrams.
Compare summaries with a partner. Assume that
you can use only four words and one diagram as a
reminder in a test. Which diagram and four words
would you choose?
314
y
Figure 17.9: The comb has been charged by rubbing it.
It attracts the water when it is held close to the water.
A charged object can affect other objects, both charged
and uncharged, without actually touching them. For
example, a charged plastic rod can exert a force on
another charged rod placed close by.
We say that there is an electric field around a charged
object. Any charged object placed in the field will
experience a force on it.
KEY WORDS
electric field: a region of space in which an
electric charge will experience a force
17 Static electricity
There are similarities between electric fields and magnetic
fields, but take care not to confuse electric fields with
magnetic fields. A magnet does not attract electric
charges. A charged object does not attract a magnet.
Representing an electric field
A charged object is surrounded by an electric field. If a
charged object moves into the electric field of a charged
object, it will experience a force - it will be attracted
or repelled. Figure 17.10 shows how we represent an
electric field by lines of force (or electric field lines). This
is similar to the way we represent a magnetic field by
magnetic field lines.
The lines of force are shown coming out of a positive
charge and going in to a negative charge. This is because
the lines indicate the direction of the force on a positive
charge placed in the field. A positive charge is repelled by
another positive charge and attracted by a negative charge.
Figure 17.10c shows the field between two oppositely
charged parallel plates. The lines of force between the
plates are straight and parallel to one another (except at
the edges).
What is electric charge?
In physics, we find it relatively easy to answer questions
such as ‘What is a rainbow?’ or ‘How does an aircraft
fly?’ It is much harder to answer an apparently simple
question like ‘What is electric charge?’. As with energy,
we have to answer it by explaining how objects behave
when they have it (energy or charge).
Objects with the same sign of charge repel one another.
Objects with opposite charges attract. This is not a very
satisfying answer, because magnetic poles behave in the
same way: north poles repel north poles and attract
south poles. Because electric charge is a fundamental
property of matter, we have to get a feel for it, rather
than having a clear definition.
The electric force between two charged objects is one of
the fundamental forces of nature. (The force of gravity
between two masses is another fundamental force.) The
electric force holds together the particles that make up
an atom. It holds atoms together to make molecules, and
it holds molecules together to make solid objects. Just
think: whenever you stand on the floor, it is the electric
force between molecules that prevents you from falling
through the floor. It is a very important force.
Charged particles
We have already seen that electrons are the charged
particles that are transferred from one object to another
when they are rubbed together. Electric charge is a
property of the particles that make up atoms.
Charge is measured in coulombs (C), named after
Charles-Augustin de Coulomb, a French physicist. He
discovered that the force between two charged objects
depends on how big their charges are and on how far
apart they are.
Figure 17.1 0: The electric field around a charged object is
represented by lines of force, a: An isolated positive charge,
b: A negatively charged sphere, c: Two parallel plates with
opposite charges.
Question
7
Draw the magnetic field around:
an isolated negative charge
b two vertical metal plates - one positive and the
other negative.
a
An electron is a negatively charged particle. It is much
smaller than an atom, and only weakly attached to the
outside of the atom. It is held there by the attraction of
the positively charged nucleus of the atom. The nucleus
is positively charged because it contains positively
charged particles called protons.
An electron has a very tiny amount of electric charge.
The electron charge is so small that it takes more than
6 million million million electrons to make 1 C of charge:
electron charge = -0.000000000000000000 16 C
or -1.6 x 1O-19C
A proton has exactly the same size of charge as an
electron, but positive, so the proton charge is:
proton charge = +0.000 000 000 000 000 000 16 C
or +1.6 x W-19C
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
—
No-one knows why these values urc exactly the same
size (or even if they are exactly the same size), but it is
fortunate that they are because it means that an atom that
contains, say, six protons and six electrons is electrically
neutral. If all the objects around us were made of charged
atoms, we would live in a shocking world!
proton: a positively charged particle found in the
atomic nucleus
Question
electron charge: the electric charge of a single
electron = -1.6 x 10“19C
KEY WORDS
coulomb (C): the SI unit for electric charge
Calculate the number of electrons needed to give a
charge of one coulomb.
8
proton charge: the electric charge of a single
proton = +1.6 x W19C
PROJECT
Shocking shopping
Figure 17.11: A carpet in a shop can caus.e a shock.
Walking across a carpet can cause friction, which
leads to people becoming electrostatically charged.
Touching another person, or a conducting object
such as a metal stair bannister, can cause a shock as
the charge flows through to earth, discharging the
person. These shocks are not usually dangerous but
can be uncomfortable.
A manager of a large store has received a lot of
complaints from customers who are experiencing
painful shocks as they shop. The manager thinks it
may be due to the carpet on the shop floor which is
made of a hard-wearing material called polypropylene.
The store manager wants to investigate whether she
should invest in a new carpet that is les^ 'likely to create
static. Until she does this, she wants to be able to
advise customers on how to avoid shocks.
Your tasks as her scientific consultant are:
1 Explain what is happening. As an Interim measure,
she would like leaflets to give to shoppers to help
them understand what is happening and what
they can do to minimise shocks. Could customers
discharge regularly before top much charge builds
up? Or would it help if they picked up their feet
2
3
rather than shuffling?
Design the leaflet. It must have no more than
50 words and it should be illustrated.
Consider how new carpets could be tested to
find out which create the most static. Testing by
shocking people is not easy or ethical. Instead you
should look at charging the carpets by friction and
investigating the force of attraction or repulsion
they produce. You will need to give step-by-step
instructions for a fair test investigation.
PEER ASSESSMENT
Exchange leaflets and investigation plans with another student. Give them written feedback by answering the
following points:
• Does the leaflet make it clear how charging happens?
• Does the leaflet give clear advice on avoiding shocks?
• Will the investigation provide valid data?
• Does the plan control all variables in order to give a fair test?
316
y
17 Static electricity
SUMMARY
There are two types of charge: positive and negative.
Like charges repel, opposite charges attract.
Conductors allow charge to flow. Insulators do not allow charge to flow.
Insulators can be charged by friction, which causes the loss or gain of electrons.
An electric field is the area around a charged object in which a charge will experience a force.
Electric fields can be represented by field lines which show the direction of the force on a positive charge.
Insulators are materials in which electrons are fixed in place. Conductors have free electrons.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which of these describes how an object becomes positively charged?
A It gains positive charge.
B It loses positive charge.
C It gains negative charge.
D It loses negative charge.
[1 ]
2 When an object is charged by friction, which particle is transferred?
A proton
B electron
C neutron
D atom
[1 ]
3 A positively charged rod is suspended so it can move freely. A negatively
[1 ]
charged rod is brought close to it. What will happen to the positive rod?
A It will repel.
B Nothing will happen.
C It isn’t possible to predict what will happen from the information given.
D It will attract.
4 What does the arrow on an electric field line show?
A The force on a positive charge.
B The force on a neutral particle.
C The force on an electron.
D The force on a negative particle.
[1 ]
317
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
5 A student investigates charging polythene by friction. She takes two identical
strips and rubs each with a cloth. She holds the two strips together and they
move apart.
[2]
a Explain why the strips move apart
COMMAND WORDS
The student repeats the experiment using two strips of aluminium.
b State and explain what the student would see with the aluminium strips. [2]
c A plastic rod is charged by rubbing it with a cloth.
A The cloth becomes negatively charged because electrons transfer
from the cloth to the rod
B The cloth becomes positively charged because electrons transfer
from the cloth to the rod
C The cloth becomes negatively charged because protons transfer
from the rod to the cloth
D The cloth becomes positively charged because protons transfer
from the rod to the cloth.
6 A student combs his hair with a plastic comb. The comb becomes negatively
charged.
a Explain how this happens.
b Name the particles which are transferred.
c The student notices his hair is now standing on end. Explain why this
happens to his hair.
[2]
[1]
[2]
[Total: 5]
>
state: express in
clear terms
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why1and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
Which statement described what has happened to the cloth?
318
>
17 Static electricity
CONTINUED
COMMAND WORD
Define the term ‘electric field'.
[1]
Copy these diagrams and draw the electric field around the charged
objects:
[6]
a positively
charged
sphere
a negatively
charged
sphere
positively and negatively
charged plates
[Total: 7]
A student rubs a balloon so that it becomes positively charged. He places the
balloon on top of an insulating sheet on an electronic balance.
insulator
Explain, in terms of movement of electrons, how the balloon becomes
[2]
positively charged.
The student now brings a charged plastic rod close to the balloon.
The reading on the balance increases to 11.63 g. State and explain
[2]
what this tells you about the plastic rod.
experiment,
The student repeats the
but this time he places the balloon
directly on to the metal pan of the balance. This time when he brings the
charged rod close to the balloon, the reading on the scale decreases to
[3]
6.94 g. Explain why.
[Total: 7
define: give precise
meaning
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
9 A painter is spray painting a metal fence. The nozzle of the sprayer is
negatively charged.
a State and explain what happens to the paint droplets as they pass
[2]
through the nozzle.
b Describe two ways in which this makes the spray painting more efficient. [2]
c What charge should be given to the fence to make the process even
[1]
more efficient?
[Total: 7]
COMMAND WORD
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
Name the two types of charge.
Say how objects with identical or opposite charges
affect each other.
Describe experiments to show how charges can be
produced and detected.
Explain how charging by friction happens by
describing what happens to the electrons.
Define and give examples of conductors and insulators.
See
Topic...
17.1
17.1
17.2
17.2
17.2
Name the unit of electrical charge.
17.3
Define what is meant by an electric field.
17.3
Draw the field between two charged plates or around
a point charge of a charged sphere, using arrows to
show the direction of the field.
Describe the difference between conductors and
insulators in terms of a simple electron model.
17.3
17.3
Needs
more work
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
> Chapter 18
Electrical
quantities
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
learn about electric current, resistance and voltage
describe an experiment to determine resistance using ammeters and voltmeters
learn how the resistance of a wire relates to its length and diameter
understand that energy is transferred from the power source (for example, a battery) to the circuit
components
calculate resistance, electrical power, energy and the cost of electrical energy
learn that electrons flow in the opposite direction to conventional current
sketch and explain current-voltage characteristics
calculate electric current and potential difference.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
Does anything get used up going around a circuit?
What do batteries and cells have that gets used up?
Do you know what happens when we charge a
mobile (cell) phone?
Why can birds stand on power lines without being
electrocuted?
INSPIRED BY AN EEL? USING PHYSICS FOR LAW ENFORCEMENT
Jean Richer, a French astronomer, met an electric
eel (Figure 18.1) during an expedition to the
Amazon basin in 1671. He described it as being 'as
fat as a leg' and it made his arm go numb for 1 5
minutes after he touched it with his finger. About
80% of an electric eel is basically a battery, with a
positive terminal at its head and a negative terminal
at its tail. The charge is carried by positive ions
instead of electrons. It has about 5000 to 6000
stacked plates (called electroplaques). Each pair
of plates is like an electric cell that can produce a
voltage of about 0.15 V so that an eel can deliver a
shock of 900 V and a current of up to 1 A. To save
energy it can send out low voltage pulses (75 V).
This makes the muscles of potential prey twitch,
which can be detected by the eel. If it detects prey,
the eel can send out bigger shocks when it wants
to stun its victim. Some eels were taken back to be
studied in Europe where they inspired the work of
Italian scientists. Luigi Galvini used frogs to show
that electricity made their legs move. Alessandro
Volta invented the first battery based on the
electric eel.
NASA researcher Jack Cover finished developing
the TASER in 1974. He named it after the book
Tom Swift and His Electric Rifle. TASERs are used
by law enforcement officers to subdue suspected
criminals without using lethal force (Figure 18.2).
The TASER fires two thin insulated copper wires at
the target. Once the barbs at the end of the wires
hook into the skin, the person becomes part of the
circuit. When a current is passed through the circuit,
the person loses control of their musclfes, like the
victims of the electric eel.
Figure 1 8.2: Even without the cartridge that sends the
copper wires to its target, a TASER still passes an electrical
charge.
Discussion questions
Figure 18.1: An electric eel.
322
)
1
Describe how an electric eel is like a battery.
2
A TASER is like an electric eel but why does the
eel not need the wires used in a TASER?
18 Electrical quantities
18.1 Current in electric
a
circuits
We use electric circuits to transfer energy from a battery
or power supply to components in the circuit, which then
transfer the energy to their surroundings. For an electric
current to flow, two things are needed: a complete circuit
for it to flow around, and something to ‘push’ it around
the circuit. The push might be provided by a cell, battery
or power supply. A battery is simply two or more cells
connected end-to-end. In most familiar circuits, metals
such as copper or steel provide the circuit for the current
to flow around.
Figure 18.3a shows how a simple circuit can be set up
in the laboratory. Once the switch is closed, there is a
continuous metal path for the current to flow along.
Current flows from the positive terminal of the battery
(or cell). In the circuit symbol for a cell, the longer line
represents the positive terminal (see Figure 18.3b).
Current flows through the switch and the filament lamp,
back to the negative terminal of the battery. A current
that flows in the same direction all the time is called
direct current (d.c.). You will meet alternating current
(a.c.) in Chapter 21 when you learn about transformers.
Alternating current is when current reverses direction.
In many countries, mains electricity has a frequency of
50 Hz so it changes direction 100 times per second.
KEY WORDS
current: the rate at which electric charge passes a
point in a circuit
cell: a device that provides an electromotive force
(e.m.f.) in a circuit by means of a chemical reaction
battery: two or more electrical cells connected
together in series
direct current (d.c.): electric current that flows in
the same direction all the time
alternating current (a.c.): electric current that
(periodically) changes direction
Figure 18.3b shows the same circuit as represented by a
circuit diagram. Each component has its own standard
symbol. If you imagine the switch being pushed so
that it closes, it is clear from the diagram that there is a
continuous path for the current to flow around the circuit.
b
filament
Figure 1 8.3a: A simple electric circuit, set up in a laboratory,
b: The same circuit represented as a circuit diagram.
It is obvious how the switch in Figure 18.3a works.
You push the springy metal downwards until it touches
the other metal contact. Then the current can flow
through it. Most switches work by bringing two pieces
of metal into contact with one another, though you
cannot usually see this happening. It is worth having
a look inside some switches to see how they work. (Of
course, they must not be connected in a circuit when you
examine them!)
Similarly, take a look at some filament lamps, like the
one in Figure 18.3a. Every lamp has two metal contacts,
for the current to flow in and out. Inside, one fine wire
carries the current up to the filament (which is another
wire), and a second wire carries the current back down
again. Notice also how the circuit symbols for these and
many other components have two connections for joining
them into a circuit.
Good conductors
bad conductors
The wires we use to connect up circuits are made of
metal because metals are good conductors of electric
current. The metal is usually surrounded by plastic, so
that, if two wires touch, the electric current cannot pass
directly from one to another (causing a short circuit).
Plastics (polymers) are good electrical insulators.
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
•
Most metals, including copper, silver, gold and steel
are good conductors.
Polymers (such as Perspex® or polythene), minerals
and glass are good insulators.
•
Measuring electric current
To measure electric current, we use an ammeter. There
are two types, as shown in Figure 18.4.
In between, there are many materials that do conduct
electricity, but not very well. For example, liquids may
conduct, but they are generally poor conductors.
• An analogue meter has a needle, which moves
People can conduct electricity - that is what happens
when you get an electric shock. A current passes through
your body and, if it is big enough, it makes your muscles
contract violently. Your heart may stop, and you may
get burns. Our bodies conduct because the water in our
tissue is quite a good electrical conductor.
•
What is electric current?
When a circuit is complete, an electric current flows.
Current flows from the positive terminal of the supply,
around the circuit, and back to the negative terminal.
What is actually travelling around the circuit? The answer
is electric charge. The battery or power supply in a circuit
provides the push needed to make the current flow. This
push is the same force that causes electric charges to
attract or repel one another.
A current is a flow of electric charge. In a metal, the
current is a flow of electrons. These are the negatively
charged particles you learned about in Chapter 17.
KEY WORDS
conductor: a material that allows an electric
current to flow through it
across a scale. You have to make a judgement of the
position of the needle against the scale.
A digital meter gives a direct read-out in figures.
There is no judgement involved in taking a reading.
A galvanometer is sometimes used instead of an ammeter
when tiny currents need to be measured. It has a different
circuit symbol - an upward pointing arrow to represent
a needle. An ammeter is connected into a circuit in
series, that is, between other components in the circuit.
This circuit is called a series circuit, where components
are connected in a line between other components. If
the meter is connected the wrong way round, it will give
negative readings. To add an ammeter to a circuit, the
circuit must be broken (see Figure 18.5).
In a simple series circuit like the one shoyvn in Figure
18.5, it does not matter where the ammeter is added,
since the current is the same all the way round the series
circuit. It does not get used up as it flows through the
lamp or other components in the circuit.
The reading on an ammeter is in amperes (shortened to
amps (A), which is the SI unit of current. Smaller currents
may be measured in milliamps (mA) or microamps (pA):
1 mA = 0.001 A = IO-3 A
1 pA = 0.000001 A = 10-6 A
insulator: a material that makes it very difficult for
an electrical current to flow through it
charge: carried around a circuit by the current;
negative charge is carried by electrons
Figure 18.4: Ammeters measure electric current, in amps
(A). There are two types: analogue (on the left) and digital
(on the right).
324
>
Figure 1 8.5: Adding an ammeter to a circuit The ammeter
is connected in series so that the current can flow through it.
18 Electrical quantities
KEY WORDS
galvanometer: a meter for measuring tiny electric
current
ammeter: a meter for measuring electric current
ampere, amps (A): the SI unit of electric current
Questions
What instrument is used to measure electric
current?
b How should it be connected in a circuit?
Draw its circuit symbol.
c
A circuit is set up in which a cell makes an electric
current flow through a lamp. Two ammeters are
included, one to measure the current flowing into
the lamp, the other to measure the current flowing
out of the lamp.
Conventional electric current flows from positive to
negative. Figure 18.7 shows the direction of the flow
of charge around a simple circuit. We picture positive
charge flowing out of the positive terminal, around the
circuit and back into the cell at the negative terminal.
Now, we know that in a metal it is the negatively charged
electrons that move. They leave the negative terminal of
the cell, and flow around to the positive terminal, in the
opposite direction to the current. Hence we have two
different pictures of what is going on in a circuit.
a
a
b
Draw a circuit diagram to represent this
circuit.
Add an arrow to show the direction of the
current around the circuit.
What can you say about the readings on the
two ammeters?
Name two materials that are good electrical
conductors.
Name two materials that are good electrical
insulators.
Two pictures: current
and electrons
Metals are good electrical conductors because they
contain electrons that can move about freely. (This has
already been mentioned in Chapters 11 and 17.) The idea
is that, in a bad conductor, such as most polymers, all of
the electrons in the material are tightly bound within the
atoms or molecules, so that they cannot move. Metals
are different. While most of the electrons in a metal are
tightly bound within their atoms, some are free to move
about within the material. These are called conduction
electrons (see Figure 18.6). A voltage, such as that
provided by a battery or power supply, can start these
conduction electrons moving in one direction through
the metal, and an electric current flows. Since electrons
have a negative electric charge, they are attracted to the
positive terminal of the battery.
electron flow
•4
current
current flow
Figure 18.6: In a metal, some electrons are free to move
about. In copper, there is one conduction electron for each
atom of the metal. The atoms, having lost an electron,
are positively charged. A battery pushes the conduction
electrons through the metal. The force is the attraction
between unlike charges that was discussed in Chapter 17.
flow of electrons
flow of conventional
current
Figure 18.7: Two ways of picturing what happens in an
electric circuit: conventional current flows from positive to
negative; electrons flow from negative to positive.
We can think of conventional current, a flow of positive
charge, moving from positive to negative. Conventional
current is rather like a fluid moving through the wires,
just like water moving through pipes. This picture does
not tell us anything about what is going on inside the
wires or components of a circuit. However, it is perfectly
good for working out many things to do with a circuit:
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
what the voltage will be across a particular component,
for example, or how much energy will be transferred to a
particular lamp.
Alternatively, we can think of electron flow as, a
movement of conduction electrons, from negative to
positive. This picture can allow us to think about what is
going on inside the components of a circuit: why a resistor
gets warm when a current flows through it, for example,
or why a diode allows current to flow in one direction only.
These two pictures are both models. The electron flow
picture is a microscopic model, since it tells us what is
going on at the level of very tiny particles (electrons).
The conventional current picture is a macroscopic or
large scale model.
The electrons in a circuit flow in the opposite direction to
the electric current. It is a nuisance to have to remember
this. It stems from the early days of experiments on static
electricity. Benjamin Franklin realised that there were
two types of electric charge, which he called positive and
negative. He had to choose which type he would call
positive. He chose to say that when amber was rubbed
with a silk cloth, the amber acquired a negative charge.
Franklin was setting up a convention, which other
scientists then followed - hence the term ‘conventional
current’. He had no way of knowing that electrons were
being rubbed from the silk to the amber, but his choice
means that we now say that electrons have a negative
charge. Remember that conventional current and electron
flow move in opposite directions around a circuit.
Quantity
Symbol for
quantity
Unit
Symbol
for unit
current
/
amps
A
charge
Q
coulombs
C
time
t
seconds
s
Table 18.1: Symbols and units for some electrical quantities.
So a current of 10 A passing a point means that 10 C of
charge flows past that point every second. You may find
it easier to recall this relationship in the following form:
charge (C)
= current (A) x time (s)
Q= H
So, if a current of 10 A flows around a circuit for 5 s,
then 50 C of charge flows around the circujt.
Worked Example 18.1 shows how to calculate the charge
that flows in a circuit.
WORKED EXAMPLE 18.1
A current of 150 mA flows around a circuit for
one minute. How much electric (jharge flows
around the circuit in this time?
1
Step 1: Write down what you know, and what
you want to know. Put all quantities in
the units shown in Table 18.1.
1= 150mA = 0.15 A (or 150 x IO’3 A)
Current and charge
= 1 minute = 60 s
e=?
t
An ammeter measures the rate at which electric charge
flows past a point in a circuit. The electric current is
defined as the charge passing a point in the circuit per
unit of time (usually per second). We can write this
relationship between current and charge as an equation
using the quantities and symbols given in Table 18.1:
charge (C)
current (A) =
time (s)
Step 2: Write down an appropriate form of the
equation relating Q, / and t. Substitute
values and calculate the answer.
Q-It
g = 0.15 A x 60s = 90C
Answer
90 coulombs of charge flow around the circuit.
Questions
4
a
b
5
a
b
326
y
In which direction does conventional current
flow around a circuit?
In which direction do electrons flow around
a circuit?
What is the unit of electric current?
What is the unit of electric charge?
18 Electrical quantities
How many milliamps are there in 1 amp?
How many microamps are there in 1 amp?
6
a
b
7
Which of the following equations shows the correct
relationship between electrical units?
—
1A=1 s
8
1C=14s
Calculate the missing values a-d in Table 18.2.
Show all your working.
Charge
charge
Current
Time
current
time
220 C
2A
a
57.6C
b
3 hours
c
0.5 A
9 minutes
5.4 C
70 mA
d
Table 18.2
18.2 Voltage in
electric circuits
Figure 18.8 shows a circuit in which a cell pushes a current
through a resistor. The cell provides the voltage needed
to push the current through the resistor. Here, ‘voltage’
is a rather loose term, and we should say that there is
a potential difference (p.d.) across the resistor. Potential
difference is defined as the work done by a unit charge
passing through a component (a resistor, in this case). It is
measured in volts (V) using a voltmeter. The p.d. is also the
difference in electrical potential between two points: the
point where the current enters a component and where
it leaves a component. This is rather like the difference in
height that makes a ball roll downhill.
Voltmeters are always connected in parallel with a
component, that is, across a component. This circuit is
called a parallel circuit, where components are connected
in branches across the circuit. Voltmeters can either have
an analogue display (with a needle) or a digital display
(with a numerical value). The reading on a voltmeter is in
volts (V) but they have different ranges. Smaller voltages
may be measured in millivolts (mV) or microvolts (pV).
Take care not to confuse italic, V, which is used as the
symbol for an unknown potential difference or voltage,
with upright, V, which is used as the symbol for the unit,
volts. You can tell the difference in books, but you cannot
easily tell the difference when they are written.
voltmeter
Figure 1 8.8: The cell provides the p.d. needed to push
the current around the circuit. The amount of current
depends on the p.d. and the resistance of the resistor. The
ammeter measures the current flowing through the resistor.
The voltmeter measures the p.d. across it. This circuit can
therefore be used to find the resistance of the resistor. The
ammeter is connected in series in the circuit. The voltmeter
is connected in parallel in the circuit.
There is a special name for the p.d. across a cell. It is called
the electromotive force (e.m.f.) of the cell, and it is also
measured in volts. The term can be misleading since e.m.f.
is a voltage, not a force. Any component that pushes a
current around a circuit is said to be a source of e.m.f., for
example, cells, batteries, power supplies and dynamos. The
e.m.f. is defined as the electrical work done by a source in
moving a unit charge around a complete circuit.
KEY WORDS
voltage: the energy transferred or work done per
unit charge; it can be imagined as the push of a
battery or power supply in a circuit
potential difference (p.d.): the work done by
(a unit) charge passing through an electrical
component; another name for the voltage
between two points
volts (V): the SI unit of voltage (p.d. or e.m.f.);
1 V = 1 J/C
voltmeter: a meter for measuring the p.'d.
(voltage) between two points
electromotive force (e.m.f.)r the electrical work
done by a source (cell, battery, etc.) in moving (a
unit) charge around a circuit; the voltage across
the terminals of a source
327
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
What is a volt?
9
Why do we use high voltages for our mains supply? The
reason is that a supply with a high e.m.f. does a lot of
work on the charge that it pushes around the circuit.
A 230 V mains supply does 230 J of work on each
coulomb of charge that travels round the circuit.
This gives us a clue as to what we mean by a volt. A
supply with an e.m.f. of 1 V does 1 J of work on each
coulomb of charge it pushes round a circuit. In other
words, a volt is a joule per coulomb.
The chemical energy supplied by the cell is what pushes
electrons around a circuit. The e.m.f. tells you how much
work is done on each coulomb of charge as it passes
through the cell. This is described by the equation:
work done on the charge (J)
„
e.m.f. (E) =
charge (C)
The bigger the e.m.f. of a cell, the more strongly
electrons are pushed around the circuit, just like pressure
determines how strongly water is pushed through a pipe.
The potential difference across a device such as a lamp
is a measure of how much electrical work is done by
each coulomb as it passes through a component. This is
described by the equation:
work done by the charge (J)
,
p.d. (V) charge (C)
a
b
c
10 a
b
What do the letters p.d. stand for?
What meter is used to measure p.d.?
Draw the symbol for this meter.
What name is given to the p.d. across a cell or
battery?
What unit is this measured in?
Combining e.m.f.s
Many battery-operated electrical appliances need more
than one cell to make them work. For example, a radio
may need four 1.5 V cells. Each has an e.m.f. of 1.5 V
and, when connected together in series, they give a
combined e.m.f. of 6 V. You can see that, when cells are
connected in series, their e.m.f.s add up.
Figure 18.9 shows some examples of this. In general, if
cells with e.m.f.s Ex and E2 are connected in series, their
combined e.m.f. E is given by:
E = E\ + E2
You can understand why e.m.f.s add up like this if you
think about what happens when electric charge passes
through. For four 1.5 V cells in series, each cell does
electrical work on each unit charge as it passes through,
so their combined e.m.f. must be 6 V.
3.0V
4.5V
1.5V
-I -I -
-I -I -I -
—I - H —
a
be
Figure 1 8.9: The e.m.f.s of cells or other supplies add up
when they are connected in series. Here, each individual
cell has an e.m.f. of 1,5V. a, b: More cells give a higher
combined e.m.f. c: When one cell is connected the wrong
way round, the combined e.m.f. is reduced.
z™
__
Both word equations above can be summarised as the
word equation:
voltage (V)
J
= workdone
charge C
Or, the symbol equation:
-I
Question
1 1 Three 12 V batteries are connected in series.
a Draw a diagram to show how these batteries
could be connected to a lamp.
b Calculate the combined e.m.f. of the batteries.
The voltage or potential difference is the work done (or
energy transferred) per unit charge.
As electric current flows through a circuit, the chemical
energy of the cell is transferred to the components as
internal energy (in a resistor) or kinetic energy (in a motor !
328
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
What is a volt?
9
Why do we use high voltages for our mains supply? The
reason is that a supply with a high e.m.f. does a lot of
work on the charge that it pushes around the circuit.
A 230 V mains supply does 230 J of work on each
coulomb of charge that travels round the circuit.
This gives us a clue as to what we mean by a volt. A
supply with an e.m.f. of 1 V does 1 J of work on each
coulomb of charge it pushes round a circuit. In other
words, a volt is a joule per coulomb.
The chemical energy supplied by the cell is what pushes
electrons around a circuit. The e.m.f. tells you how much
work is done on each coulomb of charge as it passes
through the cell. This is described by the equation:
work done on the charge (J)
e.m.f. (E) =
charge (C)
The bigger the e.m.f. of a cell, the more strongly
electrons are pushed around the circuit, just like pressure
determines how strongly water is pushed through a pipe.
The potential difference across a device such as a lamp
is a measure of how much electrical work is done by
each coulomb as it passes through a component. This is
described by the equation:
work done by the charge (J)
,
p.d. (V) =
charge (C)
a
b
c
10 a
b
What do the letters p.d. stand for?
What meter is used to measure p.d.?
Draw the symbol for this meter.
What name is given to the p.d. across a cell or
battery?
What unit is this measured in?
Combining e.m.f.s
Many battery-operated electrical appliances need more
than one cell to make them work. For example, a radio
may need four 1.5 V cells. Each has an e.m.f. of 1.5 V
and, when connected together in series, they give a
combined e.m.f. of 6 V. You can see that, when cells are
connected in series, their e.m.f.s add up.
Figure 18.9 shows some examples of this. In general, if
cells with e.m.f.s E{ and E2 are connected in series, their
combined e.m.f. E is given by:
E = E\ + E2
You can understand why e.m.f.s add up like this if you
think about what happens when electric charge passes
through. For four 1.5 V cells in series, each cell does
electrical work on each unit charge as it passes through,
so their combined e.m.f. must be 6 V.
3.0V
4.5V
1.5V
-I -I -
-I -I -I -
—I - H —
a
be
Figure 1 8.9: The e.m.f.s of cells or other supplies add up
when they are connected in series. Here, each individual
cell has an e.m.f. of 1,5V. a, b: More cells give a higher
combined e.m.f. c: When one cell is connected the wrong
way round, the combined e.m.f. is reduced.
z™
__
Both word equations above can be summarised as the
word equation:
voltage (V)
J
= workdone
charge C
Or, the symbol equation:
-I
Question
1 1 Three 12 V batteries are connected in series.
a Draw a diagram to show how these batteries
could be connected to a lamp.
b Calculate the combined e.m.f. of the batteries.
The voltage or potential difference is the work done (or
energy transferred) per unit charge.
As electric current flows through a circuit, the chemical
energy of the cell is transferred to the components as
internal energy (in a resistor) or kinetic energy (in a motor!
328
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
3
In the cake monster model of a series circuit,
compare the 'cake difference' across the cake
monster (or monsters) and the 'cake difference'
Optional
4
across the cake factory.
REFLECTION
The cake monster activity is a model for the way
electric circuits work. Did it help you understand
how a circuit works and give meaning to the
different components? For example, did you get
the idea that the cake represents energy that is
being transferred from the factory (cell) to the
monsters (lamps)? Can you suggest a better
model for the way electric circuits work?
through the resistor, measured by the ammeter. We also
need to know the p.d. across it, and this is measured by
the voltmeter connected in parallel across it.
KEY WORDS
18.3 Electrical resistance
If you use a short length of wire to connect the positive
and negative terminals of a cell (a battery) together,
you can do a lot of damage. The wire and the cell may
both get hot, as a large current will flow through them.
There is very little electrical resistance in the circuit,
so the current is large. The current flowing in a circuit
can be controlled by adding components with electrical
resistance to the circuit. The greater the resistance, the
smaller the current that will flow.
Defining resistance
How much current can a cell push through a resistor?
The electrical resistance of a component is measured in
ohms (Q). It is defined as the potential difference across
the component divided by the current passing through it:
resistance (Q)
potential difference(V)
=
current(A)
The circuit shown in Figure 18.11 illustrates how we
can measure the resistance of a resistor (or of any other
component). We need to know the current flowing
330
>
Show how you would change the cake monster
model to represent a parallel circuit. Using the
model, explain why the current passing through
the cell/battery is the sum of the currents
passing through the individual branches of a
parallel circuit.
resistance: a measure of how difficult it is for
an electric current to flow through a device or
a component in a circuit; it is the p.d. across a
component divided by the current through it
ohm (0): the SI unit of electrical resistance;
1 n = 1 v/a
A voltmeter is always connected across the relevant
component because it is measuring the potential
difference between the two ends of the component.
•
Ammeters are connected in series so that the current
can flow through them.
•
Voltmeters are connected in parallel to measure the
p.d. across the component.
Worked Example 18.2 and Figure 18.11 show how to
calculate the resistance of a resistor from measurements
of current and p.d. Notice that we can show the current
as an arrow entering (or leaving) the resistor. The p.d.
is shown by a double-headed arrow to indicate that it
is measured across the resistor. The resistance is simply
shown as a label on or next to the resistor - it does not
have a direction.
18 Electrical quantities
Changing current
You can think of an electric circuit as an obstacle race.
The current (or flow of charge) comes out of the positive
terminal of the cell and must travel around the circuit
to the negative terminal. Along the way, it must pass
through the different components. The greater their
resistance, the harder it will be for the charge to flow, and
so the current will be smaller.
The greater the resistance in the circuit, the smaller
the current that flows. However, we can make a bigger
current flow by increasing the p.d. that pushes it. A
bigger p.d. produces a bigger current. The greater the
p.d. in a circuit (or across a component), the greater the
current that flows.
Resistance and thickness
This idea of an obstacle race can help us to think about
the resistance of wires of different shapes. A long, thin
wire has more resistance than a short, fat one. Imagine
an obstacle course that includes pipes of different sizes
through which the runners have to pass. It is easy to get
through a short pipe with a large diameter. It is much
harder when the pipe is long and narrow.
•
•
The longer a wire, the greater its resistance.
The greater the diameter of a wire, the less
its resistance.
Questions
18 a
What is an ohm?
Let us think about the equation that defines what we
mean by resistance:
We can see that it takes a p.d. of 10 V to make a current
of 1 A flow through a 10 Q resistor. It takes 20 V to
make 1 A flow through a 20 Q resistor, and so on. Hence
resistance (in Q) tells us how many volts are needed to
make 1 A flow through that resistor. To put it another
way: one ohm is one volt per amp.
1Q = 1
—
b
What is the resistance of a lamp if a current of
5.0 A flows through it when it is connected to a
240 V supply?
When the p.d. across the lamp is increased, will
the current flowing increase or decrease?
19 A student cuts two pieces of wire, one long and one
short, from a reel.
Which piece of wire will have the greater
a
b
resistance?
Draw a circuit diagram to show how you would
check your answer by measuring the resistances
of the two pieces of wire.
A
In the case of Worked Example 18.2, it would take 500 V
to make 1 A flow through the 500 Q resistor.
331
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Measuring resistance
p.d. P/V
The circuit shown in Figure 18.12 can be used to find the
resistance of a resistor. The circuit has a variable power
supply, which can be adjusted to give several different
values of p.d. For each value, the current is measured, and
results like those shown in Table 18.4 are found. The last
column in Table 18.4 shows values for R, calculated using
R = VH. These can be averaged to find the value of R.
variable
power supply
$
.
Current //A
Resistance R/Q
2.0
0.08
25.0
4.0
0.17
23.5
6.0
0.24
25.0
8.0
0.31
25.8
10.0
0.40
25.0
12.0
0.49
24.5
Table 18.4: Typical results for an experimental measurement
of resistance.
Figure 1 8.1 2: A circuit for investigating how the current
through a resistor changes as the voltage across it varies.
The power supply can be adjusted to give a range of values
of p.d. (typically from OVto 12V).
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 18.1
How length and thickness affects the resistance
of a wire
Understanding howto measure resistance is really
important because it introduces the measurements
of voltage and current, which are essential for
understanding circuits. In more sophisticated
(complicated) circuits, resistance can change so that
a device can respond to the environment (for
example, a light can come on when it gets dark).
You will need:
• power supply
• 5 insulated (coloured) wires
• 2 crocodile clips
metre ruler
• 2 lengths of resistance wire of different
diameter
• masking tape
• heatproof mat to go underneath the
resistance wire
•
• ammeter
• voltmeter.
18
Electrical quantities
CONTINUED
If a power supply is not available then use a suitable
cell or series of cells but include a switch and only
close the switch when you take measurements (to
avoid draining the cell or battery). If two different
gauges of wire are not available, lightly twist two
lengths of the same gauge wire together to double
the effective cross-section.
Safety: If the insulation on the wires melts or gives
off poisonous fumes, reduce the voltage you use.
Hot wires have the potential to burn skin. Avoid
connecting the positive terminal of the power
supply directly to the negative terminal (ensure that
the current has to pass through the resistance wire).
It may be necessary to place a resistor (fixed or
variable) in series with the resistance wire in order to
reduce the current through it. The voltages involved
are too low to cause an electric shock.
Getting started
•
•
State what devices you will use to measure
voltage and current and describe how they
should be wired into the circuit.
What variable should be kept the same (control
variable)?
•
Why is it important to avoid taking
measurements when the wire has zero length?
•
Predict how the resistance of the wire will vary
with the length of the wire.
Predict how the resistance of the wire will vary
with the diameter of the wire.
Identify the independent and dependent
variables.
State two reasons why it is important to plot a
graph of your results.
You will be plotting a graph of your results.
What should be plotted along on each axis?
•
•
•
•
Method 1
1
Set up the circuit as shown in Figure 18.13a. Set the power supply to 12 V.
voltmeter
Figure 1 8.1 3a; Circuit diagram for the experiment, b: How to attach the wire to the ruler.
333
>
2 Draw a table like Table 18.5, but remember to add more rows as you need them.
Length of resistance
wire / cm
Current / A
Thin
10
20
30
Thick
10
20
30
Voltage / V
Resistance / Ω
Table 18.5
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
If your teacher has not already done so, attach the resistance wire along a metre ruler with insulating (or
masking) tape at both ends and at the centre (see Figure 18.13b).
Put crocodile clips at the ends of the insulated (coloured) wires that will attach to the resistance wire.
Attach the first crocodile clip to the resistance wire where it crosses the 0.0 cm mark on the ruler and leave
this in place throughout the experiment.
Attach the second crocodile clip where the resistance wire crosses the ruler at 10.0 cm and record the current
and voltage values in the table.
Move the second crocodile clip at 10.0 cm intervals, each time recording the current and voltage values in the
table.
𝑉
Calculate the resistance values using 𝑅 = and record the results in the table.
𝐼
Plot a graph of resistance against length of the resistance wire (with the resistance along the horizontal axis)
and label it ‘thin’.
Repeat the experiment with thicker resistance wire (or loosely twist two wires of the same diameter together
but, if you do, ensure the teeth of the crocodile clips are in contact with both wires). Plot the graph on the
same axes for easy comparison and label it ‘thick’.
Method 2
If you do not have access to resistance wires of five different diameters, twist wires of the same diameter together.
Keep the length of wire the same (say, 50 cm).
1
Use a micrometer to determine the diameter of the wire or look up the wire diameter corresponding to
the SWG (standard wire gauge) value on the reel that the wire comes from.
2
Use this information to work out the cross-sectional area of the wire or wires.
3
Using wires of the same length but increasing cross-section, record the voltage and current values, and
calculate the resistance.
4
Plot a graph of resistance against the cross-sectional area.
5
Describe the relationship between resistance and cross-section.
6
How would you show that there is an inverse relationship?
334>
18 Electrical quantities
CONTINUED
Questions
d The resistance of a resistance wire
{increases/decreases} when its diameter
increases.
e The resistance of a resistance wire
{doubles/ halves} when its cross-sectional
Copy each statement choosing the correct
answer from the brackets.
a
The resistance of a resistance wire
{increases/decreases} when its length
increases.
f
The resistance of a resistance wire
{doubles/halves} when its length doubles.
This means that the resistance is
{inversely/directly} proportional to its
length. A straight-line graph passing
through the origin will show this.
2
area doubles.
This means that the resistance is
{inversely/directly} proportional to its
cross-sectional area.
Extrapolate your resistance against length
graph (Method 1) towards the origin. What is
the resistance when the length of the resistance
wire is zero?
3 , Use your answer to the previous question to
suggest why a direct connection between the
terminals of the power supply is not a good idea.
18.4 More about
electrical resistance
21 a
The equation R = y is used to calculate the resistance of
22 a
b
a component in a circuit. We can rearrange the equation
in two ways so that we can calculate current or p.d.:
b
V=IR
So, for example, we can calculate the current that flows
through a 20 fi resistor when there is a p.d. of 6.0 V
across it. The current I is:
^^ =
20 ft
A p.d. of 240 V across a resistor causes a
current of 80 mA to flow through it. What is
the resistance of the resistor?
What p.d. would cause a current of 40mA to
flow through the resistor?
23 What current flows when a p.d. of 7.5 V is connected
across a 2 kQ resistor?
Current-voltage characteristics
0.30 A
Questions
20 Calculate the missing values a-d in Table 18.6.
Show all your working.
Potential
difference /V
Current
/A
Resistance
/0
240
2
a
12
b
3000
c
0.5
15
120
80
d
Table 18.6
What p.d. is needed to make a current of 2.0 A
flow through a 30 Q resistor?
Without calculation, what p.d. is required when
the resistance is doubled?
We can use the data shown in Table 18.4 to plot a graph
of current against potential difference for a resistor.
This graph is shown in Figure 18.14 and is known as a
current-voltage characteristic.
•
The p.d. Kis on the x-axis, because this is the
quantity we vary. It is the independent variable.
•
The current 7 is on the j-axis, because this is the
quantity that varies as we change V. It is the
dependent variable.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
•
Figure 1 8.1 4: The current-voltage characteristic for the data
in Table 18.4.
In this case, the graph is a straight line that passes
through the origin. This is what we expect because the
y
equation I = shows that the current / is proportional
—
A
to the p.d., V.
A resistor with a current-voltage characteristic like
this is called an ohmic resistor. It is easy to predict the
current that will flow through an ohmic resistor because
the current is directly proportional to the p.d. across it.
Double the voltage gives double the current, and so on.
Figure 18.15 shows what happens if we use a filament
lamp instead of an ohmic resistor. You can see that the
current-voltage characteristic for the filament lamp
is curved.
At higher voltages, the £raph starts to curve over.
The current increases more and more slowly as the
voltage is increased. Current is not proportional to
voltage.
The graph shows that the lamp is not an ohmic resistor.
Why is this? At first, when the voltage and current are
small, the lamp behaves like an ohmic resistor. However,
as the voltage increases, the current causes the filament
to get hot and glow brightly. At high temperatures, the
filament has a higher resistance and so the current does
not increase as rapidly as it would do if the filament had
remained cool.
This means that the resistance of the tungsten filament
lamp increases as the current increases. But why does
increasing the current make the tungsten hotter? This
requires a more detailed explanation.
Increasing the current leads to an increase in the number
of electrons flowing through the tungsten wire and this
increases the number of collisions between the electrons
and the lattice (the regular arrangement ^f atoms in the
metal). Some of the kinetic energy from the electrons is
transferred into internal energy, which makes the lattice
vibrate more. This increases the resistance because it
increases the number of collisions between the electrons
and the lattice. In a similar way, it is more difficult to
move through a crowd where people are moving in
random directions compared to a crowd of people who
are standing still.
'
KEY WORDS
current-voltage characteristic: a graph of
current on the vertical axis and voltage on the
horizontal axis
ohmic resistor: has a constant resistance; its f-V
characteristic is a straight line, so that the current
through it is directly proportional to the voltage
across it
Figure 18.15: The current-voltage characteristic for a
filament lamp. The graph is not a straight line through the
origin, showing that the lamp is not an ohmic resistor.
•
At first, for low voltages, the graph is straight,
showing that the current increases at a steady rate as
the voltage is increased.
336
y
Figure 18.16 shows the typical shapes of the current¬
voltage characteristics for ohmic resistors, for a filament
lamp and a diode. In Figure 18.16a, resistor Q has a
higher resistance than resistor P. We can tell this because
the current flowing through Q is always less than the
current through P, for any voltage.
18
Electrical quantities
eg. 50V
reverse
conventional current
Figure 18.16: Typical current-voltage characteristics, a: For two ohmic resistors, b: For a filament lamp, c: For a diode.
Notice that these graphs show both positive and negative
voltages. A negative current means one flowing in the
opposite direction. This is achieved by connecting the
cell or power supply the other way round. Figures 18.16a
and b are symmetrical, showing that, whichever way
round the components are connected, the current will be
the same for a given voltage.
Figure 18.16c is the I-V characteristic of a diode, which
is not symmetrical. A diode acts as a switch and only
allows current to flow in one direction. The arrow on the
diode symbol indicates the direction that conventional
current can flow. A diode is a semiconductor so
it behaves like both an insulator and a conductor.
A diode behaves like an insulator until it is given enough
voltage (energy per unit charge) to make it behave as
a conductor. For a silicon diode this threshold voltage
is 0.7 V.
Questions
24 Look at the graph shown in Figure 18.16a. How can
you tell from the graph that the resistors are both
ohmic?
25 Look at the graph shown in Figure 18.1 6b. How can
you tell from the graph that the lamp’s resistance
increases as the p.d. across it increases?
Length and area
We have seen that the resistance of a wire depends on its
length and its diameter. In fact, it is the cross-sectional
area of the wire that matters.
The resistance of a wire is proportional to its length.
The resistance of a wire is inversely proportional to
its cross-sectional area.
Suppose that we have a 4.0 metre length of wire.
Its resistance is 100 fl. What will be the resistance of a
2.0 metre length of wire with twice the cross-sectional
area? Notice that making the wire shorter will reduce
its resistance, and increasing its area will also reduce its
resistance.
Halving the length gives half the resistance
= 50 fl.
Doubling the area halves the resistance again = 25 fl.
Question
26 A 2.0 metre length of wire has a resistance of 4.0 Q.
What is the resistance of a piece of the same
a
wire of length 20.0 metres?
b
What is the resistance of a 4.0 metre wire with
half the cross-sectional area, made of the same
material?
18.5 Electrical energy,
work and power
We use electricity because it is a good way of transferring
energy from place to place. In most places, if you switch
on an electric heater, you are getting the benefit of the
energy released as fuel that is burned in a power station,
which may be over 100 km away.
When you plug in an appliance to the mains supply, you
are connecting up to quite a high voltage, something
like 1 10 V or 230 V, depending on where you live. This
high voltage is the e.m.f. of the supply. Recall that e.m.f.
is the name given to the p.d. across an electrical source
component such as a cell or power supply that pushes
current around a circuit.
)>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
By the principle of conservation of energy, the energy
given to the charges by the cell must equal the sum of the
energies given by the charges to the various components.
This means that the e.m.f. across the cell is equal to
the sum of the potential differences across all the
components round the circuit. The total voltage across
the cell equals the sum of the voltages across the lamps.
This is something you will meet again in Chapter 19.
Batteries and power supplies give energy to the charges in
a circuit. Similarly, we can think about other components
in a circuit. For example, a small lamp may have a p.d. of
1.5 V across it. This means that each coulomb of charge
does 1.5 J of electrical work to pass through the lamp
and will transfer 1.5 J of energy to the lamp. Remember,
work done is the same as energy transferred.
Electrical power
Most electrical appliances have a label that shows their
power rating. An example is shown in Figure 18.17.
The symbol, E, represents energy transferred. You
should recognise this definition of power from Chapter 8.
This equation also reminds us of the definition of the
unit of power, the watt: one watt is one joule per second,
1W = 1 J/s
Voltage and energy
We have seen that the e.m.f. (voltage) of a supply tells us
how much energy it transfers to charges flowing around
the circuit. The greater the current flowing around the
circuit, the faster that energy is transferred. Hence the
rate at which energy is transferred in the circuit (the
power, P) depends on both the e.m.f., E, of the supply
and the current, I, that it pushes round the circuit. The
following equation shows how to calculate the electrical
power:
power (W) = current (A) x p.d. (V)
P = IV
proline
MOD.:ST44
2450MHz
230V
INPUT POWER : 550
~ 50Hz MICROWAVE
MICROWAVE ENERGY OUTPUT
1
W
: 950 W
SERIAL NO.
81000138
MADE IN KOREA
C
WARNING -HIGH VOLTAGE
Figure 18.17: A label from the back of a microwave oven.
Power ratings are indicated in watts (W) or kilowatts
(kW). The power rating of an appliance shows the rate
at which it transfers energy, and indicates the maximum
electrical power the appliance draws from the mains
supply when it is operating at full power.
You may prefer to remember this as, an equation relating
units:
watts = amps x volts
Calculating energy
Since energy transferred = power x time, we can use the
= I V to give an equation for electrical energy
transferred E in terms of current and voltage:
equation P
energy transferred (J) = current (A) x p.d. (V) x time (s)
E = IVt
Electrical power is the rate at which energy is transferred:
power (W) =
—- ———
energy transferred (J)
time taken (s)
P= M
KEY WORDS
electrical power: power = current x p.d (P - VI)
338
y
Worked Example 18.3 shows how to calculate the power
of a device and how much energy is transferred in a
given time.
18
Electrical quantities
WORKED EXAMPLE 18.3
An electric fan runs from the 230 V mains supply. The
current flowing through it is 0.40 A. At what rate is
electrical energy transferred by the fan? How much
energy is transferred in one minute?
Step 1: First, we have to calculate the rate at which
electrical energy is transferred. This is the power,
P. Write down what you know and what you
want to know.
F= 230V
P = IV
P = 0.40 A x 230 V = 92W
Step 3: To calculate the energy transferred in
1 minute, use E = Pt (or E = IVt). Recall that
time, t, must be in seconds.
E = 92 W x 60s = 5520 J
Z=0.40A
Answer
So, the fan’s power is 92 W, and it transfers 5520 J of
energy each minute.
P= f
Questions
27 Write down an equation linking watts, volts
and amps.
28 Calculate the missing values a-d in Table 18.7.
Show all your working.
Voltage /V
Step 2: Write down the equation for power, which
involves V and I, substitute values and solve.
Current/A
Power/ P
240
2
a
12
b
60
c
0.5
15
120
80
d
Table 18.7
The equation E = IVt could be used to calculate the
chemical energy stored in a battery. A battery delivers
a current at its rated voltage for a given time (until it
discharges). The chemical energy stored in a battery
can also be found by multiplying its charge by its
rated voltage.
Units of electrical energy
Like other stores of energy, we could calculate the
amount of energy transferred electrically in joules (J),
but it is much more convenient to use kWh. This is
because 1 kW = 1000 W and 1 h = 3600 s, so
1 kWh = 1000 W x 3600 s 3.6 x 106 J (a big number).
1 kWh is sometimes called a unit of electricity. It is not;
it is a unit of energy. It is kWh that are measured using
an electricity meter, like the one shown in Figure 18.18.
=
29 A 12 V power supply pushes a current of 6.0 A
through a resistor. At what rate is energy transferred
to the resistor?
30 A tropical fish tank is fitted with an electric heater,
which has a power rating of 50 W.
The heater is connected to a 240 V supply.
What current flows through the heater when it is
switched on?
31 How much energy is transformed by an electric
lamp in an hour if a current of 20 mA flows through
it when it is connected to a 120 V supply?
Figure 18.18a: An electricity meter, b: Atypical smart
electricity meter, which can be accessed remotely so that
there is no need for someone to come to your house to read
your meter.
339
y
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
All devices in homes have a power rating. For example,
a fan heater might have a power output of 2kW. If left
running for two hours it would use 4 kWh (four units
of electrical energy). This is easier to imagine than
1.44 x 107J.
The equation for working out the number of units of
electrical energy that are being used is:
KEY EQUATION
energy transferred
(kWh)
= power x time
(kW)
(hours)
Worked Example 18.4 shows how the number of units a
device uses depends on how much power it transfers and
the length of time it operates.
WORKED EXAMPLE 18.4
Marcus switches on a water heater for two hours. The
power of the heater is 3.5 kW. How much energy is
transferred in kWh (units)?
Step 3: Substitute the values of the quantities
on the right-hand side and calculate
the answer.
energy transferred (kWh)
3.5 kW x 2 hours
Step 1 Start by writing down what you know, and what
you want to know.
=
= 7 kWh
Answer
The water heater uses 7 kWh (or 7 units).
power = 3.5 kW
time = 2 hours
energy transferred (kWh) = ?
Step 2: Now write down the equation for energy
transferred in kWh.
energy transferred (kWh) =
power (kW) x time (hours)
Worked Example 18.5 shows how to calculate the cost of electricity.
WORKED EXAMPLE 18.5
Zara checks her electricity bill for a three month period.
The meter reading at the start was 2531 kWh and at
the end it was 2647 kWh. Electricity costs 16p per unit.
What is her bill for electricity?
Step 3: Now write down the equation for the total
cost of electricity.
Step 1: Start by writing down what you know, and what
you want to know.
metre reading at start = 2531 kWh
meter reading at end = 2647 kWh
cost per unit 16p
units used = ?
total cost of electricity ?
Step 4: Substitute the values of the quantities on the
right-hand side and work out the answer.
=
=
Step 2: Work out how many units were used.
Units used = 2647 kWh - 2531 kWh
= 116kWh
340
>
total cost of electricity =
number of units x cost per unit
total cost of electricity =
116kWhx 16p = £18.56
Answer
Zara’s bill is £18.56.
1 8 Electrical quantities
Questions
Appliance
Power
Time
kWh / unit
Cost
32 A3 kW air conditioning unit used 216 kWh of
electricity. Calculate how many days it was switched
on for.
33 Eshan recorded the readings on his family’s
electricity meter at the beginning and end of one
month. The readings were 990 987 and 991 013.
Electricity costs 0.5 dirhams per unit. Calculate the
cost of the electrical energy used by Eshan’s family
in this month.
34 Use the information in Table 18.8 to work out the
missing values a-j. Assume that electricity costs 16p
per unit.
desktop
a
3 hours
1.3
b
870 W
c
0.87
d
e
12 hours
1.0
f
9W
9
4.5 x 10-2
h
i
j
computer
microwave
oven
television
energy
efficient
lamp
kettle
2kW 3 minutes
Table 18.8
PROJECT
Shining the light on what lamp to use
Design a public awareness and education campaign
to persuade people to switch to using LED lamps.
Your campaign must include an eye-catching and
scientifically-accurate poster or leaflet that can be
understood by the public. One way to encourage
people to read your leaflet is to provide a guide for
choosing the correct bulb, including whether they
need a screw or bayonet fitting.
You must include a table that compares the cost of
the different light bulbs. This cost should include the
purchase price plus the running cost over 20 years.
If you are working in pairs or small teams, you could
also produce a podcast.
Background
Many people are already aware that energy-saving
light bulbs can reduce carbon emissions and save
them money. However, energy-saving light bulbs are
often more expensive to buy and some people think
they prefer the colour of light emitted by tungsten
lamps or prefer the look of the filament that can be
seen through the glass when the lamp is off (Figure
18.19). Your campaign should emphasise that the
colour output of energy-saving bulbs can match that
of the traditional tungsten filament bulb.
Energy-saving light bulbs come in two varieties:
compact fluorescent lamps (CFL) and clusters of light
emitted diodes (LED). Older people remember LEDs
Figure 18.19: Different lightbulbs. From left to right:
LED, tungsten filament light, CFL.
when they produced quite a harsh light that was
highly directional (sending out a beam of light in one
direction). This was not suitable for lighting a room.
LED lights have improved and some have even
been made to look exactly like filament light bulbs.
However, energy-saving light bulbs, particularly
CFLs, contain electronic circuitry that is difficult to
recycle. CFLs also contain mercury, which is toxic and
a danger to health.
People need to be educated to look for bulbs that
give out the brightness they want (measured in
lumens) instead of the power consumed (measured
in watts). For example, a 60W tungsten filament light
bulb, a 14 W CFL and a 10W LED all emit 850lumens.
As part of the education campaign, you will need to
compare the cost of using the different light bulbs all
producing the same light output (say 850 lumens) and
switched on for 25 000 hours over a period of
>
CAMBRIDGf IGCSB™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
20 years. In Table 18.9, we have assumed that the
light bulbs all emit 850 lumens. When you research
light bulbs, note that tungsten filament light bulbs
are sometimes called incandescent light bulbs or
halogen light bulbs. Only use the data in Table 18.9
if you really do not have time to research up-to-date
numbers. By the time you read this book, CFLs and
LEDs may have become even more efficient, they may
last longer and the cost of electricity will certainly have
changed.
Quantity
Type of bulb
Tungsten filament
CFL
power rating
LED
60 W
14W
10W
average cost per bulb (£)
1
2
4
average lifespan (hours)
1200
8000
25 000
number of bulbs needed for 25 000 hours
total purchase price of bulbs over 20 years (£)
Cost of electricity over 20 years when electricity costs
£0.15 per unit (£)
Total estimated cost over 20 years (£)
Table 18.9: A table to work out the relative cost of the three different light bulbs.
Optional
Include explanations of how the lamps work. You already know how a tungsten filament light bulb works.
SUMMARY
An electric current will flow only if there is a supply of energy (for example, a battery) to push it around a
complete circuit (that is, if there are no gaps in it).
Conductors (for example, metals) allow electric current to flow through them while insulators (for example,
plastic) resist the flow of current.
Current is a flow of electric charge (for example, electrons) in a circuit.
Electric current is measured in amperes or amps (A).
Current is measured with an ammeter connected into a circuit in series.
Conventional current flows from the positive terminal of a cell or battery to the negative terminal. Electrons
flow in the opposite direction.
Current is the rate at which electric charge (for example, electrons) passes a point in a circuit: I =
@
.
Voltage or potential difference (p.d.) is like the difference in height that makes a ball roll downhill.
The p.d. across a cell is called the electromotive force (e.m.f.).
Voltage (and p.d. and e.m.f.) is measured with a voltmeter connected in parallel across the relevant component
and they are all measured in volts (V).
342
>
18
Electrical quantities
CONTINUED
Voltage is the work done or energy transferred per unit charge given by the equation V= W
The resistance of a component is measured in ohms (Q).
The resistance of a circuit component is the p.d. across it divided by the current passing through it given by
the equation R =
an^
can
f°und by experiment.
The resistance of a wire increases when it gets longer and resistance decreases as the diameter of the wire gets wider.
The resistance of a wire is proportional to its length and inversely proportional to its cross-sectional area.
A current-voltage (I-V) characteristic is a graph with current plotted on the vertical axis and the voltage on the
horizontal axis.
When the gradient of an I-V characteristic is smaller, the resistance is bigger.
The resistance of an ohmic resistor is constant because the current through it is directly proportional to the
voltage across it. The I-V characteristic of an ohmic resistor is a straight line through the origin.
A filament lamp is an example of a component that is non-ohmic. As the current through the filament increases,
it gets hot and so its resistance increases.
Electric circuits transfer energy from the battery or power source to the circuit components and then the
surroundings.
Electrical power is current multiplied by voltage (P
= IV) and electrical energy is £ = IVt.
The equation for working out the number of units of electrical energy being used is:
Energy transferred (kWh) power (kW) x time (hours)
=
The cost of electricity can be worked out using: total cost of electricity = number of units x cost per unit
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
[1]
1 Which of these non-metals can conduct electricity?
A plastic
B chalk
C carbon
D rubber
2 Which of the following carries the current in a metallic conductor?
A negatively charged electrons
B negatively charged protons
c positively charged electrons
D positively charged protons
[1]
3 To charge a camera flash, a current of 400 mA flows from a 6.0 V battery
for 1 .7 s. How much energy is transferred from the battery to the flash,
[11
approximately?
A 1.4J
B 4J
C 1400 J
D 4000 J
343
)
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
4 Which of the current voltage (/ T') characteristics shown below is for a
5 Charge separation between the ground and a cloud leads to a spark called
lightning. When a lightning flash occurs, a current passes through the air.
Use the data in this diagram to answer the questions.
speed = 1 x 107 m/s
separation = 5 km
p.d. = 33MV
I = 30 kA
COMMAND WORDS
a State the relationship between distance, speed and time.
b Calculate the time it takes the lightning strike to cross the gap between
the cloud and the ground.
c State the relationship between charge, current and time.
d Calculate the charge transferred by the lightning strike.
[1 ]
[2]
[1 ]
[2]
e State the relationship between potential difference, energy transferred
and charge.
f Calculate the energy in one lightning strike using the charge and
[1]
voltage values.
g An alternative approach for working out the energy in the lightning
strike does not involve working out the charge transferred. Show that
this method gives the same answer.
[2]
[2]
[Total: 11]
344
)
state: express in
clear terms
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
18
Electrical quantities
CONTINUED
6 A student wants to measure the resistance of filament lamp. She used an
ammeter, a battery, a lamp and a voltmeter.
a Draw the circuit she built.
b The student obtains the graph below for the filament lamp.
[2]
COMMAND WORD
give: produce an
answer from a given
source or recall I
memory
Voltage in / V
i
Use the graph to find the current through the filament lamp when
[1 ]
the voltage is 6.0 V
ii State the relationship between voltage, current and resistance.
[1]
iii Calculate the resistance of the lamp when the voltage is 6.0 V.
[3]
Give the unit.
[2]
iv Explain the shape of the I-V characteristic.
[Total: 9]
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons I make
the relationships
between things
evident I provide
why and I or how and
support with relevant
evidence
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Recall what is required for an electric current to
flow in a circuit.
18.1
Distinguish between conductors and insulators from a
list and give examples of each.
18.1
State what a current is made of.
18.1
Recall the units of current, voltage and resistance.
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
18.1, 18.2,
18.3
Recall what devices measure current and voltage and
know how to connect them into a circuit.
18.1
Work out the direction that electrons flow around a
circuit and recall that this is opposite to the direction of
conventional current.
18.1
Understand what a current is and recall and use the
equation that relates current, charge and time.
18.1
*
345
)
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
1 can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Recall the name given to the voltage across a cell
or battery.
18.2
State the units of electromotive force (e.m.f.) and
potential difference (p.d.).
18.2
Show an understanding of what e.m.f. is (not what it
stands for).
18.2
Recall the name of the unit that resistance is measured in.
18.3
Recall the equation that relates resistance, current and
voltage.
18.3
Understand how changes in resistance and voltage
affect current.
18.3
Describe an experiment to determine resistance using a
voltmeter and ammeter.
18.3
Relate the resistance of a wire to its length and diameter
(without doing any calculations).
18.3
Recall and use the relationships that relate the resistance
of a wire to its length and cross-sectional area.
18.3
Understand how the gradient of a current-voltage
characteristic relates to resistance.
18.4
Sketch and explain the current-voltage (Z-k)
characteristics of an ohmic resistor and a filament lamp.
18.4
Understand that electric circuits transfer energy from
the battery or power source to the circuit components
and then the surroundings.
18.5
Recall and use the equations for electric power and
energy.
18.5
Calculate electrical energy in kWh and work out its cost.
18.5
346
>
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
)
> Chapter 19
Electrics
circuits
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL
draw and interpret circuit diagrams
describe how current and resistance vary in different circuits
learn how to calculate resistances, currents and voltages in circuits
describe the action of diodes and potential divider circuits
highlight the hazards of using electricity and describe and explain electrical safety measures, including
fuses, circuit-breakers, and earth wires.
1
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
Spend two minutes thinking about these questions
before comparing notes with the person sitting
next to you. Add to, or correct, your own work. Be
prepared to share your thoughts with the class.
How can you tell a series circuit apart from a parallel
circuit?
Using what you remember from Chapter 18 about
how the resistance of a wire depends on its length
and diameter, try answering the following questions:
•
•
Why does less current flow when there are two
lamps in series'^
Why does more total current flow when there
are two lamps in parallel?
HOW CLOSE ARE WE TO CREATING ARTIFICIAL INTELLIGENCE?
In Chapter 18 we met Alessandro Volta. In 1 800 he
invented the first battery and the first electric circuit.
might be a threat to our future existence. Science
fiction movies like Ex Machina paint a bleak future.
Development of the first electric light bulb followed
almost immediately, though it was almost a century
before it was good enough to sell. Electric lighting
became the first of many applications of electric
circuits. For example, electric circuits can transport
electricity from where it is generated to where it is
used (see Chapters 7 and 21). As we will see later in
this chapter, circuits can also be used to automate
tasks, like switching on a lamp when it gets dark, and
transferring energy in a light bulb in the process.
The semiconductor transistor is perhaps the most
important invention of the last century because it is
much smaller and cheaper than the device (called a
valve) that it replaced. Without transistors we would
not have smartphones or personal computers as
these are based on miniature electric circuits that
use millions of transistors. If smartphones were
made using the old technology, they would fill a
room. Making computers smaller means they can
be used to control more appliances.
Driverless cars will be controlled by computers,
which will make decisions based on programs
written by people. However, an alien might think
the cars are automatons (making decisions by
themselves). Robots (Figure 19.1) already exist
that could be mistaken for artificial intelligence
(machines that can think for themselves). Some
scientists worry that we are close to creating
artificial intelligence, perhaps by accident, which
348
>
Figure 1 9.1: Rico's combat robot from the science fiction
film, Judge Dredd, 1995.
Discussion questions
1
Draw a table with two columns. In the
left column, write down the names often
household appliances (such as 'television') that
rely on electricity, and, therefore, include an
electric circuit. In the right-hand column, write
down the names of appliances that do not
need electricity. What do you notice?
2
Try describing our world if electricity had not
been discovered.
3
What are the potential positives and negatives
of automation and artificial intelligence?
19 Electric circuits
19.1 Circuit components
Figure 19.2 shows the circuit symbols for the electrical components that you are most likely to meet in this course.
You should try to remember them. A complete list is given in the appendix at the end of the book. The symbols in
blue are supplementary content.
—O
junction of
conductors
cell
battery
variable resistor
potential divider
—
O
power supply
switch
resistor
heater
fuse
magnetising coil
generator
light emitting diode
d.c. power supply
transformer
a.c. power supply
Figure 19.2: Circuit symbols for electrical components.
Resistors
A resistor (Figure 19.3) can be used to control the
amount of current flowing around a circuit. A resistor
has two terminals, so that the current can flow in one
end and out the other. They may be made from metal
wire (usually an alloy - a mixture of two or more metals
with a high resistance) or from carbon. Carbon (like the
graphite in a pencil) conducts electricity, but not as well
as most metals. Hence high-resistance resistors tend to
be made from graphite, particularly as it has a very high
melting point.
349
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
As the control is turned, the cbntact slides over the
resistive track. The current enters at one end and flows
through the track until it reaches the contact, where it
leaves the resistor. The amount of track that it flows
through depends on the position of the contact. Variable
resistors like this are often used for the volume control
of a radio or stereo system. (You may have come across
a rheostat, which is a laboratory version of a variable
resistor.)
Figure 19.3: A selection of resistors. Some have colour-coded
stripes to indicate their value, and others use a number code.
A variable resistor can be used to alter the current
flowing in a circuit. Figure 19.4a shows the inside of a
variable resistor - notice that it has three terminals.
Figure 19.4b shows an example of a circuit that contains
a variable resistor, and Figure 19.4c shows two different
circuit symbols for a variable resistor. Note that the
upper symbol has three terminals (like the resistor itself),
but this circuit only makes use of two of them.
KEY WORDS
variable resistor: a resistor whose resistance can
be changed, for example by turning a knob or
moving a slider
I
light-dependent resistor (LDR): a device whose
resistance decreases when light shines on it
r
Light-dependent resistors
A light-dependent resistor (LDR) is a type of variable
resistor whose resistance depends off the amount of light
falling on it (Figure 19.5). An LDR is made of a material
that does not normally conduct well. In the dark, an
LDR has a high resistance, often over 1 MQ. However,
light can provide the energy needed to allow a current to
flow. Shine light on an LDR and its resistance decreases.
In bright light, its resistance may decrease to 400 fl.
variable resistor
Figure 19.4a: A variable resistor. The resistance is provided
by a track of resistive wire or carbon. The resistance in the
circuit depends on the position of the sliding contact, b: The
current flowing around this circuit depends on the position
of the slider on the variable resistor. Imagine sliding the
arrow to the right. The current will then have to flow through
more resistance, and so it will decrease, c: Symbols for a
variable resistor.
350
>
Figure 19.5a: A light-dependent resistor. The interlocking
silver fingers are the two terminals through which the current
enters and leaves the resistor. In between (black-coloured)
is the resistive material, b: In the circuit symbol, the arrows
represent light shining on the LDR.
19 Electric circuits
LDRs are used in circuits to detect the level of light, for
example in security lights that switch on automatically at
night. Some digital clocks have one fitted. When the room
is brightly lit, the display is automatically brightened so
that it can be seen against its bright surroundings. In a
darkened room, the display need only be dim.
Thermistors
A thermistor (Figure 19.6) is another type of resistor
whose resistance depends on its environment. In this
case, its resistance depends on its temperature. The
resistance changes by a large amount over a narrow
range of temperatures.
2
a
b
c
3
a
b
c
What does LDR stand for?
Draw its circuit symbol.
What happens to the resistance of an LDR
when light is shone on it?
Draw the circuit symbol for a thermistor,
Give one use for a thermistor.
Explain why a thermistor is suitable for
the use you chose in b.
Relays
A relay is a type of switch that works using an
electromagnet. Figure 19.7 shows that, when a relay is
used, there are two circuits:
• the magnetising coil (electromagnet) of the relay is
in one circuit
• the switch is in the other circuit.
When a current flows through the relay or magnetising coil
in the first circuit, it becomes magnetised (Figure 1 9.7).
It pulls on the switch in the second circuit, causing it to
close, and allowing a current to flow in the second circuit
to turn on a motor. This will be shown in more detail in
Chapter 20.
The second circuit often involves a large voltage, which
would be dangerous for an operator to switch, or which
could not be switched by a normal electronic circuit
(because these work at low voltage). Remember, when a
relay is used, there are two complete circuits.
Figure 1 9.6a: A thermistor, b: The resistance of a thermistor
depends on the temperature. In this case, in the middle of the
curve, its resistance drops a lot as the temperature increases
by a small amount, c: In the circuit symbol, the line through
the resistor indicates that its resistance is not fixed but
depends on an external factor (in this case, the temperature).
For NTC thermistors, the resistance decreases as they are
heated, perhaps from 2 kQ at room temperature to 20 Q at
1 00 °C. NTC stands for negative temperature coefficient.
These thermistors are useful for temperature probes - see
the discussion of thermometers in Section 9.4.
Questions
1
a
b
Draw the circuit symbol for a resistor.
Draw the circuit symbol for a variable resistor.
Figure 1 9.7: A relay circuit.
KEY WORDS
NTC thermistor: a resistor whose resistance
decreases with increasing temperature
relay: a switch controlled by an electromagnet
351
>
’
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Sensing circuits
Diodes
A relay can be used in a circuit that senses changes in
temperature or light level. Figure 19.8 shows a circuit
that will turn on a lamp when the temperature rises. This
would be useful, for example, in an industrial freezer. If
the freezer fails, a large quantity of frozen food could be
ruined. Here is how the circuit in Figure 19.8 works:
• When the temperature is low, the thermistor has a
high resistance. The current in the left-hand circuit is
small, so the relay remains open. There is no current
in the right-hand circuit.
• When the temperature rises, the resistance of the
thermistor decreases. The current through the relay
coil increases, pulling the relay switch closed. Now
a current flows in the right-hand circuit and this
makes the lamp light.
This circuit could be adapted to detect changes in light
level. For example, the lights in a museum are switched
off at night. A thief might use a torch and this could be
detected using a light-dependent resistor in place of the
thermistor.
A diode is a component that allows electric current to
flow in one direction only. Its circuit symbol (Figure
19.9a) represents this by showing an arrow to indicate
the direction in which current can flow. Remember that
the arrow in the diode symbol shows the direction in
which conventional current can flow through the diode.
The bar shows that current is stopped if it tries to flow in
the opposite direction. It can help to think of a diode as
being a ‘waterfall’ in the circuit (Figure 19.9b). Charge
can flow over the waterfall, but it cannot flow in the
opposite direction, which would be uphill. Some diodes
give out light when a current flows through them (Figure
19.9c). A diode that does this is called a light-emitting
diode (LED). Again, it can help to think of the waterfall.
As the charge flows over the waterfall, some of the
energy it loses is given out as light.
,
Light-emitting diodes are familiar in many pieces of
electronic equipment. For example, they are used as the
small indicator lights that show whether a.stereo system
or television is on. Modem traffic lights often use arrays
of bright, energy-efficient LEDs in place ®f filament
bulbs. These LED arrays use very little power, so they are
much cheaper to run than traditional traffic lights. Also,
they require little maintenance, because, if one LED fails,
the remainder still emit light.
charge can flow
this way
Figure 19.8: An alarm circuit that uses a relay.
Question
4
a
b
c
Redraw the circuit shown in Figure 19.8 so that
a heater only comes on in the daytime. Include
a light-dependent resistor in place of the
thermistor and a heater in place of the lamp.
Explain why the heater would be cold when the
LDR is in darkness.
Explain why the heater would be hot when light
shines on the LDR.
Figure 19.9a: Circuit symbol for a diode. A diode allows
current to flow in one direction only - in the direction of
the arrow, b: A diode is like a waterfall. Charge can flow
downhill, but is prevented from flowing back uphill, c: Circuit
symbol for a light-emitting diode. The arrows represent the
light that is emitted when a current flows through it.
KEY WORDS
diode: an electrical component that allows
electric current to flow in one direction only
light-emitting diode (LED) a type of diode that
emits light when a current flows through it
352
>
1 9 Electric circuits
Questions
5
A diode will allow an electric current to flow in one
direction only. Using a lamp, battery and diode,
draw a circuit diagram in which:
a the lamp lights
b the lamp does not light.
6
A friend wants to produce the I-V characteristic of
a diode. Draw the circuit diagram that he will need
to build.
19.2 Combinations
of resistors
If you have two resistors, there are two ways they can be
connected together in a circuit: in series and in parallel.
This is illustrated for two 10 Q resistors in Figure 19.10.
It is useful to be able to work out the total resistance of
two resistors like this. What is their combined resistance
or effective resistance?
For the two 10 Q resistors in series in Figure 19.10a, the
current has to flow through two resistors instead of one.
The resistance in the circuit is doubled, so the combined
resistance is 20 Q.
For the two 10 Q resistors in parallel in Figure 19.10b,
there are two possible paths for the current to flow along,
instead of just one. The resistance in the circuit is halved,
so the effective resistance is 5 Q.
a
10Q
10Q
20 Q
I—>-
I
effective resistance
10Q
We have not really proved these values for the combined
or effective resistance, but you should see that they are
reasonable values.
To recognise when two resistors are connected in series,
trace the path of the current around the circuit. If all the
current flows through one resistor and then through the
other (as in Figure 19.10a), the resistors are connected
in series. They are connected end-to-end. For resistors in
parallel, the current flows differently.
It flows around the circuit until it reaches a point where
the circuit divides (as at point X in Figure 19.10b). Then
some of the current flows through one resistor, and
some flows through the other. Then the two currents
recombine (as at point Y in Figure 19.10b) and return to
the cell. Resistors in parallel are connected side-by-side.
Resistors in series
If several resistors are connected in series, then the current
must flow through them all, one after another. The
combined resistance, R, in the circuit is simply the sum
of all the separate resistances. For three resistors in series
(Figure 19.1 la), the equation for their combined resistance is:
R = Rt + R2 + R3
Figure 19.11b shows the same current, I, flowing through
three resistors. Remember, current cannot be used
up because charge is conserved. We can calculate the
combined resistance for this circuit:
combined resistance 10 Q + 20 Q + 20 Q = 50 Q
So the three resistors could be replaced by a single 50 Q
resistor and the current in the circuit would be the same.
So, for resistors in series:
• the combined resistance is equal to the sum of the
resistances
current is the same at all points around the circuit
the
•
• the bigger the resistance, the bigger the p.d. across it.
=
a
b
R,
R2
R3
10V
5Q
effective resistance
Figure 1 9.1 0: Two ways of connecting two resistors in a
circuit, a: In series, b: In parallel.
Figure 19.11a: Three resistors connected in series, b: Values
of current and p.d. in a series circuit. The same current, /,
flows through each of the three resistors.
353
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
When the current through an electrical conductor
is constant, the p.d. across it will increase when its
resistance increases. For example, as long as the
combined resistance of the three resistors in Figure
1 9. 1 lb is kept the same, the current at every point in the
series circuit will remain the same. However, there is a
bigger p.d. across the bigger resistors. In fact, the p.d.
is proportional to resistance. The p.d. across the 20 Q
resistors is double the voltage across the 10 (1 resistor.
If the three resistors were replaced by one 50 Q resistor
then there would be a p.d. of 10 V across it (equal to the
cell voltage). It might seem odd to think of conductors
having resistance but even the best conductors have
resistance (although superconductivity - conduction with
zero resistance - is an area of active research).
So, for two resistors in parallel:
•
the effective resistance is less than the resistance of
either resistor
•
the current from the source is greater than the
current through either resistor.
Questions
7
8
What are the advantages of connecting lamps in
parallel in a lighting circuit?
Three resistors are connected in series with a battery,
as shown in Figure 19.13.
Resistors in parallel
The lights in a conventional house are connected in
parallel with one another. The reason for this is that each
one requires the full voltage of the mains supply to work
properly. If they were connected in series, the p.d. would
be shared between them and they would be dim. In
parallel, each one can be provided with its own switch, so
that it can be operated separately. If one lamp fails, the
others remain lit.
The effective resistance of several resistors connected in
parallel is less than that of any of the individual resistors.
This is because it is easier for the current to flow. You can
see this for two resistors in parallel in Figure 19.12a. The
current flowing from the source divides up as it passes
through the resistors. Figure 19. 12b shows the current
from the power supply splitting up and passing through
two resistors in parallel.
Resistor A has the greatest resistance of the three.
The current through A is 1.4 A. What can you say
about the currents through B and C?
9
What is the combined resistance of three 30 Q
resistors connected in series?
Voltage in series circuits
When resistors are connected in series with each other in
a circuit with a power supply, there is a p.d. across each
resistor. From the numerica) example shown in Figure
19.1 lb, you can see that adding up the p.d.s across the
three separate resistors gives the p.d. of the power supply.
In other words, the p.d. of the supply is shared between
the resistors. We can write this as an equation:
V= Vl+V2+V3
Figure 19.12a: Two resistors connected in parallel, b: Values
of current and p.d. in a parallel circuit. The current flowing
from the supply is shared between the resistors.
354
>
Festive lights, such as those used to celebrate different
festivals, are often wired together in series. This is
because each bulb works on a small voltage. If a single
bulb was connected to the mains supply, the p.d. across
it would be too great. By connecting them in series, the
mains voltage is shared out between them. There is a
disadvantage; if one bulb fails (its filament breaks), they
all go out. This is because there is no longer a complete
circuit for the current to flow around.
1 9 Electric circuits
WORKED EXAMPLE 19.1
Question
Three 5.0 fl resistors are connected in series with a
12 V power supply. Calculate the combined resistance
of the three resistors, the current that flows in the
circuit, and the p.d. across each resistor.
1 0 One 4 fl resistor and one 6 fl resistor are connected
in a series circuit with a 6 V power supply. Calculate:
a the combined resistance of the two resistors
b the current that flows in the circuit
c the p.d. across each resistor.
Step 1: Draw a circuit diagram and mark on it all
the quantities you know. Add arrows to show
how the current flows (Figure 19.14)
Potential divider circuits
Often, a power supply or a battery provides a fixed
potential difference. To obtain a smaller p.d., or a
variable p.d., this fixed p.d. must be split up using a
circuit called a potential divider. Figure 19.15 shows two
forms of potential divider.
KEY WORDS
Figure 19.14: Sketch diagram.
Step 2: Calculate the combined resistance.
R = Ry + R2 + R2
7? = 5.On + 5.OQ + 5.OQ
R- I5fl
Step 3: Calculate the current flowing. A p.d. of 12 V
is pushing current through a resistor of 15 fl
total resistance. So:
y
—
_
current I =
12V
15fl
= 0.8 A
Step 4: Calculate the p.d. across an individual
5.0 fl resistor when a current of 0.8 A flows
through it.
p.d. F=/J? 0.8A x 5.0fi = 4.0V
potential divider: part of a circuit consisting
of two resistors connected in series to obtain a
smaller voltage than supplied
In the circuit shown in Figure 19.15a, two resistors R^
and Rb are connected in series across the 6 V power
supply. The p.d. across the pair is thus 6 V. (It helps
to think of the bottom line as representing 0 V and
the top line as 6 V.) The p.d. at point X, between the
two resistors, will be part-way between 0 V and 6 V,
depending on the values of the resistors. If the resistors
are equal, the p.d. at X will be 3 V. The p.d. of the supply
will have been divided in half, hence the name ‘potential
divider’.
To produce a variable output, we replace the
two resistors with a variable resistor, as shown in
Figure 19. 15b. By altering the resistance of the variable
resistor, the voltage at X can have any value between 0 V
and 6 V.
=
Note that the 12 V of the supply is shared out
equally between the resistors, since each has the same
resistance. So, we could have worked out the p.d.
across an individual resistor without knowing the
current (12 V -i-3 4 V).
=
Answer
The combined resistance of the three resistors is 15 Q,
the current that flows in the circuit is 0.8 A, and the
p.d. across each resistor is 4.0 V.
355
)
More about potential divider circui
In the circuit shown in Figure 19.16a, the p.d. across tl
lamp is equal to the e.m.f. across the cell (that is, 9 V).
b
6V
V = 6V
ov
Figure 19.15a: A simple potential-divider circuit. The output
voltage is a fraction of the input voltage. The input voltage is
divided according to the relative values of the two resistors,
b: A variable resistor is used to create a potential divider
circuit, which gives an output voltage that can be varied.
Question
11 a
b
Two resistors are going to be connected to
form a potential divider circuit. Should they
be connected in series or in parallel with
each other?
State briefly the function of a potential
divider circuit.
Normally, when the resistance of an electrical conductor
is increased, the current through it decreases. However,
the current through a pair of resistors will be constant if
their total resistance is constant. If the resistance of one
resistor is increased, the resistance of the other resistor
has to be decreased to maintain the same total resistance
and the same constant current. The p.d. will be bigger
across the bigger resistor. This is what is happening in
Figure 19.15b. The current through the variable resistor
is constant but the resistance (and the voltage) above and
below X changes.
356
y
Figure 19.16: Potential divider circuits.
The circuit in Figure 19.16b has two lamps in series witl
a 9 V cell. Imagine that the resistance of both lamps is
1 fl. We can calculate the current through this series
circuit using the equation R V which is the equation
1'
we used to define resistance.
V 9V 4.5 A
R 2fl
This allows us to work out the voltage across each lamp
using V IR:
=
_
=
=
4.5 Ax
= 4.5V
^F2 == 4.5Ax
V
1 =
1Q
fl
4.5
Notice that these voltages add up to the e.m.f. of the cel
^ceii=
+ F2 = 4.5 V + 4.5 V = 9V
1 9 Electric circuits
=
Now imagine that lamp 1 has a resistance of R} 60 and
lamp 2 has a resistance of R2 30 (as in Figure 19.16c).
The combined resistance is R R1+R2 60 + 30 = 90.
=
=
=
This time the current through the series circuit is:
^
CONTINUED
Step 2: Write down the potential divider equation
applied to this problem.
*i=Zl
= ^=1.0A
R 90
This time the voltage across each lamp is:
/?2
r2
Step 3: Substitute values from the question.
= 1.0A x 60 = 6.0V
K2 = 1.0A x 30 = 3.0V
F]
600Q _8V_2
Again, the p.d. across each lamp adds up to the e.m.f. of
the cell. However, this time the p.d. across lamp 1 is twice
as high as the p.d. across lamp 2, which is exactly the
same ratio as their resistances:
R2
4V
Step 4: Rearrange and solve for R2.
/? =
600 300Q
=
2
Answer
The series resistor, R2, needs a value of 3000.
*2 V2
KEY EQUATION
Resistance for two resistors used as a potential divider:
Question
r2
12 a
r2
b
Work out V\ and Fjn in Figure 19.18a.
Work out K] and R} in Figure 19.18b.
This seems to makes sense. The bigger the resistance of
the lamp, the bigger the work done per unit charge, or
voltage, required to push the charge through it.
WORKED EXAMPLE 19.2
A potential divider circuit is required to produce an
output voltage of 8 V across a resistor, R}, of 600 Q.
The supply voltage is 12 V. What is the required value
of the series resistor, R2?
Step 1: Sketch a circuit diagram and mark on the
information from the question (Figure 19.17).
Remember to add in the voltage across R2
(the sum of the voltages across resistors in a
series circuit must add up to the cell voltage;
so, 12V = 8V + 4V).
R2 = ?Q
4V
supply voltage = 12 Y
R, = 600 Q
Y, = 8V
Figure 19.18
Figure 19.17: Sketch diagram.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Current and resistance in
parallel circuits
In the same way that energy is conserved (Chapter 6),
electric charge is also conserved. Electrons in an electric
circuit cannot appear from nowhere or disappear.
Because charge is conserved, the charge arriving at any
junction in a circuit must equal the charge (and therefore
the current) leaving the same junction. This means that
the total current (I = Q/t) coming into a junction must
equal the total current (charge/time) leaving the same
junction. Imagine cars arriving at a junction in the road:
the number of cars leaving the junction must equal the
number of cars that arrived. If that were not the case,
the cars and their passengers would need to appear from
nowhere or disappear, which would be quite alarming.
Therefore, we know that current divides up to pass
through the branches of a parallel circuit. Adding up
the currents through the two separate resistors gives the
current flowing out of the power supply. The current
from the supply is the sum of the currents flowing
through the resistors:
Because the resistors are connected side by side, each
feels the full push of the supply.
To calculate the effective resistance R for two resistors in
parallel, we use this equation:
l=±+±
R
R,
R2
There are two ways to calculate this type of sum: either
use a calculator, or add up the fractions by finding their
lowest common denominator. Worked Example 19.3
shows how to use this equation, and how to work out the
sum by finding the lowest common denominator.
WORKED EXAMPLE 19.3
One 10 (2 resistor and a 30 Q resistor are connected in
parallel with a 12 V power supply. Calculate:
a the effective resistance of the two resistors
b the current through each resistor
c the current flowing from the power supply.
Step 1: Sketch a circuit diagram and mark on it all the
quantities you know (Figure 19.19). Add arrows
to show how the current flows, like this:
-
+ 12 V
o
o
R, = 1OQ
EZZ
>
"
Figure 19.19: Sketch circuit.
Step 2: Calculate the effective resistance.
R2
7?
1=
R
358
>
_L + _1_
1
_ ion4
R
30(2
R
= 7.5 (2
30(2
12^
Step 3: Each resistor has a p.d. of
across it. Now
we can calculate the currents using the equation:
current I through 10 (2 resistor =
\
current I through 30 (2 resistor
12V
10Q
= 1.2A
= 12V
30(2
= 0.4 A
Notice that, as you might expect, the smaller
(10 Q) resistor has a bigger current flowing
through it than the larger (30 (2) resistor.
The current, I, flowing from the supply is
the sum of the currents flowing through the
individual resistors.
1= 1.2A + 0.4A
= 1.6A
Note: we could have reached the same result
using the effective resistance (7.5 (2) of the
circuit that we found in Step 2:
I=
^=^=
L6A
R 7.5(2
This is a useful way to check that you have
calculated the effective resistance correctly.
Current divides in a parallel circuit, but the
total amount must remain the same - electrons
cannot just disappear.
19
Electric circuits
CONTINUED
Answers
b The 10 0 resistor has a current of 1.2 A flowing
a The two resistors together have an effective
resistance of 7.50.
through it. The 30 0 resistor has a current of
0.4 A flowing through it.
c There is a 1.6 A charge flowing from the power supply.
Questions
1 3 Use the idea of resistors in series to explain why a
long wire has more resistance than a short wire (of
the same thickness and material).
14 Use the idea of resistors in parallel to explain why a
thick wire has less resistance than a thin wire (of the
same length and material).
15 A 15.0 0 resistor is connected in series with a 30.0 0
resistor and a 15.0 V power supply.
a Calculate the current flowing around the circuit,
b Which resistor will have the larger share of the
p.d. across it?
C
1 6 One 6 0 resistor and one 4 0 resistor are connected
in parallel with a 6 V power supply. Calculate:
a the effective resistance of the two resistors
b the current through each resistor
c the current flowing from the power supply.
"D
R5= 8 Q
Putting it all together
We now have enough knowledge to calculate the
currents and voltages in more complex circuits. Electrical
engineers often sketch equivalent circuits in order to
solve them and we will do the same. For each resistor
in Figure 19.20a, we are going to work out the current
passing through it and the potential difference across
it. Most of the steps can be done in a different order.
It is the problem-solving strategy (or approach) that
is important here. You may need to read through this
example several times. Once you think you can follow the
steps, cover up the working and see if you can solve it
yourself. It may take you several attempts.
In Figure 19.20a, there is the same e.m.f. of 9 V across
both branches of this circuit (that is, 9 V between A and
B and as 9 V between C and E):
E
Figure 19.20: Circuit diagram examples.
The pair of series resistors R2 and R^ between C and D
can be replaced with a single resistor of their combined
resistance as shown in Figure 19.20b:
R34 = R3 + R^ = 4 0 + 40 = 8 0
There is now a pair of parallel resistors (R2 and R34)
between C and D. They can be replaced with a single
resistor (Rcd) as shown in Figure 19.20c:
_L = ± + _L
^CD ^2 ^34
e.m.f. = UAB = UCE = 9 V
_L = _L + JL
R^d 80 80
The current through Rt:
1
_ 16
Rcd
640
r
AB
_ ^AB
7?!
_ 9V _ 1.5A
60
= 40
359
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
The combined resistance of the series resistors between C
and E (Figure 19.20c) is:
Rq^
0.75"A
A
c 0.375 A
— /^cd + ^5 = 4 0 + 8 Q — 12 Q
The current between C and E is:
T
mr A
A
- ^CE - 9 V = 0.75
ZCe
C
_
*CE
12Q
The p.d. across jR5:
^5 = W5 = 0.75Ax8Q = 6V
The p.d. across R^-.
VCD = /CERCD = 0.75 A x 40 = 3 V
These potential differences add up to the e.m.f. of the
source, as expected.
Figure 19.21
The current entering junction A (Figure 19.20a) must
equal the current leaving the junction:
Resistor
Source
^source ~ ^AB + /ce = 1-5 A + 0.75 A = 2.25 A.
1
Voltage/V
9.0
9.0
Current /A
2.25
1.5
2
3.0
0.375
Resistor
3
4
5
Voltage/V
1.5
1.5
Current/A
0.375
0.375
If you look at Figure 19.20b, you will see that there
are two paths between C and D. Both paths have equal
resistance and there is the same p.d. of 3 V across them;
they must each carry half of the total current between C
and D. This can be confirmed by working out the current
in either branch between C and D:
T
^cd _ 3 V 0.375A
- ^CD
-
R34
80
At D, the 0.375 A that has come down the left-hand
branch joins with the 0.375 A that has come down the
right-hand branch so that 0.75 A passes between D
and E.
Now that we have the current through the pair of series
resistors between C and D (R3 and R4) we can work out
the p.d. dropped across each. Their resistance values are
the same so they should each have a half share of the
drop in p.d. between C and D (that is, 1.5 V across each
of them). We can confirm this:
F= ZCD x R3 = Icd x l?4
Table 19.1
\
Question
1 7 Work out the current through, and the voltage
across, each lamp in the circuit (Figure 19.22).
Summarise your results in a table like Table 19.1.
= 0.375A x 40 = 1.5 V
All the current and voltage values are summarised in
Figure 19.21 and Table 19.1.
Figure 19.22
360
>
0.75
1 9 Electric circuits
ACTIVITY 19.1
Series and parallel combinations of resistors
Task 1: Thinking about resistor combinations
Your teacher will give you some time to write down answers to the following questions:
•
What is used to measure current and how is it included in circuit? Draw a sketch if it helps.
• What is used to measure voltage and how is it included in circuit? Draw a sketch if it helps.
• How can the resistance of an electrical component (such as a lamp) be measured?
• How can we calculate the total resistance for resistors in series?
• How can we calculate the effective resistance for two resistors in parallel?
• How is it possible to make more than one cell into a battery and does it matter which way round the
cells are?
The two circuits, which are described below, use two lamps, a 3.0 V battery, and a switch. Assume that each
lamp has a resistance of 5 fl. Use this information to work out the missing values. Show your working and then
write your answers onto a copy of Tables 19.2 and 19.3. Leave the shaded boxes blank.
Part 1: Series circuit
Use a pencil and a ruler to draw a neat series circuit with two lamps in series with a 3.0 V battery and
a switch.
Calculated current / A
Calculated voltage / V
Resistance / fl
3.0
battery
lamp 1
lamp 2
circuit
Table 19.2
Part 2: Parallel circuit
Use a pencil and a ruler to draw a neat circuit using the same components you used for the series circuit
with the lamps in parallel. Make it clear where you think the switch should be placed.
Calculated current / A
battery
Calculated voltage / V
Resistance / fl
3.0
lamp 1
lamp 2
circuit
Table 19.3
Your teacher will decide how you will check your answers and help resolve any misunderstandings.
361
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Part 3: Design your own
1 Design a slightly more complicated circuit (for example, two parallel lamps in series with a third lamp).
2
3
Predict the voltages and currents for all three lamps and the battery.
Write a question based on your circuit to test another student or pair of students.
Task 2: Building resistor combinations (optional)
If you have the time and equipment you may get the chance to build the circuits you have drawn in Task 1.
Alternatively, you could build virtual circuits in an online simulation. If you are building physical circuits you
will need:
•
•
•
•
•
•
two 2.5 V lamps in holders
at least two 1 ,5 V D cells in cell holders
at least nine electrical leads
voltmeter
ammeter
switch.
If you are building physical circuits you need to be aware of the following things.
The actual value of a component will be different from the value printed on its case. When using your circuits,
ensure that the switch is closed (pressed) only when taking measurements, otherwise the cells will drain quickly
and the e.m.f. will change. The resistance of different lamps will also vary so the p.d. across them will not be
the same.
The 2.5 V lamps need a p.d. of at least 2.0 V to light up. However, your circuits should still work (giving sensible
ammeter and voltmeter readings) when the lamps do not light up.
If you use a copy of the tables (Tables 19.4 and 19.5) to record your results, leave the shaded boxes blank. The
number at the top-left hand corner of each cell refers to the step number. This is to make it easier for you to
find where you should be writing in your numbers. Do your working in your exercise book.
Ignore (do not record) any negative signs on the voltmeter or ammeter. A negative sign tells you that the meter is
connected the wrong way round (the current is passing in the wrong direction) but this does not affect the value.
Part 1: Series circuit
Use a pencil and a ruler to draw a neat series circuit with two 2.5 V lamps in series with a 3.0 V battery, a
1
switch and an ammeter.
2
3
Build the circuit you have already drawn. Label the lamps as 'lamp T and 'lamp 2' and keep track of them.
By moving the ammeter, measure the current next to lamp 1, lamp 2 and the battery. Record your
values in a table like Table 19.4.
Voltage / V
Current / A
predicted
predicted
measured
measured
Resistance / Q
predicted
calculated
battery
1.3
1.4
lamp 1
1.3
1.4
1.7
1.6
1.7
lamp 2
circuit
1.3
1.5
1.8
Table 19.4
4
362
Measure the e.m.f. across the battery and the p.d. across lamp 1 and record your values.
>
19 Electric circuits
CONTINUED
5
6
Using your values from step 4, predict the p.d. across lamp 2 and record your prediction.
Measure the p.d. across lamp 2 and record your value.
Work out the resistance for each lamp by dividing the p.d. across it by the current passing through it by
using R = y. Record your values.
8
Work out the total resistance of the two resistors in series. Use the total resistance of the series circuit
and the battery e.m.f. to work out what the current should be and compare this to the value you
actually measured (in part 1, step 3).
Part 2: Parallel circuit
Use a pencil and a ruler to draw a neat parallel circuit using the same components you have already
used with the series circuit.
2
3
Build the circuit you have just drawn.
Use the e.m.f. of the battery to predict the voltage across the battery and each lamp. Record your
predictions in a table like Table 19.5.
Voltage / V
Current / A
predicted
battery
lamp 1
lamp 2
measured
predicted
measured
Resistance / 0
predicted
calculated
2.7
2.8
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.3
2.4
2.9
2.5
2.6
2.3
2.4
2.9
circuit
2.10
Table 19.5
5
Measure and record the e.m.f. across the battery and the p.d. across each lamp.
Use the resistance values you have already calculated (from part 1, step 7) to predict the current
through each lamp (I = ^).
6
Measure and record the current through each lamp.
Use the measured currents through the two lamps to predict the current through the battery.
8
Measure the current through the battery and compare this to the value you predicted in step 7.
9
Use the voltage and current data you have collected for the parallel circuit to calculate the resistance of
each lamp and record your values.
10 Calculate the effective resistance of the circuit and record your value.
11 Use the battery e.m.f. and the effective resistance of the parallel circuit to predict the current through
the battery. Compare it to your measurement (in part 2, step 8).
Part 3: Design your own
Now that you have some experience, look back at the circuit you designed yourself (Task 1, part 3). Use the
values you have found for the battery e.m.f. and the resistance values of lamps to work out the current and
voltage values throughout your circuit. Now build the circuit and check if you were correct.
}
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Did the current change as it flowed around the series circuit?
What is the relationship between the p.d. across the lamps and the e.m.f of the battery in the series circuit?
What is the relationship between the p.d. across the lamps and the e.m.f. of the battery in a parallel circuit?
What is the relationship between the current through the lamps and the current through the battery in a
parallel circuit?
Are the resistance values for the lamps in the two circuits different? If they are, can you suggest why?
Show algebraically that for two resistors in parallel, the effective resistance is the product of their values
divided by the sum of their values: R =
Ri + R2
PEER ASSESSMENT
CONTINUED
Look at the circuit diagrams drawn by your
neighbour and look at how they built the circuits
based on their diagrams. Give your neighbour
feedback on how they drew their circuits. The
circuits should have been drawn clearly using the
correct symbols, with a pencil and a ruler. If your
neighbour had difficulty drawing or building the
circuits can you give them some suggestions that
might make it easier for them?
REFLECTION
This activity involved drawing circuits from a
description and then building the circuit.
Rate how easy you found both these steps on a
scale from 1 (very easy) to 5 (very hard).
If you found either or both steps difficult, what
would make them easier?
ACTIVITY 19.2
Make a table like Table 1 9.6 and fill it in to
summarise the rules for current and voltage in
series and parallel circuits.
Current
How much do I know about circuits?
Spend a couple of minutes labelling a copy of
the circuit diagrams in Figure 19.23 with as much
information as you know, including arrows to show
the direction of the current. Assume each lamp has
a different resistance. Explain what is happening
at different points of the circuit and include the
following words: current, potential difference,
junction.
364
>
series
parallel
Table 19.6
Voltage
19
19.3 Electrical safety
Mains electricity is hazardous, because of the large
voltages involved. If you come into contact with a bare
wire at 230 V, you could get a fatal electric shock. Here,
we will look at some aspects of the design of electrical
systems and see how they can be used safely.
Electrical cables
The cables that carry electric current around a house are
carefully chosen. Figure 19.24 shows some examples. For
each, there is a maximum current that it is designed to
carry. A 5 A cable (Figure 19.24a) is relatively thin. This
might be used for a lighting circuit, since lights do not
require much power, so the current flowing is relatively
small. The wires in a 30 A cable (Figure 19.24c) are much
thicker. This might be used for an electric cooker, which
requires much bigger currents than a lighting circuit.
Electric circuits
conductor (see Section 18.1). So, for example, if your
hands are wet when you touch an electrical appliance,
the water may provide a conductive path for current to
flow from a live wire through you to earth. This could
prove fatal.
Multi-plug adapters
The number of electrical appliances people use in their
homes is increasing. The safest option is to have more
wall sockets fitted. The alternative is to use multi-plug
adaptors that allow us to plug more than one device into
the same wall socket. Multi-plug adaptors come in two
main varieties. The safer option is to use a multi-way bar
extension, which comes as a bank of sockets on the end of
an extension lead that can be plugged into a wall socket,
as shown in Figure 19.25. These are generally fitted with a
fuse to match the wall socket (13 A in the UK).
The wires in each cable are insulated from one another,
and the whole cable has more protective insulation
around the outside. If this insulation is damaged, there is
a chance that the user will touch the bare wire and get an
electric shock.
Figure 19.25: A multi-way bar extension with four available
sockets and white electrical cable (on the right). There is a
block adapter with three sockets plugged into the left-hand
end of the extension. Plugging multi-plug adapters together
should be avoided.
Figure 1 9.24: Cables of different thicknesses are chosen
according to the maximum current that they are likely to
have flowing through them, a: 5 A. b: 15 A. c: 30 A. Each
cable has live, neutral and earth wires, which are colour
coded. In these cables, the earth wire does not have its
own insulation.
Another hazard can arise if an excessive current flows
in the wires. They will overheat and the insulation may
melt, causing it to emit poisonous fumes or even catch
fire. Thus it is vital to avoid using appliances that draw
too much current from the supply. Fuses help to prevent
this from happening.
When using electricity, it is important to avoid damp
or wet conditions. Recall that water is an electrical
Be wary of block adaptors, which are plugged directly
into a wall socket. They usually have a cubic shape
and two or more sockets (see the left-hand side of
Figure 19.25). These are less likely to contain a fuse so
there is an increased danger that a current will exceed the
rating of the wall socket. Overloading the socket in this
way increases the chance that it, and the plug, will heat
up and catch fire.
It is important not to exceed the current rating of any
part of the system. Imagine there are four devices, each
drawing a current of 3 A. This would not overload a wall
socket so they could be plugged into the same wall socket
via a fused multi-plug adaptor. However, if an extension
is rated at 10 A, no more than three of its sockets should
be used, even if more sockets are available. Avoid using a
block adapter that does not have a fuse. Never join multi¬
plug adapters together. For example, do not plug a block
adapter into an extension as shown in Figure 19.25.
365
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
1 8 Name the two main types of multi-plug adapters.
1 9 What is often missing from a block adapter that
makes it more dangerous to use than a multi-plug
It is important to choose a fuse of the correct value in
order to protect an appliance. The current rating of the
fuse should be just above the value of the current that
flows when the appliance is operating normally (see
Worked Example 19.4).
adapter?
20 Why is it important not to overload a wall socket or
any multi-plug adapter plugged into it?
Fuses
Fuses are included in circuits to stop excessive currents
from flowing. This protects the circuit and the cabling for
a domestic appliance. If the current gets too high, cables
can burn out and fires can start. A fuse contains a thin
section of wire, designed to melt and break if the current
gets above a certain value. Usually, fuses are contained in
cartridges, which makes it easy to replace them, but some
fuses use fuse wire, as shown in Figure 19.26. The thicker
the wire used for the fuse, the higher the current that is
needed to make it melt (or blow). A fuse represents a
weak link in the electricity supply chain. Replacing a fuse
is preferable to having to rewire a whole house.
KEY WORD
fuse: a device that breaks the circuit if the current
exceeds a certain value; it is a piece of metal wire
that melts when too much current flows through it
WORKED EXAMPLE 19.4
A 2 kW heater works on a 230 V mains supply. The
current flowing through it in normal use is 8.7 A.
What current rating would a suitable fuse have?
• 3A
• 13A
• 30 A.
Step 1: The 3 A fuse has a current rating that is too
low, and it would melt as soon as the heater
was switched on.
Step 2: The 30 A fuse would not melt, but it is
unsuitable because it would allow an
excessive current (say, 20 A) to (Bow, which
could cause the heater to overheat.
Step 3: The 1 3 A fuse is the correct choice, because
it has the lowest rating above the normal
operating current.
Answer
13A
Trip switch
A trip switch can replace a fuse. The switch trips and
breaks the circuit when the current flowing through the
trip switch exceeds a certain value. Some modern house
wiring systems use trip switches instead of fuses in the
fuse box (Figure 19.27). You have probably come across
trip switches on laboratory power supplies. If too much
current starts to flow, the supply itself might overheat
and be damaged. The trip switch jumps out, and you
may have to wait a short while before you can reset it.
KEY WORDS
trip switch: safety device that includes a switch
that opens (trips) when a current exceeds a
certain value
Figure 1 9.26: Cartridge fuses and fuse wire. The thicker the
wire, the higher the current that causes it to melt.
366
>
v
19 Electric circuit*
an electrical plug or an electrical cable, you will have
noticed different coloured wires. Actually, this is the
plastic insulation, and it is colour coded so that people
can wire up plugs and appliances safely. The live wire
(coloured brown in the UK) carries the electrical current
from the wall socket to the electrical appliance (such as a
television) and the neutral wire (blue in the UK) carries
the current back to the socket. There is usually also an
earth wire (yellow and green stripes).
Figure 19.28a shows the wiring when there is no fault.
Notice that the earth wire is connected between the casing
of the appliance and the earth pin of the plug. This is a
schematic diagram (to show you what is happening). The
coloured wires are all inside the electrical cable (see Figure
19.24) and the connection to the metal case is actually
made from inside the appliance.
Figure 19.27: This is where the mains electricity supply
enters a house. On the left is the meter. The white box
contains a trip switch for each circuit in the house, together
with a residual-current device, which protects the users of
any circuit.
Questions
21 In normal use, a current of 3.5 A flows through
a hair dryer. Choose a suitable fuse from the
following: 3 A, 5 A, 13 A, 30 A. Explain your choice.
22 a
b
Why are fuses fitted in the fuse box of a
domestic electricity supply?
What device could be used in place of fuses?
23 What hazards can arise when the current flowing in
an electrical wire is too high?
Using an earth wire or
double insulation
We have already seen why the insulation on wires is
important - to prevent fires or an electric shock. This is
because there is a chance that current will flow between
two bare wires (a short circuit), or from one bare wire
and any piece of metal it comes into contact with.
This is why the metal case of an electrical appliance is
earthed by connecting it to the earth wire. The earth wire
provides a low resistance electrical path to ground and
reduces the chances of a fatal electric shock.
A mains circuit consists of a live (or line) wire, a neutral
wire and an earth wire. These are carried around
buildings as part of the ring mains and we can plug
into it via wall sockets. If you have ever seen inside
Imagine that there is now a fault (Figure 19.28b) and the
live wire touches the metal case. The case will now be at
the mains voltage (230 V in the UK). Anyone touching
the casing could receive a fatal shock. However, the earth
wire provides a low resistance path to ground. You can
trace the path of the current with your finger. It passes
through the live pin at the bottom right of the plug,
along the live wire (through the fuse) to the metal casing
and then along the earth wire. Because the resistance of
this path is low and the voltage is high, a high current
will pass through the fuse, which will almost instantly
melt, stopping any current flowing to the appliance.
A switch on the electrical appliance must be connected
to the live wire. If it was connected to either the neutral
wire or the earth wire, a current could still pass into the
appliance even if the switch was open (off) and this could
lead to a fire or to somebody being electrocuted if they
touched a faulty appliance. Imagine that there was a
fault and a live wire touched the metal casing. Nothing
would happen and no current would flow as long as the
circuit was incomplete (an open circuit). If the casing
touched something that could conduct the current to
ground, then a fire might start. The current could pass
through someone touching the casing, giving them an
electric shock. Think about what would happen if the
fuse was connected to the neutral or earth wire.
KEY WORD
earthed: when the case of an electrical appliance
is connected to the earth wire of a three-pin
plug; the earth wire is electrically connected to
the ground to prevent current passing through
anyone touching a faulty appliance
367
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
KEY WORDS
double insulated: when the electric circuit for an
electrical appliance is placed inside a case made
from an electrical insulator so that it is impossible
for a live wire to touch the outer casing
wire touches
metal case
Questions
wiring in
appliance
danger:
current flows
through metal
earth wire
connected to case
Figure 1 9.28a: How the current flows from the live pin of the
plug along the live wire (brown) to the appliance and back to
the plug and socket along the neutral wire (blue), b: When
there is a fault and a bare wire in the appliance touches the
metal casing, the current flows through the earth wire (green
and yellow stripes) instead of the neutral wire, and the fuse
melts because a large current flows along this low resistance
path.
Electrical appliances that are double insulated do not
need an earth connection (only two wires are wired into
the three-pin plug). Even if there are metal parts on the
outer casing, the electrical circuit for the appliance is
inside a case underneath, which is made from electrically
insulating material (for example, plastic) so that an
electric current cannot pass through it. There is no way
that a live conductor could touch the outer case. This
means that there is no way that somebody touching
the outer case could be electrocuted. When the symbol
shown in Figure 19.29 is stuck to the casing of an
electrical appliance, then it is double insulated.
Figure 1 9.29: The symbol for double insulation. If you see
this stuck to the casing of electrical appliance then it will not
need an earth wire.
368
y
24 Explain how an earth wire makes an electrical
device safe.
25 Why must a switch be connected to the live wire and
not the earth wire or neutral wire?
26 Why should a fuse be connected to the live wire and
not the earth wire or neutral wire?
27 Explain how a fuse works.
28 What is double insulation?
I
ACTIVITY 19.2
Challenging misconceptions using refutation
texts
If what you think about an idea is incorrect then
you have a misconception. A refutation text is
when you state the misconception and then write
down the correct idea.
Most people talk about the cell or battery in
mobile phones running out of charge believing
that, when we charge our phones, we are
transferring charge (electrons) into it. However,
this cannot be true or we might get an electric
shock when we pick up a fully charged phone! The
cell or battery is more like a pump, pushing the
charges round the circuit. Here is an example of a
refutation text about charging a phone:
'Some people think that electrons are passing
into the battery when we charge it up, but we are
transferring energy to its battery.'
Complete each statement to refute the incorrect
idea:
1 Some people think that current gets used up
by a lamp, but ...
2 Some people think that all the lamps in a series
circuit will be the same brightness, but ...
3 Some people believe that the current
through both lamps in a parallel circuit will be
the same, but ...
19 Electric circuits
PROJECT
The shocking truth about electrical safety
Read the following passage.
Summary of government research into recent
house fires and hospital admissions
The frequency of house fires and people experiencing
electric shocks in the home ( some fatal ) has
increased. Our research suggests that people are
confused about electrical safety. For example, more
than two-thirds of people surveyed believe that an
appliance is safe no matter where in the circuit the
fuse is placed. Most of those questioned think it is
safe for the fuse or switch to be on the neutral wire
( on the return side of the circuit). More than 80% of
people think it is safe to fill all the available sockets
on a multi-plug adapter with an appliance as long
as each appliance has a fuse. A public education
campaign should be launched as a matter of urgency.
Emphasise the importance of using the correct
fuse rating and of placing fuses and switches in the
correct place in a circuit.
Option 2: A narrated animation
A narrated animation is a moving picture with a
voiceover. Develop a narrated animation to explain
why fuses and switches should be on the live wire
(the supply side) of an appliance. Show the path
taken by the current when the fuse (and/or switch) is
in the wrong place and a fault occurs (for example,
the live wire touches the metal case). Be careful how
you show the current passing through somebody
to avoid upsetting viewers (by using humour, for
example). Then show the path when the fuse (and/
or switch) is in the correct place. If you do not have
access to animation software you could photograph
a series of drawings to get the same effect.
Option 3: Explaining by storytelling
Option 1: A government leaflet
Design a government information leaflet about
electrical safety. Give it visual impact. Where possible,
use labelled illustrations instead of text. Do not
exceed 100 words. Highlight the dangers of using:
•
•
household electrical appliances in damp
conditions or with damaged insulation
multi-plug adapters (especially those that do
not include a fuse) and of joining multi-plug
adapters together.
Use creative writing (a short story) to explain the
science. For example, pretend that you are an evil
electron on the hunt for unsafe electrical circuits and
describe how you can spot them from the inside. Or
you could be an electron with a sense of adventure,
looking to break free of life moving along a wire.
Use one of these ideas if you cannot think of another
one. Whatever creative device you choose, you need
to avoid getting carried away with the story, though
it does need a clear plot. The story is simply there to
engage the reader; your mission is to get across the
very important safety message.
SUMMARY
A resistor can control the amount of current flowing around a circuit.
A variable resistor can alter the current flowing in a circuit.
A light-dependent resistor (LDR) is a device whose resistance decreases when light shines on it.
A thermistor is a device whose resistance decreases with increasing temperature.
A relay is a switch controlled by an electromagnet.
A diode is a component that allows conventional current to flow only in the direction of the arrow.
A light-emitting diode (LED) is a diode that gives out light when current flows through it.
369
y
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Resistors in series are connected end-to-end.
For resistors in series, the total resistance is the equal to the sum of the resistors.
The current is the same at all points around a series circuit.
The voltage of the source is shared between resistors in a series circuit.
A potential divider circuit uses a pair of resistors to obtain a smaller p.d. than provided by the source.
For resistors arranged in parallel, the effective resistance is less than the value of the smallest resistor.
To calculate the effective resistance, R, for two resistors in parallel, we use the equation
4?R = Rt + vk
R2
The current from the source divides to pass through parallel resistors.
The current from the supply is the sum of the currents flowing through parallel resistors: 1=
+ 12 + 13.
Lights in a house are arranged in parallel so that each has the supply voltage across it and can be controlled by
its own switch.
The metal case of an electrical appliance is earthed by connecting it to the earth wire to prevent current passing
through anyone touching a faulty appliance.
Excessive current through a wire can melt insulation, causing it to emit poisonous fumes or catch ^re.
Using multi-plug adapters (multi-way bar extensions and block adapters) increases the risk of overloading plugs
and sockets.
A fuse contains a thin section of wire, designed to melt and break the circuit if the current gets above a certain
value.
A circuit breaker is a safety device that automatically switches off a circuit when the current becomes too high.
A trip switch is a safety device that includes a switch that opens (trips) when a current exceeds a certain value.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 The circuit diagram shows three meters labelled X, Y and Z. You can
work out whether each of them is a voltmeter or ammeter from the way
in which they are connected. The switch is open.
370
>
19
Electric circuits
CONTINUED
When the switch is closed, the readings on the meters change.
Choose the correct combination from the options available.
X
Y
Z
A
increases
decreases
increases
B
decreases
decreases
increases
C
increases
increases
decreases
D
decreases
increases
decreases
[1]
2 The circuit shows three lamps and two ammeters in a circuit.
When lamp X stops working (the filament breaks), the readings on the
meters change. Choose the correct combination from the options available.
Reading on
Reading on
ammeter 1
ammeter 2
A
decreases
increases
Total resistance
of circuit
decreases
B
decreases
increases
increases
C
increases
decreases
decreases
D
increases
increases
increases
[1 ]
3 Two resistors R] and R2 are connected in series. Resistor R[ has double the
resistance of resistor R2.
Four possible statements about this circuit are:
1 The voltage across 7?] is twice that across R2.
2 The voltage across R2 is twice that across Rb
3 The current is the same in both resistors.
4 The current in R] is twice the current in R2.
Which pair of statements is correct?
A 1 and 4
B 2 and 3
Cl and 3
[1]
D 2 and 4
371
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
COMMAND WORD
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
372
>
19 Electric circuits
CONTINUED
The table gives the current through three of the ammeters. Copy and
complete the table to show the current through the other two ammeters. [2]
complete the table to
[3]
place.
[Total: 5]
6 The circuit diagram shows part of a sensing circuit. The LED is to be used as
a temperature warning indicator when the temperature exceeds a certain value.
The LED requires a current of at least 14 mA in order to switch on (that is,
emit light).
a Name the component labelled R in the circuit diagram.
b State the minimum current through component R when the LED s
emitting light.
Calculate the voltage across the component R when the LED is lit.
d Calculate the resistance of R to ensure that a current of 14 mA
passes through it.
The resistance of component R decreases as the temperature increases.
Determine what happens to the size of the current through the LED
as the temperature increases.
[1]
COMMAND WORDS
[1]
[1]
state: express in
clear terms
[1]
determine: establish
an answer using the
information available
[11
[Total: 5]
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
7 Many circuits contain fuses. Figure 19.26 shows a cartridge fuse. A lamp is
connected to the mains supply and takes a current of 6.2 A.
a State two reasons why is a fuse is included in the circuit.
b Which of these fuses should be used with the lamp?
[1 ]
[1]
COMMAND WORD
[2]
c Explain how a fuse works.
[1 ]
d Name another device that does the same job as a fuse.
e Explain why is it important to avoid touching a lamp or other electrical
[2]
appliance with wet hands.
f State what can be attached to the metal case of an electrical appliance
to prevent an electric shock if the appliance is faulty.
[1]
[Total: 8]
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
A 3A
B 5A
C 7A
D 13A
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
v
1 can
Recall what LDRs and thermistors are.
Describe what a relay is and describe how it works in a
switching circuit.
See
Topic...
19.1
19.1
Describe what diodes and LEDs do and how they work.
19.1
Recall whether current varies around a series circuit.
19.2
Calculate the combined resistance of two or more
resistors in series.
19.2
State the relative size of current through the source (for
example, a cell or battery) and each branch of a parallel
circuit.
19.2
State how the combined resistance of two resistors in
parallel compares to the resistance of either resistor by
itself.
19.2
State the advantages of connecting lamps in parallel in
a lighting circuit.
19.2
Recall and use the relationship between the sum of the
p.d.s across the components in a series circuit and the
p.d. across the source (for example, a cell).
19.2
374
)
Needs
Almost
more work there
Confident
to move on
1
1 9 Electric circuits
CONTINUED
1
1
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Recall and use the relationship between the current
from the source and the sum of the currents in the
separate branches of a parallel circuit.
19.2
Calculate the effective resistance of two resistors in
parallel.
19.2
Describe the action of a potential divider.
19.2
State the hazards of using electrical appliances in
damp conditions, when cables overheat or when
insulation is damaged.
19.3
State the hazards of using multi-plug adapters.
19.3
State what a fuse is used for and describe how it
works.
19.3
Choose appropriate fuse ratings and circuit breaker
settings.
19.3
Explain the benefits of earthing the metal case of an
electric appliance.
19.3
State what a trip switch is and how it works.
19.3
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
ectromagneti
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
investigate the magnetic fields around current-carrying conductors
describe some practical uses of electromagnets
observe the force on a current-carrying conductor in a magnetic field
describe the principle of an electric motor and list ways of increasing its strength
describe the factors affecting the strength and direction of electromagnetic fields and forces
describe the structure and operation of an electric motor.
20 Electromagnetic forces
GETTING STARTED
In Chapter 16 you studied magnetism. Chapters
17-19 covered electricity. As you can tell from the
title, this chapter brings electricity and magnetism
together. There are many links between the two,
and also, important differences.
On a large sheet of paper, copy and complete
the Venn diagram shown in Figure 21.1. In the
overlapping section, write all the things which are
similar. In the other sections, write down things
which only apply to electricity or to magnetism. Two
examples are given for you.
Electromagnetism was first described by a Danish
scientist named Oersted in the early 19th century.
Use the ideas you have recorded to discuss what
might have lead Oersted to think there was a link
between electricity and magnetism.
THE MAGIC OF MOTORS
make our lives easier and better use motors. Just
think for a moment about how different your life
would be without motors.
Motors have many medical applications. They are
widely used in prosthetic limbs, and can pump
fluids such as blood during dialysis. Surgeons can
remotely control motorised devices to make surgery
less invasive.
Figure 20.2: Small motors in prosthetic limbs allow a
greater range of movement for people using them.
Some things in science seem magical. For example,
the fact that a plant can feed itself using sunlight
is amazing. The electric motor is another example
of the magic of science. As you will discover in this
chapter, putting together an electric current and a
magnetic field creates movement. This is the basis of
all electric motors.
Electric motors have revolutionised our lives. It is
easy to take them for granted, but anything you
plug in which involves movement, contains a motor.
Washing machines, hair dryers, electric vehicles,
record players and many more appliances which
Figure 20.2 shows a girl with a prosthetic arm eating
her dinner. Many prosthetic limbs have small motors
inside them, greatly increasing the capabilities
of the artificial limb. Here, the motor allows the
fingers to grip the French fries and apply the right
amount of force to keep hold of them for her to then
eat. Motors can be life changing and in this case,
replaces the movement lost to an amputee.
Discussion questions
1
2
List all the applications of motors you.can
think of. Discuss how the job each application
performs would have been done before motors
were invented.
Discuss if you think there are any other scientific
inventions or discoveries which have had as
much impact as the electric motor.
377 )
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
/
20.1 The magnetic effect
of a current
In Chapter 16, we saw that an electromagnet can be
made by passing a current through a coil of wire (a
solenoid). The flow of current results in a magnetic
field around the solenoid. The field is similar to the field
around a bar magnet (see Figure 16.8).
If you uncoil a solenoid, you will have a straight wire.
With a current flowing through it, it will have a magnetic
field around it as shown in Figure 20.3. The field lines are
circles around the current.
Every electric current creates a magnetic field around it.
An electromagnet uses this effect. Winding the wire into
a coil is a way of concentrating the magnetic field.
The right-hand grip rule tells you the direction of the field
lines. Imagine gripping the wire with your right hand so
that your thumb points in the direction of the current.
The curve of your fingers shows the shape and direction
of the field lines.
Figure 20.3: Magnetic field around a wi|e.
We represent magnetic fields by drawing field lines. The
arrows on the lines show the direction of the field at any
point. A field line shows the direction of the force on a
north magnetic pole placed in the field.
KEY WORDS
right-hand grip rule: a rule which gives the
direction of field lines around a straight wire when
a current flows through it
A solenoid is a length of wire wound to form a coil. It
has a field pattern like that of a bar magnet, with field
lines emerging from a north pole at one end of the coil
and entering a south pole at the other (Figure 16.8).
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 20.1
Investigating the magnetic effect of a current
Oersted's first experiment with electromagnetism
involved just a simple circuit and a plotting
compass. You will see what he observed and look at
the fields around different shapes of wires.
Getting started
In Chapter 16 you investigated the field around a bar
Safety: The wire will become very hot when the
•
What do the iron filings tell you about a
magnetic field?
•
What is the purpose of the plotting compasses?
•
Sketch the magnetic field around a bar magnet.
current flows. Switch the power supply off as
soon as you have made your observations. Avoid
touching the wire.
Iron filings can scratch the cornea of your eye.
Wear eye protection while using iron filings. If you
378
>
get filings in your eye, tell your teacher immediately.
Do not rub your eye as this will make it worse.
magnet.
20 Electromagnetic forces
379
1
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Do your observations agree with this method?
Questions
1
Do your observations of the field around a
straight wire agree with the right-hand grip
rule?
2
In Chapter 16, we saw a method for
determining the polarity of the field around
a solenoid. This depends on the direction of
current flow at each end of the coil.
Comparing the strength and
direction of magnetic fields
3
Current in a wire
Electromagnetism in action - the relay
A current flows downwards in a wire that passes
vertically through a small hole in a table top. Will
the magnetic field lines around it go clockwise or
anticlockwise, as seen from above?
1
Further from the wire, the circular field lines are further
apart, showing that the field is weaker. If the current is
greater, the field will be stronger and so the lines will be
closer together.
A relay is a switch operated by an electromagnet. In
Chapter 19, we saw how a relay can be used in an electric
circuit. One type is shown in Figure 20.8, together with
the circuit symbol.
The direction of the field lines is reversed when the
current is reversed.
Current in a solenoid
The field lines are close together at the poles of the
electromagnet. Further from the coil, the lines are further
apart (illustrating a weaker field). Inside the coil the field
lines run parallel to each other showing that the field is
uniform (its strength is constant). Again, increasing the
current gives a stronger field.
The polarity of the field is reduced when the current
is reversed.
Figure 20.8a: A relay, capable of switching a circuit carrying
hundreds of amps, b: The circuit symbol for a relay. The
rectangle represents the electromagnet coil.
Questions
1
Copy and complete these sentences.
There is a magnetic field around a conductor when
it carries
.
The field lines around a straight wire are
380
•
.
The direction of these field lines can be found using
the
rule.
2
•
•
When switch A is closed, a small current flows around
the circuit through the coil of the electromagnet.
The electromagnet attracts the iron armature. As
the armature tips, it pushes the two contacts at B
together, completing the second circuit.
Notice that there is no electrical connection between
the two circuits.
The field around a solenoid is the same as that
.
around a
KEY WORD
What must be added to a solenoid to make it into an
electromagnet?
armature: the moving part of an electromagnetic
device such as a relay or bell
>
20 Electromagnetic forces
A relay is used to make a small current switch a larger
current on and off. For example, when a driver turns
the ignition key to start a car, a small current flows to
a relay in the engine compartment. This closes a switch
to complete the circuit, which brings a high current
to the starter motor from the battery. This means that
the wires in the dashboard can be thin wires carrying
a small current. This is safer, neater and cheaper than
running thick wires carrying the large current needed
by the starter motor all the way up to the dashboard.
Figure 20.9 shows a relay being used in this way.
PEER ASSESSMENT
Present your work to another group of students.
The audience should give smiley, straight or sad
face feedback on:
• how clear and well labelled the diagram or
model is
• how well the video, series of pictures or
movement of the model shows the way the
primary circuit controls the secondary circuit
• the clarity of the explanation in the voiceover.
Feedback may also include any parts of the
presentation which were particularly helpful, or
suggestions for improvements to the presentation.
REFLECTION
What aspect of this activity did you find most
useful? Giving an explanation or listening to
another student's explanation? If you were to
continue with this activity, would you find the
feedback you received useful?
Questions
ACTIVITY 20.1
4
a
Figure 20.10 shows an electromagnetic relay
used to switch on a motor.
Modelling a relay
It can be difficult to understand the way a relay
works without seeing it in action.
Design a teaching aid to help you describe
it to other students. This could be a video or
storyboard showing the effect of switching on
the small current circuit. Alternatively, you could
create a working model by drawing the relay on
card and having separate moving parts such as the
secondary circuit connections and the armature.
Whichever option you choose, you should write
a voiceover script to describe and explain what is
happening.
Figure 20.10: Relay used to switch on a motor.
Write out these steps in the correct order to explain
what happens when the control switch is closed.
• The contacts close together.
• Current flows through the electromagnetic
coil.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
•
•
•
b
c
Current flows in the motor circuit.
The electromagnet attracts the armature.
The electromagnet is magnetised.
Figure 20.12 shows a way io demonstrate this.
Why is the armature made of iron?
Why must soft iron be used?
Figure 20.11 shows an electromagnet in use in a
signal for a model railway set.
5
Figure 20.1 2: The motor effect. This can be summarised as
current + magnetic field = movement.
When a current is passed through the aluminium foil it
has a magnetic field around it. This interacts with the
field of the strong, permanent magnet creating a force.
The foil has been pushed downwards by this force.
Figure 20.1 1: Electromagnet used as a signal.
Explain what happens when the switch is closed, and
then when it is re-opened.
20.2 Force on a current¬
carrying conductor
The idea of an electric motor is this. There is a magnetic
field around an electric current. This magnetic field can
be attracted or repelled by another magnetic field to
produce movement. This is called the motor effect.
KEY WORDS
motor effect: when current flows in a wire in a
magnetic field which is not parallel to the current,
a force is exerted on the wire
An electric motor has a coil with a current flowing
around it (an electromagnet) in a magnetic field. It turns
because the two magnetic fields interact with each other.
However, it is not essential to have a coil to produce
movement. The basic requirements are:
• a magnetic field
• a current flowing which cuts across the magnetic
field lines.
382
>
The direction of the force can be reversed by:
• reversing the direction of the current
• reversing the direction of the field of the permanen
magnet by turning it round.
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 20.2
The catapult field
Safety: The wires will get hot when current flows.
Switch off the power supply as soon as you have
observed movement and avoid touching the
wires.
Getting started
This experiment works because two magnetic
fields interact.
Sketch the magnetic field between two opposite
poles and around a wire which is carrying current.
How could you reverse the direction of the field in
each case?
You will need:
•
•
•
•
•
power supply
2 magnadur magnets with a yoke
2 steel rods
clamp
copper wire.
20 Electromagnetic forces
CONTINUED
Method
1
Clamp two steel rods horizontally, parallel to
one another.
2
Bend a length of copper wire (see Figure 20.1 3)
(Figure 20.14a). To remember how they are arranged,
physicists use Fleming’s left-hand rule (Figure 20.14b).
This states that if the thumb and first two fingers of the
left hand are extended at right angles to each other, and
the first finger points in the direction of the field, the
second finger in the direction of current, then the thumb
will indicate the direction of the force.
to form a 'swing', which can hang between the
3
steel rods.
Attach the two magnets to the yoke,
ensuring that opposite poles are facing each
other. Place the magnets around the swing,
as shown in Figure 20.13.
KEY WORDS
Fleming's left-hand rule: a rule that gives the
relationship between the directions of force,
field and current when a current flows across a
magnetic field
It is worth practising holding your thumb and first two
fingers at right angles like this. It takes time to get this
right. Then learn what each finger represents:
• the First finger is Field
• the seCond finger is Current
• the thuMb is force or Motion.
Figure 20.13: Set-up for investigation.
4
5
6
Connect up the ends of the steel rods to a
low-voltage d.c. power supply. The current
should be able to flow along one rod, through
the swing and back through the other rod.
Switch on the power supply and observe
whether a force acts on the swing.
Investigate the effects of reversing the
current and the magnetic field (separately).
We use Fleming’s left-hand rule to predict the direction
of the force on a current-carrying conductor in a
magnetic field. By keeping your thumb and fingers at
right angles to each other, you can show that reversing
the direction of the current or field reverses the direction
of the force. (Do not try changing the direction of
individual fingers. You have to twist your whole hand
around at the wrist.)
Question
1
List two ways to reverse the force on a current¬
carrying conductor in a magnetic field.
Fleming's left-hand rule
Figure 20.14a uses arrows to represent three important
quantities in the demonstration in Figure 20.12:
• the magnetic field of the permanent magnet
• the current
• the force which moves the aluminium strip.
The magnetic field is horizontal between the poles.
The current is also horizontal, but at right angles to
the field. The force is vertical, so the foil moves down.
The three quantities are all at right angles to each other
Figure 20.14a: Force, field and current are at right angles to
each other, b: Fleming's left-hand rule.
The motor effect in action the loudspeaker
Figure 20.15 shows a loudspeaker. This creates a sound
wave in the air due to the vibrating paper cone. The cone
is attached to a coil of copper wire which fits loosely over
383 )
i
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
the centre of a cyclindrical magnet. The coil is, therefore, a
conductor which is free to move in a magnetic field. When
a current flows in the coil, the coil and cone will move.
The current input varies with the sound being produced
The movement created in thd motor effect experiments
is not very useful. The conductor moves out of the field
and the effect is over. A motor is designed to use the
motor effect to create a turning movement.
- a varying signal is received from a microphone, MP3
player or similar. The changing current causes the coil and
cone to move to and fro and produce a sound wave.
Figure 20.17: This model is used to show the principles of
operation of an electric motor.
The turning movement happens because the wire is
coiled. Look at the coil in Figure 20.17. The current
flows up the right-hand side of the coil ^fid down the
left. This means that the forces on the two wires are in
opposite directions. The right-hand wire moves up and
the left-hand wire moves down. This makes the coil spin.
The brushes and commutator make sure that the current
always flows the same way round the coil, in this case,
anticlockwise.
KEY WORD
commutator: a device used to allow current
to flow to and from the coil of a d.c. motor or
generator
Figure 20.15a: Diagram of a loudspeaker, b: This
loudspeaker has been dismantled so you can see the
permanent magnet and the coil.
20.3 Electric motors
For a d.c. motor like this (Figure 20.17) to be of any
use, its axle must be connected to something that is to be
turned - a wheel, a pulley or a pump, for example. This
model motor is not very powerful. The turning effect can
be increased by:
• increasing the number of turns of wire in the coil
• increasing the current
• increasing the strength of the magnetic field.
Questions
6
Figure 20.16a: The type of motor used in school
laboratories, b: The motor taken apart. Notice the copper
coils and the curved magnets inside the casing and the coil.
384
>
Describe the energy transfers that happen in:
a
an electric motor
b
a loudspeaker.
c
7
Electroma9netic forces
Figure 20.18 shows a type of ammeter. Copy and
complete the sentences to explain how it works.
Electric motors explained
We can apply Fleming’s left-hand rule to an electric
motor. Figure 20.21a shows a simple electric motor with
its coil horizontal in a horizontal magnetic field. The coil
is rectangular. What forces act on each of its four sides?
passes through the coil, it experiences
When
a
. This
because it is in a magnetic
causes the coil to rotate.
When the current increases, the force will be
and so the pointer will move
on the scale.
8
A student does an experiment to show the motor
effect using the apparatus shown in Figure 20.19.
The wire moves upwards.
Figure 20.19
a
Describe two ways in which the student could
reverse the effect to make the wire move
downwards.
b
The student moves the wire so that it passes
from the north to the south pole of the magnet
as shown in Figure 20.20. Explain why the wire
does not move.
Figure 20.21 a: A simple electric motor. Only the two longer
sides experience a force, since their currents cut across the
magnetic field, b: The two forces provide the turning effect
needed to make the coil rotate, c: When the coil is in the
vertical position, the forces have no turning effect.
385
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
•
Side AB: the current flows from A to B, across the
magnetic field. Fleming’s left-hand rule shows that a
force acts on it, vertically upwards.
CD: the current is flowing in the opposite
Side
•
direction to the current in AB, so the force on CD is
in the opposite direction, downwards.
• Sides BC and DA: the current here is parallel to the
field. Since it does not cross the field, there is no
force on these sides.
Figure 20.21b shows a simplified view of the coil. The
two forces acting on it are shown. They cause the coil
to turn anticlockwise. The two forces provide a turning
effect (or torque), which causes the motor to spin. From
Figure 20.21c, you can see that the forces will not turn
the coil when it is vertical. This is where we have to rely
on the coil’s momentum to carry it further round.
Questions
9
For Fleming’s left-hand rule, write down the three
quantities that are at 90° to each other, and, next to
each one, write down the finger that represents it.
10 In Figure 20.23, crosses represent a magnetic field
into the page and dots represent a field coming out
of the page. In each case, use Fleming’s left-hand
rule to determine the direction of the force on the
wire.
Keeping the motor turning
Figure 20.23
As the momentum of the coil carries it round, the wires
AB and CD swap positions. The commutator spins with
the coil. The brushes do not move. This means that, in
the motor in Figure 20.21, current always flows in on the
right, and anticlockwise round the coil. This means that
the motor keeps turning in the same direction.
11 List two ways to increase the force on a current¬
carrying conductor in a magnetic fi^ld .
12 Describe the motion that would be seen if the coil in
a motor was attached directly to a d.c. power supply
without a commutator.
20.4 Beams of charged
particles and magnetic
fields
Figure 20.22: A spinning electric motor. Every half turn the
commutator reverses the connections to the power supply,
so that the motor keeps turning in the same direction.
The diagrams show the coil as if it were a single turn of
wire. In practice, the coil might have hundreds of turns
of wire, resulting in forces hundreds of times as great. A
coil causes the current to flow across the magnetic field
many times, and each time it feels a force. A coil is simply
a way of multiplying the effect that would be experienced
using a single length of wire.
386
y
A magnetic field can also be used to deflect a beam
of electrons, or any electrically charged particles. This
can be demonstrated in the laboratory using a vacuum
tube (Figure 20.24). There is a force on the electrons in
the same way as we saw earlier for a current-carrying
conductor in a magnetic field. The direction of the force
is given by Fleming’s left-hand rule, but remember that
the conventional current is in the opposite direction to
the electron flow. In Figure 20.24, an electron beam is
travelling from left to right in a vacuum tube. This is
equivalent to a conventional current flowing from right
to left. In Figure 20.24a the north pole of a magnet is
held behind the tube, giving a field which comes out of
the page. Fleming’s left-hand rule shows that the force on
the beam is upwards. Figure 20.24a shows the effect of
this force. Figure 20.24b shows the effect of reversing the
direction of the field.
20 Electromagnetic forces
This effect is used in particle accelerators such as those
at CERN in Switzerland, to focus and to divert beams of
charged particles. The particles travel at enormously high
speeds and so have a lot of kinetic energy. Huge fields are
needed to divert them.
Figure 20.24: An electron beam in a vacuum tube, being
deflected by a magnetic field. As with a current in a wire,
reversing the field reverses the forceon the beam of
electrons.
Figure 20.25: This giant magnet, which has a mass of 1920
tonnes, was installed 100 metres below ground in a 27 km
tunnel at CERN to provide a magnetic field for a giant
particle detector.
PROJECT
Motors everywhere
In this project you will research either the uses of
motors or the motor effect in different situations.
Option 1
Collect pictures of things which use motors. These
can be photos, drawings or pictures from the Internet
or catalogues. Try to find pictures covering all the
following uses of motors:
•
•
kitchen appliances
• medicine
hair and beauty
appliances
rr
•
•
•
transportation.
industry
music
Identify the energy transfers that happen in each
appliance, including any waste energy.
This kitchen contains at least three electric motors.
Identify where they are.
Use your pictures to create a poster about motors.
Include diagrams and text to explain how motors
work, and how some motors are constructed to
make them stronger than others. Include the words:
magnetic field, current, electromagnet, force and coil.
387
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Option 2
The motor effect is used in other devices as well
as motors. Research how the effect is used in
different devices such as different types of motors,
loudspeakers, moving coil milliammeters or particle
accelerators. Prepare a short presentation (which
could be filmed) or a poster to show what you find
out. You should include:
•
detailed diagrams showing at least three uses
of the motor effect
an explanation of how each of the applications
works
follow up questions (with answers) to check
your audience understand your presentation
(include the use of Fleming's left-hand rule in
your questions).
a description of what the motor effect is (it can
be shortened to three words and two symbols!)
SUMMARY
There is a magnetic field around a current-carrying conductor.
The magnetic effect of a current has many practical uses including the electric bell and relay.
The field around a wire is strongest near the wire.
The field in a solenoid is strongest inside the coil.
The strength and direction of the field depends on the size and direction of the current.
When a current flows through a conductor in a magnetic field, there is a force on the conductor. This is called
the motor effect.
The direction of the force can be reversed by reversing the field or the current.
A coiled conductor in a magnetic field experiences a turning force. This is the basis of the electric motor.
The strength of a motor can be increased by increasing the field, the current or the number of turns on the coil.
Fleming’s left-hand rule allows you to find the direction of the force on a current-carrying conductor.
Fleming’s left-hand rule can also be used to find the direction of the force on a beam of charged particles in a
magnetic field.
An electric motor uses a split-ring commutator to produce continuous rotation.
388
>
20 Electromagnetic forces
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Current flows up a wire as shown in the diagram. What will the magnetic
field look like?
[1 ]
A straight lines from left to right
B straight lines from right to left
C clockwise circles
D anticlockwise circles
2 Which line gives the correct material for the armature of a relay, and the
property which makes it suitable?
Material
Property
A
copper
good conductor
B
soft iron
bendy
C
copper
easily magnetised
D
soft iron
easily demagnetised
3 Which of the following pairs of changes will both increase the strength
of an electric motor?
A Reversing the magnetic field and increasing the number of turns on
the coil
B Increasing the number of turns on the coil and reversing the direction
of the current
C Reversing the direction of the current and reversing the magnetic field
D Using a more powerful magnet and increasing the number of turns
on the coil
[1 ]
[1 ]
389
)
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
I
COMMAND WORDS
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
suggest: apply
knowledge and
understanding
to situations
where there are
a range of valid
responses in order
to make proposals/
put forward
considerations
describe: state the
points of a topic/give
characteristics and
main features
390
>
20
CONTINUED
7 A permanent magnet is placed on a top pan balance. A wire is suspended
between the poles of the magnet and attached to a power supply. The wire
is clamped so it cannot move.
wire connected to
d.c. power supply
When the power supply is switched on, a current flows through the wire and
[4]
the reading on the top pan balance decreases. Explain why.
8 The diagram shows the main part of a simple direct current electric motor.
Name and state the rule which is needed to work out the direction the
motor will move.
b An important part of the motor is missing from the diagram. Name it
and state its function.
c Suggest two ways to increase the strength of the motor.
a
[2]
[2]
[2]
[Total: 6]
Electromagnetic force*
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
COMMAND WORD
9 a
determine: establish
an answer using the
information available
Determine the direction of the force on a beam of electrons passing from
right to left in a magnetic field into the page.
[1 ]
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
electron
beam
field into page
b What would happen if the electron beam was replaced by a beam of
positively charged ions?
c Explain why the path of the beam curves as it passes through the field.
[2]
[1]
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Describe an experiment to show the field around a
straight wire and a solenoid when they carry current.
20.1
Draw the pattern and direction of these fields.
20.1
Describe the factors that affect the direction and
strength of these fields.
20.1
Describe the action of an electric relay and a loudspeaker.
20.1
Interpret diagrams of other devices using
electromagnets.
20.1
State that a current-carrying conductor in a magnetic
field experiences a force.
20.2
Use Fleming’s left-hand rule to find the direction
of this force.
20.2
List three ways of increasing the strength of an electric
motor.
20.3
Describe how an electric motor produces a turning
effect, including the function of the brushes and
split-ring commutator.
20.3
Recall that a beam of charged particles in a magnetic
field experiences a force and determine the direction of
this force.
20.4
392
y
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
> Chapter 21
Electromagnetic
induction
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
explain how an a.c generator works
y explain how a transformer works.
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
In Chapter 18 you learnt about the electrical
quantities we can measure or calculate. These
include: current, potential difference, resistance,
charge, energy, power and electro-motive force.
For each quantity, write a definition, the letter
used to represent the quantity in an equation (for
example, I for length), and its unit.
Write down all the equations you know which
involve these quantities.
In a small group, play a game to check your learning:
Create a set of cards. There should be one card for
the name of each quantity, one card for the unit of
each quantity, one card for time, and one card for
seconds.
Place the cards face down in a pack. The first player
turns two cards over. If they can connect the cards
in a sentence or equation, they score a point.
Return the cards to the pack, mix them up, and then
the next player takes their turn.
For example, if a player picks 'ohm' and 'current',
they could say: 'when the resistance in ohms
increases, the current drops'. If a student makes an
incorrect link, other players can score a point by
spotting the mistake and giving a correct answer.
WHY MUST ELECTRIC GUITARS HAVE METAL STRINGS?
and fed to a loudspeaker. The size and frequency of
the current depends on the vibratior^ of the strings.
This allows music to be played.
Figure 21.1: The metal circles (on the white bar below
the strings of this electric guitar) pick up sound vibrations.
Notice that the strings do not touch the pickup.
We saw in Chapter 20 that a current flowing in a
magnetic field experiences a force which can make it
move. In this chapter we will investigate the reverse
process. When a conductor and magnetic field
move relative to each other, a current flows in the
conductor. This is the principle behind the operation
of power stations.
This effect is also used to pick up sound vibrations
in an electric guitar. The guitar strings are
magnetised by a permanent magnet in the pick-up
below the strings. This is why they must be made
of a magnetic metal such as nickel or steel. The
pick-up device - the white bar below the strings
in Figure 21.1 - also contains coils of copper wire
which are wrapped around the permanent magnets.
The strings vibrate when the guitar is played.
The amplitude and frequency of these vibrations
depend on the note being played. We now have
relative movement between a conductor (the coils)
and a field (around the magnetised strings) and so
a current flows in the coils. This current is amplified
394
>
Figure 21.2: How the pi«kup in a guitar works.
Figure 21.2 shows the field lines from the permanent
magnet which magnetises the metal strings. The
changing current generated in the coil is passed
to the speaker which contains a magnet. As the
changing current flows, the speaker cone moves,
producing sound - this is the motor effect.
Discussion questions
1 The guitar pickup does not touch the strings.
Explain why this is an advantage.
2 The electromagnetic pickup shown in
Figure 21.2 would not work for a guitar with
nylon strings. Explain why.
3 Describe the energy changes involved from
the guitar being strummed to the sound being
heard from the speaker.
21 Electromagnetic induction
21.1 Generating
electricity
A motor is a device that transfers energy by an electrical
current into a mechanical (kinetic) energy store. An
electrical generator does the opposite - it transfers
energy from a mechanical energy store by an electrical
current. An electric motor can be used in reverse to
generate electricity. If you connect an electric motor to a
lamp and spin its axle, the lamp will light, showing that
you have generated a voltage which causes a current to
flow through the lamp (Figure 21.3).
Figure 21.4: The dynamo rubs against the wheel causing it
to turn. This generates current to light the bicycle lamp.
The power station generators shown in Figure 21.10
generate alternating current at a voltage of about 25 kV.
The turbines are made to spin by the high-pressure steam
from the boiler. The generator is on the same axle as the
turbine, so it spins too. A coil inside the generator spins
around inside some fixed electromagnets, which provide
the magnetic field. A large current is then induced in
the rotating coil, and this is the current that the power
station supplies to consumers.
Figure 21.3: A motor can act as a generator. Spin the motor
and the lamp lights, showing that an induced current flows
around the circuit.
Inside the motor, the coil is spinning around in the
magnetic field provided by the permanent magnets. The
result is that a current flows in the coil, and this is shown
by the lamp. We say that the current has been induced,
and the motor is acting as a generator.
There are many different designs of generator, just
as there are many different designs of electric motor.
Generators in power stations supply electricity to
communities. If you have a bicycle, you may have a
generator of a different sort - a dynamo - for powering
the lights.
All of these generators have three things in common:
•
a magnetic field (provided by magnets or
electromagnets)
•
a coil of wire (fixed or moving)
•
movement (the coil and magnetic field move relative
to one another).
When the coil and the magnetic field move relative to
each other, a current flows in the coil if it is part of a
complete circuit. This is known as an induced current.
If the generator is not connected up to a circuit, there
will be an induced e.m.f. (or induced voltage) across its
ends, ready to make a current flow around a circuit.
KEY WORDS
induced e.m.f.: (or induced voltage) the e.m.f.
created in a conductor when it cuts through
magnetic field lines
395
>
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
The principles of
electromagnetic induction
The process of generating electricity from motion
is called electromagnetic induction. The science of
electromagnetism was largely developed by Michael
Faraday. He invented the idea of the magnetic field and
drew field lines to represent it. He also invented the first
electric motor. Then he extended his studies to show
how the motor effect could work in reverse to generate
electricity. In this section, we will look at the principles
of electromagnetic induction that Faraday discovered.
As we have seen, a coil of wire and a magnet moving
relative to each other are needed to induce a voltage
across the ends of a wire. If the coil is part of a complete
circuit, the induced e.m.f. will make an induced current
flow around the circuit.
In fact, you do not need to use a coil - a single wire is
enough to induce an e.m.f., as shown in Figure 21 ,5a.
The wire is connected to a sensitive meter to show when
a current is flowing.
• Move the wire down between the poles of the
magnet and a current flows.
• Move the wire back upwards and a current flows in
the opposite direction.
• Alternatively, the wire can be kept stationary and
the magnet moved up and down. Again, a current
will flow.
You can see similar effects using a magnet and a coil
(Figure 21.5b). Pushing the magnet into and out of the
coil induces a current, which flows back and forth in the
coil. Here are two further observations:
• Reverse the magnet to use the opposite pole and the
current flows in the opposite direction.
• Hold the magnet stationary next to the wire or coil
and no current flows. They must move relative to
each other, or nothing will happen.
In these experiments it helps to use a centre-zero meter.
Then, when the needle moves to the left, it shows that the
current is flowing one way; when it moves to the right,
the current is flowing the other way.
KEY WORDS
electromagnetic induction: the production of an
e.m.f across an electrical conductor when there is
relative movement between the conductor and a
magnetic field
396
>
Figure 21.5a: Move a wire up and down between the poles
of a stationary magnet and an induced current will flow,
b: Similarly, move a magnet into and out of a coil of wire and
an induced current will again flow.
Increasing the induced e.m.f.
There are three ways to increase the e.m.f. induced in a
coil or wire:
•
•
•
use a stronger magnet
move the wire or coil more quickly relative to the
magnet
use a coil with more turns of wire. Each turn of wire
will have an e.m.f. induced in it, and these all add
together to give a bigger e.m.f.
21
Electromagnetic induction
EXPERIMENTAL SKILLS 21.1
Inducing electricity
In this experiment you will induce an e.m.f. and
investigate the factors which affect the induced
e.m.f., including the factors affecting the size and
direction of the e.m.f. induced when a conductor
moves relative to a magnetic field.
Safety: Some sensitive meters have a locking
mechanism which prevents them being damaged
during movement. Check your meter before you
begin.
4
You will need:
• thin insulated wire
• strong bar magnet
• 2 magnadur magnets and a yoke
• sensitive, centre-zero ammeter or voltmeter.
•
Move the bar magnet at different speeds
into the coil.
•
Use the opposite pole of the bar magnet.
•
Move the bar magnet out of the coil.
•
Hold the bar magnet stationary at different
distances from the coil.
5
Straighten out the wire. Keep the ends
connected to the meter.
6
Mount two magnadur magnets on a yoke.
Ensure that opposite poles are facing each
other so that there is a strong magnetic field
between the magnets.
7
Hold a section of the wire, approximately 10 cm
in length, between your two hands. Move the
wire downwards through the field (Figure 21.7).
Observe the reading on the meter.
Getting started
Look carefully at the meter you are using. Explain:
• why zero is at the centre of the scale
• how you can tell it is a very sensitive meter.
Now investigate how the reading on the meter
changes in different circumstances:
Method
1 Coil 2.0 metres of thin insulated wire with bare
ends to make a solenoid approximately 5 cm
in diameter. The coil can be flat as shown in
Figure 21.6 rather than long.
2
3
Connect the ends of the coil to the terminals of
a sensitive voltmeter or ammeter.
Bring one pole of a bar magnet towards and
into the centre of the coil. Observe the reading
on the meter.
Figure 21.7: Experimental set-up (part 2)
8
Now investigate how the reading on the meter
changes in different circumstances.
•
Move the wire at different speeds through
the magnetic field.
•
•
•
Reverse the direction of the magnetic field.
Move the wire out of the magnetic field.
Hold the wire stationary in the magnetic
field.
Figure 21.6: Experimental set-up.
397
y
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Question
Copy and complete these sentences to record
1
The size of the e.m.f. induced in a coil can be
,
increased by increasing
or
your observations:
An e.m.f. is induced in a conductor in a magnetic
field if either the
or the
move
across the other.
.
The direction of the e.m.f. can be
by
reversing the field or the direction of movement.
Questions
This idea helps us to understand the factors that affect
the magnitude and direction of the induced e.m.f.
1
•
When the magnet is stationary, there is no cutting of
field lines and so no e.m.f. is induced.
•
When the magnet is further from the wire, the field
lines are further apart and so fewer are! cut, giving a
smaller e.m.f.
•
When the magnet is moved quickly, the lines are cut
more quickly and a bigger e.m.f. is induced.
•
A coil gives a bigger effect than a single wire,
because each turn of wire cuts the magnetic field
lines. This means that each contributes to the
induced e.m.f.
2
Which of the following would not induce a current:
A moving a wire between the poles of a magnet
B taking a bar magnet out of a coil or wire
C holding a wire between the poles of a magnet
D spinning a coil or wire in a magnetic field.
Marcus holds a piece of copper wire which is
connected to an ammeter between the poles of
a magnet, but he does not get a reading on the
ammeter. What should he do to make a current flow?
3
A student moves a bar magnet into a coil of wire and
a current flows. Describe two changes which would
make the current flow in the opposite direction.
4
An a.c generator and a cell can both be used to light
a bulb. Describe how the current flowing through
the bulb is different in each case.
Induction and field lines
We can understand electromagnetic induction by thinking
about magnetic field lines. Figure 21.8 shows the field
lines between the poles of a horseshoe magnet. As the
wire is moved down between the poles of the magnet, it
cuts the field lines of the magnet. Cutting the field lines
induces the current.
Fleming's right-hand rule
We have seen that, when a wire is moved so that it cuts
across a magnetic field, a current is induced in the wire.
How can we work out the direction of the current?
In Chapter 20, we saw the opposite effect. When a
current flows in a magnetic field, there is a force on
it so that it moves. The directions of force, field and
current were given by Fleming’s left-hand rule. It is not
surprising to find that, in the case of electromagnetic
induction, the directions are given by Fleming’s right¬
hand rule. As shown in Figure 21.9, the thumb and first
two fingers show the directions of the same quantities.
Take care to use the correct hand.
KEY WORDS
Fleming's right-hand rule: a rule that gives the
relationship between the directions of force,
field and current when a current flows across a
magnetic field
Figure 21.8: As the wire cuts through the field lines, an
e.m.f. is induced in it. If the wire is part of a complete circuit,
a current will flow.
398
y
21
Electromagnetic induction
Figure 21.11 shows a simple a.c. generator, which
produces alternating current. In principle, an a.c
generator is like a d.c. motor, working in reverse. The
axle is made to turn so that the coil spins around in
the magnetic field, and a current is induced. The other
difference is in the way the coil is connected to the circuit
beyond. A d.c. motor uses a split-ring commutator,
whereas an a.c. generator uses slip rings. The slip rings
rotate with the coil. The brushes rub against the slip
rings and so have the same e.m.f. as the sides of the coil.
KEY WORDS
Figure 21 .9a: When a current is induced in a wire,
motion, field and current are at right angles to each other,
b: Fleming's right-hand rule is used to work out the direction
of the induced current.
a.c. generator: a device such as a dynamo used
to generate alternating current
slip rings: a device used to allow current to flow
to and from the coil of an a.c. generator
An a.c. generator
Faraday’s discovery of electromagnetic induction led to
the development of the electricity supply industry. In
particular, it allowed engineers to design generators that
could supply electricity. At first, this was only done on
a small scale, but gradually generators got bigger and
bigger, until, like the ones shown in Figure 21.10, they
were capable of supplying the electricity demands of
thousands of homes.
Figure 21 .11; A simple a.c. generator works like a motor in
reverse. The slip rings and brushes are used to connect the
alternating current to the external circuit.
Why does this generator produce alternating current?
As the coil rotates, each side of the coil passes first the
magnetic north pole and then the south pole.
Figure 21.1 0: The turbine and generator in the generating
hall of a nuclear power station. The turbines are fed by highpressure steam in pipes.
A generator of this type produces alternating current
(a.c.). Alternating current flows first one way then the
other as the coils turn in the magnetic field.
Figure 21.12 shows a graph of this. When the coil is
horizontal, it cuts through the field lines inducing a
voltage. As it turns to vertical, it cuts fewer field lines
so the voltage decreases to zero. As it continues back to
horizontal it cuts through the field lines in the opposite
direction, giving a peak voltage in the opposite direction.
This means that the induced current flows first one way,
and then the other. In other words, the current in the coil
is alternating.
399
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
The current flows out through the slip rings. Each ring
is connected to one end of the coil, so the alternating
current flows out through the brushes, which press
against the rings.
There are four ways of increasing the voltage generated
by an a.c. generator like the one shown in Figure 21.11:
• turn the coil more rapidly
• use a coil with more turns of wire
• use a coil with a bigger area
• use stronger magnets.
Each of these changes increases the rate at which
magnetic field fines are cut, and so the induced e.m.f. is
greater. For the a.c. generator shown in Figure 21.11,
each revolution of the coil generates one cycle of
alternating current. Spin the coil 50 times each second
and the a.c. generated has a frequency of 50 Hz.
quickly again, but in the opftosite direction, so the
induced e.m.f. will again be large, but this time it will be
negative - this corresponds to a trough on the graph.
Direction of the induced e.m.f.
How is the direction of an induced current determined?
The answer is that the current (like all currents) has a
magnetic field around it. This field always pushes back
against the field that is inducing the current. So, for the
coil shown in Figure 21.13, when the magnet’s north pole
is pushed towards the coil, the current flows to produce
a north pole at the end of the coil nearest the magnet.
These two north poles repel each other. This means that
you have to push the magnet towards the coil and that
you have to do work. The energy you use in pushing
the magnet is transferred to the current. That is where
the energy carried by the current comes from. It comes
from the work done in making a conductor cut through
magnetic field lines.
An induced current always flows in such^a way that its
magnetic field opposes the change that
it. This is
known as Lenz’s law.
causes
KEY WORDS
Lenz's law: the direction of an induced current
always opposes the change in the circuit or the
magnetic field that produces it
induced N pole
Figure 21.12: A graph to represent an alternating voltage.
As the coil turns, the voltage reaches a peak in one
direction, decreases to zero, then reverses.
Figure 21.12 shows how the e.m.f. produced by an a.c.
generator varies as the coil turns. If we think about
how the coil cuts through magnetic field lines, we can
understand why the a.c. graph varies between positive
and negative values. With the coil in the horizontal
position, as shown in position a, its two long sides are
cutting rapidly through the magnetic field lines. This
gives a large induced e.m.f., corresponding to a peak
in the a.c. graph. When the coil is vertical (position b),
its long sides are moving along the field lines, so they
are not cutting them. This gives no induced e.m.f., a
zero point on the a.c. graph. When the coil has turned
through 180° to position c, it will be cutting field lines
400
)
induced
current
induced
e.m.f.
Figure 21.13: Consider a bar magnet being moved into a
coil north pole first. Lenz's law tells us that the e.m.f. induced
will oppose this. Therefore, the end the magnet approaches
must become a north pole, to repel the approaching north
pole. This means that the current must flow anticlockwise at
that end of the coil.
21
Questions
5
A student moves the north pole of a magnet towards
a coil of wire (as shown in Figure 21.13), so that an
induced current flows. State two ways in which the
student could cause a bigger induced current to flow.
Draw a diagram similar to Figure 21.13 to show
what happens when the magnet is moved away from
the coil. (Hint: remember, the induced current will
oppose this change.)
6
Electromagnetic induction
21.2 Power lines and
transformers
ACTIVITY 21.1
Generating fitness
Figure 21.15: Electricity is usually generated at a distance
from where it is used. If you look on a map, you may be able
to trace the power lines that bring electrical power to your
neighbourhood.
Power stations may be 100 km or more from the places
where the electricity they generate is used. This electricity
must be distributed around the country.
Figure 21.14: Using an exercise bike to charge a
mobile phone.
The woman in Figure 21.14 is charging her mobile
phone. As she pedals the exercise bike, she turns
a generator to induce a current which is used to
charge her phone.
High-voltage electricity leaves the power station. Its
voltage may be as high as 1 million volts. To avoid danger
to people, it is usually carried in cables called power lines
slung high above the ground between tall pylons. Lines of
pylons carry wires across the countryside, heading for the
urban and industrial areas that need the power (Figure
21.16). This is a country’s national grid.
KEY WORDS
Produce a poster to attract customers to use a
bike charger in a public place. You should include
information about how the system helps to:
power lines: cables used to carry electricity from
power stations to consumers
•
•
•
a country
save money
improve the user's health
protect the environment.
You should also include a more detailed section for
the user to read as they pedal. This should explain
how the system works and advise the customer
how to charge their phone as quickly as possible.
national grid: the system of power lines, pylons
and transformers used to carry electricity around
When the power lines approach the area where the
power is to be used, they enter a local distribution centre.
Here the voltage is reduced to a less hazardous level,
and the power is sent through more cables (overhead or
underground) to local substations. In the substation, the
voltage is reduced to the local supply voltage, typically
230 V. Wherever you live, there is likely to be a substation
401
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Figure 21.1 6: In a national grid, voltages are increased to reduce energy losses, then reduced to a relatively safe level.
in the neighbourhood. It may be in a securely locked
building, or the electrical equipment may be surrounded
by fencing, which carries notices warning of the hazard
(Figure 21.17).
From the substation, electricity is distributed to houses,
shops, etc. In some countries, the power is carried in
cables buried underground. Other countries use tall poles
and overhead wires.
Why use high voltages?
DANGER OF DEATH
Figure 21.17: An electricity substation has warning signs
like this to indicate the extreme hazard of entering the
substation.
402
>
The high voltages used to transmit electrical power
around a country are dangerous. That is why the cables
that carry the power are supported high above people,
traffic and buildings on tall pylons. Sometimes the cables
are buried underground, but this is much more expensive,
and the cables must be safely insulated. The reason for
using high voltages is to reduce the loss of energy due to
the cables heating up. This heating happens much more
when the same power is transmitted at a lower voltage.
Transformers
A transformer is a device used to increase or decrease
the voltage of an electricity supply. They are designed
21
to be as efficient as possible (up to 99.9% efficient).
This is because the electricity we use may have passed
through as many as ten transformers before it reaches us
from the power station. A loss of 1% of energy in each
transformer would represent a total waste of 10% of the
energy leaving the power station.
Power stations typically generate electricity at 25 kV. This
has to be converted to the grid voltage (typically 400 kV)
using transformers. This is known as stepping up the
voltage.
Figure 21.18a shows the construction of a suitable
transformer. Every transformer has three parts:
•
A primary coil: the incoming voltage Vp is connected
across this coil.
•
A secondary coil: this provides the voltage Ks to the
external circuit.
•
An iron core: this links the two coils.
Electromagnetic induction
Notice that there is no electrical connection between
the two coils. They are linked together only by the
soft iron core. The wires are insulated so no current
flows from one coil to the other. Notice also that the
voltages are both alternating voltages. Transformers
only work with a.c. All they do is change the size of
an a.c. voltage.
The power station transformer described earlier steps
up the voltage from 25 kV to 400 kV - it is increased by
a factor of 16. To step up the voltage by a factor of 16,
there must be 16 times as many turns on the secondary
coil as on the primary coil. By comparing the numbers
of turns on the two coils we can tell how the voltage will
be changed.
•
•
A step-up transformer increases the voltage. There
are more turns on the secondary coil than on the
primary coil.
A step-down transformer reduces the voltage. There
are fewer turns on the secondary coil than on the
primary coil.
KEY WORDS
transformer: a device used to change voltage of
an a.c. electricity supply
primary coil: the input coil of a transformer
secondary coil: the output coil of a transformer
step-up transformer: a transformer which increases
the voltage of an a.c. supply
step-down transformer: a transformer which
decreases the voltage of an a.c. supply
Note that, when the voltage is stepped up, the current is
stepped down, and when the voltage is stepped down, the
current is stepped up.
The ratio of the number of turns tells us the factor by
which the voltage will be changed. We can write an
equation, known as the transformer equation, relating
the two voltages, Vp and Ks, to the numbers of turns on
each coil, AL and N ,:
transformer
Figure 21.18a: The structure of a transformer. This is a
step-up transformer because there are more turns on the
secondary coil than on the primary. If the connections to
it were reversed, it would be a step-down transformer,
b: The circuit symbol for a transformer shows the two coils
with the core between them.
KEY EQUATION
voltage across primary coil
voltage across secondary coil
_ number of turns on
primary
. number of turns on secondary
Vp
_ N*p
rs
M
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
WORKED EXAMPLE 21.1
There are very large transformers between power
stations to the transmission cables.
One of these transformers has 800 turns on its
primary coil and 16 000 turns on its secondary coil.
The voltage across its primary coil is 25 kV
a State what type of transformer this is.
b Calculate the voltage across its secondary coil.
Step 1: Write down what you know: The transformer
has more turns on the secondary coil than the
primary so it is a step-up transformer. This
means the voltage should increase. Use this to
check your answer to the next part.
It is often useful to do a quick mental calculation first.
For example, if a transformer decreases voltage from
230 V to 60 V, it has reduced it by about a quarter. This
means the secondary coil must have roughly a quarter of
the number of turns than those on the primary. This is
an approximate calculation. It helps you check whether
your final answer is sensible.
Questions
7
a
Copy and complete these sentences.
Electricity is distributed by the national
. This consists of substations, cables
.
and
The electricity is transmitted at very high
energy being lost as heat
to
in the cables.
The voltage can be increased or decreased by
b
Figure 21.20 shows a transformer.
Step 2: Draw a simple transformer as shown in
Figure 21.19 and mark on it the information
given in the question.
<
V = 25OOOV
>
V =?
I ~r~ U- >
NS = 16000
N = 600
f
Figure 21.1 9: Transformer symbol with the quantities
given in the question.
Step 3: Write down the transformer equation.
Ns
Vs
Step 4: Substitute in the values from the question.
25000 V
_ 800
Figure 21 .20: A transformer.
16000
Step 5: Rearrange the equation to find Vs.
Fs
vs
Name the parts labelled A, B and C.
_ 25000 V x 16000
c
800
= 500000 V
8
A transformer has ten turns on the primary coil
and five turns on the secondary. A voltage of 12 V is
applied across the primary coil.
a Is this a step-up or step-down transformer?
b Use the transformer equation to calculate the
output voltage of the transformer.
9
Copy and complete Table 21.1. Calculate the
missing information using the transformer equation.
Check that this is greater than the primary voltage as
expected.
Answer
a step-up transformer
b
Fs = 500000 V
404
>
Explain whether this is a step-up or step-down
transformer.
21
WP
V.
Ns
10
12
20
10
10000
Step-up or
step-down
transformer?
1.2
12
50
240
6
20
115000
step-up
Table 21.1
10 A portable radio has a built-in transformer so that it
can work from the mains instead of batteries. Is this
a step-up or step-down transformer?
11 A transformer increases the 1100 V from a power
station to 132 000 V for transmission. Calculate
the number of turns on the primary coil when the
secondary coil has 6000 turns.
REFLECTION
In these calculations it is useful to think about
whether the answer is sensible. Which of the
following suggestions are helpful for you? What
does this tell you about how you work?
•
Electromagnetic induction
The primary coil has alternating current flowing through
it. It is, therefore, an electromagnet, and produces an
alternating magnetic field. The core transports this
alternating field around to the secondary coil. Now the
secondary coil is a conductor in a changing magnetic
field. A current is induced in the coil. This is another
example of electromagnetic induction at work.
When the secondary coil has only a few turns, the e.m.f.
induced across it is small. When it has a lot of turns, the
e.m.f. will be large. Hence, to increase the voltage out,
we need a secondary coil with many more turns than the
primary coil.
When direct current is connected to a transformer, there
is no output voltage. This is because the magnetic field
produced by the primary coil does not change. With an
unchanging field passing through the secondary coil, no
voltage is induced in it.
Notice from Figure 21.21 that the magnetic field links
the primary and secondary coils. The energy brought
by the current in the primary coil is transferred to the
secondary coil by the magnetic field. This means that the
core must be very good at transferring magnetic energy.
A soft magnetic material must be used - usually an alloy
of iron with a small amount of silicon. (Recall that soft
magnetic materials are ones that can be magnetised and
demagnetised easily.)
alternating magnetic field line
Draw the transformer and write the numbers
on it.
Draw a diagram of the situation.
Do a quick approximate calculation first.
Decide whether the transformer is step-up or
step-down, and what this tells you about your
answer.
Think about whether you can apply any of these
ideas when you do other calculations.
21.3 How transformers
work
Transformers only work with alternating current (a.c.).
To understand why this is, we need to look at how a
transformer works (Figure 21.21). It makes use of
electromagnetic induction.
primary coil
secondary coil
Figure 21.21: The a.c. in the primary coil produces a varying
magnetic field in the core. This induces a varying current in
the secondary coil.
Even in a well-designed transformer, some energy is lost
because of the resistance of the wires, and because the
core resists the flow of the changing magnetic field.
1
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
What is the function of the core of a transformer?
Why must the core be made of a soft magnetic
material?
1 3 Explain why a transformer will not work with direct
current.
12 a
b
Calculating current
To transmit a certain power, P, we can use a small current,
I, if we transmit the power at high voltage, V. This follows
from the equation for electrical power (see Chapter 18):
electrical power P = IV
Worked Example 21.2 shows how this works.
Energy saving
There is a good reason for using high voltages. It means
that the current flowing in the cables is relatively low, and
this wastes less energy. This can be explained as follows.
A consumer needs a certain amount of power. This
power can be delivered as:
• high voltage, low current or
• low voltage, high current.
power losses in cables are proportional to the square of
the current flowing in the cables:
• double the current gives four times the losses
• three times the current gives nine times the losses.
WORKED EXAMPLE 21.2
A 20 kW generator gives an output of 5 kV. This is
transmitted to a workshop by cables with a resistance
of 20 Q. Calculate:
a the power loss in the cables
b the effect of using a transformer to increase the
output voltage to 20 kV assuming that the power
output remains the same.
When answering this question, it is important to
realise there are two different powers involved - the
power of the generator and the power loss in the
cables.
Step 1: Calculate the current in the wires at 5 kV
using the equation:
generator power, P IV
Rearrange the equation and substitute values:
I=P20000 W 5000V = 4A
—
-
Calculating power losses
Step 2: Calculate the power loss:
power loss, P = PR = (4 A)2 x 20 Q
(this is the answer to part a).
When a current flows in a wire or cable, some of
the energy it is carrying is lost because of the cable’s
resistance - the cables get warm. A small current wastes
less energy than a high current.
Step 3: Calculate the current in the wires at 20 kV:
P = IV
I P ~ K= 20000 W 20000 V = 1A
We can calculate the rate of energy loss in the cables, or
the power loss, by putting together two equations we met
in Chapter 18:
power = current x potential difference or P = IV
Step 4: Calculate the power loss:
P = PR = (1 A)2 x 20Q 20 W
and
potential difference
P
= current x resistance or V = IR
= IV becomes P = KIR) or P = PR.
KEY EQUATION
= square of current in the cable x resistance
P = PR
power loss
Electrical engineers do everything they can to reduce the
energy losses in the cables. If they can reduce the current
to half its value (by doubling the voltage), the losses will
be one-quarter of their previous value. This is because
406
>
= 320 W
—
=
Answer
a 320 W
b Using the transformer to decrease the voltage greatly
reduces the power loss, from 320 W to 20 W.
From the results of Worked Example 21.2, you can see
why electricity is transmitted at high voltages. The highej
the voltage, the smaller the current in the cables, and so
the smaller the energy losses. Increasing the voltage by
a factor of four reduces the current by a factor of four.
This means that the power lost in the cables is greatly
reduced (in fact, it is reduced by a factor of 42, which is
16), and so thinner cables can safely be used.
The current flowing in the cables is a flow of coulombs
of charge. At high voltage, we have fewer coulombs
flowing, but each coulomb carries more energy with it.
21
Electromagnetic induction
Thinking about power
CONTINUED
If a transformer is 100% efficient, no power is lost in its
coils or core. This is a reasonable approximation, because
well-designed transformers waste only about 0.1% of the
power transferred through them. This allows us to write
an equation linking the primary and secondary voltage,
Fp and Fs, to the primary and secondary currents, Ip and
/s, using P = IV.
Answer
So, the current supplied to the primary coil is 0.12 A.
In stepping down the voltage, the transformer has
stepped up the current. If both had been stepped up,
we would be getting something for nothing - which in
physics, is impossible!
KEY EQUATION
power in to primary coil - power out of secondary coil
ZpX rp =
zsx Ks
It is important to remember that this equation assumes
that no power is lost in the transformer. Worked Example
21.3 shows how to use this equation.
WORKED EXAMPLE 21.3
A school power pack has an output voltage of 9 V. It is
plugged in to the 230 V mains supply. The power pack
contains a transformer. The output current of the
power pack is 3 A. Calculate the current supplied to
the primary coil of the transformer in the power pack.
Assume there are no energy losses in the transformer.
Step 1: Draw a transformer symbol and mark on the
information from the question:
Questions
14 A power station generates 230 000 W.
a
Calculate the current in the wires when the
power is transmitted:
i
at 230 V
ii at 23000 V.
b Explain why it is better to transmit the
electricity at a higher voltage.
15 The power supply to a factory is 100 kW. The wires
have a resistance of 0.2 Q.
a
Calculate the power loss in the cables when the
voltage across the wires is 250 V.
b Calculate the power loss when the voltage is
stepped up to 12 500 V.
16 A transformer reduces the mains voltage from 240 V
to 12 V for use in a school laboratory power pack.
The current supplied by the power pack is 2 A.
What current flows into the power pack?
What assumption must you make in this calculation?
REFLECTION
Figure 21.22: Transformer symbol with the
known quantities.
Look back through your work on the motor effect
and electromagnetic induction. Are there any areas
you need to work on? Ask yourself:
Step 2: Write down the transformer power equation.
•
Are you clear about what each effect is?
Step 3: Substitute values from the question.
•
Can you recall and understand the
Zpx Ep = Zsx Fs
3 A x 9 V = Zs x 230 V
Step 4: Rearrange and solve for Z8.
3Ax9V
j
’ 230 V
= 0.12A
_
equations?
•
Can you recall and use the relevant rules for
finding directions of fields or currents?
Make revision cards with the key things you need
to remember.
407
)
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
PROJECT
Power to the people
For example, you may decide to structure your
poster around a diagram of the national grid, with
information boxes for each stage.
You must include:
•
information about the type of power stations
and renewable resources which are in use
•
a diagram of a generator and information
about how it works and how it is used in power
generation
•
a diagram similar to Figure 21.16 showing how
electricity is distributed
•
information about the role of transformers in
the system and the difference between step-up
and step-down transformers
•
reasons why the voltage of the supply has to be
changed.
Figure 21.23: A town in Sweden.
In this Swedish town coal is mined then burned to
generate electricity. The electricity is distributed to
homes via the national grid.
Electrical power generation and distribution varies
depending on where you live.
Your task is to research how electricity reaches
you. Working in a small group you will research
how electricity is generated and distributed in your
country. You will work together to produce a large
poster illustrating and explaining what you find.
Your poster will have a lot of information, so plan
carefully how the different parts will come together.
You could add:
•
a pie chart showing the different energy
resources used in your country
•
a detailed explanation of how an a.c. generator
works, including why the current generated is
a.c. (not d.c.)
•
details of the voltages at different parts of the
grid, with calculations showing the transformers
needed at each stage
•
photographs from your local area showing
pylons, substations, overhead cables and safety
notices.
SUMMARY
When there is relative movement between a conductor and a magnetic field, an e.m.f. is induced across the conductor.
The induced e.m.f. may cause an induced current to flow.
I The e.m.f. induced in a coil of wire can be increased by:
• increasing the magnetic field strength
• increasing the number of turns on the coil
• increasing the speed of movement.
The direction of the induced e.m.f. opposes the movement which causes it.
408
)
.
21
Electromagnetic induction
CONTINUED
The direction of the induced e.m.f can be found using Fleming’s right-hand rule.
Direct current flows in one direction. Alternating current reverses direction repeatedly.
The output of an a.c. generator depends on the position of the coil in relation to the magnetic field.
A transformer, consisting of a primary coil, a secondary coil and a soft iron core can be used to change
alternating voltages.
A step-up transformer increases voltage, a step-down transformer decreases voltage.
The number of turns on transformer coils and the voltages across them can be calculated using the equation.
N
V
Fs M
Transformers increase voltage for transmission by the national grid then reduce the voltage to a safer level for
consumers.
a.c. in the primary core of a transformer creates a changing magnetic field which, in turn, induces a.c. in the
secondary coil.
When a transformer is assumed to be 100% efficient, the primary and secondary currents and voltages are
related by the equation Zp x Fp = Is x Ks.
The power losses in cables can be calculated using the equation P
= PR.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which one of these is not needed for electromagnetic induction?
A a conductor
[1]
B movement
C a coil of wire
D a magnetic field
2 Which statement is true?
A A step-down transformer decreases current.
B A step-up transformer increases voltage.
C A step-up transformer is used in a school laboratory power supply.
D A step-down transformer has more turns on the secondary coil than
on the primary coil.
{1 ]
3 A student investigates the effect of moving a bar magnet into a coil.
She measures the current which flows in the coil when she moves the magnet.
[1]
Which change would increase the current?
A using a stronger bar magnet
B moving the magnet in the opposite direction
C moving the coil instead of the magnet
D moving the coil from side to side as well as in and out of the magnet
409
y
1
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
4 The diagram shows a coil and a magnet. When the magnet is moved away from
the coil, current flows.
IW
[1]
Which one of the following describes what happens?
A Current flows clockwise in the coil, creating a north pole which attracts the
south pole of the bar magnet.
B Current flows anticlockwise, creating a north pole which repels the south
pole of the bar magnet.
C Current flows anticlockwise, creating a south pole which repels the south
pole of the bar magnet.
D Current flows anticlockwise, creating a north pole which attracts the south
pole of the bar magnet.
[1]
5 a Which statement describes electromagnetic induction?
A the production of an e.m.f across an electrical conductor when there
is relative movement between the conductor and a magnetic field
B the production of an e.m.f across an electrical conductor when there
is no movement between the conductor and a magnetic field
C the production of an e.m.f across an electrical conductor when there
is relative movement between the conductor and an induced current
COMMAND WORDS
D the production of an e.m.f across an electrical conductor when there
is no movement between the conductor and an induced current
b Describe an experiment to demonstrate electromagnetic induction using
a horseshoe magnet, a piece of copper wire and a sensitive ammeter.
[3]
You may include a diagram in your answer.
c State two factors which affect the size of the current induced in this
[2]
experiment.
[Total: 6]
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
6 a Draw a diagram of a step-up transformer and label the three essential
parts of the transformer.
b A student connects the input of a step-up transformer to a battery.
He connects the output to a bulb, but it does not light.
Explain why.
[4]
[1 ]
[Total: 5]
410
>
main features
state: express in
clear terms
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons; make
the relationships
between things
evident; provide
why and/or how and
support with relevant
evidence
21
Electromagnetic induction
CONTINUED
7 a Transformers are used in the national grid to change the voltage of
the supply. For transformers A and B, state whether the transformer is
step-up or step-down, and explain why the voltage change is necessary.
[4]
COMMAND WORDS
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
b A transformer in the national grid has 800 turns on the primary
coil and 16 000 on the secondary. The primary voltage is 25 kV.
Calculate the secondary voltage.
[2]
[Total: 6]
8 A teacher demonstrates electromagnetic induction using a coil, a bar
magnet and a sensitive, centre-zero ammeter.
a The teacher slowly moves the magnet towards the coil. State and
[2]
explain what happens.
b The teacher changes different factors in the experiment. State the effect
of each of these actions on the ammeter reading:
i The teacher holds the coil still.
ii The teacher moves the coil quickly towards the coil.
iii The teacher holds the magnet still and slowly moves the coil towards
the magnet.
[4]
iv The teacher quickly moves the magnet away from the coil.
[Total: 6]
9 The diagram shows an a.c. generator.
411
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
*
CONTINUED
a Name the part labelled A.
b Name the rule which is used to find the direction of the current in a
conductor moving in a magnetic field.
c Use this law to find the direction of the force on the section of wire
labelled BC.
d The brightness of the lamp varies as the coil is turned. Explain why the
position of the coil affects the brightness of the bulb.
Hl
[1]
[1]
[3]
[Total: 6]
1 0 Spot welding is a method of joining two pieces of metal together by passing a
very high current through them. The diagram shows a transformer being used
to spot weld two iron nails.
a Explain why the nails become hot when the power is switched on.
b Use the data from the diagram to calculate the current needed
from the power supply. Assume the transformer is 100% efficient.
Give your answer to two decimal places.
[1]
[4]
[Total: 5]
COMMAND WORDS
give: produce an
answer from a given
source or recall I
memory
21 Electromagnetic induction
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
I can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
State that an e.m.f. is induced when there is relative
movement between a conductor and a magnetic field,
and describe an experiment to demonstrate this.
21.1
List the ways in which the induced e.m.f. can be
increased.
21.1
State that the induced e.m.f. opposes the change which
causes it.
21.1
Use Fleming’s right-hand rule to find the direction of
the induced current.
21.1
Describe the structure and operation of an a.c.
generator.
21.1
Sketch a graph of voltage against time for an a.c.
generator. State what position the coil must be in for the
peaks, troughs and zeros on the graph.
21.1
List the three essential parts of a transformer.
21.2
Describe the difference between a step-up and a
step-down transformer, by comparing their primary and
secondary coils.
21.2
Recall and use the equation
— = —Np .
K
21.2
Describe how and why transformers are used in high
voltage transmission.
21.2
Explain how a transformer works.
21.3
Recall and use the equation Ipx Vp- Isx Vs.
21.3
Recall and use the equation P = I2R.
21.3
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
> Chapter 22
The nuclear
atom
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
describe the structure of the atom
describe the alpha scattering experiment which provides evidence for the nuclear atom
name and state the mass and charge of the particles in the nucleus
represent nuclei in the form /X
explain what isotopes are
>
describe fission and fusion reactions.
22 The nuclear atom
GETTING STARTED
With a partner, spend two minutes making notes on
what you know about atoms. Include a sketch of an
Atoms are the smallest particles there are.
There are 92 different types of atom.
atom.
Most of the mass of an atom is in the nucleus.
Now discuss these statements and decide which are
true and which are false:
Atoms have no charge.
DANGEROUS DISCOVERIES
Figure 22.1a: New understanding of the structure of
the atom lead to the development of the nuclear bomb
b: Lise Meitner was the first person to describe nuclear
fission but did not share in the Nobel prize awarded for
this discovery.
The early 20th century was an exciting time to be a
physicist. The idea of atoms had been around since
Democritus in ancient Greece, but now huge strides
were being made in understanding how atoms were
made up. Ernest Rutherford had described a new
model of the atom, containing a tiny, dense nucleus
and the particles in the nucleus were identified.
These discoveries were being made alongside the
rise of fascism in Europe which lead to the Second
World War. German physicist Otto Hahn split a
uranium nucleus and found barium in the debris of
his experiment. Lise Meitner, a Jewish colleague
of Hahn, working in exile in Sweden, explained the
process and called it nuclear fission. Hahn was later
22.1 Atomic structure
At one time, physics textbooks would have said that
atoms are very tiny, too tiny ever to be seen. Certainly, a
single atom is too small to be seen using a conventional
light microscope. But technology now allows us to
see into the atom.There is more than one kind of
awarded the Nobel prize for this discovery. Nuclear
fission releases a huge amount of energy and the
Hungarian scientist, Leo Szilard, also working in exile,
realised that this could be used to make a bomb. The
fear was that Nazi scientists would create this bomb,
allowing them to win the war.
Szilard enlisted the help of Einstein in writing to the
US president to persuade him of the necessity of
developing the bomb before the Nazis did. After
the bombing of Pearl Harbor the USA joined the
war. Within a year the Manhattan Project successfully
produced the chain reaction needed for the bomb.
In 1945, bombs were dropped causing thousands of
deaths in Hiroshima and Nagasaki in Japan.
J. Robert Oppenheimer, one of the Manhattan
Project team who developed the bomb, described
it using words from the Bhagavad Gita, 'Now I
am become Death, the destroyer of worlds'. After
the end of the Second World War, Oppenheimer
campaigned for international cooperation to limit the
proliferation of nuclear arms.
There are now about 27 000 nuclear bombs in the
world.
Discussion questions
1
To what extent are scientists responsible for the
ways in which their discoveries are used?
2
Should the nuclear physicists have destroyed
their research when they realised how
destructive it could be?
microscope that can be used to show individual atoms.
Figure 22.2 shows a photograph made using a scanning
tunnelling microscope. The picture shows silicon atoms
on the surface of a crystal of silicon (the material that
transistors and computer chips are made from). The
diamond shape shows a group of 12 atoms. The whole
crystal is made up of vast numbers of groups of atoms
like this.
415
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Forming ions
An atom has equal amounts of positive and negative
charge so is neutral overall. Electrons can be gained or
lost by atoms relatively easily, for example by rubbing
an insulator as we saw in Chapter 17. This leads to the
formation of ions in a process called ionisation. An atom
which gains an electron has more negative than positive
charge and so becomes a negative ion. An atom which
loses an electron is left with more positive than negative
charge and so becomes a positive ion.
KEY WORD
Figure 22.2: Individual silicon atoms (bright spots, artificially
coloured by a computer) on the surface of a silicon crystal,
observed using a scanning tunnelling microscope. The
diamond shape (which has been drawn on the image)
indicates the basic repeating pattern that makes up the crystal
structure of silicon. In this photograph, the silicon atoms
are magnified 100 million times. (A good light microscope
can only magnify by about 1000 times.) Roughly speaking,
4000000000 atoms would fit into a length of 1 metre.
In 1909, Ernest Rutherford and his colleagues discovered
that every atom has a tiny central nucleus. This gave
rise to the ‘solar system’ model of the atom shown
in Figure 22.3. In this model, the negatively charged
electrons orbit the positively charged nucleus. The
electrons are attracted to the nucleus (because of its
opposite charge), but their speed prevents them from
falling into it.
Figure 22.3: The nuclear model of the atom. Six electrons
are illustrated orbiting a nucleus made up of six protons and
six neutrons.
416
>
ionisation when a particle (atom or molecule)
becomes electrically charged by losing or gaining
electrons
Discovering the nucleus
Electrons were discovered in 1896 by the English physicist,
J. J. Thomson. He realised that electrons Here much smaller
and lighter than atoms. (We now know that the mass of an
electron is about
of the mass of a hydrogen atom.)
J
1836
He guessed, correctly, that electrons Were part of atoms.
Other scientists argued that, since electrons had negative
charge, there must be other particles in an atom with an
equal amount of positive charge, so that an atom has
no overall charge - (it is neutral). Since electrons have
very little mass, the positive charge must also account for
most of the mass of the atom. Figure 22.4 shows a model
that illustrates this. The atom is formed from a sphere of
positively charged matter with tiny, negatively charged
electrons embedded in it. This is called the plum pudding
model. In this model, the electrons are the negatively
charged plums in a positively charged pudding. You can
see that this is a different model from the solar system
model we described earlier (Figure 22.3).
Figure 22.4a: A plum pudding is a cake with fruit dotted
through it. b: In Thomson's model, the negatively charged
electrons are the plums stuck in a positively charged pudding.
22 The nuclear atom
KEY WORDS
plum pudding model- a disproved model of the
atom which imagined it to consist of a positive
'pudding' with electrons dotted through it
alpha partide (a-partide): a particle made up of
two protons and two neutrons; it is emitted by an
atomic nucleus during radioactive decay
So why do we no longer think that atoms are like plum
puddings? The answer comes from an experiment carried
out by the New Zealander, Ernest Rutherford, and his
colleagues, Hans Geiger and Ernest Marsden, about ten
years after Thomson’s discovery of the electron.
They fired tiny particles called alpha particles at a very
thin piece of gold foil. Alpha particles are tiny, but an
alpha particle has almost 8000 times as much mass as an
electron, and they were moving fast (you will learn more
about alpha particles in chapter 23). They used gold as
it is easy to get gold foil which is only a few atoms thick.
Their calculations suggested this was a bit like firing
bullets at plum puddings. They predicted that the alpha
particles would pass straight through the gold.
Rutherford realised that the answer was to do with
electric charge. Alpha particles are positively charged.
If they are repelled back from the gold foil, it must be
by another positive charge. If only a few were repelled,
it was because the positive charge of the gold atoms
was concentrated in a tiny space within each atom.
Most alpha particles passed straight through because
they never went near this concentration of charge (see
Figure 22.6). This tiny core of concentrated positive
charge, at the heart of every atom, is what we now call
the atom’s nucleus.
Rutherford concluded that:
most of the mass of an atom is concentrated in the
central nucleus
the nucleus is positively charged
the nucleus is tiny compared to the atom; an atom is
mainly empty space.
Geiger and Marsden found that most of the alpha
particles passed straight through the gold foil, scarcely
deflected. However, a few bounced back towards the
source of the radiation. It was as if there was something
very hard in the gold foil, like a ball-bearing buried
inside the plum pudding. What was going on?
scattered
particles
most particles
are un deflected
Figure 22.6: Most alpha particles pass straight through
the gold foil because they do not pass close to the atomic
nucleus. The closer they are to the nucleus, the more they
are deflected or scattered. Only those which head straight to
the nucleus are reflected straight back.
In later years, Rutherford often spoke of the surprising
results of the alpha scattering experiment. He said:
source of
particles
a few particles circular fluorescent
are scattered back
towards the source
screen
Figure 22.5: The experiment to show alpha particle
scattering by gold foil. Alpha particles from the source strike
the gold foil. Most pass straight through, and some are
scattered a bit. A few, about one in 8000, are scattered back
towards the source. The experiment is performed in a vacuum
chamber as air would absorb the alpha particles.
It was quite the most incredible event that ever happened
to me in my life. It was as if you fired a fifteen-inch
artillery shell at a piece of tissue paper and it came back
and hit you.
KEY WORD
nucleus: small, dense, positively charged region
at the centre of an atom
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
A sense of scale
CONTINUED
Rutherford was able to analyse the results from Geiger
and Marsden’s experiment to work out just how big the
nucleus of a gold atom was. An atom is small (about
1010 metres across) but its nucleus is very much smaller
(about 10-15 metres in diameter). The electrons travel
around the nucleus. They are even tinier than the nucleus.
And the rest of the atom is simply empty space.
It is hard to imagine these relative sizes. Try picturing a
glass marble about 1 cm in diameter, placed at the centre
of a football pitch, to represent the nucleus of an atom.
Then the electrons are like tiny grains of dust, orbiting
the nucleus at different distances, right out to the edge of
the football ground.
It is even harder to imagine, when you stub your toe on
a rock, that the atoms of the rock (and your toe) are
almost entirely empty space!
could report this in a way that conveys Rutherford's
amazement at what his team discovered. Prepare
either a newspaper report or a videoed interview
(clearly this wouldn't have been an option in 1 909
when the experiment took place!).
Remember that the audience are not scientists, so
you will need to introduce the idea of atoms and
explain what scientists before Rutherford thought.
Questions
1
In the plum pudding model of the atom:
a what are the plums?
b what is the pudding?
2
In the alpha particle scattering experiment, explain
what happened to alpha particles:
a heading directly towards a gold nucleus
b passing close to a gold nucleus
c passing through the empty space between
nuclei.
How did this experiment prove that Ihe nucleus
must be very small?
In the solar system model of the atom, what force
holds the electrons in their orbitjiaround the
nucleus?
A successful model
Rutherford’s model of the atom was soon accepted by
other scientists. It gave a clear explanation of the alpha
particle scattering experiment, and further tests with
other metals confirmed Rutherford’s ideas. It clearly
showed that the plum pudding model was wrong.
Rutherford’s model also allowed scientists to think about
other questions. Chemists wanted to know how atoms
bonded together. Physicists wanted to understand why
some atoms are unstable and emit radiation, and how
X-rays are produced. These are all questions to which we
now have good answers, and Rutherford’s discovery of
the atomic nucleus did a lot to help answer them.
Today, scientists have rather different ideas about atoms.
They want to calculate many different quantities, and
so models of the atom are much more mathematical.
Quantum theory, developed not long after Rutherford’s
work, made the atom seem like a much fuzzier thing,
not a collection of little spheres orbiting each other.
However, the important thing about a model is that it
should help us to understand things better, and help
us to make new predictions. Rutherford’s model of the
nuclear atom has certainly done that.
ACTIVITY 22.1
Nuclear news
Imagine you are a science reporter. You have been
sent to interview Rutherford following the alpha
particle scattering experiment. Think about how you
418
y
3
4
22.2 Protons, neutrons
and electrons
We now know that the atomic nucleus is made up of two
types of particle, protons and neutrons. The protons carry
the positive charge of the nucleus, while the neutrons are
neutral. Negatively charged electrons orbit the positively
charged nucleus. Protons and neutrons have similar
masses, and they account for most of the mass of the
atom because electrons are so light. Together, protons
and neutrons are known as nucleons.
Table 22.1 summarises information about the masses and
charges of the three sub-atomic particles. The columns
headed Relative charge and Relative mass give the charge
and mass of each particle compared to that of a proton.
It is much easier to remember these values, rather than
the actual values in coulombs (C) and kilograms (kg).
22 The nuclear atom
Atoms and elements
KEY WORDS
proton: a positively charged particle found in the
atomic nucleus
neutron, an uncharged particle found in the
atomic nucleus
nucleon a particle found in the atomic nucleus; a
proton or a neutron
relative charge; the charge of a particle relative
to the charge of a proton
relative mass: the mass of a particle relative to
the mass of a proton
Once the particles that make up atoms were identified, it
was much easier to understand the Periodic Table of the
elements (Figure 22.7). This shows the elements in order,
starting with the lightest (hydrogen, then helium) and
working up to the heaviest. In fact, it is not the masses of
the atoms that determine the order in which they appear,
but the number of protons in the nucleus of each atom.
Every atom of hydrogen has one proton in its nucleus, so
hydrogen is element number 1. Every helium atom has
two protons, so helium is element number 2, and so on.
Particle
Position
Charge/C
Relative
charge
Mass/kg
Relative mass
proton
in nucleus
+1.6x10~19
+1
1.67 x10~27
1
neutron
in nucleus
0
0
1.67 x1(r27
1
electron
orbiting
nucleus
-UxKF1’
-1
9.11 x1Q-31
1
(practical|y zero>
1836
Table 22.1 Charges and masses of the three sub-atomic particles.
1
3
He
H
2
Li 4Be
5
B
6
c
7
N
Al 14Si 15P
Na Mg
13
11
8^ F Ne
9
s
16
10
Cl 18Ar
17
K 20Ca 21Sc 22Ti 23V 24Cr 25Mn 26Fe 27Co 28Ni 29Cu 30Zn 31Ga 32Ge 33As 34Se 35Br 36Kr
19
Rb 38Sr 39^ 40Zr 41Nb 42Mo 43Tc 44Ru 45Rh 46Rd Ag 48Cd 49In 50Sn 51Sb 52Te 53I 54Xe
37
La to
Os 77Ir 78Pt 79Au 80Hg 81Tl 82Pb 83Bi 84Po 85At 86Rn
Cs
Ba
Lu 72Hf 73Ta 74w 75Re 76
56
55
Fr 88Ra AcLrto
87
Sm 63Eu 64Gd 65Tb 66Dy7 67Ho 68Er 69Tm 70Yb 71Lu
La 58Ce 59Pr 60Nd 61Pm 62
57
Md 102
No 103Lr
Fm 101
Cm 97Bk 98Cf 99Es 100
Ac 90Th 91Pa 92u 93Np 94Pu 95Am 96
89
1
Figure 22.7: The Periodic Table of the elements is a way of organising what we know about the different elements, based on
their atomic structures.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Each element has its own symbol, consisting of one or
two letters, such as H for hydrogen, and He for helium.
Sometimes, the symbol for an atom may be written with
two numbers in front of it, one above the other, such as:
2 He
A nucleus can be described by two numbers: the
proton number, and the nucleon number which
is the total number of
and
in the
nucleus.
6
This represents an atom of helium. The bottom number
tells us that there are two protons in the nucleus of an
atom of helium, and the top number tells us that there
is a total of four nucleons in the nucleus of an atom of
helium. From this, it is simple to work out that there
must be two neutrons in the nucleus.
We can write the general symbol for an element (X) with
its proton number (Z), which is the number of protons in
the nucleus, and nucleon number (^), which is the number
of nucleons (protons and neutron) in the nucleus, as
follows:
Subatomic
particle
REFLECTION
What strategies have you found useful in
remembering the properties of each of the
subatomic particles and the definitions of nucleon
and proton numbers? Share your strategies with
a partner.
-1
in the
nucleus
Table 22.2
7
8
KEY WORDS
nucleon number (A): (or mass number) the
number of nucleons (protons and neutrons) in an
atomic nucleus
Relative
mass
1
electron
Z is proton number (also known as the atomic number)
and A is nucleon number (also known as the mass
number). This is known as nuclide notation.
proton number (Z): (or atomic number) the
number of protons in an atomic nucleus
Relative
charge
Position
proton
zX
A neutral atom of element X will also have Z electrons
orbiting the nucleus.
Copy and complete Table 22.2.
A particular neutral atom of boron is represented
by
a What is its proton number?
b What is its nucleon number?
c Write down the numbers of protons, neutrons
and electrons it contains.
A cobalt atom contains 33 neutrons.
a Use the periodic table to find its proton
number.
b Write down an expression in the form
to
represent the cobalt nucleus.
How many times greater is the mass of a proton
than the mass of an electron?
^X
9
Elements and isotopes
It is the proton number, that tells us which element an
atom belongs to. For example, a small atom with just two
protons in its nucleus (Z 2) is a helium atom. A much
bigger atom with 92 protons in its nucleus is a uranium
atom, because uranium is element 92.
=
From Z and A you can work out a third number, the
neutron number (TV), which is the number of neutrons in
the nucleus.
proton number + neutron number = nucleon number
Questions
5
420
Copy and complete these sentences:
An atom has a tiny, dense
. This contains
positively charged
and neutral
.
These two particles have approximately the same
>
Z + N=A
KEY WORDS
neutron number (N): number of neutrons in the
nucleus of an atom
22 The nuclear atom
WORKED EXAMPLE 22.1
What can you deduce about the atom whose nucleus
can be represented by 14 C?
Step 1: Look at the atomic symbol.
Table 22.3 shows atoms of two isotopes of helium, 4 He
(the most common isotope) and 2 He (a lighter and much
rarer isotope). Each 3 He has two protons in the nucleus
and two electrons orbiting it, but the lighter isotope
has only one neutron. These isotopes are referred to as
helium-4 and helium-3.
The symbol C tells us it is a carbon nucleus.
Step 2: Identify the number of protons:
Z= 6
Step 3: Identify the number of electrons.
It is a neutral atom, so it has the same number
of protons as electrons = 6.
Proton
Neutron
Nucleon
number Z
number 2V
number A
jHe
2.
2
4
2 He
2
1
3
Symbol for
isotope
Table 22.3: Isotopes of helium.
Step 4: Calculate the number of neutrons:
N = A-Z = 14~6 = 8
Answer
I4C is a carbon nucleus with six protons, six electrons
and eight neutrons.
The atoms of all elements exist in more than one form.
For example, Figure 22.8 shows three types of hydrogen
atom. Each has just one proton in its nucleus, but they
have different numbers of neutrons (0, 1 and 2). This
means that they are described as different isotopes
of hydrogen.
Table 22.4 shows two isotopes of uranium. Uranium-238
is the most common isotope. Uranium-238 has three
more neutrons than uranium-235, but the same number
of protons. Uranium-235 is used in nuclear power
stations as its nuclei can be split to release a huge amount
of energy.
Proton
number Z
number N
Nucleon
number A
235
92 U
u
92
143
235
u
92
146
238
Symbol for
isotope
238
92 u
Neutron
Table 22.4: Isotopes of uranium.
Isotopes at work
Figure 22.8: Hydrogen exists in three different forms known
as isotopes. All three have the same proton number.
•
•
The different isotopes of an element all have the
same chemical properties, but those with a greater
number of neutrons are heavier.
The different isotopes of an element all have the
same number of protons but different numbers of
neutrons in their nuclei.
KEY WORD
isotope: isotopes of an element have the same
proton number but different nucleon numbers
All elements have isotopes, some as many as 36. For
most chemical elements, at least one isotope is stable.
Other isotopes are often unstable. This means that the
nucleus is likely to give out radioactivity in order to
become stable. You will learn about radioactive decay in
Chapter 23.
Questions
1 0 Carbon exists in two forms g2 C and g4 C.
a Write down the number of protons, neutrons
and electrons in each.
b Copy and complete these sentences:
of carbon.
g2C and g4C are two
number, but
They have the same
numbers.
different
properties.
Both have the same
421
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
11 Table 22.5 lists the proton and nucleon numbers of
six different nuclei.
a
Copy and complete the table by filling in the
empty spaces.
b Which three nuclei are isotopes of one element?
c
Which two nuclei are isotopes of another element?
d Use the Periodic Table (Figure 22.7) to identify
the three elements in Table 22.5.
Nucleus
Proton
Neutron
number Z
number A
6
6
Nu-1
Nu-2
Nu-3
Nucleon
number A
Figure 22.9: A uranium-235 nucleus being split to make
barium and krypton nuclei, three more neutrons and a lot
of energy.
13
This reaction can be represented by a balanced nuclear
equation:
6
7
14
Nu-4
8
14
Nu-5
6
11
Nu-6
7
13
Table 22.5 Proton and nucleon numbers of nuclei.
Charge and mass of nuclei
The charge on a nucleus is equal to the number of
protons as each proton has a relative charge of + 1.
So all three isotopes of hydrogen have a charge of +1
as all contain just one proton.
The mass of a nucleus is equal to the mass of the
nucleons as both protons and neutrons have a relative
mass of one. Each of the hydrogen isotopes has a
different mass. Protium has a mass of one, deuterium
has a mass of two and tritium has a mass of three.
Question
12 Write down the mass and charge of the nuclei of the
helium and uranium isotopes shown in Tables 22.3
and 22.4.
Nuclear fission and fusion
In Chapter 7 you learnt about the use of nuclear fuels.
These produce energy by splitting nuclei which is a
process known as nuclear fission. Figure 22.9 shows a
fission reaction in which a uranium-235 nucleus is hit by
a neutron. The extra neutron causes it to become unstable
and it splits, making two new nuclei and three extra
neutrons. A large amount of energy is also released. These
neutrons can then split, leading to a chain reaction.
422
y
2^U + in ^Ba + >^Kr + 3 in + energy
Both the proton numbers and the nucleon numbers must
be equal on each side of the equation:
Proton number: 92 + 0 = 36 +56 + 3(0)
92 = 92 Z
Nucleon number: 235 + 1 = 92 + 141 + 3(1)
236 = 236 /
Nuclear fusion produces even more energy than nuclear
fission. Fusion is when two nuclei join together to form
a larger nucleus. This can only happen at extremely
high temperatures. Fusion is the process by which stars
produce heat and light. The equation, ^elow shows one of
the fusion reactions which occurs in the Sun. You can see
that the proton and nucleon numbers balance:
?H + ?H^lHe + in
Something for nothing?
As you know, energy cannot be created or destroyed. So,
where does the huge amount of energy released in fission
and fusion come from? To answer this we need one of the
most famous equations in physics:
E = me2
The total mass of the particles before a fission or fusion
reaction is found to be slightly more than the total mass
after the reaction. The mass which is lost is converted to
energy, and Einstein’s equation allows us to calculate the
amount of energy released:
energy released (£) = mass lost (m) x the speed of light
squared (c2)
The speed of light squared is a huge number, so even
a very small loss of mass will produce a large amount
of energy.
22
The nuclear atom
PROJECT
A brief history of particle physics
Throughout history mankind has tried to explain the
world around us and what it is made of. This has led
to an understanding of atoms, then their constituent
protons, neutrons and electrons. In this chapter we
have covered part of this story, but there have been
many scientists making discoveries and often
receiving Nobel prizes for their work. And the
story is not complete. In 2012, scientists at CERN
detected the Higgs boson. It is a particle which had
been predicted theoretically and which helps in our
understanding of gravity.
Figure 22.10a: Ernest Rutherford (shown here in his laboratory at Manchester University), b: The Large Hadron Collider
(LHC) at CERN in Switzerland. The LHC is so big that scientists cycle from one part of an experiment to another.
Produce a timeline or presentation showing the main
developments in particle physics from ancient world
thought to present day investigations using the Large
Hadron Collider.
You could investigate the contributions of:
•
•
•
•
•
the Jains in Ancient India
ancient Greeks such as Democritus and Leucippus
John Dalton
J. J. Thomson
Ernest Rutherford, Hans Geiger and Ernest
•
•
•
James Chadwick
Murray Gell-Mann
Francois Englert and Peter Higgs.
You should include diagrams to explain experiments
and models of the atom. Try to include as many of the
key words from this chapter as you can.
Your presentation should focus on the way in which
ideas follow on from each other. It should inspire
people with the knowledge that there is still a lot to
be discovered by the physicists of tomorrow.
Marsden
PEER ASSESSMENT
Give feedback to another group. Write comments on these points:
• Does the presentation make it clear what each scientist contributed to the story?
• Are the experiments described clearly?
• Do you feel it gives the reader/viewer a sense of scientists building on the work of those who went
before them?
423
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SUMMARY
The atom consists of a tiny positive nucleus surrounded by mainly empty space with negative electrons orbiting.
Positive or negative ions are formed when an atom loses or gains electrons.
The nucleus contains two types of nucleons: positively charged protons and neutral neutrons.
Rutherford’s alpha particle scattering experiment provided evidence to support the nuclear model of the atom.
Protons and neutrons have approximately the same mass. This is nearly 2000 times the mass of an electron.
Protons and electrons have equal but opposite charge.
A nucleus can be described using the notation X, where X is the chemical symbol, Z the number of protons
and A the number of nucleons.
Isotopes are nuclei of the same element which have the same proton number but different nucleon numbers.
Nuclear fission is the splitting of a large nucleus, which releases a lot of energy.
Nuclear fusion is joining together of small nuclei, which releases even more energy than fission.
Nuclear fission and fusion can be described using nuclear equations.
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
1 Which row correctly gives the relative charge of a proton, neutron
and electron?
Proton
Neutron
Hl
Electron
1
0
1
1
1
-1
-1
1
0
1
0
-1
2 A nucleus is represented by the notation i^Pb. What particles does it contain? [1 ]
A 82 protons and 193 neutrons
B 82 protons, 82 electrons and 111 neutrons
C 82 neutrons and 111 protons
D 82 protons and 111 neutrons
3 An element has two isotopes. What is different for the two isotopes?
[1 ]
A the number of protons
B the chemical symbol
C the number of neutrons
D the chemical properties of the isotope
4 a Name the two types of particles found in an atom’s nucleus.
[2]
b State the name given to the total number of particles in a nucleus.
[1 ]
c Describe what happens to the charge on an atom when it gains
an electron.
[2]
[Total: 5]
424
y
COMMAND WORDS
state: express in clear
terms
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
a How many electrons does the atom have?
[1 ]
b How many protons does it have?
[1 ]
c What is its nucleon number?
[1]
d How many neutrons does it have?
e Copy and complete this nuclear notation to represent the
beryllium nucleus:
[1 ]
gBe
[1]
f A radioactive isotope of beryllium is known as beryllium-11 . How many
[3]
protons, neutrons and electrons does an atom of this isotope contain?
g Write down the nuclear notation for beryllium-11.
[2]
[Total: 10]
6 The ‘plum pudding’ model was used by scientists in the early 20th century to
describe the structure of the atom.
a Scientists knew that atoms contained negative electrons and that atoms
[1 ]
were neutral overall. What did they assume about the ‘pudding’?
b Geiger and Marsden carried out an experiment which showed the plum
pudding model was wrong. They fired alpha particles at gold foil which
was only a few atoms thick. The diagram below shows three alpha particles
approaching the gold nuclei. Copy and complete the diagram to show what
[3]
happened to the three particles.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Describe the structure of the atom.
22.1
Describe how ions are formed.
22.1
Describe Rutherford’s alpha scattering experiment and
its conclusions.
22.1
Name the particles in the nucleus and state their mass
and charge.
22.2
Define proton number Z.
22.2
Define nucleon number A.
22.2
Describe nuclei using the notation ^X.
22.2
Describe the similarities and differences between two
isotopes of an element.
22.2
Describe the processes of nuclear fission and fusion.
22.2
State what the proton and nucleon numbers tell us
about the charge and mass of a nucleus.
22.2
426
>
Almost
there
Confident
to move on
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
In this chapter we will look at the radiation emitted
from the nuclei of unstable isotopes, which can
cause ionisation. This will include high frequency
electromagnetic radiation.
The sentences above include a lot of key words
you have met elsewhere in this book. Write down
Key word
Definition from memory
as many as you can in a table. Try to define each
word from memory before referring to your notes
or to the glossary at the back of the book. Research
shows that trying to recall information like this is a
great way of getting it to stick in your mind.
Definition from notes or glossary
REFLECTION
Did you remember the key parts of the definitions?
How can you help yourself to learn important
definitions?
Consider making revision cards and regularly
checking what you know. Find out about mobile
phone apps which help you do this.
THE RADIUM GIRLS
Radioactivity was first discovered in 1896. Soon
afterwards, in 1898, Marie Curie discovered radium
which was found to be useful in treating cancer.
It was assumed that these emissions which could
cure cancer, must be healthy. Radium was used to
treat any conditions where the patient seemed to
need more energy, from anaemia to impotence.
An industry developed selling products such as
radioactive water, toothpaste and face creams to
give you a 'healthy' glow. Figure 23.1 shows an
advert for such a cream.
beginning to show that radium was a dangerous
substance and so limited their own exposure to it.
Some workers questioned whether ^he radium was
safe and were reassured that they were not at risk.
Um beau maifUii&Lfe
doit ibie mecede
Radium was used in paint which converted the
radiation it emitted into light. The process is called
luminescence. This was used to make watch and
clock faces visible in the dark.
The radium was painted on to these watches by
young women in factories. These jobs were popular
as radium was a glamorous, expensive product and
the work was much cleaner than other factory work.
The women used camel hair brushes to apply the
radioactive paint. They were told to squeeze these
brushes between their lips as they worked to keep
a fine point on the brush. These instructions came
from factory owners who knew that research was
428
>
THORWDIA
InfgBj
DawaquiHanj
Figure 23.1: The name Tho-Radia refers to the radioactive
isotopes of thorium and radium used in this face cream.
23
Radioactivity
CONTINUED
developed bone and other cancers which were often
fatal. When the women began to die, some factory
owners tried to blame their deaths on a virus, or on
syphilis.
Eventually the women won a court case in 1 928
and the survivors received compensation, though
the companies appealed and it was only in 1 939
that the case was finally won. Luminous watches
were still sold until the 1960s, though the painting
techniques were changed.
Discussion questions
Figure 23.2: The radium girls painted luminous
radioactive paint on clock and watch faces.
Radium is chemically similar to calcium and the
radium replaced calcium in the bones of the
women, weakening and damaging their bones. They
experienced pain and many - probably thousands -
1
Why did the factory owners not inform the
workers about the dangers of working with
radium?
2
Do you think this situation could happen
today? Consider ways in which laws and access
to information may have made this less likely.
23.1 Radioactivity all
around us
We need to distinguish between two things: radioactive
substances and the radiation that they give out. Many
naturally occurring substances are radioactive. Usually
the radiation in these substances is not very concentrated,
so they do not cause a problem. There are two ways in
which radioactive substances can cause us problems:
•
If a radioactive substance gets inside us, its
radiation can harm us. We say that we have been
contaminated.
•
If the radiation a radioactive substance produces
hits our bodies, we receive a dose of radiation.
We have been irradiated.
In fact, we are exposed to low levels of radiation all the time
- this is known as background radiation. In addition, we
may be exposed to radiation from artificial sources, such as
the radiation we receive if we have a medical X-ray.
Figure 23.3 shows the different sources that contribute to
the average dose of radiation received by people across
the world. It is divided into natural background radiation
(about 85%) and radiation from artificial sources (about
15%). We will look at these different sources in turn.
14% medicine
(X-rays, for example)
1% nuclear industry
42% radon
(radioactive gases in the air)
14% cosmic rays
11% food and drink
18% buildings and soil
n 85% natural radiation
15% artificial radiation
Figure 23.3: This pie chart shows the different sources of
radiation and how they contribute to the average dose of
radiation received each year by an individual. Only about
15% comes from non-natural sources.
429
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Sources of natural
background radiation
The air is radioactive. It contains a radioactive gas
called radon, which seeps up to the Earth’s surface from
radioactive uranium rocks underground. Because we
breathe in air all the time, we are exposed to radiation from
this substance. This contributes about half of our annual
exposure. (This varies widely from country to country, and
from one part of a country to another, depending on how
much uranium there is in the underlying rocks.)
The ground contains radioactive substances. We use
materials from the ground to build our houses, so we are
exposed to radiation from these.
Our food and drink is also slightly radioactive. Living
things grow by taking in materials from the air and
the ground. Some of these materials are radioactive so
the plants which feed into our food chains will also be
slightly radioactive.
Finally, radiation reaches us from space in the form
of cosmic rays. Some of this radiation comes from the
Sun, some from further out in space. Most cosmic rays
are stopped by the Earth’s atmosphere. If you live up a
mountain, you will be exposed to more radiation from
this source.
Many people, such as medical radiographers and staff in
a nuclear power station, work with radiation. Overall, a
power station does not add much to the national average
dose, but for individuals who work there it can increase
their dose by up to 10%.
Finally, small amounts of radioactive substances escape
from the nuclear industry, which processes uranium for
use as the fuel in nuclear power stations and handles the
highly radioactive spent fuel after it has been used.
Detecting radiation
Radiation can be measured using a Geiger counter.
This consists of a detector called a Geiger-Muller
tube which detects radiation, connected to a counter.
The counter records the rate at which radiation is
detected. This is known as the count rate and it is
measured in counts per second (count/s) or cdunts per
minute (count/min).
Because natural background radiation is around us all
the time, we have to take account of it in experiments. It
may be necessary to measure the background level and
then to subtract it from experimental measurements.
Sources of artificial
Figure 23.4: Using a Geiger counter to monitor radiation
levels in crops.
background radiation
Most radiation from artificial sources comes from
medical sources. This includes the use of X-rays and
gamma rays for seeing inside the body, and the use of
radiation for destroying cancer cells. There is always
a danger that exposure to such radiation may trigger
cancer. Medical physicists are always working to reduce
the levels of radiation used in medical procedures.
Overall, many more lives are saved than lost through this
beneficial use of radiation.
Today, most nuclear weapons testing is done
underground. In the past, bombs were detonated on
land or in the air, and this contributed much more to the
radiation dose received by people around the world.
When you fly in an aircraft, you are high in the
atmosphere. You are exposed to more cosmic rays. This is
not a serious problem for the occasional flier, but aircraft
crews have to keep a check on their exposure.
430
y
KEY WORDS
radioactive substance: a substance that decays
by emitting radiation from its atomic nuclei
radiation: energy spreading out from a source
carried by particles or waves
contaminated: when an object has acquired
some unwanted radioactive substance
irradiated: when an object has been exposed to
radiation
background radiation: the radiation from the
environment to which we are exposed all the time
count rate: the number of decaying radioactive
atoms detected each second (or minute, or hour)
23
Questions
1
2
3
Describe what is meant by the term ‘background
radiation’.
Name three sources of natural background
radiation and three sources of artificial background
radiation.
Which type of natural background radiation are
airline crews exposed to more than most people?
23.2 Radioactive decay
Made of
Charge
a
2 protons +
2 neutrons
positive
beta
P
an electron
negative
gamma
Y
electromagnetic
radiation
neutral
Name
Symbol
alpha
Table 23.1: Three types of radiation produced by naturally
occurring radioactive substances.
•
An alpha particle (a-particle) is made up of two
protons and two neutrons. (This is the same as the
nucleus of a helium atom.) Because it contains
protons, it is positively charged.
•
A beta particle (p-particle) is an electron. It is not
one of the electrons that orbit the nucleus - it comes
from inside the nucleus. It is negatively charged, and
its mass is much less than that of an alpha particle.
Not all nuclei give out radiation. Some nuclei are
unstable and give out radiation in order to become more
stable. This process is known as radioactive decay.
If you listen to the clicks or beeps of a Geiger counter,
you may notice that it is impossible to predict when the
next sound will come. This is because radioactive decay
is a random process. Radioactive substances contain
unstable nuclei which will decay spontaneously. We
cannot predict which nucleus will decay next or when this
will happen. The direction in which the radiation will be
emitted is also random. Radioactive decay is not affected
by external factors such as temperature.
Radioactivity
• A gamma ray (y-ray) is a form of electromagnetic
radiation with a very short wavelength and high
frequency. It is similar to an X-ray, but has more
energy.
Why are some nuclei unstable?
Radiation is emitted by the nucleus of an atom which
is unstable. Many elements have isotopes which are
radioactive because their nuclei are unstable. For some
isotopes this is because the nucleus is too heavy. Other
isotopes are unstable because they have too many
neutrons. An unstable nucleus emits radiation in order to
become more stable.
Fortunately, most of the atoms around us have stable
nuclei. When the Earth formed, about 4500 million years
ago, there were many more radioactive atoms around.
This means that the level of background radiation
used to be much higher than it is today. However, most
radioactive atoms have decayed to become stable.
Three types of radiation
There are three types of radiation emitted by radioactive
substances (Table 23.1). These are named after the first
three letters of the Greek alphabet, alpha (a), beta (P)
and gamma (y). Alpha and beta are particles; gamma is a
form of electromagnetic radiation (see Chapter 15).
Figure 23.5a: Alpha emission, b: Beta emission, c: Gamma
emission.
431
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
KEY WORDS
radioactive decay the emission of alpha, beta or
gamma radiation from an unstable nucleus
random process: a process that happens at a
random rate and in random directions; the timing
and direction of the next emission cannot be
predicted
beta particle (0-particle): a high speed electron
that is emitted by an atomic nucleus during
radioactive decay
gamma ray (y-ray): electromagnetic radiation
emitted by an atomic nucleus during radioactive
decay
•
a-particles are absorbed most easily. They can travel
about 5 cm in air before they are absorbed. They are
absorbed by a thin sheet of paper, a-particles cannot
penetrate skin.
•
0-particles can travel fairly easily through air or
paper. But they are absorbed by a few millimetres of
metal such as aluminium.
•
y-radiation is the most penetrating. It takes several
centimetres of a dense metal like lead, or several
metres of concrete, to absorb most of the gamma
radiation.
Figure 23.6 shows the penetrating power of each type
of radiation.
An atom of a radioactive substance emits either an
a-particle or a 0-particle. In addition, it may emit some
energy in the form of a y-ray. The y-ray is usually emitted
at the same time as the a-particle or 0-particle, but it may
be emitted some time later.
When an atom of a radioactive substance decays by
a- or 0-decay, it becomes an atom of another element.
This is because the number of protons in the nucleus
changes.
a-particles have a much greater mass than beta particles,
so they travel more slowly, y-rays, like all electromagnetic
waves, travel at the speed of light.
Questions
4
Copy and complete the following sentences.
Radioactive decay happens when a nucleus is
. This may be because it is too massive or
.
because it contains too many
An a-particle consists of
and
. A 0-particle is an
. y-radiation is a
form of high frequency
radiation.
5
A 0-particle is identical to an electron. How is it
different to most electrons?
6
Which type of radiation travels at the speed of light?
Penetrating power
When physicists were trying to understand the nature
of radioactivity, they noticed that radiation can pass
through solid materials. Different types of radiation can
penetrate different thicknesses of materials.
432
>
Figure 23.6: The penetrating power of y-rdyiation is the
greatest, a radiation has the least amount of penetrating
power. This is related to their ability to ionise the materials
they are passing through.
I
I
Ionisation
When radiation passes through air, it may knock
electrons out of atoms. This means ions are formed.
This process is called ionisation.
•
•
a-particles are the most ionising.
y-radiation is the least ionising.
As the radiation emitted by the nuclei of radioactive
substances causes the ionisation of the materials that
absorb it, it is often known as ionising nuclear radiation.
X-rays also cause ionisation in the materials they
pass through, and so they are also classed as ionising
radiation. X-rays are very similar to y-rays. However,
X-rays usually have less energy (longer wavelength) than
y-rays, and they are produced by X-ray machines, stars
and so on, rather than by radioactive substances.
When something has been exposed to radiation, it has been
irradiated. Although it absorbs the radiation, it does not
itself become radioactive. Things only become radioactive
if they absorb a radioactive substance. So you do not
become radioactive if you absorb cosmic rays (which you
23 Radioactivity
do all the time). But you do become radioactive if you
consume a radioactive substance. Coffee, for example,
contains tiny but measurable amounts of radioactive
potassium. You become contaminated by the coffee.
How ionisation happens
To explain the ionising effect of each type of radiation
we need to consider their kinetic energy and their charge.
Using, moving and storing
radioactive materials safely
Any element comes in several forms or isotopes (see
Section 22.2). Some may be stable, but others are
unstable, that is, they are radioactive. For example, carbon
has two stable isotopes (carbon-12 and carbon-13), but
carbon-14 is an unstable isotope. Unstable (radioactive)
isotopes are known as radioisotopes.
Speed /m/s
Charge
approx, (mass of
proton) x 4
~3x107
+2
p
approx, (mass of
proton) 4- 1 840
~2.9x108
-1
ionising nuclear radiation: radiation, emitted by
the nucleus which can cause ionisation; alpha or
beta particles, or gamma rays
Y
0
3x10«
0
radioisotope: a radioactive isotope of an element
Name
Mass
a
KEY WORDS
Table 23.2: Properties of ionising radiation.
Consider an a-particle passing through the air.
An a-particle is the slowest moving of all the three
radiations and has the largest charge. As the a-particle
collides with an air molecule, it may knock an electron
from the air molecule, so that it becomes charged.
The a-particle loses a little of its energy. It must ionise
thousands of molecules before it loses all of its energy
and comes to a halt, a-radiation is the most strongly
ionising radiation.
A 0-particle can also ionise air molecules. However, it is
less ionising for two reasons: its charge is much less than
that of an a-particle, and it moves faster. This means that
it is more likely to travel straight past an air molecule
without interacting with it. This is why 0 radiation can
travel further through air without being absorbed,
y-radiation is uncharged and it moves fastest of all.
This means that it is the least readily absorbed in air,
and therefore is the least ionising. Lead is a good
absorber because it is dense (its atoms are packed closely
together), and its nuclei are relatively large, so they
present an easy target for the y-rays.
You should be able to see the pattern linking ionising
power and absorption:
• a-radiation is the most strongly ionising, so it is the
most easily absorbed and the least penetrating.
• y-radiation is the least strongly ionising, so it is the
least easily absorbed and the most penetrating.
Effects of radioisotopes on cells
To use radioisotopes safely, we need to understand how
they affect cells. There are three ways in which radiation
can damage living cells.
•
An intense dose of radiation causes a lot of
ionisation in a cell, which can kill the cell. This
is what happens when someone suffers radiation
bums. The cells affected simply die, as if they had
been burned. If the sufferer is lucky and receives
suitable treatment, the tissue may regrow.
•
If the DNA in the cell nucleus is damaged, the
mechanisms that control the cell may break down.
The cell may divide uncontrollably and a tumour
forms. This is how radiation can cause cancer.
•
If the affected cell is a gamete (a sperm or egg cell),
the damaged DNA of its genes may be passed on
to future generations. This is how radiation can
produce genetic mutations. Occasionally, a mutation
can be beneficial to the offspring, but more often it is
harmful. A fertilised egg cell may not develop at all,
or the baby may have some form of genetic disorder.
We are least likely to be harmed by a radiation coming
from a source outside our bodies. This is because the
radiation is entirely absorbed by the layer of dead skin
cells on the outside of our bodies (and by our clothes).
However, if an a source gets inside us, it can be very
damaging, because its radiation is highly ionising. That
is why radon and thoron gases are so dangerous. We
breathe them into our lungs, where they irradiate us from
the inside. The result may be lung cancer.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Today, we know much more about radiation and the
safe handling of radioactive substances. Knowing how
to reduce the hazards of radiation means that we can
learn to live safely with it and put it to many worthwhile
purposes.
Knowing about the radiation produced by radioactive
materials helps us know how to handle them as safely
as possible. Anyone working with, or being exposed to,
ionising radiation must take safety precautions, such as
shielding, or limiting their exposure time. Figure 23.7
shows some of these precautions.
Figure 23.7a: Radiation suits are worn in contaminated areas, b: Radiographers operate equipment from a separate room,
c: School laboratory sources are stored in lead-lined wooden boxes and locked away in a labelled metal cabinet when not in
use. The tweezers allow the teacher to handle the sources at a safe distance, d: Radioactive material must be clearly marked
when it is being transported.
Safety precautions
Table 23.3 shows common safety precautions when dealing with radioactive material.
Safety precaution
workers in contaminated areas wear
protective suits
radioactive hazard labels
photographic film dosimeter badges
record keeping
remote operating of scanners
storage boxes for sources
Explanation
The suit will absorb radiation. Different materials can be used
depending on the type of radiation. For y-rays, lead-lined suits can be
used.
These warn people of the danger so they can stay at a safe distance
and reduce the time they are near the source for.
These monitor the amount of exposure a person has had. Once the
safe limit is reached, workers may be transferred to other areas.
Schools are required to record how long radioactive sources were
used for, and by whom. This allows them to ensure no-one is exposed
for too long.
The operator usually controls the scanner from a separate area. This
increases their distance from the source. They may also be behind a
screen which will absorb some of the radiation.
Radioactive sources must be stored securely, usually surrounded by
lead to absorb most of the radiation.
Table 23.3: Safety precautions for dealing with radioactive material.
434
y
23
Radioactive decay equations
KEY WORDS
Radioactive decay can be described using balanced
equations with the nuclear notation we used in
Chapter 22. To write these equations we need to consider
the effect of each emission on the nucleus emitting it:
•
a-decay: two protons and two neutrons are emitted.
The proton number decreases by 2 and the nucleon
number decreases by 4.
•
p-decay: a neutron splits into a proton and an
electron; the electron is emitted. The proton number
increases by 1 and the nucleon number remains
the same.
•
y-decay: this is the emission of energy from the
nucleus and it does not change the particles in
the nucleus.
These changes all lead to the nucleus becoming more
stable.
Here is an example of an equation for alpha decay:
2
Q4
Am -► 2,27 U + 2 He + energy
This represents the decay of americium-241, the
isotope used in smoke detectors. It emits an a-particle
(represented as a helium nucleus) and becomes an
isotope of uranium. An a-particle can be represented
as 2 He or 2a.
Notice that the numbers in this equation must balance
because we cannot lose mass or charge. So:
nucleon numbers:
241
proton numbers:
94
> 237 + 4
» 92 + 2
Here is an example of an equation for beta decay:
1
gC ->
N + _Je + energy
This is the decay that is used in radiocarbon dating.
A carbon-14 nucleus decays to become a nitrogen- 14
nucleus. The p-particle, an electron, is represented by
_Je or _]p. If we could see inside the nucleus, we would
see that a single neutron has split into a proton and an
electron. So:
}p +
>
For each of these two p-decay equations, you should be
able to see that the nucleon numbers and proton numbers
are balanced. We say that, in radioactive decay, nucleon
number and proton number are conserved.
Radioactivity
alpha decay: the decay of a radioactive nucleus
by the emission of an a-particle
beta decay: the decay of a radioactive nucleus by
the emission of a p-particle
WORKED EXAMPLE 23.1
A radioisotope of thorium (^Th) decays by emitting
an a-particle. The resulting nucleus is also unstable
and emits a beta particle. Write equations for the
two emissions.
Step 1: In a-emission (2a) the proton number
decreases by 2 (in this case, from 88 to 89).
From the Periodic Table, we can see that
Radium (Ra) has the proton number 88.
The nucleon number decreases by 4 (in this
case, from 229 to 225).
Step 2: In p-emission 1 _”p) the proton number
increases by 1 (in this case from 88 to 89).
From the Periodic Table, we can see that
Actinium (Ac) has the proton number 89.
The nucleon number remains the same.
Answer
a-emission: 2^Th-> ^Ra + 2a
p-emission: ^Ra
-* ™Ac + ?p
00
•
07
Deflecting radiation
How can we tell the difference between these three types
of radiation? One method is to see how they behave in
electric and magnetic fields.
Because they have opposite charges, a and p-particles are
deflected in opposite directions when they pass through an
electric field (Figure 23.8a). Positively charged a-particles
are attracted towards a negatively charged plate, while
negatively charged p-particles are attracted towards a
positively charged plate, p-particles are deflected more
than a-particles as the are lighter.' y-rays are not deflected
because they are uncharged.
a- and p-particles are charged, so, when they move, they
constitute an electric current. Because of their opposite
signs, the forces on them in a magnetic field are in
opposite directions (Figure 23.8b). This is an example of
the motor effect (Chapter 20). The direction in which the
435
y
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
particles are deflected can be predicted using Fleming’s
left-hand rule. As in an electric field, y-rays are not
deflected because they are uncharged.
b
a State one way in which they are similar.
b State one way in which they are different.
11 Two beams of ionising radiation are passed between
charged metal plates. They are deflected, as shown
in Figure 23.9.
fl
Figure 23.9
1
Name the type of radiation for each beam,
b State the polarity of each of the plates.
Name the type of radiation whiclywould not be
c
deflected by the plates.
12 Figure 23.10 shows a radiation detection badge.
a
Figure 23.8: a- and fl-radiations are deflected in opposite
directions, a: In an electric field, b: In a magnetic field.
Questions
7
Explain why emission of a- or fl-particles changes
the nucleus to one of a different element.
8
The equation represents the decay of a polonium
nucleus to form a lead nucleus. An a-particle
is emitted.
film badge
dosemeter
Figure 23.10: A radiation detection badge.
a
2$Po -> 2^Pb + qQ + energy
a
b
Copy and complete the equation.
Show that the proton numbers are equal on
each side of the equation.
c Show that the nucleon numbers are equal on
each side of the equation.
9 Write a balanced nuclear equation to show what
happens to the polonium isotope 2yPo when it
emits a fl-particle.
10 y-rays and X-rays are both forms of ionising
radiation.
436
y
jacket
b
Explain what you would see if the film inside
the badge was developed if the wearer had been
exposed to:
i
fl-radiation
ii y-radiation.
Suggest a reason why the badge is not suitable
for detecting exposure to alpha radiation.
23.3 Activity and half-life
The activity of a radioactive source is the rate at which
its nuclei decay. This can be monitored using a Geiger
counter which measures the count rate, the number
of emissions detected each second (or minute).
23
The Geiger counter will not detect every emission, so
activity and count rate are not equal, but count rate is
used to monitor activity.
The activity of a source decreases with time. As nuclei
decay and become stable, there are fewer unstable nuclei,
so there are fewer decays each second. The count rate
and activity both decrease following the same pattern as
the number of undecayed atoms.
All radioactive substances decay with the same pattern,
as shown in Figure 23.1 la. The graph shows that the
amount of a radioactive substance decreases rapidly at
first, and then more and more slowly. In fact, because
the graph tails off more and more slowly, we cannot say
when the last atoms will decay. Different radioactive
substances decay at different rates, some much faster
than others, as shown in Figure 23.1 lb.
We cannot say when the substance will have entirely
decayed. We have to think of another way of
describing the rate of decay. As shown on the graph in
Figure 23.1 la, we identify the half-life of the substance.
The half-life of a radioactive isotope is the average time
taken for half of the atoms in a sample to decay, or the
time for its activity or count rate to halve.
Half-lives can vary from a fraction of a second to
thousands of years. Uranium decays slowly because it
has a very long half-life. The radioactive samples used
in schools usually have half-lives of a few years, so that
they have to be replaced when their activity has dropped
significantly. Some radioactive substances have half-lives
that are less than a microsecond. No sooner are they
formed than they decay into something else.
half-life
Radioactivity
KEY WORDS
activity: the rate at which nuclei decay in a
sample of a radioactive substance
half-life: the average time taken for half the atoms
in a sample of a radioactive material to decay
Explaining half-life
After one half-life, half of the atoms in a radioactive
sample have decayed. However, this does not mean that
all of the atoms will have decayed after two half-lives.
From the graph of Figure 23.1 la, you can see that onequarter will still remain after two half-lives. Why is this?
Figure 23.12 shows one way of thinking about what is
going on. Imagine that we start with a sample of 100
undecayed atoms of a radioactive substance (white
circles in Figure 23.12a). They decay randomly (black
circles in Figure 23.12b-d) - each undecayed atom has a
50% chance of decaying in the course of one half-life. So,
looking at the panels in Figure 23.12, we can describe the
decay like this:
• At the start, in Figure 23.12a, there are 100
undecayed atoms.
one half-life, in Figure 23.12b, a random
After
•
selection of 50 atoms has decayed.
• During the next half-life, in Figure 23.12c, a random
selection of half of the remaining 50 atoms decays,
leaving 25 undecayed.
• During the third half-life, in Figure 23.12d, half of
the remaining atoms decay, leaving 12 or 13.
(Of course, you cannot have half an atom.)
half-life
Time
Time
Figure 23.1 1 a: A decay graph for a radioactive substance. A curve of this shape is known as an exponential decay graph,
b: A steeper graph shows that a substance has a shorter half-life.
437
>
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
So the number of undecayed atoms goes 100, 50, 25, 12, . ..
and so on. It is because radioactive atoms decay in a
random fashion that we get this pattern of decay. Notice
b
a
o o o oo o o|o OIO
o o o 0'0 o oo O' o
o o o o'o o 0'0 oo
oo o oo o oo o o
oo o oo o o o o o
olo o OIO o o o o o
oo o OlO o o o o o
o o o oo o O O o o
o o o oo O O o o o
o o o OlO 0 0'0 o o
that, just because one atom has not decayed in the first
half-life does not mean that it is more likely to decay in
the next half-life. It has no way of remembering its past.
c
d
o eoee e
o
oe oe o
o ee e e
o oe oe e o
o
oe e e
o
o eo e e
o
oe eo e e
o
oe o e
oe ee e e
eoee o e
e ee oe eeee
e oe ee e eoee
e ee ee e eeee
e ee eo e eeeo Key:
e oe ee e eeee o
e ee ee e eoee undecayed
o e e eo e eeee atoms
e eo ee e eeoe e
e ee ee e eeee decayed
e ee ee o eeee atoms
••••••• •
••••••••
• ••••
••
••
••••••
••
••
••
••••
•
Figure 23.1 2: The pattern of radioactive decay comes about because the decay of individual atoms is random. Half of the
atoms decay during each half-life, but we have no way of predicting which individual atoms will decay.
i
WORKED EXAMPLE 23.2
The count rate from a radioactive source is recorded for
ten days. Figure 23.13a shows the results.
Use the graph to find the half-life of the source.
Figure 23.13a
Step 1: Calculate the count rate after one half-life.
The initial count rate is 80 count/s, so after one
half-life it will have dropped to 40 count/s.
Step 2: Use the graph to find the time taken for the
count rate to drop to 40 count/s.
The half-life is two days.
Figure 23.13b
438
23
Radioactivity
CONTINUED
Step 3: Check this by finding the time taken for the
count rate to halve again, from 40 count/s to
20 counts/s.
The count rate drops from 40 count/s to 20
count/s in two days, confirming that the
half-life is two days.
Time (days)
Figure 23.13c
Answer
The half-life is two days.
WORKED EXAMPLE 23.3
Strontium-90 has a half-life of 28 years. The count rate
of a sample is 480 count/s. How long will it take for the
count rate to drop to 30 count/s?
Step 1: Draw a table like Table 23.4 to work out the
number of half-lives for the count rate to drop
to 30 cps.
Number of half-lives Count rate / count/s)
0
480
1
240
2
120
3
60
4
30
So, the count rate has fallen to 30 count/s
after four half-lives.
Step 2: Calculate how long this is in years.
One half-life is 28 years, so four half-lives:
4 x 28 = 1 1 2 years.
Answer
112 years
Table 23.4
439
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
ACTIVITY 23.1
Modelling half-life
Radioactive decay is a random process. In this activity
you will model radioactive decay using another
random process - throwing dice or small cubes.
You will need a large number of dice - at least
100 - or small cubes with one side marked (as in
Figure 23.14).
Place all the dice in a container, shake the container
and throw the dice.
Any spinner showing 6, or cube with the marked side
facing upwards, have 'decayed'. Count how many
have decayed.
Create a table like Table 23.5 and record your results.
Number
decaying
(activity)
Throw number
(time)
Number
remaining (N)
Table 23.5
I
Repeat until all the dice have decayed.
Draw two graphs:
•
activity against time
•
number of 'nuclei' remaining against time.
Questions
Figure 23.14: Using small cubes to model
radioactive decay.
Corrected count rate
The count rate recorded by a Geiger counter will
include background radioactivity as well as the count
rate from the radioactive source. Often the background
count is negligible in comparison to the activity of the
1
What do you notice about the two graphs?
2
Calculate the half-life from each graph.
What do you notice?
source. If the background count is being taken into
account, it should be subtracted from the Geiger counter
measurements.
=
corrected count rate
measured count rate - background count rate
WORKED EXAMPLE 23.4
A scientist monitored a radioactive source every ten minutes using a Geiger counter. She recorded the
following readings.
Time / min
Count rate / count/min
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
330
230
165
120
92
70
56
After the experiment she recorded a background count of 30 count/min.
Plot a graph of corrected count rate against time and use it to find the half-life of the source.
440
)
23 Radioactivity
CONTINUED
Step 1: Calculate the corrected count rates.
Time / min
0
10
20
30
40
50
60
Count rate / count/min
330
230
165
120
92
70
56
Corrected count rate / count/min
300
200
135
90
62
40
26
Step 2: Plot these results on a graph.
Step 3: The initial count rate is 300 count/min. Draw a line from half of this (300
the half-life.
half-life
2
= 150 count/min) to find
Time 1 min
is 18 mins
Answer
half-life = 18 minutes
Questions
13 A sample of radioactive iodine contains 6400
undecayed atoms.
a How many will remain undecayed after three
half-lives?
b The half-life of this isotope of iodine is eight
days. How many atoms remain undecayed after
40 days?
1 4 The half-life of thorium-227 is 19 days. How long
will it take for the activity of the source to decrease
by 75%?
1 5 Figure 23. 1 5 shows the count rate for a radioactive
source at different times. What is the half-life of this
source?
Time (days)
Figure 23.15
441
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
16 Carbon has two isotopes, carbon-12 and carbon-14.
Carbon-14 is radioactive. The proportion of the
two isotopes in living things remains constant while
they are alive, but when they die, the proportion of
carbon-14 drops as the isotope decays. Archaeologists
studying a bone find it emits 20 count/s, whereas a
similar modem bone emits 80 count/s.
The half-life of carbon-14 is 5700 years. Use this to
estimate the age of the bone that the archaeologists
found.
23.4 Using radioisotopes
b
Radioisotopes at work
Now we will look at some of the many uses of
radioisotopes. We will look at these uses in four separate
groups, related to:
• their different penetrating powers
•
•
the damage their radiation causes to living cells
•
radioactive decay and half-life.
the fact that we can detect tiny quantities of
radioactive substances
Uses related to penetrating
power
Smoke detectors
These are often found in domestic kitchens, and in public
buildings such as offices and hotels. If you open a smoke
detector to replace the battery, you may see a yellow and
black radiation hazard warning sign (Figure 23.16a). The
radioactive material used is americium-241, a source of
a-radiation. Figure 23.16b shows how the smoke
detector works.
The Americium source used in smoke detectors has a
long half-life - about 430 years. This means that the
count rate from the source will not drop significantly
over the time the detector is in use.
smoke
Figure 23.16a: The inside of a smoke detector. The source
of radiation is a small amount of americiumr^41.
b: Block diagram of a smoke detector. The alarm sounds
when smoke absorbs the a radiation.
•
Radiation from the source falls on a detector. Since
a-radiation is charged, a small current flows in the
detector. The output from the processing circuit is
V
off, so the alarm is silent.
•
When smoke enters the gap between the source
and the detector, it absorbs the a-radiation. Now
no current flows in the detector, and the processing
circuit switches on, sounding the alarm.
In this application, a source of a-radiation is chosen
because a-radiation is easily absorbed by the smoke
particles.
Thickness measurements
In industry, fl-radiation is often used in to measure
thickness. Manufacturers of paper need to be sure that
their product is of a uniform thickness. To do this,
fl-radiation is directed through the paper as it comes off
the production line. A detector measures the amount of
radiation getting through.
If the paper is too thick, the radiation level will be low
and an automatic control system adjusts the thickness.
The same technique is used in the manufacture of plastic
sheeting and aluminium foil, fl-radiation is used in this
application because a-radiation would be absorbed
entirely by the paper, plastic or aluminium.
442
>
23 Radioactivity
Uses related to cell damage -
radiation therapy
Cancer treatment
Figure 23.17: If the material gets too thick, less radiation
will be detected. This will cause the rollers to be moved
closer together, making the sheet thinner.
The patient shown in Figure 23.19 is receiving radiation
as part of a treatment for cancer. A source of y-rays
(or X-rays) is directed at the tumour that needs to be
destroyed. The source moves around the patient, always
aiming at the tumour. In this way, other tissues receive
only a small dose of radiation. Radiation therapy is often
combined with chemotherapy (using drugs to target and
kill the cancerous cells).
y-radiation would hardly be affected, because it is
the most penetrating.
Sheet steel factories use a similar system but with a
y source.
Fault detection
Sometimes y-rays are used to detect faults in
manufactured goods. Figure 23.18 shows an example,
where engineers are looking for any faults in some
pipework. If there is a fault, radiation will escape
through the fault. A photographic film is strapped to the
outside of the pipe and the radioactive source is placed
on the inside. When the film is developed, it looks like an
X-ray picture, and shows any faults in the welding.
Figure 23.19: Radiation can cause cancer, but it can also
be used in its cure. This patient is being exposed to y-rays
from a radioactive source.
Food irradiation
This is a way of preserving food. Food often decays
because of the action of microbes. These can be killed
using intense y-rays. Because these organisms are
single-celled, any cell damage kills the entire organism.
Different countries permit different foods to be
irradiated. The result is sterile food, which has been used
on space missions (where long-life is important) and
for some hospital patients whose resistance to infection
by microbes may be low. Figure 23.20 shows a display
from the Nehru Science Centre in Mumbai which
demonstrates the advantages of irradiating food.
Figure 23.18: Checking for faults in a metal pipe.
The y-ray source is stored in the black box in the foreground,
but can be pushed through the pipe to reach the part that
needs checking.
443
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
can use radiation to detect tiny (Quantities of substances,
far smaller than can be detected by chemical means. Such
techniques are often known as radioactive tracing. This has
uses in medicine and engineering.
Medicine
Figure 23.20: The microbes which would cause decay have
been killed by radiation in the top sample.
The diagnosis of some diseases may be carried out using
a source of y-radiation. The patient is injected with a
radioactive chemical and a scanner is used to trace the
path of the chemical. Figure 23.22 shows a scan of a
patient with a kidney blockage. The tracer technetium-99
is injected into the patient’s blood. The scan shows that
the tracer is not passing through the kidney shown on the
right as well as it is through the other kidney. This indicates
that there is a blockage. The technetium isotope used has
a relatively short half-life - about six hours. This is long
enough for it to be used to trace the blockage, but it does
not remain radioactive very long inside the patient's body.
Sterilisation
Sterilisation of medical products works in the same
way as food irradiation. Syringes, scalpels and other
instruments are sealed in plastic bags and then
exposed to gamma radiation. Any microbes present
are killed, so that, when the packaging is opened, the
item is guaranteed to be sterile, y-radiation is used as
it can penetrate the plastic and can pass through the
equipment, making sure all parts are sterilised.
Figure 23.22: The tracer can be detected in both kidneys
and the bladder. More y - rays are detected from the kidney
seen on the right, suggesting a problem there.
Figure 23.21: The sealed package ensures the syringe
remains sterile once y-rays have killed all pathogens.
Engineering
Uses related to detectability radioactive tracing
Engineers may want to trace underground water flow, for
example. They may be constructing a new waste dump,
and they need to be sure that poisonous water from the
dump will not flow into the local water supply. Under
high pressure, they inject water containing a radioactive
chemical into a hole in the ground (Figure 23.23). Then
they monitor how it moves through underground cracks
using y-detectors at ground level.
Every time you hear a Geiger counter click, it has detected
the radioactive decay of a single atom. This means that we
23 Radioactivity
The Turin Shroud was famously dated in 1988
using a mass spectrometer. The shroud was dated to
1325 ± 33 CE, which matches the dates of the earliest
historical records of its existence.
Problems can arise with radiocarbon dating. It may be
that the amount of carbon-14 present in the atmosphere
was different in the past. Nuclear weapons testing added
extra carbon-14 to the atmosphere during the 1950s and
1960s. This means that living objects that died then have
an excess of carbon-14, making them appear younger
than they really are.
KEY WORDS
Figure 23.23: Detecting the movement of underground
water. Engineers are investigating how water moves
underground. This can also affect the stability of buildings
on the site. Water containing a source of y-radiation is
pumped underground and its passage through cracks is
monitored at ground level.
Uses related to radioactive
decay - half-life and
radiocarbon dating
Because radioactive substances decay at a rate that we
can determine, we can use them to discover how old
objects and materials are. The best-known example of
this is radiocarbon dating.
All living things contain carbon. Plants get this
from atmospheric carbon dioxide, which they use in
photosynthesis. Plant-eating animals get it from the plants
they eat to build their bodies. Meat-eating animals get it
from their prey. Most carbon is carbon-12, which is not
radioactive. A tiny amount is radioactive (carbon-14),
which has a half-life of 5700 years. It emits p-radiation.
When a living organism dies, the carbon-14 in its body
decays. As time passes, the amount remaining decreases.
We can measure the amount remaining, and then work
out when the organism was alive.
There are two ways to measure the amount of carbon-14
present in an object:
• by measuring the activity of the sample using a
detector such as a Geiger counter
• by counting the number of carbon-14 atoms using
a mass spectrometer (a large machine that uses
magnetic fields to separate atoms according to their
mass and charge).
radioactive tracing: using a radioisotope to
investigate a problem
radiocarbon dating: a technique that uses the
known rate of decay of radioactive carbon-1 4 to
find the approximate age of an object made from
dead organic material
Other radioactive dating techniques
Geologists use a radioactive dating technique to find the
age of some rocks. Many rocks contain a radioactive
isotope, potassium-40, which decays by p emission to a
stable isotope of argon. Argon is a gas, and it is trapped in
the rock as the potassium decays.
The rocks of interest form from molten material, for
example, in a volcano. There is no argon in the molten
rock because it can bubble out. After the rock solidifies,
the amount of trapped argon gradually increases as the
potassium decays. Geologists take a sample and measure
the relative amounts of argon and potassium. The greater
the proportion of argon, the older the rock must be.
Questions
17 A smoke detector uses an a-source.
Explain why:
a a p- or y-source would not work
b it is safe to have this type of smoke detector in
your home
the source used must have a half-life of years
c
rather than days.
1 8 Describe what would happen if the sheet shown
in Figure 23.17 became too thin.
19 When medical equipment is to be sterilised, it is
first sealed in a plastic wrapper. Why does this not
absorb the radiation used?
445
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
PROJECT
Demystifying radioactivity
You should:
We have known about radioactivity for just over
a century. In that time it has attracted a lot of
sensational attention as an amazing cure-all, an
invisible killer or for its fictional ability to mutate
humans or animals into monsters.
•
•
•
describe and illustrate the three types of
radioactive emission
explain how we can use knowledge about their
penetrating power to use and store sources
safely
explain what is meant by half-life and why some
radioactive waste must be stored securely for
many years
• include as many practical examples of the uses
of radioisotopes as you can.
You should present your work as a video or a group
presentation to the class, or in a written article.
Figure 23.24: This is the international warning sign for
ionising radiation.
Over the last century we have learnt that, although
dangerous, ionising radiation can be very useful, and
if handled correctly, it can be safe.
Your task is to prepare a television segment or
magazine article about radioactivity aimed at
teenagers to explain the science of radioactivity and
its uses and dangers.
Much of the fear which surrounds radioactive
materials is made worse by the language
surrounding it. Words such as 'mutation' and
'half-life' are not in everyday use and can add to the
feeling that radiation is a weird scientific threat. To
counter this, your presentation should include and
explain the following key terms:
• radioactive isotope
• radioactive
• a-particle
• nuclear decay
p-particle
•
• half-life
• background
• y-ray
radiation.
• ionisation
•
mutation
SUMMARY
We are surrounded by ionising background radiation from natural and man-made sources.
Unstable isotopes decay randomly.
Radioactive decay leads to three types of emissions - a-particles, p-particles and y-rays.
a and p emissions change the nucleus to that of a different element.
a and p emissions can be described using balanced nuclear equations.
The half-life of a radioactive source is the time taken for half its radioactive nuclei to decay.
a, p and y-radiation can all ionise cells, leading to mutations and tumours. Safety precautions must be taken
when using radioactive materials.
When used safely, radioactive materials have many uses, particularly in medicine and engineering.
446
)
23
Radioactivity
EXAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
[1 ]
1 Which of the following is a natural source of background radiation?
A medical X-rays
B nuclear power stations
C cosmic rays
D nuclear weapons testing
2 Nuclear radiation can cause ionisation by knocking electrons out of atoms.
[1 ]
Which type of radiation is least ionising?
A a-particles
B 0-particles
C y-rays
D they all have the same ionising power
3 A source contains 240 g of a radioactive isotope. The half-life of the
source is three hours. How much of the isotope will be left after 12 hours? [1 ]
A none
B30g
C 15 g
D20g
4 a Each of the statements below describe a type of radiation.
Type 1: Absorbed by a thin sheet of paper
Type 2: Absorbed by a thin sheet of metal
Which types of radiation are described in the statements?
Type 1
Type 2
A
0-radiation
a-radiation
B
y-radiation
C
a-radiation
0-radiation
0-radiation
D
0-radiation
y-radiation
b Which statement is correct?
A y-radiation is an electron emitted from the nucleus
B a-radiation has a negative charge
C y-radiation has a positive charge
D 0-radiation is an electron emitted from the nucleus
COMMAND WORDS
[3]
[Total: 10]
5 A radioisotope of radium has a half-life of 1600 years.
a Define what is meant by the term ‘half-life’.
b The paint in a luminous watch face contains 20 mg of the radioisotope
of radium. Calculate the mass that remains undecayed after 3200 years.
c Radium emits ionising radiation. State how this can affect living cells.
d Describe the safety precautions which must be taken when radioactive
radium is used in a school laboratory.
[1]
[1 ]
[1]
[2]
[Total: 5]
define: give precise
meaning
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
state: express in
clear terms
describe: state the
points of a topic; give
characteristics and
main features
447
>
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
*
CONTINUED
6 Gold has different isotopes. Gold-198 is radioactive and decays by
P-emission.
a Name a particle which is identical to a p-particle.
[1]
b Name a material which could be used to stop p-particles, but which
would not stop y-rays.
[1 ]
c The graph shows how the count rate from a sample of gold-198 changes
with time.
Use the graph to find the half-life of gold-198.
[1]
[Total: 3]
7 a-particles are a type of ionizing nuclear radiation.
a Describe the structure of an a-particle.
[1 ]
b Complete the following nuclear equation to show how emitting an
a-particle changes a uranium isotope.
“u^grh +
|3|
O
448
y
23 Radioactivity
COMMAND WORDS
explain: set out
purposes or
reasons / make
the relationships
between things
evident I provide
why and / or how and
support with relevant
evidence
deduce conclude
from available
information
449
y
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
any gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
Recall the main sources of background radiation.
See
Needs
Almost
Confident
Topic...
23.1
more work
there
to move on
State the units of count rate.
23.1
Explain what it means to say radioactive emission is
random.
23.2
Describe the nature, ionising effect and penetration of
a , p and y.
23.2
Describe how ionising radiation can be detected.
23.2
Describe how a, p and y are affected by electric and
magnetic fields.
23.2
State why some isotopes are radioactive and decay to
become different elements.
23.2
Describe how a- and p-emission change nuclei, using
nuclear equations.
23.2
Define the half-life of a radioactive source and use it in
calculations.
23.3
Describe the effects of ionising radiation on living cells,
and the safety precautions which should be taken when
using radioactive materials.
23.3
Describe and explain practical uses of radioactive
materials.
23.4
450
)
J
A
> Chapter 24
Earth and the
Solar System
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL
describe the orbital motions of the Earth and Moon and relate these to our measures of time
describe the eight planets in our Solar System in terms of their formation, movement and satellites
calculate the time light takes to travel from the Sun to the planets
explain the movement of bodies in the Solar System in terms of gravitational attraction
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
GETTING STARTED
24
Earth and the Solar System
HOW MANY PLANETS?
path as the other planets did. Astronomers predicted
this was due to the effect of the gravitational pull of
another planet. They calculated where this should be
and found Neptune in 1846. Tiny, distant Pluto was
discovered in 1930 bringing the total to nine planets.
And so it remained until 2006.
In the 1990s, several objects with similar mass to
Pluto were discovered. This created a problem.
Should these be named as planets, and if not, could
Pluto still be classed as a planet? The International
Astronomical Union decided a new definition for
the title planet was needed. It came up with three
rules. To be a planet, a body must:
•
•
•
orbit the star (our Sun)
have enough mass that its gravity pulls it into a
spherical shape
have a large enough gravitational pull to clear
away any other objects of a similar size near its
orbit around the Sun.
Figure 24.2: This artist's impression shows the Sun and
the eight planets we now know orbit the Sun.
Humans have known about the first five planets,
Mercury, Venus, Earth, Mars and Jupiter, for a long
time as we can see them with the naked eye. In 1610,
the newly invented telescope allowed Galileo Galilei
to discover Saturn. Uranus was added by William
Herschel in 1781. Careful observations of the orbit
of Uranus showed it did not follow a smooth orbital
24.1 Earth, Sun and Moon
Day and night
I'hc most obvious sign of movement in the Solar
System is the cyclical daily change from light to dark.
1 1 is not surprising that our ancestors thought the
Sun travelled round the Earth. Each day we see the
apparent movement of the Sun from rising in the east
to setting in the west. We now know that this effect is
Pluto failed the third rule due to the discovery of an
object named Eris, about the size of Pluto, orbiting
close to Pluto. Pluto and Eris were both reclassified
as a dwarf planets, leaving a total of eight planets.
Discussion questions
1
Why is it important to have international
agreement about the definition of a planet?
Are there any other areas where scientists have
agreed standard definitions?
2
A lot of people felt that Pluto should have
kept its status as a planet. What consequences
would this have had?
caused by the Earth spinning on its axis (the imaginary
line between the poles). The side of the Earth facing
the Sun experiences daylight whilst the other side is in
darkness. At sunrise at a particular spot on Earth, the
Sun is just visible on the eastern horizon. As the Earth
turns, the spot moves into the full glare of the Sun so
the Sun appears directly overhead at midday. As the
Earth continues to turn, the spot moves out of the direct
sunlight until, at sunset, the Sun appears to slip below
the western horizon.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Earth's axis
Figure 24.3: As light travels in straight lines, only half the
Earth receives sunlight at any one time.
As well as the daily changes, early civilisations were
aware of periodic changes which happened over a longer
time - the difference between seasons. The Earth orbits
the Sun. It takes just over 365 days to complete one
orbit. The seasons occur because of the tilt of the Earth’s
axis. Figure 24.4 shows how the seasons change as the
Earth orbits the Sun.
Consider a country in the northern hemisphere (the half
of the Earth north of the Equator). In Figure 24.4a, due
to the tilt of the Earth, it is tipped away from the Sun and
the energy from the Sun’s rays is more spread out, making
it colder. This means that area receives fewer hours of
sunlight. These countries are experiencing winter. In
Figure 24.4c, the northern hemisphere is tipped towards
the Sun, so it receives longer hours of more direct
sunlight. These countries are experiencing summer.
Years
position of Earth
southern
northern
month
hemisphere
hemisphere
December
summer
winter
March
autumn (fall)
spring
June
winter
summer
September
spring
autumn (fall)
season
Figure 24.4: The Earth orbits the Sun every 365.25 days. The tilt of the Earth causes seasons.
24
Earth and the Solar System
first quarter
KEY WORDS
axis: the imaginary line between the Earth's North
and South poles
orbit: the path of an object as it moves around a
larger object
hemisphere: half of a sphere; the Earth can be
considered to be made of two hemispheres
divided by the Equator
(the) Equator: an imaginary line drawn round
the Earth halfway between the North Pole and the
South Pole
Countries at the Equator do not experience seasons
because the Sun’s rays always hit them at the same angle.
The seasonal differences are more apparent the further
from the Equator you are. In the far north or south,
seasons are so extreme that, in winter, the Sun is hardly
seen and, in summer, it can be sunny at midnight. Figure
24.5 shows how, in Alaska, the Sun dips lower in the sky
towards midnight but then starts to rise again.
waning crescent
third quarter
Figure 24.6: The phases of the Moon. As the Moon orbits the
Earth, the half of the Moon that faces the Sun will be lit up by
the Sun. As the Moon moves, the shape of the light part, which
can be seen from the Earth, changes. The outer circle of Moon
diagrams shows how the Moon looks to an observer on Earth.
KEY WORDS
phases of the Moon: the different ways the Moon
looks when viewed from Earth over a period of
one month
ACTIVITY 24.1
Figure 24.5: This multiple exposure photograph shows the
position of the Sun in the hours before and after midnight in
Alaska in midsummer.
Months
The most obvious object in our sky after the Sun is the
Moon. The Moon features in many folk tales. It has often
been seen as a mystical object due to its fainter light and
its changing shape. With the benefit of telescopes and
space travel, we know the Moon is a rocky sphere which
we only see when it reflects light from the Sun. The Moon
orbits Earth every 27.5 days. Its position relative to Earth
changes the way it appears to us as different parts of
it are illuminated by the Sun. This causes the changes
called the phases of the Moon. The phases of the Moon
are shown in Figure 24.6.
Modelling day, night and seasons
Use a lamp to represent the Sun and a ball with
a rod through it to represent the Earth. Mark
your position on the Earth using a pen or a piece
of modelling clay. In a darkened area, hold the
'Earth' near to the 'Sun', and turn the Earth on its
axis to model day and night.
Tilt the Earth on its axis and investigate the
seasons by moving the Earth around the Sun.
Investigate the difference in seasons between the
southern and northern hemispheres.
Figure 24.7: Model of the Earth and Sun.
455
>
y CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Questions
1
2
3
Copy and complete the following sentences.
A day is the time taken for the
.
A month is the time taken for the
.
.
A year is the time taken for the
The Earth is tilted on its axis and this causes
which do not occur at the Equator.
Explain why it is summer in the northern
hemisphere when it is winter in the southern
hemisphere. Include a drawing in your answer.
Look at the photograph of the Moon (Figure 24.8).
The Solar System consists of the Sun which is our
star, and all the objects which orbit it. It includes the
following:
• There are eight planets: Mercury, Venus, Earth,
Mars, Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus and Neptune.
• There are minor planets, such as Pluto and Eris.
In 2014, the International Astronomical Union
recognised five dwarf planets but it is believed there
are more than 200 in all.
• Moons that orbit planets and dwarf planets.
• Millions of asteroids and meteoroids: these are
rocky objects which are smaller than planets. Most
asteroids are found in the asteroid belt between the
orbits of Mars and Jupiter.
• Comets, which are often described as giant snowballs,
orbit the Sun in very irregular orbits. When they are
furthest from the Sun, they are frozen balls of gas,
rock and dust. As they get nearer to the Sun they heat
up and leave a trail of dust and gases behind them.
(Note: this trail of dust is not the tail of the comet;
the tail always points away from the Sufi, so could
actually be at 90° to the motion of the comet.)
Figure 24.8: The Moon.
a
b
Which phase of the Moon is this?
How many days are there from one full Moon
to the next?
24.2 The Solar System
Figure 24.9: An artist's impression of the Solar System with a
visiting comet. The picture is not to scale.
456
>
Figure 24.10a: Asteroids and meteoroids sometimes
enter the Earth's atmosphere. Smaller meteoroids burn up
in the Earth's atmosphere and are seen as shooting stars,
b: It is believed that the dinosaurs became extinct due to a
large asteroid hitting the Earth creating a huge crater and
throwing up so much dust that the Sun's rays could not reach
Earth for more than a year, c: Comet Hale-Bopp was visible
to the naked eye in the summer of 1995. It is not expected to
be visible again soon as it takes 2533 years to orbit the Sun!
24 Earth and the Solar System
The Sun's gravitational pull
The orbits of the planets are almost circular. To move in a
circle an object needs a force pulling it towards the centre
of the circle. Imagine spinning a ball on the end of a piece
of string. The ball will spin in a circle as long as you hold
on. Once you let go, the ball will fly outwards. The force
needed to keep the planets orbiting the Sun comes from
the gravitational attraction of the Sun.
The formation of the planets
Evidence collected by astronomers suggests that the
planets were formed at the same time as the Sun. The Solar
System began as a nebula, which is a huge swirling ball
of dust and gas. Most of this gas was hydrogen, but there
were also other elements formed by fusion in other stars,
which had exploded at the end of their life cycle, sending
their contents out into the clouds of interstellar gas.
As gravity pulled this mass together, the centre formed
a star. You will learn more detail about this in Chapter
25. The planets formed from the materials of the nebula
which were not pulled into the Sun. The spinning motion
of the dust and gas formed a flat, spinning ring disc
known as an accretion disc. Gravity pulled dust and gas
together so they joined to make rocks which then join to
make larger rocks. The process of the dust and gas being
pulled together by gravity is called accretion and it led
to the formation of the inner, rocky planets. The intense
heat forced some of the lighter materials further away
and these formed the outer planets - the gas giants.
The four inner planets, Mercury, Venus, Earth and Mars,
are small and rocky. After Mars there is the asteroid belt.
This is made up of left-over pieces of rock. The outer
four planets, Jupiter, Saturn, Uranus and Neptune, are
huge balls of gases. These planets are much bigger than
the inner planets.
KEY WORDS
planet: a large spherical object that orbits the
Sun without another similar object close to it
minor planet: an object which orbits the Sun but
is not large enough or far enough from another
object to be defined as a planet
asteroids and meteoroids: lumps of rock which
orbit the Sun
comet: a ball of ice, dust and gas which orbits the
Sun in a highly elliptical orbit
accretion disc: a rotating disc of matter formed
by accretion
accretion: the coming together of matter under
the influence of gravity to form larger bodies
Distances and times in the
Solar System
Distances in the Solar System are almost unimaginably
big. The Earth is approximately 1 50 million
kilometres from the Sun. This is similar to circling
the Earth 4000 times. Distances are often expressed in
terms of how long it takes light to travel; one light-year
is the distance travelled by light in a year. The next
nearest star after the Sun is Proxima Centauri, which is
4.2 light-years from Earth. You will learn more about
light-years in Chapter 25.
WORKED EXAMPLE 24.1
Calculate the time for light from the Sun to travel
the 150 000 000 km to Earth. Give your answer
in minutes.
Step 1: Write down what you know:
speed of light = 300 000 000 m/s
distance travelled 150 000 000 km
=
Figure 24.11: This artist's impression shows a star forming.
The uneven, swirling mass of rock and gas around it is
flattened by its rapid rotation into an accretion disc where
the planets eventually form.
Step 2: Convert distance to metres, so units are
consistent.
150 000 000 km = 1 50 000 000 000 m
457
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
6
Step 3: Write the equation down and calculate the
time taken:
7
time taken Q
distance travelled
speed
More about the planets
_ 150000000000 m
Table 24.1 gives data about the planets in the Solar
System. It shows how the planets differ from each other,
for example looking up from the surface of Jupiter you
might see 16 moons.
300 000 000 m/s
= 500 seconds
Step 4: Convert to minutes
500 -9- 60 = 8.3 minutes
Forces
Answer
8.3 minutes
Questions
4
5
The Moon is approximately 390 000 km from Earth.
Calculate the time it takes for light to travel from the
Moon to the Earth.
How long will it take for light from the Sun to
reach:
Mercury, which is approximately 60 000 000 km
a
from the Sun.
b Neptune, which is approximately
4 500 000 000 km from the Sun.
Average
Planet
orbital
distance /
million km
It takes sunlight 43 minutes tb reach Jupiter.
Calculate the distance from Jupiter to the Sun.
Calculate how many kilometres a light-year is
equivalent to.
Orbital
duration /
years
The Sun is at the centre of the Solar System. It is by
far the most massive object in the Solar System and
makes up about 99.8% of the mass of the Solar System.
As gravitational attraction depends on mass, the
gravitational field strength of the Sun is far larger than
the field of any other object in the Solar System.
The planets, minor planets, asteroids and meteoroids and
comets all orbit the Sun. They are held in orbit by the
gravitational attraction of the Sun.
Like other non-contact forces such as magnetism and
static electricity, gravitational attraction decreases with
distance. This means that the outer planets experience
less gravitational force from the Sun than the inner
planets do.
Surface
Density / kg/
temperature
m’
/°C
Gravitational
field strength at
the surface of
the planet /
N/kg
Number of
Moons
Mercury
58
0.2
5500
-18 to 460
4
0
Venus
108
0.6
5200
470
9
0
Earth
150
1
5500
-8 to 58
10
1
Mars
228
1.9
4000
-8 to -5
4
2
Jupiter
778
12
1300
15 to 20
26
16
Saturn
1427
30
700
-140
11
20
Uranus
2870
84
1300
-200
11
15
Neptune
4497
165
1700
-220
12
8
Table 24.1
458
y
24 Earth and the Solar System
Although the planets are small compared to the Sun,
they are very massive objects. Jupiter has a mass of
1.9 x 1027kg. The more massive the planet, the greater
the gravitational force experienced by objects at its
surface. On Earth we experience a force of lON/kg.
On Earth a 60 kg student has a weight of 600 N.
On Mercury, where gravity is 4 N/kg, the same student
would weigh 240 N. The gravitational pull of planets is
enough to cause moons to orbit them.
Orbits and energy
The orbits of the planets are not completely circular.
Their shape is that of a slightly squashed circle, called an
ellipse. The orbits are described as elliptical. The amount
the orbit is squashed is called its eccentricity. Comets
have very eccentric orbits. Comets travel far from the Sun
and then return close to it.
The Sun’s gravity pulls the object in, speeds it up and
then the speed carries it on to the furthest part of the
orbit.
The object’s orbital speed is therefore greatest when it is
nearest to the Sun and slowest when it is furthest from
the Sun.
Comets, which have the most elliptical orbits of any
body in the Solar System accelerate greatly as they
approach the Sun and are slung back at high speed to the
far reaches of their orbits.
A planet orbiting in space does not experience any
friction or air resistance, so its energy remains the same
throughout its orbit. It has two types of energy:
•
•
kinetic energy
gravitational potential energy.
When it is nearest the Sun, a planet has its minimum
gravitational potential energy and is moving at its fastest
so has its maximum kinetic energy. When it is at its
furthest from the Sun, it has maximum gravitational
potential and minimum kinetic energy.
Figure 24.12: The orbit of Halley's comet is much more
eccentric than those of the planets and minor planets.
Why are orbits elliptical? To explain this, we need to
think about the early swirling mass of the Solar System.
Imagine an object moving past the Sun at high speed,
carried along by its own momentum from the explosive
start of the universe. As it passes near the Sun the
gravitational force of the Sun starts to act on the object
and to pull it towards the Sun. This force also causes it to
accelerate. This means the mass speeds up and its kinetic
energy carries it slightly further out to the furthest point
of the orbit. The object slows down and is pulled in
again towards the Sun.
The Sun is not quite at the centre of a planet’s elliptical
orbit. There is a point close to the centre of an ellipse
called the focus. The Sun is at the focus of the elliptical
path of each of the planets. The planet moves closer
to, and further away, from the Sun during each orbit.
Figure 24.1 3: Mercury has the most elliptical orbit of any
of the planets in the Solar System. At point A, it is 46 million
km from the Sun, travelling at its fastest speed but with least
potential energy. At point B, it is 70 million km from the
Sun, travelling at its slowest speed but with most potential
energy.
Speeds
The speed of a planet in orbit round a star is called
its orbital speed (v). As the planets’ orbits are almost
circular, the distance they travel can be calculated if we
know the average orbital radius, which is the average
distance of the planet from the Sun, or the average
radius of the orbit.
)
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
WORKED EXAMPLE 24.2
Calculate the orbital speed of Earth.
Step 1: Write down what you know:
r = 150 000 000 km
T = 1 year
Step 2: Convert T to seconds.
1 year = 1 x 365 = 365 days
365 days = 365 x 24 = 8760 hours
8760 hours = 8760 x 60 x 60 = 31 536000
seconds
Figure 24.14: To calculate the orbital speed, we assume
that the orbits are circular.
The distance travelled by the planet is the circumference
of its orbit. The circumference of a circle is equal to 2w.
If we also know the time for the planet to orbit the Sun
- known as its orbital period (T) - we can calculate the
speed:
speed
= distance
time
So, the average orbital speed v, can be calculated from
its orbital period, T, and its average orbital radius r,
using the equation:
KEY EQUATION
,
,
x x orbital radius
—
_
average orbital speed = 2
v
n
orbital period
= 2nr
KEY WORDS
ellipse: a squashed circle
eccentricity: a measure of how elliptical an orbit is
orbital radius: the average distance of the planet
from the Sun
orbital period: the time taken for a planet to
complete one full orbit of the Sun
460
>
Step 3: Substitute values for T and r into the equation
and calculate v.
2w
v=
T
2^x 150000000 km
3 1 536000s
30km/s
Answer
30km/s
_
=
=
Planetary patterns
Much of what astronomers have discovered has been
through observing the skies, gathering huge amounts of
data and then looking for patterns in the data. Ancient
astronomers knew the planets were different from
the stars because of the way their positions in the sky
changed. Mercury was named by ancient Greeks after
the messenger of the gods, which is a fitting name for
the planet which orbits the Sun faster than any other.
Sometimes we can learn as much from observations that
are exceptions to a pattern as from those that fit our
predictions.
The data in Table 24.1 can be used to investigate pattern*
in the properties and behaviours of planets. Plotting
data on a scatter graph can give a clear indication of
whether there is a correlation between two sets of data.
For example, a graph of density against distance from
the Sun (Figure 24.15) shows that there is not a clear
correlation between the two. However, it is clear that the
four inner rocky planets are more dense than the outer
gas giants.
24
Earth and the Solar System
Questions
Name the force which causes planets to orbit the
Sun.
b What shape are planetary orbits?
c
How is the orbit of a comet different to the orbit
of a planet?
d Describe the energy changes in a comet as it
orbits the Sun.
9 Calculate the weight of a 30 kg sheep on:
a Earth
b Mars
Jupiter.
c
1 0 Use information from Table 24.1 to calculate the
orbital speeds in m/s of:
a
Venus
b Saturn.
11 Using Table 24.1, draw and comment on scatter
graphs to investigate the relationship between:
a orbital distance and average temperature
b gravitational field strength and the number of
moons.
8
Figure 24.15: There is a pattern in this data but not a direct
correlation.
a
PROJECT
Solar System quiz
Some great ways of learning are:
• finding information from a variety of sources
• summarising the information
• writing questions and answers on the
information you have gathered
• answering questions written by your peers.
This task asks you to bring all these together to help
you become an expert on our Solar System.
Make up a quiz about the Solar System. The quiz
can be on paper, the computer, or on a mobile
device such as phone or tablet (there are lots of
good quiz making apps available). It should be
aimed at students who have studied this chapter,
and who have a good general knowledge. Spend
some time revising and researching to find
interesting facts to include. You may want to rate
questions as 'easy', 'medium' or 'hard' and give
more points for harder questions. You can include
mathematical questions and questions which
require data interpretation. You should include at
least 20 questions. Think about how you will group
your questions. You could include:
• A picture round: use pictures from the Internet
or draw your own.
•
Definitions: you could give a definition, such
as, 'this is the time it takes for the Earth to orbit
the Sun' or, 'this has the most elliptical orbit of
any object in the Solar System', and ask what is
being defined.
461
y
y
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
CONTINUED
Facts about the planets: this could involve
some questions for which the answers can be
worked out from a data chart you supply.
History of astronomical discoveries: use the
Internet and this book to help you.
When you have written your questions, test th» m।
on another group. Are your questions clear er>' mt |l>
If there are two possible answers you need to id 'i
the question to make it more clear.
•
PEER ASSESSMENT
When you exchange quizzes with another group, give them feedback on their questions. Rate question!,
'green', 'amber' or 'red':
• green: great question
• amber: good idea but needs to be clearer
• red: do not use this question as it is misleading or contains wrong information.
For questions rated amber or red, you should also give written feedback.
After feedback and improvement work following the feedback, try your quiz out on some other student).
REFLECTION
Think about what you found most useful in this project. Was it researching and summarising? Maybe you
enjoyed writing the questions, or the challenge of answering questions set by others. What does nis tell you
about how you like to learn? How will you apply this in your future revision?
SUMMARY
The Earth spins on its axis every 24 hours causing day and night.
The Earth is tilted on its axis. This causes the seasons as the Earth orbits the Sun every 365 days.
The Moon orbits the Earth every 27.5 days, causing the phases of the Moon.
The Sun is orbited by four rocky inner planets, four gaseous outer planets and minor planets, moons and conic 1
All objects orbiting the Sun are kept in orbit by its gravitational attraction.
Light from the Sun takes approximately eight minutes to reach the Earth. The distances for sunlight to reach
other planets can be calculated using the equation speed = distance/time.
The speed of an object in orbit can be calculated using the equation v =
where r is the radius of the orbit
and T is the orbital duration.
The orbits of the planets are slightly elliptical. The Sun is not at the centre of the ellipse. Comets have highly
elliptical orbits.
The Sun contains almost all of the mass of the Solar System and so has a very strong gravitational field.
As distance from the Sun increases, its gravitational field strength decreases and the orbital speed of any orbit nir 1
object decreases.
462
y
24
Earth and the Solar System
ONTINUED
When an orbiting object is at its closest to the Sun, it has its maximum kinetic energy and minimum
gravitational potential energy.
Planetary data about orbital distance, orbital duration, density, surface temperature and gravitational field
strength can be analysed to show patterns in the properties and behaviour of the planets.
i XAM-STYLE QUESTIONS
Which of the following objects is a planet?
A the Moon
B Hale-Bopp
C Pluto
[1]
D Uranus
Which statement about the orbits of the Earth and Moon is correct?
[1]
A The Moon rotates on its axis in 24 hours and orbits the Earth in 27.5 days.
B The Earth rotates on its axis in 24 hours and orbits the Sun in 365 days.
C The Moon orbits the Sun in 27.5 days.
D The Earth rotates on its axis in 24 hours and orbits the Moon in 27.5 days.
What force keeps the planets in orbit round the Sun?
A momentum
B air resistance
C tension
[1]
D gravity
The diagram shows how people 1000 years ago thought the Solar System looked.
COMMAND WORDS
State one way in which this model is different from what we now know
about the Solar System.
[1]
b State one way in which this model is similar to what we now know about
[1]
the Solar System.
one
way
Venus,
planets
State
Mercury,
in which the
Earth and Mars are
[1]
similar.
d State one way in which Jupiter and Saturn are different to the planets in
[1]
part c.
Mars is 228 million km from the Sun. Calculate the time it takes for light
to travel from the Sun to Mars. The speed of light is 3 x 108m/s.
[3]
[Total: 7]
state: express in clear
terms
calculate: work out
from given facts,
figures or information
5 Laurie is standing at point X on the Earth’s surface.
light from
the Sun
N
Earth
Moon
X
S
a How can you tell it is night time at point X?
b Redraw the diagram to show where point X will be after 12 hours.
The Moon does not emit light. Explain how Laurie is able to see the
Moon.
d Name the force which keeps the Moon in orbit around the Earth.
e Describe the movement of the Moon.
f A ball dropped on Earth will fall faster than an identical ball dropped
on the Moon. What does this tell you about the Moon’s gravity?
m
m
COMMAND W( H '
[i]
purposes or
tn
reasons; make
the relationships
between th jigs
evident; provide
why and/or how .in< I
explain: set out
[2]
[1]
[Total: 7]
evidence
6 The table shows some data about the objects orbiting the Sun.
Object
Distance
from Sun /
million km
Average surface
Density
temperature /
/ kg/m3
°C
Surface
gravity
/ N/kg
describe: state the
points of a topic; |i i
characteristics and
main features
Time of
1
orbit /
years
Venus
108
470
5200
9
0.6
| Earth
150
15
5500
10
1.0
Mars
228
-30
4000
5
1.9
| Jupiter
778
-150
1300
26
12
Saturn
1427
-180
700
11
30
| Pluto
5900
-230
500
4
248
Use the information in the table to answer the following questions.
Name the object that is not a planet.
b Which planet takes the least time to go round the Sun?
c A student writes, ‘the further away from the Sun a planet is, the lower
its density’. To what extent do you agree with this statement?
d What data from the table suggests that Pluto and Mars are the two least
massive objects?
e Calculate the average orbital speed of Jupiter. Give your answer in km/s
to two significant figures.
a
support w th relevant
[1]
[11
[2]
[2]
[3]
[Total: 9]
24 Earth and the Solar System
SELF-EVALUATION CHECKLIST
After studying this chapter, think about how confident you are with the different topics. This will help you to see
my gaps in your knowledge and help you to learn more effectively.
1 can
Explain how the Earth’s rotation on its axis causes
day and night and the apparent change in position of
the Sun.
1 Explain how the Earth’s tilted axis and its rotation
around the Sun cause seasons.
1 Explain how the Moon orbiting the Earth leads to
| the different phases of the Moon.
State how long it takes for the Earth to rotate, for the
Earth to orbit the Sim and for the Moon to orbit the
Earth.
Name the different objects which orbit the Sun.
1 Explain the difference between the inner and outer
planets.
| Calculate the time it takes for light to travel from the
Sun to a given planet.
i
See
Needs
Topic...
more work
Confident
to move on
24.1
24.1
24.1
24.1
24.2
24.2
24.2
Name the force which keeps the planets in orbit.
24.2
Describe the shape of planetary orbits and state the
position of the Sun within this shape.
24.2
Calculate orbital speed using the equation v =
24.2
Describe how gravitational potential energy and kinetic
energy vary as an object moves in an elliptical orbit.
Explain why the Sun has the largest gravitational
field of any object in the Solar System.
Interpret planetary data and describe patterns in this
data.
Almost
there
24.2
24.2
24.2
465
y
IN THIS CHAPTER YOU WILL:
describe the Sun and galaxies, including the Milky Way
learn about the relative separation of planets, stars and galaxies
describe how stable stars (such as the Sun) are powered by the thermonuclear fusion of hydrogen
learn that the redshift of light from distant galaxies supports the Big Bang theory
learn that this redshift can be described by Hubble's law, which can be used to work out the age of
the Universe.
25
Stars and the Universe
GETTING STARTED
Spend two minutes thinking about these questions
before comparing notes with your neighbour for a
further two minutes, adding to or correcting your
own work. Be prepared to share your thoughts with
the class.
Where does the Sun get its energy?
•
List what you know about the Universe.
What colour are stars?
What is a galaxy and what is the name of
our galaxy?
List the differences between planets and stars.
WHAT MAKES THE SUN SHINE?
We know many things about the Sun but a lot of that
knowledge has been gained very recently. Working
out what makes the Sun shine was a process of
eliminating different hypotheses (ideas) until one was
found that best fits the evidence.
This led scientists to work out that the Sun is
powered by thermonuclear fusion, though a fully
formed theory did not appear until 1939.
The Greek philosopher Aristotle believed the Sun
was made of ether, a perfect substance that glows
forever. However, in 1613, Galileo Galilei observed
sunspots on the Sun and these 'imperfections'
showed that the Sun could not be made of ether.
Coal was burned in steam engines to power the
UK's Industrial Revolution. This made scientists
wonder whether the Sun was a giant lump of coal
but calculations showed that a Sun made of coal
would shine for less than 1 500 years and this is a
shorter time than recorded history. However, efforts
to understand steam power led to the principle of
conservation of energy. This led scientists to look for
other sources of energy (that could be transferred
by light).
Scientists like Hermann von Helmholtz believed
the kinetic energy of meteorites (lumps of rock)
colliding with the Sun could be this source of
energy. However, the total mass of meteorites was
too small and they were not moving fast enough to
provide the required energy.
Other scientists imagined that the Sun was once
much bigger so that it only just fitted inside the
Earth's orbit. But the gravitational energy released
when it collapsed to its present size could only
have provided enough energy for 100 million years,
which was not enough time for the evolution of
different species on Earth to have taken place.
Then radioactivity was discovered, and Einstein
showed that mass can be transformed into energy.
Figure 25.1: The Sun shining.
Discussion questions
1
List at least three things that most people used
to believe about what makes the Sun shine. For
each one, write down how scientists showed
that the belief was incorrect.
467
y
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
25.1 The Sun
KEY WORDS
stable star: a starthat is not collapsing < >i
because the inward force of gravity is btil.int mi I In
radiation pressure, which pushes outward-.
plasma: a completely ionised gas in whu h lift
temperature is too high for neutral atom1 I
so it consists of electrons and positively < lim u«
atomic nuclei
solar mass: equal to the mass of the Sun
(2 x 1030kg)
The Sun is an average or medium mass star and is made
up of about 75% hydrogen and about 24% helium. The
rest (about 1%) is made up of other elements, such as
oxygen and carbon.
The glowing hydrogen at the surface of the Sun radiates
energy. About 40% of this energy is visible light, about
50% is infrared radiation, and the remaining 10% is
ultraviolet. Earth’s atmosphere absorbs a lot of this
ultraviolet radiation. The ozone layer, in particular,
absorbs most of the harmful (more ionising) ultraviolet.
Stars are powered by nuclear reactions that release energy.
Stable stars like our Sun are powered by the nuclear fusion
(or thermonuclear fusion) of hydrogen into helium. This
makes the Sun shine. It is so hot inside the Sun that matter
exists as plasma (positive ions and electrons). Although the
Sun produces gamma rays because of the nuclear fusion
process, collisions with the plasma mean that it takes
about 100000 years for that energy to reach the Sun’s
surface. In addition, because the energy is spread over a
big surface (called the photosphere) the temperature is
lower at the Sun’s surface (about 5800 K compared to a
core temperature of about 15 000 000 K).
The Earth orbits the Sun at a distance of about 150
million kilometres, which is within the habitable zone.
This is the zone where water can exist in liquid form (an
essential requirement for life as we know it). If it was
hotter, the water vapour would never condense; if it was
colder, ice would never melt.
The Sun has a mass of 2 x 1030 kg. This is referred to as
the solar mass as it provides a simple way of comparing
the mass of other stars to the mass of our Sun. For
example, a star with eight solar masses would have
eight times the mass of the Sun. The Sun contains over
99.86% of the mass of the Solar System so it exerts a
big gravitational force on the planets and causes them to
follow nearly circular orbits.
1
Questions
1
From which two elements is the Sun nunlh
made?
2
Give an approximate value for:
a the temperature in the Sun’s core
b the temperature of the Sun’s si face
c the solar mass
d the percentage of sunlight that is in I hi
infrared, visible and ultraviol :t part- ul th
electromagnetic spectrum.
.
3
Name the process that makes stable stars, mu Ii
as our Sun, shine.
4
Imagine that Earth orbited a star that give -ill
most of its energy in the ultraviolet region ul i hspectrum. Discuss whether our eyes would nil hci
evolved to see visible light.
ACTIVITY 25.1
What colour is the Sun?
Spend two minutes writing down your thoughts and
answers to the questions. Then spend one minute
discussing them with a partner.
Your teacher may give you additional time to
research these questions using the Internet, or ask
468
supplementary questions to help you reach th- •
correct answer.
1
Why do most people think the Sun is yellow?
2
Is this the correct colour of the Sun?
How do we know?
25 Stars and the Universe
REFLECTION
Did you already know the correct answer to
Activity 25.1?
It is important in science to avoid looking for
evidence that supports an idea that you already
think is correct. Scientists must also avoid not
looking for evidence at all and assuming that they
know the answer. If you thought the Sun is
yellow, did you question this idea? If you guessed
that the Sun is not yellow, did you know what
questions to ask to work out its correct colour?
Were you able to think objectively and find
evidence to support the correct answer? This is
how science progresses and it is the approach
outlined in the Science in context section What
makes the Sun shine? that led to correctly
understanding how stars shine.
25.2 Stars and galaxies
When you look into the night sky, the light that you
."c from the stars has been travelling for many years.
A Nt i onomers use this idea as a way of measuring vast
distances. A light-year is a measure of distance (not
I line). It is the distance that light travels through space in
line year. Light travels at a constant speed of 3 x 108m/s
llirough a vacuum. This means that the time it takes to
I ravel somewhere is directly proportional to distance.
< )nc light-year is the distance that light travels in one year,
Questions
5
6
The Sun is about eight light-minutes away. It takes
sunlight about eight minutes to reach Earth on its
journey from the Sun.
a Given that the speed of light is 3 x 108m/s, how
far away is the Sun in kilometres?
b How many years would it take a car to get to
the Sun travelling at 120 km/h?
After our Sun, Proxima Centauri is our next nearest
star. It is about 4.2 light-years away.
a How many seconds does it take light from
Proxima Centauri to reach Earth?
b How far away is Proxima Centauri in km?
c Helios I & II hold the record as the fastest ever
space probes at 252 738 km/h (about 70 km/s).
How many years would it take these space
probes to reach Proxima Centauri?
d How long would it take them to reach the
nearest galaxy 25 000 light-years away from us?
The force of gravity pulls stars together in groups called
galaxies. Our Sun is one of many billions of stars in our
galaxy, the Milky Way. There might be 200 billion (2 x 10’')
stars in the Milky Way, about 20 stars for every person
on Earth. The Milky Way is a spiral galaxy with a central
bulge (see Figure 25.2). It has a diameter of 100 000 lightyears and the disc is about 2000 light-years thick. Our Solar
System is located about 30 000 light-years from the galactic
centre, two-thirds of the way along a spiral arm. The Milky
Way is spinning and it takes our Solar System about 225
million years to travel once around the galaxy.
illatance = speed x time
= 3 x 108m/s x 365.25 days x 24 hours
3600 seconds = 9.5 x 10l5m.
So, one light-year
KEY WORD
light-year: the distance travelled in space by light
In one year (it is equivalent to about 9.5 x 1 015 m)
I he distance between stars is much bigger than the size
of each solar system. After the Sun, our next nearest
Mar is Proxima Centauri, which is about 4.2 light-years
ijway. When you see Proxima Centauri the light left it
I 2 years ago; sunlight only takes eight minutes to reach
lis because the Sun is much closer to us. Pluto has an
oil iptical orbit but, on average, it is 40 times further from
Ilie Sun than the Earth is. But this is dwarfed by the
distance between Proxima Centauri and the Sun, whch is
7000 times further from the Sun than Pluto is.
The Milky Way is one of many billions of galaxies,
that make up the Universe. Most people consider the
Andromeda Galaxy (Figure 25.3) to be our closest galactic
neighbour and it is certainly our closest spiral galaxy.
However, our nearest galactic neighbour is the Canis Major
469
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
Dwarf Galaxy, which is 25 000 light-years away from us
and 42 000 light-years from the centre of the Milky Way.
ACTIVITY 25.2
How do astronomers measure distances to
faraway objects?
Astronomers have many techniques to measur<'
distances in space. For nearby stars within our
own galaxy, they can use parallax. This is when
the star appears to move across the sky when
viewed from opposite sides of our orbit around
the Sun, as shown in Figure 25.4.
Figure 25.3: An infrared image of the Andromeda Galaxy,
our closest spiral galaxy.
You can experience this yourself. Stretch out
an arm in front of you and stick up your thumb
Close one eye and open the other and then
swap over which is closed and open. Your thumb
should appear to move from side to side agaim-t
the background (which should be at least two .urn
lengths away).
Questions
7
a
Make two sketches to show the Milky Way
Galaxy; one sketch should show its spiral
structure and the other should show the galaxy
edge on.
b On your sketches mark the diameter of the
Milky Way in light-years.
c
Mark the position of the Sun in the Milky Way.
d How many stars are there in the Milky Way?
8 The Solar System has existed for 4.6 billion years.
How many times has the Solar System travelled
around the Milky Way in that time?
9 How can the Canis Major Dwarf Galaxy be closer to
us than we are to the centre of our own galaxy?
1 0 Assuming that the average mass of a star is equal to
the mass of the Sun (2 x 1030kg), what is the mass
of the Milky Way?
11 Imagine that the Milky Way is shrunk down to
fit into the space between the Earth and the Sun.
On this scale, calculate how far away the following
bodies would be from Earth:
a
Proxima Centauri (in km)
b Pluto (in km)
c the Sun (in metres)
d the Moon (in cm).
1 2 Write a sentence or two comparing your answers
to question 25.11 with the length of a pencil,
the length of a cricket pitch (about 20 metres), a
400 metre athletics track, and the radius of the
Earth (6400 km).
470
background stars
)
\
^y^ &
cVstar
/i\
/
Earth in summer jr"
A"-
*
/
Q
,para lax angle /
—
/
\/
Earth in wlnb
""B
'
Figure 25.4: Parallax in nearby stars.
When a telescope is pointed at a nearby star in
the summer it appears to be at location X againiJ
the background stars. When the telescope is
pointed in the same direction six months later
(shown by the dashed line from B), the astrononv
would need to swing the telescope through twlc«
the parallax angle in order to get the telescope
back onto the star, which appears to have moved
to position Y against the background stars.
1
In groups, use the biggest space available to
you to mark out three positions to represent
the locations of the Earth in summer (A), the
Earth in winter (B), and distant star (C), locate I
roughly south of A and B. Ensure that the
distant star is on the perpendicular bisector < >l
the line joining A and B. Measure the distant
between the Sun and the star.
25 Stars and the Universe
CONTINUED
2
3
Measure the distance between A and B.
Compass apps are standard on mobile
phones. Stand at position A and use the app
to measure the angle to C. Then move to B
and measure the angle to C. Subtract the two
angles and divide by two to get the parallax
angle. Use trigonometry or a scale drawing
to find the distance between the Sun and
the star. Check whether your answer is within
10% of the distance measured. If your answer
is incorrect, identify the source of the error.
Repeat step 2 with the layout produced by
other groups but keep the distance to your
'star' a secret until the end. The winning
group is the one that gets consistently
closest to the actual value.
A protostar - how a star is born
A protostar is the first step in star formation. Stars form
from interstellar clouds of gas and dust that contain
hydrogen called molecular clouds, which are both cold
and dense enough for star formation. The Orion Nebula
(Figure 25.5) in the Milky Way is about 1 350 light-years
away and it is the closest region of star formation to us.
It is visible to the naked eye in the night sky just south of
Orion’s Belt in the constellation of Orion.
As the force of gravity pulls the hydrogen gas
molecules closer together, their gravitational potential
energy is transferred to kinetic energy. As the molecules
collide, their kinetic energy is transferred into thermal
energy. The clump contracts into a spinning sphere
of super-hot gas known as a protostar. A protostar
continues to grow by pulling in more material from the
molecular cloud. Its final mass determines what happens
to it. A protostar becomes stable when the inward force
of gravitational attraction is balanced by an outward
force due to the high temperature of a star caused by
nuclear fusion.
KEY WORDS
protostar: a very young star that is still gathering
mass from its parent molecular cloud
interstellar cloud: a cloud of gas and dust that
occupies the space between stars
molecular cloud: a cloud of interstellar gas that
consists mostly of molecular hydrogen and is cold
and dense enough to collapse to form stars
Questions
1 3 What two properties do molecular clouds have that
allow them to collapse?
14 a Explain how stars are formed.
b What causes the centre of a star to warm up
when it forms?
15 a Explain what is meant by nuclear fusion.
b Why can nuclear fusion only occur at high
temperatures?
Stable stars
Figure 25.5: The Orion Nebula, the closest region of star
formation and visible to the naked eye.
I"he collapse of a clump of molecular cloud due to
gravitational attraction starts a series of energy transfers.
Hot bodies radiate heat and this radiation exerts a
force called radiation pressure. The hotter the object
is, the higher the radiation pressure. The very high
temperature of a star leads to a radiation pressure that
acts outwards, making the star expand. This acts in
the opposite direction to the force of gravity pulling
the star inwards, making the star contract. When these
forces are balanced, the star is stable and stays the same
size as shown in Figure 25.6. An increase in the core
temperature of a star increases the radiation pressure
and the star increases in size. A star shrinks when its core
temperature falls.
>
CAMBRIDGE IGCSE™ PHYSICS: COURSEBOOK
KEY WORDS
radiation pressure: the outward force due to the
high temperature of the star
collapses into a white dwarf statr. A white dwarf CHiumi
exceed a mass of about 1.4 solar masses and typiculh
has a radius of 1000 km. When the Sun becomes a whin
dwarf, its radius will be about 1% of its present radiu
which means it will shrink to about the size of the I n I h
Though it has a white hot surface (hence the coioUi ) il 4
not hot enough inside to fuse heavier elements, so it w ill
cool to become a black dwarf. Radiation pressu
0
You can add this document to your study collection(s)
Sign in Available only to authorized usersYou can add this document to your saved list
Sign in Available only to authorized users(For complaints, use another form )